Update years in copyright notice; nfc.
[bpt/emacs.git] / man / gnus.texi
1 \input texinfo
2
3 @setfilename ../info/gnus
4 @settitle Gnus Manual
5 @syncodeindex fn cp
6 @syncodeindex vr cp
7 @syncodeindex pg cp
8
9 @copying
10 Copyright (C) 1995, 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001,
11 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
12
13 @quotation
14 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
15 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
16 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
17 Invariant Sections, with the Front-Cover texts being ``A GNU
18 Manual'', and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below. A copy of the
19 license is included in the section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation
20 License'' in the Emacs manual.
21
22 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have freedom to copy and modify
23 this GNU Manual, like GNU software. Copies published by the Free
24 Software Foundation raise funds for GNU development.''
25
26 This document is part of a collection distributed under the GNU Free
27 Documentation License. If you want to distribute this document
28 separately from the collection, you can do so by adding a copy of the
29 license to the document, as described in section 6 of the license.
30 @end quotation
31 @end copying
32
33 @iftex
34 @iflatex
35 \documentclass[twoside,a4paper,openright,11pt]{book}
36 \usepackage[latin1]{inputenc}
37 \usepackage{pagestyle}
38 \usepackage{epsfig}
39 \usepackage{pixidx}
40 \input{gnusconfig.tex}
41
42 \ifx\pdfoutput\undefined
43 \else
44 \usepackage[pdftex,bookmarks,colorlinks=true]{hyperref}
45 \usepackage{thumbpdf}
46 \pdfcompresslevel=9
47 \fi
48
49 \makeindex
50 \begin{document}
51
52 \newcommand{\gnusversionname}{Gnus v5.10.6}
53 \newcommand{\gnuschaptername}{}
54 \newcommand{\gnussectionname}{}
55
56 \newcommand{\gnusbackslash}{/}
57
58 \newcommand{\gnusref}[1]{``#1'' on page \pageref{#1}}
59 \ifx\pdfoutput\undefined
60 \newcommand{\gnusuref}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
61 \else
62 \newcommand{\gnusuref}[1]{\href{#1}{\gnustt{#1}}}
63 \fi
64 \newcommand{\gnusxref}[1]{See ``#1'' on page \pageref{#1}}
65 \newcommand{\gnuspxref}[1]{see ``#1'' on page \pageref{#1}}
66
67 \newcommand{\gnuskindex}[1]{\index{#1}}
68 \newcommand{\gnusindex}[1]{\index{#1}}
69
70 \newcommand{\gnustt}[1]{{\gnusselectttfont{}#1}}
71 \newcommand{\gnuscode}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
72 \newcommand{\gnusasis}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
73 \newcommand{\gnusurl}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
74 \newcommand{\gnuscommand}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
75 \newcommand{\gnusenv}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
76 \newcommand{\gnussamp}[1]{``{\fontencoding{OT1}\gnusselectttfont{}#1}''}
77 \newcommand{\gnuslisp}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
78 \newcommand{\gnuskbd}[1]{`\gnustt{#1}'}
79 \newcommand{\gnuskey}[1]{`\gnustt{#1}'}
80 \newcommand{\gnusfile}[1]{`\gnustt{#1}'}
81 \newcommand{\gnusdfn}[1]{\textit{#1}}
82 \newcommand{\gnusi}[1]{\textit{#1}}
83 \newcommand{\gnusr}[1]{\textrm{#1}}
84 \newcommand{\gnusstrong}[1]{\textbf{#1}}
85 \newcommand{\gnusemph}[1]{\textit{#1}}
86 \newcommand{\gnusvar}[1]{{\fontsize{10pt}{10}\selectfont\textsl{\textsf{#1}}}}
87 \newcommand{\gnussc}[1]{\textsc{#1}}
88 \newcommand{\gnustitle}[1]{{\huge\textbf{#1}}}
89 \newcommand{\gnusversion}[1]{{\small\textit{#1}}}
90 \newcommand{\gnusauthor}[1]{{\large\textbf{#1}}}
91 \newcommand{\gnusresult}[1]{\gnustt{=> #1}}
92 \newcommand{\gnusacronym}[1]{\textsc{#1}}
93 \newcommand{\gnusemail}[1]{\textit{#1}}
94
95 \newcommand{\gnusbullet}{{${\bullet}$}}
96 \newcommand{\gnusdollar}{\$}
97 \newcommand{\gnusampersand}{\&}
98 \newcommand{\gnuspercent}{\%}
99 \newcommand{\gnushash}{\#}
100 \newcommand{\gnushat}{\symbol{"5E}}
101 \newcommand{\gnusunderline}{\symbol{"5F}}
102 \newcommand{\gnusnot}{$\neg$}
103 \newcommand{\gnustilde}{\symbol{"7E}}
104 \newcommand{\gnusless}{{$<$}}
105 \newcommand{\gnusgreater}{{$>$}}
106 \newcommand{\gnusbraceleft}{{$>$}}
107 \newcommand{\gnusbraceright}{{$>$}}
108
109 \newcommand{\gnushead}{\raisebox{-1cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-head,height=1cm}}}
110 \newcommand{\gnusinteresting}{
111 \marginpar[\mbox{}\hfill\gnushead]{\gnushead}
112 }
113
114 \newcommand{\gnuscleardoublepage}{\ifodd\count0\mbox{}\clearpage\thispagestyle{empty}\mbox{}\clearpage\else\clearpage\fi}
115
116 \newcommand{\gnuspagechapter}[1]{
117 {\mbox{}}
118 }
119
120 \newdimen{\gnusdimen}
121 \gnusdimen 0pt
122
123 \newcommand{\gnuschapter}[2]{
124 \gnuscleardoublepage
125 \ifdim \gnusdimen = 0pt\setcounter{page}{1}\pagestyle{gnus}\pagenumbering{arabic} \gnusdimen 1pt\fi
126 \chapter{#2}
127 \renewcommand{\gnussectionname}{}
128 \renewcommand{\gnuschaptername}{#2}
129 \thispagestyle{empty}
130 \hspace*{-2cm}
131 \begin{picture}(500,500)(0,0)
132 \put(480,350){\makebox(0,0)[tr]{#1}}
133 \put(40,300){\makebox(500,50)[bl]{{\Huge\bf{#2}}}}
134 \end{picture}
135 \clearpage
136 }
137
138 \newcommand{\gnusfigure}[3]{
139 \begin{figure}
140 \mbox{}\ifodd\count0\hspace*{-0.8cm}\else\hspace*{-3cm}\fi\begin{picture}(440,#2)
141 #3
142 \end{picture}
143 \caption{#1}
144 \end{figure}
145 }
146
147 \newcommand{\gnusicon}[1]{
148 \marginpar[\mbox{}\hfill\raisebox{-1.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/#1-up,height=1.5cm}}]{\raisebox{-1cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/#1-up,height=1cm}}}
149 }
150
151 \newcommand{\gnuspicon}[1]{
152 \margindex{\epsfig{figure=#1,width=2cm}}
153 }
154
155 \newcommand{\gnusxface}[2]{
156 \margindex{\epsfig{figure=#1,width=1cm}\epsfig{figure=#2,width=1cm}}
157 }
158
159 \newcommand{\gnussmiley}[2]{
160 \margindex{\makebox[2cm]{\hfill\epsfig{figure=#1,width=0.5cm}\hfill\epsfig{figure=#2,width=0.5cm}\hfill}}
161 }
162
163 \newcommand{\gnusitemx}[1]{\mbox{}\vspace*{-\itemsep}\vspace*{-\parsep}\item#1}
164
165 \newcommand{\gnussection}[1]{
166 \renewcommand{\gnussectionname}{#1}
167 \section{#1}
168 }
169
170 \newenvironment{codelist}%
171 {\begin{list}{}{
172 }
173 }{\end{list}}
174
175 \newenvironment{asislist}%
176 {\begin{list}{}{
177 }
178 }{\end{list}}
179
180 \newenvironment{kbdlist}%
181 {\begin{list}{}{
182 \labelwidth=0cm
183 }
184 }{\end{list}}
185
186 \newenvironment{dfnlist}%
187 {\begin{list}{}{
188 }
189 }{\end{list}}
190
191 \newenvironment{stronglist}%
192 {\begin{list}{}{
193 }
194 }{\end{list}}
195
196 \newenvironment{samplist}%
197 {\begin{list}{}{
198 }
199 }{\end{list}}
200
201 \newenvironment{varlist}%
202 {\begin{list}{}{
203 }
204 }{\end{list}}
205
206 \newenvironment{emphlist}%
207 {\begin{list}{}{
208 }
209 }{\end{list}}
210
211 \newlength\gnusheadtextwidth
212 \setlength{\gnusheadtextwidth}{\headtextwidth}
213 \addtolength{\gnusheadtextwidth}{1cm}
214
215 \newpagestyle{gnuspreamble}%
216 {
217 {
218 \ifodd\count0
219 {
220 \hspace*{-0.23cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\mbox{}}\textbf{\hfill\roman{page}}}
221 }
222 \else
223 {
224 \hspace*{-3.25cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\roman{page}\hfill\mbox{}}}
225 }
226 }
227 \fi
228 }
229 }
230 {
231 \ifodd\count0
232 \mbox{} \hfill
233 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
234 \else
235 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
236 \hfill \mbox{}
237 \fi
238 }
239
240 \newpagestyle{gnusindex}%
241 {
242 {
243 \ifodd\count0
244 {
245 \hspace*{-0.23cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\gnuschaptername\hfill\arabic{page}}}}
246 }
247 \else
248 {
249 \hspace*{-3.25cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\arabic{page}\hfill\gnuschaptername}}}
250 }
251 \fi
252 }
253 }
254 {
255 \ifodd\count0
256 \mbox{} \hfill
257 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
258 \else
259 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
260 \hfill \mbox{}
261 \fi
262 }
263
264 \newpagestyle{gnus}%
265 {
266 {
267 \ifodd\count0
268 {
269 \makebox[12cm]{\hspace*{3.1cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\arabic{chapter}.\arabic{section}} \textbf{\gnussectionname\hfill\arabic{page}}}}}
270 }
271 \else
272 {
273 \makebox[12cm]{\hspace*{-2.95cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\arabic{page}\hfill\gnuschaptername}}}}
274 }
275 \fi
276 }
277 }
278 {
279 \ifodd\count0
280 \mbox{} \hfill
281 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
282 \else
283 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
284 \hfill \mbox{}
285 \fi
286 }
287
288 \pagenumbering{roman}
289 \pagestyle{gnuspreamble}
290
291 @end iflatex
292 @end iftex
293
294 @iftex
295 @iflatex
296
297 \begin{titlepage}
298 {
299
300 %\addtolength{\oddsidemargin}{-5cm}
301 %\addtolength{\evensidemargin}{-5cm}
302 \parindent=0cm
303 \addtolength{\textheight}{2cm}
304
305 \gnustitle{\gnustitlename}\hfill\gnusversion{\gnusversionname}\\
306 \rule{15cm}{1mm}\\
307 \vfill
308 \hspace*{0cm}\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=15cm}
309 \vfill
310 \rule{15cm}{1mm}\\
311 \gnusauthor{by Lars Magne Ingebrigtsen}
312 \newpage
313 }
314
315 \mbox{}
316 \vfill
317
318 \thispagestyle{empty}
319
320 @c @insertcopying
321 \newpage
322 \end{titlepage}
323 @end iflatex
324 @end iftex
325
326 @ifnottex
327 @insertcopying
328 @end ifnottex
329
330 @dircategory Emacs
331 @direntry
332 * Gnus: (gnus). The newsreader Gnus.
333 @end direntry
334 @iftex
335 @finalout
336 @end iftex
337 @setchapternewpage odd
338
339
340
341 @titlepage
342 @title Gnus Manual
343
344 @author by Lars Magne Ingebrigtsen
345 @page
346 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
347 @insertcopying
348 @end titlepage
349
350
351 @node Top
352 @top The Gnus Newsreader
353
354 @ifinfo
355
356 You can read news (and mail) from within Emacs by using Gnus. The news
357 can be gotten by any nefarious means you can think of---@acronym{NNTP}, local
358 spool or your mbox file. All at the same time, if you want to push your
359 luck.
360
361 This manual corresponds to Gnus v5.10.6.
362
363 @end ifinfo
364
365 @iftex
366
367 @iflatex
368 \tableofcontents
369 \gnuscleardoublepage
370 @end iflatex
371
372 Gnus is the advanced, self-documenting, customizable, extensible
373 unreal-time newsreader for GNU Emacs.
374
375 Oops. That sounds oddly familiar, so let's start over again to avoid
376 being accused of plagiarism:
377
378 Gnus is a message-reading laboratory. It will let you look at just
379 about anything as if it were a newsgroup. You can read mail with it,
380 you can browse directories with it, you can @code{ftp} with it---you
381 can even read news with it!
382
383 Gnus tries to empower people who read news the same way Emacs empowers
384 people who edit text. Gnus sets no limits to what the user should be
385 allowed to do. Users are encouraged to extend Gnus to make it behave
386 like they want it to behave. A program should not control people;
387 people should be empowered to do what they want by using (or abusing)
388 the program.
389
390 @end iftex
391
392 @menu
393 * Starting Up:: Finding news can be a pain.
394 * Group Buffer:: Selecting, subscribing and killing groups.
395 * Summary Buffer:: Reading, saving and posting articles.
396 * Article Buffer:: Displaying and handling articles.
397 * Composing Messages:: Information on sending mail and news.
398 * Select Methods:: Gnus reads all messages from various select methods.
399 * Scoring:: Assigning values to articles.
400 * Various:: General purpose settings.
401 * The End:: Farewell and goodbye.
402 * Appendices:: Terminology, Emacs intro, @acronym{FAQ}, History, Internals.
403 * Index:: Variable, function and concept index.
404 * Key Index:: Key Index.
405
406 Other related manuals
407
408 * Message:(message). Composing messages.
409 * Emacs-MIME:(emacs-mime). Composing messages; @acronym{MIME}-specific parts.
410 * Sieve:(sieve). Managing Sieve scripts in Emacs.
411 * PGG:(pgg). @acronym{PGP/MIME} with Gnus.
412
413 @detailmenu
414 --- The Detailed Node Listing ---
415
416 Starting Gnus
417
418 * Finding the News:: Choosing a method for getting news.
419 * The First Time:: What does Gnus do the first time you start it?
420 * The Server is Down:: How can I read my mail then?
421 * Slave Gnusae:: You can have more than one Gnus active at a time.
422 * Fetching a Group:: Starting Gnus just to read a group.
423 * New Groups:: What is Gnus supposed to do with new groups?
424 * Changing Servers:: You may want to move from one server to another.
425 * Startup Files:: Those pesky startup files---@file{.newsrc}.
426 * Auto Save:: Recovering from a crash.
427 * The Active File:: Reading the active file over a slow line Takes Time.
428 * Startup Variables:: Other variables you might change.
429
430 New Groups
431
432 * Checking New Groups:: Determining what groups are new.
433 * Subscription Methods:: What Gnus should do with new groups.
434 * Filtering New Groups:: Making Gnus ignore certain new groups.
435
436 Group Buffer
437
438 * Group Buffer Format:: Information listed and how you can change it.
439 * Group Maneuvering:: Commands for moving in the group buffer.
440 * Selecting a Group:: Actually reading news.
441 * Subscription Commands:: Unsubscribing, killing, subscribing.
442 * Group Data:: Changing the info for a group.
443 * Group Levels:: Levels? What are those, then?
444 * Group Score:: A mechanism for finding out what groups you like.
445 * Marking Groups:: You can mark groups for later processing.
446 * Foreign Groups:: Creating and editing groups.
447 * Group Parameters:: Each group may have different parameters set.
448 * Listing Groups:: Gnus can list various subsets of the groups.
449 * Sorting Groups:: Re-arrange the group order.
450 * Group Maintenance:: Maintaining a tidy @file{.newsrc} file.
451 * Browse Foreign Server:: You can browse a server. See what it has to offer.
452 * Exiting Gnus:: Stop reading news and get some work done.
453 * Group Topics:: A folding group mode divided into topics.
454 * Misc Group Stuff:: Other stuff that you can to do.
455
456 Group Buffer Format
457
458 * Group Line Specification:: Deciding how the group buffer is to look.
459 * Group Mode Line Specification:: The group buffer mode line.
460 * Group Highlighting:: Having nice colors in the group buffer.
461
462 Group Topics
463
464 * Topic Commands:: Interactive E-Z commands.
465 * Topic Variables:: How to customize the topics the Lisp Way.
466 * Topic Sorting:: Sorting each topic individually.
467 * Topic Topology:: A map of the world.
468 * Topic Parameters:: Parameters that apply to all groups in a topic.
469
470 Misc Group Stuff
471
472 * Scanning New Messages:: Asking Gnus to see whether new messages have arrived.
473 * Group Information:: Information and help on groups and Gnus.
474 * Group Timestamp:: Making Gnus keep track of when you last read a group.
475 * File Commands:: Reading and writing the Gnus files.
476 * Sieve Commands:: Managing Sieve scripts.
477
478 Summary Buffer
479
480 * Summary Buffer Format:: Deciding how the summary buffer is to look.
481 * Summary Maneuvering:: Moving around the summary buffer.
482 * Choosing Articles:: Reading articles.
483 * Paging the Article:: Scrolling the current article.
484 * Reply Followup and Post:: Posting articles.
485 * Delayed Articles:: Send articles at a later time.
486 * Marking Articles:: Marking articles as read, expirable, etc.
487 * Limiting:: You can limit the summary buffer.
488 * Threading:: How threads are made.
489 * Sorting the Summary Buffer:: How articles and threads are sorted.
490 * Asynchronous Fetching:: Gnus might be able to pre-fetch articles.
491 * Article Caching:: You may store articles in a cache.
492 * Persistent Articles:: Making articles expiry-resistant.
493 * Article Backlog:: Having already read articles hang around.
494 * Saving Articles:: Ways of customizing article saving.
495 * Decoding Articles:: Gnus can treat series of (uu)encoded articles.
496 * Article Treatment:: The article buffer can be mangled at will.
497 * MIME Commands:: Doing MIMEy things with the articles.
498 * Charsets:: Character set issues.
499 * Article Commands:: Doing various things with the article buffer.
500 * Summary Sorting:: Sorting the summary buffer in various ways.
501 * Finding the Parent:: No child support? Get the parent.
502 * Alternative Approaches:: Reading using non-default summaries.
503 * Tree Display:: A more visual display of threads.
504 * Mail Group Commands:: Some commands can only be used in mail groups.
505 * Various Summary Stuff:: What didn't fit anywhere else.
506 * Exiting the Summary Buffer:: Returning to the Group buffer,
507 or reselecting the current group.
508 * Crosspost Handling:: How crossposted articles are dealt with.
509 * Duplicate Suppression:: An alternative when crosspost handling fails.
510 * Security:: Decrypt and Verify.
511 * Mailing List:: Mailing list minor mode.
512
513 Summary Buffer Format
514
515 * Summary Buffer Lines:: You can specify how summary lines should look.
516 * To From Newsgroups:: How to not display your own name.
517 * Summary Buffer Mode Line:: You can say how the mode line should look.
518 * Summary Highlighting:: Making the summary buffer all pretty and nice.
519
520 Choosing Articles
521
522 * Choosing Commands:: Commands for choosing articles.
523 * Choosing Variables:: Variables that influence these commands.
524
525 Reply, Followup and Post
526
527 * Summary Mail Commands:: Sending mail.
528 * Summary Post Commands:: Sending news.
529 * Summary Message Commands:: Other Message-related commands.
530 * Canceling and Superseding::
531
532 Marking Articles
533
534 * Unread Articles:: Marks for unread articles.
535 * Read Articles:: Marks for read articles.
536 * Other Marks:: Marks that do not affect readedness.
537 * Setting Marks:: How to set and remove marks.
538 * Generic Marking Commands:: How to customize the marking.
539 * Setting Process Marks:: How to mark articles for later processing.
540
541 Threading
542
543 * Customizing Threading:: Variables you can change to affect the threading.
544 * Thread Commands:: Thread based commands in the summary buffer.
545
546 Customizing Threading
547
548 * Loose Threads:: How Gnus gathers loose threads into bigger threads.
549 * Filling In Threads:: Making the threads displayed look fuller.
550 * More Threading:: Even more variables for fiddling with threads.
551 * Low-Level Threading:: You thought it was over@dots{} but you were wrong!
552
553 Decoding Articles
554
555 * Uuencoded Articles:: Uudecode articles.
556 * Shell Archives:: Unshar articles.
557 * PostScript Files:: Split PostScript.
558 * Other Files:: Plain save and binhex.
559 * Decoding Variables:: Variables for a happy decoding.
560 * Viewing Files:: You want to look at the result of the decoding?
561
562 Decoding Variables
563
564 * Rule Variables:: Variables that say how a file is to be viewed.
565 * Other Decode Variables:: Other decode variables.
566 * Uuencoding and Posting:: Variables for customizing uuencoding.
567
568 Article Treatment
569
570 * Article Highlighting:: You want to make the article look like fruit salad.
571 * Article Fontisizing:: Making emphasized text look nice.
572 * Article Hiding:: You also want to make certain info go away.
573 * Article Washing:: Lots of way-neat functions to make life better.
574 * Article Header:: Doing various header transformations.
575 * Article Buttons:: Click on URLs, Message-IDs, addresses and the like.
576 * Article Button Levels:: Controlling appearance of buttons.
577 * Article Date:: Grumble, UT!
578 * Article Display:: Display various stuff---X-Face, Picons, Smileys
579 * Article Signature:: What is a signature?
580 * Article Miscellanea:: Various other stuff.
581
582 Alternative Approaches
583
584 * Pick and Read:: First mark articles and then read them.
585 * Binary Groups:: Auto-decode all articles.
586
587 Various Summary Stuff
588
589 * Summary Group Information:: Information oriented commands.
590 * Searching for Articles:: Multiple article commands.
591 * Summary Generation Commands::
592 * Really Various Summary Commands:: Those pesky non-conformant commands.
593
594 Article Buffer
595
596 * Hiding Headers:: Deciding what headers should be displayed.
597 * Using MIME:: Pushing articles through @acronym{MIME} before reading them.
598 * Customizing Articles:: Tailoring the look of the articles.
599 * Article Keymap:: Keystrokes available in the article buffer.
600 * Misc Article:: Other stuff.
601
602 Composing Messages
603
604 * Mail:: Mailing and replying.
605 * Posting Server:: What server should you post and mail via?
606 * POP before SMTP:: You cannot send a mail unless you read a mail.
607 * Mail and Post:: Mailing and posting at the same time.
608 * Archived Messages:: Where Gnus stores the messages you've sent.
609 * Posting Styles:: An easier way to specify who you are.
610 * Drafts:: Postponing messages and rejected messages.
611 * Rejected Articles:: What happens if the server doesn't like your article?
612 * Signing and encrypting:: How to compose secure messages.
613
614 Select Methods
615
616 * Server Buffer:: Making and editing virtual servers.
617 * Getting News:: Reading USENET news with Gnus.
618 * Getting Mail:: Reading your personal mail with Gnus.
619 * Browsing the Web:: Getting messages from a plethora of Web sources.
620 * IMAP:: Using Gnus as a @acronym{IMAP} client.
621 * Other Sources:: Reading directories, files, SOUP packets.
622 * Combined Groups:: Combining groups into one group.
623 * Gnus Unplugged:: Reading news and mail offline.
624
625 Server Buffer
626
627 * Server Buffer Format:: You can customize the look of this buffer.
628 * Server Commands:: Commands to manipulate servers.
629 * Example Methods:: Examples server specifications.
630 * Creating a Virtual Server:: An example session.
631 * Server Variables:: Which variables to set.
632 * Servers and Methods:: You can use server names as select methods.
633 * Unavailable Servers:: Some servers you try to contact may be down.
634
635 Getting News
636
637 * NNTP:: Reading news from an @acronym{NNTP} server.
638 * News Spool:: Reading news from the local spool.
639
640 @acronym{NNTP}
641
642 * Direct Functions:: Connecting directly to the server.
643 * Indirect Functions:: Connecting indirectly to the server.
644 * Common Variables:: Understood by several connection functions.
645
646 Getting Mail
647
648 * Mail in a Newsreader:: Important introductory notes.
649 * Getting Started Reading Mail:: A simple cookbook example.
650 * Splitting Mail:: How to create mail groups.
651 * Mail Sources:: How to tell Gnus where to get mail from.
652 * Mail Back End Variables:: Variables for customizing mail handling.
653 * Fancy Mail Splitting:: Gnus can do hairy splitting of incoming mail.
654 * Group Mail Splitting:: Use group customize to drive mail splitting.
655 * Incorporating Old Mail:: What about the old mail you have?
656 * Expiring Mail:: Getting rid of unwanted mail.
657 * Washing Mail:: Removing cruft from the mail you get.
658 * Duplicates:: Dealing with duplicated mail.
659 * Not Reading Mail:: Using mail back ends for reading other files.
660 * Choosing a Mail Back End:: Gnus can read a variety of mail formats.
661
662 Mail Sources
663
664 * Mail Source Specifiers:: How to specify what a mail source is.
665 * Mail Source Customization:: Some variables that influence things.
666 * Fetching Mail:: Using the mail source specifiers.
667
668 Choosing a Mail Back End
669
670 * Unix Mail Box:: Using the (quite) standard Un*x mbox.
671 * Rmail Babyl:: Emacs programs use the Rmail Babyl format.
672 * Mail Spool:: Store your mail in a private spool?
673 * MH Spool:: An mhspool-like back end.
674 * Maildir:: Another one-file-per-message format.
675 * Mail Folders:: Having one file for each group.
676 * Comparing Mail Back Ends:: An in-depth looks at pros and cons.
677
678 Browsing the Web
679
680 * Archiving Mail::
681 * Web Searches:: Creating groups from articles that match a string.
682 * Slashdot:: Reading the Slashdot comments.
683 * Ultimate:: The Ultimate Bulletin Board systems.
684 * Web Archive:: Reading mailing list archived on web.
685 * RSS:: Reading RDF site summary.
686 * Customizing w3:: Doing stuff to Emacs/w3 from Gnus.
687
688 @acronym{IMAP}
689
690 * Splitting in IMAP:: Splitting mail with nnimap.
691 * Expiring in IMAP:: Expiring mail with nnimap.
692 * Editing IMAP ACLs:: Limiting/enabling other users access to a mailbox.
693 * Expunging mailboxes:: Equivalent of a ``compress mailbox'' button.
694 * A note on namespaces:: How to (not) use @acronym{IMAP} namespace in Gnus.
695 * Debugging IMAP:: What to do when things don't work.
696
697 Other Sources
698
699 * Directory Groups:: You can read a directory as if it was a newsgroup.
700 * Anything Groups:: Dired? Who needs dired?
701 * Document Groups:: Single files can be the basis of a group.
702 * SOUP:: Reading @sc{soup} packets ``offline''.
703 * Mail-To-News Gateways:: Posting articles via mail-to-news gateways.
704
705 Document Groups
706
707 * Document Server Internals:: How to add your own document types.
708
709 SOUP
710
711 * SOUP Commands:: Commands for creating and sending @sc{soup} packets
712 * SOUP Groups:: A back end for reading @sc{soup} packets.
713 * SOUP Replies:: How to enable @code{nnsoup} to take over mail and news.
714
715 Combined Groups
716
717 * Virtual Groups:: Combining articles from many groups.
718 * Kibozed Groups:: Looking through parts of the newsfeed for articles.
719
720 Gnus Unplugged
721
722 * Agent Basics:: How it all is supposed to work.
723 * Agent Categories:: How to tell the Gnus Agent what to download.
724 * Agent Commands:: New commands for all the buffers.
725 * Agent Visuals:: Ways that the agent may effect your summary buffer.
726 * Agent as Cache:: The Agent is a big cache too.
727 * Agent Expiry:: How to make old articles go away.
728 * Agent Regeneration:: How to recover from lost connections and other accidents.
729 * Agent and IMAP:: How to use the Agent with @acronym{IMAP}.
730 * Outgoing Messages:: What happens when you post/mail something?
731 * Agent Variables:: Customizing is fun.
732 * Example Setup:: An example @file{~/.gnus.el} file for offline people.
733 * Batching Agents:: How to fetch news from a @code{cron} job.
734 * Agent Caveats:: What you think it'll do and what it does.
735
736 Agent Categories
737
738 * Category Syntax:: What a category looks like.
739 * Category Buffer:: A buffer for maintaining categories.
740 * Category Variables:: Customize'r'Us.
741
742 Agent Commands
743
744 * Group Agent Commands:: Configure groups and fetch their contents.
745 * Summary Agent Commands:: Manually select then fetch specific articles.
746 * Server Agent Commands:: Select the servers that are supported by the agent.
747
748 Scoring
749
750 * Summary Score Commands:: Adding score entries for the current group.
751 * Group Score Commands:: General score commands.
752 * Score Variables:: Customize your scoring. (My, what terminology).
753 * Score File Format:: What a score file may contain.
754 * Score File Editing:: You can edit score files by hand as well.
755 * Adaptive Scoring:: Big Sister Gnus knows what you read.
756 * Home Score File:: How to say where new score entries are to go.
757 * Followups To Yourself:: Having Gnus notice when people answer you.
758 * Scoring On Other Headers:: Scoring on non-standard headers.
759 * Scoring Tips:: How to score effectively.
760 * Reverse Scoring:: That problem child of old is not problem.
761 * Global Score Files:: Earth-spanning, ear-splitting score files.
762 * Kill Files:: They are still here, but they can be ignored.
763 * Converting Kill Files:: Translating kill files to score files.
764 * GroupLens:: Getting predictions on what you like to read.
765 * Advanced Scoring:: Using logical expressions to build score rules.
766 * Score Decays:: It can be useful to let scores wither away.
767
768 GroupLens
769
770 * Using GroupLens:: How to make Gnus use GroupLens.
771 * Rating Articles:: Letting GroupLens know how you rate articles.
772 * Displaying Predictions:: Displaying predictions given by GroupLens.
773 * GroupLens Variables:: Customizing GroupLens.
774
775 Advanced Scoring
776
777 * Advanced Scoring Syntax:: A definition.
778 * Advanced Scoring Examples:: What they look like.
779 * Advanced Scoring Tips:: Getting the most out of it.
780
781 Various
782
783 * Process/Prefix:: A convention used by many treatment commands.
784 * Interactive:: Making Gnus ask you many questions.
785 * Symbolic Prefixes:: How to supply some Gnus functions with options.
786 * Formatting Variables:: You can specify what buffers should look like.
787 * Window Layout:: Configuring the Gnus buffer windows.
788 * Faces and Fonts:: How to change how faces look.
789 * Compilation:: How to speed Gnus up.
790 * Mode Lines:: Displaying information in the mode lines.
791 * Highlighting and Menus:: Making buffers look all nice and cozy.
792 * Buttons:: Get tendinitis in ten easy steps!
793 * Daemons:: Gnus can do things behind your back.
794 * NoCeM:: How to avoid spam and other fatty foods.
795 * Undo:: Some actions can be undone.
796 * Predicate Specifiers:: Specifying predicates.
797 * Moderation:: What to do if you're a moderator.
798 * Image Enhancements:: Modern versions of Emacs/XEmacs can display images.
799 * Fuzzy Matching:: What's the big fuzz?
800 * Thwarting Email Spam:: A how-to on avoiding unsolicited commercial email.
801 * Other modes:: Interaction with other modes.
802 * Various Various:: Things that are really various.
803
804 Formatting Variables
805
806 * Formatting Basics:: A formatting variable is basically a format string.
807 * Mode Line Formatting:: Some rules about mode line formatting variables.
808 * Advanced Formatting:: Modifying output in various ways.
809 * User-Defined Specs:: Having Gnus call your own functions.
810 * Formatting Fonts:: Making the formatting look colorful and nice.
811 * Positioning Point:: Moving point to a position after an operation.
812 * Tabulation:: Tabulating your output.
813 * Wide Characters:: Dealing with wide characters.
814
815 Image Enhancements
816
817 * X-Face:: Display a funky, teensy black-and-white image.
818 * Face:: Display a funkier, teensier colored image.
819 * Smileys:: Show all those happy faces the way they were meant to be shown.
820 * Picons:: How to display pictures of what you're reading.
821 * XVarious:: Other XEmacsy Gnusey variables.
822
823 Thwarting Email Spam
824
825 * The problem of spam:: Some background, and some solutions
826 * Anti-Spam Basics:: Simple steps to reduce the amount of spam.
827 * SpamAssassin:: How to use external anti-spam tools.
828 * Hashcash:: Reduce spam by burning CPU time.
829 * Filtering Spam Using The Spam ELisp Package::
830 * Filtering Spam Using Statistics with spam-stat::
831
832 Filtering Spam Using The Spam ELisp Package
833
834 * Spam ELisp Package Sequence of Events::
835 * Spam ELisp Package Filtering of Incoming Mail::
836 * Spam ELisp Package Global Variables::
837 * Spam ELisp Package Configuration Examples::
838 * Blacklists and Whitelists::
839 * BBDB Whitelists::
840 * Gmane Spam Reporting::
841 * Anti-spam Hashcash Payments::
842 * Blackholes::
843 * Regular Expressions Header Matching::
844 * Bogofilter::
845 * ifile spam filtering::
846 * spam-stat spam filtering::
847 * SpamOracle::
848 * Extending the Spam ELisp package::
849
850 Filtering Spam Using Statistics with spam-stat
851
852 * Creating a spam-stat dictionary::
853 * Splitting mail using spam-stat::
854 * Low-level interface to the spam-stat dictionary::
855
856 Appendices
857
858 * XEmacs:: Requirements for installing under XEmacs.
859 * History:: How Gnus got where it is today.
860 * On Writing Manuals:: Why this is not a beginner's guide.
861 * Terminology:: We use really difficult, like, words here.
862 * Customization:: Tailoring Gnus to your needs.
863 * Troubleshooting:: What you might try if things do not work.
864 * Gnus Reference Guide:: Rilly, rilly technical stuff.
865 * Emacs for Heathens:: A short introduction to Emacsian terms.
866 * Frequently Asked Questions:: The Gnus FAQ
867
868 History
869
870 * Gnus Versions:: What Gnus versions have been released.
871 * Other Gnus Versions:: Other Gnus versions that also have been released.
872 * Why?:: What's the point of Gnus?
873 * Compatibility:: Just how compatible is Gnus with @sc{gnus}?
874 * Conformity:: Gnus tries to conform to all standards.
875 * Emacsen:: Gnus can be run on a few modern Emacsen.
876 * Gnus Development:: How Gnus is developed.
877 * Contributors:: Oodles of people.
878 * New Features:: Pointers to some of the new stuff in Gnus.
879
880 New Features
881
882 * ding Gnus:: New things in Gnus 5.0/5.1, the first new Gnus.
883 * September Gnus:: The Thing Formally Known As Gnus 5.2/5.3.
884 * Red Gnus:: Third time best---Gnus 5.4/5.5.
885 * Quassia Gnus:: Two times two is four, or Gnus 5.6/5.7.
886 * Pterodactyl Gnus:: Pentad also starts with P, AKA Gnus 5.8/5.9.
887 * Oort Gnus:: It's big. It's far out. Gnus 5.10/5.11.
888
889 Customization
890
891 * Slow/Expensive Connection:: You run a local Emacs and get the news elsewhere.
892 * Slow Terminal Connection:: You run a remote Emacs.
893 * Little Disk Space:: You feel that having large setup files is icky.
894 * Slow Machine:: You feel like buying a faster machine.
895
896 Gnus Reference Guide
897
898 * Gnus Utility Functions:: Common functions and variable to use.
899 * Back End Interface:: How Gnus communicates with the servers.
900 * Score File Syntax:: A BNF definition of the score file standard.
901 * Headers:: How Gnus stores headers internally.
902 * Ranges:: A handy format for storing mucho numbers.
903 * Group Info:: The group info format.
904 * Extended Interactive:: Symbolic prefixes and stuff.
905 * Emacs/XEmacs Code:: Gnus can be run under all modern Emacsen.
906 * Various File Formats:: Formats of files that Gnus use.
907
908 Back End Interface
909
910 * Required Back End Functions:: Functions that must be implemented.
911 * Optional Back End Functions:: Functions that need not be implemented.
912 * Error Messaging:: How to get messages and report errors.
913 * Writing New Back Ends:: Extending old back ends.
914 * Hooking New Back Ends Into Gnus:: What has to be done on the Gnus end.
915 * Mail-like Back Ends:: Some tips on mail back ends.
916
917 Various File Formats
918
919 * Active File Format:: Information on articles and groups available.
920 * Newsgroups File Format:: Group descriptions.
921
922 Emacs for Heathens
923
924 * Keystrokes:: Entering text and executing commands.
925 * Emacs Lisp:: The built-in Emacs programming language.
926
927 @end detailmenu
928 @end menu
929
930 @node Starting Up
931 @chapter Starting Gnus
932 @cindex starting up
933
934 @kindex M-x gnus
935 @findex gnus
936 If your system administrator has set things up properly, starting Gnus
937 and reading news is extremely easy---you just type @kbd{M-x gnus} in
938 your Emacs.
939
940 @findex gnus-other-frame
941 @kindex M-x gnus-other-frame
942 If you want to start Gnus in a different frame, you can use the command
943 @kbd{M-x gnus-other-frame} instead.
944
945 If things do not go smoothly at startup, you have to twiddle some
946 variables in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file. This file is similar to
947 @file{~/.emacs}, but is read when Gnus starts.
948
949 If you puzzle at any terms used in this manual, please refer to the
950 terminology section (@pxref{Terminology}).
951
952 @menu
953 * Finding the News:: Choosing a method for getting news.
954 * The First Time:: What does Gnus do the first time you start it?
955 * The Server is Down:: How can I read my mail then?
956 * Slave Gnusae:: You can have more than one Gnus active at a time.
957 * New Groups:: What is Gnus supposed to do with new groups?
958 * Changing Servers:: You may want to move from one server to another.
959 * Startup Files:: Those pesky startup files---@file{.newsrc}.
960 * Auto Save:: Recovering from a crash.
961 * The Active File:: Reading the active file over a slow line Takes Time.
962 * Startup Variables:: Other variables you might change.
963 @end menu
964
965
966 @node Finding the News
967 @section Finding the News
968 @cindex finding news
969
970 @vindex gnus-select-method
971 @c @head
972 The @code{gnus-select-method} variable says where Gnus should look for
973 news. This variable should be a list where the first element says
974 @dfn{how} and the second element says @dfn{where}. This method is your
975 native method. All groups not fetched with this method are
976 foreign groups.
977
978 For instance, if the @samp{news.somewhere.edu} @acronym{NNTP} server is where
979 you want to get your daily dosage of news from, you'd say:
980
981 @lisp
982 (setq gnus-select-method '(nntp "news.somewhere.edu"))
983 @end lisp
984
985 If you want to read directly from the local spool, say:
986
987 @lisp
988 (setq gnus-select-method '(nnspool ""))
989 @end lisp
990
991 If you can use a local spool, you probably should, as it will almost
992 certainly be much faster. But do not use the local spool if your
993 server is running Leafnode (which is a simple, standalone private news
994 server); in this case, use @code{(nntp "localhost")}.
995
996 @vindex gnus-nntpserver-file
997 @cindex NNTPSERVER
998 @cindex @acronym{NNTP} server
999 If this variable is not set, Gnus will take a look at the
1000 @env{NNTPSERVER} environment variable. If that variable isn't set,
1001 Gnus will see whether @code{gnus-nntpserver-file}
1002 (@file{/etc/nntpserver} by default) has any opinions on the matter.
1003 If that fails as well, Gnus will try to use the machine running Emacs
1004 as an @acronym{NNTP} server. That's a long shot, though.
1005
1006 @vindex gnus-nntp-server
1007 If @code{gnus-nntp-server} is set, this variable will override
1008 @code{gnus-select-method}. You should therefore set
1009 @code{gnus-nntp-server} to @code{nil}, which is what it is by default.
1010
1011 @vindex gnus-secondary-servers
1012 @vindex gnus-nntp-server
1013 You can also make Gnus prompt you interactively for the name of an
1014 @acronym{NNTP} server. If you give a non-numerical prefix to @code{gnus}
1015 (i.e., @kbd{C-u M-x gnus}), Gnus will let you choose between the servers
1016 in the @code{gnus-secondary-servers} list (if any). You can also just
1017 type in the name of any server you feel like visiting. (Note that this
1018 will set @code{gnus-nntp-server}, which means that if you then @kbd{M-x
1019 gnus} later in the same Emacs session, Gnus will contact the same
1020 server.)
1021
1022 @findex gnus-group-browse-foreign-server
1023 @kindex B (Group)
1024 However, if you use one @acronym{NNTP} server regularly and are just
1025 interested in a couple of groups from a different server, you would be
1026 better served by using the @kbd{B} command in the group buffer. It will
1027 let you have a look at what groups are available, and you can subscribe
1028 to any of the groups you want to. This also makes @file{.newsrc}
1029 maintenance much tidier. @xref{Foreign Groups}.
1030
1031 @vindex gnus-secondary-select-methods
1032 @c @head
1033 A slightly different approach to foreign groups is to set the
1034 @code{gnus-secondary-select-methods} variable. The select methods
1035 listed in this variable are in many ways just as native as the
1036 @code{gnus-select-method} server. They will also be queried for active
1037 files during startup (if that's required), and new newsgroups that
1038 appear on these servers will be subscribed (or not) just as native
1039 groups are.
1040
1041 For instance, if you use the @code{nnmbox} back end to read your mail,
1042 you would typically set this variable to
1043
1044 @lisp
1045 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods '((nnmbox "")))
1046 @end lisp
1047
1048
1049 @node The First Time
1050 @section The First Time
1051 @cindex first time usage
1052
1053 If no startup files exist (@pxref{Startup Files}), Gnus will try to
1054 determine what groups should be subscribed by default.
1055
1056 @vindex gnus-default-subscribed-newsgroups
1057 If the variable @code{gnus-default-subscribed-newsgroups} is set, Gnus
1058 will subscribe you to just those groups in that list, leaving the rest
1059 killed. Your system administrator should have set this variable to
1060 something useful.
1061
1062 Since she hasn't, Gnus will just subscribe you to a few arbitrarily
1063 picked groups (i.e., @samp{*.newusers}). (@dfn{Arbitrary} is defined
1064 here as @dfn{whatever Lars thinks you should read}.)
1065
1066 You'll also be subscribed to the Gnus documentation group, which should
1067 help you with most common problems.
1068
1069 If @code{gnus-default-subscribed-newsgroups} is @code{t}, Gnus will just
1070 use the normal functions for handling new groups, and not do anything
1071 special.
1072
1073
1074 @node The Server is Down
1075 @section The Server is Down
1076 @cindex server errors
1077
1078 If the default server is down, Gnus will understandably have some
1079 problems starting. However, if you have some mail groups in addition to
1080 the news groups, you may want to start Gnus anyway.
1081
1082 Gnus, being the trusting sort of program, will ask whether to proceed
1083 without a native select method if that server can't be contacted. This
1084 will happen whether the server doesn't actually exist (i.e., you have
1085 given the wrong address) or the server has just momentarily taken ill
1086 for some reason or other. If you decide to continue and have no foreign
1087 groups, you'll find it difficult to actually do anything in the group
1088 buffer. But, hey, that's your problem. Blllrph!
1089
1090 @findex gnus-no-server
1091 @kindex M-x gnus-no-server
1092 @c @head
1093 If you know that the server is definitely down, or you just want to read
1094 your mail without bothering with the server at all, you can use the
1095 @code{gnus-no-server} command to start Gnus. That might come in handy
1096 if you're in a hurry as well. This command will not attempt to contact
1097 your primary server---instead, it will just activate all groups on level
1098 1 and 2. (You should preferably keep no native groups on those two
1099 levels.) Also @pxref{Group Levels}.
1100
1101
1102 @node Slave Gnusae
1103 @section Slave Gnusae
1104 @cindex slave
1105
1106 You might want to run more than one Emacs with more than one Gnus at the
1107 same time. If you are using different @file{.newsrc} files (e.g., if you
1108 are using the two different Gnusae to read from two different servers),
1109 that is no problem whatsoever. You just do it.
1110
1111 The problem appears when you want to run two Gnusae that use the same
1112 @file{.newsrc} file.
1113
1114 To work around that problem some, we here at the Think-Tank at the Gnus
1115 Towers have come up with a new concept: @dfn{Masters} and
1116 @dfn{slaves}. (We have applied for a patent on this concept, and have
1117 taken out a copyright on those words. If you wish to use those words in
1118 conjunction with each other, you have to send $1 per usage instance to
1119 me. Usage of the patent (@dfn{Master/Slave Relationships In Computer
1120 Applications}) will be much more expensive, of course.)
1121
1122 @findex gnus-slave
1123 Anyway, you start one Gnus up the normal way with @kbd{M-x gnus} (or
1124 however you do it). Each subsequent slave Gnusae should be started with
1125 @kbd{M-x gnus-slave}. These slaves won't save normal @file{.newsrc}
1126 files, but instead save @dfn{slave files} that contain information only
1127 on what groups have been read in the slave session. When a master Gnus
1128 starts, it will read (and delete) these slave files, incorporating all
1129 information from them. (The slave files will be read in the sequence
1130 they were created, so the latest changes will have precedence.)
1131
1132 Information from the slave files has, of course, precedence over the
1133 information in the normal (i.e., master) @file{.newsrc} file.
1134
1135 If the @file{.newsrc*} files have not been saved in the master when the
1136 slave starts, you may be prompted as to whether to read an auto-save
1137 file. If you answer ``yes'', the unsaved changes to the master will be
1138 incorporated into the slave. If you answer ``no'', the slave may see some
1139 messages as unread that have been read in the master.
1140
1141
1142
1143 @node New Groups
1144 @section New Groups
1145 @cindex new groups
1146 @cindex subscription
1147
1148 @vindex gnus-check-new-newsgroups
1149 If you are satisfied that you really never want to see any new groups,
1150 you can set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} to @code{nil}. This will
1151 also save you some time at startup. Even if this variable is
1152 @code{nil}, you can always subscribe to the new groups just by pressing
1153 @kbd{U} in the group buffer (@pxref{Group Maintenance}). This variable
1154 is @code{ask-server} by default. If you set this variable to
1155 @code{always}, then Gnus will query the back ends for new groups even
1156 when you do the @kbd{g} command (@pxref{Scanning New Messages}).
1157
1158 @menu
1159 * Checking New Groups:: Determining what groups are new.
1160 * Subscription Methods:: What Gnus should do with new groups.
1161 * Filtering New Groups:: Making Gnus ignore certain new groups.
1162 @end menu
1163
1164
1165 @node Checking New Groups
1166 @subsection Checking New Groups
1167
1168 Gnus normally determines whether a group is new or not by comparing the
1169 list of groups from the active file(s) with the lists of subscribed and
1170 dead groups. This isn't a particularly fast method. If
1171 @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} is @code{ask-server}, Gnus will ask the
1172 server for new groups since the last time. This is both faster and
1173 cheaper. This also means that you can get rid of the list of killed
1174 groups altogether, so you may set @code{gnus-save-killed-list} to
1175 @code{nil}, which will save time both at startup, at exit, and all over.
1176 Saves disk space, too. Why isn't this the default, then?
1177 Unfortunately, not all servers support this command.
1178
1179 I bet I know what you're thinking now: How do I find out whether my
1180 server supports @code{ask-server}? No? Good, because I don't have a
1181 fail-safe answer. I would suggest just setting this variable to
1182 @code{ask-server} and see whether any new groups appear within the next
1183 few days. If any do, then it works. If none do, then it doesn't
1184 work. I could write a function to make Gnus guess whether the server
1185 supports @code{ask-server}, but it would just be a guess. So I won't.
1186 You could @code{telnet} to the server and say @code{HELP} and see
1187 whether it lists @samp{NEWGROUPS} among the commands it understands. If
1188 it does, then it might work. (But there are servers that lists
1189 @samp{NEWGROUPS} without supporting the function properly.)
1190
1191 This variable can also be a list of select methods. If so, Gnus will
1192 issue an @code{ask-server} command to each of the select methods, and
1193 subscribe them (or not) using the normal methods. This might be handy
1194 if you are monitoring a few servers for new groups. A side effect is
1195 that startup will take much longer, so you can meditate while waiting.
1196 Use the mantra ``dingnusdingnusdingnus'' to achieve permanent bliss.
1197
1198
1199 @node Subscription Methods
1200 @subsection Subscription Methods
1201
1202 @vindex gnus-subscribe-newsgroup-method
1203 What Gnus does when it encounters a new group is determined by the
1204 @code{gnus-subscribe-newsgroup-method} variable.
1205
1206 This variable should contain a function. This function will be called
1207 with the name of the new group as the only parameter.
1208
1209 Some handy pre-fab functions are:
1210
1211 @table @code
1212
1213 @item gnus-subscribe-zombies
1214 @vindex gnus-subscribe-zombies
1215 Make all new groups zombies. This is the default. You can browse the
1216 zombies later (with @kbd{A z}) and either kill them all off properly
1217 (with @kbd{S z}), or subscribe to them (with @kbd{u}).
1218
1219 @item gnus-subscribe-randomly
1220 @vindex gnus-subscribe-randomly
1221 Subscribe all new groups in arbitrary order. This really means that all
1222 new groups will be added at ``the top'' of the group buffer.
1223
1224 @item gnus-subscribe-alphabetically
1225 @vindex gnus-subscribe-alphabetically
1226 Subscribe all new groups in alphabetical order.
1227
1228 @item gnus-subscribe-hierarchically
1229 @vindex gnus-subscribe-hierarchically
1230 Subscribe all new groups hierarchically. The difference between this
1231 function and @code{gnus-subscribe-alphabetically} is slight.
1232 @code{gnus-subscribe-alphabetically} will subscribe new groups in a strictly
1233 alphabetical fashion, while this function will enter groups into its
1234 hierarchy. So if you want to have the @samp{rec} hierarchy before the
1235 @samp{comp} hierarchy, this function will not mess that configuration
1236 up. Or something like that.
1237
1238 @item gnus-subscribe-interactively
1239 @vindex gnus-subscribe-interactively
1240 Subscribe new groups interactively. This means that Gnus will ask
1241 you about @strong{all} new groups. The groups you choose to subscribe
1242 to will be subscribed hierarchically.
1243
1244 @item gnus-subscribe-killed
1245 @vindex gnus-subscribe-killed
1246 Kill all new groups.
1247
1248 @item gnus-subscribe-topics
1249 @vindex gnus-subscribe-topics
1250 Put the groups into the topic that has a matching @code{subscribe} topic
1251 parameter (@pxref{Topic Parameters}). For instance, a @code{subscribe}
1252 topic parameter that looks like
1253
1254 @example
1255 "nnslashdot"
1256 @end example
1257
1258 will mean that all groups that match that regex will be subscribed under
1259 that topic.
1260
1261 If no topics match the groups, the groups will be subscribed in the
1262 top-level topic.
1263
1264 @end table
1265
1266 @vindex gnus-subscribe-hierarchical-interactive
1267 A closely related variable is
1268 @code{gnus-subscribe-hierarchical-interactive}. (That's quite a
1269 mouthful.) If this variable is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will ask you in a
1270 hierarchical fashion whether to subscribe to new groups or not. Gnus
1271 will ask you for each sub-hierarchy whether you want to descend the
1272 hierarchy or not.
1273
1274 One common mistake is to set the variable a few paragraphs above
1275 (@code{gnus-subscribe-newsgroup-method}) to
1276 @code{gnus-subscribe-hierarchical-interactive}. This is an error. This
1277 will not work. This is ga-ga. So don't do it.
1278
1279
1280 @node Filtering New Groups
1281 @subsection Filtering New Groups
1282
1283 A nice and portable way to control which new newsgroups should be
1284 subscribed (or ignored) is to put an @dfn{options} line at the start of
1285 the @file{.newsrc} file. Here's an example:
1286
1287 @example
1288 options -n !alt.all !rec.all sci.all
1289 @end example
1290
1291 @vindex gnus-subscribe-options-newsgroup-method
1292 This line obviously belongs to a serious-minded intellectual scientific
1293 person (or she may just be plain old boring), because it says that all
1294 groups that have names beginning with @samp{alt} and @samp{rec} should
1295 be ignored, and all groups with names beginning with @samp{sci} should
1296 be subscribed. Gnus will not use the normal subscription method for
1297 subscribing these groups.
1298 @code{gnus-subscribe-options-newsgroup-method} is used instead. This
1299 variable defaults to @code{gnus-subscribe-alphabetically}.
1300
1301 @vindex gnus-options-not-subscribe
1302 @vindex gnus-options-subscribe
1303 If you don't want to mess with your @file{.newsrc} file, you can just
1304 set the two variables @code{gnus-options-subscribe} and
1305 @code{gnus-options-not-subscribe}. These two variables do exactly the
1306 same as the @file{.newsrc} @samp{options -n} trick. Both are regexps,
1307 and if the new group matches the former, it will be unconditionally
1308 subscribed, and if it matches the latter, it will be ignored.
1309
1310 @vindex gnus-auto-subscribed-groups
1311 Yet another variable that meddles here is
1312 @code{gnus-auto-subscribed-groups}. It works exactly like
1313 @code{gnus-options-subscribe}, and is therefore really superfluous,
1314 but I thought it would be nice to have two of these. This variable is
1315 more meant for setting some ground rules, while the other variable is
1316 used more for user fiddling. By default this variable makes all new
1317 groups that come from mail back ends (@code{nnml}, @code{nnbabyl},
1318 @code{nnfolder}, @code{nnmbox}, @code{nnmh}, and @code{nnmaildir})
1319 subscribed. If you don't like that, just set this variable to
1320 @code{nil}.
1321
1322 New groups that match this regexp are subscribed using
1323 @code{gnus-subscribe-options-newsgroup-method}.
1324
1325
1326 @node Changing Servers
1327 @section Changing Servers
1328 @cindex changing servers
1329
1330 Sometimes it is necessary to move from one @acronym{NNTP} server to another.
1331 This happens very rarely, but perhaps you change jobs, or one server is
1332 very flaky and you want to use another.
1333
1334 Changing the server is pretty easy, right? You just change
1335 @code{gnus-select-method} to point to the new server?
1336
1337 @emph{Wrong!}
1338
1339 Article numbers are not (in any way) kept synchronized between different
1340 @acronym{NNTP} servers, and the only way Gnus keeps track of what articles
1341 you have read is by keeping track of article numbers. So when you
1342 change @code{gnus-select-method}, your @file{.newsrc} file becomes
1343 worthless.
1344
1345 Gnus provides a few functions to attempt to translate a @file{.newsrc}
1346 file from one server to another. They all have one thing in
1347 common---they take a looong time to run. You don't want to use these
1348 functions more than absolutely necessary.
1349
1350 @kindex M-x gnus-change-server
1351 @findex gnus-change-server
1352 If you have access to both servers, Gnus can request the headers for all
1353 the articles you have read and compare @code{Message-ID}s and map the
1354 article numbers of the read articles and article marks. The @kbd{M-x
1355 gnus-change-server} command will do this for all your native groups. It
1356 will prompt for the method you want to move to.
1357
1358 @kindex M-x gnus-group-move-group-to-server
1359 @findex gnus-group-move-group-to-server
1360 You can also move individual groups with the @kbd{M-x
1361 gnus-group-move-group-to-server} command. This is useful if you want to
1362 move a (foreign) group from one server to another.
1363
1364 @kindex M-x gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
1365 @findex gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
1366 If you don't have access to both the old and new server, all your marks
1367 and read ranges have become worthless. You can use the @kbd{M-x
1368 gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups} command to clear out all data
1369 that you have on your native groups. Use with caution.
1370
1371 @kindex M-x gnus-group-clear-data
1372 @findex gnus-group-clear-data
1373 Clear the data from the current group only---nix out marks and the
1374 list of read articles (@code{gnus-group-clear-data}).
1375
1376 After changing servers, you @strong{must} move the cache hierarchy away,
1377 since the cached articles will have wrong article numbers, which will
1378 affect which articles Gnus thinks are read.
1379 @code{gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups} will ask you if you want
1380 to have it done automatically; for @code{gnus-group-clear-data}, you
1381 can use @kbd{M-x gnus-cache-move-cache} (but beware, it will move the
1382 cache for all groups).
1383
1384
1385 @node Startup Files
1386 @section Startup Files
1387 @cindex startup files
1388 @cindex .newsrc
1389 @cindex .newsrc.el
1390 @cindex .newsrc.eld
1391
1392 Most common Unix news readers use a shared startup file called
1393 @file{.newsrc}. This file contains all the information about what
1394 groups are subscribed, and which articles in these groups have been
1395 read.
1396
1397 Things got a bit more complicated with @sc{gnus}. In addition to
1398 keeping the @file{.newsrc} file updated, it also used a file called
1399 @file{.newsrc.el} for storing all the information that didn't fit into
1400 the @file{.newsrc} file. (Actually, it also duplicated everything in
1401 the @file{.newsrc} file.) @sc{gnus} would read whichever one of these
1402 files was the most recently saved, which enabled people to swap between
1403 @sc{gnus} and other newsreaders.
1404
1405 That was kinda silly, so Gnus went one better: In addition to the
1406 @file{.newsrc} and @file{.newsrc.el} files, Gnus also has a file called
1407 @file{.newsrc.eld}. It will read whichever of these files that are most
1408 recent, but it will never write a @file{.newsrc.el} file. You should
1409 never delete the @file{.newsrc.eld} file---it contains much information
1410 not stored in the @file{.newsrc} file.
1411
1412 @vindex gnus-save-newsrc-file
1413 @vindex gnus-read-newsrc-file
1414 You can turn off writing the @file{.newsrc} file by setting
1415 @code{gnus-save-newsrc-file} to @code{nil}, which means you can delete
1416 the file and save some space, as well as exiting from Gnus faster.
1417 However, this will make it impossible to use other newsreaders than
1418 Gnus. But hey, who would want to, right? Similarly, setting
1419 @code{gnus-read-newsrc-file} to @code{nil} makes Gnus ignore the
1420 @file{.newsrc} file and any @file{.newsrc-SERVER} files, which can be
1421 convenient if you use a different news reader occasionally, and you
1422 want to read a different subset of the available groups with that
1423 news reader.
1424
1425 @vindex gnus-save-killed-list
1426 If @code{gnus-save-killed-list} (default @code{t}) is @code{nil}, Gnus
1427 will not save the list of killed groups to the startup file. This will
1428 save both time (when starting and quitting) and space (on disk). It
1429 will also mean that Gnus has no record of what groups are new or old,
1430 so the automatic new groups subscription methods become meaningless.
1431 You should always set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} to @code{nil} or
1432 @code{ask-server} if you set this variable to @code{nil} (@pxref{New
1433 Groups}). This variable can also be a regular expression. If that's
1434 the case, remove all groups that do not match this regexp before
1435 saving. This can be useful in certain obscure situations that involve
1436 several servers where not all servers support @code{ask-server}.
1437
1438 @vindex gnus-startup-file
1439 @vindex gnus-backup-startup-file
1440 @vindex version-control
1441 The @code{gnus-startup-file} variable says where the startup files are.
1442 The default value is @file{~/.newsrc}, with the Gnus (El Dingo) startup
1443 file being whatever that one is, with a @samp{.eld} appended.
1444 If you want version control for this file, set
1445 @code{gnus-backup-startup-file}. It respects the same values as the
1446 @code{version-control} variable.
1447
1448 @vindex gnus-save-newsrc-hook
1449 @vindex gnus-save-quick-newsrc-hook
1450 @vindex gnus-save-standard-newsrc-hook
1451 @code{gnus-save-newsrc-hook} is called before saving any of the newsrc
1452 files, while @code{gnus-save-quick-newsrc-hook} is called just before
1453 saving the @file{.newsrc.eld} file, and
1454 @code{gnus-save-standard-newsrc-hook} is called just before saving the
1455 @file{.newsrc} file. The latter two are commonly used to turn version
1456 control on or off. Version control is on by default when saving the
1457 startup files. If you want to turn backup creation off, say something like:
1458
1459 @lisp
1460 (defun turn-off-backup ()
1461 (set (make-local-variable 'backup-inhibited) t))
1462
1463 (add-hook 'gnus-save-quick-newsrc-hook 'turn-off-backup)
1464 (add-hook 'gnus-save-standard-newsrc-hook 'turn-off-backup)
1465 @end lisp
1466
1467 @vindex gnus-init-file
1468 @vindex gnus-site-init-file
1469 When Gnus starts, it will read the @code{gnus-site-init-file}
1470 (@file{.../site-lisp/gnus-init} by default) and @code{gnus-init-file}
1471 (@file{~/.gnus} by default) files. These are normal Emacs Lisp files
1472 and can be used to avoid cluttering your @file{~/.emacs} and
1473 @file{site-init} files with Gnus stuff. Gnus will also check for files
1474 with the same names as these, but with @file{.elc} and @file{.el}
1475 suffixes. In other words, if you have set @code{gnus-init-file} to
1476 @file{~/.gnus}, it will look for @file{~/.gnus.elc}, @file{~/.gnus.el},
1477 and finally @file{~/.gnus} (in this order). If Emacs was invoked with
1478 the @option{-q} or @option{--no-init-file} options (@pxref{Initial
1479 Options, ,Initial Options, emacs, The Emacs Manual}), Gnus doesn't read
1480 @code{gnus-init-file}.
1481
1482
1483 @node Auto Save
1484 @section Auto Save
1485 @cindex dribble file
1486 @cindex auto-save
1487
1488 Whenever you do something that changes the Gnus data (reading articles,
1489 catching up, killing/subscribing groups), the change is added to a
1490 special @dfn{dribble buffer}. This buffer is auto-saved the normal
1491 Emacs way. If your Emacs should crash before you have saved the
1492 @file{.newsrc} files, all changes you have made can be recovered from
1493 this file.
1494
1495 If Gnus detects this file at startup, it will ask the user whether to
1496 read it. The auto save file is deleted whenever the real startup file is
1497 saved.
1498
1499 @vindex gnus-use-dribble-file
1500 If @code{gnus-use-dribble-file} is @code{nil}, Gnus won't create and
1501 maintain a dribble buffer. The default is @code{t}.
1502
1503 @vindex gnus-dribble-directory
1504 Gnus will put the dribble file(s) in @code{gnus-dribble-directory}. If
1505 this variable is @code{nil}, which it is by default, Gnus will dribble
1506 into the directory where the @file{.newsrc} file is located. (This is
1507 normally the user's home directory.) The dribble file will get the same
1508 file permissions as the @file{.newsrc} file.
1509
1510 @vindex gnus-always-read-dribble-file
1511 If @code{gnus-always-read-dribble-file} is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will
1512 read the dribble file on startup without querying the user.
1513
1514
1515 @node The Active File
1516 @section The Active File
1517 @cindex active file
1518 @cindex ignored groups
1519
1520 When Gnus starts, or indeed whenever it tries to determine whether new
1521 articles have arrived, it reads the active file. This is a very large
1522 file that lists all the active groups and articles on the server.
1523
1524 @vindex gnus-ignored-newsgroups
1525 Before examining the active file, Gnus deletes all lines that match the
1526 regexp @code{gnus-ignored-newsgroups}. This is done primarily to reject
1527 any groups with bogus names, but you can use this variable to make Gnus
1528 ignore hierarchies you aren't ever interested in. However, this is not
1529 recommended. In fact, it's highly discouraged. Instead, @pxref{New
1530 Groups} for an overview of other variables that can be used instead.
1531
1532 @c This variable is
1533 @c @code{nil} by default, and will slow down active file handling somewhat
1534 @c if you set it to anything else.
1535
1536 @vindex gnus-read-active-file
1537 @c @head
1538 The active file can be rather Huge, so if you have a slow network, you
1539 can set @code{gnus-read-active-file} to @code{nil} to prevent Gnus from
1540 reading the active file. This variable is @code{some} by default.
1541
1542 Gnus will try to make do by getting information just on the groups that
1543 you actually subscribe to.
1544
1545 Note that if you subscribe to lots and lots of groups, setting this
1546 variable to @code{nil} will probably make Gnus slower, not faster. At
1547 present, having this variable @code{nil} will slow Gnus down
1548 considerably, unless you read news over a 2400 baud modem.
1549
1550 This variable can also have the value @code{some}. Gnus will then
1551 attempt to read active info only on the subscribed groups. On some
1552 servers this is quite fast (on sparkling, brand new INN servers that
1553 support the @code{LIST ACTIVE group} command), on others this isn't fast
1554 at all. In any case, @code{some} should be faster than @code{nil}, and
1555 is certainly faster than @code{t} over slow lines.
1556
1557 Some news servers (old versions of Leafnode and old versions of INN, for
1558 instance) do not support the @code{LIST ACTIVE group}. For these
1559 servers, @code{nil} is probably the most efficient value for this
1560 variable.
1561
1562 If this variable is @code{nil}, Gnus will ask for group info in total
1563 lock-step, which isn't very fast. If it is @code{some} and you use an
1564 @acronym{NNTP} server, Gnus will pump out commands as fast as it can, and
1565 read all the replies in one swoop. This will normally result in better
1566 performance, but if the server does not support the aforementioned
1567 @code{LIST ACTIVE group} command, this isn't very nice to the server.
1568
1569 If you think that starting up Gnus takes too long, try all the three
1570 different values for this variable and see what works best for you.
1571
1572 In any case, if you use @code{some} or @code{nil}, you should definitely
1573 kill all groups that you aren't interested in to speed things up.
1574
1575 Note that this variable also affects active file retrieval from
1576 secondary select methods.
1577
1578
1579 @node Startup Variables
1580 @section Startup Variables
1581
1582 @table @code
1583
1584 @item gnus-load-hook
1585 @vindex gnus-load-hook
1586 A hook run while Gnus is being loaded. Note that this hook will
1587 normally be run just once in each Emacs session, no matter how many
1588 times you start Gnus.
1589
1590 @item gnus-before-startup-hook
1591 @vindex gnus-before-startup-hook
1592 A hook run after starting up Gnus successfully.
1593
1594 @item gnus-startup-hook
1595 @vindex gnus-startup-hook
1596 A hook run as the very last thing after starting up Gnus
1597
1598 @item gnus-started-hook
1599 @vindex gnus-started-hook
1600 A hook that is run as the very last thing after starting up Gnus
1601 successfully.
1602
1603 @item gnus-setup-news-hook
1604 @vindex gnus-setup-news-hook
1605 A hook that is run after reading the @file{.newsrc} file(s), but before
1606 generating the group buffer.
1607
1608 @item gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups
1609 @vindex gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups
1610 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will check for and delete all bogus groups at
1611 startup. A @dfn{bogus group} is a group that you have in your
1612 @file{.newsrc} file, but doesn't exist on the news server. Checking for
1613 bogus groups can take quite a while, so to save time and resources it's
1614 best to leave this option off, and do the checking for bogus groups once
1615 in a while from the group buffer instead (@pxref{Group Maintenance}).
1616
1617 @item gnus-inhibit-startup-message
1618 @vindex gnus-inhibit-startup-message
1619 If non-@code{nil}, the startup message won't be displayed. That way,
1620 your boss might not notice as easily that you are reading news instead
1621 of doing your job. Note that this variable is used before
1622 @file{~/.gnus.el} is loaded, so it should be set in @file{.emacs} instead.
1623
1624 @item gnus-no-groups-message
1625 @vindex gnus-no-groups-message
1626 Message displayed by Gnus when no groups are available.
1627
1628 @item gnus-play-startup-jingle
1629 @vindex gnus-play-startup-jingle
1630 If non-@code{nil}, play the Gnus jingle at startup.
1631
1632 @item gnus-startup-jingle
1633 @vindex gnus-startup-jingle
1634 Jingle to be played if the above variable is non-@code{nil}. The
1635 default is @samp{Tuxedomoon.Jingle4.au}.
1636
1637 @end table
1638
1639
1640 @node Group Buffer
1641 @chapter Group Buffer
1642 @cindex group buffer
1643
1644 @c Alex Schroeder suggests to rearrange this as follows:
1645 @c
1646 @c <kensanata> ok, just save it for reference. I'll go to bed in a minute.
1647 @c 1. Selecting a Group, 2. (new) Finding a Group, 3. Group Levels,
1648 @c 4. Subscription Commands, 5. Group Maneuvering, 6. Group Data,
1649 @c 7. Group Score, 8. Group Buffer Format
1650 @c <kensanata> Group Levels should have more information on levels 5 to 9. I
1651 @c suggest to split the 4th paragraph ("Gnus considers groups...") as follows:
1652 @c <kensanata> First, "Gnus considers groups... (default 9)."
1653 @c <kensanata> New, a table summarizing what levels 1 to 9 mean.
1654 @c <kensanata> Third, "Gnus treats subscribed ... reasons of efficiency"
1655 @c <kensanata> Then expand the next paragraph or add some more to it.
1656 @c This short one sentence explains levels 1 and 2, therefore I understand
1657 @c that I should keep important news at 3 and boring news at 4.
1658 @c Say so! Then go on to explain why I should bother with levels 6 to 9.
1659 @c Maybe keep those that you don't want to read temporarily at 6,
1660 @c those that you never want to read at 8, those that offend your
1661 @c human rights at 9...
1662
1663
1664 The @dfn{group buffer} lists all (or parts) of the available groups. It
1665 is the first buffer shown when Gnus starts, and will never be killed as
1666 long as Gnus is active.
1667
1668 @iftex
1669 @iflatex
1670 \gnusfigure{The Group Buffer}{320}{
1671 \put(75,50){\epsfig{figure=ps/group,height=9cm}}
1672 \put(120,37){\makebox(0,0)[t]{Buffer name}}
1673 \put(120,38){\vector(1,2){10}}
1674 \put(40,60){\makebox(0,0)[r]{Mode line}}
1675 \put(40,58){\vector(1,0){30}}
1676 \put(200,28){\makebox(0,0)[t]{Native select method}}
1677 \put(200,26){\vector(-1,2){15}}
1678 }
1679 @end iflatex
1680 @end iftex
1681
1682 @menu
1683 * Group Buffer Format:: Information listed and how you can change it.
1684 * Group Maneuvering:: Commands for moving in the group buffer.
1685 * Selecting a Group:: Actually reading news.
1686 * Subscription Commands:: Unsubscribing, killing, subscribing.
1687 * Group Data:: Changing the info for a group.
1688 * Group Levels:: Levels? What are those, then?
1689 * Group Score:: A mechanism for finding out what groups you like.
1690 * Marking Groups:: You can mark groups for later processing.
1691 * Foreign Groups:: Creating and editing groups.
1692 * Group Parameters:: Each group may have different parameters set.
1693 * Listing Groups:: Gnus can list various subsets of the groups.
1694 * Sorting Groups:: Re-arrange the group order.
1695 * Group Maintenance:: Maintaining a tidy @file{.newsrc} file.
1696 * Browse Foreign Server:: You can browse a server. See what it has to offer.
1697 * Exiting Gnus:: Stop reading news and get some work done.
1698 * Group Topics:: A folding group mode divided into topics.
1699 * Misc Group Stuff:: Other stuff that you can to do.
1700 @end menu
1701
1702
1703 @node Group Buffer Format
1704 @section Group Buffer Format
1705
1706 @menu
1707 * Group Line Specification:: Deciding how the group buffer is to look.
1708 * Group Mode Line Specification:: The group buffer mode line.
1709 * Group Highlighting:: Having nice colors in the group buffer.
1710 @end menu
1711
1712
1713 @node Group Line Specification
1714 @subsection Group Line Specification
1715 @cindex group buffer format
1716
1717 The default format of the group buffer is nice and dull, but you can
1718 make it as exciting and ugly as you feel like.
1719
1720 Here's a couple of example group lines:
1721
1722 @example
1723 25: news.announce.newusers
1724 * 0: alt.fan.andrea-dworkin
1725 @end example
1726
1727 Quite simple, huh?
1728
1729 You can see that there are 25 unread articles in
1730 @samp{news.announce.newusers}. There are no unread articles, but some
1731 ticked articles, in @samp{alt.fan.andrea-dworkin} (see that little
1732 asterisk at the beginning of the line?).
1733
1734 @vindex gnus-group-line-format
1735 You can change that format to whatever you want by fiddling with the
1736 @code{gnus-group-line-format} variable. This variable works along the
1737 lines of a @code{format} specification, which is pretty much the same as
1738 a @code{printf} specifications, for those of you who use (feh!) C.
1739 @xref{Formatting Variables}.
1740
1741 @samp{%M%S%5y:%B%(%g%)\n} is the value that produced those lines above.
1742
1743 There should always be a colon on the line; the cursor always moves to
1744 the colon after performing an operation. @xref{Positioning
1745 Point}. Nothing else is required---not even the group name. All
1746 displayed text is just window dressing, and is never examined by Gnus.
1747 Gnus stores all real information it needs using text properties.
1748
1749 (Note that if you make a really strange, wonderful, spreadsheet-like
1750 layout, everybody will believe you are hard at work with the accounting
1751 instead of wasting time reading news.)
1752
1753 Here's a list of all available format characters:
1754
1755 @table @samp
1756
1757 @item M
1758 An asterisk if the group only has marked articles.
1759
1760 @item S
1761 Whether the group is subscribed.
1762
1763 @item L
1764 Level of subscribedness.
1765
1766 @item N
1767 Number of unread articles.
1768
1769 @item I
1770 Number of dormant articles.
1771
1772 @item T
1773 Number of ticked articles.
1774
1775 @item R
1776 Number of read articles.
1777
1778 @item U
1779 Number of unseen articles.
1780
1781 @item t
1782 Estimated total number of articles. (This is really @var{max-number}
1783 minus @var{min-number} plus 1.)
1784
1785 Gnus uses this estimation because the @acronym{NNTP} protocol provides
1786 efficient access to @var{max-number} and @var{min-number} but getting
1787 the true unread message count is not possible efficiently. For
1788 hysterical raisins, even the mail back ends, where the true number of
1789 unread messages might be available efficiently, use the same limited
1790 interface. To remove this restriction from Gnus means that the back
1791 end interface has to be changed, which is not an easy job. If you
1792 want to work on this, please contact the Gnus mailing list.
1793
1794 @item y
1795 Number of unread, unticked, non-dormant articles.
1796
1797 @item i
1798 Number of ticked and dormant articles.
1799
1800 @item g
1801 Full group name.
1802
1803 @item G
1804 Group name.
1805
1806 @item C
1807 Group comment (@pxref{Group Parameters}) or group name if there is no
1808 comment element in the group parameters.
1809
1810 @item D
1811 Newsgroup description. You need to read the group descriptions
1812 before these will appear, and to do that, you either have to set
1813 @code{gnus-read-active-file} or use the group buffer @kbd{M-d}
1814 command.
1815
1816 @item o
1817 @samp{m} if moderated.
1818
1819 @item O
1820 @samp{(m)} if moderated.
1821
1822 @item s
1823 Select method.
1824
1825 @item B
1826 If the summary buffer for the group is open or not.
1827
1828 @item n
1829 Select from where.
1830
1831 @item z
1832 A string that looks like @samp{<%s:%n>} if a foreign select method is
1833 used.
1834
1835 @item P
1836 Indentation based on the level of the topic (@pxref{Group Topics}).
1837
1838 @item c
1839 @vindex gnus-group-uncollapsed-levels
1840 Short (collapsed) group name. The @code{gnus-group-uncollapsed-levels}
1841 variable says how many levels to leave at the end of the group name.
1842 The default is 1---this will mean that group names like
1843 @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus} will be shortened to @samp{g.e.gnus}.
1844
1845 @item m
1846 @vindex gnus-new-mail-mark
1847 @cindex %
1848 @samp{%} (@code{gnus-new-mail-mark}) if there has arrived new mail to
1849 the group lately.
1850
1851 @item p
1852 @samp{#} (@code{gnus-process-mark}) if the group is process marked.
1853
1854 @item d
1855 A string that says when you last read the group (@pxref{Group
1856 Timestamp}).
1857
1858 @item u
1859 User defined specifier. The next character in the format string should
1860 be a letter. Gnus will call the function
1861 @code{gnus-user-format-function-}@samp{X}, where @samp{X} is the letter
1862 following @samp{%u}. The function will be passed a single dummy
1863 parameter as argument. The function should return a string, which will
1864 be inserted into the buffer just like information from any other
1865 specifier.
1866 @end table
1867
1868 @cindex *
1869 All the ``number-of'' specs will be filled with an asterisk (@samp{*})
1870 if no info is available---for instance, if it is a non-activated foreign
1871 group, or a bogus native group.
1872
1873
1874 @node Group Mode Line Specification
1875 @subsection Group Mode Line Specification
1876 @cindex group mode line
1877
1878 @vindex gnus-group-mode-line-format
1879 The mode line can be changed by setting
1880 @code{gnus-group-mode-line-format} (@pxref{Mode Line Formatting}). It
1881 doesn't understand that many format specifiers:
1882
1883 @table @samp
1884 @item S
1885 The native news server.
1886 @item M
1887 The native select method.
1888 @end table
1889
1890
1891 @node Group Highlighting
1892 @subsection Group Highlighting
1893 @cindex highlighting
1894 @cindex group highlighting
1895
1896 @vindex gnus-group-highlight
1897 Highlighting in the group buffer is controlled by the
1898 @code{gnus-group-highlight} variable. This is an alist with elements
1899 that look like @code{(@var{form} . @var{face})}. If @var{form} evaluates to
1900 something non-@code{nil}, the @var{face} will be used on the line.
1901
1902 Here's an example value for this variable that might look nice if the
1903 background is dark:
1904
1905 @lisp
1906 (cond (window-system
1907 (setq custom-background-mode 'light)
1908 (defface my-group-face-1
1909 '((t (:foreground "Red" :bold t))) "First group face")
1910 (defface my-group-face-2
1911 '((t (:foreground "DarkSeaGreen4" :bold t)))
1912 "Second group face")
1913 (defface my-group-face-3
1914 '((t (:foreground "Green4" :bold t))) "Third group face")
1915 (defface my-group-face-4
1916 '((t (:foreground "SteelBlue" :bold t))) "Fourth group face")
1917 (defface my-group-face-5
1918 '((t (:foreground "Blue" :bold t))) "Fifth group face")))
1919
1920 (setq gnus-group-highlight
1921 '(((> unread 200) . my-group-face-1)
1922 ((and (< level 3) (zerop unread)) . my-group-face-2)
1923 ((< level 3) . my-group-face-3)
1924 ((zerop unread) . my-group-face-4)
1925 (t . my-group-face-5)))
1926 @end lisp
1927
1928 Also @pxref{Faces and Fonts}.
1929
1930 Variables that are dynamically bound when the forms are evaluated
1931 include:
1932
1933 @table @code
1934 @item group
1935 The group name.
1936 @item unread
1937 The number of unread articles in the group.
1938 @item method
1939 The select method.
1940 @item mailp
1941 Whether the group is a mail group.
1942 @item level
1943 The level of the group.
1944 @item score
1945 The score of the group.
1946 @item ticked
1947 The number of ticked articles in the group.
1948 @item total
1949 The total number of articles in the group. Or rather,
1950 @var{max-number} minus @var{min-number} plus one.
1951 @item topic
1952 When using the topic minor mode, this variable is bound to the current
1953 topic being inserted.
1954 @end table
1955
1956 When the forms are @code{eval}ed, point is at the beginning of the line
1957 of the group in question, so you can use many of the normal Gnus
1958 functions for snarfing info on the group.
1959
1960 @vindex gnus-group-update-hook
1961 @findex gnus-group-highlight-line
1962 @code{gnus-group-update-hook} is called when a group line is changed.
1963 It will not be called when @code{gnus-visual} is @code{nil}. This hook
1964 calls @code{gnus-group-highlight-line} by default.
1965
1966
1967 @node Group Maneuvering
1968 @section Group Maneuvering
1969 @cindex group movement
1970
1971 All movement commands understand the numeric prefix and will behave as
1972 expected, hopefully.
1973
1974 @table @kbd
1975
1976 @item n
1977 @kindex n (Group)
1978 @findex gnus-group-next-unread-group
1979 Go to the next group that has unread articles
1980 (@code{gnus-group-next-unread-group}).
1981
1982 @item p
1983 @itemx DEL
1984 @kindex DEL (Group)
1985 @kindex p (Group)
1986 @findex gnus-group-prev-unread-group
1987 Go to the previous group that has unread articles
1988 (@code{gnus-group-prev-unread-group}).
1989
1990 @item N
1991 @kindex N (Group)
1992 @findex gnus-group-next-group
1993 Go to the next group (@code{gnus-group-next-group}).
1994
1995 @item P
1996 @kindex P (Group)
1997 @findex gnus-group-prev-group
1998 Go to the previous group (@code{gnus-group-prev-group}).
1999
2000 @item M-n
2001 @kindex M-n (Group)
2002 @findex gnus-group-next-unread-group-same-level
2003 Go to the next unread group on the same (or lower) level
2004 (@code{gnus-group-next-unread-group-same-level}).
2005
2006 @item M-p
2007 @kindex M-p (Group)
2008 @findex gnus-group-prev-unread-group-same-level
2009 Go to the previous unread group on the same (or lower) level
2010 (@code{gnus-group-prev-unread-group-same-level}).
2011 @end table
2012
2013 Three commands for jumping to groups:
2014
2015 @table @kbd
2016
2017 @item j
2018 @kindex j (Group)
2019 @findex gnus-group-jump-to-group
2020 Jump to a group (and make it visible if it isn't already)
2021 (@code{gnus-group-jump-to-group}). Killed groups can be jumped to, just
2022 like living groups.
2023
2024 @item ,
2025 @kindex , (Group)
2026 @findex gnus-group-best-unread-group
2027 Jump to the unread group with the lowest level
2028 (@code{gnus-group-best-unread-group}).
2029
2030 @item .
2031 @kindex . (Group)
2032 @findex gnus-group-first-unread-group
2033 Jump to the first group with unread articles
2034 (@code{gnus-group-first-unread-group}).
2035 @end table
2036
2037 @vindex gnus-group-goto-unread
2038 If @code{gnus-group-goto-unread} is @code{nil}, all the movement
2039 commands will move to the next group, not the next unread group. Even
2040 the commands that say they move to the next unread group. The default
2041 is @code{t}.
2042
2043
2044 @node Selecting a Group
2045 @section Selecting a Group
2046 @cindex group selection
2047
2048 @table @kbd
2049
2050 @item SPACE
2051 @kindex SPACE (Group)
2052 @findex gnus-group-read-group
2053 Select the current group, switch to the summary buffer and display the
2054 first unread article (@code{gnus-group-read-group}). If there are no
2055 unread articles in the group, or if you give a non-numerical prefix to
2056 this command, Gnus will offer to fetch all the old articles in this
2057 group from the server. If you give a numerical prefix @var{n}, @var{n}
2058 determines the number of articles Gnus will fetch. If @var{n} is
2059 positive, Gnus fetches the @var{n} newest articles, if @var{n} is
2060 negative, Gnus fetches the @code{abs(@var{n})} oldest articles.
2061
2062 Thus, @kbd{SPC} enters the group normally, @kbd{C-u SPC} offers old
2063 articles, @kbd{C-u 4 2 SPC} fetches the 42 newest articles, and @kbd{C-u
2064 - 4 2 SPC} fetches the 42 oldest ones.
2065
2066 When you are in the group (in the Summary buffer), you can type
2067 @kbd{M-g} to fetch new articles, or @kbd{C-u M-g} to also show the old
2068 ones.
2069
2070 @item RET
2071 @kindex RET (Group)
2072 @findex gnus-group-select-group
2073 Select the current group and switch to the summary buffer
2074 (@code{gnus-group-select-group}). Takes the same arguments as
2075 @code{gnus-group-read-group}---the only difference is that this command
2076 does not display the first unread article automatically upon group
2077 entry.
2078
2079 @item M-RET
2080 @kindex M-RET (Group)
2081 @findex gnus-group-quick-select-group
2082 This does the same as the command above, but tries to do it with the
2083 minimum amount of fuzz (@code{gnus-group-quick-select-group}). No
2084 scoring/killing will be performed, there will be no highlights and no
2085 expunging. This might be useful if you're in a real hurry and have to
2086 enter some humongous group. If you give a 0 prefix to this command
2087 (i.e., @kbd{0 M-RET}), Gnus won't even generate the summary buffer,
2088 which is useful if you want to toggle threading before generating the
2089 summary buffer (@pxref{Summary Generation Commands}).
2090
2091 @item M-SPACE
2092 @kindex M-SPACE (Group)
2093 @findex gnus-group-visible-select-group
2094 This is yet one more command that does the same as the @kbd{RET}
2095 command, but this one does it without expunging and hiding dormants
2096 (@code{gnus-group-visible-select-group}).
2097
2098 @item C-M-RET
2099 @kindex C-M-RET (Group)
2100 @findex gnus-group-select-group-ephemerally
2101 Finally, this command selects the current group ephemerally without
2102 doing any processing of its contents
2103 (@code{gnus-group-select-group-ephemerally}). Even threading has been
2104 turned off. Everything you do in the group after selecting it in this
2105 manner will have no permanent effects.
2106
2107 @end table
2108
2109 @vindex gnus-large-newsgroup
2110 The @code{gnus-large-newsgroup} variable says what Gnus should
2111 consider to be a big group. If it is @code{nil}, no groups are
2112 considered big. The default value is 200. If the group has more
2113 (unread and/or ticked) articles than this, Gnus will query the user
2114 before entering the group. The user can then specify how many
2115 articles should be fetched from the server. If the user specifies a
2116 negative number (@var{-n}), the @var{n} oldest articles will be
2117 fetched. If it is positive, the @var{n} articles that have arrived
2118 most recently will be fetched.
2119
2120 @vindex gnus-large-ephemeral-newsgroup
2121 @code{gnus-large-ephemeral-newsgroup} is the same as
2122 @code{gnus-large-newsgroup}, but is only used for ephemeral
2123 newsgroups.
2124
2125 @vindex gnus-select-group-hook
2126 @vindex gnus-auto-select-first
2127 @vindex gnus-auto-select-subject
2128 If @code{gnus-auto-select-first} is non-@code{nil}, select an article
2129 automatically when entering a group with the @kbd{SPACE} command.
2130 Which article this is is controlled by the
2131 @code{gnus-auto-select-subject} variable. Valid values for this
2132 variable is:
2133
2134 @table @code
2135
2136 @item unread
2137 Place point on the subject line of the first unread article.
2138
2139 @item first
2140 Place point on the subject line of the first article.
2141
2142 @item unseen
2143 Place point on the subject line of the first unseen article.
2144
2145 @item unseen-or-unread
2146 Place point on the subject line of the first unseen article, and if
2147 there is no such article, place point on the subject line of the first
2148 unread article.
2149
2150 @item best
2151 Place point on the subject line of the highest-scored unread article.
2152
2153 @end table
2154
2155 This variable can also be a function. In that case, that function
2156 will be called to place point on a subject line.
2157
2158 If you want to prevent automatic selection in some group (say, in a
2159 binary group with Huge articles) you can set the
2160 @code{gnus-auto-select-first} variable to @code{nil} in
2161 @code{gnus-select-group-hook}, which is called when a group is
2162 selected.
2163
2164
2165 @node Subscription Commands
2166 @section Subscription Commands
2167 @cindex subscription
2168
2169 @table @kbd
2170
2171 @item S t
2172 @itemx u
2173 @kindex S t (Group)
2174 @kindex u (Group)
2175 @findex gnus-group-unsubscribe-current-group
2176 @c @icon{gnus-group-unsubscribe}
2177 Toggle subscription to the current group
2178 (@code{gnus-group-unsubscribe-current-group}).
2179
2180 @item S s
2181 @itemx U
2182 @kindex S s (Group)
2183 @kindex U (Group)
2184 @findex gnus-group-unsubscribe-group
2185 Prompt for a group to subscribe, and then subscribe it. If it was
2186 subscribed already, unsubscribe it instead
2187 (@code{gnus-group-unsubscribe-group}).
2188
2189 @item S k
2190 @itemx C-k
2191 @kindex S k (Group)
2192 @kindex C-k (Group)
2193 @findex gnus-group-kill-group
2194 @c @icon{gnus-group-kill-group}
2195 Kill the current group (@code{gnus-group-kill-group}).
2196
2197 @item S y
2198 @itemx C-y
2199 @kindex S y (Group)
2200 @kindex C-y (Group)
2201 @findex gnus-group-yank-group
2202 Yank the last killed group (@code{gnus-group-yank-group}).
2203
2204 @item C-x C-t
2205 @kindex C-x C-t (Group)
2206 @findex gnus-group-transpose-groups
2207 Transpose two groups (@code{gnus-group-transpose-groups}). This isn't
2208 really a subscription command, but you can use it instead of a
2209 kill-and-yank sequence sometimes.
2210
2211 @item S w
2212 @itemx C-w
2213 @kindex S w (Group)
2214 @kindex C-w (Group)
2215 @findex gnus-group-kill-region
2216 Kill all groups in the region (@code{gnus-group-kill-region}).
2217
2218 @item S z
2219 @kindex S z (Group)
2220 @findex gnus-group-kill-all-zombies
2221 Kill all zombie groups (@code{gnus-group-kill-all-zombies}).
2222
2223 @item S C-k
2224 @kindex S C-k (Group)
2225 @findex gnus-group-kill-level
2226 Kill all groups on a certain level (@code{gnus-group-kill-level}).
2227 These groups can't be yanked back after killing, so this command should
2228 be used with some caution. The only time where this command comes in
2229 really handy is when you have a @file{.newsrc} with lots of unsubscribed
2230 groups that you want to get rid off. @kbd{S C-k} on level 7 will
2231 kill off all unsubscribed groups that do not have message numbers in the
2232 @file{.newsrc} file.
2233
2234 @end table
2235
2236 Also @pxref{Group Levels}.
2237
2238
2239 @node Group Data
2240 @section Group Data
2241
2242 @table @kbd
2243
2244 @item c
2245 @kindex c (Group)
2246 @findex gnus-group-catchup-current
2247 @vindex gnus-group-catchup-group-hook
2248 @c @icon{gnus-group-catchup-current}
2249 Mark all unticked articles in this group as read
2250 (@code{gnus-group-catchup-current}).
2251 @code{gnus-group-catchup-group-hook} is called when catching up a group from
2252 the group buffer.
2253
2254 @item C
2255 @kindex C (Group)
2256 @findex gnus-group-catchup-current-all
2257 Mark all articles in this group, even the ticked ones, as read
2258 (@code{gnus-group-catchup-current-all}).
2259
2260 @item M-c
2261 @kindex M-c (Group)
2262 @findex gnus-group-clear-data
2263 Clear the data from the current group---nix out marks and the list of
2264 read articles (@code{gnus-group-clear-data}).
2265
2266 @item M-x gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
2267 @kindex M-x gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
2268 @findex gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
2269 If you have switched from one @acronym{NNTP} server to another, all your marks
2270 and read ranges have become worthless. You can use this command to
2271 clear out all data that you have on your native groups. Use with
2272 caution.
2273
2274 @end table
2275
2276
2277 @node Group Levels
2278 @section Group Levels
2279 @cindex group level
2280 @cindex level
2281
2282 All groups have a level of @dfn{subscribedness}. For instance, if a
2283 group is on level 2, it is more subscribed than a group on level 5. You
2284 can ask Gnus to just list groups on a given level or lower
2285 (@pxref{Listing Groups}), or to just check for new articles in groups on
2286 a given level or lower (@pxref{Scanning New Messages}).
2287
2288 Remember: The higher the level of the group, the less important it is.
2289
2290 @table @kbd
2291
2292 @item S l
2293 @kindex S l (Group)
2294 @findex gnus-group-set-current-level
2295 Set the level of the current group. If a numeric prefix is given, the
2296 next @var{n} groups will have their levels set. The user will be
2297 prompted for a level.
2298 @end table
2299
2300 @vindex gnus-level-killed
2301 @vindex gnus-level-zombie
2302 @vindex gnus-level-unsubscribed
2303 @vindex gnus-level-subscribed
2304 Gnus considers groups from levels 1 to
2305 @code{gnus-level-subscribed} (inclusive) (default 5) to be subscribed,
2306 @code{gnus-level-subscribed} (exclusive) and
2307 @code{gnus-level-unsubscribed} (inclusive) (default 7) to be
2308 unsubscribed, @code{gnus-level-zombie} to be zombies (walking dead)
2309 (default 8) and @code{gnus-level-killed} to be killed (completely dead)
2310 (default 9). Gnus treats subscribed and unsubscribed groups exactly the
2311 same, but zombie and killed groups have no information on what articles
2312 you have read, etc, stored. This distinction between dead and living
2313 groups isn't done because it is nice or clever, it is done purely for
2314 reasons of efficiency.
2315
2316 It is recommended that you keep all your mail groups (if any) on quite
2317 low levels (e.g. 1 or 2).
2318
2319 Maybe the following description of the default behavior of Gnus helps to
2320 understand what these levels are all about. By default, Gnus shows you
2321 subscribed nonempty groups, but by hitting @kbd{L} you can have it show
2322 empty subscribed groups and unsubscribed groups, too. Type @kbd{l} to
2323 go back to showing nonempty subscribed groups again. Thus, unsubscribed
2324 groups are hidden, in a way.
2325
2326 Zombie and killed groups are similar to unsubscribed groups in that they
2327 are hidden by default. But they are different from subscribed and
2328 unsubscribed groups in that Gnus doesn't ask the news server for
2329 information (number of messages, number of unread messages) on zombie
2330 and killed groups. Normally, you use @kbd{C-k} to kill the groups you
2331 aren't interested in. If most groups are killed, Gnus is faster.
2332
2333 Why does Gnus distinguish between zombie and killed groups? Well, when
2334 a new group arrives on the server, Gnus by default makes it a zombie
2335 group. This means that you are normally not bothered with new groups,
2336 but you can type @kbd{A z} to get a list of all new groups. Subscribe
2337 the ones you like and kill the ones you don't want. (@kbd{A k} shows a
2338 list of killed groups.)
2339
2340 If you want to play with the level variables, you should show some care.
2341 Set them once, and don't touch them ever again. Better yet, don't touch
2342 them at all unless you know exactly what you're doing.
2343
2344 @vindex gnus-level-default-unsubscribed
2345 @vindex gnus-level-default-subscribed
2346 Two closely related variables are @code{gnus-level-default-subscribed}
2347 (default 3) and @code{gnus-level-default-unsubscribed} (default 6),
2348 which are the levels that new groups will be put on if they are
2349 (un)subscribed. These two variables should, of course, be inside the
2350 relevant valid ranges.
2351
2352 @vindex gnus-keep-same-level
2353 If @code{gnus-keep-same-level} is non-@code{nil}, some movement commands
2354 will only move to groups of the same level (or lower). In
2355 particular, going from the last article in one group to the next group
2356 will go to the next group of the same level (or lower). This might be
2357 handy if you want to read the most important groups before you read the
2358 rest.
2359
2360 If this variable is @code{best}, Gnus will make the next newsgroup the
2361 one with the best level.
2362
2363 @vindex gnus-group-default-list-level
2364 All groups with a level less than or equal to
2365 @code{gnus-group-default-list-level} will be listed in the group buffer
2366 by default.
2367
2368 @vindex gnus-group-list-inactive-groups
2369 If @code{gnus-group-list-inactive-groups} is non-@code{nil}, non-active
2370 groups will be listed along with the unread groups. This variable is
2371 @code{t} by default. If it is @code{nil}, inactive groups won't be
2372 listed.
2373
2374 @vindex gnus-group-use-permanent-levels
2375 If @code{gnus-group-use-permanent-levels} is non-@code{nil}, once you
2376 give a level prefix to @kbd{g} or @kbd{l}, all subsequent commands will
2377 use this level as the ``work'' level.
2378
2379 @vindex gnus-activate-level
2380 Gnus will normally just activate (i. e., query the server about) groups
2381 on level @code{gnus-activate-level} or less. If you don't want to
2382 activate unsubscribed groups, for instance, you might set this variable
2383 to 5. The default is 6.
2384
2385
2386 @node Group Score
2387 @section Group Score
2388 @cindex group score
2389 @cindex group rank
2390 @cindex rank
2391
2392 You would normally keep important groups on high levels, but that scheme
2393 is somewhat restrictive. Don't you wish you could have Gnus sort the
2394 group buffer according to how often you read groups, perhaps? Within
2395 reason?
2396
2397 This is what @dfn{group score} is for. You can have Gnus assign a score
2398 to each group through the mechanism described below. You can then sort
2399 the group buffer based on this score. Alternatively, you can sort on
2400 score and then level. (Taken together, the level and the score is
2401 called the @dfn{rank} of the group. A group that is on level 4 and has
2402 a score of 1 has a higher rank than a group on level 5 that has a score
2403 of 300. (The level is the most significant part and the score is the
2404 least significant part.))
2405
2406 @findex gnus-summary-bubble-group
2407 If you want groups you read often to get higher scores than groups you
2408 read seldom you can add the @code{gnus-summary-bubble-group} function to
2409 the @code{gnus-summary-exit-hook} hook. This will result (after
2410 sorting) in a bubbling sort of action. If you want to see that in
2411 action after each summary exit, you can add
2412 @code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-rank} or
2413 @code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-score} to the same hook, but that will
2414 slow things down somewhat.
2415
2416
2417 @node Marking Groups
2418 @section Marking Groups
2419 @cindex marking groups
2420
2421 If you want to perform some command on several groups, and they appear
2422 subsequently in the group buffer, you would normally just give a
2423 numerical prefix to the command. Most group commands will then do your
2424 bidding on those groups.
2425
2426 However, if the groups are not in sequential order, you can still
2427 perform a command on several groups. You simply mark the groups first
2428 with the process mark and then execute the command.
2429
2430 @table @kbd
2431
2432 @item #
2433 @kindex # (Group)
2434 @itemx M m
2435 @kindex M m (Group)
2436 @findex gnus-group-mark-group
2437 Set the mark on the current group (@code{gnus-group-mark-group}).
2438
2439 @item M-#
2440 @kindex M-# (Group)
2441 @itemx M u
2442 @kindex M u (Group)
2443 @findex gnus-group-unmark-group
2444 Remove the mark from the current group
2445 (@code{gnus-group-unmark-group}).
2446
2447 @item M U
2448 @kindex M U (Group)
2449 @findex gnus-group-unmark-all-groups
2450 Remove the mark from all groups (@code{gnus-group-unmark-all-groups}).
2451
2452 @item M w
2453 @kindex M w (Group)
2454 @findex gnus-group-mark-region
2455 Mark all groups between point and mark (@code{gnus-group-mark-region}).
2456
2457 @item M b
2458 @kindex M b (Group)
2459 @findex gnus-group-mark-buffer
2460 Mark all groups in the buffer (@code{gnus-group-mark-buffer}).
2461
2462 @item M r
2463 @kindex M r (Group)
2464 @findex gnus-group-mark-regexp
2465 Mark all groups that match some regular expression
2466 (@code{gnus-group-mark-regexp}).
2467 @end table
2468
2469 Also @pxref{Process/Prefix}.
2470
2471 @findex gnus-group-universal-argument
2472 If you want to execute some command on all groups that have been marked
2473 with the process mark, you can use the @kbd{M-&}
2474 (@code{gnus-group-universal-argument}) command. It will prompt you for
2475 the command to be executed.
2476
2477
2478 @node Foreign Groups
2479 @section Foreign Groups
2480 @cindex foreign groups
2481
2482 Below are some group mode commands for making and editing general foreign
2483 groups, as well as commands to ease the creation of a few
2484 special-purpose groups. All these commands insert the newly created
2485 groups under point---@code{gnus-subscribe-newsgroup-method} is not
2486 consulted.
2487
2488 @table @kbd
2489
2490 @item G m
2491 @kindex G m (Group)
2492 @findex gnus-group-make-group
2493 @cindex making groups
2494 Make a new group (@code{gnus-group-make-group}). Gnus will prompt you
2495 for a name, a method and possibly an @dfn{address}. For an easier way
2496 to subscribe to @acronym{NNTP} groups (@pxref{Browse Foreign Server}).
2497
2498 @item G M
2499 @kindex G M (Group)
2500 @findex gnus-group-read-ephemeral-group
2501 Make an ephemeral group (@code{gnus-group-read-ephemeral-group}). Gnus
2502 will prompt you for a name, a method and an @dfn{address}.
2503
2504 @item G r
2505 @kindex G r (Group)
2506 @findex gnus-group-rename-group
2507 @cindex renaming groups
2508 Rename the current group to something else
2509 (@code{gnus-group-rename-group}). This is valid only on some
2510 groups---mail groups mostly. This command might very well be quite slow
2511 on some back ends.
2512
2513 @item G c
2514 @kindex G c (Group)
2515 @cindex customizing
2516 @findex gnus-group-customize
2517 Customize the group parameters (@code{gnus-group-customize}).
2518
2519 @item G e
2520 @kindex G e (Group)
2521 @findex gnus-group-edit-group-method
2522 @cindex renaming groups
2523 Enter a buffer where you can edit the select method of the current
2524 group (@code{gnus-group-edit-group-method}).
2525
2526 @item G p
2527 @kindex G p (Group)
2528 @findex gnus-group-edit-group-parameters
2529 Enter a buffer where you can edit the group parameters
2530 (@code{gnus-group-edit-group-parameters}).
2531
2532 @item G E
2533 @kindex G E (Group)
2534 @findex gnus-group-edit-group
2535 Enter a buffer where you can edit the group info
2536 (@code{gnus-group-edit-group}).
2537
2538 @item G d
2539 @kindex G d (Group)
2540 @findex gnus-group-make-directory-group
2541 @cindex nndir
2542 Make a directory group (@pxref{Directory Groups}). You will be prompted
2543 for a directory name (@code{gnus-group-make-directory-group}).
2544
2545 @item G h
2546 @kindex G h (Group)
2547 @cindex help group
2548 @findex gnus-group-make-help-group
2549 Make the Gnus help group (@code{gnus-group-make-help-group}).
2550
2551 @item G a
2552 @kindex G a (Group)
2553 @cindex (ding) archive
2554 @cindex archive group
2555 @findex gnus-group-make-archive-group
2556 @vindex gnus-group-archive-directory
2557 @vindex gnus-group-recent-archive-directory
2558 Make a Gnus archive group (@code{gnus-group-make-archive-group}). By
2559 default a group pointing to the most recent articles will be created
2560 (@code{gnus-group-recent-archive-directory}), but given a prefix, a full
2561 group will be created from @code{gnus-group-archive-directory}.
2562
2563 @item G k
2564 @kindex G k (Group)
2565 @findex gnus-group-make-kiboze-group
2566 @cindex nnkiboze
2567 Make a kiboze group. You will be prompted for a name, for a regexp to
2568 match groups to be ``included'' in the kiboze group, and a series of
2569 strings to match on headers (@code{gnus-group-make-kiboze-group}).
2570 @xref{Kibozed Groups}.
2571
2572 @item G D
2573 @kindex G D (Group)
2574 @findex gnus-group-enter-directory
2575 @cindex nneething
2576 Read an arbitrary directory as if it were a newsgroup with the
2577 @code{nneething} back end (@code{gnus-group-enter-directory}).
2578 @xref{Anything Groups}.
2579
2580 @item G f
2581 @kindex G f (Group)
2582 @findex gnus-group-make-doc-group
2583 @cindex ClariNet Briefs
2584 @cindex nndoc
2585 Make a group based on some file or other
2586 (@code{gnus-group-make-doc-group}). If you give a prefix to this
2587 command, you will be prompted for a file name and a file type.
2588 Currently supported types are @code{mbox}, @code{babyl},
2589 @code{digest}, @code{news}, @code{rnews}, @code{mmdf}, @code{forward},
2590 @code{rfc934}, @code{rfc822-forward}, @code{mime-parts},
2591 @code{standard-digest}, @code{slack-digest}, @code{clari-briefs},
2592 @code{nsmail}, @code{outlook}, @code{oe-dbx}, and @code{mailman}. If
2593 you run this command without a prefix, Gnus will guess at the file
2594 type. @xref{Document Groups}.
2595
2596 @item G u
2597 @kindex G u (Group)
2598 @vindex gnus-useful-groups
2599 @findex gnus-group-make-useful-group
2600 Create one of the groups mentioned in @code{gnus-useful-groups}
2601 (@code{gnus-group-make-useful-group}).
2602
2603 @item G w
2604 @kindex G w (Group)
2605 @findex gnus-group-make-web-group
2606 @cindex Google
2607 @cindex nnweb
2608 @cindex gmane
2609 Make an ephemeral group based on a web search
2610 (@code{gnus-group-make-web-group}). If you give a prefix to this
2611 command, make a solid group instead. You will be prompted for the
2612 search engine type and the search string. Valid search engine types
2613 include @code{google}, @code{dejanews}, and @code{gmane}.
2614 @xref{Web Searches}.
2615
2616 If you use the @code{google} search engine, you can limit the search
2617 to a particular group by using a match string like
2618 @samp{shaving group:alt.sysadmin.recovery}.
2619
2620 @item G R
2621 @kindex G R (Group)
2622 @findex gnus-group-make-rss-group
2623 Make a group based on an @acronym{RSS} feed
2624 (@code{gnus-group-make-rss-group}). You will be prompted for an URL.
2625 @xref{RSS}.
2626
2627 @item G DEL
2628 @kindex G DEL (Group)
2629 @findex gnus-group-delete-group
2630 This function will delete the current group
2631 (@code{gnus-group-delete-group}). If given a prefix, this function will
2632 actually delete all the articles in the group, and forcibly remove the
2633 group itself from the face of the Earth. Use a prefix only if you are
2634 absolutely sure of what you are doing. This command can't be used on
2635 read-only groups (like @code{nntp} groups), though.
2636
2637 @item G V
2638 @kindex G V (Group)
2639 @findex gnus-group-make-empty-virtual
2640 Make a new, fresh, empty @code{nnvirtual} group
2641 (@code{gnus-group-make-empty-virtual}). @xref{Virtual Groups}.
2642
2643 @item G v
2644 @kindex G v (Group)
2645 @findex gnus-group-add-to-virtual
2646 Add the current group to an @code{nnvirtual} group
2647 (@code{gnus-group-add-to-virtual}). Uses the process/prefix convention.
2648 @end table
2649
2650 @xref{Select Methods}, for more information on the various select
2651 methods.
2652
2653 @vindex gnus-activate-foreign-newsgroups
2654 If @code{gnus-activate-foreign-newsgroups} is a positive number,
2655 Gnus will check all foreign groups with this level or lower at startup.
2656 This might take quite a while, especially if you subscribe to lots of
2657 groups from different @acronym{NNTP} servers. Also @pxref{Group Levels};
2658 @code{gnus-activate-level} also affects activation of foreign
2659 newsgroups.
2660
2661
2662 @node Group Parameters
2663 @section Group Parameters
2664 @cindex group parameters
2665
2666 The group parameters store information local to a particular group.
2667 Here's an example group parameter list:
2668
2669 @example
2670 ((to-address . "ding@@gnus.org")
2671 (auto-expire . t))
2672 @end example
2673
2674 We see that each element consists of a ``dotted pair''---the thing before
2675 the dot is the key, while the thing after the dot is the value. All the
2676 parameters have this form @emph{except} local variable specs, which are
2677 not dotted pairs, but proper lists.
2678
2679 Some parameters have correspondent customizable variables, each of which
2680 is an alist of regexps and values.
2681
2682 The following group parameters can be used:
2683
2684 @table @code
2685 @item to-address
2686 @cindex to-address
2687 Address used by when doing followups and new posts.
2688
2689 @example
2690 (to-address . "some@@where.com")
2691 @end example
2692
2693 This is primarily useful in mail groups that represent closed mailing
2694 lists---mailing lists where it's expected that everybody that writes to
2695 the mailing list is subscribed to it. Since using this parameter
2696 ensures that the mail only goes to the mailing list itself, it means
2697 that members won't receive two copies of your followups.
2698
2699 Using @code{to-address} will actually work whether the group is foreign
2700 or not. Let's say there's a group on the server that is called
2701 @samp{fa.4ad-l}. This is a real newsgroup, but the server has gotten
2702 the articles from a mail-to-news gateway. Posting directly to this
2703 group is therefore impossible---you have to send mail to the mailing
2704 list address instead.
2705
2706 See also @code{gnus-parameter-to-address-alist}.
2707
2708 @item to-list
2709 @cindex to-list
2710 Address used when doing @kbd{a} in that group.
2711
2712 @example
2713 (to-list . "some@@where.com")
2714 @end example
2715
2716 It is totally ignored
2717 when doing a followup---except that if it is present in a news group,
2718 you'll get mail group semantics when doing @kbd{f}.
2719
2720 If you do an @kbd{a} command in a mail group and you have neither a
2721 @code{to-list} group parameter nor a @code{to-address} group parameter,
2722 then a @code{to-list} group parameter will be added automatically upon
2723 sending the message if @code{gnus-add-to-list} is set to @code{t}.
2724 @vindex gnus-add-to-list
2725
2726 @findex gnus-mailing-list-mode
2727 @cindex mail list groups
2728 If this variable is set, @code{gnus-mailing-list-mode} is turned on when
2729 entering summary buffer.
2730
2731 See also @code{gnus-parameter-to-list-alist}.
2732
2733 @anchor{subscribed}
2734 @item subscribed
2735 @cindex subscribed
2736 @cindex Mail-Followup-To
2737 @findex gnus-find-subscribed-addresses
2738 If this parameter is set to @code{t}, Gnus will consider the
2739 to-address and to-list parameters for this group as addresses of
2740 mailing lists you are subscribed to. Giving Gnus this information is
2741 (only) a first step in getting it to generate correct Mail-Followup-To
2742 headers for your posts to these lists. The second step is to put the
2743 following in your @file{.gnus.el}
2744
2745 @lisp
2746 (setq message-subscribed-address-functions
2747 '(gnus-find-subscribed-addresses))
2748 @end lisp
2749
2750 @xref{Mailing Lists, ,Mailing Lists, message, The Message Manual}, for
2751 a complete treatment of available MFT support.
2752
2753 @item visible
2754 @cindex visible
2755 If the group parameter list has the element @code{(visible . t)},
2756 that group will always be visible in the Group buffer, regardless
2757 of whether it has any unread articles.
2758
2759 @item broken-reply-to
2760 @cindex broken-reply-to
2761 Elements like @code{(broken-reply-to . t)} signals that @code{Reply-To}
2762 headers in this group are to be ignored, and for the header to be hidden
2763 if @code{reply-to} is part of @code{gnus-boring-article-headers}. This
2764 can be useful if you're reading a mailing list group where the listserv
2765 has inserted @code{Reply-To} headers that point back to the listserv
2766 itself. That is broken behavior. So there!
2767
2768 @item to-group
2769 @cindex to-group
2770 Elements like @code{(to-group . "some.group.name")} means that all
2771 posts in that group will be sent to @code{some.group.name}.
2772
2773 @item newsgroup
2774 @cindex newsgroup
2775 If you have @code{(newsgroup . t)} in the group parameter list, Gnus
2776 will treat all responses as if they were responses to news articles.
2777 This can be useful if you have a mail group that's really a mirror of a
2778 news group.
2779
2780 @item gcc-self
2781 @cindex gcc-self
2782 If @code{(gcc-self . t)} is present in the group parameter list, newly
2783 composed messages will be @code{Gcc}'d to the current group. If
2784 @code{(gcc-self . none)} is present, no @code{Gcc:} header will be
2785 generated, if @code{(gcc-self . "string")} is present, this string will
2786 be inserted literally as a @code{gcc} header. This parameter takes
2787 precedence over any default @code{Gcc} rules as described later
2788 (@pxref{Archived Messages}).
2789
2790 @strong{Caveat}: Adding @code{(gcc-self . t)} to the parameter list of
2791 @code{nntp} groups (or the like) isn't valid. An @code{nntp} server
2792 doesn't accept articles.
2793
2794 @item auto-expire
2795 @cindex auto-expire
2796 If the group parameter has an element that looks like @code{(auto-expire
2797 . t)}, all articles read will be marked as expirable. For an
2798 alternative approach, @pxref{Expiring Mail}.
2799
2800 See also @code{gnus-auto-expirable-newsgroups}.
2801
2802 @item total-expire
2803 @cindex total-expire
2804 If the group parameter has an element that looks like
2805 @code{(total-expire . t)}, all read articles will be put through the
2806 expiry process, even if they are not marked as expirable. Use with
2807 caution. Unread, ticked and dormant articles are not eligible for
2808 expiry.
2809
2810 See also @code{gnus-total-expirable-newsgroups}.
2811
2812 @item expiry-wait
2813 @cindex expiry-wait
2814 @vindex nnmail-expiry-wait-function
2815 If the group parameter has an element that looks like
2816 @code{(expiry-wait . 10)}, this value will override any
2817 @code{nnmail-expiry-wait} and @code{nnmail-expiry-wait-function}
2818 (@pxref{Expiring Mail}) when expiring expirable messages. The value
2819 can either be a number of days (not necessarily an integer) or the
2820 symbols @code{never} or @code{immediate}.
2821
2822 @item expiry-target
2823 @cindex expiry-target
2824 Where expired messages end up. This parameter overrides
2825 @code{nnmail-expiry-target}.
2826
2827 @item score-file
2828 @cindex score file group parameter
2829 Elements that look like @code{(score-file . "file")} will make
2830 @file{file} into the current score file for the group in question. All
2831 interactive score entries will be put into this file.
2832
2833 @item adapt-file
2834 @cindex adapt file group parameter
2835 Elements that look like @code{(adapt-file . "file")} will make
2836 @file{file} into the current adaptive file for the group in question.
2837 All adaptive score entries will be put into this file.
2838
2839 @item admin-address
2840 @cindex admin-address
2841 When unsubscribing from a mailing list you should never send the
2842 unsubscription notice to the mailing list itself. Instead, you'd send
2843 messages to the administrative address. This parameter allows you to
2844 put the admin address somewhere convenient.
2845
2846 @item display
2847 @cindex display
2848 Elements that look like @code{(display . MODE)} say which articles to
2849 display on entering the group. Valid values are:
2850
2851 @table @code
2852 @item all
2853 Display all articles, both read and unread.
2854
2855 @item an integer
2856 Display the last @var{integer} articles in the group. This is the same as
2857 entering the group with @kbd{C-u @var{integer}}.
2858
2859 @item default
2860 Display the default visible articles, which normally includes unread and
2861 ticked articles.
2862
2863 @item an array
2864 Display articles that satisfy a predicate.
2865
2866 Here are some examples:
2867
2868 @table @code
2869 @item [unread]
2870 Display only unread articles.
2871
2872 @item [not expire]
2873 Display everything except expirable articles.
2874
2875 @item [and (not reply) (not expire)]
2876 Display everything except expirable and articles you've already
2877 responded to.
2878 @end table
2879
2880 The available operators are @code{not}, @code{and} and @code{or}.
2881 Predicates include @code{tick}, @code{unsend}, @code{undownload},
2882 @code{unread}, @code{dormant}, @code{expire}, @code{reply},
2883 @code{killed}, @code{bookmark}, @code{score}, @code{save},
2884 @code{cache}, @code{forward}, @code{unseen} and @code{recent}.
2885
2886 @end table
2887
2888 The @code{display} parameter works by limiting the summary buffer to
2889 the subset specified. You can pop the limit by using the @kbd{/ w}
2890 command (@pxref{Limiting}).
2891
2892 @item comment
2893 @cindex comment
2894 Elements that look like @code{(comment . "This is a comment")} are
2895 arbitrary comments on the group. You can display comments in the
2896 group line (@pxref{Group Line Specification}).
2897
2898 @item charset
2899 @cindex charset
2900 Elements that look like @code{(charset . iso-8859-1)} will make
2901 @code{iso-8859-1} the default charset; that is, the charset that will be
2902 used for all articles that do not specify a charset.
2903
2904 See also @code{gnus-group-charset-alist}.
2905
2906 @item ignored-charsets
2907 @cindex ignored-charset
2908 Elements that look like @code{(ignored-charsets x-unknown iso-8859-1)}
2909 will make @code{iso-8859-1} and @code{x-unknown} ignored; that is, the
2910 default charset will be used for decoding articles.
2911
2912 See also @code{gnus-group-ignored-charsets-alist}.
2913
2914 @item posting-style
2915 @cindex posting-style
2916 You can store additional posting style information for this group
2917 here (@pxref{Posting Styles}). The format is that of an entry in the
2918 @code{gnus-posting-styles} alist, except that there's no regexp matching
2919 the group name (of course). Style elements in this group parameter will
2920 take precedence over the ones found in @code{gnus-posting-styles}.
2921
2922 For instance, if you want a funky name and signature in this group only,
2923 instead of hacking @code{gnus-posting-styles}, you could put something
2924 like this in the group parameters:
2925
2926 @example
2927 (posting-style
2928 (name "Funky Name")
2929 ("X-My-Header" "Funky Value")
2930 (signature "Funky Signature"))
2931 @end example
2932
2933 @item post-method
2934 @cindex post-method
2935 If it is set, the value is used as the method for posting message
2936 instead of @code{gnus-post-method}.
2937
2938 @item banner
2939 @cindex banner
2940 An item like @code{(banner . @var{regexp})} causes any part of an article
2941 that matches the regular expression @var{regexp} to be stripped. Instead of
2942 @var{regexp}, you can also use the symbol @code{signature} which strips the
2943 last signature or any of the elements of the alist
2944 @code{gnus-article-banner-alist}.
2945
2946 @item sieve
2947 @cindex sieve
2948 This parameter contains a Sieve test that should match incoming mail
2949 that should be placed in this group. From this group parameter, a
2950 Sieve @samp{IF} control structure is generated, having the test as the
2951 condition and @samp{fileinto "group.name";} as the body.
2952
2953 For example, if the @samp{INBOX.list.sieve} group has the @code{(sieve
2954 address "sender" "sieve-admin@@extundo.com")} group parameter, when
2955 translating the group parameter into a Sieve script (@pxref{Sieve
2956 Commands}) the following Sieve code is generated:
2957
2958 @example
2959 if address \"sender\" \"sieve-admin@@extundo.com\" @{
2960 fileinto \"INBOX.list.sieve\";
2961 @}
2962 @end example
2963
2964 The Sieve language is described in RFC 3028. @xref{Top, Emacs Sieve,
2965 Top, sieve, Emacs Sieve}.
2966
2967 @item (agent parameters)
2968 If the agent has been enabled, you can set any of the its parameters
2969 to control the behavior of the agent in individual groups. See Agent
2970 Parameters in @ref{Category Syntax}. Most users will choose to set
2971 agent parameters in either an agent category or group topic to
2972 minimize the configuration effort.
2973
2974 @item (@var{variable} @var{form})
2975 You can use the group parameters to set variables local to the group you
2976 are entering. If you want to turn threading off in @samp{news.answers},
2977 you could put @code{(gnus-show-threads nil)} in the group parameters of
2978 that group. @code{gnus-show-threads} will be made into a local variable
2979 in the summary buffer you enter, and the form @code{nil} will be
2980 @code{eval}ed there.
2981
2982 Note that this feature sets the variable locally to the summary buffer.
2983 But some variables are evaluated in the article buffer, or in the
2984 message buffer (of a reply or followup or otherwise newly created
2985 message). As a workaround, it might help to add the variable in
2986 question to @code{gnus-newsgroup-variables}. @xref{Various Summary
2987 Stuff}. So if you want to set @code{message-from-style} via the group
2988 parameters, then you may need the following statement elsewhere in your
2989 @file{~/.gnus} file:
2990
2991 @lisp
2992 (add-to-list 'gnus-newsgroup-variables 'message-from-style)
2993 @end lisp
2994
2995 @vindex gnus-list-identifiers
2996 A use for this feature is to remove a mailing list identifier tag in
2997 the subject fields of articles. E.g. if the news group
2998
2999 @example
3000 nntp+news.gnus.org:gmane.text.docbook.apps
3001 @end example
3002
3003 has the tag @samp{DOC-BOOK-APPS:} in the subject of all articles, this
3004 tag can be removed from the article subjects in the summary buffer for
3005 the group by putting @code{(gnus-list-identifiers "DOCBOOK-APPS:")}
3006 into the group parameters for the group.
3007
3008 This can also be used as a group-specific hook function. If you want to
3009 hear a beep when you enter a group, you could put something like
3010 @code{(dummy-variable (ding))} in the parameters of that group.
3011 @code{dummy-variable} will be set to the (meaningless) result of the
3012 @code{(ding)} form.
3013
3014 Alternatively, since the VARIABLE becomes local to the group, this
3015 pattern can be used to temporarily change a hook. For example, if the
3016 following is added to a group parameter
3017
3018 @lisp
3019 (gnus-summary-prepared-hook
3020 '(lambda nil (local-set-key "d" (local-key-binding "n"))))
3021 @end lisp
3022
3023 when the group is entered, the 'd' key will not mark the article as
3024 expired.
3025
3026 @end table
3027
3028 Use the @kbd{G p} or the @kbd{G c} command to edit group parameters of a
3029 group. (@kbd{G p} presents you with a Lisp-based interface, @kbd{G c}
3030 presents you with a Customize-like interface. The latter helps avoid
3031 silly Lisp errors.) You might also be interested in reading about topic
3032 parameters (@pxref{Topic Parameters}).
3033
3034 @vindex gnus-parameters
3035 Group parameters can be set via the @code{gnus-parameters} variable too.
3036 But some variables, such as @code{visible}, have no effect. For
3037 example:
3038
3039 @lisp
3040 (setq gnus-parameters
3041 '(("mail\\..*"
3042 (gnus-show-threads nil)
3043 (gnus-use-scoring nil)
3044 (gnus-summary-line-format
3045 "%U%R%z%I%(%[%d:%ub%-23,23f%]%) %s\n")
3046 (gcc-self . t)
3047 (display . all))
3048
3049 ("^nnimap:\\(foo.bar\\)$"
3050 (to-group . "\\1"))
3051
3052 ("mail\\.me"
3053 (gnus-use-scoring t))
3054
3055 ("list\\..*"
3056 (total-expire . t)
3057 (broken-reply-to . t))))
3058 @end lisp
3059
3060 String value of parameters will be subjected to regexp substitution, as
3061 the @code{to-group} example shows.
3062
3063
3064 @node Listing Groups
3065 @section Listing Groups
3066 @cindex group listing
3067
3068 These commands all list various slices of the groups available.
3069
3070 @table @kbd
3071
3072 @item l
3073 @itemx A s
3074 @kindex A s (Group)
3075 @kindex l (Group)
3076 @findex gnus-group-list-groups
3077 List all groups that have unread articles
3078 (@code{gnus-group-list-groups}). If the numeric prefix is used, this
3079 command will list only groups of level ARG and lower. By default, it
3080 only lists groups of level five (i.e.,
3081 @code{gnus-group-default-list-level}) or lower (i.e., just subscribed
3082 groups).
3083
3084 @item L
3085 @itemx A u
3086 @kindex A u (Group)
3087 @kindex L (Group)
3088 @findex gnus-group-list-all-groups
3089 List all groups, whether they have unread articles or not
3090 (@code{gnus-group-list-all-groups}). If the numeric prefix is used,
3091 this command will list only groups of level ARG and lower. By default,
3092 it lists groups of level seven or lower (i.e., just subscribed and
3093 unsubscribed groups).
3094
3095 @item A l
3096 @kindex A l (Group)
3097 @findex gnus-group-list-level
3098 List all unread groups on a specific level
3099 (@code{gnus-group-list-level}). If given a prefix, also list the groups
3100 with no unread articles.
3101
3102 @item A k
3103 @kindex A k (Group)
3104 @findex gnus-group-list-killed
3105 List all killed groups (@code{gnus-group-list-killed}). If given a
3106 prefix argument, really list all groups that are available, but aren't
3107 currently (un)subscribed. This could entail reading the active file
3108 from the server.
3109
3110 @item A z
3111 @kindex A z (Group)
3112 @findex gnus-group-list-zombies
3113 List all zombie groups (@code{gnus-group-list-zombies}).
3114
3115 @item A m
3116 @kindex A m (Group)
3117 @findex gnus-group-list-matching
3118 List all unread, subscribed groups with names that match a regexp
3119 (@code{gnus-group-list-matching}).
3120
3121 @item A M
3122 @kindex A M (Group)
3123 @findex gnus-group-list-all-matching
3124 List groups that match a regexp (@code{gnus-group-list-all-matching}).
3125
3126 @item A A
3127 @kindex A A (Group)
3128 @findex gnus-group-list-active
3129 List absolutely all groups in the active file(s) of the
3130 server(s) you are connected to (@code{gnus-group-list-active}). This
3131 might very well take quite a while. It might actually be a better idea
3132 to do a @kbd{A M} to list all matching, and just give @samp{.} as the
3133 thing to match on. Also note that this command may list groups that
3134 don't exist (yet)---these will be listed as if they were killed groups.
3135 Take the output with some grains of salt.
3136
3137 @item A a
3138 @kindex A a (Group)
3139 @findex gnus-group-apropos
3140 List all groups that have names that match a regexp
3141 (@code{gnus-group-apropos}).
3142
3143 @item A d
3144 @kindex A d (Group)
3145 @findex gnus-group-description-apropos
3146 List all groups that have names or descriptions that match a regexp
3147 (@code{gnus-group-description-apropos}).
3148
3149 @item A c
3150 @kindex A c (Group)
3151 @findex gnus-group-list-cached
3152 List all groups with cached articles (@code{gnus-group-list-cached}).
3153
3154 @item A ?
3155 @kindex A ? (Group)
3156 @findex gnus-group-list-dormant
3157 List all groups with dormant articles (@code{gnus-group-list-dormant}).
3158
3159 @item A /
3160 @kindex A / (Group)
3161 @findex gnus-group-list-limit
3162 List groups limited within the current selection
3163 (@code{gnus-group-list-limit}).
3164
3165 @item A f
3166 @kindex A f (Group)
3167 @findex gnus-group-list-flush
3168 Flush groups from the current selection (@code{gnus-group-list-flush}).
3169
3170 @item A p
3171 @kindex A p (Group)
3172 @findex gnus-group-list-plus
3173 List groups plus the current selection (@code{gnus-group-list-plus}).
3174
3175 @end table
3176
3177 @vindex gnus-permanently-visible-groups
3178 @cindex visible group parameter
3179 Groups that match the @code{gnus-permanently-visible-groups} regexp will
3180 always be shown, whether they have unread articles or not. You can also
3181 add the @code{visible} element to the group parameters in question to
3182 get the same effect.
3183
3184 @vindex gnus-list-groups-with-ticked-articles
3185 Groups that have just ticked articles in it are normally listed in the
3186 group buffer. If @code{gnus-list-groups-with-ticked-articles} is
3187 @code{nil}, these groups will be treated just like totally empty
3188 groups. It is @code{t} by default.
3189
3190
3191 @node Sorting Groups
3192 @section Sorting Groups
3193 @cindex sorting groups
3194
3195 @kindex C-c C-s (Group)
3196 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups
3197 @vindex gnus-group-sort-function
3198 The @kbd{C-c C-s} (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups}) command sorts the
3199 group buffer according to the function(s) given by the
3200 @code{gnus-group-sort-function} variable. Available sorting functions
3201 include:
3202
3203 @table @code
3204
3205 @item gnus-group-sort-by-alphabet
3206 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-alphabet
3207 Sort the group names alphabetically. This is the default.
3208
3209 @item gnus-group-sort-by-real-name
3210 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-real-name
3211 Sort the group alphabetically on the real (unprefixed) group names.
3212
3213 @item gnus-group-sort-by-level
3214 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-level
3215 Sort by group level.
3216
3217 @item gnus-group-sort-by-score
3218 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-score
3219 Sort by group score. @xref{Group Score}.
3220
3221 @item gnus-group-sort-by-rank
3222 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-rank
3223 Sort by group score and then the group level. The level and the score
3224 are, when taken together, the group's @dfn{rank}. @xref{Group Score}.
3225
3226 @item gnus-group-sort-by-unread
3227 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-unread
3228 Sort by number of unread articles.
3229
3230 @item gnus-group-sort-by-method
3231 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-method
3232 Sort alphabetically on the select method.
3233
3234 @item gnus-group-sort-by-server
3235 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-server
3236 Sort alphabetically on the Gnus server name.
3237
3238
3239 @end table
3240
3241 @code{gnus-group-sort-function} can also be a list of sorting
3242 functions. In that case, the most significant sort key function must be
3243 the last one.
3244
3245
3246 There are also a number of commands for sorting directly according to
3247 some sorting criteria:
3248
3249 @table @kbd
3250 @item G S a
3251 @kindex G S a (Group)
3252 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-alphabet
3253 Sort the group buffer alphabetically by group name
3254 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-alphabet}).
3255
3256 @item G S u
3257 @kindex G S u (Group)
3258 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-unread
3259 Sort the group buffer by the number of unread articles
3260 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-unread}).
3261
3262 @item G S l
3263 @kindex G S l (Group)
3264 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-level
3265 Sort the group buffer by group level
3266 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-level}).
3267
3268 @item G S v
3269 @kindex G S v (Group)
3270 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-score
3271 Sort the group buffer by group score
3272 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-score}). @xref{Group Score}.
3273
3274 @item G S r
3275 @kindex G S r (Group)
3276 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-rank
3277 Sort the group buffer by group rank
3278 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-rank}). @xref{Group Score}.
3279
3280 @item G S m
3281 @kindex G S m (Group)
3282 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-method
3283 Sort the group buffer alphabetically by back end name@*
3284 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-method}).
3285
3286 @item G S n
3287 @kindex G S n (Group)
3288 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-real-name
3289 Sort the group buffer alphabetically by real (unprefixed) group name
3290 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-real-name}).
3291
3292 @end table
3293
3294 All the commands below obey the process/prefix convention
3295 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
3296
3297 When given a symbolic prefix (@pxref{Symbolic Prefixes}), all these
3298 commands will sort in reverse order.
3299
3300 You can also sort a subset of the groups:
3301
3302 @table @kbd
3303 @item G P a
3304 @kindex G P a (Group)
3305 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-alphabet
3306 Sort the groups alphabetically by group name
3307 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-alphabet}).
3308
3309 @item G P u
3310 @kindex G P u (Group)
3311 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-unread
3312 Sort the groups by the number of unread articles
3313 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-unread}).
3314
3315 @item G P l
3316 @kindex G P l (Group)
3317 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-level
3318 Sort the groups by group level
3319 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-level}).
3320
3321 @item G P v
3322 @kindex G P v (Group)
3323 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-score
3324 Sort the groups by group score
3325 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-score}). @xref{Group Score}.
3326
3327 @item G P r
3328 @kindex G P r (Group)
3329 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-rank
3330 Sort the groups by group rank
3331 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-rank}). @xref{Group Score}.
3332
3333 @item G P m
3334 @kindex G P m (Group)
3335 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-method
3336 Sort the groups alphabetically by back end name@*
3337 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-method}).
3338
3339 @item G P n
3340 @kindex G P n (Group)
3341 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-real-name
3342 Sort the groups alphabetically by real (unprefixed) group name
3343 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-real-name}).
3344
3345 @item G P s
3346 @kindex G P s (Group)
3347 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups
3348 Sort the groups according to @code{gnus-group-sort-function}.
3349
3350 @end table
3351
3352 And finally, note that you can use @kbd{C-k} and @kbd{C-y} to manually
3353 move groups around.
3354
3355
3356 @node Group Maintenance
3357 @section Group Maintenance
3358 @cindex bogus groups
3359
3360 @table @kbd
3361 @item b
3362 @kindex b (Group)
3363 @findex gnus-group-check-bogus-groups
3364 Find bogus groups and delete them
3365 (@code{gnus-group-check-bogus-groups}).
3366
3367 @item F
3368 @kindex F (Group)
3369 @findex gnus-group-find-new-groups
3370 Find new groups and process them (@code{gnus-group-find-new-groups}).
3371 With 1 @kbd{C-u}, use the @code{ask-server} method to query the server
3372 for new groups. With 2 @kbd{C-u}'s, use most complete method possible
3373 to query the server for new groups, and subscribe the new groups as
3374 zombies.
3375
3376 @item C-c C-x
3377 @kindex C-c C-x (Group)
3378 @findex gnus-group-expire-articles
3379 Run all expirable articles in the current group through the expiry
3380 process (if any) (@code{gnus-group-expire-articles}). That is, delete
3381 all expirable articles in the group that have been around for a while.
3382 (@pxref{Expiring Mail}).
3383
3384 @item C-c C-M-x
3385 @kindex C-c C-M-x (Group)
3386 @findex gnus-group-expire-all-groups
3387 Run all expirable articles in all groups through the expiry process
3388 (@code{gnus-group-expire-all-groups}).
3389
3390 @end table
3391
3392
3393 @node Browse Foreign Server
3394 @section Browse Foreign Server
3395 @cindex foreign servers
3396 @cindex browsing servers
3397
3398 @table @kbd
3399 @item B
3400 @kindex B (Group)
3401 @findex gnus-group-browse-foreign-server
3402 You will be queried for a select method and a server name. Gnus will
3403 then attempt to contact this server and let you browse the groups there
3404 (@code{gnus-group-browse-foreign-server}).
3405 @end table
3406
3407 @findex gnus-browse-mode
3408 A new buffer with a list of available groups will appear. This buffer
3409 will use the @code{gnus-browse-mode}. This buffer looks a bit (well,
3410 a lot) like a normal group buffer.
3411
3412 Here's a list of keystrokes available in the browse mode:
3413
3414 @table @kbd
3415 @item n
3416 @kindex n (Browse)
3417 @findex gnus-group-next-group
3418 Go to the next group (@code{gnus-group-next-group}).
3419
3420 @item p
3421 @kindex p (Browse)
3422 @findex gnus-group-prev-group
3423 Go to the previous group (@code{gnus-group-prev-group}).
3424
3425 @item SPACE
3426 @kindex SPACE (Browse)
3427 @findex gnus-browse-read-group
3428 Enter the current group and display the first article
3429 (@code{gnus-browse-read-group}).
3430
3431 @item RET
3432 @kindex RET (Browse)
3433 @findex gnus-browse-select-group
3434 Enter the current group (@code{gnus-browse-select-group}).
3435
3436 @item u
3437 @kindex u (Browse)
3438 @findex gnus-browse-unsubscribe-current-group
3439 Unsubscribe to the current group, or, as will be the case here,
3440 subscribe to it (@code{gnus-browse-unsubscribe-current-group}).
3441
3442 @item l
3443 @itemx q
3444 @kindex q (Browse)
3445 @kindex l (Browse)
3446 @findex gnus-browse-exit
3447 Exit browse mode (@code{gnus-browse-exit}).
3448
3449 @item d
3450 @kindex d (Browse)
3451 @findex gnus-browse-describe-group
3452 Describe the current group (@code{gnus-browse-describe-group}).
3453
3454 @item ?
3455 @kindex ? (Browse)
3456 @findex gnus-browse-describe-briefly
3457 Describe browse mode briefly (well, there's not much to describe, is
3458 there) (@code{gnus-browse-describe-briefly}).
3459 @end table
3460
3461
3462 @node Exiting Gnus
3463 @section Exiting Gnus
3464 @cindex exiting Gnus
3465
3466 Yes, Gnus is ex(c)iting.
3467
3468 @table @kbd
3469 @item z
3470 @kindex z (Group)
3471 @findex gnus-group-suspend
3472 Suspend Gnus (@code{gnus-group-suspend}). This doesn't really exit Gnus,
3473 but it kills all buffers except the Group buffer. I'm not sure why this
3474 is a gain, but then who am I to judge?
3475
3476 @item q
3477 @kindex q (Group)
3478 @findex gnus-group-exit
3479 @c @icon{gnus-group-exit}
3480 Quit Gnus (@code{gnus-group-exit}).
3481
3482 @item Q
3483 @kindex Q (Group)
3484 @findex gnus-group-quit
3485 Quit Gnus without saving the @file{.newsrc} files (@code{gnus-group-quit}).
3486 The dribble file will be saved, though (@pxref{Auto Save}).
3487 @end table
3488
3489 @vindex gnus-exit-gnus-hook
3490 @vindex gnus-suspend-gnus-hook
3491 @vindex gnus-after-exiting-gnus-hook
3492 @code{gnus-suspend-gnus-hook} is called when you suspend Gnus and
3493 @code{gnus-exit-gnus-hook} is called when you quit Gnus, while
3494 @code{gnus-after-exiting-gnus-hook} is called as the final item when
3495 exiting Gnus.
3496
3497 Note:
3498
3499 @quotation
3500 Miss Lisa Cannifax, while sitting in English class, felt her feet go
3501 numbly heavy and herself fall into a hazy trance as the boy sitting
3502 behind her drew repeated lines with his pencil across the back of her
3503 plastic chair.
3504 @end quotation
3505
3506
3507 @node Group Topics
3508 @section Group Topics
3509 @cindex topics
3510
3511 If you read lots and lots of groups, it might be convenient to group
3512 them hierarchically according to topics. You put your Emacs groups over
3513 here, your sex groups over there, and the rest (what, two groups or so?)
3514 you put in some misc section that you never bother with anyway. You can
3515 even group the Emacs sex groups as a sub-topic to either the Emacs
3516 groups or the sex groups---or both! Go wild!
3517
3518 @iftex
3519 @iflatex
3520 \gnusfigure{Group Topics}{400}{
3521 \put(75,50){\epsfig{figure=ps/group-topic,height=9cm}}
3522 }
3523 @end iflatex
3524 @end iftex
3525
3526 Here's an example:
3527
3528 @example
3529 Gnus
3530 Emacs -- I wuw it!
3531 3: comp.emacs
3532 2: alt.religion.emacs
3533 Naughty Emacs
3534 452: alt.sex.emacs
3535 0: comp.talk.emacs.recovery
3536 Misc
3537 8: comp.binaries.fractals
3538 13: comp.sources.unix
3539 @end example
3540
3541 @findex gnus-topic-mode
3542 @kindex t (Group)
3543 To get this @emph{fab} functionality you simply turn on (ooh!) the
3544 @code{gnus-topic} minor mode---type @kbd{t} in the group buffer. (This
3545 is a toggling command.)
3546
3547 Go ahead, just try it. I'll still be here when you get back. La de
3548 dum@dots{} Nice tune, that@dots{} la la la@dots{} What, you're back?
3549 Yes, and now press @kbd{l}. There. All your groups are now listed
3550 under @samp{misc}. Doesn't that make you feel all warm and fuzzy?
3551 Hot and bothered?
3552
3553 If you want this permanently enabled, you should add that minor mode to
3554 the hook for the group mode. Put the following line in your
3555 @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
3556
3557 @lisp
3558 (add-hook 'gnus-group-mode-hook 'gnus-topic-mode)
3559 @end lisp
3560
3561 @menu
3562 * Topic Commands:: Interactive E-Z commands.
3563 * Topic Variables:: How to customize the topics the Lisp Way.
3564 * Topic Sorting:: Sorting each topic individually.
3565 * Topic Topology:: A map of the world.
3566 * Topic Parameters:: Parameters that apply to all groups in a topic.
3567 @end menu
3568
3569
3570 @node Topic Commands
3571 @subsection Topic Commands
3572 @cindex topic commands
3573
3574 When the topic minor mode is turned on, a new @kbd{T} submap will be
3575 available. In addition, a few of the standard keys change their
3576 definitions slightly.
3577
3578 In general, the following kinds of operations are possible on topics.
3579 First of all, you want to create topics. Secondly, you want to put
3580 groups in topics and to move them around until you have an order you
3581 like. The third kind of operation is to show/hide parts of the whole
3582 shebang. You might want to hide a topic including its subtopics and
3583 groups, to get a better overview of the other groups.
3584
3585 Here is a list of the basic keys that you might need to set up topics
3586 the way you like.
3587
3588 @table @kbd
3589
3590 @item T n
3591 @kindex T n (Topic)
3592 @findex gnus-topic-create-topic
3593 Prompt for a new topic name and create it
3594 (@code{gnus-topic-create-topic}).
3595
3596 @item T TAB
3597 @itemx TAB
3598 @kindex T TAB (Topic)
3599 @kindex TAB (Topic)
3600 @findex gnus-topic-indent
3601 ``Indent'' the current topic so that it becomes a sub-topic of the
3602 previous topic (@code{gnus-topic-indent}). If given a prefix,
3603 ``un-indent'' the topic instead.
3604
3605 @item M-TAB
3606 @kindex M-TAB (Topic)
3607 @findex gnus-topic-unindent
3608 ``Un-indent'' the current topic so that it becomes a sub-topic of the
3609 parent of its current parent (@code{gnus-topic-unindent}).
3610
3611 @end table
3612
3613 The following two keys can be used to move groups and topics around.
3614 They work like the well-known cut and paste. @kbd{C-k} is like cut and
3615 @kbd{C-y} is like paste. Of course, this being Emacs, we use the terms
3616 kill and yank rather than cut and paste.
3617
3618 @table @kbd
3619
3620 @item C-k
3621 @kindex C-k (Topic)
3622 @findex gnus-topic-kill-group
3623 Kill a group or topic (@code{gnus-topic-kill-group}). All groups in the
3624 topic will be removed along with the topic.
3625
3626 @item C-y
3627 @kindex C-y (Topic)
3628 @findex gnus-topic-yank-group
3629 Yank the previously killed group or topic
3630 (@code{gnus-topic-yank-group}). Note that all topics will be yanked
3631 before all groups.
3632
3633 So, to move a topic to the beginning of the list of topics, just hit
3634 @kbd{C-k} on it. This is like the ``cut'' part of cut and paste. Then,
3635 move the cursor to the beginning of the buffer (just below the ``Gnus''
3636 topic) and hit @kbd{C-y}. This is like the ``paste'' part of cut and
3637 paste. Like I said -- E-Z.
3638
3639 You can use @kbd{C-k} and @kbd{C-y} on groups as well as on topics. So
3640 you can move topics around as well as groups.
3641
3642 @end table
3643
3644 After setting up the topics the way you like them, you might wish to
3645 hide a topic, or to show it again. That's why we have the following
3646 key.
3647
3648 @table @kbd
3649
3650 @item RET
3651 @kindex RET (Topic)
3652 @findex gnus-topic-select-group
3653 @itemx SPACE
3654 Either select a group or fold a topic (@code{gnus-topic-select-group}).
3655 When you perform this command on a group, you'll enter the group, as
3656 usual. When done on a topic line, the topic will be folded (if it was
3657 visible) or unfolded (if it was folded already). So it's basically a
3658 toggling command on topics. In addition, if you give a numerical
3659 prefix, group on that level (and lower) will be displayed.
3660
3661 @end table
3662
3663 Now for a list of other commands, in no particular order.
3664
3665 @table @kbd
3666
3667 @item T m
3668 @kindex T m (Topic)
3669 @findex gnus-topic-move-group
3670 Move the current group to some other topic
3671 (@code{gnus-topic-move-group}). This command uses the process/prefix
3672 convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
3673
3674 @item T j
3675 @kindex T j (Topic)
3676 @findex gnus-topic-jump-to-topic
3677 Go to a topic (@code{gnus-topic-jump-to-topic}).
3678
3679 @item T c
3680 @kindex T c (Topic)
3681 @findex gnus-topic-copy-group
3682 Copy the current group to some other topic
3683 (@code{gnus-topic-copy-group}). This command uses the process/prefix
3684 convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
3685
3686 @item T h
3687 @kindex T h (Topic)
3688 @findex gnus-topic-hide-topic
3689 Hide the current topic (@code{gnus-topic-hide-topic}). If given
3690 a prefix, hide the topic permanently.
3691
3692 @item T s
3693 @kindex T s (Topic)
3694 @findex gnus-topic-show-topic
3695 Show the current topic (@code{gnus-topic-show-topic}). If given
3696 a prefix, show the topic permanently.
3697
3698 @item T D
3699 @kindex T D (Topic)
3700 @findex gnus-topic-remove-group
3701 Remove a group from the current topic (@code{gnus-topic-remove-group}).
3702 This command is mainly useful if you have the same group in several
3703 topics and wish to remove it from one of the topics. You may also
3704 remove a group from all topics, but in that case, Gnus will add it to
3705 the root topic the next time you start Gnus. In fact, all new groups
3706 (which, naturally, don't belong to any topic) will show up in the root
3707 topic.
3708
3709 This command uses the process/prefix convention
3710 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
3711
3712 @item T M
3713 @kindex T M (Topic)
3714 @findex gnus-topic-move-matching
3715 Move all groups that match some regular expression to a topic
3716 (@code{gnus-topic-move-matching}).
3717
3718 @item T C
3719 @kindex T C (Topic)
3720 @findex gnus-topic-copy-matching
3721 Copy all groups that match some regular expression to a topic
3722 (@code{gnus-topic-copy-matching}).
3723
3724 @item T H
3725 @kindex T H (Topic)
3726 @findex gnus-topic-toggle-display-empty-topics
3727 Toggle hiding empty topics
3728 (@code{gnus-topic-toggle-display-empty-topics}).
3729
3730 @item T #
3731 @kindex T # (Topic)
3732 @findex gnus-topic-mark-topic
3733 Mark all groups in the current topic with the process mark
3734 (@code{gnus-topic-mark-topic}). This command works recursively on
3735 sub-topics unless given a prefix.
3736
3737 @item T M-#
3738 @kindex T M-# (Topic)
3739 @findex gnus-topic-unmark-topic
3740 Remove the process mark from all groups in the current topic
3741 (@code{gnus-topic-unmark-topic}). This command works recursively on
3742 sub-topics unless given a prefix.
3743
3744 @item C-c C-x
3745 @kindex C-c C-x (Topic)
3746 @findex gnus-topic-expire-articles
3747 Run all expirable articles in the current group or topic through the
3748 expiry process (if any)
3749 (@code{gnus-topic-expire-articles}). (@pxref{Expiring Mail}).
3750
3751 @item T r
3752 @kindex T r (Topic)
3753 @findex gnus-topic-rename
3754 Rename a topic (@code{gnus-topic-rename}).
3755
3756 @item T DEL
3757 @kindex T DEL (Topic)
3758 @findex gnus-topic-delete
3759 Delete an empty topic (@code{gnus-topic-delete}).
3760
3761 @item A T
3762 @kindex A T (Topic)
3763 @findex gnus-topic-list-active
3764 List all groups that Gnus knows about in a topics-ified way
3765 (@code{gnus-topic-list-active}).
3766
3767 @item T M-n
3768 @kindex T M-n (Topic)
3769 @findex gnus-topic-goto-next-topic
3770 Go to the next topic (@code{gnus-topic-goto-next-topic}).
3771
3772 @item T M-p
3773 @kindex T M-p (Topic)
3774 @findex gnus-topic-goto-previous-topic
3775 Go to the next topic (@code{gnus-topic-goto-previous-topic}).
3776
3777 @item G p
3778 @kindex G p (Topic)
3779 @findex gnus-topic-edit-parameters
3780 @cindex group parameters
3781 @cindex topic parameters
3782 @cindex parameters
3783 Edit the topic parameters (@code{gnus-topic-edit-parameters}).
3784 @xref{Topic Parameters}.
3785
3786 @end table
3787
3788
3789 @node Topic Variables
3790 @subsection Topic Variables
3791 @cindex topic variables
3792
3793 The previous section told you how to tell Gnus which topics to display.
3794 This section explains how to tell Gnus what to display about each topic.
3795
3796 @vindex gnus-topic-line-format
3797 The topic lines themselves are created according to the
3798 @code{gnus-topic-line-format} variable (@pxref{Formatting Variables}).
3799 Valid elements are:
3800
3801 @table @samp
3802 @item i
3803 Indentation.
3804 @item n
3805 Topic name.
3806 @item v
3807 Visibility.
3808 @item l
3809 Level.
3810 @item g
3811 Number of groups in the topic.
3812 @item a
3813 Number of unread articles in the topic.
3814 @item A
3815 Number of unread articles in the topic and all its subtopics.
3816 @end table
3817
3818 @vindex gnus-topic-indent-level
3819 Each sub-topic (and the groups in the sub-topics) will be indented with
3820 @code{gnus-topic-indent-level} times the topic level number of spaces.
3821 The default is 2.
3822
3823 @vindex gnus-topic-mode-hook
3824 @code{gnus-topic-mode-hook} is called in topic minor mode buffers.
3825
3826 @vindex gnus-topic-display-empty-topics
3827 The @code{gnus-topic-display-empty-topics} says whether to display even
3828 topics that have no unread articles in them. The default is @code{t}.
3829
3830
3831 @node Topic Sorting
3832 @subsection Topic Sorting
3833 @cindex topic sorting
3834
3835 You can sort the groups in each topic individually with the following
3836 commands:
3837
3838
3839 @table @kbd
3840 @item T S a
3841 @kindex T S a (Topic)
3842 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-alphabet
3843 Sort the current topic alphabetically by group name
3844 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-alphabet}).
3845
3846 @item T S u
3847 @kindex T S u (Topic)
3848 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-unread
3849 Sort the current topic by the number of unread articles
3850 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-unread}).
3851
3852 @item T S l
3853 @kindex T S l (Topic)
3854 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-level
3855 Sort the current topic by group level
3856 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-level}).
3857
3858 @item T S v
3859 @kindex T S v (Topic)
3860 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-score
3861 Sort the current topic by group score
3862 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-score}). @xref{Group Score}.
3863
3864 @item T S r
3865 @kindex T S r (Topic)
3866 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-rank
3867 Sort the current topic by group rank
3868 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-rank}). @xref{Group Score}.
3869
3870 @item T S m
3871 @kindex T S m (Topic)
3872 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-method
3873 Sort the current topic alphabetically by back end name
3874 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-method}).
3875
3876 @item T S e
3877 @kindex T S e (Topic)
3878 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-server
3879 Sort the current topic alphabetically by server name
3880 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-server}).
3881
3882 @item T S s
3883 @kindex T S s (Topic)
3884 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups
3885 Sort the current topic according to the function(s) given by the
3886 @code{gnus-group-sort-function} variable
3887 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups}).
3888
3889 @end table
3890
3891 When given a prefix argument, all these commands will sort in reverse
3892 order. @xref{Sorting Groups}, for more information about group
3893 sorting.
3894
3895
3896 @node Topic Topology
3897 @subsection Topic Topology
3898 @cindex topic topology
3899 @cindex topology
3900
3901 So, let's have a look at an example group buffer:
3902
3903 @example
3904 @group
3905 Gnus
3906 Emacs -- I wuw it!
3907 3: comp.emacs
3908 2: alt.religion.emacs
3909 Naughty Emacs
3910 452: alt.sex.emacs
3911 0: comp.talk.emacs.recovery
3912 Misc
3913 8: comp.binaries.fractals
3914 13: comp.sources.unix
3915 @end group
3916 @end example
3917
3918 So, here we have one top-level topic (@samp{Gnus}), two topics under
3919 that, and one sub-topic under one of the sub-topics. (There is always
3920 just one (1) top-level topic). This topology can be expressed as
3921 follows:
3922
3923 @lisp
3924 (("Gnus" visible)
3925 (("Emacs -- I wuw it!" visible)
3926 (("Naughty Emacs" visible)))
3927 (("Misc" visible)))
3928 @end lisp
3929
3930 @vindex gnus-topic-topology
3931 This is in fact how the variable @code{gnus-topic-topology} would look
3932 for the display above. That variable is saved in the @file{.newsrc.eld}
3933 file, and shouldn't be messed with manually---unless you really want
3934 to. Since this variable is read from the @file{.newsrc.eld} file,
3935 setting it in any other startup files will have no effect.
3936
3937 This topology shows what topics are sub-topics of what topics (right),
3938 and which topics are visible. Two settings are currently
3939 allowed---@code{visible} and @code{invisible}.
3940
3941
3942 @node Topic Parameters
3943 @subsection Topic Parameters
3944 @cindex topic parameters
3945
3946 All groups in a topic will inherit group parameters from the parent
3947 (and ancestor) topic parameters. All valid group parameters are valid
3948 topic parameters (@pxref{Group Parameters}). When the agent is
3949 enabled, all agent parameters (See Agent Parameters in @ref{Category
3950 Syntax}) are also valid topic parameters.
3951
3952 In addition, the following parameters are only valid as topic
3953 parameters:
3954
3955 @table @code
3956 @item subscribe
3957 When subscribing new groups by topic (@pxref{Subscription Methods}), the
3958 @code{subscribe} topic parameter says what groups go in what topic. Its
3959 value should be a regexp to match the groups that should go in that
3960 topic.
3961
3962 @item subscribe-level
3963 When subscribing new groups by topic (see the @code{subscribe} parameter),
3964 the group will be subscribed with the level specified in the
3965 @code{subscribe-level} instead of @code{gnus-level-default-subscribed}.
3966
3967 @end table
3968
3969 Group parameters (of course) override topic parameters, and topic
3970 parameters in sub-topics override topic parameters in super-topics. You
3971 know. Normal inheritance rules. (@dfn{Rules} is here a noun, not a
3972 verb, although you may feel free to disagree with me here.)
3973
3974 @example
3975 @group
3976 Gnus
3977 Emacs
3978 3: comp.emacs
3979 2: alt.religion.emacs
3980 452: alt.sex.emacs
3981 Relief
3982 452: alt.sex.emacs
3983 0: comp.talk.emacs.recovery
3984 Misc
3985 8: comp.binaries.fractals
3986 13: comp.sources.unix
3987 452: alt.sex.emacs
3988 @end group
3989 @end example
3990
3991 The @samp{Emacs} topic has the topic parameter @code{(score-file
3992 . "emacs.SCORE")}; the @samp{Relief} topic has the topic parameter
3993 @code{(score-file . "relief.SCORE")}; and the @samp{Misc} topic has the
3994 topic parameter @code{(score-file . "emacs.SCORE")}. In addition,
3995 @* @samp{alt.religion.emacs} has the group parameter @code{(score-file
3996 . "religion.SCORE")}.
3997
3998 Now, when you enter @samp{alt.sex.emacs} in the @samp{Relief} topic, you
3999 will get the @file{relief.SCORE} home score file. If you enter the same
4000 group in the @samp{Emacs} topic, you'll get the @file{emacs.SCORE} home
4001 score file. If you enter the group @samp{alt.religion.emacs}, you'll
4002 get the @file{religion.SCORE} home score file.
4003
4004 This seems rather simple and self-evident, doesn't it? Well, yes. But
4005 there are some problems, especially with the @code{total-expiry}
4006 parameter. Say you have a mail group in two topics; one with
4007 @code{total-expiry} and one without. What happens when you do @kbd{M-x
4008 gnus-expire-all-expirable-groups}? Gnus has no way of telling which one
4009 of these topics you mean to expire articles from, so anything may
4010 happen. In fact, I hereby declare that it is @dfn{undefined} what
4011 happens. You just have to be careful if you do stuff like that.
4012
4013
4014 @node Misc Group Stuff
4015 @section Misc Group Stuff
4016
4017 @menu
4018 * Scanning New Messages:: Asking Gnus to see whether new messages have arrived.
4019 * Group Information:: Information and help on groups and Gnus.
4020 * Group Timestamp:: Making Gnus keep track of when you last read a group.
4021 * File Commands:: Reading and writing the Gnus files.
4022 * Sieve Commands:: Managing Sieve scripts.
4023 @end menu
4024
4025 @table @kbd
4026
4027 @item ^
4028 @kindex ^ (Group)
4029 @findex gnus-group-enter-server-mode
4030 Enter the server buffer (@code{gnus-group-enter-server-mode}).
4031 @xref{Server Buffer}.
4032
4033 @item a
4034 @kindex a (Group)
4035 @findex gnus-group-post-news
4036 Start composing a message (a news by default)
4037 (@code{gnus-group-post-news}). If given a prefix, post to the group
4038 under the point. If the prefix is 1, prompt for a group to post to.
4039 Contrary to what the name of this function suggests, the prepared
4040 article might be a mail instead of a news, if a mail group is specified
4041 with the prefix argument. @xref{Composing Messages}.
4042
4043 @item m
4044 @kindex m (Group)
4045 @findex gnus-group-mail
4046 Mail a message somewhere (@code{gnus-group-mail}). If given a prefix,
4047 use the posting style of the group under the point. If the prefix is 1,
4048 prompt for a group name to find the posting style.
4049 @xref{Composing Messages}.
4050
4051 @item i
4052 @kindex i (Group)
4053 @findex gnus-group-news
4054 Start composing a news (@code{gnus-group-news}). If given a prefix,
4055 post to the group under the point. If the prefix is 1, prompt
4056 for group to post to. @xref{Composing Messages}.
4057
4058 This function actually prepares a news even when using mail groups.
4059 This is useful for ``posting'' messages to mail groups without actually
4060 sending them over the network: they're just saved directly to the group
4061 in question. The corresponding back end must have a request-post method
4062 for this to work though.
4063
4064 @end table
4065
4066 Variables for the group buffer:
4067
4068 @table @code
4069
4070 @item gnus-group-mode-hook
4071 @vindex gnus-group-mode-hook
4072 is called after the group buffer has been
4073 created.
4074
4075 @item gnus-group-prepare-hook
4076 @vindex gnus-group-prepare-hook
4077 is called after the group buffer is
4078 generated. It may be used to modify the buffer in some strange,
4079 unnatural way.
4080
4081 @item gnus-group-prepared-hook
4082 @vindex gnus-group-prepare-hook
4083 is called as the very last thing after the group buffer has been
4084 generated. It may be used to move point around, for instance.
4085
4086 @item gnus-permanently-visible-groups
4087 @vindex gnus-permanently-visible-groups
4088 Groups matching this regexp will always be listed in the group buffer,
4089 whether they are empty or not.
4090
4091 @item gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist
4092 @vindex gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist
4093 An alist of method and the charset for group names. It is used to show
4094 non-@acronym{ASCII} group names.
4095
4096 For example:
4097 @lisp
4098 (setq gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist
4099 '(((nntp "news.com.cn") . cn-gb-2312)))
4100 @end lisp
4101
4102 @item gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist
4103 @cindex UTF-8 group names
4104 @vindex gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist
4105 An alist of regexp of group name and the charset for group names. It
4106 is used to show non-@acronym{ASCII} group names. @code{((".*"
4107 utf-8))} is the default value if UTF-8 is supported, otherwise the
4108 default is @code{nil}.
4109
4110 For example:
4111 @lisp
4112 (setq gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist
4113 '(("\\.com\\.cn:" . cn-gb-2312)))
4114 @end lisp
4115
4116 @end table
4117
4118 @node Scanning New Messages
4119 @subsection Scanning New Messages
4120 @cindex new messages
4121 @cindex scanning new news
4122
4123 @table @kbd
4124
4125 @item g
4126 @kindex g (Group)
4127 @findex gnus-group-get-new-news
4128 @c @icon{gnus-group-get-new-news}
4129 Check the server(s) for new articles. If the numerical prefix is used,
4130 this command will check only groups of level @var{arg} and lower
4131 (@code{gnus-group-get-new-news}). If given a non-numerical prefix, this
4132 command will force a total re-reading of the active file(s) from the
4133 back end(s).
4134
4135 @item M-g
4136 @kindex M-g (Group)
4137 @findex gnus-group-get-new-news-this-group
4138 @vindex gnus-goto-next-group-when-activating
4139 @c @icon{gnus-group-get-new-news-this-group}
4140 Check whether new articles have arrived in the current group
4141 (@code{gnus-group-get-new-news-this-group}).
4142 @code{gnus-goto-next-group-when-activating} says whether this command is
4143 to move point to the next group or not. It is @code{t} by default.
4144
4145 @findex gnus-activate-all-groups
4146 @cindex activating groups
4147 @item C-c M-g
4148 @kindex C-c M-g (Group)
4149 Activate absolutely all groups (@code{gnus-activate-all-groups}).
4150
4151 @item R
4152 @kindex R (Group)
4153 @cindex restarting
4154 @findex gnus-group-restart
4155 Restart Gnus (@code{gnus-group-restart}). This saves the @file{.newsrc}
4156 file(s), closes the connection to all servers, clears up all run-time
4157 Gnus variables, and then starts Gnus all over again.
4158
4159 @end table
4160
4161 @vindex gnus-get-new-news-hook
4162 @code{gnus-get-new-news-hook} is run just before checking for new news.
4163
4164 @vindex gnus-after-getting-new-news-hook
4165 @code{gnus-after-getting-new-news-hook} is run after checking for new
4166 news.
4167
4168
4169 @node Group Information
4170 @subsection Group Information
4171 @cindex group information
4172 @cindex information on groups
4173
4174 @table @kbd
4175
4176
4177 @item H f
4178 @kindex H f (Group)
4179 @findex gnus-group-fetch-faq
4180 @vindex gnus-group-faq-directory
4181 @cindex FAQ
4182 @cindex ange-ftp
4183 Try to fetch the @acronym{FAQ} for the current group
4184 (@code{gnus-group-fetch-faq}). Gnus will try to get the @acronym{FAQ}
4185 from @code{gnus-group-faq-directory}, which is usually a directory on
4186 a remote machine. This variable can also be a list of directories.
4187 In that case, giving a prefix to this command will allow you to choose
4188 between the various sites. @code{ange-ftp} (or @code{efs}) will be
4189 used for fetching the file.
4190
4191 If fetching from the first site is unsuccessful, Gnus will attempt to go
4192 through @code{gnus-group-faq-directory} and try to open them one by one.
4193
4194 @item H c
4195 @kindex H c (Group)
4196 @findex gnus-group-fetch-charter
4197 @vindex gnus-group-charter-alist
4198 @cindex charter
4199 Try to open the charter for the current group in a web browser
4200 (@code{gnus-group-fetch-charter}). Query for a group if given a
4201 prefix argument.
4202
4203 Gnus will use @code{gnus-group-charter-alist} to find the location of
4204 the charter. If no location is known, Gnus will fetch the control
4205 messages for the group, which in some cases includes the charter.
4206
4207 @item H C
4208 @kindex H C (Group)
4209 @findex gnus-group-fetch-control
4210 @vindex gnus-group-fetch-control-use-browse-url
4211 @cindex control message
4212 Fetch the control messages for the group from the archive at
4213 @code{ftp.isc.org} (@code{gnus-group-fetch-control}). Query for a
4214 group if given a prefix argument.
4215
4216 If @code{gnus-group-fetch-control-use-browse-url} is non-@code{nil},
4217 Gnus will open the control messages in a browser using
4218 @code{browse-url}. Otherwise they are fetched using @code{ange-ftp}
4219 and displayed in an ephemeral group.
4220
4221 Note that the control messages are compressed. To use this command
4222 you need to turn on @code{auto-compression-mode} (@pxref{Compressed
4223 Files, ,Compressed Files, emacs, The Emacs Manual}).
4224
4225 @item H d
4226 @itemx C-c C-d
4227 @c @icon{gnus-group-describe-group}
4228 @kindex H d (Group)
4229 @kindex C-c C-d (Group)
4230 @cindex describing groups
4231 @cindex group description
4232 @findex gnus-group-describe-group
4233 Describe the current group (@code{gnus-group-describe-group}). If given
4234 a prefix, force Gnus to re-read the description from the server.
4235
4236 @item M-d
4237 @kindex M-d (Group)
4238 @findex gnus-group-describe-all-groups
4239 Describe all groups (@code{gnus-group-describe-all-groups}). If given a
4240 prefix, force Gnus to re-read the description file from the server.
4241
4242 @item H v
4243 @itemx V
4244 @kindex V (Group)
4245 @kindex H v (Group)
4246 @cindex version
4247 @findex gnus-version
4248 Display current Gnus version numbers (@code{gnus-version}).
4249
4250 @item ?
4251 @kindex ? (Group)
4252 @findex gnus-group-describe-briefly
4253 Give a very short help message (@code{gnus-group-describe-briefly}).
4254
4255 @item C-c C-i
4256 @kindex C-c C-i (Group)
4257 @cindex info
4258 @cindex manual
4259 @findex gnus-info-find-node
4260 Go to the Gnus info node (@code{gnus-info-find-node}).
4261 @end table
4262
4263
4264 @node Group Timestamp
4265 @subsection Group Timestamp
4266 @cindex timestamps
4267 @cindex group timestamps
4268
4269 It can be convenient to let Gnus keep track of when you last read a
4270 group. To set the ball rolling, you should add
4271 @code{gnus-group-set-timestamp} to @code{gnus-select-group-hook}:
4272
4273 @lisp
4274 (add-hook 'gnus-select-group-hook 'gnus-group-set-timestamp)
4275 @end lisp
4276
4277 After doing this, each time you enter a group, it'll be recorded.
4278
4279 This information can be displayed in various ways---the easiest is to
4280 use the @samp{%d} spec in the group line format:
4281
4282 @lisp
4283 (setq gnus-group-line-format
4284 "%M\%S\%p\%P\%5y: %(%-40,40g%) %d\n")
4285 @end lisp
4286
4287 This will result in lines looking like:
4288
4289 @example
4290 * 0: mail.ding 19961002T012943
4291 0: custom 19961002T012713
4292 @end example
4293
4294 As you can see, the date is displayed in compact ISO 8601 format. This
4295 may be a bit too much, so to just display the date, you could say
4296 something like:
4297
4298 @lisp
4299 (setq gnus-group-line-format
4300 "%M\%S\%p\%P\%5y: %(%-40,40g%) %6,6~(cut 2)d\n")
4301 @end lisp
4302
4303 If you would like greater control of the time format, you can use a
4304 user-defined format spec. Something like the following should do the
4305 trick:
4306
4307 @lisp
4308 (setq gnus-group-line-format
4309 "%M\%S\%p\%P\%5y: %(%-40,40g%) %ud\n")
4310 (defun gnus-user-format-function-d (headers)
4311 (let ((time (gnus-group-timestamp gnus-tmp-group)))
4312 (if time
4313 (format-time-string "%b %d %H:%M" time)
4314 "")))
4315 @end lisp
4316
4317
4318 @node File Commands
4319 @subsection File Commands
4320 @cindex file commands
4321
4322 @table @kbd
4323
4324 @item r
4325 @kindex r (Group)
4326 @findex gnus-group-read-init-file
4327 @vindex gnus-init-file
4328 @cindex reading init file
4329 Re-read the init file (@code{gnus-init-file}, which defaults to
4330 @file{~/.gnus.el}) (@code{gnus-group-read-init-file}).
4331
4332 @item s
4333 @kindex s (Group)
4334 @findex gnus-group-save-newsrc
4335 @cindex saving .newsrc
4336 Save the @file{.newsrc.eld} file (and @file{.newsrc} if wanted)
4337 (@code{gnus-group-save-newsrc}). If given a prefix, force saving the
4338 file(s) whether Gnus thinks it is necessary or not.
4339
4340 @c @item Z
4341 @c @kindex Z (Group)
4342 @c @findex gnus-group-clear-dribble
4343 @c Clear the dribble buffer (@code{gnus-group-clear-dribble}).
4344
4345 @end table
4346
4347
4348 @node Sieve Commands
4349 @subsection Sieve Commands
4350 @cindex group sieve commands
4351
4352 Sieve is a server-side mail filtering language. In Gnus you can use
4353 the @code{sieve} group parameter (@pxref{Group Parameters}) to specify
4354 sieve rules that should apply to each group. Gnus provides two
4355 commands to translate all these group parameters into a proper Sieve
4356 script that can be transfered to the server somehow.
4357
4358 @vindex gnus-sieve-file
4359 @vindex gnus-sieve-region-start
4360 @vindex gnus-sieve-region-end
4361 The generated Sieve script is placed in @code{gnus-sieve-file} (by
4362 default @file{~/.sieve}). The Sieve code that Gnus generate is placed
4363 between two delimiters, @code{gnus-sieve-region-start} and
4364 @code{gnus-sieve-region-end}, so you may write additional Sieve code
4365 outside these delimiters that will not be removed the next time you
4366 regenerate the Sieve script.
4367
4368 @vindex gnus-sieve-crosspost
4369 The variable @code{gnus-sieve-crosspost} controls how the Sieve script
4370 is generated. If it is non-@code{nil} (the default) articles is
4371 placed in all groups that have matching rules, otherwise the article
4372 is only placed in the group with the first matching rule. For
4373 example, the group parameter @samp{(sieve address "sender"
4374 "owner-ding@@hpc.uh.edu")} will generate the following piece of Sieve
4375 code if @code{gnus-sieve-crosspost} is @code{nil}. (When
4376 @code{gnus-sieve-crosspost} is non-@code{nil}, it looks the same
4377 except that the line containing the call to @code{stop} is removed.)
4378
4379 @example
4380 if address "sender" "owner-ding@@hpc.uh.edu" @{
4381 fileinto "INBOX.ding";
4382 stop;
4383 @}
4384 @end example
4385
4386 @xref{Top, Emacs Sieve, Top, sieve, Emacs Sieve}.
4387
4388 @table @kbd
4389
4390 @item D g
4391 @kindex D g (Group)
4392 @findex gnus-sieve-generate
4393 @vindex gnus-sieve-file
4394 @cindex generating sieve script
4395 Regenerate a Sieve script from the @code{sieve} group parameters and
4396 put you into the @code{gnus-sieve-file} without saving it.
4397
4398 @item D u
4399 @kindex D u (Group)
4400 @findex gnus-sieve-update
4401 @vindex gnus-sieve-file
4402 @cindex updating sieve script
4403 Regenerates the Gnus managed part of @code{gnus-sieve-file} using the
4404 @code{sieve} group parameters, save the file and upload it to the
4405 server using the @code{sieveshell} program.
4406
4407 @end table
4408
4409
4410 @node Summary Buffer
4411 @chapter Summary Buffer
4412 @cindex summary buffer
4413
4414 A line for each article is displayed in the summary buffer. You can
4415 move around, read articles, post articles and reply to articles.
4416
4417 The most common way to a summary buffer is to select a group from the
4418 group buffer (@pxref{Selecting a Group}).
4419
4420 You can have as many summary buffers open as you wish.
4421
4422 @menu
4423 * Summary Buffer Format:: Deciding how the summary buffer is to look.
4424 * Summary Maneuvering:: Moving around the summary buffer.
4425 * Choosing Articles:: Reading articles.
4426 * Paging the Article:: Scrolling the current article.
4427 * Reply Followup and Post:: Posting articles.
4428 * Delayed Articles:: Send articles at a later time.
4429 * Marking Articles:: Marking articles as read, expirable, etc.
4430 * Limiting:: You can limit the summary buffer.
4431 * Threading:: How threads are made.
4432 * Sorting the Summary Buffer:: How articles and threads are sorted.
4433 * Asynchronous Fetching:: Gnus might be able to pre-fetch articles.
4434 * Article Caching:: You may store articles in a cache.
4435 * Persistent Articles:: Making articles expiry-resistant.
4436 * Article Backlog:: Having already read articles hang around.
4437 * Saving Articles:: Ways of customizing article saving.
4438 * Decoding Articles:: Gnus can treat series of (uu)encoded articles.
4439 * Article Treatment:: The article buffer can be mangled at will.
4440 * MIME Commands:: Doing MIMEy things with the articles.
4441 * Charsets:: Character set issues.
4442 * Article Commands:: Doing various things with the article buffer.
4443 * Summary Sorting:: Sorting the summary buffer in various ways.
4444 * Finding the Parent:: No child support? Get the parent.
4445 * Alternative Approaches:: Reading using non-default summaries.
4446 * Tree Display:: A more visual display of threads.
4447 * Mail Group Commands:: Some commands can only be used in mail groups.
4448 * Various Summary Stuff:: What didn't fit anywhere else.
4449 * Exiting the Summary Buffer:: Returning to the Group buffer,
4450 or reselecting the current group.
4451 * Crosspost Handling:: How crossposted articles are dealt with.
4452 * Duplicate Suppression:: An alternative when crosspost handling fails.
4453 * Security:: Decrypt and Verify.
4454 * Mailing List:: Mailing list minor mode.
4455 @end menu
4456
4457
4458 @node Summary Buffer Format
4459 @section Summary Buffer Format
4460 @cindex summary buffer format
4461
4462 @iftex
4463 @iflatex
4464 \gnusfigure{The Summary Buffer}{180}{
4465 \put(0,0){\epsfig{figure=ps/summary,width=7.5cm}}
4466 \put(445,0){\makebox(0,0)[br]{\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-article,width=7.5cm}}}
4467 }
4468 @end iflatex
4469 @end iftex
4470
4471 @menu
4472 * Summary Buffer Lines:: You can specify how summary lines should look.
4473 * To From Newsgroups:: How to not display your own name.
4474 * Summary Buffer Mode Line:: You can say how the mode line should look.
4475 * Summary Highlighting:: Making the summary buffer all pretty and nice.
4476 @end menu
4477
4478 @findex mail-extract-address-components
4479 @findex gnus-extract-address-components
4480 @vindex gnus-extract-address-components
4481 Gnus will use the value of the @code{gnus-extract-address-components}
4482 variable as a function for getting the name and address parts of a
4483 @code{From} header. Two pre-defined functions exist:
4484 @code{gnus-extract-address-components}, which is the default, quite
4485 fast, and too simplistic solution; and
4486 @code{mail-extract-address-components}, which works very nicely, but is
4487 slower. The default function will return the wrong answer in 5% of the
4488 cases. If this is unacceptable to you, use the other function instead:
4489
4490 @lisp
4491 (setq gnus-extract-address-components
4492 'mail-extract-address-components)
4493 @end lisp
4494
4495 @vindex gnus-summary-same-subject
4496 @code{gnus-summary-same-subject} is a string indicating that the current
4497 article has the same subject as the previous. This string will be used
4498 with those specs that require it. The default is @code{""}.
4499
4500
4501 @node Summary Buffer Lines
4502 @subsection Summary Buffer Lines
4503
4504 @vindex gnus-summary-line-format
4505 You can change the format of the lines in the summary buffer by changing
4506 the @code{gnus-summary-line-format} variable. It works along the same
4507 lines as a normal @code{format} string, with some extensions
4508 (@pxref{Formatting Variables}).
4509
4510 There should always be a colon or a point position marker on the line;
4511 the cursor always moves to the point position marker or the colon after
4512 performing an operation. (Of course, Gnus wouldn't be Gnus if it wasn't
4513 possible to change this. Just write a new function
4514 @code{gnus-goto-colon} which does whatever you like with the cursor.)
4515 @xref{Positioning Point}.
4516
4517 The default string is @samp{%U%R%z%I%(%[%4L: %-23,23f%]%) %s\n}.
4518
4519 The following format specification characters and extended format
4520 specification(s) are understood:
4521
4522 @table @samp
4523 @item N
4524 Article number.
4525 @item S
4526 Subject string. List identifiers stripped,
4527 @code{gnus-list-identifies}. @xref{Article Hiding}.
4528 @item s
4529 Subject if the article is the root of the thread or the previous article
4530 had a different subject, @code{gnus-summary-same-subject} otherwise.
4531 (@code{gnus-summary-same-subject} defaults to @code{""}.)
4532 @item F
4533 Full @code{From} header.
4534 @item n
4535 The name (from the @code{From} header).
4536 @item f
4537 The name, @code{To} header or the @code{Newsgroups} header (@pxref{To
4538 From Newsgroups}).
4539 @item a
4540 The name (from the @code{From} header). This differs from the @code{n}
4541 spec in that it uses the function designated by the
4542 @code{gnus-extract-address-components} variable, which is slower, but
4543 may be more thorough.
4544 @item A
4545 The address (from the @code{From} header). This works the same way as
4546 the @code{a} spec.
4547 @item L
4548 Number of lines in the article.
4549 @item c
4550 Number of characters in the article. This specifier is not supported
4551 in some methods (like nnfolder).
4552 @item k
4553 Pretty-printed version of the number of characters in the article;
4554 for example, @samp{1.2k} or @samp{0.4M}.
4555 @item I
4556 Indentation based on thread level (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).
4557 @item B
4558 A complex trn-style thread tree, showing response-connecting trace
4559 lines. A thread could be drawn like this:
4560
4561 @example
4562 >
4563 +->
4564 | +->
4565 | | \->
4566 | | \->
4567 | \->
4568 +->
4569 \->
4570 @end example
4571
4572 You can customize the appearance with the following options. Note
4573 that it is possible to make the thread display look really neat by
4574 replacing the default @acronym{ASCII} characters with graphic
4575 line-drawing glyphs.
4576 @table @code
4577 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-root
4578 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-root
4579 Used for the root of a thread. If @code{nil}, use subject
4580 instead. The default is @samp{> }.
4581
4582 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-false-root
4583 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-false-root
4584 Used for the false root of a thread (@pxref{Loose Threads}). If
4585 @code{nil}, use subject instead. The default is @samp{> }.
4586
4587 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-single-indent
4588 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-single-indent
4589 Used for a thread with just one message. If @code{nil}, use subject
4590 instead. The default is @samp{}.
4591
4592 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-vertical
4593 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-vertical
4594 Used for drawing a vertical line. The default is @samp{| }.
4595
4596 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-indent
4597 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-indent
4598 Used for indenting. The default is @samp{ }.
4599
4600 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-leaf-with-other
4601 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-leaf-with-other
4602 Used for a leaf with brothers. The default is @samp{+-> }.
4603
4604 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-single-leaf
4605 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-single-leaf
4606 Used for a leaf without brothers. The default is @samp{\-> }
4607
4608 @end table
4609
4610 @item T
4611 Nothing if the article is a root and lots of spaces if it isn't (it
4612 pushes everything after it off the screen).
4613 @item [
4614 Opening bracket, which is normally @samp{[}, but can also be @samp{<}
4615 for adopted articles (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).
4616 @item ]
4617 Closing bracket, which is normally @samp{]}, but can also be @samp{>}
4618 for adopted articles.
4619 @item >
4620 One space for each thread level.
4621 @item <
4622 Twenty minus thread level spaces.
4623 @item U
4624 Unread. @xref{Read Articles}.
4625
4626 @item R
4627 This misleadingly named specifier is the @dfn{secondary mark}. This
4628 mark will say whether the article has been replied to, has been cached,
4629 or has been saved. @xref{Other Marks}.
4630
4631 @item i
4632 Score as a number (@pxref{Scoring}).
4633 @item z
4634 @vindex gnus-summary-zcore-fuzz
4635 Zcore, @samp{+} if above the default level and @samp{-} if below the
4636 default level. If the difference between
4637 @code{gnus-summary-default-score} and the score is less than
4638 @code{gnus-summary-zcore-fuzz}, this spec will not be used.
4639 @item V
4640 Total thread score.
4641 @item x
4642 @code{Xref}.
4643 @item D
4644 @code{Date}.
4645 @item d
4646 The @code{Date} in @code{DD-MMM} format.
4647 @item o
4648 The @code{Date} in @var{YYYYMMDD}@code{T}@var{HHMMSS} format.
4649 @item M
4650 @code{Message-ID}.
4651 @item r
4652 @code{References}.
4653 @item t
4654 Number of articles in the current sub-thread. Using this spec will slow
4655 down summary buffer generation somewhat.
4656 @item e
4657 An @samp{=} (@code{gnus-not-empty-thread-mark}) will be displayed if the
4658 article has any children.
4659 @item P
4660 The line number.
4661 @item O
4662 Download mark.
4663 @item &user-date;
4664 Age sensitive date format. Various date format is defined in
4665 @code{gnus-user-date-format-alist}.
4666 @item u
4667 User defined specifier. The next character in the format string should
4668 be a letter. Gnus will call the function
4669 @code{gnus-user-format-function-@var{x}}, where @var{x} is the letter
4670 following @samp{%u}. The function will be passed the current header as
4671 argument. The function should return a string, which will be inserted
4672 into the summary just like information from any other summary specifier.
4673 @end table
4674
4675 Text between @samp{%(} and @samp{%)} will be highlighted with
4676 @code{gnus-mouse-face} when the mouse point is placed inside the area.
4677 There can only be one such area.
4678
4679 The @samp{%U} (status), @samp{%R} (replied) and @samp{%z} (zcore) specs
4680 have to be handled with care. For reasons of efficiency, Gnus will
4681 compute what column these characters will end up in, and ``hard-code''
4682 that. This means that it is invalid to have these specs after a
4683 variable-length spec. Well, you might not be arrested, but your summary
4684 buffer will look strange, which is bad enough.
4685
4686 The smart choice is to have these specs as far to the left as possible.
4687 (Isn't that the case with everything, though? But I digress.)
4688
4689 This restriction may disappear in later versions of Gnus.
4690
4691
4692 @node To From Newsgroups
4693 @subsection To From Newsgroups
4694 @cindex To
4695 @cindex Newsgroups
4696
4697 In some groups (particularly in archive groups), the @code{From} header
4698 isn't very interesting, since all the articles there are written by
4699 you. To display the information in the @code{To} or @code{Newsgroups}
4700 headers instead, you need to decide three things: What information to
4701 gather; where to display it; and when to display it.
4702
4703 @enumerate
4704 @item
4705 @vindex gnus-extra-headers
4706 The reading of extra header information is controlled by the
4707 @code{gnus-extra-headers}. This is a list of header symbols. For
4708 instance:
4709
4710 @lisp
4711 (setq gnus-extra-headers
4712 '(To Newsgroups X-Newsreader))
4713 @end lisp
4714
4715 This will result in Gnus trying to obtain these three headers, and
4716 storing it in header structures for later easy retrieval.
4717
4718 @item
4719 @findex gnus-extra-header
4720 The value of these extra headers can be accessed via the
4721 @code{gnus-extra-header} function. Here's a format line spec that will
4722 access the @code{X-Newsreader} header:
4723
4724 @example
4725 "%~(form (gnus-extra-header 'X-Newsreader))@@"
4726 @end example
4727
4728 @item
4729 @vindex gnus-ignored-from-addresses
4730 The @code{gnus-ignored-from-addresses} variable says when the @samp{%f}
4731 summary line spec returns the @code{To}, @code{Newsreader} or
4732 @code{From} header. If this regexp matches the contents of the
4733 @code{From} header, the value of the @code{To} or @code{Newsreader}
4734 headers are used instead.
4735
4736 @end enumerate
4737
4738 @vindex nnmail-extra-headers
4739 A related variable is @code{nnmail-extra-headers}, which controls when
4740 to include extra headers when generating overview (@acronym{NOV}) files.
4741 If you have old overview files, you should regenerate them after
4742 changing this variable, by entering the server buffer using @kbd{^},
4743 and then @kbd{g} on the appropriate mail server (e.g. nnml) to cause
4744 regeneration.
4745
4746 @vindex gnus-summary-line-format
4747 You also have to instruct Gnus to display the data by changing the
4748 @code{%n} spec to the @code{%f} spec in the
4749 @code{gnus-summary-line-format} variable.
4750
4751 In summary, you'd typically put something like the following in
4752 @file{~/.gnus.el}:
4753
4754 @lisp
4755 (setq gnus-extra-headers
4756 '(To Newsgroups))
4757 (setq nnmail-extra-headers gnus-extra-headers)
4758 (setq gnus-summary-line-format
4759 "%U%R%z%I%(%[%4L: %-23,23f%]%) %s\n")
4760 (setq gnus-ignored-from-addresses
4761 "Your Name Here")
4762 @end lisp
4763
4764 (The values listed above are the default values in Gnus. Alter them
4765 to fit your needs.)
4766
4767 A note for news server administrators, or for users who wish to try to
4768 convince their news server administrator to provide some additional
4769 support:
4770
4771 The above is mostly useful for mail groups, where you have control over
4772 the @acronym{NOV} files that are created. However, if you can persuade your
4773 nntp admin to add (in the usual implementation, notably INN):
4774
4775 @example
4776 Newsgroups:full
4777 @end example
4778
4779 to the end of her @file{overview.fmt} file, then you can use that just
4780 as you would the extra headers from the mail groups.
4781
4782
4783 @node Summary Buffer Mode Line
4784 @subsection Summary Buffer Mode Line
4785
4786 @vindex gnus-summary-mode-line-format
4787 You can also change the format of the summary mode bar (@pxref{Mode Line
4788 Formatting}). Set @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format} to whatever you
4789 like. The default is @samp{Gnus: %%b [%A] %Z}.
4790
4791 Here are the elements you can play with:
4792
4793 @table @samp
4794 @item G
4795 Group name.
4796 @item p
4797 Unprefixed group name.
4798 @item A
4799 Current article number.
4800 @item z
4801 Current article score.
4802 @item V
4803 Gnus version.
4804 @item U
4805 Number of unread articles in this group.
4806 @item e
4807 Number of unread articles in this group that aren't displayed in the
4808 summary buffer.
4809 @item Z
4810 A string with the number of unread and unselected articles represented
4811 either as @samp{<%U(+%e) more>} if there are both unread and unselected
4812 articles, and just as @samp{<%U more>} if there are just unread articles
4813 and no unselected ones.
4814 @item g
4815 Shortish group name. For instance, @samp{rec.arts.anime} will be
4816 shortened to @samp{r.a.anime}.
4817 @item S
4818 Subject of the current article.
4819 @item u
4820 User-defined spec (@pxref{User-Defined Specs}).
4821 @item s
4822 Name of the current score file (@pxref{Scoring}).
4823 @item d
4824 Number of dormant articles (@pxref{Unread Articles}).
4825 @item t
4826 Number of ticked articles (@pxref{Unread Articles}).
4827 @item r
4828 Number of articles that have been marked as read in this session.
4829 @item E
4830 Number of articles expunged by the score files.
4831 @end table
4832
4833
4834 @node Summary Highlighting
4835 @subsection Summary Highlighting
4836
4837 @table @code
4838
4839 @item gnus-visual-mark-article-hook
4840 @vindex gnus-visual-mark-article-hook
4841 This hook is run after selecting an article. It is meant to be used for
4842 highlighting the article in some way. It is not run if
4843 @code{gnus-visual} is @code{nil}.
4844
4845 @item gnus-summary-update-hook
4846 @vindex gnus-summary-update-hook
4847 This hook is called when a summary line is changed. It is not run if
4848 @code{gnus-visual} is @code{nil}.
4849
4850 @item gnus-summary-selected-face
4851 @vindex gnus-summary-selected-face
4852 This is the face (or @dfn{font} as some people call it) used to
4853 highlight the current article in the summary buffer.
4854
4855 @item gnus-summary-highlight
4856 @vindex gnus-summary-highlight
4857 Summary lines are highlighted according to this variable, which is a
4858 list where the elements are of the format @code{(@var{form}
4859 . @var{face})}. If you would, for instance, like ticked articles to be
4860 italic and high-scored articles to be bold, you could set this variable
4861 to something like
4862 @lisp
4863 (((eq mark gnus-ticked-mark) . italic)
4864 ((> score default) . bold))
4865 @end lisp
4866 As you may have guessed, if @var{form} returns a non-@code{nil} value,
4867 @var{face} will be applied to the line.
4868 @end table
4869
4870
4871 @node Summary Maneuvering
4872 @section Summary Maneuvering
4873 @cindex summary movement
4874
4875 All the straight movement commands understand the numeric prefix and
4876 behave pretty much as you'd expect.
4877
4878 None of these commands select articles.
4879
4880 @table @kbd
4881 @item G M-n
4882 @itemx M-n
4883 @kindex M-n (Summary)
4884 @kindex G M-n (Summary)
4885 @findex gnus-summary-next-unread-subject
4886 Go to the next summary line of an unread article
4887 (@code{gnus-summary-next-unread-subject}).
4888
4889 @item G M-p
4890 @itemx M-p
4891 @kindex M-p (Summary)
4892 @kindex G M-p (Summary)
4893 @findex gnus-summary-prev-unread-subject
4894 Go to the previous summary line of an unread article
4895 (@code{gnus-summary-prev-unread-subject}).
4896
4897 @item G g
4898 @kindex G g (Summary)
4899 @findex gnus-summary-goto-subject
4900 Ask for an article number and then go to the summary line of that article
4901 without displaying the article (@code{gnus-summary-goto-subject}).
4902 @end table
4903
4904 If Gnus asks you to press a key to confirm going to the next group, you
4905 can use the @kbd{C-n} and @kbd{C-p} keys to move around the group
4906 buffer, searching for the next group to read without actually returning
4907 to the group buffer.
4908
4909 Variables related to summary movement:
4910
4911 @table @code
4912
4913 @vindex gnus-auto-select-next
4914 @item gnus-auto-select-next
4915 If you issue one of the movement commands (like @kbd{n}) and there are
4916 no more unread articles after the current one, Gnus will offer to go to
4917 the next group. If this variable is @code{t} and the next group is
4918 empty, Gnus will exit summary mode and return to the group buffer. If
4919 this variable is neither @code{t} nor @code{nil}, Gnus will select the
4920 next group with unread articles. As a special case, if this variable
4921 is @code{quietly}, Gnus will select the next group without asking for
4922 confirmation. If this variable is @code{almost-quietly}, the same
4923 will happen only if you are located on the last article in the group.
4924 Finally, if this variable is @code{slightly-quietly}, the @kbd{Z n}
4925 command will go to the next group without confirmation. Also
4926 @pxref{Group Levels}.
4927
4928 @item gnus-auto-select-same
4929 @vindex gnus-auto-select-same
4930 If non-@code{nil}, all the movement commands will try to go to the next
4931 article with the same subject as the current. (@dfn{Same} here might
4932 mean @dfn{roughly equal}. See @code{gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit}
4933 for details (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).) If there are no more
4934 articles with the same subject, go to the first unread article.
4935
4936 This variable is not particularly useful if you use a threaded display.
4937
4938 @item gnus-summary-check-current
4939 @vindex gnus-summary-check-current
4940 If non-@code{nil}, all the ``unread'' movement commands will not proceed
4941 to the next (or previous) article if the current article is unread.
4942 Instead, they will choose the current article.
4943
4944 @item gnus-auto-center-summary
4945 @vindex gnus-auto-center-summary
4946 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will keep the point in the summary buffer
4947 centered at all times. This makes things quite tidy, but if you have a
4948 slow network connection, or simply do not like this un-Emacsism, you can
4949 set this variable to @code{nil} to get the normal Emacs scrolling
4950 action. This will also inhibit horizontal re-centering of the summary
4951 buffer, which might make it more inconvenient to read extremely long
4952 threads.
4953
4954 This variable can also be a number. In that case, center the window at
4955 the given number of lines from the top.
4956
4957 @end table
4958
4959
4960 @node Choosing Articles
4961 @section Choosing Articles
4962 @cindex selecting articles
4963
4964 @menu
4965 * Choosing Commands:: Commands for choosing articles.
4966 * Choosing Variables:: Variables that influence these commands.
4967 @end menu
4968
4969
4970 @node Choosing Commands
4971 @subsection Choosing Commands
4972
4973 None of the following movement commands understand the numeric prefix,
4974 and they all select and display an article.
4975
4976 If you want to fetch new articles or redisplay the group, see
4977 @ref{Exiting the Summary Buffer}.
4978
4979 @table @kbd
4980 @item SPACE
4981 @kindex SPACE (Summary)
4982 @findex gnus-summary-next-page
4983 Select the current article, or, if that one's read already, the next
4984 unread article (@code{gnus-summary-next-page}).
4985
4986 If you have an article window open already and you press @kbd{SPACE}
4987 again, the article will be scrolled. This lets you conveniently
4988 @kbd{SPACE} through an entire newsgroup. @xref{Paging the Article}.
4989
4990 @item G n
4991 @itemx n
4992 @kindex n (Summary)
4993 @kindex G n (Summary)
4994 @findex gnus-summary-next-unread-article
4995 @c @icon{gnus-summary-next-unread}
4996 Go to next unread article (@code{gnus-summary-next-unread-article}).
4997
4998 @item G p
4999 @itemx p
5000 @kindex p (Summary)
5001 @findex gnus-summary-prev-unread-article
5002 @c @icon{gnus-summary-prev-unread}
5003 Go to previous unread article (@code{gnus-summary-prev-unread-article}).
5004
5005 @item G N
5006 @itemx N
5007 @kindex N (Summary)
5008 @kindex G N (Summary)
5009 @findex gnus-summary-next-article
5010 Go to the next article (@code{gnus-summary-next-article}).
5011
5012 @item G P
5013 @itemx P
5014 @kindex P (Summary)
5015 @kindex G P (Summary)
5016 @findex gnus-summary-prev-article
5017 Go to the previous article (@code{gnus-summary-prev-article}).
5018
5019 @item G C-n
5020 @kindex G C-n (Summary)
5021 @findex gnus-summary-next-same-subject
5022 Go to the next article with the same subject
5023 (@code{gnus-summary-next-same-subject}).
5024
5025 @item G C-p
5026 @kindex G C-p (Summary)
5027 @findex gnus-summary-prev-same-subject
5028 Go to the previous article with the same subject
5029 (@code{gnus-summary-prev-same-subject}).
5030
5031 @item G f
5032 @itemx .
5033 @kindex G f (Summary)
5034 @kindex . (Summary)
5035 @findex gnus-summary-first-unread-article
5036 Go to the first unread article
5037 (@code{gnus-summary-first-unread-article}).
5038
5039 @item G b
5040 @itemx ,
5041 @kindex G b (Summary)
5042 @kindex , (Summary)
5043 @findex gnus-summary-best-unread-article
5044 Go to the unread article with the highest score
5045 (@code{gnus-summary-best-unread-article}). If given a prefix argument,
5046 go to the first unread article that has a score over the default score.
5047
5048 @item G l
5049 @itemx l
5050 @kindex l (Summary)
5051 @kindex G l (Summary)
5052 @findex gnus-summary-goto-last-article
5053 Go to the previous article read (@code{gnus-summary-goto-last-article}).
5054
5055 @item G o
5056 @kindex G o (Summary)
5057 @findex gnus-summary-pop-article
5058 @cindex history
5059 @cindex article history
5060 Pop an article off the summary history and go to this article
5061 (@code{gnus-summary-pop-article}). This command differs from the
5062 command above in that you can pop as many previous articles off the
5063 history as you like, while @kbd{l} toggles the two last read articles.
5064 For a somewhat related issue (if you use these commands a lot),
5065 @pxref{Article Backlog}.
5066
5067 @item G j
5068 @itemx j
5069 @kindex j (Summary)
5070 @kindex G j (Summary)
5071 @findex gnus-summary-goto-article
5072 Ask for an article number or @code{Message-ID}, and then go to that
5073 article (@code{gnus-summary-goto-article}).
5074
5075 @end table
5076
5077
5078 @node Choosing Variables
5079 @subsection Choosing Variables
5080
5081 Some variables relevant for moving and selecting articles:
5082
5083 @table @code
5084 @item gnus-auto-extend-newsgroup
5085 @vindex gnus-auto-extend-newsgroup
5086 All the movement commands will try to go to the previous (or next)
5087 article, even if that article isn't displayed in the Summary buffer if
5088 this variable is non-@code{nil}. Gnus will then fetch the article from
5089 the server and display it in the article buffer.
5090
5091 @item gnus-select-article-hook
5092 @vindex gnus-select-article-hook
5093 This hook is called whenever an article is selected. By default it
5094 exposes any threads hidden under the selected article. If you would
5095 like each article to be saved in the Agent as you read it, putting
5096 @code{gnus-agent-fetch-selected-article} on this hook will do so.
5097
5098 @item gnus-mark-article-hook
5099 @vindex gnus-mark-article-hook
5100 @findex gnus-summary-mark-unread-as-read
5101 @findex gnus-summary-mark-read-and-unread-as-read
5102 @findex gnus-unread-mark
5103 This hook is called whenever an article is selected. It is intended to
5104 be used for marking articles as read. The default value is
5105 @code{gnus-summary-mark-read-and-unread-as-read}, and will change the
5106 mark of almost any article you read to @code{gnus-unread-mark}. The
5107 only articles not affected by this function are ticked, dormant, and
5108 expirable articles. If you'd instead like to just have unread articles
5109 marked as read, you can use @code{gnus-summary-mark-unread-as-read}
5110 instead. It will leave marks like @code{gnus-low-score-mark},
5111 @code{gnus-del-mark} (and so on) alone.
5112
5113 @end table
5114
5115
5116 @node Paging the Article
5117 @section Scrolling the Article
5118 @cindex article scrolling
5119
5120 @table @kbd
5121
5122 @item SPACE
5123 @kindex SPACE (Summary)
5124 @findex gnus-summary-next-page
5125 Pressing @kbd{SPACE} will scroll the current article forward one page,
5126 or, if you have come to the end of the current article, will choose the
5127 next article (@code{gnus-summary-next-page}).
5128
5129 @vindex gnus-article-boring-faces
5130 @vindex gnus-article-skip-boring
5131 If @code{gnus-article-skip-boring} is non-@code{nil} and the rest of
5132 the article consists only of citations and signature, then it will be
5133 skipped; the next article will be shown instead. You can customize
5134 what is considered uninteresting with
5135 @code{gnus-article-boring-faces}. You can manually view the article's
5136 pages, no matter how boring, using @kbd{C-M-v}.
5137
5138 @item DEL
5139 @kindex DEL (Summary)
5140 @findex gnus-summary-prev-page
5141 Scroll the current article back one page (@code{gnus-summary-prev-page}).
5142
5143 @item RET
5144 @kindex RET (Summary)
5145 @findex gnus-summary-scroll-up
5146 Scroll the current article one line forward
5147 (@code{gnus-summary-scroll-up}).
5148
5149 @item M-RET
5150 @kindex M-RET (Summary)
5151 @findex gnus-summary-scroll-down
5152 Scroll the current article one line backward
5153 (@code{gnus-summary-scroll-down}).
5154
5155 @item A g
5156 @itemx g
5157 @kindex A g (Summary)
5158 @kindex g (Summary)
5159 @findex gnus-summary-show-article
5160 @vindex gnus-summary-show-article-charset-alist
5161 (Re)fetch the current article (@code{gnus-summary-show-article}). If
5162 given a prefix, fetch the current article, but don't run any of the
5163 article treatment functions. This will give you a ``raw'' article, just
5164 the way it came from the server.
5165
5166 If given a numerical prefix, you can do semi-manual charset stuff.
5167 @kbd{C-u 0 g cn-gb-2312 RET} will decode the message as if it were
5168 encoded in the @code{cn-gb-2312} charset. If you have
5169
5170 @lisp
5171 (setq gnus-summary-show-article-charset-alist
5172 '((1 . cn-gb-2312)
5173 (2 . big5)))
5174 @end lisp
5175
5176 then you can say @kbd{C-u 1 g} to get the same effect.
5177
5178 @item A <
5179 @itemx <
5180 @kindex < (Summary)
5181 @kindex A < (Summary)
5182 @findex gnus-summary-beginning-of-article
5183 Scroll to the beginning of the article
5184 (@code{gnus-summary-beginning-of-article}).
5185
5186 @item A >
5187 @itemx >
5188 @kindex > (Summary)
5189 @kindex A > (Summary)
5190 @findex gnus-summary-end-of-article
5191 Scroll to the end of the article (@code{gnus-summary-end-of-article}).
5192
5193 @item A s
5194 @itemx s
5195 @kindex A s (Summary)
5196 @kindex s (Summary)
5197 @findex gnus-summary-isearch-article
5198 Perform an isearch in the article buffer
5199 (@code{gnus-summary-isearch-article}).
5200
5201 @item h
5202 @kindex h (Summary)
5203 @findex gnus-summary-select-article-buffer
5204 Select the article buffer (@code{gnus-summary-select-article-buffer}).
5205
5206 @end table
5207
5208
5209 @node Reply Followup and Post
5210 @section Reply, Followup and Post
5211
5212 @menu
5213 * Summary Mail Commands:: Sending mail.
5214 * Summary Post Commands:: Sending news.
5215 * Summary Message Commands:: Other Message-related commands.
5216 * Canceling and Superseding::
5217 @end menu
5218
5219
5220 @node Summary Mail Commands
5221 @subsection Summary Mail Commands
5222 @cindex mail
5223 @cindex composing mail
5224
5225 Commands for composing a mail message:
5226
5227 @table @kbd
5228
5229 @item S r
5230 @itemx r
5231 @kindex S r (Summary)
5232 @kindex r (Summary)
5233 @findex gnus-summary-reply
5234 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-reply}
5235 @c @icon{gnus-summary-reply}
5236 Mail a reply to the author of the current article
5237 (@code{gnus-summary-reply}).
5238
5239 @item S R
5240 @itemx R
5241 @kindex R (Summary)
5242 @kindex S R (Summary)
5243 @findex gnus-summary-reply-with-original
5244 @c @icon{gnus-summary-reply-with-original}
5245 Mail a reply to the author of the current article and include the
5246 original message (@code{gnus-summary-reply-with-original}). This
5247 command uses the process/prefix convention.
5248
5249 @item S w
5250 @kindex S w (Summary)
5251 @findex gnus-summary-wide-reply
5252 Mail a wide reply to the author of the current article
5253 (@code{gnus-summary-wide-reply}). A @dfn{wide reply} is a reply that
5254 goes out to all people listed in the @code{To}, @code{From} (or
5255 @code{Reply-to}) and @code{Cc} headers. If @code{Mail-Followup-To} is
5256 present, that's used instead.
5257
5258 @item S W
5259 @kindex S W (Summary)
5260 @findex gnus-summary-wide-reply-with-original
5261 Mail a wide reply to the current article and include the original
5262 message (@code{gnus-summary-wide-reply-with-original}). This command uses
5263 the process/prefix convention.
5264
5265 @item S v
5266 @kindex S v (Summary)
5267 @findex gnus-summary-very-wide-reply
5268 Mail a very wide reply to the author of the current article
5269 (@code{gnus-summary-wide-reply}). A @dfn{very wide reply} is a reply
5270 that goes out to all people listed in the @code{To}, @code{From} (or
5271 @code{Reply-to}) and @code{Cc} headers in all the process/prefixed
5272 articles. This command uses the process/prefix convention.
5273
5274 @item S V
5275 @kindex S V (Summary)
5276 @findex gnus-summary-very-wide-reply-with-original
5277 Mail a very wide reply to the author of the current article and include the
5278 original message (@code{gnus-summary-very-wide-reply-with-original}). This
5279 command uses the process/prefix convention.
5280
5281 @item S B r
5282 @kindex S B r (Summary)
5283 @findex gnus-summary-reply-broken-reply-to
5284 Mail a reply to the author of the current article but ignore the
5285 @code{Reply-To} field (@code{gnus-summary-reply-broken-reply-to}).
5286 If you need this because a mailing list incorrectly sets a
5287 @code{Reply-To} header pointing to the list, you probably want to set
5288 the @code{broken-reply-to} group parameter instead, so things will work
5289 correctly. @xref{Group Parameters}.
5290
5291 @item S B R
5292 @kindex S B R (Summary)
5293 @findex gnus-summary-reply-broken-reply-to-with-original
5294 Mail a reply to the author of the current article and include the
5295 original message but ignore the @code{Reply-To} field
5296 (@code{gnus-summary-reply-broken-reply-to-with-original}).
5297
5298 @item S o m
5299 @itemx C-c C-f
5300 @kindex S o m (Summary)
5301 @kindex C-c C-f (Summary)
5302 @findex gnus-summary-mail-forward
5303 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-forward}
5304 Forward the current article to some other person
5305 (@code{gnus-summary-mail-forward}). If no prefix is given, the message
5306 is forwarded according to the value of (@code{message-forward-as-mime})
5307 and (@code{message-forward-show-mml}); if the prefix is 1, decode the
5308 message and forward directly inline; if the prefix is 2, forward message
5309 as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section; if the prefix is 3, decode message and
5310 forward as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section; if the prefix is 4, forward message
5311 directly inline; otherwise, the message is forwarded as no prefix given
5312 but use the flipped value of (@code{message-forward-as-mime}). By
5313 default, the message is decoded and forwarded as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME}
5314 section.
5315
5316 @item S m
5317 @itemx m
5318 @kindex m (Summary)
5319 @kindex S m (Summary)
5320 @findex gnus-summary-mail-other-window
5321 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-originate}
5322 Prepare a mail (@code{gnus-summary-mail-other-window}). By default, use
5323 the posting style of the current group. If given a prefix, disable that.
5324 If the prefix is 1, prompt for a group name to find the posting style.
5325
5326 @item S i
5327 @itemx i
5328 @kindex i (Summary)
5329 @kindex S i (Summary)
5330 @findex gnus-summary-news-other-window
5331 Prepare a news (@code{gnus-summary-news-other-window}). By default,
5332 post to the current group. If given a prefix, disable that. If the
5333 prefix is 1, prompt for a group to post to.
5334
5335 This function actually prepares a news even when using mail groups.
5336 This is useful for ``posting'' messages to mail groups without actually
5337 sending them over the network: they're just saved directly to the group
5338 in question. The corresponding back end must have a request-post method
5339 for this to work though.
5340
5341 @item S D b
5342 @kindex S D b (Summary)
5343 @findex gnus-summary-resend-bounced-mail
5344 @cindex bouncing mail
5345 If you have sent a mail, but the mail was bounced back to you for some
5346 reason (wrong address, transient failure), you can use this command to
5347 resend that bounced mail (@code{gnus-summary-resend-bounced-mail}). You
5348 will be popped into a mail buffer where you can edit the headers before
5349 sending the mail off again. If you give a prefix to this command, and
5350 the bounced mail is a reply to some other mail, Gnus will try to fetch
5351 that mail and display it for easy perusal of its headers. This might
5352 very well fail, though.
5353
5354 @item S D r
5355 @kindex S D r (Summary)
5356 @findex gnus-summary-resend-message
5357 Not to be confused with the previous command,
5358 @code{gnus-summary-resend-message} will prompt you for an address to
5359 send the current message off to, and then send it to that place. The
5360 headers of the message won't be altered---but lots of headers that say
5361 @code{Resent-To}, @code{Resent-From} and so on will be added. This
5362 means that you actually send a mail to someone that has a @code{To}
5363 header that (probably) points to yourself. This will confuse people.
5364 So, natcherly you'll only do that if you're really eVIl.
5365
5366 This command is mainly used if you have several accounts and want to
5367 ship a mail to a different account of yours. (If you're both
5368 @code{root} and @code{postmaster} and get a mail for @code{postmaster}
5369 to the @code{root} account, you may want to resend it to
5370 @code{postmaster}. Ordnung muss sein!
5371
5372 This command understands the process/prefix convention
5373 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
5374
5375 @item S D e
5376 @kindex S D e (Summary)
5377 @findex gnus-summary-resend-message-edit
5378
5379 Like the previous command, but will allow you to edit the message as
5380 if it were a new message before resending.
5381
5382 @item S O m
5383 @kindex S O m (Summary)
5384 @findex gnus-uu-digest-mail-forward
5385 Digest the current series (@pxref{Decoding Articles}) and forward the
5386 result using mail (@code{gnus-uu-digest-mail-forward}). This command
5387 uses the process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
5388
5389 @item S M-c
5390 @kindex S M-c (Summary)
5391 @findex gnus-summary-mail-crosspost-complaint
5392 @cindex crossposting
5393 @cindex excessive crossposting
5394 Send a complaint about excessive crossposting to the author of the
5395 current article (@code{gnus-summary-mail-crosspost-complaint}).
5396
5397 @findex gnus-crosspost-complaint
5398 This command is provided as a way to fight back against the current
5399 crossposting pandemic that's sweeping Usenet. It will compose a reply
5400 using the @code{gnus-crosspost-complaint} variable as a preamble. This
5401 command understands the process/prefix convention
5402 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}) and will prompt you before sending each mail.
5403
5404 @end table
5405
5406 Also @xref{Header Commands, ,Header Commands, message, The Message
5407 Manual}, for more information.
5408
5409
5410 @node Summary Post Commands
5411 @subsection Summary Post Commands
5412 @cindex post
5413 @cindex composing news
5414
5415 Commands for posting a news article:
5416
5417 @table @kbd
5418 @item S p
5419 @itemx a
5420 @kindex a (Summary)
5421 @kindex S p (Summary)
5422 @findex gnus-summary-post-news
5423 @c @icon{gnus-summary-post-news}
5424 Prepare for posting an article (@code{gnus-summary-post-news}). By
5425 default, post to the current group. If given a prefix, disable that.
5426 If the prefix is 1, prompt for another group instead.
5427
5428 @item S f
5429 @itemx f
5430 @kindex f (Summary)
5431 @kindex S f (Summary)
5432 @findex gnus-summary-followup
5433 @c @icon{gnus-summary-followup}
5434 Post a followup to the current article (@code{gnus-summary-followup}).
5435
5436 @item S F
5437 @itemx F
5438 @kindex S F (Summary)
5439 @kindex F (Summary)
5440 @c @icon{gnus-summary-followup-with-original}
5441 @findex gnus-summary-followup-with-original
5442 Post a followup to the current article and include the original message
5443 (@code{gnus-summary-followup-with-original}). This command uses the
5444 process/prefix convention.
5445
5446 @item S n
5447 @kindex S n (Summary)
5448 @findex gnus-summary-followup-to-mail
5449 Post a followup to the current article via news, even if you got the
5450 message through mail (@code{gnus-summary-followup-to-mail}).
5451
5452 @item S N
5453 @kindex S N (Summary)
5454 @findex gnus-summary-followup-to-mail-with-original
5455 Post a followup to the current article via news, even if you got the
5456 message through mail and include the original message
5457 (@code{gnus-summary-followup-to-mail-with-original}). This command uses
5458 the process/prefix convention.
5459
5460 @item S o p
5461 @kindex S o p (Summary)
5462 @findex gnus-summary-post-forward
5463 Forward the current article to a newsgroup
5464 (@code{gnus-summary-post-forward}).
5465 If no prefix is given, the message is forwarded according to the value
5466 of (@code{message-forward-as-mime}) and
5467 (@code{message-forward-show-mml}); if the prefix is 1, decode the
5468 message and forward directly inline; if the prefix is 2, forward message
5469 as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section; if the prefix is 3, decode message and
5470 forward as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section; if the prefix is 4, forward message
5471 directly inline; otherwise, the message is forwarded as no prefix given
5472 but use the flipped value of (@code{message-forward-as-mime}). By
5473 default, the message is decoded and forwarded as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section.
5474
5475 @item S O p
5476 @kindex S O p (Summary)
5477 @findex gnus-uu-digest-post-forward
5478 @cindex digests
5479 @cindex making digests
5480 Digest the current series and forward the result to a newsgroup
5481 (@code{gnus-uu-digest-mail-forward}). This command uses the
5482 process/prefix convention.
5483
5484 @item S u
5485 @kindex S u (Summary)
5486 @findex gnus-uu-post-news
5487 @c @icon{gnus-uu-post-news}
5488 Uuencode a file, split it into parts, and post it as a series
5489 (@code{gnus-uu-post-news}). (@pxref{Uuencoding and Posting}).
5490 @end table
5491
5492 Also @xref{Header Commands, ,Header Commands, message, The Message
5493 Manual}, for more information.
5494
5495
5496 @node Summary Message Commands
5497 @subsection Summary Message Commands
5498
5499 @table @kbd
5500 @item S y
5501 @kindex S y (Summary)
5502 @findex gnus-summary-yank-message
5503 Yank the current article into an already existing Message composition
5504 buffer (@code{gnus-summary-yank-message}). This command prompts for
5505 what message buffer you want to yank into, and understands the
5506 process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
5507
5508 @end table
5509
5510
5511 @node Canceling and Superseding
5512 @subsection Canceling Articles
5513 @cindex canceling articles
5514 @cindex superseding articles
5515
5516 Have you ever written something, and then decided that you really,
5517 really, really wish you hadn't posted that?
5518
5519 Well, you can't cancel mail, but you can cancel posts.
5520
5521 @findex gnus-summary-cancel-article
5522 @kindex C (Summary)
5523 @c @icon{gnus-summary-cancel-article}
5524 Find the article you wish to cancel (you can only cancel your own
5525 articles, so don't try any funny stuff). Then press @kbd{C} or @kbd{S
5526 c} (@code{gnus-summary-cancel-article}). Your article will be
5527 canceled---machines all over the world will be deleting your article.
5528 This command uses the process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
5529
5530 Be aware, however, that not all sites honor cancels, so your article may
5531 live on here and there, while most sites will delete the article in
5532 question.
5533
5534 Gnus will use the ``current'' select method when canceling. If you
5535 want to use the standard posting method, use the @samp{a} symbolic
5536 prefix (@pxref{Symbolic Prefixes}).
5537
5538 Gnus ensures that only you can cancel your own messages using a
5539 @code{Cancel-Lock} header (@pxref{Canceling News, Canceling News, ,
5540 message, Message Manual}).
5541
5542 If you discover that you have made some mistakes and want to do some
5543 corrections, you can post a @dfn{superseding} article that will replace
5544 your original article.
5545
5546 @findex gnus-summary-supersede-article
5547 @kindex S (Summary)
5548 Go to the original article and press @kbd{S s}
5549 (@code{gnus-summary-supersede-article}). You will be put in a buffer
5550 where you can edit the article all you want before sending it off the
5551 usual way.
5552
5553 The same goes for superseding as for canceling, only more so: Some
5554 sites do not honor superseding. On those sites, it will appear that you
5555 have posted almost the same article twice.
5556
5557 If you have just posted the article, and change your mind right away,
5558 there is a trick you can use to cancel/supersede the article without
5559 waiting for the article to appear on your site first. You simply return
5560 to the post buffer (which is called @code{*sent ...*}). There you will
5561 find the article you just posted, with all the headers intact. Change
5562 the @code{Message-ID} header to a @code{Cancel} or @code{Supersedes}
5563 header by substituting one of those words for the word
5564 @code{Message-ID}. Then just press @kbd{C-c C-c} to send the article as
5565 you would do normally. The previous article will be
5566 canceled/superseded.
5567
5568 Just remember, kids: There is no 'c' in 'supersede'.
5569
5570 @node Delayed Articles
5571 @section Delayed Articles
5572 @cindex delayed sending
5573 @cindex send delayed
5574
5575 Sometimes, you might wish to delay the sending of a message. For
5576 example, you might wish to arrange for a message to turn up just in time
5577 to remind your about the birthday of your Significant Other. For this,
5578 there is the @code{gnus-delay} package. Setup is simple:
5579
5580 @lisp
5581 (gnus-delay-initialize)
5582 @end lisp
5583
5584 @findex gnus-delay-article
5585 Normally, to send a message you use the @kbd{C-c C-c} command from
5586 Message mode. To delay a message, use @kbd{C-c C-j}
5587 (@code{gnus-delay-article}) instead. This will ask you for how long the
5588 message should be delayed. Possible answers are:
5589
5590 @itemize @bullet
5591 @item
5592 A time span. Consists of an integer and a letter. For example,
5593 @code{42d} means to delay for 42 days. Available letters are @code{m}
5594 (minutes), @code{h} (hours), @code{d} (days), @code{w} (weeks), @code{M}
5595 (months) and @code{Y} (years).
5596
5597 @item
5598 A specific date. Looks like @code{YYYY-MM-DD}. The message will be
5599 delayed until that day, at a specific time (eight o'clock by default).
5600 See also @code{gnus-delay-default-hour}.
5601
5602 @item
5603 A specific time of day. Given in @code{hh:mm} format, 24h, no am/pm
5604 stuff. The deadline will be at that time today, except if that time has
5605 already passed, then it's at the given time tomorrow. So if it's ten
5606 o'clock in the morning and you specify @code{11:15}, then the deadline
5607 is one hour and fifteen minutes hence. But if you specify @code{9:20},
5608 that means a time tomorrow.
5609 @end itemize
5610
5611 The action of the @code{gnus-delay-article} command is influenced by a
5612 couple of variables:
5613
5614 @table @code
5615 @item gnus-delay-default-hour
5616 @vindex gnus-delay-default-hour
5617 When you specify a specific date, the message will be due on that hour
5618 on the given date. Possible values are integers 0 through 23.
5619
5620 @item gnus-delay-default-delay
5621 @vindex gnus-delay-default-delay
5622 This is a string and gives the default delay. It can be of any of the
5623 formats described above.
5624
5625 @item gnus-delay-group
5626 @vindex gnus-delay-group
5627 Delayed articles will be kept in this group on the drafts server until
5628 they are due. You probably don't need to change this. The default
5629 value is @code{"delayed"}.
5630
5631 @item gnus-delay-header
5632 @vindex gnus-delay-header
5633 The deadline for each article will be stored in a header. This variable
5634 is a string and gives the header name. You probably don't need to
5635 change this. The default value is @code{"X-Gnus-Delayed"}.
5636 @end table
5637
5638 The way delaying works is like this: when you use the
5639 @code{gnus-delay-article} command, you give a certain delay. Gnus
5640 calculates the deadline of the message and stores it in the
5641 @code{X-Gnus-Delayed} header and puts the message in the
5642 @code{nndraft:delayed} group.
5643
5644 @findex gnus-delay-send-queue
5645 And whenever you get new news, Gnus looks through the group for articles
5646 which are due and sends them. It uses the @code{gnus-delay-send-queue}
5647 function for this. By default, this function is added to the hook
5648 @code{gnus-get-new-news-hook}. But of course, you can change this.
5649 Maybe you want to use the demon to send drafts? Just tell the demon to
5650 execute the @code{gnus-delay-send-queue} function.
5651
5652 @table @code
5653 @item gnus-delay-initialize
5654 @findex gnus-delay-initialize
5655 By default, this function installs @code{gnus-delay-send-queue} in
5656 @code{gnus-get-new-news-hook}. But it accepts the optional second
5657 argument @code{no-check}. If it is non-@code{nil},
5658 @code{gnus-get-new-news-hook} is not changed. The optional first
5659 argument is ignored.
5660
5661 For example, @code{(gnus-delay-initialize nil t)} means to do nothing.
5662 Presumably, you want to use the demon for sending due delayed articles.
5663 Just don't forget to set that up :-)
5664 @end table
5665
5666
5667 @node Marking Articles
5668 @section Marking Articles
5669 @cindex article marking
5670 @cindex article ticking
5671 @cindex marks
5672
5673 There are several marks you can set on an article.
5674
5675 You have marks that decide the @dfn{readedness} (whoo, neato-keano
5676 neologism ohoy!) of the article. Alphabetic marks generally mean
5677 @dfn{read}, while non-alphabetic characters generally mean @dfn{unread}.
5678
5679 In addition, you also have marks that do not affect readedness.
5680
5681 @ifinfo
5682 There's a plethora of commands for manipulating these marks.
5683 @end ifinfo
5684
5685 @menu
5686 * Unread Articles:: Marks for unread articles.
5687 * Read Articles:: Marks for read articles.
5688 * Other Marks:: Marks that do not affect readedness.
5689 * Setting Marks:: How to set and remove marks.
5690 * Generic Marking Commands:: How to customize the marking.
5691 * Setting Process Marks:: How to mark articles for later processing.
5692 @end menu
5693
5694
5695 @node Unread Articles
5696 @subsection Unread Articles
5697
5698 The following marks mark articles as (kinda) unread, in one form or
5699 other.
5700
5701 @table @samp
5702 @item !
5703 @vindex gnus-ticked-mark
5704 Marked as ticked (@code{gnus-ticked-mark}).
5705
5706 @dfn{Ticked articles} are articles that will remain visible always. If
5707 you see an article that you find interesting, or you want to put off
5708 reading it, or replying to it, until sometime later, you'd typically
5709 tick it. However, articles can be expired (from news servers by the
5710 news server software, Gnus itself never expires ticked messages), so if
5711 you want to keep an article forever, you'll have to make it persistent
5712 (@pxref{Persistent Articles}).
5713
5714 @item ?
5715 @vindex gnus-dormant-mark
5716 Marked as dormant (@code{gnus-dormant-mark}).
5717
5718 @dfn{Dormant articles} will only appear in the summary buffer if there
5719 are followups to it. If you want to see them even if they don't have
5720 followups, you can use the @kbd{/ D} command (@pxref{Limiting}).
5721 Otherwise (except for the visibility issue), they are just like ticked
5722 messages.
5723
5724 @item SPACE
5725 @vindex gnus-unread-mark
5726 Marked as unread (@code{gnus-unread-mark}).
5727
5728 @dfn{Unread articles} are articles that haven't been read at all yet.
5729 @end table
5730
5731
5732 @node Read Articles
5733 @subsection Read Articles
5734 @cindex expirable mark
5735
5736 All the following marks mark articles as read.
5737
5738 @table @samp
5739
5740 @item r
5741 @vindex gnus-del-mark
5742 These are articles that the user has marked as read with the @kbd{d}
5743 command manually, more or less (@code{gnus-del-mark}).
5744
5745 @item R
5746 @vindex gnus-read-mark
5747 Articles that have actually been read (@code{gnus-read-mark}).
5748
5749 @item O
5750 @vindex gnus-ancient-mark
5751 Articles that were marked as read in previous sessions and are now
5752 @dfn{old} (@code{gnus-ancient-mark}).
5753
5754 @item K
5755 @vindex gnus-killed-mark
5756 Marked as killed (@code{gnus-killed-mark}).
5757
5758 @item X
5759 @vindex gnus-kill-file-mark
5760 Marked as killed by kill files (@code{gnus-kill-file-mark}).
5761
5762 @item Y
5763 @vindex gnus-low-score-mark
5764 Marked as read by having too low a score (@code{gnus-low-score-mark}).
5765
5766 @item C
5767 @vindex gnus-catchup-mark
5768 Marked as read by a catchup (@code{gnus-catchup-mark}).
5769
5770 @item G
5771 @vindex gnus-canceled-mark
5772 Canceled article (@code{gnus-canceled-mark})
5773
5774 @item F
5775 @vindex gnus-souped-mark
5776 @sc{soup}ed article (@code{gnus-souped-mark}). @xref{SOUP}.
5777
5778 @item Q
5779 @vindex gnus-sparse-mark
5780 Sparsely reffed article (@code{gnus-sparse-mark}). @xref{Customizing
5781 Threading}.
5782
5783 @item M
5784 @vindex gnus-duplicate-mark
5785 Article marked as read by duplicate suppression
5786 (@code{gnus-duplicate-mark}). @xref{Duplicate Suppression}.
5787
5788 @end table
5789
5790 All these marks just mean that the article is marked as read, really.
5791 They are interpreted differently when doing adaptive scoring, though.
5792
5793 One more special mark, though:
5794
5795 @table @samp
5796 @item E
5797 @vindex gnus-expirable-mark
5798 Marked as expirable (@code{gnus-expirable-mark}).
5799
5800 Marking articles as @dfn{expirable} (or have them marked as such
5801 automatically) doesn't make much sense in normal groups---a user doesn't
5802 control expiring of news articles, but in mail groups, for instance,
5803 articles marked as @dfn{expirable} can be deleted by Gnus at
5804 any time.
5805 @end table
5806
5807
5808 @node Other Marks
5809 @subsection Other Marks
5810 @cindex process mark
5811 @cindex bookmarks
5812
5813 There are some marks that have nothing to do with whether the article is
5814 read or not.
5815
5816 @itemize @bullet
5817
5818 @item
5819 You can set a bookmark in the current article. Say you are reading a
5820 long thesis on cats' urinary tracts, and have to go home for dinner
5821 before you've finished reading the thesis. You can then set a bookmark
5822 in the article, and Gnus will jump to this bookmark the next time it
5823 encounters the article. @xref{Setting Marks}.
5824
5825 @item
5826 @vindex gnus-replied-mark
5827 All articles that you have replied to or made a followup to (i.e., have
5828 answered) will be marked with an @samp{A} in the second column
5829 (@code{gnus-replied-mark}).
5830
5831 @item
5832 @vindex gnus-forwarded-mark
5833 All articles that you have forwarded will be marked with an @samp{F} in
5834 the second column (@code{gnus-forwarded-mark}).
5835
5836 @item
5837 @vindex gnus-cached-mark
5838 Articles stored in the article cache will be marked with an @samp{*} in
5839 the second column (@code{gnus-cached-mark}). @xref{Article Caching}.
5840
5841 @item
5842 @vindex gnus-saved-mark
5843 Articles ``saved'' (in some manner or other; not necessarily
5844 religiously) are marked with an @samp{S} in the second column
5845 (@code{gnus-saved-mark}).
5846
5847 @item
5848 @vindex gnus-recent-mark
5849 Articles that according to the server haven't been shown to the user
5850 before are marked with a @samp{N} in the second column
5851 (@code{gnus-recent-mark}). Note that not all servers support this
5852 mark, in which case it simply never appears. Compare with
5853 @code{gnus-unseen-mark}.
5854
5855 @item
5856 @vindex gnus-unseen-mark
5857 Articles that haven't been seen before in Gnus by the user are marked
5858 with a @samp{.} in the second column (@code{gnus-unseen-mark}).
5859 Compare with @code{gnus-recent-mark}.
5860
5861 @item
5862 @vindex gnus-downloaded-mark
5863 When using the Gnus agent (@pxref{Agent Basics}), articles may be
5864 downloaded for unplugged (offline) viewing. If you are using the
5865 @samp{%O} spec, these articles get the @samp{+} mark in that spec.
5866 (The variable @code{gnus-downloaded-mark} controls which character to
5867 use.)
5868
5869 @item
5870 @vindex gnus-undownloaded-mark
5871 When using the Gnus agent (@pxref{Agent Basics}), some articles might
5872 not have been downloaded. Such articles cannot be viewed while you
5873 are unplugged (offline). If you are using the @samp{%O} spec, these
5874 articles get the @samp{-} mark in that spec. (The variable
5875 @code{gnus-undownloaded-mark} controls which character to use.)
5876
5877 @item
5878 @vindex gnus-downloadable-mark
5879 The Gnus agent (@pxref{Agent Basics}) downloads some articles
5880 automatically, but it is also possible to explicitly mark articles for
5881 download, even if they would not be downloaded automatically. Such
5882 explicitly-marked articles get the @samp{%} mark in the first column.
5883 (The variable @code{gnus-downloadable-mark} controls which character to
5884 use.)
5885
5886 @item
5887 @vindex gnus-not-empty-thread-mark
5888 @vindex gnus-empty-thread-mark
5889 If the @samp{%e} spec is used, the presence of threads or not will be
5890 marked with @code{gnus-not-empty-thread-mark} and
5891 @code{gnus-empty-thread-mark} in the third column, respectively.
5892
5893 @item
5894 @vindex gnus-process-mark
5895 Finally we have the @dfn{process mark} (@code{gnus-process-mark}). A
5896 variety of commands react to the presence of the process mark. For
5897 instance, @kbd{X u} (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu}) will uudecode and view
5898 all articles that have been marked with the process mark. Articles
5899 marked with the process mark have a @samp{#} in the second column.
5900
5901 @end itemize
5902
5903 You might have noticed that most of these ``non-readedness'' marks
5904 appear in the second column by default. So if you have a cached, saved,
5905 replied article that you have process-marked, what will that look like?
5906
5907 Nothing much. The precedence rules go as follows: process -> cache ->
5908 replied -> saved. So if the article is in the cache and is replied,
5909 you'll only see the cache mark and not the replied mark.
5910
5911
5912 @node Setting Marks
5913 @subsection Setting Marks
5914 @cindex setting marks
5915
5916 All the marking commands understand the numeric prefix.
5917
5918 @table @kbd
5919 @item M c
5920 @itemx M-u
5921 @kindex M c (Summary)
5922 @kindex M-u (Summary)
5923 @findex gnus-summary-clear-mark-forward
5924 @cindex mark as unread
5925 Clear all readedness-marks from the current article
5926 (@code{gnus-summary-clear-mark-forward}). In other words, mark the
5927 article as unread.
5928
5929 @item M t
5930 @itemx !
5931 @kindex ! (Summary)
5932 @kindex M t (Summary)
5933 @findex gnus-summary-tick-article-forward
5934 Tick the current article (@code{gnus-summary-tick-article-forward}).
5935 @xref{Article Caching}.
5936
5937 @item M ?
5938 @itemx ?
5939 @kindex ? (Summary)
5940 @kindex M ? (Summary)
5941 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-dormant
5942 Mark the current article as dormant
5943 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-dormant}). @xref{Article Caching}.
5944
5945 @item M d
5946 @itemx d
5947 @kindex M d (Summary)
5948 @kindex d (Summary)
5949 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-read-forward
5950 Mark the current article as read
5951 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-read-forward}).
5952
5953 @item D
5954 @kindex D (Summary)
5955 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-read-backward
5956 Mark the current article as read and move point to the previous line
5957 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-read-backward}).
5958
5959 @item M k
5960 @itemx k
5961 @kindex k (Summary)
5962 @kindex M k (Summary)
5963 @findex gnus-summary-kill-same-subject-and-select
5964 Mark all articles that have the same subject as the current one as read,
5965 and then select the next unread article
5966 (@code{gnus-summary-kill-same-subject-and-select}).
5967
5968 @item M K
5969 @itemx C-k
5970 @kindex M K (Summary)
5971 @kindex C-k (Summary)
5972 @findex gnus-summary-kill-same-subject
5973 Mark all articles that have the same subject as the current one as read
5974 (@code{gnus-summary-kill-same-subject}).
5975
5976 @item M C
5977 @kindex M C (Summary)
5978 @findex gnus-summary-catchup
5979 @c @icon{gnus-summary-catchup}
5980 Mark all unread articles as read (@code{gnus-summary-catchup}).
5981
5982 @item M C-c
5983 @kindex M C-c (Summary)
5984 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-all
5985 Mark all articles in the group as read---even the ticked and dormant
5986 articles (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-all}).
5987
5988 @item M H
5989 @kindex M H (Summary)
5990 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-to-here
5991 Catchup the current group to point (before the point)
5992 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-to-here}).
5993
5994 @item M h
5995 @kindex M h (Summary)
5996 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-from-here
5997 Catchup the current group from point (after the point)
5998 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-from-here}).
5999
6000 @item C-w
6001 @kindex C-w (Summary)
6002 @findex gnus-summary-mark-region-as-read
6003 Mark all articles between point and mark as read
6004 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-region-as-read}).
6005
6006 @item M V k
6007 @kindex M V k (Summary)
6008 @findex gnus-summary-kill-below
6009 Kill all articles with scores below the default score (or below the
6010 numeric prefix) (@code{gnus-summary-kill-below}).
6011
6012 @item M e
6013 @itemx E
6014 @kindex M e (Summary)
6015 @kindex E (Summary)
6016 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-expirable
6017 Mark the current article as expirable
6018 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-expirable}).
6019
6020 @item M b
6021 @kindex M b (Summary)
6022 @findex gnus-summary-set-bookmark
6023 Set a bookmark in the current article
6024 (@code{gnus-summary-set-bookmark}).
6025
6026 @item M B
6027 @kindex M B (Summary)
6028 @findex gnus-summary-remove-bookmark
6029 Remove the bookmark from the current article
6030 (@code{gnus-summary-remove-bookmark}).
6031
6032 @item M V c
6033 @kindex M V c (Summary)
6034 @findex gnus-summary-clear-above
6035 Clear all marks from articles with scores over the default score (or
6036 over the numeric prefix) (@code{gnus-summary-clear-above}).
6037
6038 @item M V u
6039 @kindex M V u (Summary)
6040 @findex gnus-summary-tick-above
6041 Tick all articles with scores over the default score (or over the
6042 numeric prefix) (@code{gnus-summary-tick-above}).
6043
6044 @item M V m
6045 @kindex M V m (Summary)
6046 @findex gnus-summary-mark-above
6047 Prompt for a mark, and mark all articles with scores over the default
6048 score (or over the numeric prefix) with this mark
6049 (@code{gnus-summary-clear-above}).
6050 @end table
6051
6052 @vindex gnus-summary-goto-unread
6053 The @code{gnus-summary-goto-unread} variable controls what action should
6054 be taken after setting a mark. If non-@code{nil}, point will move to
6055 the next/previous unread article. If @code{nil}, point will just move
6056 one line up or down. As a special case, if this variable is
6057 @code{never}, all the marking commands as well as other commands (like
6058 @kbd{SPACE}) will move to the next article, whether it is unread or not.
6059 The default is @code{t}.
6060
6061
6062 @node Generic Marking Commands
6063 @subsection Generic Marking Commands
6064
6065 Some people would like the command that ticks an article (@kbd{!}) go to
6066 the next article. Others would like it to go to the next unread
6067 article. Yet others would like it to stay on the current article. And
6068 even though I haven't heard of anybody wanting it to go to the
6069 previous (unread) article, I'm sure there are people that want that as
6070 well.
6071
6072 Multiply these five behaviors with five different marking commands, and
6073 you get a potentially complex set of variable to control what each
6074 command should do.
6075
6076 To sidestep that mess, Gnus provides commands that do all these
6077 different things. They can be found on the @kbd{M M} map in the summary
6078 buffer. Type @kbd{M M C-h} to see them all---there are too many of them
6079 to list in this manual.
6080
6081 While you can use these commands directly, most users would prefer
6082 altering the summary mode keymap. For instance, if you would like the
6083 @kbd{!} command to go to the next article instead of the next unread
6084 article, you could say something like:
6085
6086 @lisp
6087 @group
6088 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-mode-hook 'my-alter-summary-map)
6089 (defun my-alter-summary-map ()
6090 (local-set-key "!" 'gnus-summary-put-mark-as-ticked-next))
6091 @end group
6092 @end lisp
6093
6094 @noindent
6095 or
6096
6097 @lisp
6098 (defun my-alter-summary-map ()
6099 (local-set-key "!" "MM!n"))
6100 @end lisp
6101
6102
6103 @node Setting Process Marks
6104 @subsection Setting Process Marks
6105 @cindex setting process marks
6106
6107 Process marks are displayed as @code{#} in the summary buffer, and are
6108 used for marking articles in such a way that other commands will
6109 process these articles. For instance, if you process mark four
6110 articles and then use the @kbd{*} command, Gnus will enter these four
6111 commands into the cache. For more information,
6112 @pxref{Process/Prefix}.
6113
6114 @table @kbd
6115
6116 @item M P p
6117 @itemx #
6118 @kindex # (Summary)
6119 @kindex M P p (Summary)
6120 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-processable
6121 Mark the current article with the process mark
6122 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-processable}).
6123 @findex gnus-summary-unmark-as-processable
6124
6125 @item M P u
6126 @itemx M-#
6127 @kindex M P u (Summary)
6128 @kindex M-# (Summary)
6129 Remove the process mark, if any, from the current article
6130 (@code{gnus-summary-unmark-as-processable}).
6131
6132 @item M P U
6133 @kindex M P U (Summary)
6134 @findex gnus-summary-unmark-all-processable
6135 Remove the process mark from all articles
6136 (@code{gnus-summary-unmark-all-processable}).
6137
6138 @item M P i
6139 @kindex M P i (Summary)
6140 @findex gnus-uu-invert-processable
6141 Invert the list of process marked articles
6142 (@code{gnus-uu-invert-processable}).
6143
6144 @item M P R
6145 @kindex M P R (Summary)
6146 @findex gnus-uu-mark-by-regexp
6147 Mark articles that have a @code{Subject} header that matches a regular
6148 expression (@code{gnus-uu-mark-by-regexp}).
6149
6150 @item M P G
6151 @kindex M P G (Summary)
6152 @findex gnus-uu-unmark-by-regexp
6153 Unmark articles that have a @code{Subject} header that matches a regular
6154 expression (@code{gnus-uu-unmark-by-regexp}).
6155
6156 @item M P r
6157 @kindex M P r (Summary)
6158 @findex gnus-uu-mark-region
6159 Mark articles in region (@code{gnus-uu-mark-region}).
6160
6161 @item M P g
6162 @kindex M P g (Summary)
6163 @findex gnus-uu-unmark-region
6164 Unmark articles in region (@code{gnus-uu-unmark-region}).
6165
6166 @item M P t
6167 @kindex M P t (Summary)
6168 @findex gnus-uu-mark-thread
6169 Mark all articles in the current (sub)thread
6170 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-thread}).
6171
6172 @item M P T
6173 @kindex M P T (Summary)
6174 @findex gnus-uu-unmark-thread
6175 Unmark all articles in the current (sub)thread
6176 (@code{gnus-uu-unmark-thread}).
6177
6178 @item M P v
6179 @kindex M P v (Summary)
6180 @findex gnus-uu-mark-over
6181 Mark all articles that have a score above the prefix argument
6182 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-over}).
6183
6184 @item M P s
6185 @kindex M P s (Summary)
6186 @findex gnus-uu-mark-series
6187 Mark all articles in the current series (@code{gnus-uu-mark-series}).
6188
6189 @item M P S
6190 @kindex M P S (Summary)
6191 @findex gnus-uu-mark-sparse
6192 Mark all series that have already had some articles marked
6193 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-sparse}).
6194
6195 @item M P a
6196 @kindex M P a (Summary)
6197 @findex gnus-uu-mark-all
6198 Mark all articles in series order (@code{gnus-uu-mark-all}).
6199
6200 @item M P b
6201 @kindex M P b (Summary)
6202 @findex gnus-uu-mark-buffer
6203 Mark all articles in the buffer in the order they appear
6204 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-buffer}).
6205
6206 @item M P k
6207 @kindex M P k (Summary)
6208 @findex gnus-summary-kill-process-mark
6209 Push the current process mark set onto the stack and unmark all articles
6210 (@code{gnus-summary-kill-process-mark}).
6211
6212 @item M P y
6213 @kindex M P y (Summary)
6214 @findex gnus-summary-yank-process-mark
6215 Pop the previous process mark set from the stack and restore it
6216 (@code{gnus-summary-yank-process-mark}).
6217
6218 @item M P w
6219 @kindex M P w (Summary)
6220 @findex gnus-summary-save-process-mark
6221 Push the current process mark set onto the stack
6222 (@code{gnus-summary-save-process-mark}).
6223
6224 @end table
6225
6226 Also see the @kbd{&} command in @ref{Searching for Articles}, for how to
6227 set process marks based on article body contents.
6228
6229
6230 @node Limiting
6231 @section Limiting
6232 @cindex limiting
6233
6234 It can be convenient to limit the summary buffer to just show some
6235 subset of the articles currently in the group. The effect most limit
6236 commands have is to remove a few (or many) articles from the summary
6237 buffer.
6238
6239 All limiting commands work on subsets of the articles already fetched
6240 from the servers. None of these commands query the server for
6241 additional articles.
6242
6243 @table @kbd
6244
6245 @item / /
6246 @itemx / s
6247 @kindex / / (Summary)
6248 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-subject
6249 Limit the summary buffer to articles that match some subject
6250 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-subject}). If given a prefix, exclude
6251 matching articles.
6252
6253 @item / a
6254 @kindex / a (Summary)
6255 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-author
6256 Limit the summary buffer to articles that match some author
6257 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-author}). If given a prefix, exclude
6258 matching articles.
6259
6260 @item / x
6261 @kindex / x (Summary)
6262 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-extra
6263 Limit the summary buffer to articles that match one of the ``extra''
6264 headers (@pxref{To From Newsgroups})
6265 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-extra}). If given a prefix, exclude
6266 matching articles.
6267
6268 @item / u
6269 @itemx x
6270 @kindex / u (Summary)
6271 @kindex x (Summary)
6272 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-unread
6273 Limit the summary buffer to articles not marked as read
6274 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-unread}). If given a prefix, limit the
6275 buffer to articles strictly unread. This means that ticked and
6276 dormant articles will also be excluded.
6277
6278 @item / m
6279 @kindex / m (Summary)
6280 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-marks
6281 Ask for a mark and then limit to all articles that have been marked
6282 with that mark (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-marks}).
6283
6284 @item / t
6285 @kindex / t (Summary)
6286 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-age
6287 Ask for a number and then limit the summary buffer to articles older than (or equal to) that number of days
6288 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-age}). If given a prefix, limit to
6289 articles younger than that number of days.
6290
6291 @item / n
6292 @kindex / n (Summary)
6293 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-articles
6294 Limit the summary buffer to the current article
6295 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-articles}). Uses the process/prefix
6296 convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
6297
6298 @item / w
6299 @kindex / w (Summary)
6300 @findex gnus-summary-pop-limit
6301 Pop the previous limit off the stack and restore it
6302 (@code{gnus-summary-pop-limit}). If given a prefix, pop all limits off
6303 the stack.
6304
6305 @item / .
6306 @kindex / . (Summary)
6307 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-unseen
6308 Limit the summary buffer to the unseen articles
6309 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-unseen}).
6310
6311 @item / v
6312 @kindex / v (Summary)
6313 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-score
6314 Limit the summary buffer to articles that have a score at or above some
6315 score (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-score}).
6316
6317 @item / p
6318 @kindex / p (Summary)
6319 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-display-predicate
6320 Limit the summary buffer to articles that satisfy the @code{display}
6321 group parameter predicate
6322 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-display-predicate}). @xref{Group
6323 Parameters}, for more on this predicate.
6324
6325 @item / E
6326 @itemx M S
6327 @kindex M S (Summary)
6328 @kindex / E (Summary)
6329 @findex gnus-summary-limit-include-expunged
6330 Include all expunged articles in the limit
6331 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-include-expunged}).
6332
6333 @item / D
6334 @kindex / D (Summary)
6335 @findex gnus-summary-limit-include-dormant
6336 Include all dormant articles in the limit
6337 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-include-dormant}).
6338
6339 @item / *
6340 @kindex / * (Summary)
6341 @findex gnus-summary-limit-include-cached
6342 Include all cached articles in the limit
6343 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-include-cached}).
6344
6345 @item / d
6346 @kindex / d (Summary)
6347 @findex gnus-summary-limit-exclude-dormant
6348 Exclude all dormant articles from the limit
6349 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-exclude-dormant}).
6350
6351 @item / M
6352 @kindex / M (Summary)
6353 @findex gnus-summary-limit-exclude-marks
6354 Exclude all marked articles (@code{gnus-summary-limit-exclude-marks}).
6355
6356 @item / T
6357 @kindex / T (Summary)
6358 @findex gnus-summary-limit-include-thread
6359 Include all the articles in the current thread in the limit.
6360
6361 @item / c
6362 @kindex / c (Summary)
6363 @findex gnus-summary-limit-exclude-childless-dormant
6364 Exclude all dormant articles that have no children from the limit@*
6365 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-exclude-childless-dormant}).
6366
6367 @item / C
6368 @kindex / C (Summary)
6369 @findex gnus-summary-limit-mark-excluded-as-read
6370 Mark all excluded unread articles as read
6371 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-mark-excluded-as-read}). If given a prefix,
6372 also mark excluded ticked and dormant articles as read.
6373
6374 @item / N
6375 @kindex / N (Summary)
6376 @findex gnus-summary-insert-new-articles
6377 Insert all new articles in the summary buffer. It scans for new emails
6378 if @var{back-end}@code{-get-new-mail} is non-@code{nil}.
6379
6380 @item / o
6381 @kindex / o (Summary)
6382 @findex gnus-summary-insert-old-articles
6383 Insert all old articles in the summary buffer. If given a numbered
6384 prefix, fetch this number of articles.
6385
6386 @end table
6387
6388
6389 @node Threading
6390 @section Threading
6391 @cindex threading
6392 @cindex article threading
6393
6394 Gnus threads articles by default. @dfn{To thread} is to put responses
6395 to articles directly after the articles they respond to---in a
6396 hierarchical fashion.
6397
6398 Threading is done by looking at the @code{References} headers of the
6399 articles. In a perfect world, this would be enough to build pretty
6400 trees, but unfortunately, the @code{References} header is often broken
6401 or simply missing. Weird news propagation exacerbates the problem,
6402 so one has to employ other heuristics to get pleasing results. A
6403 plethora of approaches exists, as detailed in horrible detail in
6404 @ref{Customizing Threading}.
6405
6406 First, a quick overview of the concepts:
6407
6408 @table @dfn
6409 @item root
6410 The top-most article in a thread; the first article in the thread.
6411
6412 @item thread
6413 A tree-like article structure.
6414
6415 @item sub-thread
6416 A small(er) section of this tree-like structure.
6417
6418 @item loose threads
6419 Threads often lose their roots due to article expiry, or due to the root
6420 already having been read in a previous session, and not displayed in the
6421 summary buffer. We then typically have many sub-threads that really
6422 belong to one thread, but are without connecting roots. These are
6423 called loose threads.
6424
6425 @item thread gathering
6426 An attempt to gather loose threads into bigger threads.
6427
6428 @item sparse threads
6429 A thread where the missing articles have been ``guessed'' at, and are
6430 displayed as empty lines in the summary buffer.
6431
6432 @end table
6433
6434
6435 @menu
6436 * Customizing Threading:: Variables you can change to affect the threading.
6437 * Thread Commands:: Thread based commands in the summary buffer.
6438 @end menu
6439
6440
6441 @node Customizing Threading
6442 @subsection Customizing Threading
6443 @cindex customizing threading
6444
6445 @menu
6446 * Loose Threads:: How Gnus gathers loose threads into bigger threads.
6447 * Filling In Threads:: Making the threads displayed look fuller.
6448 * More Threading:: Even more variables for fiddling with threads.
6449 * Low-Level Threading:: You thought it was over@dots{} but you were wrong!
6450 @end menu
6451
6452
6453 @node Loose Threads
6454 @subsubsection Loose Threads
6455 @cindex <
6456 @cindex >
6457 @cindex loose threads
6458
6459 @table @code
6460 @item gnus-summary-make-false-root
6461 @vindex gnus-summary-make-false-root
6462 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will gather all loose subtrees into one big tree
6463 and create a dummy root at the top. (Wait a minute. Root at the top?
6464 Yup.) Loose subtrees occur when the real root has expired, or you've
6465 read or killed the root in a previous session.
6466
6467 When there is no real root of a thread, Gnus will have to fudge
6468 something. This variable says what fudging method Gnus should use.
6469 There are four possible values:
6470
6471 @iftex
6472 @iflatex
6473 \gnusfigure{The Summary Buffer}{390}{
6474 \put(0,0){\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-adopt,width=7.5cm}}
6475 \put(445,0){\makebox(0,0)[br]{\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-empty,width=7.5cm}}}
6476 \put(0,400){\makebox(0,0)[tl]{\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-none,width=7.5cm}}}
6477 \put(445,400){\makebox(0,0)[tr]{\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-dummy,width=7.5cm}}}
6478 }
6479 @end iflatex
6480 @end iftex
6481
6482 @cindex adopting articles
6483
6484 @table @code
6485
6486 @item adopt
6487 Gnus will make the first of the orphaned articles the parent. This
6488 parent will adopt all the other articles. The adopted articles will be
6489 marked as such by pointy brackets (@samp{<>}) instead of the standard
6490 square brackets (@samp{[]}). This is the default method.
6491
6492 @item dummy
6493 @vindex gnus-summary-dummy-line-format
6494 @vindex gnus-summary-make-false-root-always
6495 Gnus will create a dummy summary line that will pretend to be the
6496 parent. This dummy line does not correspond to any real article, so
6497 selecting it will just select the first real article after the dummy
6498 article. @code{gnus-summary-dummy-line-format} is used to specify the
6499 format of the dummy roots. It accepts only one format spec: @samp{S},
6500 which is the subject of the article. @xref{Formatting Variables}.
6501 If you want all threads to have a dummy root, even the non-gathered
6502 ones, set @code{gnus-summary-make-false-root-always} to @code{t}.
6503
6504 @item empty
6505 Gnus won't actually make any article the parent, but simply leave the
6506 subject field of all orphans except the first empty. (Actually, it will
6507 use @code{gnus-summary-same-subject} as the subject (@pxref{Summary
6508 Buffer Format}).)
6509
6510 @item none
6511 Don't make any article parent at all. Just gather the threads and
6512 display them after one another.
6513
6514 @item nil
6515 Don't gather loose threads.
6516 @end table
6517
6518 @item gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit
6519 @vindex gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit
6520 Loose threads are gathered by comparing subjects of articles. If this
6521 variable is @code{nil}, Gnus requires an exact match between the
6522 subjects of the loose threads before gathering them into one big
6523 super-thread. This might be too strict a requirement, what with the
6524 presence of stupid newsreaders that chop off long subject lines. If
6525 you think so, set this variable to, say, 20 to require that only the
6526 first 20 characters of the subjects have to match. If you set this
6527 variable to a really low number, you'll find that Gnus will gather
6528 everything in sight into one thread, which isn't very helpful.
6529
6530 @cindex fuzzy article gathering
6531 If you set this variable to the special value @code{fuzzy}, Gnus will
6532 use a fuzzy string comparison algorithm on the subjects (@pxref{Fuzzy
6533 Matching}).
6534
6535 @item gnus-simplify-subject-fuzzy-regexp
6536 @vindex gnus-simplify-subject-fuzzy-regexp
6537 This can either be a regular expression or list of regular expressions
6538 that match strings that will be removed from subjects if fuzzy subject
6539 simplification is used.
6540
6541 @item gnus-simplify-ignored-prefixes
6542 @vindex gnus-simplify-ignored-prefixes
6543 If you set @code{gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit} to something as low
6544 as 10, you might consider setting this variable to something sensible:
6545
6546 @c Written by Michael Ernst <mernst@cs.rice.edu>
6547 @lisp
6548 (setq gnus-simplify-ignored-prefixes
6549 (concat
6550 "\\`\\[?\\("
6551 (mapconcat
6552 'identity
6553 '("looking"
6554 "wanted" "followup" "summary\\( of\\)?"
6555 "help" "query" "problem" "question"
6556 "answer" "reference" "announce"
6557 "How can I" "How to" "Comparison of"
6558 ;; ...
6559 )
6560 "\\|")
6561 "\\)\\s *\\("
6562 (mapconcat 'identity
6563 '("for" "for reference" "with" "about")
6564 "\\|")
6565 "\\)?\\]?:?[ \t]*"))
6566 @end lisp
6567
6568 All words that match this regexp will be removed before comparing two
6569 subjects.
6570
6571 @item gnus-simplify-subject-functions
6572 @vindex gnus-simplify-subject-functions
6573 If non-@code{nil}, this variable overrides
6574 @code{gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit}. This variable should be a
6575 list of functions to apply to the @code{Subject} string iteratively to
6576 arrive at the simplified version of the string.
6577
6578 Useful functions to put in this list include:
6579
6580 @table @code
6581 @item gnus-simplify-subject-re
6582 @findex gnus-simplify-subject-re
6583 Strip the leading @samp{Re:}.
6584
6585 @item gnus-simplify-subject-fuzzy
6586 @findex gnus-simplify-subject-fuzzy
6587 Simplify fuzzily.
6588
6589 @item gnus-simplify-whitespace
6590 @findex gnus-simplify-whitespace
6591 Remove excessive whitespace.
6592
6593 @item gnus-simplify-all-whitespace
6594 @findex gnus-simplify-all-whitespace
6595 Remove all whitespace.
6596 @end table
6597
6598 You may also write your own functions, of course.
6599
6600
6601 @item gnus-summary-gather-exclude-subject
6602 @vindex gnus-summary-gather-exclude-subject
6603 Since loose thread gathering is done on subjects only, that might lead
6604 to many false hits, especially with certain common subjects like
6605 @samp{} and @samp{(none)}. To make the situation slightly better,
6606 you can use the regexp @code{gnus-summary-gather-exclude-subject} to say
6607 what subjects should be excluded from the gathering process.@*
6608 The default is @samp{^ *$\\|^(none)$}.
6609
6610 @item gnus-summary-thread-gathering-function
6611 @vindex gnus-summary-thread-gathering-function
6612 Gnus gathers threads by looking at @code{Subject} headers. This means
6613 that totally unrelated articles may end up in the same ``thread'', which
6614 is confusing. An alternate approach is to look at all the
6615 @code{Message-ID}s in all the @code{References} headers to find matches.
6616 This will ensure that no gathered threads ever include unrelated
6617 articles, but it also means that people who have posted with broken
6618 newsreaders won't be gathered properly. The choice is yours---plague or
6619 cholera:
6620
6621 @table @code
6622 @item gnus-gather-threads-by-subject
6623 @findex gnus-gather-threads-by-subject
6624 This function is the default gathering function and looks at
6625 @code{Subject}s exclusively.
6626
6627 @item gnus-gather-threads-by-references
6628 @findex gnus-gather-threads-by-references
6629 This function looks at @code{References} headers exclusively.
6630 @end table
6631
6632 If you want to test gathering by @code{References}, you could say
6633 something like:
6634
6635 @lisp
6636 (setq gnus-summary-thread-gathering-function
6637 'gnus-gather-threads-by-references)
6638 @end lisp
6639
6640 @end table
6641
6642
6643 @node Filling In Threads
6644 @subsubsection Filling In Threads
6645
6646 @table @code
6647 @item gnus-fetch-old-headers
6648 @vindex gnus-fetch-old-headers
6649 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will attempt to build old threads by fetching
6650 more old headers---headers to articles marked as read. If you would
6651 like to display as few summary lines as possible, but still connect as
6652 many loose threads as possible, you should set this variable to
6653 @code{some} or a number. If you set it to a number, no more than that
6654 number of extra old headers will be fetched. In either case, fetching
6655 old headers only works if the back end you are using carries overview
6656 files---this would normally be @code{nntp}, @code{nnspool},
6657 @code{nnml}, and @code{nnmaildir}. Also remember that if the root of
6658 the thread has been expired by the server, there's not much Gnus can
6659 do about that.
6660
6661 This variable can also be set to @code{invisible}. This won't have any
6662 visible effects, but is useful if you use the @kbd{A T} command a lot
6663 (@pxref{Finding the Parent}).
6664
6665 @item gnus-fetch-old-ephemeral-headers
6666 @vindex gnus-fetch-old-ephemeral-headers
6667 Same as @code{gnus-fetch-old-headers}, but only used for ephemeral
6668 newsgroups.
6669
6670 @item gnus-build-sparse-threads
6671 @vindex gnus-build-sparse-threads
6672 Fetching old headers can be slow. A low-rent similar effect can be
6673 gotten by setting this variable to @code{some}. Gnus will then look at
6674 the complete @code{References} headers of all articles and try to string
6675 together articles that belong in the same thread. This will leave
6676 @dfn{gaps} in the threading display where Gnus guesses that an article
6677 is missing from the thread. (These gaps appear like normal summary
6678 lines. If you select a gap, Gnus will try to fetch the article in
6679 question.) If this variable is @code{t}, Gnus will display all these
6680 ``gaps'' without regard for whether they are useful for completing the
6681 thread or not. Finally, if this variable is @code{more}, Gnus won't cut
6682 off sparse leaf nodes that don't lead anywhere. This variable is
6683 @code{nil} by default.
6684
6685 @item gnus-read-all-available-headers
6686 @vindex gnus-read-all-available-headers
6687 This is a rather obscure variable that few will find useful. It's
6688 intended for those non-news newsgroups where the back end has to fetch
6689 quite a lot to present the summary buffer, and where it's impossible to
6690 go back to parents of articles. This is mostly the case in the
6691 web-based groups, like the @code{nnultimate} groups.
6692
6693 If you don't use those, then it's safe to leave this as the default
6694 @code{nil}. If you want to use this variable, it should be a regexp
6695 that matches the group name, or @code{t} for all groups.
6696
6697 @end table
6698
6699
6700 @node More Threading
6701 @subsubsection More Threading
6702
6703 @table @code
6704 @item gnus-show-threads
6705 @vindex gnus-show-threads
6706 If this variable is @code{nil}, no threading will be done, and all of
6707 the rest of the variables here will have no effect. Turning threading
6708 off will speed group selection up a bit, but it is sure to make reading
6709 slower and more awkward.
6710
6711 @item gnus-thread-hide-subtree
6712 @vindex gnus-thread-hide-subtree
6713 If non-@code{nil}, all threads will be hidden when the summary buffer is
6714 generated.
6715
6716 This can also be a predicate specifier (@pxref{Predicate Specifiers}).
6717 Available predicates are @code{gnus-article-unread-p} and
6718 @code{gnus-article-unseen-p}.
6719
6720 Here's an example:
6721
6722 @lisp
6723 (setq gnus-thread-hide-subtree
6724 '(or gnus-article-unread-p
6725 gnus-article-unseen-p))
6726 @end lisp
6727
6728 (It's a pretty nonsensical example, since all unseen articles are also
6729 unread, but you get my drift.)
6730
6731
6732 @item gnus-thread-expunge-below
6733 @vindex gnus-thread-expunge-below
6734 All threads that have a total score (as defined by
6735 @code{gnus-thread-score-function}) less than this number will be
6736 expunged. This variable is @code{nil} by default, which means that no
6737 threads are expunged.
6738
6739 @item gnus-thread-hide-killed
6740 @vindex gnus-thread-hide-killed
6741 if you kill a thread and this variable is non-@code{nil}, the subtree
6742 will be hidden.
6743
6744 @item gnus-thread-ignore-subject
6745 @vindex gnus-thread-ignore-subject
6746 Sometimes somebody changes the subject in the middle of a thread. If
6747 this variable is non-@code{nil}, which is the default, the subject
6748 change is ignored. If it is @code{nil}, a change in the subject will
6749 result in a new thread.
6750
6751 @item gnus-thread-indent-level
6752 @vindex gnus-thread-indent-level
6753 This is a number that says how much each sub-thread should be indented.
6754 The default is 4.
6755
6756 @item gnus-sort-gathered-threads-function
6757 @vindex gnus-sort-gathered-threads-function
6758 Sometimes, particularly with mailing lists, the order in which mails
6759 arrive locally is not necessarily the same as the order in which they
6760 arrived on the mailing list. Consequently, when sorting sub-threads
6761 using the default @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-number}, responses can end
6762 up appearing before the article to which they are responding to.
6763 Setting this variable to an alternate value
6764 (e.g. @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-date}), in a group's parameters or in an
6765 appropriate hook (e.g. @code{gnus-summary-generate-hook}) can produce a
6766 more logical sub-thread ordering in such instances.
6767
6768 @end table
6769
6770
6771 @node Low-Level Threading
6772 @subsubsection Low-Level Threading
6773
6774 @table @code
6775
6776 @item gnus-parse-headers-hook
6777 @vindex gnus-parse-headers-hook
6778 Hook run before parsing any headers.
6779
6780 @item gnus-alter-header-function
6781 @vindex gnus-alter-header-function
6782 If non-@code{nil}, this function will be called to allow alteration of
6783 article header structures. The function is called with one parameter,
6784 the article header vector, which it may alter in any way. For instance,
6785 if you have a mail-to-news gateway which alters the @code{Message-ID}s
6786 in systematic ways (by adding prefixes and such), you can use this
6787 variable to un-scramble the @code{Message-ID}s so that they are more
6788 meaningful. Here's one example:
6789
6790 @lisp
6791 (setq gnus-alter-header-function 'my-alter-message-id)
6792
6793 (defun my-alter-message-id (header)
6794 (let ((id (mail-header-id header)))
6795 (when (string-match
6796 "\\(<[^<>@@]*\\)\\.?cygnus\\..*@@\\([^<>@@]*>\\)" id)
6797 (mail-header-set-id
6798 (concat (match-string 1 id) "@@" (match-string 2 id))
6799 header))))
6800 @end lisp
6801
6802 @end table
6803
6804
6805 @node Thread Commands
6806 @subsection Thread Commands
6807 @cindex thread commands
6808
6809 @table @kbd
6810
6811 @item T k
6812 @itemx C-M-k
6813 @kindex T k (Summary)
6814 @kindex C-M-k (Summary)
6815 @findex gnus-summary-kill-thread
6816 Mark all articles in the current (sub-)thread as read
6817 (@code{gnus-summary-kill-thread}). If the prefix argument is positive,
6818 remove all marks instead. If the prefix argument is negative, tick
6819 articles instead.
6820
6821 @item T l
6822 @itemx C-M-l
6823 @kindex T l (Summary)
6824 @kindex C-M-l (Summary)
6825 @findex gnus-summary-lower-thread
6826 Lower the score of the current (sub-)thread
6827 (@code{gnus-summary-lower-thread}).
6828
6829 @item T i
6830 @kindex T i (Summary)
6831 @findex gnus-summary-raise-thread
6832 Increase the score of the current (sub-)thread
6833 (@code{gnus-summary-raise-thread}).
6834
6835 @item T #
6836 @kindex T # (Summary)
6837 @findex gnus-uu-mark-thread
6838 Set the process mark on the current (sub-)thread
6839 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-thread}).
6840
6841 @item T M-#
6842 @kindex T M-# (Summary)
6843 @findex gnus-uu-unmark-thread
6844 Remove the process mark from the current (sub-)thread
6845 (@code{gnus-uu-unmark-thread}).
6846
6847 @item T T
6848 @kindex T T (Summary)
6849 @findex gnus-summary-toggle-threads
6850 Toggle threading (@code{gnus-summary-toggle-threads}).
6851
6852 @item T s
6853 @kindex T s (Summary)
6854 @findex gnus-summary-show-thread
6855 Expose the (sub-)thread hidden under the current article, if any@*
6856 (@code{gnus-summary-show-thread}).
6857
6858 @item T h
6859 @kindex T h (Summary)
6860 @findex gnus-summary-hide-thread
6861 Hide the current (sub-)thread (@code{gnus-summary-hide-thread}).
6862
6863 @item T S
6864 @kindex T S (Summary)
6865 @findex gnus-summary-show-all-threads
6866 Expose all hidden threads (@code{gnus-summary-show-all-threads}).
6867
6868 @item T H
6869 @kindex T H (Summary)
6870 @findex gnus-summary-hide-all-threads
6871 Hide all threads (@code{gnus-summary-hide-all-threads}).
6872
6873 @item T t
6874 @kindex T t (Summary)
6875 @findex gnus-summary-rethread-current
6876 Re-thread the current article's thread
6877 (@code{gnus-summary-rethread-current}). This works even when the
6878 summary buffer is otherwise unthreaded.
6879
6880 @item T ^
6881 @kindex T ^ (Summary)
6882 @findex gnus-summary-reparent-thread
6883 Make the current article the child of the marked (or previous) article
6884 (@code{gnus-summary-reparent-thread}).
6885
6886 @end table
6887
6888 The following commands are thread movement commands. They all
6889 understand the numeric prefix.
6890
6891 @table @kbd
6892
6893 @item T n
6894 @kindex T n (Summary)
6895 @itemx C-M-f
6896 @kindex C-M-n (Summary)
6897 @itemx M-down
6898 @kindex M-down (Summary)
6899 @findex gnus-summary-next-thread
6900 Go to the next thread (@code{gnus-summary-next-thread}).
6901
6902 @item T p
6903 @kindex T p (Summary)
6904 @itemx C-M-b
6905 @kindex C-M-p (Summary)
6906 @itemx M-up
6907 @kindex M-up (Summary)
6908 @findex gnus-summary-prev-thread
6909 Go to the previous thread (@code{gnus-summary-prev-thread}).
6910
6911 @item T d
6912 @kindex T d (Summary)
6913 @findex gnus-summary-down-thread
6914 Descend the thread (@code{gnus-summary-down-thread}).
6915
6916 @item T u
6917 @kindex T u (Summary)
6918 @findex gnus-summary-up-thread
6919 Ascend the thread (@code{gnus-summary-up-thread}).
6920
6921 @item T o
6922 @kindex T o (Summary)
6923 @findex gnus-summary-top-thread
6924 Go to the top of the thread (@code{gnus-summary-top-thread}).
6925 @end table
6926
6927 @vindex gnus-thread-operation-ignore-subject
6928 If you ignore subject while threading, you'll naturally end up with
6929 threads that have several different subjects in them. If you then issue
6930 a command like @kbd{T k} (@code{gnus-summary-kill-thread}) you might not
6931 wish to kill the entire thread, but just those parts of the thread that
6932 have the same subject as the current article. If you like this idea,
6933 you can fiddle with @code{gnus-thread-operation-ignore-subject}. If it
6934 is non-@code{nil} (which it is by default), subjects will be ignored
6935 when doing thread commands. If this variable is @code{nil}, articles in
6936 the same thread with different subjects will not be included in the
6937 operation in question. If this variable is @code{fuzzy}, only articles
6938 that have subjects fuzzily equal will be included (@pxref{Fuzzy
6939 Matching}).
6940
6941
6942 @node Sorting the Summary Buffer
6943 @section Sorting the Summary Buffer
6944
6945 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-total-score
6946 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-date
6947 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-score
6948 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-subject
6949 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-author
6950 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-number
6951 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-random
6952 @vindex gnus-thread-sort-functions
6953 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-most-recent-number
6954 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-most-recent-date
6955 If you are using a threaded summary display, you can sort the threads by
6956 setting @code{gnus-thread-sort-functions}, which can be either a single
6957 function, a list of functions, or a list containing functions and
6958 @code{(not some-function)} elements.
6959
6960 By default, sorting is done on article numbers. Ready-made sorting
6961 predicate functions include @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-number},
6962 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-author}, @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-subject},
6963 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-date}, @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-score},
6964 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-most-recent-number},
6965 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-most-recent-date},
6966 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-random} and
6967 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-total-score}.
6968
6969 Each function takes two threads and returns non-@code{nil} if the first
6970 thread should be sorted before the other. Note that sorting really is
6971 normally done by looking only at the roots of each thread.
6972
6973 If you use more than one function, the primary sort key should be the
6974 last function in the list. You should probably always include
6975 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-number} in the list of sorting
6976 functions---preferably first. This will ensure that threads that are
6977 equal with respect to the other sort criteria will be displayed in
6978 ascending article order.
6979
6980 If you would like to sort by reverse score, then by subject, and finally
6981 by number, you could do something like:
6982
6983 @lisp
6984 (setq gnus-thread-sort-functions
6985 '(gnus-thread-sort-by-number
6986 gnus-thread-sort-by-subject
6987 (not gnus-thread-sort-by-total-score)))
6988 @end lisp
6989
6990 The threads that have highest score will be displayed first in the
6991 summary buffer. When threads have the same score, they will be sorted
6992 alphabetically. The threads that have the same score and the same
6993 subject will be sorted by number, which is (normally) the sequence in
6994 which the articles arrived.
6995
6996 If you want to sort by score and then reverse arrival order, you could
6997 say something like:
6998
6999 @lisp
7000 (setq gnus-thread-sort-functions
7001 '((lambda (t1 t2)
7002 (not (gnus-thread-sort-by-number t1 t2)))
7003 gnus-thread-sort-by-score))
7004 @end lisp
7005
7006 @vindex gnus-thread-score-function
7007 The function in the @code{gnus-thread-score-function} variable (default
7008 @code{+}) is used for calculating the total score of a thread. Useful
7009 functions might be @code{max}, @code{min}, or squared means, or whatever
7010 tickles your fancy.
7011
7012 @findex gnus-article-sort-functions
7013 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-date
7014 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-score
7015 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-subject
7016 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-author
7017 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-random
7018 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-number
7019 If you are using an unthreaded display for some strange reason or
7020 other, you have to fiddle with the @code{gnus-article-sort-functions}
7021 variable. It is very similar to the
7022 @code{gnus-thread-sort-functions}, except that it uses slightly
7023 different functions for article comparison. Available sorting
7024 predicate functions are @code{gnus-article-sort-by-number},
7025 @code{gnus-article-sort-by-author},
7026 @code{gnus-article-sort-by-subject}, @code{gnus-article-sort-by-date},
7027 @code{gnus-article-sort-by-random}, and
7028 @code{gnus-article-sort-by-score}.
7029
7030 If you want to sort an unthreaded summary display by subject, you could
7031 say something like:
7032
7033 @lisp
7034 (setq gnus-article-sort-functions
7035 '(gnus-article-sort-by-number
7036 gnus-article-sort-by-subject))
7037 @end lisp
7038
7039
7040
7041 @node Asynchronous Fetching
7042 @section Asynchronous Article Fetching
7043 @cindex asynchronous article fetching
7044 @cindex article pre-fetch
7045 @cindex pre-fetch
7046
7047 If you read your news from an @acronym{NNTP} server that's far away, the
7048 network latencies may make reading articles a chore. You have to wait
7049 for a while after pressing @kbd{n} to go to the next article before the
7050 article appears. Why can't Gnus just go ahead and fetch the article
7051 while you are reading the previous one? Why not, indeed.
7052
7053 First, some caveats. There are some pitfalls to using asynchronous
7054 article fetching, especially the way Gnus does it.
7055
7056 Let's say you are reading article 1, which is short, and article 2 is
7057 quite long, and you are not interested in reading that. Gnus does not
7058 know this, so it goes ahead and fetches article 2. You decide to read
7059 article 3, but since Gnus is in the process of fetching article 2, the
7060 connection is blocked.
7061
7062 To avoid these situations, Gnus will open two (count 'em two)
7063 connections to the server. Some people may think this isn't a very nice
7064 thing to do, but I don't see any real alternatives. Setting up that
7065 extra connection takes some time, so Gnus startup will be slower.
7066
7067 Gnus will fetch more articles than you will read. This will mean that
7068 the link between your machine and the @acronym{NNTP} server will become more
7069 loaded than if you didn't use article pre-fetch. The server itself will
7070 also become more loaded---both with the extra article requests, and the
7071 extra connection.
7072
7073 Ok, so now you know that you shouldn't really use this thing@dots{} unless
7074 you really want to.
7075
7076 @vindex gnus-asynchronous
7077 Here's how: Set @code{gnus-asynchronous} to @code{t}. The rest should
7078 happen automatically.
7079
7080 @vindex gnus-use-article-prefetch
7081 You can control how many articles are to be pre-fetched by setting
7082 @code{gnus-use-article-prefetch}. This is 30 by default, which means
7083 that when you read an article in the group, the back end will pre-fetch
7084 the next 30 articles. If this variable is @code{t}, the back end will
7085 pre-fetch all the articles it can without bound. If it is
7086 @code{nil}, no pre-fetching will be done.
7087
7088 @vindex gnus-async-prefetch-article-p
7089 @findex gnus-async-read-p
7090 There are probably some articles that you don't want to pre-fetch---read
7091 articles, for instance. The @code{gnus-async-prefetch-article-p}
7092 variable controls whether an article is to be pre-fetched. This
7093 function should return non-@code{nil} when the article in question is
7094 to be pre-fetched. The default is @code{gnus-async-read-p}, which
7095 returns @code{nil} on read articles. The function is called with an
7096 article data structure as the only parameter.
7097
7098 If, for instance, you wish to pre-fetch only unread articles shorter
7099 than 100 lines, you could say something like:
7100
7101 @lisp
7102 (defun my-async-short-unread-p (data)
7103 "Return non-nil for short, unread articles."
7104 (and (gnus-data-unread-p data)
7105 (< (mail-header-lines (gnus-data-header data))
7106 100)))
7107
7108 (setq gnus-async-prefetch-article-p 'my-async-short-unread-p)
7109 @end lisp
7110
7111 These functions will be called many, many times, so they should
7112 preferably be short and sweet to avoid slowing down Gnus too much.
7113 It's probably a good idea to byte-compile things like this.
7114
7115 @vindex gnus-prefetched-article-deletion-strategy
7116 Articles have to be removed from the asynch buffer sooner or later. The
7117 @code{gnus-prefetched-article-deletion-strategy} says when to remove
7118 articles. This is a list that may contain the following elements:
7119
7120 @table @code
7121 @item read
7122 Remove articles when they are read.
7123
7124 @item exit
7125 Remove articles when exiting the group.
7126 @end table
7127
7128 The default value is @code{(read exit)}.
7129
7130 @c @vindex gnus-use-header-prefetch
7131 @c If @code{gnus-use-header-prefetch} is non-@code{nil}, prefetch articles
7132 @c from the next group.
7133
7134
7135 @node Article Caching
7136 @section Article Caching
7137 @cindex article caching
7138 @cindex caching
7139
7140 If you have an @emph{extremely} slow @acronym{NNTP} connection, you may
7141 consider turning article caching on. Each article will then be stored
7142 locally under your home directory. As you may surmise, this could
7143 potentially use @emph{huge} amounts of disk space, as well as eat up all
7144 your inodes so fast it will make your head swim. In vodka.
7145
7146 Used carefully, though, it could be just an easier way to save articles.
7147
7148 @vindex gnus-use-long-file-name
7149 @vindex gnus-cache-directory
7150 @vindex gnus-use-cache
7151 To turn caching on, set @code{gnus-use-cache} to @code{t}. By default,
7152 all articles ticked or marked as dormant will then be copied
7153 over to your local cache (@code{gnus-cache-directory}). Whether this
7154 cache is flat or hierarchical is controlled by the
7155 @code{gnus-use-long-file-name} variable, as usual.
7156
7157 When re-selecting a ticked or dormant article, it will be fetched from the
7158 cache instead of from the server. As articles in your cache will never
7159 expire, this might serve as a method of saving articles while still
7160 keeping them where they belong. Just mark all articles you want to save
7161 as dormant, and don't worry.
7162
7163 When an article is marked as read, is it removed from the cache.
7164
7165 @vindex gnus-cache-remove-articles
7166 @vindex gnus-cache-enter-articles
7167 The entering/removal of articles from the cache is controlled by the
7168 @code{gnus-cache-enter-articles} and @code{gnus-cache-remove-articles}
7169 variables. Both are lists of symbols. The first is @code{(ticked
7170 dormant)} by default, meaning that ticked and dormant articles will be
7171 put in the cache. The latter is @code{(read)} by default, meaning that
7172 articles marked as read are removed from the cache. Possibly
7173 symbols in these two lists are @code{ticked}, @code{dormant},
7174 @code{unread} and @code{read}.
7175
7176 @findex gnus-jog-cache
7177 So where does the massive article-fetching and storing come into the
7178 picture? The @code{gnus-jog-cache} command will go through all
7179 subscribed newsgroups, request all unread articles, score them, and
7180 store them in the cache. You should only ever, ever ever ever, use this
7181 command if 1) your connection to the @acronym{NNTP} server is really, really,
7182 really slow and 2) you have a really, really, really huge disk.
7183 Seriously. One way to cut down on the number of articles downloaded is
7184 to score unwanted articles down and have them marked as read. They will
7185 not then be downloaded by this command.
7186
7187 @vindex gnus-uncacheable-groups
7188 @vindex gnus-cacheable-groups
7189 It is likely that you do not want caching on all groups. For instance,
7190 if your @code{nnml} mail is located under your home directory, it makes no
7191 sense to cache it somewhere else under your home directory. Unless you
7192 feel that it's neat to use twice as much space.
7193
7194 To limit the caching, you could set @code{gnus-cacheable-groups} to a
7195 regexp of groups to cache, @samp{^nntp} for instance, or set the
7196 @code{gnus-uncacheable-groups} regexp to @samp{^nnml}, for instance.
7197 Both variables are @code{nil} by default. If a group matches both
7198 variables, the group is not cached.
7199
7200 @findex gnus-cache-generate-nov-databases
7201 @findex gnus-cache-generate-active
7202 @vindex gnus-cache-active-file
7203 The cache stores information on what articles it contains in its active
7204 file (@code{gnus-cache-active-file}). If this file (or any other parts
7205 of the cache) becomes all messed up for some reason or other, Gnus
7206 offers two functions that will try to set things right. @kbd{M-x
7207 gnus-cache-generate-nov-databases} will (re)build all the @acronym{NOV}
7208 files, and @kbd{gnus-cache-generate-active} will (re)generate the active
7209 file.
7210
7211 @findex gnus-cache-move-cache
7212 @code{gnus-cache-move-cache} will move your whole
7213 @code{gnus-cache-directory} to some other location. You get asked to
7214 where, isn't that cool?
7215
7216 @node Persistent Articles
7217 @section Persistent Articles
7218 @cindex persistent articles
7219
7220 Closely related to article caching, we have @dfn{persistent articles}.
7221 In fact, it's just a different way of looking at caching, and much more
7222 useful in my opinion.
7223
7224 Say you're reading a newsgroup, and you happen on to some valuable gem
7225 that you want to keep and treasure forever. You'd normally just save it
7226 (using one of the many saving commands) in some file. The problem with
7227 that is that it's just, well, yucky. Ideally you'd prefer just having
7228 the article remain in the group where you found it forever; untouched by
7229 the expiry going on at the news server.
7230
7231 This is what a @dfn{persistent article} is---an article that just won't
7232 be deleted. It's implemented using the normal cache functions, but
7233 you use two explicit commands for managing persistent articles:
7234
7235 @table @kbd
7236
7237 @item *
7238 @kindex * (Summary)
7239 @findex gnus-cache-enter-article
7240 Make the current article persistent (@code{gnus-cache-enter-article}).
7241
7242 @item M-*
7243 @kindex M-* (Summary)
7244 @findex gnus-cache-remove-article
7245 Remove the current article from the persistent articles
7246 (@code{gnus-cache-remove-article}). This will normally delete the
7247 article.
7248 @end table
7249
7250 Both these commands understand the process/prefix convention.
7251
7252 To avoid having all ticked articles (and stuff) entered into the cache,
7253 you should set @code{gnus-use-cache} to @code{passive} if you're just
7254 interested in persistent articles:
7255
7256 @lisp
7257 (setq gnus-use-cache 'passive)
7258 @end lisp
7259
7260
7261 @node Article Backlog
7262 @section Article Backlog
7263 @cindex backlog
7264 @cindex article backlog
7265
7266 If you have a slow connection, but the idea of using caching seems
7267 unappealing to you (and it is, really), you can help the situation some
7268 by switching on the @dfn{backlog}. This is where Gnus will buffer
7269 already read articles so that it doesn't have to re-fetch articles
7270 you've already read. This only helps if you are in the habit of
7271 re-selecting articles you've recently read, of course. If you never do
7272 that, turning the backlog on will slow Gnus down a little bit, and
7273 increase memory usage some.
7274
7275 @vindex gnus-keep-backlog
7276 If you set @code{gnus-keep-backlog} to a number @var{n}, Gnus will store
7277 at most @var{n} old articles in a buffer for later re-fetching. If this
7278 variable is non-@code{nil} and is not a number, Gnus will store
7279 @emph{all} read articles, which means that your Emacs will grow without
7280 bound before exploding and taking your machine down with you. I put
7281 that in there just to keep y'all on your toes.
7282
7283 The default value is 20.
7284
7285
7286 @node Saving Articles
7287 @section Saving Articles
7288 @cindex saving articles
7289
7290 Gnus can save articles in a number of ways. Below is the documentation
7291 for saving articles in a fairly straight-forward fashion (i.e., little
7292 processing of the article is done before it is saved). For a different
7293 approach (uudecoding, unsharing) you should use @code{gnus-uu}
7294 (@pxref{Decoding Articles}).
7295
7296 For the commands listed here, the target is a file. If you want to
7297 save to a group, see the @kbd{B c} (@code{gnus-summary-copy-article})
7298 command (@pxref{Mail Group Commands}).
7299
7300 @vindex gnus-save-all-headers
7301 If @code{gnus-save-all-headers} is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will not delete
7302 unwanted headers before saving the article.
7303
7304 @vindex gnus-saved-headers
7305 If the preceding variable is @code{nil}, all headers that match the
7306 @code{gnus-saved-headers} regexp will be kept, while the rest will be
7307 deleted before saving.
7308
7309 @table @kbd
7310
7311 @item O o
7312 @itemx o
7313 @kindex O o (Summary)
7314 @kindex o (Summary)
7315 @findex gnus-summary-save-article
7316 @c @icon{gnus-summary-save-article}
7317 Save the current article using the default article saver
7318 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article}).
7319
7320 @item O m
7321 @kindex O m (Summary)
7322 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-mail
7323 Save the current article in mail format
7324 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-mail}).
7325
7326 @item O r
7327 @kindex O r (Summary)
7328 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-rmail
7329 Save the current article in Rmail format
7330 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-rmail}).
7331
7332 @item O f
7333 @kindex O f (Summary)
7334 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-file
7335 @c @icon{gnus-summary-save-article-file}
7336 Save the current article in plain file format
7337 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-file}).
7338
7339 @item O F
7340 @kindex O F (Summary)
7341 @findex gnus-summary-write-article-file
7342 Write the current article in plain file format, overwriting any previous
7343 file contents (@code{gnus-summary-write-article-file}).
7344
7345 @item O b
7346 @kindex O b (Summary)
7347 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-body-file
7348 Save the current article body in plain file format
7349 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-body-file}).
7350
7351 @item O h
7352 @kindex O h (Summary)
7353 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-folder
7354 Save the current article in mh folder format
7355 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-folder}).
7356
7357 @item O v
7358 @kindex O v (Summary)
7359 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-vm
7360 Save the current article in a VM folder
7361 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-vm}).
7362
7363 @item O p
7364 @itemx |
7365 @kindex O p (Summary)
7366 @kindex | (Summary)
7367 @findex gnus-summary-pipe-output
7368 Save the current article in a pipe. Uhm, like, what I mean is---Pipe
7369 the current article to a process (@code{gnus-summary-pipe-output}).
7370 If given a symbolic prefix (@pxref{Symbolic Prefixes}), include the
7371 complete headers in the piped output.
7372
7373 @item O P
7374 @kindex O P (Summary)
7375 @findex gnus-summary-muttprint
7376 @vindex gnus-summary-muttprint-program
7377 Save the current article into muttprint. That is, print it using the
7378 external program @uref{http://muttprint.sourceforge.net/,
7379 Muttprint}. The program name and options to use is controlled by the
7380 variable @code{gnus-summary-muttprint-program}.
7381 (@code{gnus-summary-muttprint}).
7382
7383 @end table
7384
7385 @vindex gnus-prompt-before-saving
7386 All these commands use the process/prefix convention
7387 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}). If you save bunches of articles using these
7388 functions, you might get tired of being prompted for files to save each
7389 and every article in. The prompting action is controlled by
7390 the @code{gnus-prompt-before-saving} variable, which is @code{always} by
7391 default, giving you that excessive prompting action you know and
7392 loathe. If you set this variable to @code{t} instead, you'll be prompted
7393 just once for each series of articles you save. If you like to really
7394 have Gnus do all your thinking for you, you can even set this variable
7395 to @code{nil}, which means that you will never be prompted for files to
7396 save articles in. Gnus will simply save all the articles in the default
7397 files.
7398
7399
7400 @vindex gnus-default-article-saver
7401 You can customize the @code{gnus-default-article-saver} variable to make
7402 Gnus do what you want it to. You can use any of the six ready-made
7403 functions below, or you can create your own.
7404
7405 @table @code
7406
7407 @item gnus-summary-save-in-rmail
7408 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-rmail
7409 @vindex gnus-rmail-save-name
7410 @findex gnus-plain-save-name
7411 This is the default format, @dfn{Babyl}. Uses the function in the
7412 @code{gnus-rmail-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7413 article in. The default is @code{gnus-plain-save-name}.
7414
7415 @item gnus-summary-save-in-mail
7416 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-mail
7417 @vindex gnus-mail-save-name
7418 Save in a Unix mail (mbox) file. Uses the function in the
7419 @code{gnus-mail-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7420 article in. The default is @code{gnus-plain-save-name}.
7421
7422 @item gnus-summary-save-in-file
7423 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-file
7424 @vindex gnus-file-save-name
7425 @findex gnus-numeric-save-name
7426 Append the article straight to an ordinary file. Uses the function in
7427 the @code{gnus-file-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7428 article in. The default is @code{gnus-numeric-save-name}.
7429
7430 @item gnus-summary-write-to-file
7431 @findex gnus-summary-write-to-file
7432 Write the article straight to an ordinary file. The file is
7433 overwritten if it exists. Uses the function in the
7434 @code{gnus-file-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7435 article in. The default is @code{gnus-numeric-save-name}.
7436
7437 @item gnus-summary-save-body-in-file
7438 @findex gnus-summary-save-body-in-file
7439 Append the article body to an ordinary file. Uses the function in the
7440 @code{gnus-file-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7441 article in. The default is @code{gnus-numeric-save-name}.
7442
7443 @item gnus-summary-save-in-folder
7444 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-folder
7445 @findex gnus-folder-save-name
7446 @findex gnus-Folder-save-name
7447 @vindex gnus-folder-save-name
7448 @cindex rcvstore
7449 @cindex MH folders
7450 Save the article to an MH folder using @code{rcvstore} from the MH
7451 library. Uses the function in the @code{gnus-folder-save-name} variable
7452 to get a file name to save the article in. The default is
7453 @code{gnus-folder-save-name}, but you can also use
7454 @code{gnus-Folder-save-name}, which creates capitalized names.
7455
7456 @item gnus-summary-save-in-vm
7457 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-vm
7458 Save the article in a VM folder. You have to have the VM mail
7459 reader to use this setting.
7460 @end table
7461
7462 @vindex gnus-article-save-directory
7463 All of these functions, except for the last one, will save the article
7464 in the @code{gnus-article-save-directory}, which is initialized from the
7465 @env{SAVEDIR} environment variable. This is @file{~/News/} by
7466 default.
7467
7468 As you can see above, the functions use different functions to find a
7469 suitable name of a file to save the article in. Below is a list of
7470 available functions that generate names:
7471
7472 @table @code
7473
7474 @item gnus-Numeric-save-name
7475 @findex gnus-Numeric-save-name
7476 File names like @file{~/News/Alt.andrea-dworkin/45}.
7477
7478 @item gnus-numeric-save-name
7479 @findex gnus-numeric-save-name
7480 File names like @file{~/News/alt.andrea-dworkin/45}.
7481
7482 @item gnus-Plain-save-name
7483 @findex gnus-Plain-save-name
7484 File names like @file{~/News/Alt.andrea-dworkin}.
7485
7486 @item gnus-plain-save-name
7487 @findex gnus-plain-save-name
7488 File names like @file{~/News/alt.andrea-dworkin}.
7489
7490 @item gnus-sender-save-name
7491 @findex gnus-sender-save-name
7492 File names like @file{~/News/larsi}.
7493 @end table
7494
7495 @vindex gnus-split-methods
7496 You can have Gnus suggest where to save articles by plonking a regexp into
7497 the @code{gnus-split-methods} alist. For instance, if you would like to
7498 save articles related to Gnus in the file @file{gnus-stuff}, and articles
7499 related to VM in @file{vm-stuff}, you could set this variable to something
7500 like:
7501
7502 @lisp
7503 (("^Subject:.*gnus\\|^Newsgroups:.*gnus" "gnus-stuff")
7504 ("^Subject:.*vm\\|^Xref:.*vm" "vm-stuff")
7505 (my-choosing-function "../other-dir/my-stuff")
7506 ((equal gnus-newsgroup-name "mail.misc") "mail-stuff"))
7507 @end lisp
7508
7509 We see that this is a list where each element is a list that has two
7510 elements---the @dfn{match} and the @dfn{file}. The match can either be
7511 a string (in which case it is used as a regexp to match on the article
7512 head); it can be a symbol (which will be called as a function with the
7513 group name as a parameter); or it can be a list (which will be
7514 @code{eval}ed). If any of these actions have a non-@code{nil} result,
7515 the @dfn{file} will be used as a default prompt. In addition, the
7516 result of the operation itself will be used if the function or form
7517 called returns a string or a list of strings.
7518
7519 You basically end up with a list of file names that might be used when
7520 saving the current article. (All ``matches'' will be used.) You will
7521 then be prompted for what you really want to use as a name, with file
7522 name completion over the results from applying this variable.
7523
7524 This variable is @code{((gnus-article-archive-name))} by default, which
7525 means that Gnus will look at the articles it saves for an
7526 @code{Archive-name} line and use that as a suggestion for the file
7527 name.
7528
7529 Here's an example function to clean up file names somewhat. If you have
7530 lots of mail groups called things like
7531 @samp{nnml:mail.whatever}, you may want to chop off the beginning of
7532 these group names before creating the file name to save to. The
7533 following will do just that:
7534
7535 @lisp
7536 (defun my-save-name (group)
7537 (when (string-match "^nnml:mail." group)
7538 (substring group (match-end 0))))
7539
7540 (setq gnus-split-methods
7541 '((gnus-article-archive-name)
7542 (my-save-name)))
7543 @end lisp
7544
7545
7546 @vindex gnus-use-long-file-name
7547 Finally, you have the @code{gnus-use-long-file-name} variable. If it is
7548 @code{nil}, all the preceding functions will replace all periods
7549 (@samp{.}) in the group names with slashes (@samp{/})---which means that
7550 the functions will generate hierarchies of directories instead of having
7551 all the files in the top level directory
7552 (@file{~/News/alt/andrea-dworkin} instead of
7553 @file{~/News/alt.andrea-dworkin}.) This variable is @code{t} by default
7554 on most systems. However, for historical reasons, this is @code{nil} on
7555 Xenix and usg-unix-v machines by default.
7556
7557 This function also affects kill and score file names. If this variable
7558 is a list, and the list contains the element @code{not-score}, long file
7559 names will not be used for score files, if it contains the element
7560 @code{not-save}, long file names will not be used for saving, and if it
7561 contains the element @code{not-kill}, long file names will not be used
7562 for kill files.
7563
7564 If you'd like to save articles in a hierarchy that looks something like
7565 a spool, you could
7566
7567 @lisp
7568 (setq gnus-use-long-file-name '(not-save)) ; @r{to get a hierarchy}
7569 (setq gnus-default-article-saver
7570 'gnus-summary-save-in-file) ; @r{no encoding}
7571 @end lisp
7572
7573 Then just save with @kbd{o}. You'd then read this hierarchy with
7574 ephemeral @code{nneething} groups---@kbd{G D} in the group buffer, and
7575 the top level directory as the argument (@file{~/News/}). Then just walk
7576 around to the groups/directories with @code{nneething}.
7577
7578
7579 @node Decoding Articles
7580 @section Decoding Articles
7581 @cindex decoding articles
7582
7583 Sometime users post articles (or series of articles) that have been
7584 encoded in some way or other. Gnus can decode them for you.
7585
7586 @menu
7587 * Uuencoded Articles:: Uudecode articles.
7588 * Shell Archives:: Unshar articles.
7589 * PostScript Files:: Split PostScript.
7590 * Other Files:: Plain save and binhex.
7591 * Decoding Variables:: Variables for a happy decoding.
7592 * Viewing Files:: You want to look at the result of the decoding?
7593 @end menu
7594
7595 @cindex series
7596 @cindex article series
7597 All these functions use the process/prefix convention
7598 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}) for finding out what articles to work on, with
7599 the extension that a ``single article'' means ``a single series''. Gnus
7600 can find out by itself what articles belong to a series, decode all the
7601 articles and unpack/view/save the resulting file(s).
7602
7603 Gnus guesses what articles are in the series according to the following
7604 simplish rule: The subjects must be (nearly) identical, except for the
7605 last two numbers of the line. (Spaces are largely ignored, however.)
7606
7607 For example: If you choose a subject called @samp{cat.gif (2/3)}, Gnus
7608 will find all the articles that match the regexp @samp{^cat.gif
7609 ([0-9]+/[0-9]+).*$}.
7610
7611 Subjects that are non-standard, like @samp{cat.gif (2/3) Part 6 of a
7612 series}, will not be properly recognized by any of the automatic viewing
7613 commands, and you have to mark the articles manually with @kbd{#}.
7614
7615
7616 @node Uuencoded Articles
7617 @subsection Uuencoded Articles
7618 @cindex uudecode
7619 @cindex uuencoded articles
7620
7621 @table @kbd
7622
7623 @item X u
7624 @kindex X u (Summary)
7625 @findex gnus-uu-decode-uu
7626 @c @icon{gnus-uu-decode-uu}
7627 Uudecodes the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu}).
7628
7629 @item X U
7630 @kindex X U (Summary)
7631 @findex gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save
7632 Uudecodes and saves the current series
7633 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save}).
7634
7635 @item X v u
7636 @kindex X v u (Summary)
7637 @findex gnus-uu-decode-uu-view
7638 Uudecodes and views the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu-view}).
7639
7640 @item X v U
7641 @kindex X v U (Summary)
7642 @findex gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save-view
7643 Uudecodes, views and saves the current series
7644 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save-view}).
7645
7646 @end table
7647
7648 Remember that these all react to the presence of articles marked with
7649 the process mark. If, for instance, you'd like to decode and save an
7650 entire newsgroup, you'd typically do @kbd{M P a}
7651 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-all}) and then @kbd{X U}
7652 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save}).
7653
7654 All this is very much different from how @code{gnus-uu} worked with
7655 @sc{gnus 4.1}, where you had explicit keystrokes for everything under
7656 the sun. This version of @code{gnus-uu} generally assumes that you mark
7657 articles in some way (@pxref{Setting Process Marks}) and then press
7658 @kbd{X u}.
7659
7660 @vindex gnus-uu-notify-files
7661 Note: When trying to decode articles that have names matching
7662 @code{gnus-uu-notify-files}, which is hard-coded to
7663 @samp{[Cc][Ii][Nn][Dd][Yy][0-9]+.\\(gif\\|jpg\\)}, @code{gnus-uu} will
7664 automatically post an article on @samp{comp.unix.wizards} saying that
7665 you have just viewed the file in question. This feature can't be turned
7666 off.
7667
7668
7669 @node Shell Archives
7670 @subsection Shell Archives
7671 @cindex unshar
7672 @cindex shell archives
7673 @cindex shared articles
7674
7675 Shell archives (``shar files'') used to be a popular way to distribute
7676 sources, but it isn't used all that much today. In any case, we have
7677 some commands to deal with these:
7678
7679 @table @kbd
7680
7681 @item X s
7682 @kindex X s (Summary)
7683 @findex gnus-uu-decode-unshar
7684 Unshars the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-unshar}).
7685
7686 @item X S
7687 @kindex X S (Summary)
7688 @findex gnus-uu-decode-unshar-and-save
7689 Unshars and saves the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-unshar-and-save}).
7690
7691 @item X v s
7692 @kindex X v s (Summary)
7693 @findex gnus-uu-decode-unshar-view
7694 Unshars and views the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-unshar-view}).
7695
7696 @item X v S
7697 @kindex X v S (Summary)
7698 @findex gnus-uu-decode-unshar-and-save-view
7699 Unshars, views and saves the current series
7700 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-unshar-and-save-view}).
7701 @end table
7702
7703
7704 @node PostScript Files
7705 @subsection PostScript Files
7706 @cindex PostScript
7707
7708 @table @kbd
7709
7710 @item X p
7711 @kindex X p (Summary)
7712 @findex gnus-uu-decode-postscript
7713 Unpack the current PostScript series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-postscript}).
7714
7715 @item X P
7716 @kindex X P (Summary)
7717 @findex gnus-uu-decode-postscript-and-save
7718 Unpack and save the current PostScript series
7719 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-postscript-and-save}).
7720
7721 @item X v p
7722 @kindex X v p (Summary)
7723 @findex gnus-uu-decode-postscript-view
7724 View the current PostScript series
7725 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-postscript-view}).
7726
7727 @item X v P
7728 @kindex X v P (Summary)
7729 @findex gnus-uu-decode-postscript-and-save-view
7730 View and save the current PostScript series
7731 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-postscript-and-save-view}).
7732 @end table
7733
7734
7735 @node Other Files
7736 @subsection Other Files
7737
7738 @table @kbd
7739 @item X o
7740 @kindex X o (Summary)
7741 @findex gnus-uu-decode-save
7742 Save the current series
7743 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-save}).
7744
7745 @item X b
7746 @kindex X b (Summary)
7747 @findex gnus-uu-decode-binhex
7748 Unbinhex the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-binhex}). This
7749 doesn't really work yet.
7750 @end table
7751
7752
7753 @node Decoding Variables
7754 @subsection Decoding Variables
7755
7756 Adjective, not verb.
7757
7758 @menu
7759 * Rule Variables:: Variables that say how a file is to be viewed.
7760 * Other Decode Variables:: Other decode variables.
7761 * Uuencoding and Posting:: Variables for customizing uuencoding.
7762 @end menu
7763
7764
7765 @node Rule Variables
7766 @subsubsection Rule Variables
7767 @cindex rule variables
7768
7769 Gnus uses @dfn{rule variables} to decide how to view a file. All these
7770 variables are of the form
7771
7772 @lisp
7773 (list '(regexp1 command2)
7774 '(regexp2 command2)
7775 ...)
7776 @end lisp
7777
7778 @table @code
7779
7780 @item gnus-uu-user-view-rules
7781 @vindex gnus-uu-user-view-rules
7782 @cindex sox
7783 This variable is consulted first when viewing files. If you wish to use,
7784 for instance, @code{sox} to convert an @file{.au} sound file, you could
7785 say something like:
7786 @lisp
7787 (setq gnus-uu-user-view-rules
7788 (list '("\\\\.au$" "sox %s -t .aiff > /dev/audio")))
7789 @end lisp
7790
7791 @item gnus-uu-user-view-rules-end
7792 @vindex gnus-uu-user-view-rules-end
7793 This variable is consulted if Gnus couldn't make any matches from the
7794 user and default view rules.
7795
7796 @item gnus-uu-user-archive-rules
7797 @vindex gnus-uu-user-archive-rules
7798 This variable can be used to say what commands should be used to unpack
7799 archives.
7800 @end table
7801
7802
7803 @node Other Decode Variables
7804 @subsubsection Other Decode Variables
7805
7806 @table @code
7807 @vindex gnus-uu-grabbed-file-functions
7808
7809 @item gnus-uu-grabbed-file-functions
7810 All functions in this list will be called right after each file has been
7811 successfully decoded---so that you can move or view files right away,
7812 and don't have to wait for all files to be decoded before you can do
7813 anything. Ready-made functions you can put in this list are:
7814
7815 @table @code
7816
7817 @item gnus-uu-grab-view
7818 @findex gnus-uu-grab-view
7819 View the file.
7820
7821 @item gnus-uu-grab-move
7822 @findex gnus-uu-grab-move
7823 Move the file (if you're using a saving function.)
7824 @end table
7825
7826 @item gnus-uu-be-dangerous
7827 @vindex gnus-uu-be-dangerous
7828 Specifies what to do if unusual situations arise during decoding. If
7829 @code{nil}, be as conservative as possible. If @code{t}, ignore things
7830 that didn't work, and overwrite existing files. Otherwise, ask each
7831 time.
7832
7833 @item gnus-uu-ignore-files-by-name
7834 @vindex gnus-uu-ignore-files-by-name
7835 Files with name matching this regular expression won't be viewed.
7836
7837 @item gnus-uu-ignore-files-by-type
7838 @vindex gnus-uu-ignore-files-by-type
7839 Files with a @acronym{MIME} type matching this variable won't be viewed.
7840 Note that Gnus tries to guess what type the file is based on the name.
7841 @code{gnus-uu} is not a @acronym{MIME} package (yet), so this is slightly
7842 kludgey.
7843
7844 @item gnus-uu-tmp-dir
7845 @vindex gnus-uu-tmp-dir
7846 Where @code{gnus-uu} does its work.
7847
7848 @item gnus-uu-do-not-unpack-archives
7849 @vindex gnus-uu-do-not-unpack-archives
7850 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} won't peek inside archives
7851 looking for files to display.
7852
7853 @item gnus-uu-view-and-save
7854 @vindex gnus-uu-view-and-save
7855 Non-@code{nil} means that the user will always be asked to save a file
7856 after viewing it.
7857
7858 @item gnus-uu-ignore-default-view-rules
7859 @vindex gnus-uu-ignore-default-view-rules
7860 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will ignore the default viewing
7861 rules.
7862
7863 @item gnus-uu-ignore-default-archive-rules
7864 @vindex gnus-uu-ignore-default-archive-rules
7865 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will ignore the default archive
7866 unpacking commands.
7867
7868 @item gnus-uu-kill-carriage-return
7869 @vindex gnus-uu-kill-carriage-return
7870 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will strip all carriage returns
7871 from articles.
7872
7873 @item gnus-uu-unmark-articles-not-decoded
7874 @vindex gnus-uu-unmark-articles-not-decoded
7875 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will mark unsuccessfully
7876 decoded articles as unread.
7877
7878 @item gnus-uu-correct-stripped-uucode
7879 @vindex gnus-uu-correct-stripped-uucode
7880 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will @emph{try} to fix
7881 uuencoded files that have had trailing spaces deleted.
7882
7883 @item gnus-uu-pre-uudecode-hook
7884 @vindex gnus-uu-pre-uudecode-hook
7885 Hook run before sending a message to @code{uudecode}.
7886
7887 @item gnus-uu-view-with-metamail
7888 @vindex gnus-uu-view-with-metamail
7889 @cindex metamail
7890 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will ignore the viewing
7891 commands defined by the rule variables and just fudge a @acronym{MIME}
7892 content type based on the file name. The result will be fed to
7893 @code{metamail} for viewing.
7894
7895 @item gnus-uu-save-in-digest
7896 @vindex gnus-uu-save-in-digest
7897 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu}, when asked to save without
7898 decoding, will save in digests. If this variable is @code{nil},
7899 @code{gnus-uu} will just save everything in a file without any
7900 embellishments. The digesting almost conforms to RFC 1153---no easy way
7901 to specify any meaningful volume and issue numbers were found, so I
7902 simply dropped them.
7903
7904 @end table
7905
7906
7907 @node Uuencoding and Posting
7908 @subsubsection Uuencoding and Posting
7909
7910 @table @code
7911
7912 @item gnus-uu-post-include-before-composing
7913 @vindex gnus-uu-post-include-before-composing
7914 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will ask for a file to encode
7915 before you compose the article. If this variable is @code{t}, you can
7916 either include an encoded file with @kbd{C-c C-i} or have one included
7917 for you when you post the article.
7918
7919 @item gnus-uu-post-length
7920 @vindex gnus-uu-post-length
7921 Maximum length of an article. The encoded file will be split into how
7922 many articles it takes to post the entire file.
7923
7924 @item gnus-uu-post-threaded
7925 @vindex gnus-uu-post-threaded
7926 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will post the encoded file in a
7927 thread. This may not be smart, as no other decoder I have seen is able
7928 to follow threads when collecting uuencoded articles. (Well, I have
7929 seen one package that does that---@code{gnus-uu}, but somehow, I don't
7930 think that counts@dots{}) Default is @code{nil}.
7931
7932 @item gnus-uu-post-separate-description
7933 @vindex gnus-uu-post-separate-description
7934 Non-@code{nil} means that the description will be posted in a separate
7935 article. The first article will typically be numbered (0/x). If this
7936 variable is @code{nil}, the description the user enters will be included
7937 at the beginning of the first article, which will be numbered (1/x).
7938 Default is @code{t}.
7939
7940 @end table
7941
7942
7943 @node Viewing Files
7944 @subsection Viewing Files
7945 @cindex viewing files
7946 @cindex pseudo-articles
7947
7948 After decoding, if the file is some sort of archive, Gnus will attempt
7949 to unpack the archive and see if any of the files in the archive can be
7950 viewed. For instance, if you have a gzipped tar file @file{pics.tar.gz}
7951 containing the files @file{pic1.jpg} and @file{pic2.gif}, Gnus will
7952 uncompress and de-tar the main file, and then view the two pictures.
7953 This unpacking process is recursive, so if the archive contains archives
7954 of archives, it'll all be unpacked.
7955
7956 Finally, Gnus will normally insert a @dfn{pseudo-article} for each
7957 extracted file into the summary buffer. If you go to these
7958 ``articles'', you will be prompted for a command to run (usually Gnus
7959 will make a suggestion), and then the command will be run.
7960
7961 @vindex gnus-view-pseudo-asynchronously
7962 If @code{gnus-view-pseudo-asynchronously} is @code{nil}, Emacs will wait
7963 until the viewing is done before proceeding.
7964
7965 @vindex gnus-view-pseudos
7966 If @code{gnus-view-pseudos} is @code{automatic}, Gnus will not insert
7967 the pseudo-articles into the summary buffer, but view them
7968 immediately. If this variable is @code{not-confirm}, the user won't even
7969 be asked for a confirmation before viewing is done.
7970
7971 @vindex gnus-view-pseudos-separately
7972 If @code{gnus-view-pseudos-separately} is non-@code{nil}, one
7973 pseudo-article will be created for each file to be viewed. If
7974 @code{nil}, all files that use the same viewing command will be given as
7975 a list of parameters to that command.
7976
7977 @vindex gnus-insert-pseudo-articles
7978 If @code{gnus-insert-pseudo-articles} is non-@code{nil}, insert
7979 pseudo-articles when decoding. It is @code{t} by default.
7980
7981 So; there you are, reading your @emph{pseudo-articles} in your
7982 @emph{virtual newsgroup} from the @emph{virtual server}; and you think:
7983 Why isn't anything real anymore? How did we get here?
7984
7985
7986 @node Article Treatment
7987 @section Article Treatment
7988
7989 Reading through this huge manual, you may have quite forgotten that the
7990 object of newsreaders is to actually, like, read what people have
7991 written. Reading articles. Unfortunately, people are quite bad at
7992 writing, so there are tons of functions and variables to make reading
7993 these articles easier.
7994
7995 @menu
7996 * Article Highlighting:: You want to make the article look like fruit salad.
7997 * Article Fontisizing:: Making emphasized text look nice.
7998 * Article Hiding:: You also want to make certain info go away.
7999 * Article Washing:: Lots of way-neat functions to make life better.
8000 * Article Header:: Doing various header transformations.
8001 * Article Buttons:: Click on URLs, Message-IDs, addresses and the like.
8002 * Article Button Levels:: Controlling appearance of buttons.
8003 * Article Date:: Grumble, UT!
8004 * Article Display:: Display various stuff---X-Face, Picons, Smileys
8005 * Article Signature:: What is a signature?
8006 * Article Miscellanea:: Various other stuff.
8007 @end menu
8008
8009
8010 @node Article Highlighting
8011 @subsection Article Highlighting
8012 @cindex highlighting
8013
8014 Not only do you want your article buffer to look like fruit salad, but
8015 you want it to look like technicolor fruit salad.
8016
8017 @table @kbd
8018
8019 @item W H a
8020 @kindex W H a (Summary)
8021 @findex gnus-article-highlight
8022 @findex gnus-article-maybe-highlight
8023 Do much highlighting of the current article
8024 (@code{gnus-article-highlight}). This function highlights header, cited
8025 text, the signature, and adds buttons to the body and the head.
8026
8027 @item W H h
8028 @kindex W H h (Summary)
8029 @findex gnus-article-highlight-headers
8030 @vindex gnus-header-face-alist
8031 Highlight the headers (@code{gnus-article-highlight-headers}). The
8032 highlighting will be done according to the @code{gnus-header-face-alist}
8033 variable, which is a list where each element has the form
8034 @code{(@var{regexp} @var{name} @var{content})}.
8035 @var{regexp} is a regular expression for matching the
8036 header, @var{name} is the face used for highlighting the header name
8037 (@pxref{Faces and Fonts}) and @var{content} is the face for highlighting
8038 the header value. The first match made will be used. Note that
8039 @var{regexp} shouldn't have @samp{^} prepended---Gnus will add one.
8040
8041 @item W H c
8042 @kindex W H c (Summary)
8043 @findex gnus-article-highlight-citation
8044 Highlight cited text (@code{gnus-article-highlight-citation}).
8045
8046 Some variables to customize the citation highlights:
8047
8048 @table @code
8049 @vindex gnus-cite-parse-max-size
8050
8051 @item gnus-cite-parse-max-size
8052 If the article size if bigger than this variable (which is 25000 by
8053 default), no citation highlighting will be performed.
8054
8055 @item gnus-cite-max-prefix
8056 @vindex gnus-cite-max-prefix
8057 Maximum possible length for a citation prefix (default 20).
8058
8059 @item gnus-cite-face-list
8060 @vindex gnus-cite-face-list
8061 List of faces used for highlighting citations (@pxref{Faces and Fonts}).
8062 When there are citations from multiple articles in the same message,
8063 Gnus will try to give each citation from each article its own face.
8064 This should make it easier to see who wrote what.
8065
8066 @item gnus-supercite-regexp
8067 @vindex gnus-supercite-regexp
8068 Regexp matching normal Supercite attribution lines.
8069
8070 @item gnus-supercite-secondary-regexp
8071 @vindex gnus-supercite-secondary-regexp
8072 Regexp matching mangled Supercite attribution lines.
8073
8074 @item gnus-cite-minimum-match-count
8075 @vindex gnus-cite-minimum-match-count
8076 Minimum number of identical prefixes we have to see before we believe
8077 that it's a citation.
8078
8079 @item gnus-cite-attribution-prefix
8080 @vindex gnus-cite-attribution-prefix
8081 Regexp matching the beginning of an attribution line.
8082
8083 @item gnus-cite-attribution-suffix
8084 @vindex gnus-cite-attribution-suffix
8085 Regexp matching the end of an attribution line.
8086
8087 @item gnus-cite-attribution-face
8088 @vindex gnus-cite-attribution-face
8089 Face used for attribution lines. It is merged with the face for the
8090 cited text belonging to the attribution.
8091
8092 @item gnus-cite-ignore-quoted-from
8093 @vindex gnus-cite-ignore-quoted-from
8094 If non-@code{nil}, no citation highlighting will be performed on lines
8095 beginning with @samp{>From }. Those lines may have been quoted by MTAs
8096 in order not to mix up with the envelope From line. The default value
8097 is @code{t}.
8098
8099 @end table
8100
8101
8102 @item W H s
8103 @kindex W H s (Summary)
8104 @vindex gnus-signature-separator
8105 @vindex gnus-signature-face
8106 @findex gnus-article-highlight-signature
8107 Highlight the signature (@code{gnus-article-highlight-signature}).
8108 Everything after @code{gnus-signature-separator} (@pxref{Article
8109 Signature}) in an article will be considered a signature and will be
8110 highlighted with @code{gnus-signature-face}, which is @code{italic} by
8111 default.
8112
8113 @end table
8114
8115 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to highlight articles automatically.
8116
8117
8118 @node Article Fontisizing
8119 @subsection Article Fontisizing
8120 @cindex emphasis
8121 @cindex article emphasis
8122
8123 @findex gnus-article-emphasize
8124 @kindex W e (Summary)
8125 People commonly add emphasis to words in news articles by writing things
8126 like @samp{_this_} or @samp{*this*} or @samp{/this/}. Gnus can make
8127 this look nicer by running the article through the @kbd{W e}
8128 (@code{gnus-article-emphasize}) command.
8129
8130 @vindex gnus-emphasis-alist
8131 How the emphasis is computed is controlled by the
8132 @code{gnus-emphasis-alist} variable. This is an alist where the first
8133 element is a regular expression to be matched. The second is a number
8134 that says what regular expression grouping is used to find the entire
8135 emphasized word. The third is a number that says what regexp grouping
8136 should be displayed and highlighted. (The text between these two
8137 groupings will be hidden.) The fourth is the face used for
8138 highlighting.
8139
8140 @lisp
8141 (setq gnus-emphasis-alist
8142 '(("_\\(\\w+\\)_" 0 1 gnus-emphasis-underline)
8143 ("\\*\\(\\w+\\)\\*" 0 1 gnus-emphasis-bold)))
8144 @end lisp
8145
8146 @cindex slash
8147 @cindex asterisk
8148 @cindex underline
8149 @cindex /
8150 @cindex *
8151
8152 @vindex gnus-emphasis-underline
8153 @vindex gnus-emphasis-bold
8154 @vindex gnus-emphasis-italic
8155 @vindex gnus-emphasis-underline-bold
8156 @vindex gnus-emphasis-underline-italic
8157 @vindex gnus-emphasis-bold-italic
8158 @vindex gnus-emphasis-underline-bold-italic
8159 By default, there are seven rules, and they use the following faces:
8160 @code{gnus-emphasis-bold}, @code{gnus-emphasis-italic},
8161 @code{gnus-emphasis-underline}, @code{gnus-emphasis-bold-italic},
8162 @code{gnus-emphasis-underline-italic},
8163 @code{gnus-emphasis-underline-bold}, and
8164 @code{gnus-emphasis-underline-bold-italic}.
8165
8166 If you want to change these faces, you can either use @kbd{M-x
8167 customize}, or you can use @code{copy-face}. For instance, if you want
8168 to make @code{gnus-emphasis-italic} use a red face instead, you could
8169 say something like:
8170
8171 @lisp
8172 (copy-face 'red 'gnus-emphasis-italic)
8173 @end lisp
8174
8175 @vindex gnus-group-highlight-words-alist
8176
8177 If you want to highlight arbitrary words, you can use the
8178 @code{gnus-group-highlight-words-alist} variable, which uses the same
8179 syntax as @code{gnus-emphasis-alist}. The @code{highlight-words} group
8180 parameter (@pxref{Group Parameters}) can also be used.
8181
8182 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to fontize articles automatically.
8183
8184
8185 @node Article Hiding
8186 @subsection Article Hiding
8187 @cindex article hiding
8188
8189 Or rather, hiding certain things in each article. There usually is much
8190 too much cruft in most articles.
8191
8192 @table @kbd
8193
8194 @item W W a
8195 @kindex W W a (Summary)
8196 @findex gnus-article-hide
8197 Do quite a lot of hiding on the article buffer
8198 (@kbd{gnus-article-hide}). In particular, this function will hide
8199 headers, @acronym{PGP}, cited text and the signature.
8200
8201 @item W W h
8202 @kindex W W h (Summary)
8203 @findex gnus-article-hide-headers
8204 Hide headers (@code{gnus-article-hide-headers}). @xref{Hiding
8205 Headers}.
8206
8207 @item W W b
8208 @kindex W W b (Summary)
8209 @findex gnus-article-hide-boring-headers
8210 Hide headers that aren't particularly interesting
8211 (@code{gnus-article-hide-boring-headers}). @xref{Hiding Headers}.
8212
8213 @item W W s
8214 @kindex W W s (Summary)
8215 @findex gnus-article-hide-signature
8216 Hide signature (@code{gnus-article-hide-signature}). @xref{Article
8217 Signature}.
8218
8219 @item W W l
8220 @kindex W W l (Summary)
8221 @findex gnus-article-hide-list-identifiers
8222 @vindex gnus-list-identifiers
8223 Strip list identifiers specified in @code{gnus-list-identifiers}. These
8224 are strings some mailing list servers add to the beginning of all
8225 @code{Subject} headers---for example, @samp{[zebra 4711]}. Any leading
8226 @samp{Re: } is skipped before stripping. @code{gnus-list-identifiers}
8227 may not contain @code{\\(..\\)}.
8228
8229 @table @code
8230
8231 @item gnus-list-identifiers
8232 @vindex gnus-list-identifiers
8233 A regular expression that matches list identifiers to be removed from
8234 subject. This can also be a list of regular expressions.
8235
8236 @end table
8237
8238 @item W W P
8239 @kindex W W P (Summary)
8240 @findex gnus-article-hide-pem
8241 Hide @acronym{PEM} (privacy enhanced messages) cruft
8242 (@code{gnus-article-hide-pem}).
8243
8244 @item W W B
8245 @kindex W W B (Summary)
8246 @findex gnus-article-strip-banner
8247 @vindex gnus-article-banner-alist
8248 @vindex gnus-article-address-banner-alist
8249 @cindex banner
8250 @cindex OneList
8251 @cindex stripping advertisements
8252 @cindex advertisements
8253 Strip the banner specified by the @code{banner} group parameter
8254 (@code{gnus-article-strip-banner}). This is mainly used to hide those
8255 annoying banners and/or signatures that some mailing lists and moderated
8256 groups adds to all the messages. The way to use this function is to add
8257 the @code{banner} group parameter (@pxref{Group Parameters}) to the
8258 group you want banners stripped from. The parameter either be a string,
8259 which will be interpreted as a regular expression matching text to be
8260 removed, or the symbol @code{signature}, meaning that the (last)
8261 signature should be removed, or other symbol, meaning that the
8262 corresponding regular expression in @code{gnus-article-banner-alist} is
8263 used.
8264
8265 Regardless of a group, you can hide things like advertisements only when
8266 the sender of an article has a certain mail address specified in
8267 @code{gnus-article-address-banner-alist}.
8268
8269 @table @code
8270
8271 @item gnus-article-address-banner-alist
8272 @vindex gnus-article-address-banner-alist
8273 Alist of mail addresses and banners. Each element has the form
8274 @code{(@var{address} . @var{banner})}, where @var{address} is a regexp
8275 matching a mail address in the From header, @var{banner} is one of a
8276 symbol @code{signature}, an item in @code{gnus-article-banner-alist},
8277 a regexp and @code{nil}. If @var{address} matches author's mail
8278 address, it will remove things like advertisements. For example, if a
8279 sender has the mail address @samp{hail@@yoo-hoo.co.jp} and there is a
8280 banner something like @samp{Do You Yoo-hoo!?} in all articles he
8281 sends, you can use the following element to remove them:
8282
8283 @lisp
8284 ("@@yoo-hoo\\.co\\.jp\\'" .
8285 "\n_+\nDo You Yoo-hoo!\\?\n.*\n.*\n")
8286 @end lisp
8287
8288 @end table
8289
8290 @item W W c
8291 @kindex W W c (Summary)
8292 @findex gnus-article-hide-citation
8293 Hide citation (@code{gnus-article-hide-citation}). Some variables for
8294 customizing the hiding:
8295
8296 @table @code
8297
8298 @item gnus-cited-opened-text-button-line-format
8299 @itemx gnus-cited-closed-text-button-line-format
8300 @vindex gnus-cited-closed-text-button-line-format
8301 @vindex gnus-cited-opened-text-button-line-format
8302 Gnus adds buttons to show where the cited text has been hidden, and to
8303 allow toggle hiding the text. The format of the variable is specified
8304 by these format-like variable (@pxref{Formatting Variables}). These
8305 specs are valid:
8306
8307 @table @samp
8308 @item b
8309 Starting point of the hidden text.
8310 @item e
8311 Ending point of the hidden text.
8312 @item l
8313 Number of characters in the hidden region.
8314 @item n
8315 Number of lines of hidden text.
8316 @end table
8317
8318 @item gnus-cited-lines-visible
8319 @vindex gnus-cited-lines-visible
8320 The number of lines at the beginning of the cited text to leave
8321 shown. This can also be a cons cell with the number of lines at the top
8322 and bottom of the text, respectively, to remain visible.
8323
8324 @end table
8325
8326 @item W W C-c
8327 @kindex W W C-c (Summary)
8328 @findex gnus-article-hide-citation-maybe
8329
8330 Hide citation (@code{gnus-article-hide-citation-maybe}) depending on the
8331 following two variables:
8332
8333 @table @code
8334 @item gnus-cite-hide-percentage
8335 @vindex gnus-cite-hide-percentage
8336 If the cited text is of a bigger percentage than this variable (default
8337 50), hide the cited text.
8338
8339 @item gnus-cite-hide-absolute
8340 @vindex gnus-cite-hide-absolute
8341 The cited text must have at least this length (default 10) before it
8342 is hidden.
8343 @end table
8344
8345 @item W W C
8346 @kindex W W C (Summary)
8347 @findex gnus-article-hide-citation-in-followups
8348 Hide cited text in articles that aren't roots
8349 (@code{gnus-article-hide-citation-in-followups}). This isn't very
8350 useful as an interactive command, but might be a handy function to stick
8351 have happen automatically (@pxref{Customizing Articles}).
8352
8353 @end table
8354
8355 All these ``hiding'' commands are toggles, but if you give a negative
8356 prefix to these commands, they will show what they have previously
8357 hidden. If you give a positive prefix, they will always hide.
8358
8359 Also @pxref{Article Highlighting} for further variables for
8360 citation customization.
8361
8362 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to hide article elements
8363 automatically.
8364
8365
8366 @node Article Washing
8367 @subsection Article Washing
8368 @cindex washing
8369 @cindex article washing
8370
8371 We call this ``article washing'' for a really good reason. Namely, the
8372 @kbd{A} key was taken, so we had to use the @kbd{W} key instead.
8373
8374 @dfn{Washing} is defined by us as ``changing something from something to
8375 something else'', but normally results in something looking better.
8376 Cleaner, perhaps.
8377
8378 @xref{Customizing Articles}, if you want to change how Gnus displays
8379 articles by default.
8380
8381 @table @kbd
8382
8383 @item C-u g
8384 This is not really washing, it's sort of the opposite of washing. If
8385 you type this, you see the article exactly as it exists on disk or on
8386 the server.
8387
8388 @item g
8389 Force redisplaying of the current article
8390 (@code{gnus-summary-show-article}). This is also not really washing.
8391 If you type this, you see the article without any previously applied
8392 interactive Washing functions but with all default treatments
8393 (@pxref{Customizing Articles}).
8394
8395 @item W l
8396 @kindex W l (Summary)
8397 @findex gnus-summary-stop-page-breaking
8398 Remove page breaks from the current article
8399 (@code{gnus-summary-stop-page-breaking}). @xref{Misc Article}, for page
8400 delimiters.
8401
8402 @item W r
8403 @kindex W r (Summary)
8404 @findex gnus-summary-caesar-message
8405 @c @icon{gnus-summary-caesar-message}
8406 Do a Caesar rotate (rot13) on the article buffer
8407 (@code{gnus-summary-caesar-message}).
8408 Unreadable articles that tell you to read them with Caesar rotate or rot13.
8409 (Typically offensive jokes and such.)
8410
8411 It's commonly called ``rot13'' because each letter is rotated 13
8412 positions in the alphabet, e. g. @samp{B} (letter #2) -> @samp{O} (letter
8413 #15). It is sometimes referred to as ``Caesar rotate'' because Caesar
8414 is rumored to have employed this form of, uh, somewhat weak encryption.
8415
8416 @item W m
8417 @kindex W m (Summary)
8418 @findex gnus-summary-morse-message
8419 Morse decode the article buffer (@code{gnus-summary-morse-message}).
8420
8421 @item W t
8422 @item t
8423 @kindex W t (Summary)
8424 @kindex t (Summary)
8425 @findex gnus-summary-toggle-header
8426 Toggle whether to display all headers in the article buffer
8427 (@code{gnus-summary-toggle-header}).
8428
8429 @item W v
8430 @kindex W v (Summary)
8431 @findex gnus-summary-verbose-headers
8432 Toggle whether to display all headers in the article buffer permanently
8433 (@code{gnus-summary-verbose-headers}).
8434
8435 @item W o
8436 @kindex W o (Summary)
8437 @findex gnus-article-treat-overstrike
8438 Treat overstrike (@code{gnus-article-treat-overstrike}).
8439
8440 @item W d
8441 @kindex W d (Summary)
8442 @findex gnus-article-treat-dumbquotes
8443 @vindex gnus-article-dumbquotes-map
8444 @cindex Smartquotes
8445 @cindex M****s*** sm*rtq**t*s
8446 @cindex Latin 1
8447 Treat M****s*** sm*rtq**t*s according to
8448 @code{gnus-article-dumbquotes-map}
8449 (@code{gnus-article-treat-dumbquotes}). Note that this function guesses
8450 whether a character is a sm*rtq**t* or not, so it should only be used
8451 interactively.
8452
8453 Sm*rtq**t*s are M****s***'s unilateral extension to the character map in
8454 an attempt to provide more quoting characters. If you see something
8455 like @code{\222} or @code{\264} where you're expecting some kind of
8456 apostrophe or quotation mark, then try this wash.
8457
8458 @item W Y f
8459 @kindex W Y f (Summary)
8460 @findex gnus-article-outlook-deuglify-article
8461 @cindex Outlook Express
8462 Full deuglify of broken Outlook (Express) articles: Treat dumbquotes,
8463 unwrap lines, repair attribution and rearrange citation.
8464 (@code{gnus-article-outlook-deuglify-article}).
8465
8466 @item W Y u
8467 @kindex W Y u (Summary)
8468 @findex gnus-article-outlook-unwrap-lines
8469 @vindex gnus-outlook-deuglify-unwrap-min
8470 @vindex gnus-outlook-deuglify-unwrap-max
8471 Unwrap lines that appear to be wrapped citation lines. You can control
8472 what lines will be unwrapped by frobbing
8473 @code{gnus-outlook-deuglify-unwrap-min} and
8474 @code{gnus-outlook-deuglify-unwrap-max}, indicating the minimum and
8475 maximum length of an unwrapped citation line.
8476 (@code{gnus-article-outlook-unwrap-lines}).
8477
8478 @item W Y a
8479 @kindex W Y a (Summary)
8480 @findex gnus-article-outlook-repair-attribution
8481 Repair a broken attribution line.@*
8482 (@code{gnus-article-outlook-repair-attribution}).
8483
8484 @item W Y c
8485 @kindex W Y c (Summary)
8486 @findex gnus-article-outlook-rearrange-citation
8487 Repair broken citations by rearranging the text.
8488 (@code{gnus-article-outlook-rearrange-citation}).
8489
8490 @item W w
8491 @kindex W w (Summary)
8492 @findex gnus-article-fill-cited-article
8493 Do word wrap (@code{gnus-article-fill-cited-article}).
8494
8495 You can give the command a numerical prefix to specify the width to use
8496 when filling.
8497
8498 @item W Q
8499 @kindex W Q (Summary)
8500 @findex gnus-article-fill-long-lines
8501 Fill long lines (@code{gnus-article-fill-long-lines}).
8502
8503 @item W C
8504 @kindex W C (Summary)
8505 @findex gnus-article-capitalize-sentences
8506 Capitalize the first word in each sentence
8507 (@code{gnus-article-capitalize-sentences}).
8508
8509 @item W c
8510 @kindex W c (Summary)
8511 @findex gnus-article-remove-cr
8512 Translate CRLF pairs (i. e., @samp{^M}s on the end of the lines) into LF
8513 (this takes care of DOS line endings), and then translate any remaining
8514 CRs into LF (this takes care of Mac line endings)
8515 (@code{gnus-article-remove-cr}).
8516
8517 @item W q
8518 @kindex W q (Summary)
8519 @findex gnus-article-de-quoted-unreadable
8520 Treat quoted-printable (@code{gnus-article-de-quoted-unreadable}).
8521 Quoted-Printable is one common @acronym{MIME} encoding employed when
8522 sending non-@acronym{ASCII} (i.e., 8-bit) articles. It typically
8523 makes strings like @samp{déjà vu} look like @samp{d=E9j=E0 vu}, which
8524 doesn't look very readable to me. Note that this is usually done
8525 automatically by Gnus if the message in question has a
8526 @code{Content-Transfer-Encoding} header that says that this encoding
8527 has been done. If a prefix is given, a charset will be asked for.
8528
8529 @item W 6
8530 @kindex W 6 (Summary)
8531 @findex gnus-article-de-base64-unreadable
8532 Treat base64 (@code{gnus-article-de-base64-unreadable}). Base64 is
8533 one common @acronym{MIME} encoding employed when sending
8534 non-@acronym{ASCII} (i.e., 8-bit) articles. Note that this is
8535 usually done automatically by Gnus if the message in question has a
8536 @code{Content-Transfer-Encoding} header that says that this encoding
8537 has been done. If a prefix is given, a charset will be asked for.
8538
8539 @item W Z
8540 @kindex W Z (Summary)
8541 @findex gnus-article-decode-HZ
8542 Treat HZ or HZP (@code{gnus-article-decode-HZ}). HZ (or HZP) is one
8543 common encoding employed when sending Chinese articles. It typically
8544 makes strings look like @samp{~@{<:Ky2;S@{#,NpJ)l6HK!#~@}}.
8545
8546 @item W u
8547 @kindex W u (Summary)
8548 @findex gnus-article-unsplit-urls
8549 Remove newlines from within URLs. Some mailers insert newlines into
8550 outgoing email messages to keep lines short. This reformatting can
8551 split long URLs onto multiple lines. Repair those URLs by removing
8552 the newlines (@code{gnus-article-unsplit-urls}).
8553
8554 @item W h
8555 @kindex W h (Summary)
8556 @findex gnus-article-wash-html
8557 Treat @acronym{HTML} (@code{gnus-article-wash-html}). Note that this is
8558 usually done automatically by Gnus if the message in question has a
8559 @code{Content-Type} header that says that the message is @acronym{HTML}.
8560
8561 If a prefix is given, a charset will be asked for.
8562
8563 @vindex gnus-article-wash-function
8564 The default is to use the function specified by
8565 @code{mm-text-html-renderer} (@pxref{Display Customization, ,Display
8566 Customization, emacs-mime, The Emacs MIME Manual}) to convert the
8567 @acronym{HTML}, but this is controlled by the
8568 @code{gnus-article-wash-function} variable. Pre-defined functions you
8569 can use include:
8570
8571 @table @code
8572 @item w3
8573 Use Emacs/w3.
8574
8575 @item w3m
8576 Use @uref{http://emacs-w3m.namazu.org/, emacs-w3m}.
8577
8578 @item links
8579 Use @uref{http://links.sf.net/, Links}.
8580
8581 @item lynx
8582 Use @uref{http://lynx.isc.org/, Lynx}.
8583
8584 @item html2text
8585 Use html2text---a simple @acronym{HTML} converter included with Gnus.
8586
8587 @end table
8588
8589 @item W b
8590 @kindex W b (Summary)
8591 @findex gnus-article-add-buttons
8592 Add clickable buttons to the article (@code{gnus-article-add-buttons}).
8593 @xref{Article Buttons}.
8594
8595 @item W B
8596 @kindex W B (Summary)
8597 @findex gnus-article-add-buttons-to-head
8598 Add clickable buttons to the article headers
8599 (@code{gnus-article-add-buttons-to-head}).
8600
8601 @item W p
8602 @kindex W p (Summary)
8603 @findex gnus-article-verify-x-pgp-sig
8604 Verify a signed control message
8605 (@code{gnus-article-verify-x-pgp-sig}). Control messages such as
8606 @code{newgroup} and @code{checkgroups} are usually signed by the
8607 hierarchy maintainer. You need to add the @acronym{PGP} public key of
8608 the maintainer to your keyring to verify the
8609 message.@footnote{@acronym{PGP} keys for many hierarchies are
8610 available at @uref{ftp://ftp.isc.org/pub/pgpcontrol/README.html}}
8611
8612 @item W s
8613 @kindex W s (Summary)
8614 @findex gnus-summary-force-verify-and-decrypt
8615 Verify a signed (@acronym{PGP}, @acronym{PGP/MIME} or
8616 @acronym{S/MIME}) message
8617 (@code{gnus-summary-force-verify-and-decrypt}). @xref{Security}.
8618
8619 @item W a
8620 @kindex W a (Summary)
8621 @findex gnus-article-strip-headers-in-body
8622 Strip headers like the @code{X-No-Archive} header from the beginning of
8623 article bodies (@code{gnus-article-strip-headers-in-body}).
8624
8625 @item W E l
8626 @kindex W E l (Summary)
8627 @findex gnus-article-strip-leading-blank-lines
8628 Remove all blank lines from the beginning of the article
8629 (@code{gnus-article-strip-leading-blank-lines}).
8630
8631 @item W E m
8632 @kindex W E m (Summary)
8633 @findex gnus-article-strip-multiple-blank-lines
8634 Replace all blank lines with empty lines and then all multiple empty
8635 lines with a single empty line.
8636 (@code{gnus-article-strip-multiple-blank-lines}).
8637
8638 @item W E t
8639 @kindex W E t (Summary)
8640 @findex gnus-article-remove-trailing-blank-lines
8641 Remove all blank lines at the end of the article
8642 (@code{gnus-article-remove-trailing-blank-lines}).
8643
8644 @item W E a
8645 @kindex W E a (Summary)
8646 @findex gnus-article-strip-blank-lines
8647 Do all the three commands above
8648 (@code{gnus-article-strip-blank-lines}).
8649
8650 @item W E A
8651 @kindex W E A (Summary)
8652 @findex gnus-article-strip-all-blank-lines
8653 Remove all blank lines
8654 (@code{gnus-article-strip-all-blank-lines}).
8655
8656 @item W E s
8657 @kindex W E s (Summary)
8658 @findex gnus-article-strip-leading-space
8659 Remove all white space from the beginning of all lines of the article
8660 body (@code{gnus-article-strip-leading-space}).
8661
8662 @item W E e
8663 @kindex W E e (Summary)
8664 @findex gnus-article-strip-trailing-space
8665 Remove all white space from the end of all lines of the article
8666 body (@code{gnus-article-strip-trailing-space}).
8667
8668 @end table
8669
8670 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to wash articles automatically.
8671
8672
8673 @node Article Header
8674 @subsection Article Header
8675
8676 These commands perform various transformations of article header.
8677
8678 @table @kbd
8679
8680 @item W G u
8681 @kindex W G u (Summary)
8682 @findex gnus-article-treat-unfold-headers
8683 Unfold folded header lines (@code{gnus-article-treat-unfold-headers}).
8684
8685 @item W G n
8686 @kindex W G n (Summary)
8687 @findex gnus-article-treat-fold-newsgroups
8688 Fold the @code{Newsgroups} and @code{Followup-To} headers
8689 (@code{gnus-article-treat-fold-newsgroups}).
8690
8691 @item W G f
8692 @kindex W G f (Summary)
8693 @findex gnus-article-treat-fold-headers
8694 Fold all the message headers
8695 (@code{gnus-article-treat-fold-headers}).
8696
8697 @item W E w
8698 @kindex W E w (Summary)
8699 @findex gnus-article-remove-leading-whitespace
8700 Remove excessive whitespace from all headers
8701 (@code{gnus-article-remove-leading-whitespace}).
8702
8703 @end table
8704
8705
8706 @node Article Buttons
8707 @subsection Article Buttons
8708 @cindex buttons
8709
8710 People often include references to other stuff in articles, and it would
8711 be nice if Gnus could just fetch whatever it is that people talk about
8712 with the minimum of fuzz when you hit @kbd{RET} or use the middle mouse
8713 button on these references.
8714
8715 @vindex gnus-button-man-handler
8716 Gnus adds @dfn{buttons} to certain standard references by default:
8717 Well-formed URLs, mail addresses, Message-IDs, Info links, man pages and
8718 Emacs or Gnus related references. This is controlled by two variables,
8719 one that handles article bodies and one that handles article heads:
8720
8721 @table @code
8722
8723 @item gnus-button-alist
8724 @vindex gnus-button-alist
8725 This is an alist where each entry has this form:
8726
8727 @lisp
8728 (@var{regexp} @var{button-par} @var{use-p} @var{function} @var{data-par})
8729 @end lisp
8730
8731 @table @var
8732
8733 @item regexp
8734 All text that match this regular expression (case insensitive) will be
8735 considered an external reference. Here's a typical regexp that matches
8736 embedded URLs: @samp{<URL:\\([^\n\r>]*\\)>}. This can also be a
8737 variable containing a regexp, useful variables to use include
8738 @code{gnus-button-url-regexp} and @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-regexp}.
8739
8740 @item button-par
8741 Gnus has to know which parts of the matches is to be highlighted. This
8742 is a number that says what sub-expression of the regexp is to be
8743 highlighted. If you want it all highlighted, you use 0 here.
8744
8745 @item use-p
8746 This form will be @code{eval}ed, and if the result is non-@code{nil},
8747 this is considered a match. This is useful if you want extra sifting to
8748 avoid false matches. Often variables named
8749 @code{gnus-button-@var{*}-level} are used here, @xref{Article Button
8750 Levels}, but any other form may be used too.
8751
8752 @c @code{use-p} is @code{eval}ed only if @code{regexp} matches.
8753
8754 @item function
8755 This function will be called when you click on this button.
8756
8757 @item data-par
8758 As with @var{button-par}, this is a sub-expression number, but this one
8759 says which part of the match is to be sent as data to @var{function}.
8760
8761 @end table
8762
8763 So the full entry for buttonizing URLs is then
8764
8765 @lisp
8766 ("<URL:\\([^\n\r>]*\\)>" 0 t gnus-button-url 1)
8767 @end lisp
8768
8769 @item gnus-header-button-alist
8770 @vindex gnus-header-button-alist
8771 This is just like the other alist, except that it is applied to the
8772 article head only, and that each entry has an additional element that is
8773 used to say what headers to apply the buttonize coding to:
8774
8775 @lisp
8776 (@var{header} @var{regexp} @var{button-par} @var{use-p} @var{function} @var{data-par})
8777 @end lisp
8778
8779 @var{header} is a regular expression.
8780 @end table
8781
8782 @subsubsection Related variables and functions
8783
8784 @table @code
8785 @item gnus-button-@var{*}-level
8786 @xref{Article Button Levels}.
8787
8788 @c Stuff related to gnus-button-browse-level
8789
8790 @item gnus-button-url-regexp
8791 @vindex gnus-button-url-regexp
8792 A regular expression that matches embedded URLs. It is used in the
8793 default values of the variables above.
8794
8795 @c Stuff related to gnus-button-man-level
8796
8797 @item gnus-button-man-handler
8798 @vindex gnus-button-man-handler
8799 The function to use for displaying man pages. It must take at least one
8800 argument with a string naming the man page.
8801
8802 @c Stuff related to gnus-button-message-level
8803
8804 @item gnus-button-mid-or-mail-regexp
8805 @vindex gnus-button-mid-or-mail-regexp
8806 Regular expression that matches a message ID or a mail address.
8807
8808 @item gnus-button-prefer-mid-or-mail
8809 @vindex gnus-button-prefer-mid-or-mail
8810 This variable determines what to do when the button on a string as
8811 @samp{foo123@@bar.invalid} is pushed. Strings like this can be either a
8812 message ID or a mail address. If it is one of the symbols @code{mid} or
8813 @code{mail}, Gnus will always assume that the string is a message ID or
8814 a mail address, respectively. If this variable is set to the symbol
8815 @code{ask}, always query the user what do do. If it is a function, this
8816 function will be called with the string as its only argument. The
8817 function must return @code{mid}, @code{mail}, @code{invalid} or
8818 @code{ask}. The default value is the function
8819 @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic}.
8820
8821 @item gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic
8822 @findex gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic
8823 Function that guesses whether its argument is a message ID or a mail
8824 address. Returns @code{mid} if it's a message IDs, @code{mail} if
8825 it's a mail address, @code{ask} if unsure and @code{invalid} if the
8826 string is invalid.
8827
8828 @item gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic-alist
8829 @vindex gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic-alist
8830 An alist of @code{(RATE . REGEXP)} pairs used by the function
8831 @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic}.
8832
8833 @c Stuff related to gnus-button-tex-level
8834
8835 @item gnus-button-ctan-handler
8836 @findex gnus-button-ctan-handler
8837 The function to use for displaying CTAN links. It must take one
8838 argument, the string naming the URL.
8839
8840 @item gnus-ctan-url
8841 @vindex gnus-ctan-url
8842 Top directory of a CTAN (Comprehensive TeX Archive Network) archive used
8843 by @code{gnus-button-ctan-handler}.
8844
8845 @c Misc stuff
8846
8847 @item gnus-article-button-face
8848 @vindex gnus-article-button-face
8849 Face used on buttons.
8850
8851 @item gnus-article-mouse-face
8852 @vindex gnus-article-mouse-face
8853 Face used when the mouse cursor is over a button.
8854
8855 @end table
8856
8857 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to buttonize articles automatically.
8858
8859
8860 @node Article Button Levels
8861 @subsection Article button levels
8862 @cindex button levels
8863 The higher the value of the variables @code{gnus-button-@var{*}-level},
8864 the more buttons will appear. If the level is zero, no corresponding
8865 buttons are displayed. With the default value (which is 5) you should
8866 already see quite a lot of buttons. With higher levels, you will see
8867 more buttons, but you may also get more false positives. To avoid them,
8868 you can set the variables @code{gnus-button-@var{*}-level} local to
8869 specific groups (@pxref{Group Parameters}). Here's an example for the
8870 variable @code{gnus-parameters}:
8871
8872 @lisp
8873 ;; @r{increase @code{gnus-button-*-level} in some groups:}
8874 (setq gnus-parameters
8875 '(("\\<\\(emacs\\|gnus\\)\\>" (gnus-button-emacs-level 10))
8876 ("\\<unix\\>" (gnus-button-man-level 10))
8877 ("\\<tex\\>" (gnus-button-tex-level 10))))
8878 @end lisp
8879
8880 @table @code
8881
8882 @item gnus-button-browse-level
8883 @vindex gnus-button-browse-level
8884 Controls the display of references to message IDs, mail addresses and
8885 news URLs. Related variables and functions include
8886 @code{gnus-button-url-regexp}, @code{browse-url}, and
8887 @code{browse-url-browser-function}.
8888
8889 @item gnus-button-emacs-level
8890 @vindex gnus-button-emacs-level
8891 Controls the display of Emacs or Gnus references. Related functions are
8892 @code{gnus-button-handle-custom},
8893 @code{gnus-button-handle-describe-function},
8894 @code{gnus-button-handle-describe-variable},
8895 @code{gnus-button-handle-symbol},
8896 @code{gnus-button-handle-describe-key},
8897 @code{gnus-button-handle-apropos},
8898 @code{gnus-button-handle-apropos-command},
8899 @code{gnus-button-handle-apropos-variable},
8900 @code{gnus-button-handle-apropos-documentation}, and
8901 @code{gnus-button-handle-library}.
8902
8903 @item gnus-button-man-level
8904 @vindex gnus-button-man-level
8905 Controls the display of references to (Unix) man pages.
8906 See @code{gnus-button-man-handler}.
8907
8908 @item gnus-button-message-level
8909 @vindex gnus-button-message-level
8910 Controls the display of message IDs, mail addresses and news URLs.
8911 Related variables and functions include
8912 @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-regexp},
8913 @code{gnus-button-prefer-mid-or-mail},
8914 @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic}, and
8915 @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic-alist}.
8916
8917 @item gnus-button-tex-level
8918 @vindex gnus-button-tex-level
8919 Controls the display of references to @TeX{} or LaTeX stuff, e.g. for CTAN
8920 URLs. See the variables @code{gnus-ctan-url},
8921 @code{gnus-button-ctan-handler},
8922 @code{gnus-button-ctan-directory-regexp}, and
8923 @code{gnus-button-handle-ctan-bogus-regexp}.
8924
8925 @end table
8926
8927
8928 @node Article Date
8929 @subsection Article Date
8930
8931 The date is most likely generated in some obscure timezone you've never
8932 heard of, so it's quite nice to be able to find out what the time was
8933 when the article was sent.
8934
8935 @table @kbd
8936
8937 @item W T u
8938 @kindex W T u (Summary)
8939 @findex gnus-article-date-ut
8940 Display the date in UT (aka. GMT, aka ZULU)
8941 (@code{gnus-article-date-ut}).
8942
8943 @item W T i
8944 @kindex W T i (Summary)
8945 @findex gnus-article-date-iso8601
8946 @cindex ISO 8601
8947 Display the date in international format, aka. ISO 8601
8948 (@code{gnus-article-date-iso8601}).
8949
8950 @item W T l
8951 @kindex W T l (Summary)
8952 @findex gnus-article-date-local
8953 Display the date in the local timezone (@code{gnus-article-date-local}).
8954
8955 @item W T p
8956 @kindex W T p (Summary)
8957 @findex gnus-article-date-english
8958 Display the date in a format that's easily pronounceable in English
8959 (@code{gnus-article-date-english}).
8960
8961 @item W T s
8962 @kindex W T s (Summary)
8963 @vindex gnus-article-time-format
8964 @findex gnus-article-date-user
8965 @findex format-time-string
8966 Display the date using a user-defined format
8967 (@code{gnus-article-date-user}). The format is specified by the
8968 @code{gnus-article-time-format} variable, and is a string that's passed
8969 to @code{format-time-string}. See the documentation of that variable
8970 for a list of possible format specs.
8971
8972 @item W T e
8973 @kindex W T e (Summary)
8974 @findex gnus-article-date-lapsed
8975 @findex gnus-start-date-timer
8976 @findex gnus-stop-date-timer
8977 Say how much time has elapsed between the article was posted and now
8978 (@code{gnus-article-date-lapsed}). It looks something like:
8979
8980 @example
8981 X-Sent: 6 weeks, 4 days, 1 hour, 3 minutes, 8 seconds ago
8982 @end example
8983
8984 @vindex gnus-article-date-lapsed-new-header
8985 The value of @code{gnus-article-date-lapsed-new-header} determines
8986 whether this header will just be added below the old Date one, or will
8987 replace it.
8988
8989 An advantage of using Gnus to read mail is that it converts simple bugs
8990 into wonderful absurdities.
8991
8992 If you want to have this line updated continually, you can put
8993
8994 @lisp
8995 (gnus-start-date-timer)
8996 @end lisp
8997
8998 in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file, or you can run it off of some hook. If
8999 you want to stop the timer, you can use the @code{gnus-stop-date-timer}
9000 command.
9001
9002 @item W T o
9003 @kindex W T o (Summary)
9004 @findex gnus-article-date-original
9005 Display the original date (@code{gnus-article-date-original}). This can
9006 be useful if you normally use some other conversion function and are
9007 worried that it might be doing something totally wrong. Say, claiming
9008 that the article was posted in 1854. Although something like that is
9009 @emph{totally} impossible. Don't you trust me? *titter*
9010
9011 @end table
9012
9013 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to display the date in your
9014 preferred format automatically.
9015
9016
9017 @node Article Display
9018 @subsection Article Display
9019 @cindex picons
9020 @cindex x-face
9021 @cindex smileys
9022
9023 These commands add various frivolous display gimmicks to the article
9024 buffer in Emacs versions that support them.
9025
9026 @code{X-Face} headers are small black-and-white images supplied by the
9027 message headers (@pxref{X-Face}).
9028
9029 @code{Face} headers are small colored images supplied by the message
9030 headers (@pxref{Face}).
9031
9032 Smileys are those little @samp{:-)} symbols that people like to litter
9033 their messages with (@pxref{Smileys}).
9034
9035 Picons, on the other hand, reside on your own system, and Gnus will
9036 try to match the headers to what you have (@pxref{Picons}).
9037
9038 All these functions are toggles---if the elements already exist,
9039 they'll be removed.
9040
9041 @table @kbd
9042 @item W D x
9043 @kindex W D x (Summary)
9044 @findex gnus-article-display-x-face
9045 Display an @code{X-Face} in the @code{From} header.
9046 (@code{gnus-article-display-x-face}).
9047
9048 @item W D d
9049 @kindex W D d (Summary)
9050 @findex gnus-article-display-face
9051 Display a @code{Face} in the @code{From} header.
9052 (@code{gnus-article-display-face}).
9053
9054 @item W D s
9055 @kindex W D s (Summary)
9056 @findex gnus-treat-smiley
9057 Display smileys (@code{gnus-treat-smiley}).
9058
9059 @item W D f
9060 @kindex W D f (Summary)
9061 @findex gnus-treat-from-picon
9062 Piconify the @code{From} header (@code{gnus-treat-from-picon}).
9063
9064 @item W D m
9065 @kindex W D m (Summary)
9066 @findex gnus-treat-mail-picon
9067 Piconify all mail headers (i. e., @code{Cc}, @code{To})
9068 (@code{gnus-treat-mail-picon}).
9069
9070 @item W D n
9071 @kindex W D n (Summary)
9072 @findex gnus-treat-newsgroups-picon
9073 Piconify all news headers (i. e., @code{Newsgroups} and
9074 @code{Followup-To}) (@code{gnus-treat-newsgroups-picon}).
9075
9076 @item W D D
9077 @kindex W D D (Summary)
9078 @findex gnus-article-remove-images
9079 Remove all images from the article buffer
9080 (@code{gnus-article-remove-images}).
9081
9082 @end table
9083
9084
9085
9086 @node Article Signature
9087 @subsection Article Signature
9088 @cindex signatures
9089 @cindex article signature
9090
9091 @vindex gnus-signature-separator
9092 Each article is divided into two parts---the head and the body. The
9093 body can be divided into a signature part and a text part. The variable
9094 that says what is to be considered a signature is
9095 @code{gnus-signature-separator}. This is normally the standard
9096 @samp{^-- $} as mandated by son-of-RFC 1036. However, many people use
9097 non-standard signature separators, so this variable can also be a list
9098 of regular expressions to be tested, one by one. (Searches are done
9099 from the end of the body towards the beginning.) One likely value is:
9100
9101 @lisp
9102 (setq gnus-signature-separator
9103 '("^-- $" ; @r{The standard}
9104 "^-- *$" ; @r{A common mangling}
9105 "^-------*$" ; @r{Many people just use a looong}
9106 ; @r{line of dashes. Shame!}
9107 "^ *--------*$" ; @r{Double-shame!}
9108 "^________*$" ; @r{Underscores are also popular}
9109 "^========*$")) ; @r{Pervert!}
9110 @end lisp
9111
9112 The more permissive you are, the more likely it is that you'll get false
9113 positives.
9114
9115 @vindex gnus-signature-limit
9116 @code{gnus-signature-limit} provides a limit to what is considered a
9117 signature when displaying articles.
9118
9119 @enumerate
9120 @item
9121 If it is an integer, no signature may be longer (in characters) than
9122 that integer.
9123 @item
9124 If it is a floating point number, no signature may be longer (in lines)
9125 than that number.
9126 @item
9127 If it is a function, the function will be called without any parameters,
9128 and if it returns @code{nil}, there is no signature in the buffer.
9129 @item
9130 If it is a string, it will be used as a regexp. If it matches, the text
9131 in question is not a signature.
9132 @end enumerate
9133
9134 This variable can also be a list where the elements may be of the types
9135 listed above. Here's an example:
9136
9137 @lisp
9138 (setq gnus-signature-limit
9139 '(200.0 "^---*Forwarded article"))
9140 @end lisp
9141
9142 This means that if there are more than 200 lines after the signature
9143 separator, or the text after the signature separator is matched by
9144 the regular expression @samp{^---*Forwarded article}, then it isn't a
9145 signature after all.
9146
9147
9148 @node Article Miscellanea
9149 @subsection Article Miscellanea
9150
9151 @table @kbd
9152 @item A t
9153 @kindex A t (Summary)
9154 @findex gnus-article-babel
9155 Translate the article from one language to another
9156 (@code{gnus-article-babel}).
9157
9158 @end table
9159
9160
9161 @node MIME Commands
9162 @section MIME Commands
9163 @cindex MIME decoding
9164 @cindex attachments
9165 @cindex viewing attachments
9166
9167 The following commands all understand the numerical prefix. For
9168 instance, @kbd{3 b} means ``view the third @acronym{MIME} part''.
9169
9170 @table @kbd
9171 @item b
9172 @itemx K v
9173 @kindex b (Summary)
9174 @kindex K v (Summary)
9175 View the @acronym{MIME} part.
9176
9177 @item K o
9178 @kindex K o (Summary)
9179 Save the @acronym{MIME} part.
9180
9181 @item K c
9182 @kindex K c (Summary)
9183 Copy the @acronym{MIME} part.
9184
9185 @item K e
9186 @kindex K e (Summary)
9187 View the @acronym{MIME} part externally.
9188
9189 @item K i
9190 @kindex K i (Summary)
9191 View the @acronym{MIME} part internally.
9192
9193 @item K |
9194 @kindex K | (Summary)
9195 Pipe the @acronym{MIME} part to an external command.
9196 @end table
9197
9198 The rest of these @acronym{MIME} commands do not use the numerical prefix in
9199 the same manner:
9200
9201 @table @kbd
9202 @item K b
9203 @kindex K b (Summary)
9204 Make all the @acronym{MIME} parts have buttons in front of them. This is
9205 mostly useful if you wish to save (or perform other actions) on inlined
9206 parts.
9207
9208 @item K m
9209 @kindex K m (Summary)
9210 @findex gnus-summary-repair-multipart
9211 Some multipart messages are transmitted with missing or faulty headers.
9212 This command will attempt to ``repair'' these messages so that they can
9213 be viewed in a more pleasant manner
9214 (@code{gnus-summary-repair-multipart}).
9215
9216 @item X m
9217 @kindex X m (Summary)
9218 @findex gnus-summary-save-parts
9219 Save all parts matching a @acronym{MIME} type to a directory
9220 (@code{gnus-summary-save-parts}). Understands the process/prefix
9221 convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
9222
9223 @item M-t
9224 @kindex M-t (Summary)
9225 @findex gnus-summary-toggle-display-buttonized
9226 Toggle the buttonized display of the article buffer
9227 (@code{gnus-summary-toggle-display-buttonized}).
9228
9229 @item W M w
9230 @kindex W M w (Summary)
9231 @findex gnus-article-decode-mime-words
9232 Decode RFC 2047-encoded words in the article headers
9233 (@code{gnus-article-decode-mime-words}).
9234
9235 @item W M c
9236 @kindex W M c (Summary)
9237 @findex gnus-article-decode-charset
9238 Decode encoded article bodies as well as charsets
9239 (@code{gnus-article-decode-charset}).
9240
9241 This command looks in the @code{Content-Type} header to determine the
9242 charset. If there is no such header in the article, you can give it a
9243 prefix, which will prompt for the charset to decode as. In regional
9244 groups where people post using some common encoding (but do not
9245 include @acronym{MIME} headers), you can set the @code{charset} group/topic
9246 parameter to the required charset (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
9247
9248 @item W M v
9249 @kindex W M v (Summary)
9250 @findex gnus-mime-view-all-parts
9251 View all the @acronym{MIME} parts in the current article
9252 (@code{gnus-mime-view-all-parts}).
9253
9254 @end table
9255
9256 Relevant variables:
9257
9258 @table @code
9259 @item gnus-ignored-mime-types
9260 @vindex gnus-ignored-mime-types
9261 This is a list of regexps. @acronym{MIME} types that match a regexp from
9262 this list will be completely ignored by Gnus. The default value is
9263 @code{nil}.
9264
9265 To have all Vcards be ignored, you'd say something like this:
9266
9267 @lisp
9268 (setq gnus-ignored-mime-types
9269 '("text/x-vcard"))
9270 @end lisp
9271
9272 @item gnus-article-loose-mime
9273 @vindex gnus-article-loose-mime
9274 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus won't require the @samp{MIME-Version} header
9275 before interpreting the message as a @acronym{MIME} message. This helps
9276 when reading messages from certain broken mail user agents. The
9277 default is @code{nil}.
9278
9279 @item gnus-article-emulate-mime
9280 @vindex gnus-article-emulate-mime
9281 There are other, non-@acronym{MIME} encoding methods used. The most common
9282 is @samp{uuencode}, but yEncode is also getting to be popular. If
9283 this variable is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will look in message bodies to
9284 see if it finds these encodings, and if so, it'll run them through the
9285 Gnus @acronym{MIME} machinery. The default is @code{t}.
9286
9287 @item gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types
9288 @vindex gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types
9289 This is a list of regexps. @acronym{MIME} types that match a regexp from
9290 this list won't have @acronym{MIME} buttons inserted unless they aren't
9291 displayed or this variable is overridden by
9292 @code{gnus-buttonized-mime-types}. The default value is
9293 @code{(".*/.*")}. This variable is only used when
9294 @code{gnus-inhibit-mime-unbuttonizing} is @code{nil}.
9295
9296 @item gnus-buttonized-mime-types
9297 @vindex gnus-buttonized-mime-types
9298 This is a list of regexps. @acronym{MIME} types that match a regexp from
9299 this list will have @acronym{MIME} buttons inserted unless they aren't
9300 displayed. This variable overrides
9301 @code{gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types}. The default value is @code{nil}.
9302 This variable is only used when @code{gnus-inhibit-mime-unbuttonizing}
9303 is @code{nil}.
9304
9305 To see e.g. security buttons but no other buttons, you could set this
9306 variable to @code{("multipart/signed")} and leave
9307 @code{gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types} at the default value.
9308
9309 @item gnus-inhibit-mime-unbuttonizing
9310 @vindex gnus-inhibit-mime-unbuttonizing
9311 If this is non-@code{nil}, then all @acronym{MIME} parts get buttons. The
9312 default value is @code{nil}.
9313
9314 @item gnus-article-mime-part-function
9315 @vindex gnus-article-mime-part-function
9316 For each @acronym{MIME} part, this function will be called with the @acronym{MIME}
9317 handle as the parameter. The function is meant to be used to allow
9318 users to gather information from the article (e. g., add Vcard info to
9319 the bbdb database) or to do actions based on parts (e. g., automatically
9320 save all jpegs into some directory).
9321
9322 Here's an example function the does the latter:
9323
9324 @lisp
9325 (defun my-save-all-jpeg-parts (handle)
9326 (when (equal (car (mm-handle-type handle)) "image/jpeg")
9327 (with-temp-buffer
9328 (insert (mm-get-part handle))
9329 (write-region (point-min) (point-max)
9330 (read-file-name "Save jpeg to: ")))))
9331 (setq gnus-article-mime-part-function
9332 'my-save-all-jpeg-parts)
9333 @end lisp
9334
9335 @vindex gnus-mime-multipart-functions
9336 @item gnus-mime-multipart-functions
9337 Alist of @acronym{MIME} multipart types and functions to handle them.
9338
9339 @vindex gnus-mime-display-multipart-alternative-as-mixed
9340 @item gnus-mime-display-multipart-alternative-as-mixed
9341 Display "multipart/alternative" parts as "multipart/mixed".
9342
9343 @vindex gnus-mime-display-multipart-related-as-mixed
9344 @item gnus-mime-display-multipart-related-as-mixed
9345 Display "multipart/related" parts as "multipart/mixed".
9346
9347 If displaying "text/html" is discouraged, see
9348 @code{mm-discouraged-alternatives} in @ref{Display Customization,
9349 Display Customization, , emacs-mime, Emacs-Mime Manual}. Images or
9350 other material inside a "multipart/related" part might be overlooked
9351 when this variable is @code{nil}.
9352
9353 @vindex gnus-mime-display-multipart-as-mixed
9354 @item gnus-mime-display-multipart-as-mixed
9355 Display "multipart" parts as "multipart/mixed". If @code{t}, it
9356 overrides @code{nil} values of
9357 @code{gnus-mime-display-multipart-alternative-as-mixed} and
9358 @code{gnus-mime-display-multipart-related-as-mixed}.
9359
9360 @vindex mm-file-name-rewrite-functions
9361 @item mm-file-name-rewrite-functions
9362 List of functions used for rewriting file names of @acronym{MIME} parts.
9363 Each function takes a file name as input and returns a file name.
9364
9365 Ready-made functions include@*
9366 @code{mm-file-name-delete-whitespace},
9367 @code{mm-file-name-trim-whitespace},
9368 @code{mm-file-name-collapse-whitespace}, and
9369 @code{mm-file-name-replace-whitespace}. The later uses the value of
9370 the variable @code{mm-file-name-replace-whitespace} to replace each
9371 whitespace character in a file name with that string; default value
9372 is @code{"_"} (a single underscore).
9373 @findex mm-file-name-delete-whitespace
9374 @findex mm-file-name-trim-whitespace
9375 @findex mm-file-name-collapse-whitespace
9376 @findex mm-file-name-replace-whitespace
9377 @vindex mm-file-name-replace-whitespace
9378
9379 The standard functions @code{capitalize}, @code{downcase},
9380 @code{upcase}, and @code{upcase-initials} may be useful, too.
9381
9382 Everybody knows that whitespace characters in file names are evil,
9383 except those who don't know. If you receive lots of attachments from
9384 such unenlightened users, you can make live easier by adding
9385
9386 @lisp
9387 (setq mm-file-name-rewrite-functions
9388 '(mm-file-name-trim-whitespace
9389 mm-file-name-collapse-whitespace
9390 mm-file-name-replace-whitespace))
9391 @end lisp
9392
9393 @noindent
9394 to your @file{~/.gnus.el} file.
9395
9396 @end table
9397
9398
9399 @node Charsets
9400 @section Charsets
9401 @cindex charsets
9402
9403 People use different charsets, and we have @acronym{MIME} to let us know what
9404 charsets they use. Or rather, we wish we had. Many people use
9405 newsreaders and mailers that do not understand or use @acronym{MIME}, and
9406 just send out messages without saying what character sets they use. To
9407 help a bit with this, some local news hierarchies have policies that say
9408 what character set is the default. For instance, the @samp{fj}
9409 hierarchy uses @code{iso-2022-jp-2}.
9410
9411 @vindex gnus-group-charset-alist
9412 This knowledge is encoded in the @code{gnus-group-charset-alist}
9413 variable, which is an alist of regexps (use the first item to match full
9414 group names) and default charsets to be used when reading these groups.
9415
9416 @vindex gnus-newsgroup-ignored-charsets
9417 In addition, some people do use soi-disant @acronym{MIME}-aware agents that
9418 aren't. These blithely mark messages as being in @code{iso-8859-1}
9419 even if they really are in @code{koi-8}. To help here, the
9420 @code{gnus-newsgroup-ignored-charsets} variable can be used. The
9421 charsets that are listed here will be ignored. The variable can be
9422 set on a group-by-group basis using the group parameters (@pxref{Group
9423 Parameters}). The default value is @code{(unknown-8bit x-unknown)},
9424 which includes values some agents insist on having in there.
9425
9426 @vindex gnus-group-posting-charset-alist
9427 When posting, @code{gnus-group-posting-charset-alist} is used to
9428 determine which charsets should not be encoded using the @acronym{MIME}
9429 encodings. For instance, some hierarchies discourage using
9430 quoted-printable header encoding.
9431
9432 This variable is an alist of regexps and permitted unencoded charsets
9433 for posting. Each element of the alist has the form @code{(}@var{test
9434 header body-list}@code{)}, where:
9435
9436 @table @var
9437 @item test
9438 is either a regular expression matching the newsgroup header or a
9439 variable to query,
9440 @item header
9441 is the charset which may be left unencoded in the header (@code{nil}
9442 means encode all charsets),
9443 @item body-list
9444 is a list of charsets which may be encoded using 8bit content-transfer
9445 encoding in the body, or one of the special values @code{nil} (always
9446 encode using quoted-printable) or @code{t} (always use 8bit).
9447 @end table
9448
9449 @cindex Russian
9450 @cindex koi8-r
9451 @cindex koi8-u
9452 @cindex iso-8859-5
9453 @cindex coding system aliases
9454 @cindex preferred charset
9455
9456 @xref{Encoding Customization, , Encoding Customization, emacs-mime,
9457 The Emacs MIME Manual}, for additional variables that control which
9458 MIME charsets are used when sending messages.
9459
9460 Other charset tricks that may be useful, although not Gnus-specific:
9461
9462 If there are several @acronym{MIME} charsets that encode the same Emacs
9463 charset, you can choose what charset to use by saying the following:
9464
9465 @lisp
9466 (put-charset-property 'cyrillic-iso8859-5
9467 'preferred-coding-system 'koi8-r)
9468 @end lisp
9469
9470 This means that Russian will be encoded using @code{koi8-r} instead of
9471 the default @code{iso-8859-5} @acronym{MIME} charset.
9472
9473 If you want to read messages in @code{koi8-u}, you can cheat and say
9474
9475 @lisp
9476 (define-coding-system-alias 'koi8-u 'koi8-r)
9477 @end lisp
9478
9479 This will almost do the right thing.
9480
9481 And finally, to read charsets like @code{windows-1251}, you can say
9482 something like
9483
9484 @lisp
9485 (codepage-setup 1251)
9486 (define-coding-system-alias 'windows-1251 'cp1251)
9487 @end lisp
9488
9489
9490 @node Article Commands
9491 @section Article Commands
9492
9493 @table @kbd
9494
9495 @item A P
9496 @cindex PostScript
9497 @cindex printing
9498 @kindex A P (Summary)
9499 @vindex gnus-ps-print-hook
9500 @findex gnus-summary-print-article
9501 Generate and print a PostScript image of the article buffer
9502 (@code{gnus-summary-print-article}). @code{gnus-ps-print-hook} will
9503 be run just before printing the buffer. An alternative way to print
9504 article is to use Muttprint (@pxref{Saving Articles}).
9505
9506 @end table
9507
9508
9509 @node Summary Sorting
9510 @section Summary Sorting
9511 @cindex summary sorting
9512
9513 You can have the summary buffer sorted in various ways, even though I
9514 can't really see why you'd want that.
9515
9516 @table @kbd
9517
9518 @item C-c C-s C-n
9519 @kindex C-c C-s C-n (Summary)
9520 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-number
9521 Sort by article number (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-number}).
9522
9523 @item C-c C-s C-a
9524 @kindex C-c C-s C-a (Summary)
9525 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-author
9526 Sort by author (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-author}).
9527
9528 @item C-c C-s C-s
9529 @kindex C-c C-s C-s (Summary)
9530 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-subject
9531 Sort by subject (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-subject}).
9532
9533 @item C-c C-s C-d
9534 @kindex C-c C-s C-d (Summary)
9535 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-date
9536 Sort by date (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-date}).
9537
9538 @item C-c C-s C-l
9539 @kindex C-c C-s C-l (Summary)
9540 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-lines
9541 Sort by lines (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-lines}).
9542
9543 @item C-c C-s C-c
9544 @kindex C-c C-s C-c (Summary)
9545 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-chars
9546 Sort by article length (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-chars}).
9547
9548 @item C-c C-s C-i
9549 @kindex C-c C-s C-i (Summary)
9550 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-score
9551 Sort by score (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-score}).
9552
9553 @item C-c C-s C-r
9554 @kindex C-c C-s C-r (Summary)
9555 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-random
9556 Randomize (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-random}).
9557
9558 @item C-c C-s C-o
9559 @kindex C-c C-s C-o (Summary)
9560 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-original
9561 Sort using the default sorting method
9562 (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-original}).
9563 @end table
9564
9565 These functions will work both when you use threading and when you don't
9566 use threading. In the latter case, all summary lines will be sorted,
9567 line by line. In the former case, sorting will be done on a
9568 root-by-root basis, which might not be what you were looking for. To
9569 toggle whether to use threading, type @kbd{T T} (@pxref{Thread
9570 Commands}).
9571
9572
9573 @node Finding the Parent
9574 @section Finding the Parent
9575 @cindex parent articles
9576 @cindex referring articles
9577
9578 @table @kbd
9579 @item ^
9580 @kindex ^ (Summary)
9581 @findex gnus-summary-refer-parent-article
9582 If you'd like to read the parent of the current article, and it is not
9583 displayed in the summary buffer, you might still be able to. That is,
9584 if the current group is fetched by @acronym{NNTP}, the parent hasn't expired
9585 and the @code{References} in the current article are not mangled, you
9586 can just press @kbd{^} or @kbd{A r}
9587 (@code{gnus-summary-refer-parent-article}). If everything goes well,
9588 you'll get the parent. If the parent is already displayed in the
9589 summary buffer, point will just move to this article.
9590
9591 If given a positive numerical prefix, fetch that many articles back into
9592 the ancestry. If given a negative numerical prefix, fetch just that
9593 ancestor. So if you say @kbd{3 ^}, Gnus will fetch the parent, the
9594 grandparent and the grandgrandparent of the current article. If you say
9595 @kbd{-3 ^}, Gnus will only fetch the grandgrandparent of the current
9596 article.
9597
9598 @item A R (Summary)
9599 @findex gnus-summary-refer-references
9600 @kindex A R (Summary)
9601 Fetch all articles mentioned in the @code{References} header of the
9602 article (@code{gnus-summary-refer-references}).
9603
9604 @item A T (Summary)
9605 @findex gnus-summary-refer-thread
9606 @kindex A T (Summary)
9607 Display the full thread where the current article appears
9608 (@code{gnus-summary-refer-thread}). This command has to fetch all the
9609 headers in the current group to work, so it usually takes a while. If
9610 you do it often, you may consider setting @code{gnus-fetch-old-headers}
9611 to @code{invisible} (@pxref{Filling In Threads}). This won't have any
9612 visible effects normally, but it'll make this command work a whole lot
9613 faster. Of course, it'll make group entry somewhat slow.
9614
9615 @vindex gnus-refer-thread-limit
9616 The @code{gnus-refer-thread-limit} variable says how many old (i. e.,
9617 articles before the first displayed in the current group) headers to
9618 fetch when doing this command. The default is 200. If @code{t}, all
9619 the available headers will be fetched. This variable can be overridden
9620 by giving the @kbd{A T} command a numerical prefix.
9621
9622 @item M-^ (Summary)
9623 @findex gnus-summary-refer-article
9624 @kindex M-^ (Summary)
9625 @cindex Message-ID
9626 @cindex fetching by Message-ID
9627 You can also ask the @acronym{NNTP} server for an arbitrary article, no
9628 matter what group it belongs to. @kbd{M-^}
9629 (@code{gnus-summary-refer-article}) will ask you for a
9630 @code{Message-ID}, which is one of those long, hard-to-read thingies
9631 that look something like @samp{<38o6up$6f2@@hymir.ifi.uio.no>}. You
9632 have to get it all exactly right. No fuzzy searches, I'm afraid.
9633 @end table
9634
9635 The current select method will be used when fetching by
9636 @code{Message-ID} from non-news select method, but you can override this
9637 by giving this command a prefix.
9638
9639 @vindex gnus-refer-article-method
9640 If the group you are reading is located on a back end that does not
9641 support fetching by @code{Message-ID} very well (like @code{nnspool}),
9642 you can set @code{gnus-refer-article-method} to an @acronym{NNTP} method. It
9643 would, perhaps, be best if the @acronym{NNTP} server you consult is the one
9644 updating the spool you are reading from, but that's not really
9645 necessary.
9646
9647 It can also be a list of select methods, as well as the special symbol
9648 @code{current}, which means to use the current select method. If it
9649 is a list, Gnus will try all the methods in the list until it finds a
9650 match.
9651
9652 Here's an example setting that will first try the current method, and
9653 then ask Google if that fails:
9654
9655 @lisp
9656 (setq gnus-refer-article-method
9657 '(current
9658 (nnweb "google" (nnweb-type google))))
9659 @end lisp
9660
9661 Most of the mail back ends support fetching by @code{Message-ID}, but
9662 do not do a particularly excellent job at it. That is, @code{nnmbox},
9663 @code{nnbabyl}, @code{nnmaildir}, @code{nnml}, are able to locate
9664 articles from any groups, while @code{nnfolder}, and @code{nnimap} are
9665 only able to locate articles that have been posted to the current
9666 group. (Anything else would be too time consuming.) @code{nnmh} does
9667 not support this at all.
9668
9669
9670 @node Alternative Approaches
9671 @section Alternative Approaches
9672
9673 Different people like to read news using different methods. This being
9674 Gnus, we offer a small selection of minor modes for the summary buffers.
9675
9676 @menu
9677 * Pick and Read:: First mark articles and then read them.
9678 * Binary Groups:: Auto-decode all articles.
9679 @end menu
9680
9681
9682 @node Pick and Read
9683 @subsection Pick and Read
9684 @cindex pick and read
9685
9686 Some newsreaders (like @code{nn} and, uhm, @code{Netnews} on VM/CMS) use
9687 a two-phased reading interface. The user first marks in a summary
9688 buffer the articles she wants to read. Then she starts reading the
9689 articles with just an article buffer displayed.
9690
9691 @findex gnus-pick-mode
9692 @kindex M-x gnus-pick-mode
9693 Gnus provides a summary buffer minor mode that allows
9694 this---@code{gnus-pick-mode}. This basically means that a few process
9695 mark commands become one-keystroke commands to allow easy marking, and
9696 it provides one additional command for switching to the summary buffer.
9697
9698 Here are the available keystrokes when using pick mode:
9699
9700 @table @kbd
9701 @item .
9702 @kindex . (Pick)
9703 @findex gnus-pick-article-or-thread
9704 Pick the article or thread on the current line
9705 (@code{gnus-pick-article-or-thread}). If the variable
9706 @code{gnus-thread-hide-subtree} is true, then this key selects the
9707 entire thread when used at the first article of the thread. Otherwise,
9708 it selects just the article. If given a numerical prefix, go to that
9709 thread or article and pick it. (The line number is normally displayed
9710 at the beginning of the summary pick lines.)
9711
9712 @item SPACE
9713 @kindex SPACE (Pick)
9714 @findex gnus-pick-next-page
9715 Scroll the summary buffer up one page (@code{gnus-pick-next-page}). If
9716 at the end of the buffer, start reading the picked articles.
9717
9718 @item u
9719 @kindex u (Pick)
9720 @findex gnus-pick-unmark-article-or-thread.
9721 Unpick the thread or article
9722 (@code{gnus-pick-unmark-article-or-thread}). If the variable
9723 @code{gnus-thread-hide-subtree} is true, then this key unpicks the
9724 thread if used at the first article of the thread. Otherwise it unpicks
9725 just the article. You can give this key a numerical prefix to unpick
9726 the thread or article at that line.
9727
9728 @item RET
9729 @kindex RET (Pick)
9730 @findex gnus-pick-start-reading
9731 @vindex gnus-pick-display-summary
9732 Start reading the picked articles (@code{gnus-pick-start-reading}). If
9733 given a prefix, mark all unpicked articles as read first. If
9734 @code{gnus-pick-display-summary} is non-@code{nil}, the summary buffer
9735 will still be visible when you are reading.
9736
9737 @end table
9738
9739 All the normal summary mode commands are still available in the
9740 pick-mode, with the exception of @kbd{u}. However @kbd{!} is available
9741 which is mapped to the same function
9742 @code{gnus-summary-tick-article-forward}.
9743
9744 If this sounds like a good idea to you, you could say:
9745
9746 @lisp
9747 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-mode-hook 'gnus-pick-mode)
9748 @end lisp
9749
9750 @vindex gnus-pick-mode-hook
9751 @code{gnus-pick-mode-hook} is run in pick minor mode buffers.
9752
9753 @vindex gnus-mark-unpicked-articles-as-read
9754 If @code{gnus-mark-unpicked-articles-as-read} is non-@code{nil}, mark
9755 all unpicked articles as read. The default is @code{nil}.
9756
9757 @vindex gnus-summary-pick-line-format
9758 The summary line format in pick mode is slightly different from the
9759 standard format. At the beginning of each line the line number is
9760 displayed. The pick mode line format is controlled by the
9761 @code{gnus-summary-pick-line-format} variable (@pxref{Formatting
9762 Variables}). It accepts the same format specs that
9763 @code{gnus-summary-line-format} does (@pxref{Summary Buffer Lines}).
9764
9765
9766 @node Binary Groups
9767 @subsection Binary Groups
9768 @cindex binary groups
9769
9770 @findex gnus-binary-mode
9771 @kindex M-x gnus-binary-mode
9772 If you spend much time in binary groups, you may grow tired of hitting
9773 @kbd{X u}, @kbd{n}, @kbd{RET} all the time. @kbd{M-x gnus-binary-mode}
9774 is a minor mode for summary buffers that makes all ordinary Gnus article
9775 selection functions uudecode series of articles and display the result
9776 instead of just displaying the articles the normal way.
9777
9778 @kindex g (Binary)
9779 @findex gnus-binary-show-article
9780 The only way, in fact, to see the actual articles is the @kbd{g}
9781 command, when you have turned on this mode
9782 (@code{gnus-binary-show-article}).
9783
9784 @vindex gnus-binary-mode-hook
9785 @code{gnus-binary-mode-hook} is called in binary minor mode buffers.
9786
9787
9788 @node Tree Display
9789 @section Tree Display
9790 @cindex trees
9791
9792 @vindex gnus-use-trees
9793 If you don't like the normal Gnus summary display, you might try setting
9794 @code{gnus-use-trees} to @code{t}. This will create (by default) an
9795 additional @dfn{tree buffer}. You can execute all summary mode commands
9796 in the tree buffer.
9797
9798 There are a few variables to customize the tree display, of course:
9799
9800 @table @code
9801 @item gnus-tree-mode-hook
9802 @vindex gnus-tree-mode-hook
9803 A hook called in all tree mode buffers.
9804
9805 @item gnus-tree-mode-line-format
9806 @vindex gnus-tree-mode-line-format
9807 A format string for the mode bar in the tree mode buffers (@pxref{Mode
9808 Line Formatting}). The default is @samp{Gnus: %%b %S %Z}. For a list
9809 of valid specs, @pxref{Summary Buffer Mode Line}.
9810
9811 @item gnus-selected-tree-face
9812 @vindex gnus-selected-tree-face
9813 Face used for highlighting the selected article in the tree buffer. The
9814 default is @code{modeline}.
9815
9816 @item gnus-tree-line-format
9817 @vindex gnus-tree-line-format
9818 A format string for the tree nodes. The name is a bit of a misnomer,
9819 though---it doesn't define a line, but just the node. The default value
9820 is @samp{%(%[%3,3n%]%)}, which displays the first three characters of
9821 the name of the poster. It is vital that all nodes are of the same
9822 length, so you @emph{must} use @samp{%4,4n}-like specifiers.
9823
9824 Valid specs are:
9825
9826 @table @samp
9827 @item n
9828 The name of the poster.
9829 @item f
9830 The @code{From} header.
9831 @item N
9832 The number of the article.
9833 @item [
9834 The opening bracket.
9835 @item ]
9836 The closing bracket.
9837 @item s
9838 The subject.
9839 @end table
9840
9841 @xref{Formatting Variables}.
9842
9843 Variables related to the display are:
9844
9845 @table @code
9846 @item gnus-tree-brackets
9847 @vindex gnus-tree-brackets
9848 This is used for differentiating between ``real'' articles and
9849 ``sparse'' articles. The format is
9850 @example
9851 ((@var{real-open} . @var{real-close})
9852 (@var{sparse-open} . @var{sparse-close})
9853 (@var{dummy-open} . @var{dummy-close}))
9854 @end example
9855 and the default is @code{((?[ . ?]) (?( . ?)) (?@{ . ?@}) (?< . ?>))}.
9856
9857 @item gnus-tree-parent-child-edges
9858 @vindex gnus-tree-parent-child-edges
9859 This is a list that contains the characters used for connecting parent
9860 nodes to their children. The default is @code{(?- ?\\ ?|)}.
9861
9862 @end table
9863
9864 @item gnus-tree-minimize-window
9865 @vindex gnus-tree-minimize-window
9866 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will try to keep the tree
9867 buffer as small as possible to allow more room for the other Gnus
9868 windows. If this variable is a number, the tree buffer will never be
9869 higher than that number. The default is @code{t}. Note that if you
9870 have several windows displayed side-by-side in a frame and the tree
9871 buffer is one of these, minimizing the tree window will also resize all
9872 other windows displayed next to it.
9873
9874 You may also wish to add the following hook to keep the window minimized
9875 at all times:
9876
9877 @lisp
9878 (add-hook 'gnus-configure-windows-hook
9879 'gnus-tree-perhaps-minimize)
9880 @end lisp
9881
9882 @item gnus-generate-tree-function
9883 @vindex gnus-generate-tree-function
9884 @findex gnus-generate-horizontal-tree
9885 @findex gnus-generate-vertical-tree
9886 The function that actually generates the thread tree. Two predefined
9887 functions are available: @code{gnus-generate-horizontal-tree} and
9888 @code{gnus-generate-vertical-tree} (which is the default).
9889
9890 @end table
9891
9892 Here's an example from a horizontal tree buffer:
9893
9894 @example
9895 @{***@}-(***)-[odd]-[Gun]
9896 | \[Jan]
9897 | \[odd]-[Eri]
9898 | \(***)-[Eri]
9899 | \[odd]-[Paa]
9900 \[Bjo]
9901 \[Gun]
9902 \[Gun]-[Jor]
9903 @end example
9904
9905 Here's the same thread displayed in a vertical tree buffer:
9906
9907 @example
9908 @group
9909 @{***@}
9910 |--------------------------\-----\-----\
9911 (***) [Bjo] [Gun] [Gun]
9912 |--\-----\-----\ |
9913 [odd] [Jan] [odd] (***) [Jor]
9914 | | |--\
9915 [Gun] [Eri] [Eri] [odd]
9916 |
9917 [Paa]
9918 @end group
9919 @end example
9920
9921 If you're using horizontal trees, it might be nice to display the trees
9922 side-by-side with the summary buffer. You could add something like the
9923 following to your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
9924
9925 @lisp
9926 (setq gnus-use-trees t
9927 gnus-generate-tree-function 'gnus-generate-horizontal-tree
9928 gnus-tree-minimize-window nil)
9929 (gnus-add-configuration
9930 '(article
9931 (vertical 1.0
9932 (horizontal 0.25
9933 (summary 0.75 point)
9934 (tree 1.0))
9935 (article 1.0))))
9936 @end lisp
9937
9938 @xref{Window Layout}.
9939
9940
9941 @node Mail Group Commands
9942 @section Mail Group Commands
9943 @cindex mail group commands
9944
9945 Some commands only make sense in mail groups. If these commands are
9946 invalid in the current group, they will raise a hell and let you know.
9947
9948 All these commands (except the expiry and edit commands) use the
9949 process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
9950
9951 @table @kbd
9952
9953 @item B e
9954 @kindex B e (Summary)
9955 @findex gnus-summary-expire-articles
9956 Run all expirable articles in the current group through the expiry
9957 process (@code{gnus-summary-expire-articles}). That is, delete all
9958 expirable articles in the group that have been around for a while.
9959 (@pxref{Expiring Mail}).
9960
9961 @item B C-M-e
9962 @kindex B C-M-e (Summary)
9963 @findex gnus-summary-expire-articles-now
9964 Delete all the expirable articles in the group
9965 (@code{gnus-summary-expire-articles-now}). This means that @strong{all}
9966 articles eligible for expiry in the current group will
9967 disappear forever into that big @file{/dev/null} in the sky.
9968
9969 @item B DEL
9970 @kindex B DEL (Summary)
9971 @findex gnus-summary-delete-article
9972 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-delete}
9973 Delete the mail article. This is ``delete'' as in ``delete it from your
9974 disk forever and ever, never to return again.'' Use with caution.
9975 (@code{gnus-summary-delete-article}).
9976
9977 @item B m
9978 @kindex B m (Summary)
9979 @cindex move mail
9980 @findex gnus-summary-move-article
9981 @vindex gnus-preserve-marks
9982 Move the article from one mail group to another
9983 (@code{gnus-summary-move-article}). Marks will be preserved if
9984 @code{gnus-preserve-marks} is non-@code{nil} (which is the default).
9985
9986 @item B c
9987 @kindex B c (Summary)
9988 @cindex copy mail
9989 @findex gnus-summary-copy-article
9990 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-copy}
9991 Copy the article from one group (mail group or not) to a mail group
9992 (@code{gnus-summary-copy-article}). Marks will be preserved if
9993 @code{gnus-preserve-marks} is non-@code{nil} (which is the default).
9994
9995 @item B B
9996 @kindex B B (Summary)
9997 @cindex crosspost mail
9998 @findex gnus-summary-crosspost-article
9999 Crosspost the current article to some other group
10000 (@code{gnus-summary-crosspost-article}). This will create a new copy of
10001 the article in the other group, and the Xref headers of the article will
10002 be properly updated.
10003
10004 @item B i
10005 @kindex B i (Summary)
10006 @findex gnus-summary-import-article
10007 Import an arbitrary file into the current mail newsgroup
10008 (@code{gnus-summary-import-article}). You will be prompted for a file
10009 name, a @code{From} header and a @code{Subject} header.
10010
10011 @item B I
10012 @kindex B I (Summary)
10013 @findex gnus-summary-create-article
10014 Create an empty article in the current mail newsgroups
10015 (@code{gnus-summary-create-article}). You will be prompted for a
10016 @code{From} header and a @code{Subject} header.
10017
10018 @item B r
10019 @kindex B r (Summary)
10020 @findex gnus-summary-respool-article
10021 @vindex gnus-summary-respool-default-method
10022 Respool the mail article (@code{gnus-summary-respool-article}).
10023 @code{gnus-summary-respool-default-method} will be used as the default
10024 select method when respooling. This variable is @code{nil} by default,
10025 which means that the current group select method will be used instead.
10026 Marks will be preserved if @code{gnus-preserve-marks} is non-@code{nil}
10027 (which is the default).
10028
10029 @item B w
10030 @itemx e
10031 @kindex B w (Summary)
10032 @kindex e (Summary)
10033 @findex gnus-summary-edit-article
10034 @kindex C-c C-c (Article)
10035 @findex gnus-summary-edit-article-done
10036 Edit the current article (@code{gnus-summary-edit-article}). To finish
10037 editing and make the changes permanent, type @kbd{C-c C-c}
10038 (@code{gnus-summary-edit-article-done}). If you give a prefix to the
10039 @kbd{C-c C-c} command, Gnus won't re-highlight the article.
10040
10041 @item B q
10042 @kindex B q (Summary)
10043 @findex gnus-summary-respool-query
10044 If you want to re-spool an article, you might be curious as to what group
10045 the article will end up in before you do the re-spooling. This command
10046 will tell you (@code{gnus-summary-respool-query}).
10047
10048 @item B t
10049 @kindex B t (Summary)
10050 @findex gnus-summary-respool-trace
10051 Similarly, this command will display all fancy splitting patterns used
10052 when respooling, if any (@code{gnus-summary-respool-trace}).
10053
10054 @item B p
10055 @kindex B p (Summary)
10056 @findex gnus-summary-article-posted-p
10057 Some people have a tendency to send you ``courtesy'' copies when they
10058 follow up to articles you have posted. These usually have a
10059 @code{Newsgroups} header in them, but not always. This command
10060 (@code{gnus-summary-article-posted-p}) will try to fetch the current
10061 article from your news server (or rather, from
10062 @code{gnus-refer-article-method} or @code{gnus-select-method}) and will
10063 report back whether it found the article or not. Even if it says that
10064 it didn't find the article, it may have been posted anyway---mail
10065 propagation is much faster than news propagation, and the news copy may
10066 just not have arrived yet.
10067
10068 @item K E
10069 @kindex K E (Summary)
10070 @findex gnus-article-encrypt-body
10071 @vindex gnus-article-encrypt-protocol
10072 Encrypt the body of an article (@code{gnus-article-encrypt-body}).
10073 The body is encrypted with the encryption protocol specified by the
10074 variable @code{gnus-article-encrypt-protocol}.
10075
10076 @end table
10077
10078 @vindex gnus-move-split-methods
10079 @cindex moving articles
10080 If you move (or copy) articles regularly, you might wish to have Gnus
10081 suggest where to put the articles. @code{gnus-move-split-methods} is a
10082 variable that uses the same syntax as @code{gnus-split-methods}
10083 (@pxref{Saving Articles}). You may customize that variable to create
10084 suggestions you find reasonable. (Note that
10085 @code{gnus-move-split-methods} uses group names where
10086 @code{gnus-split-methods} uses file names.)
10087
10088 @lisp
10089 (setq gnus-move-split-methods
10090 '(("^From:.*Lars Magne" "nnml:junk")
10091 ("^Subject:.*gnus" "nnfolder:important")
10092 (".*" "nnml:misc")))
10093 @end lisp
10094
10095
10096 @node Various Summary Stuff
10097 @section Various Summary Stuff
10098
10099 @menu
10100 * Summary Group Information:: Information oriented commands.
10101 * Searching for Articles:: Multiple article commands.
10102 * Summary Generation Commands::
10103 * Really Various Summary Commands:: Those pesky non-conformant commands.
10104 @end menu
10105
10106 @table @code
10107 @vindex gnus-summary-display-while-building
10108 @item gnus-summary-display-while-building
10109 If non-@code{nil}, show and update the summary buffer as it's being
10110 built. If @code{t}, update the buffer after every line is inserted.
10111 If the value is an integer, @var{n}, update the display every @var{n}
10112 lines. The default is @code{nil}.
10113
10114 @vindex gnus-summary-display-arrow
10115 @item gnus-summary-display-arrow
10116 If non-@code{nil}, display an arrow in the fringe to indicate the
10117 current article.
10118
10119 @vindex gnus-summary-mode-hook
10120 @item gnus-summary-mode-hook
10121 This hook is called when creating a summary mode buffer.
10122
10123 @vindex gnus-summary-generate-hook
10124 @item gnus-summary-generate-hook
10125 This is called as the last thing before doing the threading and the
10126 generation of the summary buffer. It's quite convenient for customizing
10127 the threading variables based on what data the newsgroup has. This hook
10128 is called from the summary buffer after most summary buffer variables
10129 have been set.
10130
10131 @vindex gnus-summary-prepare-hook
10132 @item gnus-summary-prepare-hook
10133 It is called after the summary buffer has been generated. You might use
10134 it to, for instance, highlight lines or modify the look of the buffer in
10135 some other ungodly manner. I don't care.
10136
10137 @vindex gnus-summary-prepared-hook
10138 @item gnus-summary-prepared-hook
10139 A hook called as the very last thing after the summary buffer has been
10140 generated.
10141
10142 @vindex gnus-summary-ignore-duplicates
10143 @item gnus-summary-ignore-duplicates
10144 When Gnus discovers two articles that have the same @code{Message-ID},
10145 it has to do something drastic. No articles are allowed to have the
10146 same @code{Message-ID}, but this may happen when reading mail from some
10147 sources. Gnus allows you to customize what happens with this variable.
10148 If it is @code{nil} (which is the default), Gnus will rename the
10149 @code{Message-ID} (for display purposes only) and display the article as
10150 any other article. If this variable is @code{t}, it won't display the
10151 article---it'll be as if it never existed.
10152
10153 @vindex gnus-alter-articles-to-read-function
10154 @item gnus-alter-articles-to-read-function
10155 This function, which takes two parameters (the group name and the list
10156 of articles to be selected), is called to allow the user to alter the
10157 list of articles to be selected.
10158
10159 For instance, the following function adds the list of cached articles to
10160 the list in one particular group:
10161
10162 @lisp
10163 (defun my-add-cached-articles (group articles)
10164 (if (string= group "some.group")
10165 (append gnus-newsgroup-cached articles)
10166 articles))
10167 @end lisp
10168
10169 @vindex gnus-newsgroup-variables
10170 @item gnus-newsgroup-variables
10171 A list of newsgroup (summary buffer) local variables, or cons of
10172 variables and their default expressions to be evalled (when the default
10173 values are not @code{nil}), that should be made global while the summary
10174 buffer is active.
10175
10176 Note: The default expressions will be evaluated (using function
10177 @code{eval}) before assignment to the local variable rather than just
10178 assigned to it. If the default expression is the symbol @code{global},
10179 that symbol will not be evaluated but the global value of the local
10180 variable will be used instead.
10181
10182 These variables can be used to set variables in the group parameters
10183 while still allowing them to affect operations done in other
10184 buffers. For example:
10185
10186 @lisp
10187 (setq gnus-newsgroup-variables
10188 '(message-use-followup-to
10189 (gnus-visible-headers .
10190 "^From:\\|^Newsgroups:\\|^Subject:\\|^Date:\\|^To:")))
10191 @end lisp
10192
10193 Also @pxref{Group Parameters}.
10194 @end table
10195
10196
10197 @node Summary Group Information
10198 @subsection Summary Group Information
10199
10200 @table @kbd
10201
10202 @item H f
10203 @kindex H f (Summary)
10204 @findex gnus-summary-fetch-faq
10205 @vindex gnus-group-faq-directory
10206 Try to fetch the @acronym{FAQ} (list of frequently asked questions)
10207 for the current group (@code{gnus-summary-fetch-faq}). Gnus will try
10208 to get the @acronym{FAQ} from @code{gnus-group-faq-directory}, which
10209 is usually a directory on a remote machine. This variable can also be
10210 a list of directories. In that case, giving a prefix to this command
10211 will allow you to choose between the various sites. @code{ange-ftp}
10212 or @code{efs} will probably be used for fetching the file.
10213
10214 @item H d
10215 @kindex H d (Summary)
10216 @findex gnus-summary-describe-group
10217 Give a brief description of the current group
10218 (@code{gnus-summary-describe-group}). If given a prefix, force
10219 rereading the description from the server.
10220
10221 @item H h
10222 @kindex H h (Summary)
10223 @findex gnus-summary-describe-briefly
10224 Give an extremely brief description of the most important summary
10225 keystrokes (@code{gnus-summary-describe-briefly}).
10226
10227 @item H i
10228 @kindex H i (Summary)
10229 @findex gnus-info-find-node
10230 Go to the Gnus info node (@code{gnus-info-find-node}).
10231 @end table
10232
10233
10234 @node Searching for Articles
10235 @subsection Searching for Articles
10236
10237 @table @kbd
10238
10239 @item M-s
10240 @kindex M-s (Summary)
10241 @findex gnus-summary-search-article-forward
10242 Search through all subsequent (raw) articles for a regexp
10243 (@code{gnus-summary-search-article-forward}).
10244
10245 @item M-r
10246 @kindex M-r (Summary)
10247 @findex gnus-summary-search-article-backward
10248 Search through all previous (raw) articles for a regexp
10249 (@code{gnus-summary-search-article-backward}).
10250
10251 @item &
10252 @kindex & (Summary)
10253 @findex gnus-summary-execute-command
10254 This command will prompt you for a header, a regular expression to match
10255 on this field, and a command to be executed if the match is made
10256 (@code{gnus-summary-execute-command}). If the header is an empty
10257 string, the match is done on the entire article. If given a prefix,
10258 search backward instead.
10259
10260 For instance, @kbd{& RET some.*string RET #} will put the process mark on
10261 all articles that have heads or bodies that match @samp{some.*string}.
10262
10263 @item M-&
10264 @kindex M-& (Summary)
10265 @findex gnus-summary-universal-argument
10266 Perform any operation on all articles that have been marked with
10267 the process mark (@code{gnus-summary-universal-argument}).
10268 @end table
10269
10270 @node Summary Generation Commands
10271 @subsection Summary Generation Commands
10272
10273 @table @kbd
10274
10275 @item Y g
10276 @kindex Y g (Summary)
10277 @findex gnus-summary-prepare
10278 Regenerate the current summary buffer (@code{gnus-summary-prepare}).
10279
10280 @item Y c
10281 @kindex Y c (Summary)
10282 @findex gnus-summary-insert-cached-articles
10283 Pull all cached articles (for the current group) into the summary buffer
10284 (@code{gnus-summary-insert-cached-articles}).
10285
10286 @item Y d
10287 @kindex Y d (Summary)
10288 @findex gnus-summary-insert-dormant-articles
10289 Pull all dormant articles (for the current group) into the summary buffer
10290 (@code{gnus-summary-insert-dormant-articles}).
10291
10292 @end table
10293
10294
10295 @node Really Various Summary Commands
10296 @subsection Really Various Summary Commands
10297
10298 @table @kbd
10299
10300 @item A D
10301 @itemx C-d
10302 @kindex C-d (Summary)
10303 @kindex A D (Summary)
10304 @findex gnus-summary-enter-digest-group
10305 If the current article is a collection of other articles (for instance,
10306 a digest), you might use this command to enter a group based on the that
10307 article (@code{gnus-summary-enter-digest-group}). Gnus will try to
10308 guess what article type is currently displayed unless you give a prefix
10309 to this command, which forces a ``digest'' interpretation. Basically,
10310 whenever you see a message that is a collection of other messages of
10311 some format, you @kbd{C-d} and read these messages in a more convenient
10312 fashion.
10313
10314 @item C-M-d
10315 @kindex C-M-d (Summary)
10316 @findex gnus-summary-read-document
10317 This command is very similar to the one above, but lets you gather
10318 several documents into one biiig group
10319 (@code{gnus-summary-read-document}). It does this by opening several
10320 @code{nndoc} groups for each document, and then opening an
10321 @code{nnvirtual} group on top of these @code{nndoc} groups. This
10322 command understands the process/prefix convention
10323 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
10324
10325 @item C-t
10326 @kindex C-t (Summary)
10327 @findex gnus-summary-toggle-truncation
10328 Toggle truncation of summary lines
10329 (@code{gnus-summary-toggle-truncation}). This will probably confuse the
10330 line centering function in the summary buffer, so it's not a good idea
10331 to have truncation switched off while reading articles.
10332
10333 @item =
10334 @kindex = (Summary)
10335 @findex gnus-summary-expand-window
10336 Expand the summary buffer window (@code{gnus-summary-expand-window}).
10337 If given a prefix, force an @code{article} window configuration.
10338
10339 @item C-M-e
10340 @kindex C-M-e (Summary)
10341 @findex gnus-summary-edit-parameters
10342 Edit the group parameters (@pxref{Group Parameters}) of the current
10343 group (@code{gnus-summary-edit-parameters}).
10344
10345 @item C-M-a
10346 @kindex C-M-a (Summary)
10347 @findex gnus-summary-customize-parameters
10348 Customize the group parameters (@pxref{Group Parameters}) of the current
10349 group (@code{gnus-summary-customize-parameters}).
10350
10351 @end table
10352
10353
10354 @node Exiting the Summary Buffer
10355 @section Exiting the Summary Buffer
10356 @cindex summary exit
10357 @cindex exiting groups
10358
10359 Exiting from the summary buffer will normally update all info on the
10360 group and return you to the group buffer.
10361
10362 @table @kbd
10363
10364 @item Z Z
10365 @itemx Z Q
10366 @itemx q
10367 @kindex Z Z (Summary)
10368 @kindex Z Q (Summary)
10369 @kindex q (Summary)
10370 @findex gnus-summary-exit
10371 @vindex gnus-summary-exit-hook
10372 @vindex gnus-summary-prepare-exit-hook
10373 @vindex gnus-group-no-more-groups-hook
10374 @c @icon{gnus-summary-exit}
10375 Exit the current group and update all information on the group
10376 (@code{gnus-summary-exit}). @code{gnus-summary-prepare-exit-hook} is
10377 called before doing much of the exiting, which calls
10378 @code{gnus-summary-expire-articles} by default.
10379 @code{gnus-summary-exit-hook} is called after finishing the exit
10380 process. @code{gnus-group-no-more-groups-hook} is run when returning to
10381 group mode having no more (unread) groups.
10382
10383 @item Z E
10384 @itemx Q
10385 @kindex Z E (Summary)
10386 @kindex Q (Summary)
10387 @findex gnus-summary-exit-no-update
10388 Exit the current group without updating any information on the group
10389 (@code{gnus-summary-exit-no-update}).
10390
10391 @item Z c
10392 @itemx c
10393 @kindex Z c (Summary)
10394 @kindex c (Summary)
10395 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-and-exit
10396 @c @icon{gnus-summary-catchup-and-exit}
10397 Mark all unticked articles in the group as read and then exit
10398 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-and-exit}).
10399
10400 @item Z C
10401 @kindex Z C (Summary)
10402 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-all-and-exit
10403 Mark all articles, even the ticked ones, as read and then exit
10404 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-all-and-exit}).
10405
10406 @item Z n
10407 @kindex Z n (Summary)
10408 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-and-goto-next-group
10409 Mark all articles as read and go to the next group
10410 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-and-goto-next-group}).
10411
10412 @item Z R
10413 @itemx C-x C-s
10414 @kindex Z R (Summary)
10415 @kindex C-x C-s (Summary)
10416 @findex gnus-summary-reselect-current-group
10417 Exit this group, and then enter it again
10418 (@code{gnus-summary-reselect-current-group}). If given a prefix, select
10419 all articles, both read and unread.
10420
10421 @item Z G
10422 @itemx M-g
10423 @kindex Z G (Summary)
10424 @kindex M-g (Summary)
10425 @findex gnus-summary-rescan-group
10426 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-get}
10427 Exit the group, check for new articles in the group, and select the
10428 group (@code{gnus-summary-rescan-group}). If given a prefix, select all
10429 articles, both read and unread.
10430
10431 @item Z N
10432 @kindex Z N (Summary)
10433 @findex gnus-summary-next-group
10434 Exit the group and go to the next group
10435 (@code{gnus-summary-next-group}).
10436
10437 @item Z P
10438 @kindex Z P (Summary)
10439 @findex gnus-summary-prev-group
10440 Exit the group and go to the previous group
10441 (@code{gnus-summary-prev-group}).
10442
10443 @item Z s
10444 @kindex Z s (Summary)
10445 @findex gnus-summary-save-newsrc
10446 Save the current number of read/marked articles in the dribble buffer
10447 and then save the dribble buffer (@code{gnus-summary-save-newsrc}). If
10448 given a prefix, also save the @file{.newsrc} file(s). Using this
10449 command will make exit without updating (the @kbd{Q} command) worthless.
10450 @end table
10451
10452 @vindex gnus-exit-group-hook
10453 @code{gnus-exit-group-hook} is called when you exit the current group
10454 with an ``updating'' exit. For instance @kbd{Q}
10455 (@code{gnus-summary-exit-no-update}) does not call this hook.
10456
10457 @findex gnus-summary-wake-up-the-dead
10458 @findex gnus-dead-summary-mode
10459 @vindex gnus-kill-summary-on-exit
10460 If you're in the habit of exiting groups, and then changing your mind
10461 about it, you might set @code{gnus-kill-summary-on-exit} to @code{nil}.
10462 If you do that, Gnus won't kill the summary buffer when you exit it.
10463 (Quelle surprise!) Instead it will change the name of the buffer to
10464 something like @samp{*Dead Summary ... *} and install a minor mode
10465 called @code{gnus-dead-summary-mode}. Now, if you switch back to this
10466 buffer, you'll find that all keys are mapped to a function called
10467 @code{gnus-summary-wake-up-the-dead}. So tapping any keys in a dead
10468 summary buffer will result in a live, normal summary buffer.
10469
10470 There will never be more than one dead summary buffer at any one time.
10471
10472 @vindex gnus-use-cross-reference
10473 The data on the current group will be updated (which articles you have
10474 read, which articles you have replied to, etc.) when you exit the
10475 summary buffer. If the @code{gnus-use-cross-reference} variable is
10476 @code{t} (which is the default), articles that are cross-referenced to
10477 this group and are marked as read, will also be marked as read in the
10478 other subscribed groups they were cross-posted to. If this variable is
10479 neither @code{nil} nor @code{t}, the article will be marked as read in
10480 both subscribed and unsubscribed groups (@pxref{Crosspost Handling}).
10481
10482
10483 @node Crosspost Handling
10484 @section Crosspost Handling
10485
10486 @cindex velveeta
10487 @cindex spamming
10488 Marking cross-posted articles as read ensures that you'll never have to
10489 read the same article more than once. Unless, of course, somebody has
10490 posted it to several groups separately. Posting the same article to
10491 several groups (not cross-posting) is called @dfn{spamming}, and you are
10492 by law required to send nasty-grams to anyone who perpetrates such a
10493 heinous crime. You may want to try NoCeM handling to filter out spam
10494 (@pxref{NoCeM}).
10495
10496 Remember: Cross-posting is kinda ok, but posting the same article
10497 separately to several groups is not. Massive cross-posting (aka.
10498 @dfn{velveeta}) is to be avoided at all costs, and you can even use the
10499 @code{gnus-summary-mail-crosspost-complaint} command to complain about
10500 excessive crossposting (@pxref{Summary Mail Commands}).
10501
10502 @cindex cross-posting
10503 @cindex Xref
10504 @cindex @acronym{NOV}
10505 One thing that may cause Gnus to not do the cross-posting thing
10506 correctly is if you use an @acronym{NNTP} server that supports @sc{xover}
10507 (which is very nice, because it speeds things up considerably) which
10508 does not include the @code{Xref} header in its @acronym{NOV} lines. This is
10509 Evil, but all too common, alas, alack. Gnus tries to Do The Right Thing
10510 even with @sc{xover} by registering the @code{Xref} lines of all
10511 articles you actually read, but if you kill the articles, or just mark
10512 them as read without reading them, Gnus will not get a chance to snoop
10513 the @code{Xref} lines out of these articles, and will be unable to use
10514 the cross reference mechanism.
10515
10516 @cindex LIST overview.fmt
10517 @cindex overview.fmt
10518 To check whether your @acronym{NNTP} server includes the @code{Xref} header
10519 in its overview files, try @samp{telnet your.nntp.server nntp},
10520 @samp{MODE READER} on @code{inn} servers, and then say @samp{LIST
10521 overview.fmt}. This may not work, but if it does, and the last line you
10522 get does not read @samp{Xref:full}, then you should shout and whine at
10523 your news admin until she includes the @code{Xref} header in the
10524 overview files.
10525
10526 @vindex gnus-nov-is-evil
10527 If you want Gnus to get the @code{Xref}s right all the time, you have to
10528 set @code{gnus-nov-is-evil} to @code{t}, which slows things down
10529 considerably.
10530
10531 C'est la vie.
10532
10533 For an alternative approach, @pxref{Duplicate Suppression}.
10534
10535
10536 @node Duplicate Suppression
10537 @section Duplicate Suppression
10538
10539 By default, Gnus tries to make sure that you don't have to read the same
10540 article more than once by utilizing the crossposting mechanism
10541 (@pxref{Crosspost Handling}). However, that simple and efficient
10542 approach may not work satisfactory for some users for various
10543 reasons.
10544
10545 @enumerate
10546 @item
10547 The @acronym{NNTP} server may fail to generate the @code{Xref} header. This
10548 is evil and not very common.
10549
10550 @item
10551 The @acronym{NNTP} server may fail to include the @code{Xref} header in the
10552 @file{.overview} data bases. This is evil and all too common, alas.
10553
10554 @item
10555 You may be reading the same group (or several related groups) from
10556 different @acronym{NNTP} servers.
10557
10558 @item
10559 You may be getting mail that duplicates articles posted to groups.
10560 @end enumerate
10561
10562 I'm sure there are other situations where @code{Xref} handling fails as
10563 well, but these four are the most common situations.
10564
10565 If, and only if, @code{Xref} handling fails for you, then you may
10566 consider switching on @dfn{duplicate suppression}. If you do so, Gnus
10567 will remember the @code{Message-ID}s of all articles you have read or
10568 otherwise marked as read, and then, as if by magic, mark them as read
10569 all subsequent times you see them---in @emph{all} groups. Using this
10570 mechanism is quite likely to be somewhat inefficient, but not overly
10571 so. It's certainly preferable to reading the same articles more than
10572 once.
10573
10574 Duplicate suppression is not a very subtle instrument. It's more like a
10575 sledge hammer than anything else. It works in a very simple
10576 fashion---if you have marked an article as read, it adds this Message-ID
10577 to a cache. The next time it sees this Message-ID, it will mark the
10578 article as read with the @samp{M} mark. It doesn't care what group it
10579 saw the article in.
10580
10581 @table @code
10582 @item gnus-suppress-duplicates
10583 @vindex gnus-suppress-duplicates
10584 If non-@code{nil}, suppress duplicates.
10585
10586 @item gnus-save-duplicate-list
10587 @vindex gnus-save-duplicate-list
10588 If non-@code{nil}, save the list of duplicates to a file. This will
10589 make startup and shutdown take longer, so the default is @code{nil}.
10590 However, this means that only duplicate articles read in a single Gnus
10591 session are suppressed.
10592
10593 @item gnus-duplicate-list-length
10594 @vindex gnus-duplicate-list-length
10595 This variable says how many @code{Message-ID}s to keep in the duplicate
10596 suppression list. The default is 10000.
10597
10598 @item gnus-duplicate-file
10599 @vindex gnus-duplicate-file
10600 The name of the file to store the duplicate suppression list in. The
10601 default is @file{~/News/suppression}.
10602 @end table
10603
10604 If you have a tendency to stop and start Gnus often, setting
10605 @code{gnus-save-duplicate-list} to @code{t} is probably a good idea. If
10606 you leave Gnus running for weeks on end, you may have it @code{nil}. On
10607 the other hand, saving the list makes startup and shutdown much slower,
10608 so that means that if you stop and start Gnus often, you should set
10609 @code{gnus-save-duplicate-list} to @code{nil}. Uhm. I'll leave this up
10610 to you to figure out, I think.
10611
10612 @node Security
10613 @section Security
10614
10615 Gnus is able to verify signed messages or decrypt encrypted messages.
10616 The formats that are supported are @acronym{PGP}, @acronym{PGP/MIME}
10617 and @acronym{S/MIME}, however you need some external programs to get
10618 things to work:
10619
10620 @enumerate
10621 @item
10622 To handle @acronym{PGP} and @acronym{PGP/MIME} messages, you have to
10623 install an OpenPGP implementation such as GnuPG. The Lisp interface
10624 to GnuPG included with Gnus is called PGG (@pxref{Top, ,PGG, pgg, PGG
10625 Manual}), but Mailcrypt and gpg.el are also supported.
10626
10627 @item
10628 To handle @acronym{S/MIME} message, you need to install OpenSSL. OpenSSL 0.9.6
10629 or newer is recommended.
10630
10631 @end enumerate
10632
10633 More information on how to set things up can be found in the message
10634 manual (@pxref{Security, ,Security, message, Message Manual}).
10635
10636 @table @code
10637 @item mm-verify-option
10638 @vindex mm-verify-option
10639 Option of verifying signed parts. @code{never}, not verify;
10640 @code{always}, always verify; @code{known}, only verify known
10641 protocols. Otherwise, ask user.
10642
10643 @item mm-decrypt-option
10644 @vindex mm-decrypt-option
10645 Option of decrypting encrypted parts. @code{never}, no decryption;
10646 @code{always}, always decrypt; @code{known}, only decrypt known
10647 protocols. Otherwise, ask user.
10648
10649 @item mml1991-use
10650 @vindex mml1991-use
10651 Symbol indicating elisp interface to OpenPGP implementation for
10652 @acronym{PGP} messages. The default is @code{pgg}, but
10653 @code{mailcrypt} and @code{gpg} are also supported although
10654 deprecated.
10655
10656 @item mml2015-use
10657 @vindex mml2015-use
10658 Symbol indicating elisp interface to OpenPGP implementation for
10659 @acronym{PGP/MIME} messages. The default is @code{pgg}, but
10660 @code{mailcrypt} and @code{gpg} are also supported although
10661 deprecated.
10662
10663 @end table
10664
10665 @cindex snarfing keys
10666 @cindex importing PGP keys
10667 @cindex PGP key ring import
10668 Snarfing OpenPGP keys (i.e., importing keys from articles into your
10669 key ring) is not supported explicitly through a menu item or command,
10670 rather Gnus do detect and label keys as @samp{application/pgp-keys},
10671 allowing you to specify whatever action you think is appropriate
10672 through the usual @acronym{MIME} infrastructure. You can use a
10673 @file{~/.mailcap} entry (@pxref{mailcap, , mailcap, emacs-mime, The
10674 Emacs MIME Manual}) such as the following to import keys using GNU
10675 Privacy Guard when you click on the @acronym{MIME} button
10676 (@pxref{Using MIME}).
10677
10678 @example
10679 application/pgp-keys; gpg --import --interactive --verbose; needsterminal
10680 @end example
10681 @noindent
10682 This happens to also be the default action defined in
10683 @code{mailcap-mime-data}.
10684
10685 @node Mailing List
10686 @section Mailing List
10687 @cindex mailing list
10688 @cindex RFC 2396
10689
10690 @kindex A M (summary)
10691 @findex gnus-mailing-list-insinuate
10692 Gnus understands some mailing list fields of RFC 2369. To enable it,
10693 add a @code{to-list} group parameter (@pxref{Group Parameters}),
10694 possibly using @kbd{A M} (@code{gnus-mailing-list-insinuate}) in the
10695 summary buffer.
10696
10697 That enables the following commands to the summary buffer:
10698
10699 @table @kbd
10700
10701 @item C-c C-n h
10702 @kindex C-c C-n h (Summary)
10703 @findex gnus-mailing-list-help
10704 Send a message to fetch mailing list help, if List-Help field exists.
10705
10706 @item C-c C-n s
10707 @kindex C-c C-n s (Summary)
10708 @findex gnus-mailing-list-subscribe
10709 Send a message to subscribe the mailing list, if List-Subscribe field exists.
10710
10711 @item C-c C-n u
10712 @kindex C-c C-n u (Summary)
10713 @findex gnus-mailing-list-unsubscribe
10714 Send a message to unsubscribe the mailing list, if List-Unsubscribe
10715 field exists.
10716
10717 @item C-c C-n p
10718 @kindex C-c C-n p (Summary)
10719 @findex gnus-mailing-list-post
10720 Post to the mailing list, if List-Post field exists.
10721
10722 @item C-c C-n o
10723 @kindex C-c C-n o (Summary)
10724 @findex gnus-mailing-list-owner
10725 Send a message to the mailing list owner, if List-Owner field exists.
10726
10727 @item C-c C-n a
10728 @kindex C-c C-n a (Summary)
10729 @findex gnus-mailing-list-owner
10730 Browse the mailing list archive, if List-Archive field exists.
10731
10732 @end table
10733
10734
10735 @node Article Buffer
10736 @chapter Article Buffer
10737 @cindex article buffer
10738
10739 The articles are displayed in the article buffer, of which there is only
10740 one. All the summary buffers share the same article buffer unless you
10741 tell Gnus otherwise.
10742
10743 @menu
10744 * Hiding Headers:: Deciding what headers should be displayed.
10745 * Using MIME:: Pushing articles through @acronym{MIME} before reading them.
10746 * Customizing Articles:: Tailoring the look of the articles.
10747 * Article Keymap:: Keystrokes available in the article buffer.
10748 * Misc Article:: Other stuff.
10749 @end menu
10750
10751
10752 @node Hiding Headers
10753 @section Hiding Headers
10754 @cindex hiding headers
10755 @cindex deleting headers
10756
10757 The top section of each article is the @dfn{head}. (The rest is the
10758 @dfn{body}, but you may have guessed that already.)
10759
10760 @vindex gnus-show-all-headers
10761 There is a lot of useful information in the head: the name of the person
10762 who wrote the article, the date it was written and the subject of the
10763 article. That's well and nice, but there's also lots of information
10764 most people do not want to see---what systems the article has passed
10765 through before reaching you, the @code{Message-ID}, the
10766 @code{References}, etc. ad nauseam---and you'll probably want to get rid
10767 of some of those lines. If you want to keep all those lines in the
10768 article buffer, you can set @code{gnus-show-all-headers} to @code{t}.
10769
10770 Gnus provides you with two variables for sifting headers:
10771
10772 @table @code
10773
10774 @item gnus-visible-headers
10775 @vindex gnus-visible-headers
10776 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, it should be a regular expression
10777 that says what headers you wish to keep in the article buffer. All
10778 headers that do not match this variable will be hidden.
10779
10780 For instance, if you only want to see the name of the person who wrote
10781 the article and the subject, you'd say:
10782
10783 @lisp
10784 (setq gnus-visible-headers "^From:\\|^Subject:")
10785 @end lisp
10786
10787 This variable can also be a list of regexps to match headers to
10788 remain visible.
10789
10790 @item gnus-ignored-headers
10791 @vindex gnus-ignored-headers
10792 This variable is the reverse of @code{gnus-visible-headers}. If this
10793 variable is set (and @code{gnus-visible-headers} is @code{nil}), it
10794 should be a regular expression that matches all lines that you want to
10795 hide. All lines that do not match this variable will remain visible.
10796
10797 For instance, if you just want to get rid of the @code{References} line
10798 and the @code{Xref} line, you might say:
10799
10800 @lisp
10801 (setq gnus-ignored-headers "^References:\\|^Xref:")
10802 @end lisp
10803
10804 This variable can also be a list of regexps to match headers to
10805 be removed.
10806
10807 Note that if @code{gnus-visible-headers} is non-@code{nil}, this
10808 variable will have no effect.
10809
10810 @end table
10811
10812 @vindex gnus-sorted-header-list
10813 Gnus can also sort the headers for you. (It does this by default.) You
10814 can control the sorting by setting the @code{gnus-sorted-header-list}
10815 variable. It is a list of regular expressions that says in what order
10816 the headers are to be displayed.
10817
10818 For instance, if you want the name of the author of the article first,
10819 and then the subject, you might say something like:
10820
10821 @lisp
10822 (setq gnus-sorted-header-list '("^From:" "^Subject:"))
10823 @end lisp
10824
10825 Any headers that are to remain visible, but are not listed in this
10826 variable, will be displayed in random order after all the headers listed in this variable.
10827
10828 @findex gnus-article-hide-boring-headers
10829 @vindex gnus-boring-article-headers
10830 You can hide further boring headers by setting
10831 @code{gnus-treat-hide-boring-headers} to @code{head}. What this function
10832 does depends on the @code{gnus-boring-article-headers} variable. It's a
10833 list, but this list doesn't actually contain header names. Instead it
10834 lists various @dfn{boring conditions} that Gnus can check and remove
10835 from sight.
10836
10837 These conditions are:
10838 @table @code
10839 @item empty
10840 Remove all empty headers.
10841 @item followup-to
10842 Remove the @code{Followup-To} header if it is identical to the
10843 @code{Newsgroups} header.
10844 @item reply-to
10845 Remove the @code{Reply-To} header if it lists the same addresses as
10846 the @code{From} header, or if the @code{broken-reply-to} group
10847 parameter is set.
10848 @item newsgroups
10849 Remove the @code{Newsgroups} header if it only contains the current group
10850 name.
10851 @item to-address
10852 Remove the @code{To} header if it only contains the address identical to
10853 the current group's @code{to-address} parameter.
10854 @item to-list
10855 Remove the @code{To} header if it only contains the address identical to
10856 the current group's @code{to-list} parameter.
10857 @item cc-list
10858 Remove the @code{CC} header if it only contains the address identical to
10859 the current group's @code{to-list} parameter.
10860 @item date
10861 Remove the @code{Date} header if the article is less than three days
10862 old.
10863 @item long-to
10864 Remove the @code{To} header if it is very long.
10865 @item many-to
10866 Remove all @code{To} headers if there are more than one.
10867 @end table
10868
10869 To include these three elements, you could say something like:
10870
10871 @lisp
10872 (setq gnus-boring-article-headers
10873 '(empty followup-to reply-to))
10874 @end lisp
10875
10876 This is also the default value for this variable.
10877
10878
10879 @node Using MIME
10880 @section Using MIME
10881 @cindex @acronym{MIME}
10882
10883 Mime is a standard for waving your hands through the air, aimlessly,
10884 while people stand around yawning.
10885
10886 @acronym{MIME}, however, is a standard for encoding your articles, aimlessly,
10887 while all newsreaders die of fear.
10888
10889 @acronym{MIME} may specify what character set the article uses, the encoding
10890 of the characters, and it also makes it possible to embed pictures and
10891 other naughty stuff in innocent-looking articles.
10892
10893 @vindex gnus-display-mime-function
10894 @findex gnus-display-mime
10895 Gnus pushes @acronym{MIME} articles through @code{gnus-display-mime-function}
10896 to display the @acronym{MIME} parts. This is @code{gnus-display-mime} by
10897 default, which creates a bundle of clickable buttons that can be used to
10898 display, save and manipulate the @acronym{MIME} objects.
10899
10900 The following commands are available when you have placed point over a
10901 @acronym{MIME} button:
10902
10903 @table @kbd
10904 @findex gnus-article-press-button
10905 @item RET (Article)
10906 @kindex RET (Article)
10907 @itemx BUTTON-2 (Article)
10908 Toggle displaying of the @acronym{MIME} object
10909 (@code{gnus-article-press-button}). If built-in viewers can not display
10910 the object, Gnus resorts to external viewers in the @file{mailcap}
10911 files. If a viewer has the @samp{copiousoutput} specification, the
10912 object is displayed inline.
10913
10914 @findex gnus-mime-view-part
10915 @item M-RET (Article)
10916 @kindex M-RET (Article)
10917 @itemx v (Article)
10918 Prompt for a method, and then view the @acronym{MIME} object using this
10919 method (@code{gnus-mime-view-part}).
10920
10921 @findex gnus-mime-view-part-as-type
10922 @item t (Article)
10923 @kindex t (Article)
10924 View the @acronym{MIME} object as if it were a different @acronym{MIME} media type
10925 (@code{gnus-mime-view-part-as-type}).
10926
10927 @findex gnus-mime-view-part-as-charset
10928 @item C (Article)
10929 @kindex C (Article)
10930 Prompt for a charset, and then view the @acronym{MIME} object using this
10931 charset (@code{gnus-mime-view-part-as-charset}).
10932
10933 @findex gnus-mime-save-part
10934 @item o (Article)
10935 @kindex o (Article)
10936 Prompt for a file name, and then save the @acronym{MIME} object
10937 (@code{gnus-mime-save-part}).
10938
10939 @findex gnus-mime-save-part-and-strip
10940 @item C-o (Article)
10941 @kindex C-o (Article)
10942 Prompt for a file name, then save the @acronym{MIME} object and strip it from
10943 the article. Then proceed to article editing, where a reasonable
10944 suggestion is being made on how the altered article should look
10945 like. The stripped @acronym{MIME} object will be referred via the
10946 message/external-body @acronym{MIME} type.
10947 (@code{gnus-mime-save-part-and-strip}).
10948
10949 @findex gnus-mime-delete-part
10950 @item d (Article)
10951 @kindex d (Article)
10952 Delete the @acronym{MIME} object from the article and replace it with some
10953 information about the removed @acronym{MIME} object
10954 (@code{gnus-mime-delete-part}).
10955
10956 @findex gnus-mime-copy-part
10957 @item c (Article)
10958 @kindex c (Article)
10959 Copy the @acronym{MIME} object to a fresh buffer and display this buffer
10960 (@code{gnus-mime-copy-part}). Compressed files like @file{.gz} and
10961 @file{.bz2} are automatically decompressed if
10962 @code{auto-compression-mode} is enabled (@pxref{Compressed Files,,
10963 Accessing Compressed Files, emacs, The Emacs Editor}).
10964
10965 @findex gnus-mime-print-part
10966 @item p (Article)
10967 @kindex p (Article)
10968 Print the @acronym{MIME} object (@code{gnus-mime-print-part}). This
10969 command respects the @samp{print=} specifications in the
10970 @file{.mailcap} file.
10971
10972 @findex gnus-mime-inline-part
10973 @item i (Article)
10974 @kindex i (Article)
10975 Insert the contents of the @acronym{MIME} object into the buffer
10976 (@code{gnus-mime-inline-part}) as text/plain. If given a prefix, insert
10977 the raw contents without decoding. If given a numerical prefix, you can
10978 do semi-manual charset stuff (see
10979 @code{gnus-summary-show-article-charset-alist} in @ref{Paging the
10980 Article}).
10981
10982 @findex gnus-mime-view-part-internally
10983 @item E (Article)
10984 @kindex E (Article)
10985 View the @acronym{MIME} object with an internal viewer. If no internal
10986 viewer is available, use an external viewer
10987 (@code{gnus-mime-view-part-internally}).
10988
10989 @findex gnus-mime-view-part-externally
10990 @item e (Article)
10991 @kindex e (Article)
10992 View the @acronym{MIME} object with an external viewer.
10993 (@code{gnus-mime-view-part-externally}).
10994
10995 @findex gnus-mime-pipe-part
10996 @item | (Article)
10997 @kindex | (Article)
10998 Output the @acronym{MIME} object to a process (@code{gnus-mime-pipe-part}).
10999
11000 @findex gnus-mime-action-on-part
11001 @item . (Article)
11002 @kindex . (Article)
11003 Interactively run an action on the @acronym{MIME} object
11004 (@code{gnus-mime-action-on-part}).
11005
11006 @end table
11007
11008 Gnus will display some @acronym{MIME} objects automatically. The way Gnus
11009 determines which parts to do this with is described in the Emacs
11010 @acronym{MIME} manual.
11011
11012 It might be best to just use the toggling functions from the article
11013 buffer to avoid getting nasty surprises. (For instance, you enter the
11014 group @samp{alt.sing-a-long} and, before you know it, @acronym{MIME} has
11015 decoded the sound file in the article and some horrible sing-a-long song
11016 comes screaming out your speakers, and you can't find the volume button,
11017 because there isn't one, and people are starting to look at you, and you
11018 try to stop the program, but you can't, and you can't find the program
11019 to control the volume, and everybody else in the room suddenly decides
11020 to look at you disdainfully, and you'll feel rather stupid.)
11021
11022 Any similarity to real events and people is purely coincidental. Ahem.
11023
11024 Also @pxref{MIME Commands}.
11025
11026
11027 @node Customizing Articles
11028 @section Customizing Articles
11029 @cindex article customization
11030
11031 A slew of functions for customizing how the articles are to look like
11032 exist. You can call these functions interactively
11033 (@pxref{Article Washing}), or you can have them
11034 called automatically when you select the articles.
11035
11036 To have them called automatically, you should set the corresponding
11037 ``treatment'' variable. For instance, to have headers hidden, you'd set
11038 @code{gnus-treat-hide-headers}. Below is a list of variables that can
11039 be set, but first we discuss the values these variables can have.
11040
11041 Note: Some values, while valid, make little sense. Check the list below
11042 for sensible values.
11043
11044 @enumerate
11045 @item
11046 @code{nil}: Don't do this treatment.
11047
11048 @item
11049 @code{t}: Do this treatment on all body parts.
11050
11051 @item
11052 @code{head}: Do the treatment on the headers.
11053
11054 @item
11055 @code{last}: Do this treatment on the last part.
11056
11057 @item
11058 An integer: Do this treatment on all body parts that have a length less
11059 than this number.
11060
11061 @item
11062 A list of strings: Do this treatment on all body parts that are in
11063 articles that are read in groups that have names that match one of the
11064 regexps in the list.
11065
11066 @item
11067 A list where the first element is not a string:
11068
11069 The list is evaluated recursively. The first element of the list is a
11070 predicate. The following predicates are recognized: @code{or},
11071 @code{and}, @code{not} and @code{typep}. Here's an example:
11072
11073 @lisp
11074 (or last
11075 (typep "text/x-vcard"))
11076 @end lisp
11077
11078 @end enumerate
11079
11080 You may have noticed that the word @dfn{part} is used here. This refers
11081 to the fact that some messages are @acronym{MIME} multipart articles that may
11082 be divided into several parts. Articles that are not multiparts are
11083 considered to contain just a single part.
11084
11085 @vindex gnus-article-treat-types
11086 Are the treatments applied to all sorts of multipart parts? Yes, if you
11087 want to, but by default, only @samp{text/plain} parts are given the
11088 treatment. This is controlled by the @code{gnus-article-treat-types}
11089 variable, which is a list of regular expressions that are matched to the
11090 type of the part. This variable is ignored if the value of the
11091 controlling variable is a predicate list, as described above.
11092
11093 The following treatment options are available. The easiest way to
11094 customize this is to examine the @code{gnus-article-treat} customization
11095 group. Values in parenthesis are suggested sensible values. Others are
11096 possible but those listed are probably sufficient for most people.
11097
11098 @table @code
11099 @item gnus-treat-buttonize (t, integer)
11100 @item gnus-treat-buttonize-head (head)
11101
11102 @xref{Article Buttons}.
11103
11104 @item gnus-treat-capitalize-sentences (t, integer)
11105 @item gnus-treat-overstrike (t, integer)
11106 @item gnus-treat-strip-cr (t, integer)
11107 @item gnus-treat-strip-headers-in-body (t, integer)
11108 @item gnus-treat-strip-leading-blank-lines (t, integer)
11109 @item gnus-treat-strip-multiple-blank-lines (t, integer)
11110 @item gnus-treat-strip-pem (t, last, integer)
11111 @item gnus-treat-strip-trailing-blank-lines (t, last, integer)
11112 @item gnus-treat-unsplit-urls (t, integer)
11113 @item gnus-treat-wash-html (t, integer)
11114
11115 @xref{Article Washing}.
11116
11117 @item gnus-treat-date-english (head)
11118 @item gnus-treat-date-iso8601 (head)
11119 @item gnus-treat-date-lapsed (head)
11120 @item gnus-treat-date-local (head)
11121 @item gnus-treat-date-original (head)
11122 @item gnus-treat-date-user-defined (head)
11123 @item gnus-treat-date-ut (head)
11124
11125 @xref{Article Date}.
11126
11127 @item gnus-treat-from-picon (head)
11128 @item gnus-treat-mail-picon (head)
11129 @item gnus-treat-newsgroups-picon (head)
11130
11131 @xref{Picons}.
11132
11133 @item gnus-treat-display-smileys (t, integer)
11134
11135 @item gnus-treat-body-boundary (head)
11136
11137 @vindex gnus-body-boundary-delimiter
11138 Adds a delimiter between header and body, the string used as delimiter
11139 is controlled by @code{gnus-body-boundary-delimiter}.
11140
11141 @xref{Smileys}.
11142
11143 @item gnus-treat-display-x-face (head)
11144
11145 @xref{X-Face}.
11146
11147 @item gnus-treat-display-face (head)
11148
11149 @xref{Face}.
11150
11151 @item gnus-treat-emphasize (t, head, integer)
11152 @item gnus-treat-fill-article (t, integer)
11153 @item gnus-treat-fill-long-lines (t, integer)
11154 @item gnus-treat-hide-boring-headers (head)
11155 @item gnus-treat-hide-citation (t, integer)
11156 @item gnus-treat-hide-citation-maybe (t, integer)
11157 @item gnus-treat-hide-headers (head)
11158 @item gnus-treat-hide-signature (t, last)
11159 @item gnus-treat-strip-banner (t, last)
11160 @item gnus-treat-strip-list-identifiers (head)
11161
11162 @xref{Article Hiding}.
11163
11164 @item gnus-treat-highlight-citation (t, integer)
11165 @item gnus-treat-highlight-headers (head)
11166 @item gnus-treat-highlight-signature (t, last, integer)
11167
11168 @xref{Article Highlighting}.
11169
11170 @item gnus-treat-play-sounds
11171 @item gnus-treat-translate
11172 @item gnus-treat-x-pgp-sig (head)
11173
11174 @item gnus-treat-unfold-headers (head)
11175 @item gnus-treat-fold-headers (head)
11176 @item gnus-treat-fold-newsgroups (head)
11177 @item gnus-treat-leading-whitespace (head)
11178
11179 @xref{Article Header}.
11180
11181
11182 @end table
11183
11184 @vindex gnus-part-display-hook
11185 You can, of course, write your own functions to be called from
11186 @code{gnus-part-display-hook}. The functions are called narrowed to the
11187 part, and you can do anything you like, pretty much. There is no
11188 information that you have to keep in the buffer---you can change
11189 everything.
11190
11191
11192 @node Article Keymap
11193 @section Article Keymap
11194
11195 Most of the keystrokes in the summary buffer can also be used in the
11196 article buffer. They should behave as if you typed them in the summary
11197 buffer, which means that you don't actually have to have a summary
11198 buffer displayed while reading. You can do it all from the article
11199 buffer.
11200
11201 A few additional keystrokes are available:
11202
11203 @table @kbd
11204
11205 @item SPACE
11206 @kindex SPACE (Article)
11207 @findex gnus-article-next-page
11208 Scroll forwards one page (@code{gnus-article-next-page}).
11209 This is exactly the same as @kbd{h SPACE h}.
11210
11211 @item DEL
11212 @kindex DEL (Article)
11213 @findex gnus-article-prev-page
11214 Scroll backwards one page (@code{gnus-article-prev-page}).
11215 This is exactly the same as @kbd{h DEL h}.
11216
11217 @item C-c ^
11218 @kindex C-c ^ (Article)
11219 @findex gnus-article-refer-article
11220 If point is in the neighborhood of a @code{Message-ID} and you press
11221 @kbd{C-c ^}, Gnus will try to get that article from the server
11222 (@code{gnus-article-refer-article}).
11223
11224 @item C-c C-m
11225 @kindex C-c C-m (Article)
11226 @findex gnus-article-mail
11227 Send a reply to the address near point (@code{gnus-article-mail}). If
11228 given a prefix, include the mail.
11229
11230 @item s
11231 @kindex s (Article)
11232 @findex gnus-article-show-summary
11233 Reconfigure the buffers so that the summary buffer becomes visible
11234 (@code{gnus-article-show-summary}).
11235
11236 @item ?
11237 @kindex ? (Article)
11238 @findex gnus-article-describe-briefly
11239 Give a very brief description of the available keystrokes
11240 (@code{gnus-article-describe-briefly}).
11241
11242 @item TAB
11243 @kindex TAB (Article)
11244 @findex gnus-article-next-button
11245 Go to the next button, if any (@code{gnus-article-next-button}). This
11246 only makes sense if you have buttonizing turned on.
11247
11248 @item M-TAB
11249 @kindex M-TAB (Article)
11250 @findex gnus-article-prev-button
11251 Go to the previous button, if any (@code{gnus-article-prev-button}).
11252
11253 @item R
11254 @kindex R (Article)
11255 @findex gnus-article-reply-with-original
11256 Send a reply to the current article and yank the current article
11257 (@code{gnus-article-reply-with-original}). If given a prefix, make a
11258 wide reply. If the region is active, only yank the text in the
11259 region.
11260
11261 @item F
11262 @kindex F (Article)
11263 @findex gnus-article-followup-with-original
11264 Send a followup to the current article and yank the current article
11265 (@code{gnus-article-followup-with-original}). If given a prefix, make
11266 a wide reply. If the region is active, only yank the text in the
11267 region.
11268
11269
11270 @end table
11271
11272
11273 @node Misc Article
11274 @section Misc Article
11275
11276 @table @code
11277
11278 @item gnus-single-article-buffer
11279 @vindex gnus-single-article-buffer
11280 If non-@code{nil}, use the same article buffer for all the groups.
11281 (This is the default.) If @code{nil}, each group will have its own
11282 article buffer.
11283
11284 @vindex gnus-article-decode-hook
11285 @item gnus-article-decode-hook
11286 @cindex @acronym{MIME}
11287 Hook used to decode @acronym{MIME} articles. The default value is
11288 @code{(article-decode-charset article-decode-encoded-words)}
11289
11290 @vindex gnus-article-prepare-hook
11291 @item gnus-article-prepare-hook
11292 This hook is called right after the article has been inserted into the
11293 article buffer. It is mainly intended for functions that do something
11294 depending on the contents; it should probably not be used for changing
11295 the contents of the article buffer.
11296
11297 @item gnus-article-mode-hook
11298 @vindex gnus-article-mode-hook
11299 Hook called in article mode buffers.
11300
11301 @item gnus-article-mode-syntax-table
11302 @vindex gnus-article-mode-syntax-table
11303 Syntax table used in article buffers. It is initialized from
11304 @code{text-mode-syntax-table}.
11305
11306 @vindex gnus-article-over-scroll
11307 @item gnus-article-over-scroll
11308 If non-@code{nil}, allow scrolling the article buffer even when there
11309 no more new text to scroll in. The default is @code{nil}.
11310
11311 @vindex gnus-article-mode-line-format
11312 @item gnus-article-mode-line-format
11313 This variable is a format string along the same lines as
11314 @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format} (@pxref{Summary Buffer Mode
11315 Line}). It accepts the same format specifications as that variable,
11316 with two extensions:
11317
11318 @table @samp
11319
11320 @item w
11321 The @dfn{wash status} of the article. This is a short string with one
11322 character for each possible article wash operation that may have been
11323 performed. The characters and their meaning:
11324
11325 @table @samp
11326
11327 @item c
11328 Displayed when cited text may be hidden in the article buffer.
11329
11330 @item h
11331 Displayed when headers are hidden in the article buffer.
11332
11333 @item p
11334 Displayed when article is digitally signed or encrypted, and Gnus has
11335 hidden the security headers. (N.B. does not tell anything about
11336 security status, i.e. good or bad signature.)
11337
11338 @item s
11339 Displayed when the signature has been hidden in the Article buffer.
11340
11341 @item o
11342 Displayed when Gnus has treated overstrike characters in the article buffer.
11343
11344 @item e
11345 Displayed when Gnus has treated emphasised strings in the article buffer.
11346
11347 @end table
11348
11349 @item m
11350 The number of @acronym{MIME} parts in the article.
11351
11352 @end table
11353
11354 @vindex gnus-break-pages
11355
11356 @item gnus-break-pages
11357 Controls whether @dfn{page breaking} is to take place. If this variable
11358 is non-@code{nil}, the articles will be divided into pages whenever a
11359 page delimiter appears in the article. If this variable is @code{nil},
11360 paging will not be done.
11361
11362 @item gnus-page-delimiter
11363 @vindex gnus-page-delimiter
11364 This is the delimiter mentioned above. By default, it is @samp{^L}
11365 (formfeed).
11366
11367 @cindex IDNA
11368 @cindex internationalized domain names
11369 @vindex gnus-use-idna
11370 @item gnus-use-idna
11371 This variable controls whether Gnus performs IDNA decoding of
11372 internationalized domain names inside @samp{From}, @samp{To} and
11373 @samp{Cc} headers. This requires
11374 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/libidn/, GNU Libidn}, and this
11375 variable is only enabled if you have installed it.
11376
11377 @end table
11378
11379
11380 @node Composing Messages
11381 @chapter Composing Messages
11382 @cindex composing messages
11383 @cindex messages
11384 @cindex mail
11385 @cindex sending mail
11386 @cindex reply
11387 @cindex followup
11388 @cindex post
11389 @cindex using gpg
11390 @cindex using s/mime
11391 @cindex using smime
11392
11393 @kindex C-c C-c (Post)
11394 All commands for posting and mailing will put you in a message buffer
11395 where you can edit the article all you like, before you send the
11396 article by pressing @kbd{C-c C-c}. @xref{Top, , Overview, message,
11397 Message Manual}. Where the message will be posted/mailed to depends
11398 on your setup (@pxref{Posting Server}).
11399
11400 @menu
11401 * Mail:: Mailing and replying.
11402 * Posting Server:: What server should you post and mail via?
11403 * POP before SMTP:: You cannot send a mail unless you read a mail.
11404 * Mail and Post:: Mailing and posting at the same time.
11405 * Archived Messages:: Where Gnus stores the messages you've sent.
11406 * Posting Styles:: An easier way to specify who you are.
11407 * Drafts:: Postponing messages and rejected messages.
11408 * Rejected Articles:: What happens if the server doesn't like your article?
11409 * Signing and encrypting:: How to compose secure messages.
11410 @end menu
11411
11412 Also @pxref{Canceling and Superseding} for information on how to
11413 remove articles you shouldn't have posted.
11414
11415
11416 @node Mail
11417 @section Mail
11418
11419 Variables for customizing outgoing mail:
11420
11421 @table @code
11422 @item gnus-uu-digest-headers
11423 @vindex gnus-uu-digest-headers
11424 List of regexps to match headers included in digested messages. The
11425 headers will be included in the sequence they are matched. If
11426 @code{nil} include all headers.
11427
11428 @item gnus-add-to-list
11429 @vindex gnus-add-to-list
11430 If non-@code{nil}, add a @code{to-list} group parameter to mail groups
11431 that have none when you do a @kbd{a}.
11432
11433 @item gnus-confirm-mail-reply-to-news
11434 @vindex gnus-confirm-mail-reply-to-news
11435 This can also be a function receiving the group name as the only
11436 parameter which should return non-@code{nil} if a confirmation is
11437 needed, or a regular expression matching group names, where
11438 confirmation is should be asked for.
11439
11440 If you find yourself never wanting to reply to mail, but occasionally
11441 press R anyway, this variable might be for you.
11442
11443 @item gnus-confirm-treat-mail-like-news
11444 @vindex gnus-confirm-treat-mail-like-news
11445 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus also requests confirmation according to
11446 @code{gnus-confirm-mail-reply-to-news} when replying to mail. This is
11447 useful for treating mailing lists like newsgroups.
11448
11449 @end table
11450
11451
11452 @node Posting Server
11453 @section Posting Server
11454
11455 When you press those magical @kbd{C-c C-c} keys to ship off your latest
11456 (extremely intelligent, of course) article, where does it go?
11457
11458 Thank you for asking. I hate you.
11459
11460 It can be quite complicated.
11461
11462 @vindex gnus-post-method
11463 When posting news, Message usually invokes @code{message-send-news}
11464 (@pxref{News Variables, , News Variables, message, Message Manual}).
11465 Normally, Gnus will post using the same select method as you're
11466 reading from (which might be convenient if you're reading lots of
11467 groups from different private servers). However. If the server
11468 you're reading from doesn't allow posting, just reading, you probably
11469 want to use some other server to post your (extremely intelligent and
11470 fabulously interesting) articles. You can then set the
11471 @code{gnus-post-method} to some other method:
11472
11473 @lisp
11474 (setq gnus-post-method '(nnspool ""))
11475 @end lisp
11476
11477 Now, if you've done this, and then this server rejects your article, or
11478 this server is down, what do you do then? To override this variable you
11479 can use a non-zero prefix to the @kbd{C-c C-c} command to force using
11480 the ``current'' server, to get back the default behavior, for posting.
11481
11482 If you give a zero prefix (i.e., @kbd{C-u 0 C-c C-c}) to that command,
11483 Gnus will prompt you for what method to use for posting.
11484
11485 You can also set @code{gnus-post-method} to a list of select methods.
11486 If that's the case, Gnus will always prompt you for what method to use
11487 for posting.
11488
11489 Finally, if you want to always post using the native select method,
11490 you can set this variable to @code{native}.
11491
11492 When sending mail, Message invokes @code{message-send-mail-function}.
11493 The default function, @code{message-send-mail-with-sendmail}, pipes
11494 your article to the @code{sendmail} binary for further queuing and
11495 sending. When your local system is not configured for sending mail
11496 using @code{sendmail}, and you have access to a remote @acronym{SMTP}
11497 server, you can set @code{message-send-mail-function} to
11498 @code{smtpmail-send-it} and make sure to setup the @code{smtpmail}
11499 package correctly. An example:
11500
11501 @lisp
11502 (setq message-send-mail-function 'smtpmail-send-it
11503 smtpmail-default-smtp-server "YOUR SMTP HOST")
11504 @end lisp
11505
11506 To the thing similar to this, there is
11507 @code{message-smtpmail-send-it}. It is useful if your @acronym{ISP}
11508 requires the @acronym{POP}-before-@acronym{SMTP} authentication.
11509 @xref{POP before SMTP}.
11510
11511 Other possible choices for @code{message-send-mail-function} includes
11512 @code{message-send-mail-with-mh}, @code{message-send-mail-with-qmail},
11513 and @code{feedmail-send-it}.
11514
11515 @node POP before SMTP
11516 @section POP before SMTP
11517 @cindex pop before smtp
11518 @findex message-smtpmail-send-it
11519 @findex mail-source-touch-pop
11520
11521 Does your @acronym{ISP} require the @acronym{POP}-before-@acronym{SMTP}
11522 authentication? It is whether you need to connect to the @acronym{POP}
11523 mail server within a certain time before sending mails. If so, there is
11524 a convenient way. To do that, put the following lines in your
11525 @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
11526
11527 @lisp
11528 (setq message-send-mail-function 'message-smtpmail-send-it)
11529 (add-hook 'message-send-mail-hook 'mail-source-touch-pop)
11530 @end lisp
11531
11532 @noindent
11533 It means to let Gnus connect to the @acronym{POP} mail server in advance
11534 whenever you send a mail. The @code{mail-source-touch-pop} function
11535 does only a @acronym{POP} authentication according to the value of
11536 @code{mail-sources} without fetching mails, just before sending a mail.
11537 Note that you have to use @code{message-smtpmail-send-it} which runs
11538 @code{message-send-mail-hook} rather than @code{smtpmail-send-it} and
11539 set the value of @code{mail-sources} for a @acronym{POP} connection
11540 correctly. @xref{Mail Sources}.
11541
11542 If you have two or more @acronym{POP} mail servers set in
11543 @code{mail-sources}, you may want to specify one of them to
11544 @code{mail-source-primary-source} as the @acronym{POP} mail server to be
11545 used for the @acronym{POP}-before-@acronym{SMTP} authentication. If it
11546 is your primary @acronym{POP} mail server (i.e., you are fetching mails
11547 mainly from that server), you can set it permanently as follows:
11548
11549 @lisp
11550 (setq mail-source-primary-source
11551 '(pop :server "pop3.mail.server"
11552 :password "secret"))
11553 @end lisp
11554
11555 @noindent
11556 Otherwise, bind it dynamically only when performing the
11557 @acronym{POP}-before-@acronym{SMTP} authentication as follows:
11558
11559 @lisp
11560 (add-hook 'message-send-mail-hook
11561 (lambda ()
11562 (let ((mail-source-primary-source
11563 '(pop :server "pop3.mail.server"
11564 :password "secret")))
11565 (mail-source-touch-pop))))
11566 @end lisp
11567
11568 @node Mail and Post
11569 @section Mail and Post
11570
11571 Here's a list of variables relevant to both mailing and
11572 posting:
11573
11574 @table @code
11575 @item gnus-mailing-list-groups
11576 @findex gnus-mailing-list-groups
11577 @cindex mailing lists
11578
11579 If your news server offers groups that are really mailing lists
11580 gatewayed to the @acronym{NNTP} server, you can read those groups without
11581 problems, but you can't post/followup to them without some difficulty.
11582 One solution is to add a @code{to-address} to the group parameters
11583 (@pxref{Group Parameters}). An easier thing to do is set the
11584 @code{gnus-mailing-list-groups} to a regexp that matches the groups that
11585 really are mailing lists. Then, at least, followups to the mailing
11586 lists will work most of the time. Posting to these groups (@kbd{a}) is
11587 still a pain, though.
11588
11589 @item gnus-user-agent
11590 @vindex gnus-user-agent
11591 @cindex User-Agent
11592
11593 This variable controls which information should be exposed in the
11594 User-Agent header. It can be one of the symbols @code{gnus} (show only
11595 Gnus version), @code{emacs-gnus} (show only Emacs and Gnus versions),
11596 @code{emacs-gnus-config} (same as @code{emacs-gnus} plus system
11597 configuration), @code{emacs-gnus-type} (same as @code{emacs-gnus} plus
11598 system type) or a custom string. If you set it to a string, be sure to
11599 use a valid format, see RFC 2616.
11600
11601 @end table
11602
11603 You may want to do spell-checking on messages that you send out. Or, if
11604 you don't want to spell-check by hand, you could add automatic
11605 spell-checking via the @code{ispell} package:
11606
11607 @cindex ispell
11608 @findex ispell-message
11609 @lisp
11610 (add-hook 'message-send-hook 'ispell-message)
11611 @end lisp
11612
11613 If you want to change the @code{ispell} dictionary based on what group
11614 you're in, you could say something like the following:
11615
11616 @lisp
11617 (add-hook 'gnus-select-group-hook
11618 (lambda ()
11619 (cond
11620 ((string-match
11621 "^de\\." (gnus-group-real-name gnus-newsgroup-name))
11622 (ispell-change-dictionary "deutsch"))
11623 (t
11624 (ispell-change-dictionary "english")))))
11625 @end lisp
11626
11627 Modify to suit your needs.
11628
11629
11630 @node Archived Messages
11631 @section Archived Messages
11632 @cindex archived messages
11633 @cindex sent messages
11634
11635 Gnus provides a few different methods for storing the mail and news you
11636 send. The default method is to use the @dfn{archive virtual server} to
11637 store the messages. If you want to disable this completely, the
11638 @code{gnus-message-archive-group} variable should be @code{nil}, which
11639 is the default.
11640
11641 For archiving interesting messages in a group you read, see the
11642 @kbd{B c} (@code{gnus-summary-copy-article}) command (@pxref{Mail
11643 Group Commands}).
11644
11645 @vindex gnus-message-archive-method
11646 @code{gnus-message-archive-method} says what virtual server Gnus is to
11647 use to store sent messages. The default is:
11648
11649 @lisp
11650 (nnfolder "archive"
11651 (nnfolder-directory "~/Mail/archive")
11652 (nnfolder-active-file "~/Mail/archive/active")
11653 (nnfolder-get-new-mail nil)
11654 (nnfolder-inhibit-expiry t))
11655 @end lisp
11656
11657 You can, however, use any mail select method (@code{nnml},
11658 @code{nnmbox}, etc.). @code{nnfolder} is a quite likable select method
11659 for doing this sort of thing, though. If you don't like the default
11660 directory chosen, you could say something like:
11661
11662 @lisp
11663 (setq gnus-message-archive-method
11664 '(nnfolder "archive"
11665 (nnfolder-inhibit-expiry t)
11666 (nnfolder-active-file "~/News/sent-mail/active")
11667 (nnfolder-directory "~/News/sent-mail/")))
11668 @end lisp
11669
11670 @vindex gnus-message-archive-group
11671 @cindex Gcc
11672 Gnus will insert @code{Gcc} headers in all outgoing messages that point
11673 to one or more group(s) on that server. Which group to use is
11674 determined by the @code{gnus-message-archive-group} variable.
11675
11676 This variable can be used to do the following:
11677
11678 @table @asis
11679 @item a string
11680 Messages will be saved in that group.
11681
11682 Note that you can include a select method in the group name, then the
11683 message will not be stored in the select method given by
11684 @code{gnus-message-archive-method}, but in the select method specified
11685 by the group name, instead. Suppose @code{gnus-message-archive-method}
11686 has the default value shown above. Then setting
11687 @code{gnus-message-archive-group} to @code{"foo"} means that outgoing
11688 messages are stored in @samp{nnfolder+archive:foo}, but if you use the
11689 value @code{"nnml:foo"}, then outgoing messages will be stored in
11690 @samp{nnml:foo}.
11691
11692 @item a list of strings
11693 Messages will be saved in all those groups.
11694
11695 @item an alist of regexps, functions and forms
11696 When a key ``matches'', the result is used.
11697
11698 @item @code{nil}
11699 No message archiving will take place. This is the default.
11700 @end table
11701
11702 Let's illustrate:
11703
11704 Just saving to a single group called @samp{MisK}:
11705 @lisp
11706 (setq gnus-message-archive-group "MisK")
11707 @end lisp
11708
11709 Saving to two groups, @samp{MisK} and @samp{safe}:
11710 @lisp
11711 (setq gnus-message-archive-group '("MisK" "safe"))
11712 @end lisp
11713
11714 Save to different groups based on what group you are in:
11715 @lisp
11716 (setq gnus-message-archive-group
11717 '(("^alt" "sent-to-alt")
11718 ("mail" "sent-to-mail")
11719 (".*" "sent-to-misc")))
11720 @end lisp
11721
11722 More complex stuff:
11723 @lisp
11724 (setq gnus-message-archive-group
11725 '((if (message-news-p)
11726 "misc-news"
11727 "misc-mail")))
11728 @end lisp
11729
11730 How about storing all news messages in one file, but storing all mail
11731 messages in one file per month:
11732
11733 @lisp
11734 (setq gnus-message-archive-group
11735 '((if (message-news-p)
11736 "misc-news"
11737 (concat "mail." (format-time-string "%Y-%m")))))
11738 @end lisp
11739
11740 @c (XEmacs 19.13 doesn't have @code{format-time-string}, so you'll have to
11741 @c use a different value for @code{gnus-message-archive-group} there.)
11742
11743 Now, when you send a message off, it will be stored in the appropriate
11744 group. (If you want to disable storing for just one particular message,
11745 you can just remove the @code{Gcc} header that has been inserted.) The
11746 archive group will appear in the group buffer the next time you start
11747 Gnus, or the next time you press @kbd{F} in the group buffer. You can
11748 enter it and read the articles in it just like you'd read any other
11749 group. If the group gets really big and annoying, you can simply rename
11750 if (using @kbd{G r} in the group buffer) to something
11751 nice---@samp{misc-mail-september-1995}, or whatever. New messages will
11752 continue to be stored in the old (now empty) group.
11753
11754 That's the default method of archiving sent messages. Gnus offers a
11755 different way for the people who don't like the default method. In that
11756 case you should set @code{gnus-message-archive-group} to @code{nil};
11757 this will disable archiving.
11758
11759 @table @code
11760 @item gnus-outgoing-message-group
11761 @vindex gnus-outgoing-message-group
11762 All outgoing messages will be put in this group. If you want to store
11763 all your outgoing mail and articles in the group @samp{nnml:archive},
11764 you set this variable to that value. This variable can also be a list of
11765 group names.
11766
11767 If you want to have greater control over what group to put each
11768 message in, you can set this variable to a function that checks the
11769 current newsgroup name and then returns a suitable group name (or list
11770 of names).
11771
11772 This variable can be used instead of @code{gnus-message-archive-group},
11773 but the latter is the preferred method.
11774
11775 @item gnus-gcc-mark-as-read
11776 @vindex gnus-gcc-mark-as-read
11777 If non-@code{nil}, automatically mark @code{Gcc} articles as read.
11778
11779 @item gnus-gcc-externalize-attachments
11780 @vindex gnus-gcc-externalize-attachments
11781 If @code{nil}, attach files as normal parts in Gcc copies; if a regexp
11782 and matches the Gcc group name, attach files as external parts; if it is
11783 @code{all}, attach local files as external parts; if it is other
11784 non-@code{nil}, the behavior is the same as @code{all}, but it may be
11785 changed in the future.
11786
11787 @end table
11788
11789
11790 @node Posting Styles
11791 @section Posting Styles
11792 @cindex posting styles
11793 @cindex styles
11794
11795 All them variables, they make my head swim.
11796
11797 So what if you want a different @code{Organization} and signature based
11798 on what groups you post to? And you post both from your home machine
11799 and your work machine, and you want different @code{From} lines, and so
11800 on?
11801
11802 @vindex gnus-posting-styles
11803 One way to do stuff like that is to write clever hooks that change the
11804 variables you need to have changed. That's a bit boring, so somebody
11805 came up with the bright idea of letting the user specify these things in
11806 a handy alist. Here's an example of a @code{gnus-posting-styles}
11807 variable:
11808
11809 @lisp
11810 ((".*"
11811 (signature "Peace and happiness")
11812 (organization "What me?"))
11813 ("^comp"
11814 (signature "Death to everybody"))
11815 ("comp.emacs.i-love-it"
11816 (organization "Emacs is it")))
11817 @end lisp
11818
11819 As you might surmise from this example, this alist consists of several
11820 @dfn{styles}. Each style will be applicable if the first element
11821 ``matches'', in some form or other. The entire alist will be iterated
11822 over, from the beginning towards the end, and each match will be
11823 applied, which means that attributes in later styles that match override
11824 the same attributes in earlier matching styles. So
11825 @samp{comp.programming.literate} will have the @samp{Death to everybody}
11826 signature and the @samp{What me?} @code{Organization} header.
11827
11828 The first element in each style is called the @code{match}. If it's a
11829 string, then Gnus will try to regexp match it against the group name.
11830 If it is the form @code{(header @var{match} @var{regexp})}, then Gnus
11831 will look in the original article for a header whose name is
11832 @var{match} and compare that @var{regexp}. @var{match} and
11833 @var{regexp} are strings. (The original article is the one you are
11834 replying or following up to. If you are not composing a reply or a
11835 followup, then there is nothing to match against.) If the
11836 @code{match} is a function symbol, that function will be called with
11837 no arguments. If it's a variable symbol, then the variable will be
11838 referenced. If it's a list, then that list will be @code{eval}ed. In
11839 any case, if this returns a non-@code{nil} value, then the style is
11840 said to @dfn{match}.
11841
11842 Each style may contain an arbitrary amount of @dfn{attributes}. Each
11843 attribute consists of a @code{(@var{name} @var{value})} pair. In
11844 addition, you can also use the @code{(@var{name} :file @var{value})}
11845 form or the @code{(@var{name} :value @var{value})} form. Where
11846 @code{:file} signifies @var{value} represents a file name and its
11847 contents should be used as the attribute value, @code{:value} signifies
11848 @var{value} does not represent a file name explicitly. The attribute
11849 name can be one of:
11850
11851 @itemize @bullet
11852 @item @code{signature}
11853 @item @code{signature-file}
11854 @item @code{x-face-file}
11855 @item @code{address}, overriding @code{user-mail-address}
11856 @item @code{name}, overriding @code{(user-full-name)}
11857 @item @code{body}
11858 @end itemize
11859
11860 The attribute name can also be a string or a symbol. In that case,
11861 this will be used as a header name, and the value will be inserted in
11862 the headers of the article; if the value is @code{nil}, the header
11863 name will be removed. If the attribute name is @code{eval}, the form
11864 is evaluated, and the result is thrown away.
11865
11866 The attribute value can be a string (used verbatim), a function with
11867 zero arguments (the return value will be used), a variable (its value
11868 will be used) or a list (it will be @code{eval}ed and the return value
11869 will be used). The functions and sexps are called/@code{eval}ed in the
11870 message buffer that is being set up. The headers of the current article
11871 are available through the @code{message-reply-headers} variable, which
11872 is a vector of the following headers: number subject from date id
11873 references chars lines xref extra.
11874
11875 @vindex message-reply-headers
11876
11877 If you wish to check whether the message you are about to compose is
11878 meant to be a news article or a mail message, you can check the values
11879 of the @code{message-news-p} and @code{message-mail-p} functions.
11880
11881 @findex message-mail-p
11882 @findex message-news-p
11883
11884 So here's a new example:
11885
11886 @lisp
11887 (setq gnus-posting-styles
11888 '((".*"
11889 (signature-file "~/.signature")
11890 (name "User Name")
11891 ("X-Home-Page" (getenv "WWW_HOME"))
11892 (organization "People's Front Against MWM"))
11893 ("^rec.humor"
11894 (signature my-funny-signature-randomizer))
11895 ((equal (system-name) "gnarly") ;; @r{A form}
11896 (signature my-quote-randomizer))
11897 (message-news-p ;; @r{A function symbol}
11898 (signature my-news-signature))
11899 (window-system ;; @r{A value symbol}
11900 ("X-Window-System" (format "%s" window-system)))
11901 ;; @r{If I'm replying to Larsi, set the Organization header.}
11902 ((header "from" "larsi.*org")
11903 (Organization "Somewhere, Inc."))
11904 ((posting-from-work-p) ;; @r{A user defined function}
11905 (signature-file "~/.work-signature")
11906 (address "user@@bar.foo")
11907 (body "You are fired.\n\nSincerely, your boss.")
11908 (organization "Important Work, Inc"))
11909 ("nnml:.*"
11910 (From (save-excursion
11911 (set-buffer gnus-article-buffer)
11912 (message-fetch-field "to"))))
11913 ("^nn.+:"
11914 (signature-file "~/.mail-signature"))))
11915 @end lisp
11916
11917 The @samp{nnml:.*} rule means that you use the @code{To} address as the
11918 @code{From} address in all your outgoing replies, which might be handy
11919 if you fill many roles.
11920
11921
11922 @node Drafts
11923 @section Drafts
11924 @cindex drafts
11925
11926 If you are writing a message (mail or news) and suddenly remember that
11927 you have a steak in the oven (or some pesto in the food processor, you
11928 craaazy vegetarians), you'll probably wish there was a method to save
11929 the message you are writing so that you can continue editing it some
11930 other day, and send it when you feel its finished.
11931
11932 Well, don't worry about it. Whenever you start composing a message of
11933 some sort using the Gnus mail and post commands, the buffer you get will
11934 automatically associate to an article in a special @dfn{draft} group.
11935 If you save the buffer the normal way (@kbd{C-x C-s}, for instance), the
11936 article will be saved there. (Auto-save files also go to the draft
11937 group.)
11938
11939 @cindex nndraft
11940 @vindex nndraft-directory
11941 The draft group is a special group (which is implemented as an
11942 @code{nndraft} group, if you absolutely have to know) called
11943 @samp{nndraft:drafts}. The variable @code{nndraft-directory} says where
11944 @code{nndraft} is to store its files. What makes this group special is
11945 that you can't tick any articles in it or mark any articles as
11946 read---all articles in the group are permanently unread.
11947
11948 If the group doesn't exist, it will be created and you'll be subscribed
11949 to it. The only way to make it disappear from the Group buffer is to
11950 unsubscribe it. The special properties of the draft group comes from
11951 a group property (@pxref{Group Parameters}), and if lost the group
11952 behaves like any other group. This means the commands below will not
11953 be available. To restore the special properties of the group, the
11954 simplest way is to kill the group, using @kbd{C-k}, and restart
11955 Gnus. The group is automatically created again with the
11956 correct parameters. The content of the group is not lost.
11957
11958 @c @findex gnus-dissociate-buffer-from-draft
11959 @c @kindex C-c M-d (Mail)
11960 @c @kindex C-c M-d (Post)
11961 @c @findex gnus-associate-buffer-with-draft
11962 @c @kindex C-c C-d (Mail)
11963 @c @kindex C-c C-d (Post)
11964 @c If you're writing some super-secret message that you later want to
11965 @c encode with PGP before sending, you may wish to turn the auto-saving
11966 @c (and association with the draft group) off. You never know who might be
11967 @c interested in reading all your extremely valuable and terribly horrible
11968 @c and interesting secrets. The @kbd{C-c M-d}
11969 @c (@code{gnus-dissociate-buffer-from-draft}) command does that for you.
11970 @c If you change your mind and want to turn the auto-saving back on again,
11971 @c @kbd{C-c C-d} (@code{gnus-associate-buffer-with-draft} does that.
11972 @c
11973 @c @vindex gnus-use-draft
11974 @c To leave association with the draft group off by default, set
11975 @c @code{gnus-use-draft} to @code{nil}. It is @code{t} by default.
11976
11977 @findex gnus-draft-edit-message
11978 @kindex D e (Draft)
11979 When you want to continue editing the article, you simply enter the
11980 draft group and push @kbd{D e} (@code{gnus-draft-edit-message}) to do
11981 that. You will be placed in a buffer where you left off.
11982
11983 Rejected articles will also be put in this draft group (@pxref{Rejected
11984 Articles}).
11985
11986 @findex gnus-draft-send-all-messages
11987 @kindex D s (Draft)
11988 @findex gnus-draft-send-message
11989 @kindex D S (Draft)
11990 If you have lots of rejected messages you want to post (or mail) without
11991 doing further editing, you can use the @kbd{D s} command
11992 (@code{gnus-draft-send-message}). This command understands the
11993 process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}). The @kbd{D S}
11994 command (@code{gnus-draft-send-all-messages}) will ship off all messages
11995 in the buffer.
11996
11997 @findex gnus-draft-toggle-sending
11998 @kindex D t (Draft)
11999 If you have some messages that you wish not to send, you can use the
12000 @kbd{D t} (@code{gnus-draft-toggle-sending}) command to mark the message
12001 as unsendable. This is a toggling command.
12002
12003
12004 @node Rejected Articles
12005 @section Rejected Articles
12006 @cindex rejected articles
12007
12008 Sometimes a news server will reject an article. Perhaps the server
12009 doesn't like your face. Perhaps it just feels miserable. Perhaps
12010 @emph{there be demons}. Perhaps you have included too much cited text.
12011 Perhaps the disk is full. Perhaps the server is down.
12012
12013 These situations are, of course, totally beyond the control of Gnus.
12014 (Gnus, of course, loves the way you look, always feels great, has angels
12015 fluttering around inside of it, doesn't care about how much cited text
12016 you include, never runs full and never goes down.) So Gnus saves these
12017 articles until some later time when the server feels better.
12018
12019 The rejected articles will automatically be put in a special draft group
12020 (@pxref{Drafts}). When the server comes back up again, you'd then
12021 typically enter that group and send all the articles off.
12022
12023 @node Signing and encrypting
12024 @section Signing and encrypting
12025 @cindex using gpg
12026 @cindex using s/mime
12027 @cindex using smime
12028
12029 Gnus can digitally sign and encrypt your messages, using vanilla
12030 @acronym{PGP} format or @acronym{PGP/MIME} or @acronym{S/MIME}. For
12031 decoding such messages, see the @code{mm-verify-option} and
12032 @code{mm-decrypt-option} options (@pxref{Security}).
12033
12034 @vindex gnus-message-replysign
12035 @vindex gnus-message-replyencrypt
12036 @vindex gnus-message-replysignencrypted
12037 Often, you would like to sign replies to people who send you signed
12038 messages. Even more often, you might want to encrypt messages which
12039 are in reply to encrypted messages. Gnus offers
12040 @code{gnus-message-replysign} to enable the former, and
12041 @code{gnus-message-replyencrypt} for the latter. In addition, setting
12042 @code{gnus-message-replysignencrypted} (on by default) will sign
12043 automatically encrypted messages.
12044
12045 Instructing @acronym{MML} to perform security operations on a
12046 @acronym{MIME} part is done using the @kbd{C-c C-m s} key map for
12047 signing and the @kbd{C-c C-m c} key map for encryption, as follows.
12048
12049 @table @kbd
12050
12051 @item C-c C-m s s
12052 @kindex C-c C-m s s (Message)
12053 @findex mml-secure-message-sign-smime
12054
12055 Digitally sign current message using @acronym{S/MIME}.
12056
12057 @item C-c C-m s o
12058 @kindex C-c C-m s o (Message)
12059 @findex mml-secure-message-sign-pgp
12060
12061 Digitally sign current message using @acronym{PGP}.
12062
12063 @item C-c C-m s p
12064 @kindex C-c C-m s p (Message)
12065 @findex mml-secure-message-sign-pgp
12066
12067 Digitally sign current message using @acronym{PGP/MIME}.
12068
12069 @item C-c C-m c s
12070 @kindex C-c C-m c s (Message)
12071 @findex mml-secure-message-encrypt-smime
12072
12073 Digitally encrypt current message using @acronym{S/MIME}.
12074
12075 @item C-c C-m c o
12076 @kindex C-c C-m c o (Message)
12077 @findex mml-secure-message-encrypt-pgp
12078
12079 Digitally encrypt current message using @acronym{PGP}.
12080
12081 @item C-c C-m c p
12082 @kindex C-c C-m c p (Message)
12083 @findex mml-secure-message-encrypt-pgpmime
12084
12085 Digitally encrypt current message using @acronym{PGP/MIME}.
12086
12087 @item C-c C-m C-n
12088 @kindex C-c C-m C-n (Message)
12089 @findex mml-unsecure-message
12090 Remove security related @acronym{MML} tags from message.
12091
12092 @end table
12093
12094 @xref{Security, ,Security, message, Message Manual}, for more information.
12095
12096 @node Select Methods
12097 @chapter Select Methods
12098 @cindex foreign groups
12099 @cindex select methods
12100
12101 A @dfn{foreign group} is a group not read by the usual (or
12102 default) means. It could be, for instance, a group from a different
12103 @acronym{NNTP} server, it could be a virtual group, or it could be your own
12104 personal mail group.
12105
12106 A foreign group (or any group, really) is specified by a @dfn{name} and
12107 a @dfn{select method}. To take the latter first, a select method is a
12108 list where the first element says what back end to use (e.g. @code{nntp},
12109 @code{nnspool}, @code{nnml}) and the second element is the @dfn{server
12110 name}. There may be additional elements in the select method, where the
12111 value may have special meaning for the back end in question.
12112
12113 One could say that a select method defines a @dfn{virtual server}---so
12114 we do just that (@pxref{Server Buffer}).
12115
12116 The @dfn{name} of the group is the name the back end will recognize the
12117 group as.
12118
12119 For instance, the group @samp{soc.motss} on the @acronym{NNTP} server
12120 @samp{some.where.edu} will have the name @samp{soc.motss} and select
12121 method @code{(nntp "some.where.edu")}. Gnus will call this group
12122 @samp{nntp+some.where.edu:soc.motss}, even though the @code{nntp}
12123 back end just knows this group as @samp{soc.motss}.
12124
12125 The different methods all have their peculiarities, of course.
12126
12127 @menu
12128 * Server Buffer:: Making and editing virtual servers.
12129 * Getting News:: Reading USENET news with Gnus.
12130 * Getting Mail:: Reading your personal mail with Gnus.
12131 * Browsing the Web:: Getting messages from a plethora of Web sources.
12132 * IMAP:: Using Gnus as a @acronym{IMAP} client.
12133 * Other Sources:: Reading directories, files, SOUP packets.
12134 * Combined Groups:: Combining groups into one group.
12135 * Gnus Unplugged:: Reading news and mail offline.
12136 @end menu
12137
12138
12139 @node Server Buffer
12140 @section Server Buffer
12141
12142 Traditionally, a @dfn{server} is a machine or a piece of software that
12143 one connects to, and then requests information from. Gnus does not
12144 connect directly to any real servers, but does all transactions through
12145 one back end or other. But that's just putting one layer more between
12146 the actual media and Gnus, so we might just as well say that each
12147 back end represents a virtual server.
12148
12149 For instance, the @code{nntp} back end may be used to connect to several
12150 different actual @acronym{NNTP} servers, or, perhaps, to many different ports
12151 on the same actual @acronym{NNTP} server. You tell Gnus which back end to
12152 use, and what parameters to set by specifying a @dfn{select method}.
12153
12154 These select method specifications can sometimes become quite
12155 complicated---say, for instance, that you want to read from the
12156 @acronym{NNTP} server @samp{news.funet.fi} on port number 13, which
12157 hangs if queried for @acronym{NOV} headers and has a buggy select. Ahem.
12158 Anyway, if you had to specify that for each group that used this
12159 server, that would be too much work, so Gnus offers a way of naming
12160 select methods, which is what you do in the server buffer.
12161
12162 To enter the server buffer, use the @kbd{^}
12163 (@code{gnus-group-enter-server-mode}) command in the group buffer.
12164
12165 @menu
12166 * Server Buffer Format:: You can customize the look of this buffer.
12167 * Server Commands:: Commands to manipulate servers.
12168 * Example Methods:: Examples server specifications.
12169 * Creating a Virtual Server:: An example session.
12170 * Server Variables:: Which variables to set.
12171 * Servers and Methods:: You can use server names as select methods.
12172 * Unavailable Servers:: Some servers you try to contact may be down.
12173 @end menu
12174
12175 @vindex gnus-server-mode-hook
12176 @code{gnus-server-mode-hook} is run when creating the server buffer.
12177
12178
12179 @node Server Buffer Format
12180 @subsection Server Buffer Format
12181 @cindex server buffer format
12182
12183 @vindex gnus-server-line-format
12184 You can change the look of the server buffer lines by changing the
12185 @code{gnus-server-line-format} variable. This is a @code{format}-like
12186 variable, with some simple extensions:
12187
12188 @table @samp
12189
12190 @item h
12191 How the news is fetched---the back end name.
12192
12193 @item n
12194 The name of this server.
12195
12196 @item w
12197 Where the news is to be fetched from---the address.
12198
12199 @item s
12200 The opened/closed/denied status of the server.
12201 @end table
12202
12203 @vindex gnus-server-mode-line-format
12204 The mode line can also be customized by using the
12205 @code{gnus-server-mode-line-format} variable (@pxref{Mode Line
12206 Formatting}). The following specs are understood:
12207
12208 @table @samp
12209 @item S
12210 Server name.
12211
12212 @item M
12213 Server method.
12214 @end table
12215
12216 Also @pxref{Formatting Variables}.
12217
12218
12219 @node Server Commands
12220 @subsection Server Commands
12221 @cindex server commands
12222
12223 @table @kbd
12224
12225 @item a
12226 @kindex a (Server)
12227 @findex gnus-server-add-server
12228 Add a new server (@code{gnus-server-add-server}).
12229
12230 @item e
12231 @kindex e (Server)
12232 @findex gnus-server-edit-server
12233 Edit a server (@code{gnus-server-edit-server}).
12234
12235 @item SPACE
12236 @kindex SPACE (Server)
12237 @findex gnus-server-read-server
12238 Browse the current server (@code{gnus-server-read-server}).
12239
12240 @item q
12241 @kindex q (Server)
12242 @findex gnus-server-exit
12243 Return to the group buffer (@code{gnus-server-exit}).
12244
12245 @item k
12246 @kindex k (Server)
12247 @findex gnus-server-kill-server
12248 Kill the current server (@code{gnus-server-kill-server}).
12249
12250 @item y
12251 @kindex y (Server)
12252 @findex gnus-server-yank-server
12253 Yank the previously killed server (@code{gnus-server-yank-server}).
12254
12255 @item c
12256 @kindex c (Server)
12257 @findex gnus-server-copy-server
12258 Copy the current server (@code{gnus-server-copy-server}).
12259
12260 @item l
12261 @kindex l (Server)
12262 @findex gnus-server-list-servers
12263 List all servers (@code{gnus-server-list-servers}).
12264
12265 @item s
12266 @kindex s (Server)
12267 @findex gnus-server-scan-server
12268 Request that the server scan its sources for new articles
12269 (@code{gnus-server-scan-server}). This is mainly sensible with mail
12270 servers.
12271
12272 @item g
12273 @kindex g (Server)
12274 @findex gnus-server-regenerate-server
12275 Request that the server regenerate all its data structures
12276 (@code{gnus-server-regenerate-server}). This can be useful if you have
12277 a mail back end that has gotten out of sync.
12278
12279 @end table
12280
12281
12282 @node Example Methods
12283 @subsection Example Methods
12284
12285 Most select methods are pretty simple and self-explanatory:
12286
12287 @lisp
12288 (nntp "news.funet.fi")
12289 @end lisp
12290
12291 Reading directly from the spool is even simpler:
12292
12293 @lisp
12294 (nnspool "")
12295 @end lisp
12296
12297 As you can see, the first element in a select method is the name of the
12298 back end, and the second is the @dfn{address}, or @dfn{name}, if you
12299 will.
12300
12301 After these two elements, there may be an arbitrary number of
12302 @code{(@var{variable} @var{form})} pairs.
12303
12304 To go back to the first example---imagine that you want to read from
12305 port 15 on that machine. This is what the select method should
12306 look like then:
12307
12308 @lisp
12309 (nntp "news.funet.fi" (nntp-port-number 15))
12310 @end lisp
12311
12312 You should read the documentation to each back end to find out what
12313 variables are relevant, but here's an @code{nnmh} example:
12314
12315 @code{nnmh} is a mail back end that reads a spool-like structure. Say
12316 you have two structures that you wish to access: One is your private
12317 mail spool, and the other is a public one. Here's the possible spec for
12318 your private mail:
12319
12320 @lisp
12321 (nnmh "private" (nnmh-directory "~/private/mail/"))
12322 @end lisp
12323
12324 (This server is then called @samp{private}, but you may have guessed
12325 that.)
12326
12327 Here's the method for a public spool:
12328
12329 @lisp
12330 (nnmh "public"
12331 (nnmh-directory "/usr/information/spool/")
12332 (nnmh-get-new-mail nil))
12333 @end lisp
12334
12335 @cindex proxy
12336 @cindex firewall
12337
12338 If you are behind a firewall and only have access to the @acronym{NNTP}
12339 server from the firewall machine, you can instruct Gnus to @code{rlogin}
12340 on the firewall machine and telnet from there to the @acronym{NNTP} server.
12341 Doing this can be rather fiddly, but your virtual server definition
12342 should probably look something like this:
12343
12344 @lisp
12345 (nntp "firewall"
12346 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-telnet)
12347 (nntp-via-address "the.firewall.machine")
12348 (nntp-address "the.real.nntp.host")
12349 (nntp-end-of-line "\n"))
12350 @end lisp
12351
12352 If you want to use the wonderful @code{ssh} program to provide a
12353 compressed connection over the modem line, you could add the following
12354 configuration to the example above:
12355
12356 @lisp
12357 (nntp-via-rlogin-command "ssh")
12358 @end lisp
12359
12360 See also @code{nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches}.
12361
12362 If you're behind a firewall, but have direct access to the outside world
12363 through a wrapper command like "runsocks", you could open a socksified
12364 telnet connection to the news server as follows:
12365
12366 @lisp
12367 (nntp "outside"
12368 (nntp-pre-command "runsocks")
12369 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-via-telnet)
12370 (nntp-address "the.news.server")
12371 (nntp-end-of-line "\n"))
12372 @end lisp
12373
12374 This means that you have to have set up @code{ssh-agent} correctly to
12375 provide automatic authorization, of course. And to get a compressed
12376 connection, you have to have the @samp{Compression} option in the
12377 @code{ssh} @file{config} file.
12378
12379
12380 @node Creating a Virtual Server
12381 @subsection Creating a Virtual Server
12382
12383 If you're saving lots of articles in the cache by using persistent
12384 articles, you may want to create a virtual server to read the cache.
12385
12386 First you need to add a new server. The @kbd{a} command does that. It
12387 would probably be best to use @code{nnml} to read the cache. You
12388 could also use @code{nnspool} or @code{nnmh}, though.
12389
12390 Type @kbd{a nnml RET cache RET}.
12391
12392 You should now have a brand new @code{nnml} virtual server called
12393 @samp{cache}. You now need to edit it to have the right definitions.
12394 Type @kbd{e} to edit the server. You'll be entered into a buffer that
12395 will contain the following:
12396
12397 @lisp
12398 (nnml "cache")
12399 @end lisp
12400
12401 Change that to:
12402
12403 @lisp
12404 (nnml "cache"
12405 (nnml-directory "~/News/cache/")
12406 (nnml-active-file "~/News/cache/active"))
12407 @end lisp
12408
12409 Type @kbd{C-c C-c} to return to the server buffer. If you now press
12410 @kbd{RET} over this virtual server, you should be entered into a browse
12411 buffer, and you should be able to enter any of the groups displayed.
12412
12413
12414 @node Server Variables
12415 @subsection Server Variables
12416 @cindex server variables
12417 @cindex server parameters
12418
12419 One sticky point when defining variables (both on back ends and in Emacs
12420 in general) is that some variables are typically initialized from other
12421 variables when the definition of the variables is being loaded. If you
12422 change the ``base'' variable after the variables have been loaded, you
12423 won't change the ``derived'' variables.
12424
12425 This typically affects directory and file variables. For instance,
12426 @code{nnml-directory} is @file{~/Mail/} by default, and all @code{nnml}
12427 directory variables are initialized from that variable, so
12428 @code{nnml-active-file} will be @file{~/Mail/active}. If you define a
12429 new virtual @code{nnml} server, it will @emph{not} suffice to set just
12430 @code{nnml-directory}---you have to explicitly set all the file
12431 variables to be what you want them to be. For a complete list of
12432 variables for each back end, see each back end's section later in this
12433 manual, but here's an example @code{nnml} definition:
12434
12435 @lisp
12436 (nnml "public"
12437 (nnml-directory "~/my-mail/")
12438 (nnml-active-file "~/my-mail/active")
12439 (nnml-newsgroups-file "~/my-mail/newsgroups"))
12440 @end lisp
12441
12442 Server variables are often called @dfn{server parameters}.
12443
12444 @node Servers and Methods
12445 @subsection Servers and Methods
12446
12447 Wherever you would normally use a select method
12448 (e.g. @code{gnus-secondary-select-method}, in the group select method,
12449 when browsing a foreign server) you can use a virtual server name
12450 instead. This could potentially save lots of typing. And it's nice all
12451 over.
12452
12453
12454 @node Unavailable Servers
12455 @subsection Unavailable Servers
12456
12457 If a server seems to be unreachable, Gnus will mark that server as
12458 @code{denied}. That means that any subsequent attempt to make contact
12459 with that server will just be ignored. ``It can't be opened,'' Gnus
12460 will tell you, without making the least effort to see whether that is
12461 actually the case or not.
12462
12463 That might seem quite naughty, but it does make sense most of the time.
12464 Let's say you have 10 groups subscribed to on server
12465 @samp{nephelococcygia.com}. This server is located somewhere quite far
12466 away from you and the machine is quite slow, so it takes 1 minute just
12467 to find out that it refuses connection to you today. If Gnus were to
12468 attempt to do that 10 times, you'd be quite annoyed, so Gnus won't
12469 attempt to do that. Once it has gotten a single ``connection refused'',
12470 it will regard that server as ``down''.
12471
12472 So, what happens if the machine was only feeling unwell temporarily?
12473 How do you test to see whether the machine has come up again?
12474
12475 You jump to the server buffer (@pxref{Server Buffer}) and poke it
12476 with the following commands:
12477
12478 @table @kbd
12479
12480 @item O
12481 @kindex O (Server)
12482 @findex gnus-server-open-server
12483 Try to establish connection to the server on the current line
12484 (@code{gnus-server-open-server}).
12485
12486 @item C
12487 @kindex C (Server)
12488 @findex gnus-server-close-server
12489 Close the connection (if any) to the server
12490 (@code{gnus-server-close-server}).
12491
12492 @item D
12493 @kindex D (Server)
12494 @findex gnus-server-deny-server
12495 Mark the current server as unreachable
12496 (@code{gnus-server-deny-server}).
12497
12498 @item M-o
12499 @kindex M-o (Server)
12500 @findex gnus-server-open-all-servers
12501 Open the connections to all servers in the buffer
12502 (@code{gnus-server-open-all-servers}).
12503
12504 @item M-c
12505 @kindex M-c (Server)
12506 @findex gnus-server-close-all-servers
12507 Close the connections to all servers in the buffer
12508 (@code{gnus-server-close-all-servers}).
12509
12510 @item R
12511 @kindex R (Server)
12512 @findex gnus-server-remove-denials
12513 Remove all marks to whether Gnus was denied connection from any servers
12514 (@code{gnus-server-remove-denials}).
12515
12516 @item L
12517 @kindex L (Server)
12518 @findex gnus-server-offline-server
12519 Set server status to offline (@code{gnus-server-offline-server}).
12520
12521 @end table
12522
12523
12524 @node Getting News
12525 @section Getting News
12526 @cindex reading news
12527 @cindex news back ends
12528
12529 A newsreader is normally used for reading news. Gnus currently provides
12530 only two methods of getting news---it can read from an @acronym{NNTP} server,
12531 or it can read from a local spool.
12532
12533 @menu
12534 * NNTP:: Reading news from an @acronym{NNTP} server.
12535 * News Spool:: Reading news from the local spool.
12536 @end menu
12537
12538
12539 @node NNTP
12540 @subsection NNTP
12541 @cindex nntp
12542
12543 Subscribing to a foreign group from an @acronym{NNTP} server is rather easy.
12544 You just specify @code{nntp} as method and the address of the @acronym{NNTP}
12545 server as the, uhm, address.
12546
12547 If the @acronym{NNTP} server is located at a non-standard port, setting the
12548 third element of the select method to this port number should allow you
12549 to connect to the right port. You'll have to edit the group info for
12550 that (@pxref{Foreign Groups}).
12551
12552 The name of the foreign group can be the same as a native group. In
12553 fact, you can subscribe to the same group from as many different servers
12554 you feel like. There will be no name collisions.
12555
12556 The following variables can be used to create a virtual @code{nntp}
12557 server:
12558
12559 @table @code
12560
12561 @item nntp-server-opened-hook
12562 @vindex nntp-server-opened-hook
12563 @cindex @sc{mode reader}
12564 @cindex authinfo
12565 @cindex authentification
12566 @cindex nntp authentification
12567 @findex nntp-send-authinfo
12568 @findex nntp-send-mode-reader
12569 is run after a connection has been made. It can be used to send
12570 commands to the @acronym{NNTP} server after it has been contacted. By
12571 default it sends the command @code{MODE READER} to the server with the
12572 @code{nntp-send-mode-reader} function. This function should always be
12573 present in this hook.
12574
12575 @item nntp-authinfo-function
12576 @vindex nntp-authinfo-function
12577 @findex nntp-send-authinfo
12578 @vindex nntp-authinfo-file
12579 This function will be used to send @samp{AUTHINFO} to the @acronym{NNTP}
12580 server. The default function is @code{nntp-send-authinfo}, which looks
12581 through your @file{~/.authinfo} (or whatever you've set the
12582 @code{nntp-authinfo-file} variable to) for applicable entries. If none
12583 are found, it will prompt you for a login name and a password. The
12584 format of the @file{~/.authinfo} file is (almost) the same as the
12585 @code{ftp} @file{~/.netrc} file, which is defined in the @code{ftp}
12586 manual page, but here are the salient facts:
12587
12588 @enumerate
12589 @item
12590 The file contains one or more line, each of which define one server.
12591
12592 @item
12593 Each line may contain an arbitrary number of token/value pairs.
12594
12595 The valid tokens include @samp{machine}, @samp{login}, @samp{password},
12596 @samp{default}. In addition Gnus introduces two new tokens, not present
12597 in the original @file{.netrc}/@code{ftp} syntax, namely @samp{port} and
12598 @samp{force}. (This is the only way the @file{.authinfo} file format
12599 deviates from the @file{.netrc} file format.) @samp{port} is used to
12600 indicate what port on the server the credentials apply to and
12601 @samp{force} is explained below.
12602
12603 @end enumerate
12604
12605 Here's an example file:
12606
12607 @example
12608 machine news.uio.no login larsi password geheimnis
12609 machine nntp.ifi.uio.no login larsi force yes
12610 @end example
12611
12612 The token/value pairs may appear in any order; @samp{machine} doesn't
12613 have to be first, for instance.
12614
12615 In this example, both login name and password have been supplied for the
12616 former server, while the latter has only the login name listed, and the
12617 user will be prompted for the password. The latter also has the
12618 @samp{force} tag, which means that the authinfo will be sent to the
12619 @var{nntp} server upon connection; the default (i.e., when there is not
12620 @samp{force} tag) is to not send authinfo to the @var{nntp} server
12621 until the @var{nntp} server asks for it.
12622
12623 You can also add @samp{default} lines that will apply to all servers
12624 that don't have matching @samp{machine} lines.
12625
12626 @example
12627 default force yes
12628 @end example
12629
12630 This will force sending @samp{AUTHINFO} commands to all servers not
12631 previously mentioned.
12632
12633 Remember to not leave the @file{~/.authinfo} file world-readable.
12634
12635 @item nntp-server-action-alist
12636 @vindex nntp-server-action-alist
12637 This is a list of regexps to match on server types and actions to be
12638 taken when matches are made. For instance, if you want Gnus to beep
12639 every time you connect to innd, you could say something like:
12640
12641 @lisp
12642 (setq nntp-server-action-alist
12643 '(("innd" (ding))))
12644 @end lisp
12645
12646 You probably don't want to do that, though.
12647
12648 The default value is
12649
12650 @lisp
12651 '(("nntpd 1\\.5\\.11t"
12652 (remove-hook 'nntp-server-opened-hook
12653 'nntp-send-mode-reader)))
12654 @end lisp
12655
12656 This ensures that Gnus doesn't send the @code{MODE READER} command to
12657 nntpd 1.5.11t, since that command chokes that server, I've been told.
12658
12659 @item nntp-maximum-request
12660 @vindex nntp-maximum-request
12661 If the @acronym{NNTP} server doesn't support @acronym{NOV} headers, this back end
12662 will collect headers by sending a series of @code{head} commands. To
12663 speed things up, the back end sends lots of these commands without
12664 waiting for reply, and then reads all the replies. This is controlled
12665 by the @code{nntp-maximum-request} variable, and is 400 by default. If
12666 your network is buggy, you should set this to 1.
12667
12668 @item nntp-connection-timeout
12669 @vindex nntp-connection-timeout
12670 If you have lots of foreign @code{nntp} groups that you connect to
12671 regularly, you're sure to have problems with @acronym{NNTP} servers not
12672 responding properly, or being too loaded to reply within reasonable
12673 time. This is can lead to awkward problems, which can be helped
12674 somewhat by setting @code{nntp-connection-timeout}. This is an integer
12675 that says how many seconds the @code{nntp} back end should wait for a
12676 connection before giving up. If it is @code{nil}, which is the default,
12677 no timeouts are done.
12678
12679 @c @item nntp-command-timeout
12680 @c @vindex nntp-command-timeout
12681 @c @cindex PPP connections
12682 @c @cindex dynamic IP addresses
12683 @c If you're running Gnus on a machine that has a dynamically assigned
12684 @c address, Gnus may become confused. If the address of your machine
12685 @c changes after connecting to the @acronym{NNTP} server, Gnus will simply sit
12686 @c waiting forever for replies from the server. To help with this
12687 @c unfortunate problem, you can set this command to a number. Gnus will
12688 @c then, if it sits waiting for a reply from the server longer than that
12689 @c number of seconds, shut down the connection, start a new one, and resend
12690 @c the command. This should hopefully be transparent to the user. A
12691 @c likely number is 30 seconds.
12692 @c
12693 @c @item nntp-retry-on-break
12694 @c @vindex nntp-retry-on-break
12695 @c If this variable is non-@code{nil}, you can also @kbd{C-g} if Gnus
12696 @c hangs. This will have much the same effect as the command timeout
12697 @c described above.
12698
12699 @item nntp-server-hook
12700 @vindex nntp-server-hook
12701 This hook is run as the last step when connecting to an @acronym{NNTP}
12702 server.
12703
12704 @item nntp-buggy-select
12705 @vindex nntp-buggy-select
12706 Set this to non-@code{nil} if your select routine is buggy.
12707
12708 @item nntp-nov-is-evil
12709 @vindex nntp-nov-is-evil
12710 If the @acronym{NNTP} server does not support @acronym{NOV}, you could set this
12711 variable to @code{t}, but @code{nntp} usually checks automatically whether @acronym{NOV}
12712 can be used.
12713
12714 @item nntp-xover-commands
12715 @vindex nntp-xover-commands
12716 @cindex @acronym{NOV}
12717 @cindex XOVER
12718 List of strings used as commands to fetch @acronym{NOV} lines from a
12719 server. The default value of this variable is @code{("XOVER"
12720 "XOVERVIEW")}.
12721
12722 @item nntp-nov-gap
12723 @vindex nntp-nov-gap
12724 @code{nntp} normally sends just one big request for @acronym{NOV} lines to
12725 the server. The server responds with one huge list of lines. However,
12726 if you have read articles 2-5000 in the group, and only want to read
12727 article 1 and 5001, that means that @code{nntp} will fetch 4999 @acronym{NOV}
12728 lines that you will not need. This variable says how
12729 big a gap between two consecutive articles is allowed to be before the
12730 @code{XOVER} request is split into several request. Note that if your
12731 network is fast, setting this variable to a really small number means
12732 that fetching will probably be slower. If this variable is @code{nil},
12733 @code{nntp} will never split requests. The default is 5.
12734
12735 @item nntp-prepare-server-hook
12736 @vindex nntp-prepare-server-hook
12737 A hook run before attempting to connect to an @acronym{NNTP} server.
12738
12739 @item nntp-warn-about-losing-connection
12740 @vindex nntp-warn-about-losing-connection
12741 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, some noise will be made when a
12742 server closes connection.
12743
12744 @item nntp-record-commands
12745 @vindex nntp-record-commands
12746 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nntp} will log all commands it sends to the
12747 @acronym{NNTP} server (along with a timestamp) in the @samp{*nntp-log*}
12748 buffer. This is useful if you are debugging a Gnus/@acronym{NNTP} connection
12749 that doesn't seem to work.
12750
12751 @item nntp-open-connection-function
12752 @vindex nntp-open-connection-function
12753 It is possible to customize how the connection to the nntp server will
12754 be opened. If you specify an @code{nntp-open-connection-function}
12755 parameter, Gnus will use that function to establish the connection.
12756 Five pre-made functions are supplied. These functions can be grouped in
12757 two categories: direct connection functions (three pre-made), and
12758 indirect ones (two pre-made).
12759
12760 @item nntp-prepare-post-hook
12761 @vindex nntp-prepare-post-hook
12762 A hook run just before posting an article. If there is no
12763 @code{Message-ID} header in the article and the news server provides the
12764 recommended ID, it will be added to the article before running this
12765 hook. It is useful to make @code{Cancel-Lock} headers even if you
12766 inhibit Gnus to add a @code{Message-ID} header, you could say:
12767
12768 @lisp
12769 (add-hook 'nntp-prepare-post-hook 'canlock-insert-header)
12770 @end lisp
12771
12772 Note that not all servers support the recommended ID. This works for
12773 INN versions 2.3.0 and later, for instance.
12774
12775 @item nntp-read-timeout
12776 @vindex nntp-read-timeout
12777 How long nntp should wait between checking for the end of output.
12778 Shorter values mean quicker response, but is more CPU intensive. The
12779 default is 0.1 seconds. If you have a slow line to the server (and
12780 don't like to see Emacs eat your available CPU power), you might set
12781 this to, say, 1.
12782
12783 @end table
12784
12785 @menu
12786 * Direct Functions:: Connecting directly to the server.
12787 * Indirect Functions:: Connecting indirectly to the server.
12788 * Common Variables:: Understood by several connection functions.
12789 @end menu
12790
12791
12792 @node Direct Functions
12793 @subsubsection Direct Functions
12794 @cindex direct connection functions
12795
12796 These functions are called direct because they open a direct connection
12797 between your machine and the @acronym{NNTP} server. The behavior of these
12798 functions is also affected by commonly understood variables
12799 (@pxref{Common Variables}).
12800
12801 @table @code
12802 @findex nntp-open-network-stream
12803 @item nntp-open-network-stream
12804 This is the default, and simply connects to some port or other on the
12805 remote system.
12806
12807 @findex nntp-open-tls-stream
12808 @item nntp-open-tls-stream
12809 Opens a connection to a server over a @dfn{secure} channel. To use
12810 this you must have @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gnutls/, GNUTLS}
12811 installed. You then define a server as follows:
12812
12813 @lisp
12814 ;; @r{"nntps" is port 563 and is predefined in our @file{/etc/services}}
12815 ;; @r{however, @samp{gnutls-cli -p} doesn't like named ports.}
12816 ;;
12817 (nntp "snews.bar.com"
12818 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-tls-stream)
12819 (nntp-port-number )
12820 (nntp-address "snews.bar.com"))
12821 @end lisp
12822
12823 @findex nntp-open-ssl-stream
12824 @item nntp-open-ssl-stream
12825 Opens a connection to a server over a @dfn{secure} channel. To use
12826 this you must have @uref{http://www.openssl.org, OpenSSL} or
12827 @uref{ftp://ftp.psy.uq.oz.au/pub/Crypto/SSL, SSLeay} installed. You
12828 then define a server as follows:
12829
12830 @lisp
12831 ;; @r{"snews" is port 563 and is predefined in our @file{/etc/services}}
12832 ;; @r{however, @samp{openssl s_client -port} doesn't like named ports.}
12833 ;;
12834 (nntp "snews.bar.com"
12835 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-ssl-stream)
12836 (nntp-port-number 563)
12837 (nntp-address "snews.bar.com"))
12838 @end lisp
12839
12840 @findex nntp-open-telnet-stream
12841 @item nntp-open-telnet-stream
12842 Opens a connection to an @acronym{NNTP} server by simply @samp{telnet}'ing
12843 it. You might wonder why this function exists, since we have the
12844 default @code{nntp-open-network-stream} which would do the job. (One
12845 of) the reason(s) is that if you are behind a firewall but have direct
12846 connections to the outside world thanks to a command wrapper like
12847 @code{runsocks}, you can use it like this:
12848
12849 @lisp
12850 (nntp "socksified"
12851 (nntp-pre-command "runsocks")
12852 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-telnet-stream)
12853 (nntp-address "the.news.server"))
12854 @end lisp
12855
12856 With the default method, you would need to wrap your whole Emacs
12857 session, which is not a good idea.
12858 @end table
12859
12860
12861 @node Indirect Functions
12862 @subsubsection Indirect Functions
12863 @cindex indirect connection functions
12864
12865 These functions are called indirect because they connect to an
12866 intermediate host before actually connecting to the @acronym{NNTP} server.
12867 All of these functions and related variables are also said to belong to
12868 the ``via'' family of connection: they're all prefixed with ``via'' to make
12869 things cleaner. The behavior of these functions is also affected by
12870 commonly understood variables (@pxref{Common Variables}).
12871
12872 @table @code
12873 @item nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-telnet
12874 @findex nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-telnet
12875 Does an @samp{rlogin} on a remote system, and then does a @samp{telnet}
12876 to the real @acronym{NNTP} server from there. This is useful for instance if
12877 you need to connect to a firewall machine first.
12878
12879 @code{nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-telnet}-specific variables:
12880
12881 @table @code
12882 @item nntp-via-rlogin-command
12883 @vindex nntp-via-rlogin-command
12884 Command used to log in on the intermediate host. The default is
12885 @samp{rsh}, but @samp{ssh} is a popular alternative.
12886
12887 @item nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches
12888 @vindex nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches
12889 List of strings to be used as the switches to
12890 @code{nntp-via-rlogin-command}. The default is @code{nil}. If you use
12891 @samp{ssh} for @code{nntp-via-rlogin-command}, you may set this to
12892 @samp{("-C")} in order to compress all data connections, otherwise set
12893 this to @samp{("-t" "-e" "none")} or @samp{("-C" "-t" "-e" "none")} if
12894 the telnet command requires a pseudo-tty allocation on an intermediate
12895 host.
12896 @end table
12897
12898 @item nntp-open-via-telnet-and-telnet
12899 @findex nntp-open-via-telnet-and-telnet
12900 Does essentially the same, but uses @samp{telnet} instead of
12901 @samp{rlogin} to connect to the intermediate host.
12902
12903 @code{nntp-open-via-telnet-and-telnet}-specific variables:
12904
12905 @table @code
12906 @item nntp-via-telnet-command
12907 @vindex nntp-via-telnet-command
12908 Command used to @code{telnet} the intermediate host. The default is
12909 @samp{telnet}.
12910
12911 @item nntp-via-telnet-switches
12912 @vindex nntp-via-telnet-switches
12913 List of strings to be used as the switches to the
12914 @code{nntp-via-telnet-command} command. The default is @samp{("-8")}.
12915
12916 @item nntp-via-user-password
12917 @vindex nntp-via-user-password
12918 Password to use when logging in on the intermediate host.
12919
12920 @item nntp-via-envuser
12921 @vindex nntp-via-envuser
12922 If non-@code{nil}, the intermediate @code{telnet} session (client and
12923 server both) will support the @code{ENVIRON} option and not prompt for
12924 login name. This works for Solaris @code{telnet}, for instance.
12925
12926 @item nntp-via-shell-prompt
12927 @vindex nntp-via-shell-prompt
12928 Regexp matching the shell prompt on the intermediate host. The default
12929 is @samp{bash\\|\$ *\r?$\\|> *\r?}.
12930
12931 @end table
12932
12933 @end table
12934
12935
12936 Here are some additional variables that are understood by all the above
12937 functions:
12938
12939 @table @code
12940
12941 @item nntp-via-user-name
12942 @vindex nntp-via-user-name
12943 User name to use when connecting to the intermediate host.
12944
12945 @item nntp-via-address
12946 @vindex nntp-via-address
12947 Address of the intermediate host to connect to.
12948
12949 @end table
12950
12951
12952 @node Common Variables
12953 @subsubsection Common Variables
12954
12955 The following variables affect the behavior of all, or several of the
12956 pre-made connection functions. When not specified, all functions are
12957 affected.
12958
12959 @table @code
12960
12961 @item nntp-pre-command
12962 @vindex nntp-pre-command
12963 A command wrapper to use when connecting through a non native
12964 connection function (all except @code{nntp-open-network-stream},
12965 @code{nntp-open-tls-stream}, and @code{nntp-open-ssl-stream}. This is
12966 where you would put a @samp{SOCKS} wrapper for instance.
12967
12968 @item nntp-address
12969 @vindex nntp-address
12970 The address of the @acronym{NNTP} server.
12971
12972 @item nntp-port-number
12973 @vindex nntp-port-number
12974 Port number to connect to the @acronym{NNTP} server. The default is
12975 @samp{nntp}. If you use @acronym{NNTP} over
12976 @acronym{tls}/@acronym{ssl}, you may want to use integer ports rather
12977 than named ports (i.e, use @samp{563} instead of @samp{snews} or
12978 @samp{nntps}), because external @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} tools may
12979 not work with named ports.
12980
12981 @item nntp-end-of-line
12982 @vindex nntp-end-of-line
12983 String to use as end-of-line marker when talking to the @acronym{NNTP}
12984 server. This is @samp{\r\n} by default, but should be @samp{\n} when
12985 using a non native connection function.
12986
12987 @item nntp-telnet-command
12988 @vindex nntp-telnet-command
12989 Command to use when connecting to the @acronym{NNTP} server through
12990 @samp{telnet}. This is @emph{not} for an intermediate host. This is
12991 just for the real @acronym{NNTP} server. The default is
12992 @samp{telnet}.
12993
12994 @item nntp-telnet-switches
12995 @vindex nntp-telnet-switches
12996 A list of switches to pass to @code{nntp-telnet-command}. The default
12997 is @samp{("-8")}.
12998
12999 @end table
13000
13001
13002 @node News Spool
13003 @subsection News Spool
13004 @cindex nnspool
13005 @cindex news spool
13006
13007 Subscribing to a foreign group from the local spool is extremely easy,
13008 and might be useful, for instance, to speed up reading groups that
13009 contain very big articles---@samp{alt.binaries.pictures.furniture}, for
13010 instance.
13011
13012 Anyway, you just specify @code{nnspool} as the method and @code{""} (or
13013 anything else) as the address.
13014
13015 If you have access to a local spool, you should probably use that as the
13016 native select method (@pxref{Finding the News}). It is normally faster
13017 than using an @code{nntp} select method, but might not be. It depends.
13018 You just have to try to find out what's best at your site.
13019
13020 @table @code
13021
13022 @item nnspool-inews-program
13023 @vindex nnspool-inews-program
13024 Program used to post an article.
13025
13026 @item nnspool-inews-switches
13027 @vindex nnspool-inews-switches
13028 Parameters given to the inews program when posting an article.
13029
13030 @item nnspool-spool-directory
13031 @vindex nnspool-spool-directory
13032 Where @code{nnspool} looks for the articles. This is normally
13033 @file{/usr/spool/news/}.
13034
13035 @item nnspool-nov-directory
13036 @vindex nnspool-nov-directory
13037 Where @code{nnspool} will look for @acronym{NOV} files. This is normally@*
13038 @file{/usr/spool/news/over.view/}.
13039
13040 @item nnspool-lib-dir
13041 @vindex nnspool-lib-dir
13042 Where the news lib dir is (@file{/usr/lib/news/} by default).
13043
13044 @item nnspool-active-file
13045 @vindex nnspool-active-file
13046 The name of the active file.
13047
13048 @item nnspool-newsgroups-file
13049 @vindex nnspool-newsgroups-file
13050 The name of the group descriptions file.
13051
13052 @item nnspool-history-file
13053 @vindex nnspool-history-file
13054 The name of the news history file.
13055
13056 @item nnspool-active-times-file
13057 @vindex nnspool-active-times-file
13058 The name of the active date file.
13059
13060 @item nnspool-nov-is-evil
13061 @vindex nnspool-nov-is-evil
13062 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnspool} won't try to use any @acronym{NOV} files
13063 that it finds.
13064
13065 @item nnspool-sift-nov-with-sed
13066 @vindex nnspool-sift-nov-with-sed
13067 @cindex sed
13068 If non-@code{nil}, which is the default, use @code{sed} to get the
13069 relevant portion from the overview file. If @code{nil},
13070 @code{nnspool} will load the entire file into a buffer and process it
13071 there.
13072
13073 @end table
13074
13075
13076 @node Getting Mail
13077 @section Getting Mail
13078 @cindex reading mail
13079 @cindex mail
13080
13081 Reading mail with a newsreader---isn't that just plain WeIrD? But of
13082 course.
13083
13084 @menu
13085 * Mail in a Newsreader:: Important introductory notes.
13086 * Getting Started Reading Mail:: A simple cookbook example.
13087 * Splitting Mail:: How to create mail groups.
13088 * Mail Sources:: How to tell Gnus where to get mail from.
13089 * Mail Back End Variables:: Variables for customizing mail handling.
13090 * Fancy Mail Splitting:: Gnus can do hairy splitting of incoming mail.
13091 * Group Mail Splitting:: Use group customize to drive mail splitting.
13092 * Incorporating Old Mail:: What about the old mail you have?
13093 * Expiring Mail:: Getting rid of unwanted mail.
13094 * Washing Mail:: Removing cruft from the mail you get.
13095 * Duplicates:: Dealing with duplicated mail.
13096 * Not Reading Mail:: Using mail back ends for reading other files.
13097 * Choosing a Mail Back End:: Gnus can read a variety of mail formats.
13098 @end menu
13099
13100
13101 @node Mail in a Newsreader
13102 @subsection Mail in a Newsreader
13103
13104 If you are used to traditional mail readers, but have decided to switch
13105 to reading mail with Gnus, you may find yourself experiencing something
13106 of a culture shock.
13107
13108 Gnus does not behave like traditional mail readers. If you want to make
13109 it behave that way, you can, but it's an uphill battle.
13110
13111 Gnus, by default, handles all its groups using the same approach. This
13112 approach is very newsreaderly---you enter a group, see the new/unread
13113 messages, and when you read the messages, they get marked as read, and
13114 you don't see them any more. (Unless you explicitly ask for them.)
13115
13116 In particular, you do not do anything explicitly to delete messages.
13117
13118 Does this mean that all the messages that have been marked as read are
13119 deleted? How awful!
13120
13121 But, no, it means that old messages are @dfn{expired} according to some
13122 scheme or other. For news messages, the expire process is controlled by
13123 the news administrator; for mail, the expire process is controlled by
13124 you. The expire process for mail is covered in depth in @ref{Expiring
13125 Mail}.
13126
13127 What many Gnus users find, after using it a while for both news and
13128 mail, is that the transport mechanism has very little to do with how
13129 they want to treat a message.
13130
13131 Many people subscribe to several mailing lists. These are transported
13132 via @acronym{SMTP}, and are therefore mail. But we might go for weeks without
13133 answering, or even reading these messages very carefully. We may not
13134 need to save them because if we should need to read one again, they are
13135 archived somewhere else.
13136
13137 Some people have local news groups which have only a handful of readers.
13138 These are transported via @acronym{NNTP}, and are therefore news. But we may need
13139 to read and answer a large fraction of the messages very carefully in
13140 order to do our work. And there may not be an archive, so we may need
13141 to save the interesting messages the same way we would personal mail.
13142
13143 The important distinction turns out to be not the transport mechanism,
13144 but other factors such as how interested we are in the subject matter,
13145 or how easy it is to retrieve the message if we need to read it again.
13146
13147 Gnus provides many options for sorting mail into ``groups'' which behave
13148 like newsgroups, and for treating each group (whether mail or news)
13149 differently.
13150
13151 Some users never get comfortable using the Gnus (ahem) paradigm and wish
13152 that Gnus should grow up and be a male, er, mail reader. It is possible
13153 to whip Gnus into a more mailreaderly being, but, as said before, it's
13154 not easy. People who prefer proper mail readers should try @sc{vm}
13155 instead, which is an excellent, and proper, mail reader.
13156
13157 I don't mean to scare anybody off, but I want to make it clear that you
13158 may be required to learn a new way of thinking about messages. After
13159 you've been subjected to The Gnus Way, you will come to love it. I can
13160 guarantee it. (At least the guy who sold me the Emacs Subliminal
13161 Brain-Washing Functions that I've put into Gnus did guarantee it. You
13162 Will Be Assimilated. You Love Gnus. You Love The Gnus Mail Way.
13163 You Do.)
13164
13165
13166 @node Getting Started Reading Mail
13167 @subsection Getting Started Reading Mail
13168
13169 It's quite easy to use Gnus to read your new mail. You just plonk the
13170 mail back end of your choice into @code{gnus-secondary-select-methods},
13171 and things will happen automatically.
13172
13173 For instance, if you want to use @code{nnml} (which is a ``one file per
13174 mail'' back end), you could put the following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
13175
13176 @lisp
13177 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods '((nnml "")))
13178 @end lisp
13179
13180 Now, the next time you start Gnus, this back end will be queried for new
13181 articles, and it will move all the messages in your spool file to its
13182 directory, which is @file{~/Mail/} by default. The new group that will
13183 be created (@samp{mail.misc}) will be subscribed, and you can read it
13184 like any other group.
13185
13186 You will probably want to split the mail into several groups, though:
13187
13188 @lisp
13189 (setq nnmail-split-methods
13190 '(("junk" "^From:.*Lars Ingebrigtsen")
13191 ("crazy" "^Subject:.*die\\|^Organization:.*flabby")
13192 ("other" "")))
13193 @end lisp
13194
13195 This will result in three new @code{nnml} mail groups being created:
13196 @samp{nnml:junk}, @samp{nnml:crazy}, and @samp{nnml:other}. All the
13197 mail that doesn't fit into the first two groups will be placed in the
13198 last group.
13199
13200 This should be sufficient for reading mail with Gnus. You might want to
13201 give the other sections in this part of the manual a perusal, though.
13202 Especially @pxref{Choosing a Mail Back End} and @pxref{Expiring Mail}.
13203
13204
13205 @node Splitting Mail
13206 @subsection Splitting Mail
13207 @cindex splitting mail
13208 @cindex mail splitting
13209 @cindex mail filtering (splitting)
13210
13211 @vindex nnmail-split-methods
13212 The @code{nnmail-split-methods} variable says how the incoming mail is
13213 to be split into groups.
13214
13215 @lisp
13216 (setq nnmail-split-methods
13217 '(("mail.junk" "^From:.*Lars Ingebrigtsen")
13218 ("mail.crazy" "^Subject:.*die\\|^Organization:.*flabby")
13219 ("mail.other" "")))
13220 @end lisp
13221
13222 This variable is a list of lists, where the first element of each of
13223 these lists is the name of the mail group (they do not have to be called
13224 something beginning with @samp{mail}, by the way), and the second
13225 element is a regular expression used on the header of each mail to
13226 determine if it belongs in this mail group. The first string may
13227 contain @samp{\\1} forms, like the ones used by @code{replace-match} to
13228 insert sub-expressions from the matched text. For instance:
13229
13230 @lisp
13231 ("list.\\1" "From:.* \\(.*\\)-list@@majordomo.com")
13232 @end lisp
13233
13234 @noindent
13235 In that case, @code{nnmail-split-lowercase-expanded} controls whether
13236 the inserted text should be made lowercase. @xref{Fancy Mail Splitting}.
13237
13238 The second element can also be a function. In that case, it will be
13239 called narrowed to the headers with the first element of the rule as the
13240 argument. It should return a non-@code{nil} value if it thinks that the
13241 mail belongs in that group.
13242
13243 @cindex @samp{bogus} group
13244 The last of these groups should always be a general one, and the regular
13245 expression should @emph{always} be @samp{""} so that it matches any mails
13246 that haven't been matched by any of the other regexps. (These rules are
13247 processed from the beginning of the alist toward the end. The first rule
13248 to make a match will ``win'', unless you have crossposting enabled. In
13249 that case, all matching rules will ``win''.) If no rule matched, the mail
13250 will end up in the @samp{bogus} group. When new groups are created by
13251 splitting mail, you may want to run @code{gnus-group-find-new-groups} to
13252 see the new groups. This also applies to the @samp{bogus} group.
13253
13254 If you like to tinker with this yourself, you can set this variable to a
13255 function of your choice. This function will be called without any
13256 arguments in a buffer narrowed to the headers of an incoming mail
13257 message. The function should return a list of group names that it
13258 thinks should carry this mail message.
13259
13260 Note that the mail back ends are free to maul the poor, innocent,
13261 incoming headers all they want to. They all add @code{Lines} headers;
13262 some add @code{X-Gnus-Group} headers; most rename the Unix mbox
13263 @code{From<SPACE>} line to something else.
13264
13265 @vindex nnmail-crosspost
13266 The mail back ends all support cross-posting. If several regexps match,
13267 the mail will be ``cross-posted'' to all those groups.
13268 @code{nnmail-crosspost} says whether to use this mechanism or not. Note
13269 that no articles are crossposted to the general (@samp{""}) group.
13270
13271 @vindex nnmail-crosspost-link-function
13272 @cindex crosspost
13273 @cindex links
13274 @code{nnmh} and @code{nnml} makes crossposts by creating hard links to
13275 the crossposted articles. However, not all file systems support hard
13276 links. If that's the case for you, set
13277 @code{nnmail-crosspost-link-function} to @code{copy-file}. (This
13278 variable is @code{add-name-to-file} by default.)
13279
13280 @kindex M-x nnmail-split-history
13281 @findex nnmail-split-history
13282 If you wish to see where the previous mail split put the messages, you
13283 can use the @kbd{M-x nnmail-split-history} command. If you wish to see
13284 where re-spooling messages would put the messages, you can use
13285 @code{gnus-summary-respool-trace} and related commands (@pxref{Mail
13286 Group Commands}).
13287
13288 @vindex nnmail-split-header-length-limit
13289 Header lines longer than the value of
13290 @code{nnmail-split-header-length-limit} are excluded from the split
13291 function.
13292
13293 @vindex nnmail-mail-splitting-charset
13294 @vindex nnmail-mail-splitting-decodes
13295 By default the splitting codes @acronym{MIME} decodes headers so you
13296 can match on non-@acronym{ASCII} strings. The
13297 @code{nnmail-mail-splitting-charset} variable specifies the default
13298 charset for decoding. The behavior can be turned off completely by
13299 binding @code{nnmail-mail-splitting-decodes} to @code{nil}, which is
13300 useful if you want to match articles based on the raw header data.
13301
13302 @vindex nnmail-resplit-incoming
13303 By default, splitting is performed on all incoming messages. If you
13304 specify a @code{directory} entry for the variable @code{mail-sources}
13305 (@pxref{Mail Source Specifiers}), however, then splitting does
13306 @emph{not} happen by default. You can set the variable
13307 @code{nnmail-resplit-incoming} to a non-@code{nil} value to make
13308 splitting happen even in this case. (This variable has no effect on
13309 other kinds of entries.)
13310
13311 Gnus gives you all the opportunity you could possibly want for shooting
13312 yourself in the foot. Let's say you create a group that will contain
13313 all the mail you get from your boss. And then you accidentally
13314 unsubscribe from the group. Gnus will still put all the mail from your
13315 boss in the unsubscribed group, and so, when your boss mails you ``Have
13316 that report ready by Monday or you're fired!'', you'll never see it and,
13317 come Tuesday, you'll still believe that you're gainfully employed while
13318 you really should be out collecting empty bottles to save up for next
13319 month's rent money.
13320
13321
13322 @node Mail Sources
13323 @subsection Mail Sources
13324
13325 Mail can be gotten from many different sources---the mail spool, from
13326 a @acronym{POP} mail server, from a procmail directory, or from a
13327 maildir, for instance.
13328
13329 @menu
13330 * Mail Source Specifiers:: How to specify what a mail source is.
13331 * Mail Source Customization:: Some variables that influence things.
13332 * Fetching Mail:: Using the mail source specifiers.
13333 @end menu
13334
13335
13336 @node Mail Source Specifiers
13337 @subsubsection Mail Source Specifiers
13338 @cindex POP
13339 @cindex mail server
13340 @cindex procmail
13341 @cindex mail spool
13342 @cindex mail source
13343
13344 You tell Gnus how to fetch mail by setting @code{mail-sources}
13345 (@pxref{Fetching Mail}) to a @dfn{mail source specifier}.
13346
13347 Here's an example:
13348
13349 @lisp
13350 (pop :server "pop3.mailserver.com" :user "myname")
13351 @end lisp
13352
13353 As can be observed, a mail source specifier is a list where the first
13354 element is a @dfn{mail source type}, followed by an arbitrary number of
13355 @dfn{keywords}. Keywords that are not explicitly specified are given
13356 default values.
13357
13358 The following mail source types are available:
13359
13360 @table @code
13361 @item file
13362 Get mail from a single file; typically from the mail spool.
13363
13364 Keywords:
13365
13366 @table @code
13367 @item :path
13368 The file name. Defaults to the value of the @env{MAIL}
13369 environment variable or the value of @code{rmail-spool-directory}
13370 (usually something like @file{/usr/mail/spool/user-name}).
13371
13372 @item :prescript
13373 @itemx :postscript
13374 Script run before/after fetching mail.
13375 @end table
13376
13377 An example file mail source:
13378
13379 @lisp
13380 (file :path "/usr/spool/mail/user-name")
13381 @end lisp
13382
13383 Or using the default file name:
13384
13385 @lisp
13386 (file)
13387 @end lisp
13388
13389 If the mail spool file is not located on the local machine, it's best
13390 to use @acronym{POP} or @acronym{IMAP} or the like to fetch the mail.
13391 You can not use ange-ftp file names here---it has no way to lock the
13392 mail spool while moving the mail.
13393
13394 If it's impossible to set up a proper server, you can use ssh instead.
13395
13396 @lisp
13397 (setq mail-sources
13398 '((file :prescript "ssh host bin/getmail >%t")))
13399 @end lisp
13400
13401 The @samp{getmail} script would look something like the following:
13402
13403 @example
13404 #!/bin/sh
13405 # getmail - move mail from spool to stdout
13406 # flu@@iki.fi
13407
13408 MOVEMAIL=/usr/lib/emacs/20.3/i386-redhat-linux/movemail
13409 TMP=$HOME/Mail/tmp
13410 rm -f $TMP; $MOVEMAIL $MAIL $TMP >/dev/null && cat $TMP
13411 @end example
13412
13413 Alter this script to fit find the @samp{movemail} you want to use.
13414
13415
13416 @item directory
13417 @vindex nnmail-scan-directory-mail-source-once
13418 Get mail from several files in a directory. This is typically used
13419 when you have procmail split the incoming mail into several files.
13420 That is, there is a one-to-one correspondence between files in that
13421 directory and groups, so that mail from the file @file{foo.bar.spool}
13422 will be put in the group @code{foo.bar}. (You can change the suffix
13423 to be used instead of @code{.spool}.) Setting
13424 @code{nnmail-scan-directory-mail-source-once} to non-@code{nil} forces
13425 Gnus to scan the mail source only once. This is particularly useful
13426 if you want to scan mail groups at a specified level.
13427
13428 @vindex nnmail-resplit-incoming
13429 There is also the variable @code{nnmail-resplit-incoming}, if you set
13430 that to a non-@code{nil} value, then the normal splitting process is
13431 applied to all the files from the directory, @ref{Splitting Mail}.
13432
13433 Keywords:
13434
13435 @table @code
13436 @item :path
13437 The name of the directory where the files are. There is no default
13438 value.
13439
13440 @item :suffix
13441 Only files ending with this suffix are used. The default is
13442 @samp{.spool}.
13443
13444 @item :predicate
13445 Only files that have this predicate return non-@code{nil} are returned.
13446 The default is @code{identity}. This is used as an additional
13447 filter---only files that have the right suffix @emph{and} satisfy this
13448 predicate are considered.
13449
13450 @item :prescript
13451 @itemx :postscript
13452 Script run before/after fetching mail.
13453
13454 @end table
13455
13456 An example directory mail source:
13457
13458 @lisp
13459 (directory :path "/home/user-name/procmail-dir/"
13460 :suffix ".prcml")
13461 @end lisp
13462
13463 @item pop
13464 Get mail from a @acronym{POP} server.
13465
13466 Keywords:
13467
13468 @table @code
13469 @item :server
13470 The name of the @acronym{POP} server. The default is taken from the
13471 @env{MAILHOST} environment variable.
13472
13473 @item :port
13474 The port number of the @acronym{POP} server. This can be a number (eg,
13475 @samp{:port 1234}) or a string (eg, @samp{:port "pop3"}). If it is a
13476 string, it should be a service name as listed in @file{/etc/services} on
13477 Unix systems. The default is @samp{"pop3"}. On some systems you might
13478 need to specify it as @samp{"pop-3"} instead.
13479
13480 @item :user
13481 The user name to give to the @acronym{POP} server. The default is the login
13482 name.
13483
13484 @item :password
13485 The password to give to the @acronym{POP} server. If not specified,
13486 the user is prompted.
13487
13488 @item :program
13489 The program to use to fetch mail from the @acronym{POP} server. This
13490 should be a @code{format}-like string. Here's an example:
13491
13492 @example
13493 fetchmail %u@@%s -P %p %t
13494 @end example
13495
13496 The valid format specifier characters are:
13497
13498 @table @samp
13499 @item t
13500 The name of the file the mail is to be moved to. This must always be
13501 included in this string.
13502
13503 @item s
13504 The name of the server.
13505
13506 @item P
13507 The port number of the server.
13508
13509 @item u
13510 The user name to use.
13511
13512 @item p
13513 The password to use.
13514 @end table
13515
13516 The values used for these specs are taken from the values you give the
13517 corresponding keywords.
13518
13519 @item :prescript
13520 A script to be run before fetching the mail. The syntax is the same as
13521 the @code{:program} keyword. This can also be a function to be run.
13522
13523 @item :postscript
13524 A script to be run after fetching the mail. The syntax is the same as
13525 the @code{:program} keyword. This can also be a function to be run.
13526
13527 @item :function
13528 The function to use to fetch mail from the @acronym{POP} server. The
13529 function is called with one parameter---the name of the file where the
13530 mail should be moved to.
13531
13532 @item :authentication
13533 This can be either the symbol @code{password} or the symbol @code{apop}
13534 and says what authentication scheme to use. The default is
13535 @code{password}.
13536
13537 @end table
13538
13539 @vindex pop3-movemail
13540 @vindex pop3-leave-mail-on-server
13541 If the @code{:program} and @code{:function} keywords aren't specified,
13542 @code{pop3-movemail} will be used. If the
13543 @code{pop3-leave-mail-on-server} is non-@code{nil} the mail is to be
13544 left on the @acronym{POP} server after fetching when using
13545 @code{pop3-movemail}. Note that POP servers maintain no state
13546 information between sessions, so what the client believes is there and
13547 what is actually there may not match up. If they do not, then the whole
13548 thing can fall apart and leave you with a corrupt mailbox.
13549
13550 Here are some examples. Fetch from the default @acronym{POP} server,
13551 using the default user name, and default fetcher:
13552
13553 @lisp
13554 (pop)
13555 @end lisp
13556
13557 Fetch from a named server with a named user and password:
13558
13559 @lisp
13560 (pop :server "my.pop.server"
13561 :user "user-name" :password "secret")
13562 @end lisp
13563
13564 Use @samp{movemail} to move the mail:
13565
13566 @lisp
13567 (pop :program "movemail po:%u %t %p")
13568 @end lisp
13569
13570 @item maildir
13571 Get mail from a maildir. This is a type of mailbox that is supported by
13572 at least qmail and postfix, where each file in a special directory
13573 contains exactly one mail.
13574
13575 Keywords:
13576
13577 @table @code
13578 @item :path
13579 The name of the directory where the mails are stored. The default is
13580 taken from the @env{MAILDIR} environment variable or
13581 @file{~/Maildir/}.
13582 @item :subdirs
13583 The subdirectories of the Maildir. The default is
13584 @samp{("new" "cur")}.
13585
13586 @c If you sometimes look at your mail through a pop3 daemon before fetching
13587 @c them with Gnus, you may also have to fetch your mails from the
13588 @c @code{cur} directory inside the maildir, like in the first example
13589 @c below.
13590
13591 You can also get mails from remote hosts (because maildirs don't suffer
13592 from locking problems).
13593
13594 @end table
13595
13596 Two example maildir mail sources:
13597
13598 @lisp
13599 (maildir :path "/home/user-name/Maildir/"
13600 :subdirs ("cur" "new"))
13601 @end lisp
13602
13603 @lisp
13604 (maildir :path "/user@@remotehost.org:~/Maildir/"
13605 :subdirs ("new"))
13606 @end lisp
13607
13608 @item imap
13609 Get mail from a @acronym{IMAP} server. If you don't want to use
13610 @acronym{IMAP} as intended, as a network mail reading protocol (ie
13611 with nnimap), for some reason or other, Gnus let you treat it similar
13612 to a @acronym{POP} server and fetches articles from a given
13613 @acronym{IMAP} mailbox. @xref{IMAP}, for more information.
13614
13615 Note that for the Kerberos, GSSAPI, @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} and STARTTLS support you
13616 may need external programs and libraries, @xref{IMAP}.
13617
13618 Keywords:
13619
13620 @table @code
13621 @item :server
13622 The name of the @acronym{IMAP} server. The default is taken from the
13623 @env{MAILHOST} environment variable.
13624
13625 @item :port
13626 The port number of the @acronym{IMAP} server. The default is @samp{143}, or
13627 @samp{993} for @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} connections.
13628
13629 @item :user
13630 The user name to give to the @acronym{IMAP} server. The default is the login
13631 name.
13632
13633 @item :password
13634 The password to give to the @acronym{IMAP} server. If not specified, the user is
13635 prompted.
13636
13637 @item :stream
13638 What stream to use for connecting to the server, this is one of the
13639 symbols in @code{imap-stream-alist}. Right now, this means
13640 @samp{gssapi}, @samp{kerberos4}, @samp{starttls}, @samp{tls},
13641 @samp{ssl}, @samp{shell} or the default @samp{network}.
13642
13643 @item :authentication
13644 Which authenticator to use for authenticating to the server, this is
13645 one of the symbols in @code{imap-authenticator-alist}. Right now,
13646 this means @samp{gssapi}, @samp{kerberos4}, @samp{digest-md5},
13647 @samp{cram-md5}, @samp{anonymous} or the default @samp{login}.
13648
13649 @item :program
13650 When using the `shell' :stream, the contents of this variable is
13651 mapped into the @code{imap-shell-program} variable. This should be a
13652 @code{format}-like string (or list of strings). Here's an example:
13653
13654 @example
13655 ssh %s imapd
13656 @end example
13657
13658 The valid format specifier characters are:
13659
13660 @table @samp
13661 @item s
13662 The name of the server.
13663
13664 @item l
13665 User name from @code{imap-default-user}.
13666
13667 @item p
13668 The port number of the server.
13669 @end table
13670
13671 The values used for these specs are taken from the values you give the
13672 corresponding keywords.
13673
13674 @item :mailbox
13675 The name of the mailbox to get mail from. The default is @samp{INBOX}
13676 which normally is the mailbox which receive incoming mail.
13677
13678 @item :predicate
13679 The predicate used to find articles to fetch. The default, @samp{UNSEEN
13680 UNDELETED}, is probably the best choice for most people, but if you
13681 sometimes peek in your mailbox with a @acronym{IMAP} client and mark some
13682 articles as read (or; SEEN) you might want to set this to @samp{1:*}.
13683 Then all articles in the mailbox is fetched, no matter what. For a
13684 complete list of predicates, see RFC 2060 section 6.4.4.
13685
13686 @item :fetchflag
13687 How to flag fetched articles on the server, the default @samp{\Deleted}
13688 will mark them as deleted, an alternative would be @samp{\Seen} which
13689 would simply mark them as read. These are the two most likely choices,
13690 but more flags are defined in RFC 2060 section 2.3.2.
13691
13692 @item :dontexpunge
13693 If non-@code{nil}, don't remove all articles marked as deleted in the
13694 mailbox after finishing the fetch.
13695
13696 @end table
13697
13698 An example @acronym{IMAP} mail source:
13699
13700 @lisp
13701 (imap :server "mail.mycorp.com"
13702 :stream kerberos4
13703 :fetchflag "\\Seen")
13704 @end lisp
13705
13706 @item webmail
13707 Get mail from a webmail server, such as @uref{http://www.hotmail.com/},
13708 @uref{http://webmail.netscape.com/}, @uref{http://www.netaddress.com/},
13709 @uref{http://mail.yahoo.com/}.
13710
13711 NOTE: Webmail largely depends on cookies. A "one-line-cookie" patch is
13712 required for url "4.0pre.46".
13713
13714 WARNING: Mails may be lost. NO WARRANTY.
13715
13716 Keywords:
13717
13718 @table @code
13719 @item :subtype
13720 The type of the webmail server. The default is @code{hotmail}. The
13721 alternatives are @code{netscape}, @code{netaddress}, @code{my-deja}.
13722
13723 @item :user
13724 The user name to give to the webmail server. The default is the login
13725 name.
13726
13727 @item :password
13728 The password to give to the webmail server. If not specified, the user is
13729 prompted.
13730
13731 @item :dontexpunge
13732 If non-@code{nil}, only fetch unread articles and don't move them to
13733 trash folder after finishing the fetch.
13734
13735 @end table
13736
13737 An example webmail source:
13738
13739 @lisp
13740 (webmail :subtype 'hotmail
13741 :user "user-name"
13742 :password "secret")
13743 @end lisp
13744 @end table
13745
13746 @table @dfn
13747 @item Common Keywords
13748 Common keywords can be used in any type of mail source.
13749
13750 Keywords:
13751
13752 @table @code
13753 @item :plugged
13754 If non-@code{nil}, fetch the mail even when Gnus is unplugged. If you
13755 use directory source to get mail, you can specify it as in this
13756 example:
13757
13758 @lisp
13759 (setq mail-sources
13760 '((directory :path "/home/pavel/.Spool/"
13761 :suffix ""
13762 :plugged t)))
13763 @end lisp
13764
13765 Gnus will then fetch your mail even when you are unplugged. This is
13766 useful when you use local mail and news.
13767
13768 @end table
13769 @end table
13770
13771 @subsubsection Function Interface
13772
13773 Some of the above keywords specify a Lisp function to be executed.
13774 For each keyword @code{:foo}, the Lisp variable @code{foo} is bound to
13775 the value of the keyword while the function is executing. For example,
13776 consider the following mail-source setting:
13777
13778 @lisp
13779 (setq mail-sources '((pop :user "jrl"
13780 :server "pophost" :function fetchfunc)))
13781 @end lisp
13782
13783 While the function @code{fetchfunc} is executing, the symbol @code{user}
13784 is bound to @code{"jrl"}, and the symbol @code{server} is bound to
13785 @code{"pophost"}. The symbols @code{port}, @code{password},
13786 @code{program}, @code{prescript}, @code{postscript}, @code{function},
13787 and @code{authentication} are also bound (to their default values).
13788
13789 See above for a list of keywords for each type of mail source.
13790
13791
13792 @node Mail Source Customization
13793 @subsubsection Mail Source Customization
13794
13795 The following is a list of variables that influence how the mail is
13796 fetched. You would normally not need to set or change any of these
13797 variables.
13798
13799 @table @code
13800 @item mail-source-crash-box
13801 @vindex mail-source-crash-box
13802 File where mail will be stored while processing it. The default is@*
13803 @file{~/.emacs-mail-crash-box}.
13804
13805 @item mail-source-delete-incoming
13806 @vindex mail-source-delete-incoming
13807 If non-@code{nil}, delete incoming files after handling them. If
13808 @code{t}, delete the files immediately, if @code{nil}, never delete any
13809 files. If a positive number, delete files older than number of days
13810 (This will only happen, when receiving new mail). You may also set
13811 @code{mail-source-delete-incoming} to @code{nil} and call
13812 @code{mail-source-delete-old-incoming} from a hook or interactively.
13813
13814 @item mail-source-delete-old-incoming-confirm
13815 @vindex mail-source-delete-old-incoming-confirm
13816 If non-@code{nil}, ask for for confirmation before deleting old incoming
13817 files. This variable only applies when
13818 @code{mail-source-delete-incoming} is a positive number.
13819
13820 @item mail-source-ignore-errors
13821 @vindex mail-source-ignore-errors
13822 If non-@code{nil}, ignore errors when reading mail from a mail source.
13823
13824 @item mail-source-directory
13825 @vindex mail-source-directory
13826 Directory where incoming mail source files (if any) will be stored. The
13827 default is @file{~/Mail/}. At present, the only thing this is used for
13828 is to say where the incoming files will be stored if the variable
13829 @code{mail-source-delete-incoming} is @code{nil} or a number.
13830
13831 @item mail-source-incoming-file-prefix
13832 @vindex mail-source-incoming-file-prefix
13833 Prefix for file name for storing incoming mail. The default is
13834 @file{Incoming}, in which case files will end up with names like
13835 @file{Incoming30630D_} or @file{Incoming298602ZD}. This is really only
13836 relevant if @code{mail-source-delete-incoming} is @code{nil}.
13837
13838 @item mail-source-default-file-modes
13839 @vindex mail-source-default-file-modes
13840 All new mail files will get this file mode. The default is 384.
13841
13842 @item mail-source-movemail-program
13843 @vindex mail-source-movemail-program
13844 If non-@code{nil}, name of program for fetching new mail. If
13845 @code{nil}, @code{movemail} in @var{exec-directory}.
13846
13847 @end table
13848
13849
13850 @node Fetching Mail
13851 @subsubsection Fetching Mail
13852
13853 @vindex mail-sources
13854 @vindex nnmail-spool-file
13855 The way to actually tell Gnus where to get new mail from is to set
13856 @code{mail-sources} to a list of mail source specifiers
13857 (@pxref{Mail Source Specifiers}).
13858
13859 If this variable (and the obsolescent @code{nnmail-spool-file}) is
13860 @code{nil}, the mail back ends will never attempt to fetch mail by
13861 themselves.
13862
13863 If you want to fetch mail both from your local spool as well as a
13864 @acronym{POP} mail server, you'd say something like:
13865
13866 @lisp
13867 (setq mail-sources
13868 '((file)
13869 (pop :server "pop3.mail.server"
13870 :password "secret")))
13871 @end lisp
13872
13873 Or, if you don't want to use any of the keyword defaults:
13874
13875 @lisp
13876 (setq mail-sources
13877 '((file :path "/var/spool/mail/user-name")
13878 (pop :server "pop3.mail.server"
13879 :user "user-name"
13880 :port "pop3"
13881 :password "secret")))
13882 @end lisp
13883
13884
13885 When you use a mail back end, Gnus will slurp all your mail from your
13886 inbox and plonk it down in your home directory. Gnus doesn't move any
13887 mail if you're not using a mail back end---you have to do a lot of magic
13888 invocations first. At the time when you have finished drawing the
13889 pentagram, lightened the candles, and sacrificed the goat, you really
13890 shouldn't be too surprised when Gnus moves your mail.
13891
13892
13893
13894 @node Mail Back End Variables
13895 @subsection Mail Back End Variables
13896
13897 These variables are (for the most part) pertinent to all the various
13898 mail back ends.
13899
13900 @table @code
13901 @vindex nnmail-read-incoming-hook
13902 @item nnmail-read-incoming-hook
13903 The mail back ends all call this hook after reading new mail. You can
13904 use this hook to notify any mail watch programs, if you want to.
13905
13906 @vindex nnmail-split-hook
13907 @item nnmail-split-hook
13908 @findex gnus-article-decode-encoded-words
13909 @cindex RFC 1522 decoding
13910 @cindex RFC 2047 decoding
13911 Hook run in the buffer where the mail headers of each message is kept
13912 just before the splitting based on these headers is done. The hook is
13913 free to modify the buffer contents in any way it sees fit---the buffer
13914 is discarded after the splitting has been done, and no changes performed
13915 in the buffer will show up in any files.
13916 @code{gnus-article-decode-encoded-words} is one likely function to add
13917 to this hook.
13918
13919 @vindex nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook
13920 @vindex nnmail-post-get-new-mail-hook
13921 @item nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook
13922 @itemx nnmail-post-get-new-mail-hook
13923 These are two useful hooks executed when treating new incoming
13924 mail---@code{nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook} (is called just before
13925 starting to handle the new mail) and
13926 @code{nnmail-post-get-new-mail-hook} (is called when the mail handling
13927 is done). Here's and example of using these two hooks to change the
13928 default file modes the new mail files get:
13929
13930 @lisp
13931 (add-hook 'nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook
13932 (lambda () (set-default-file-modes 511)))
13933
13934 (add-hook 'nnmail-post-get-new-mail-hook
13935 (lambda () (set-default-file-modes 551)))
13936 @end lisp
13937
13938 @item nnmail-use-long-file-names
13939 @vindex nnmail-use-long-file-names
13940 If non-@code{nil}, the mail back ends will use long file and directory
13941 names. Groups like @samp{mail.misc} will end up in directories
13942 (assuming use of @code{nnml} back end) or files (assuming use of
13943 @code{nnfolder} back end) like @file{mail.misc}. If it is @code{nil},
13944 the same group will end up in @file{mail/misc}.
13945
13946 @item nnmail-delete-file-function
13947 @vindex nnmail-delete-file-function
13948 @findex delete-file
13949 Function called to delete files. It is @code{delete-file} by default.
13950
13951 @item nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids
13952 @vindex nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids
13953 If non-@code{nil}, put the @code{Message-ID}s of articles imported into
13954 the back end (via @code{Gcc}, for instance) into the mail duplication
13955 discovery cache. The default is @code{nil}.
13956
13957 @item nnmail-cache-ignore-groups
13958 @vindex nnmail-cache-ignore-groups
13959 This can be a regular expression or a list of regular expressions.
13960 Group names that match any of the regular expressions will never be
13961 recorded in the @code{Message-ID} cache.
13962
13963 This can be useful, for example, when using Fancy Splitting
13964 (@pxref{Fancy Mail Splitting}) together with the function
13965 @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent}.
13966
13967 @end table
13968
13969
13970 @node Fancy Mail Splitting
13971 @subsection Fancy Mail Splitting
13972 @cindex mail splitting
13973 @cindex fancy mail splitting
13974
13975 @vindex nnmail-split-fancy
13976 @findex nnmail-split-fancy
13977 If the rather simple, standard method for specifying how to split mail
13978 doesn't allow you to do what you want, you can set
13979 @code{nnmail-split-methods} to @code{nnmail-split-fancy}. Then you can
13980 play with the @code{nnmail-split-fancy} variable.
13981
13982 Let's look at an example value of this variable first:
13983
13984 @lisp
13985 ;; @r{Messages from the mailer daemon are not crossposted to any of}
13986 ;; @r{the ordinary groups. Warnings are put in a separate group}
13987 ;; @r{from real errors.}
13988 (| ("from" mail (| ("subject" "warn.*" "mail.warning")
13989 "mail.misc"))
13990 ;; @r{Non-error messages are crossposted to all relevant}
13991 ;; @r{groups, but we don't crosspost between the group for the}
13992 ;; @r{(ding) list and the group for other (ding) related mail.}
13993 (& (| (any "ding@@ifi\\.uio\\.no" "ding.list")
13994 ("subject" "ding" "ding.misc"))
13995 ;; @r{Other mailing lists@dots{}}
13996 (any "procmail@@informatik\\.rwth-aachen\\.de" "procmail.list")
13997 (any "SmartList@@informatik\\.rwth-aachen\\.de" "SmartList.list")
13998 ;; @r{Both lists below have the same suffix, so prevent}
13999 ;; @r{cross-posting to mkpkg.list of messages posted only to}
14000 ;; @r{the bugs- list, but allow cross-posting when the}
14001 ;; @r{message was really cross-posted.}
14002 (any "bugs-mypackage@@somewhere" "mypkg.bugs")
14003 (any "mypackage@@somewhere" - "bugs-mypackage" "mypkg.list")
14004 ;; @r{People@dots{}}
14005 (any "larsi@@ifi\\.uio\\.no" "people.Lars_Magne_Ingebrigtsen"))
14006 ;; @r{Unmatched mail goes to the catch all group.}
14007 "misc.misc")
14008 @end lisp
14009
14010 This variable has the format of a @dfn{split}. A split is a
14011 (possibly) recursive structure where each split may contain other
14012 splits. Here are the possible split syntaxes:
14013
14014 @table @code
14015
14016 @item group
14017 If the split is a string, that will be taken as a group name. Normal
14018 regexp match expansion will be done. See below for examples.
14019
14020 @item (@var{field} @var{value} [- @var{restrict} [@dots{}] ] @var{split})
14021 If the split is a list, the first element of which is a string, then
14022 store the message as specified by @var{split}, if header @var{field}
14023 (a regexp) contains @var{value} (also a regexp). If @var{restrict}
14024 (yet another regexp) matches some string after @var{field} and before
14025 the end of the matched @var{value}, the @var{split} is ignored. If
14026 none of the @var{restrict} clauses match, @var{split} is processed.
14027
14028 @item (| @var{split} @dots{})
14029 If the split is a list, and the first element is @code{|} (vertical
14030 bar), then process each @var{split} until one of them matches. A
14031 @var{split} is said to match if it will cause the mail message to be
14032 stored in one or more groups.
14033
14034 @item (& @var{split} @dots{})
14035 If the split is a list, and the first element is @code{&}, then
14036 process all @var{split}s in the list.
14037
14038 @item junk
14039 If the split is the symbol @code{junk}, then don't save (i.e., delete)
14040 this message. Use with extreme caution.
14041
14042 @item (: @var{function} @var{arg1} @var{arg2} @dots{})
14043 If the split is a list, and the first element is @samp{:}, then the
14044 second element will be called as a function with @var{args} given as
14045 arguments. The function should return a @var{split}.
14046
14047 @cindex body split
14048 For instance, the following function could be used to split based on the
14049 body of the messages:
14050
14051 @lisp
14052 (defun split-on-body ()
14053 (save-excursion
14054 (save-restriction
14055 (widen)
14056 (goto-char (point-min))
14057 (when (re-search-forward "Some.*string" nil t)
14058 "string.group"))))
14059 @end lisp
14060
14061 The buffer is narrowed to the message in question when @var{function}
14062 is run. That's why @code{(widen)} needs to be called after
14063 @code{save-excursion} and @code{save-restriction} in the example
14064 above. Also note that with the nnimap backend, message bodies will
14065 not be downloaded by default. You need to set
14066 @code{nnimap-split-download-body} to @code{t} to do that
14067 (@pxref{Splitting in IMAP}).
14068
14069 @item (! @var{func} @var{split})
14070 If the split is a list, and the first element is @code{!}, then
14071 @var{split} will be processed, and @var{func} will be called as a
14072 function with the result of @var{split} as argument. @var{func}
14073 should return a split.
14074
14075 @item nil
14076 If the split is @code{nil}, it is ignored.
14077
14078 @end table
14079
14080 In these splits, @var{field} must match a complete field name.
14081 @var{value} must match a complete word according to the fundamental mode
14082 syntax table. You can use @code{.*} in the regexps to match partial
14083 field names or words. In other words, all @var{value}'s are wrapped in
14084 @samp{\<} and @samp{\>} pairs.
14085
14086 @vindex nnmail-split-abbrev-alist
14087 @var{field} and @var{value} can also be Lisp symbols, in that case
14088 they are expanded as specified by the variable
14089 @code{nnmail-split-abbrev-alist}. This is an alist of cons cells,
14090 where the @sc{car} of a cell contains the key, and the @sc{cdr}
14091 contains the associated value. Predefined entries in
14092 @code{nnmail-split-abbrev-alist} include:
14093
14094 @table @code
14095 @item from
14096 Matches the @samp{From}, @samp{Sender} and @samp{Resent-From} fields.
14097 @item to
14098 Matches the @samp{To}, @samp{Cc}, @samp{Apparently-To},
14099 @samp{Resent-To} and @samp{Resent-Cc} fields.
14100 @item any
14101 Is the union of the @code{from} and @code{to} entries.
14102 @end table
14103
14104 @vindex nnmail-split-fancy-syntax-table
14105 @code{nnmail-split-fancy-syntax-table} is the syntax table in effect
14106 when all this splitting is performed.
14107
14108 If you want to have Gnus create groups dynamically based on some
14109 information in the headers (i.e., do @code{replace-match}-like
14110 substitutions in the group names), you can say things like:
14111
14112 @example
14113 (any "debian-\\b\\(\\w+\\)@@lists.debian.org" "mail.debian.\\1")
14114 @end example
14115
14116 In this example, messages sent to @samp{debian-foo@@lists.debian.org}
14117 will be filed in @samp{mail.debian.foo}.
14118
14119 If the string contains the element @samp{\&}, then the previously
14120 matched string will be substituted. Similarly, the elements @samp{\\1}
14121 up to @samp{\\9} will be substituted with the text matched by the
14122 groupings 1 through 9.
14123
14124 @vindex nnmail-split-lowercase-expanded
14125 Where @code{nnmail-split-lowercase-expanded} controls whether the
14126 lowercase of the matched string should be used for the substitution.
14127 Setting it as non-@code{nil} is useful to avoid the creation of multiple
14128 groups when users send to an address using different case
14129 (i.e. mailing-list@@domain vs Mailing-List@@Domain). The default value
14130 is @code{t}.
14131
14132 @vindex nnmail-split-fancy-match-partial-words
14133 @code{nnmail-split-fancy-match-partial-words} controls whether partial
14134 words are matched during fancy splitting.
14135
14136 Normally, regular expressions given in @code{nnmail-split-fancy} are
14137 implicitly surrounded by @code{\<...\>} markers, which are word
14138 delimiters. If this variable is true, they are not implicitly
14139 surrounded by anything.
14140
14141 @example
14142 (any "joe" "joemail")
14143 @end example
14144
14145 In this example, messages sent from @samp{joedavis@@foo.org} will
14146 normally not be filed in @samp{joemail}. With
14147 @code{nnmail-split-fancy-match-partial-words} set to @code{t},
14148 however, the match will happen. In effect, the requirement of a word
14149 boundary is removed and instead the match becomes more like a grep.
14150
14151 @findex nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent
14152 @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent} is a function which allows you to
14153 split followups into the same groups their parents are in. Sometimes
14154 you can't make splitting rules for all your mail. For example, your
14155 boss might send you personal mail regarding different projects you are
14156 working on, and as you can't tell your boss to put a distinguishing
14157 string into the subject line, you have to resort to manually moving the
14158 messages into the right group. With this function, you only have to do
14159 it once per thread.
14160
14161 To use this feature, you have to set @code{nnmail-treat-duplicates}
14162 and @code{nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids} to a non-@code{nil}
14163 value. And then you can include @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent}
14164 using the colon feature, like so:
14165 @lisp
14166 (setq nnmail-treat-duplicates 'warn ; @r{or @code{delete}}
14167 nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids t
14168 nnmail-split-fancy
14169 '(| (: nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent)
14170 ;; @r{other splits go here}
14171 ))
14172 @end lisp
14173
14174 This feature works as follows: when @code{nnmail-treat-duplicates} is
14175 non-@code{nil}, Gnus records the message id of every message it sees
14176 in the file specified by the variable
14177 @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-file}, together with the group it is in
14178 (the group is omitted for non-mail messages). When mail splitting is
14179 invoked, the function @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent} then looks
14180 at the References (and In-Reply-To) header of each message to split
14181 and searches the file specified by @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-file}
14182 for the message ids. When it has found a parent, it returns the
14183 corresponding group name unless the group name matches the regexp
14184 @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent-ignore-groups}. It is
14185 recommended that you set @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-length} to a
14186 somewhat higher number than the default so that the message ids are
14187 still in the cache. (A value of 5000 appears to create a file some
14188 300 kBytes in size.)
14189 @vindex nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids
14190 When @code{nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids} is non-@code{nil}, Gnus
14191 also records the message ids of moved articles, so that the followup
14192 messages goes into the new group.
14193
14194 Also see the variable @code{nnmail-cache-ignore-groups} if you don't
14195 want certain groups to be recorded in the cache. For example, if all
14196 outgoing messages are written to an ``outgoing'' group, you could set
14197 @code{nnmail-cache-ignore-groups} to match that group name.
14198 Otherwise, answers to all your messages would end up in the
14199 ``outgoing'' group.
14200
14201
14202 @node Group Mail Splitting
14203 @subsection Group Mail Splitting
14204 @cindex mail splitting
14205 @cindex group mail splitting
14206
14207 @findex gnus-group-split
14208 If you subscribe to dozens of mailing lists but you don't want to
14209 maintain mail splitting rules manually, group mail splitting is for you.
14210 You just have to set @code{to-list} and/or @code{to-address} in group
14211 parameters or group customization and set @code{nnmail-split-methods} to
14212 @code{gnus-group-split}. This splitting function will scan all groups
14213 for those parameters and split mail accordingly, i.e., messages posted
14214 from or to the addresses specified in the parameters @code{to-list} or
14215 @code{to-address} of a mail group will be stored in that group.
14216
14217 Sometimes, mailing lists have multiple addresses, and you may want mail
14218 splitting to recognize them all: just set the @code{extra-aliases} group
14219 parameter to the list of additional addresses and it's done. If you'd
14220 rather use a regular expression, set @code{split-regexp}.
14221
14222 All these parameters in a group will be used to create an
14223 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} split, in which the @var{field} is @samp{any},
14224 the @var{value} is a single regular expression that matches
14225 @code{to-list}, @code{to-address}, all of @code{extra-aliases} and all
14226 matches of @code{split-regexp}, and the @var{split} is the name of the
14227 group. @var{restrict}s are also supported: just set the
14228 @code{split-exclude} parameter to a list of regular expressions.
14229
14230 If you can't get the right split to be generated using all these
14231 parameters, or you just need something fancier, you can set the
14232 parameter @code{split-spec} to an @code{nnmail-split-fancy} split. In
14233 this case, all other aforementioned parameters will be ignored by
14234 @code{gnus-group-split}. In particular, @code{split-spec} may be set to
14235 @code{nil}, in which case the group will be ignored by
14236 @code{gnus-group-split}.
14237
14238 @vindex gnus-group-split-default-catch-all-group
14239 @code{gnus-group-split} will do cross-posting on all groups that match,
14240 by defining a single @code{&} fancy split containing one split for each
14241 group. If a message doesn't match any split, it will be stored in the
14242 group named in @code{gnus-group-split-default-catch-all-group}, unless
14243 some group has @code{split-spec} set to @code{catch-all}, in which case
14244 that group is used as the catch-all group. Even though this variable is
14245 often used just to name a group, it may also be set to an arbitrarily
14246 complex fancy split (after all, a group name is a fancy split), and this
14247 may be useful to split mail that doesn't go to any mailing list to
14248 personal mail folders. Note that this fancy split is added as the last
14249 element of a @code{|} split list that also contains a @code{&} split
14250 with the rules extracted from group parameters.
14251
14252 It's time for an example. Assume the following group parameters have
14253 been defined:
14254
14255 @example
14256 nnml:mail.bar:
14257 ((to-address . "bar@@femail.com")
14258 (split-regexp . ".*@@femail\\.com"))
14259 nnml:mail.foo:
14260 ((to-list . "foo@@nowhere.gov")
14261 (extra-aliases "foo@@localhost" "foo-redist@@home")
14262 (split-exclude "bugs-foo" "rambling-foo")
14263 (admin-address . "foo-request@@nowhere.gov"))
14264 nnml:mail.others:
14265 ((split-spec . catch-all))
14266 @end example
14267
14268 Setting @code{nnmail-split-methods} to @code{gnus-group-split} will
14269 behave as if @code{nnmail-split-fancy} had been selected and variable
14270 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} had been set as follows:
14271
14272 @lisp
14273 (| (& (any "\\(bar@@femail\\.com\\|.*@@femail\\.com\\)" "mail.bar")
14274 (any "\\(foo@@nowhere\\.gov\\|foo@@localhost\\|foo-redist@@home\\)"
14275 - "bugs-foo" - "rambling-foo" "mail.foo"))
14276 "mail.others")
14277 @end lisp
14278
14279 @findex gnus-group-split-fancy
14280 If you'd rather not use group splitting for all your mail groups, you
14281 may use it for only some of them, by using @code{nnmail-split-fancy}
14282 splits like this:
14283
14284 @lisp
14285 (: gnus-group-split-fancy @var{groups} @var{no-crosspost} @var{catch-all})
14286 @end lisp
14287
14288 @var{groups} may be a regular expression or a list of group names whose
14289 parameters will be scanned to generate the output split.
14290 @var{no-crosspost} can be used to disable cross-posting; in this case, a
14291 single @code{|} split will be output. @var{catch-all} is the fall back
14292 fancy split, used like @code{gnus-group-split-default-catch-all-group}.
14293 If @var{catch-all} is @code{nil}, or if @code{split-regexp} matches the
14294 empty string in any selected group, no catch-all split will be issued.
14295 Otherwise, if some group has @code{split-spec} set to @code{catch-all},
14296 this group will override the value of the @var{catch-all} argument.
14297
14298 @findex gnus-group-split-setup
14299 Unfortunately, scanning all groups and their parameters can be quite
14300 slow, especially considering that it has to be done for every message.
14301 But don't despair! The function @code{gnus-group-split-setup} can be
14302 used to enable @code{gnus-group-split} in a much more efficient way. It
14303 sets @code{nnmail-split-methods} to @code{nnmail-split-fancy} and sets
14304 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} to the split produced by
14305 @code{gnus-group-split-fancy}. Thus, the group parameters are only
14306 scanned once, no matter how many messages are split.
14307
14308 @findex gnus-group-split-update
14309 However, if you change group parameters, you'd have to update
14310 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} manually. You can do it by running
14311 @code{gnus-group-split-update}. If you'd rather have it updated
14312 automatically, just tell @code{gnus-group-split-setup} to do it for
14313 you. For example, add to your @file{~/.gnus.el}:
14314
14315 @lisp
14316 (gnus-group-split-setup @var{auto-update} @var{catch-all})
14317 @end lisp
14318
14319 If @var{auto-update} is non-@code{nil}, @code{gnus-group-split-update}
14320 will be added to @code{nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook}, so you won't ever
14321 have to worry about updating @code{nnmail-split-fancy} again. If you
14322 don't omit @var{catch-all} (it's optional, equivalent to @code{nil}),
14323 @code{gnus-group-split-default-catch-all-group} will be set to its
14324 value.
14325
14326 @vindex gnus-group-split-updated-hook
14327 Because you may want to change @code{nnmail-split-fancy} after it is set
14328 by @code{gnus-group-split-update}, this function will run
14329 @code{gnus-group-split-updated-hook} just before finishing.
14330
14331 @node Incorporating Old Mail
14332 @subsection Incorporating Old Mail
14333 @cindex incorporating old mail
14334 @cindex import old mail
14335
14336 Most people have lots of old mail stored in various file formats. If
14337 you have set up Gnus to read mail using one of the spiffy Gnus mail
14338 back ends, you'll probably wish to have that old mail incorporated into
14339 your mail groups.
14340
14341 Doing so can be quite easy.
14342
14343 To take an example: You're reading mail using @code{nnml}
14344 (@pxref{Mail Spool}), and have set @code{nnmail-split-methods} to a
14345 satisfactory value (@pxref{Splitting Mail}). You have an old Unix mbox
14346 file filled with important, but old, mail. You want to move it into
14347 your @code{nnml} groups.
14348
14349 Here's how:
14350
14351 @enumerate
14352 @item
14353 Go to the group buffer.
14354
14355 @item
14356 Type @kbd{G f} and give the file name to the mbox file when prompted to create an
14357 @code{nndoc} group from the mbox file (@pxref{Foreign Groups}).
14358
14359 @item
14360 Type @kbd{SPACE} to enter the newly created group.
14361
14362 @item
14363 Type @kbd{M P b} to process-mark all articles in this group's buffer
14364 (@pxref{Setting Process Marks}).
14365
14366 @item
14367 Type @kbd{B r} to respool all the process-marked articles, and answer
14368 @samp{nnml} when prompted (@pxref{Mail Group Commands}).
14369 @end enumerate
14370
14371 All the mail messages in the mbox file will now also be spread out over
14372 all your @code{nnml} groups. Try entering them and check whether things
14373 have gone without a glitch. If things look ok, you may consider
14374 deleting the mbox file, but I wouldn't do that unless I was absolutely
14375 sure that all the mail has ended up where it should be.
14376
14377 Respooling is also a handy thing to do if you're switching from one mail
14378 back end to another. Just respool all the mail in the old mail groups
14379 using the new mail back end.
14380
14381
14382 @node Expiring Mail
14383 @subsection Expiring Mail
14384 @cindex article expiry
14385
14386 Traditional mail readers have a tendency to remove mail articles when
14387 you mark them as read, in some way. Gnus takes a fundamentally
14388 different approach to mail reading.
14389
14390 Gnus basically considers mail just to be news that has been received in
14391 a rather peculiar manner. It does not think that it has the power to
14392 actually change the mail, or delete any mail messages. If you enter a
14393 mail group, and mark articles as ``read'', or kill them in some other
14394 fashion, the mail articles will still exist on the system. I repeat:
14395 Gnus will not delete your old, read mail. Unless you ask it to, of
14396 course.
14397
14398 To make Gnus get rid of your unwanted mail, you have to mark the
14399 articles as @dfn{expirable}. (With the default key bindings, this means
14400 that you have to type @kbd{E}.) This does not mean that the articles
14401 will disappear right away, however. In general, a mail article will be
14402 deleted from your system if, 1) it is marked as expirable, AND 2) it is
14403 more than one week old. If you do not mark an article as expirable, it
14404 will remain on your system until hell freezes over. This bears
14405 repeating one more time, with some spurious capitalizations: IF you do
14406 NOT mark articles as EXPIRABLE, Gnus will NEVER delete those ARTICLES.
14407
14408 You do not have to mark articles as expirable by hand. Gnus provides
14409 two features, called ``auto-expire'' and ``total-expire'', that can help you
14410 with this. In a nutshell, ``auto-expire'' means that Gnus hits @kbd{E}
14411 for you when you select an article. And ``total-expire'' means that Gnus
14412 considers all articles as expirable that are read. So, in addition to
14413 the articles marked @samp{E}, also the articles marked @samp{r},
14414 @samp{R}, @samp{O}, @samp{K}, @samp{Y} and so on are considered
14415 expirable.
14416
14417 When should either auto-expire or total-expire be used? Most people
14418 who are subscribed to mailing lists split each list into its own group
14419 and then turn on auto-expire or total-expire for those groups.
14420 (@xref{Splitting Mail}, for more information on splitting each list
14421 into its own group.)
14422
14423 Which one is better, auto-expire or total-expire? It's not easy to
14424 answer. Generally speaking, auto-expire is probably faster. Another
14425 advantage of auto-expire is that you get more marks to work with: for
14426 the articles that are supposed to stick around, you can still choose
14427 between tick and dormant and read marks. But with total-expire, you
14428 only have dormant and ticked to choose from. The advantage of
14429 total-expire is that it works well with adaptive scoring (@pxref{Adaptive
14430 Scoring}). Auto-expire works with normal scoring but not with adaptive
14431 scoring.
14432
14433 @vindex gnus-auto-expirable-newsgroups
14434 Groups that match the regular expression
14435 @code{gnus-auto-expirable-newsgroups} will have all articles that you
14436 read marked as expirable automatically. All articles marked as
14437 expirable have an @samp{E} in the first column in the summary buffer.
14438
14439 By default, if you have auto expiry switched on, Gnus will mark all the
14440 articles you read as expirable, no matter if they were read or unread
14441 before. To avoid having articles marked as read marked as expirable
14442 automatically, you can put something like the following in your
14443 @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
14444
14445 @vindex gnus-mark-article-hook
14446 @lisp
14447 (remove-hook 'gnus-mark-article-hook
14448 'gnus-summary-mark-read-and-unread-as-read)
14449 (add-hook 'gnus-mark-article-hook 'gnus-summary-mark-unread-as-read)
14450 @end lisp
14451
14452 Note that making a group auto-expirable doesn't mean that all read
14453 articles are expired---only the articles marked as expirable
14454 will be expired. Also note that using the @kbd{d} command won't make
14455 articles expirable---only semi-automatic marking of articles as read will
14456 mark the articles as expirable in auto-expirable groups.
14457
14458 Let's say you subscribe to a couple of mailing lists, and you want the
14459 articles you have read to disappear after a while:
14460
14461 @lisp
14462 (setq gnus-auto-expirable-newsgroups
14463 "mail.nonsense-list\\|mail.nice-list")
14464 @end lisp
14465
14466 Another way to have auto-expiry happen is to have the element
14467 @code{auto-expire} in the group parameters of the group.
14468
14469 If you use adaptive scoring (@pxref{Adaptive Scoring}) and
14470 auto-expiring, you'll have problems. Auto-expiring and adaptive scoring
14471 don't really mix very well.
14472
14473 @vindex nnmail-expiry-wait
14474 The @code{nnmail-expiry-wait} variable supplies the default time an
14475 expirable article has to live. Gnus starts counting days from when the
14476 message @emph{arrived}, not from when it was sent. The default is seven
14477 days.
14478
14479 Gnus also supplies a function that lets you fine-tune how long articles
14480 are to live, based on what group they are in. Let's say you want to
14481 have one month expiry period in the @samp{mail.private} group, a one day
14482 expiry period in the @samp{mail.junk} group, and a six day expiry period
14483 everywhere else:
14484
14485 @vindex nnmail-expiry-wait-function
14486 @lisp
14487 (setq nnmail-expiry-wait-function
14488 (lambda (group)
14489 (cond ((string= group "mail.private")
14490 31)
14491 ((string= group "mail.junk")
14492 1)
14493 ((string= group "important")
14494 'never)
14495 (t
14496 6))))
14497 @end lisp
14498
14499 The group names this function is fed are ``unadorned'' group
14500 names---no @samp{nnml:} prefixes and the like.
14501
14502 The @code{nnmail-expiry-wait} variable and
14503 @code{nnmail-expiry-wait-function} function can either be a number (not
14504 necessarily an integer) or one of the symbols @code{immediate} or
14505 @code{never}.
14506
14507 You can also use the @code{expiry-wait} group parameter to selectively
14508 change the expiry period (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
14509
14510 @vindex nnmail-expiry-target
14511 The normal action taken when expiring articles is to delete them.
14512 However, in some circumstances it might make more sense to move them
14513 to other groups instead of deleting them. The variable
14514 @code{nnmail-expiry-target} (and the @code{expiry-target} group
14515 parameter) controls this. The variable supplies a default value for
14516 all groups, which can be overridden for specific groups by the group
14517 parameter. default value is @code{delete}, but this can also be a
14518 string (which should be the name of the group the message should be
14519 moved to), or a function (which will be called in a buffer narrowed to
14520 the message in question, and with the name of the group being moved
14521 from as its parameter) which should return a target---either a group
14522 name or @code{delete}.
14523
14524 Here's an example for specifying a group name:
14525 @lisp
14526 (setq nnmail-expiry-target "nnml:expired")
14527 @end lisp
14528
14529 @findex nnmail-fancy-expiry-target
14530 @vindex nnmail-fancy-expiry-targets
14531 Gnus provides a function @code{nnmail-fancy-expiry-target} which will
14532 expire mail to groups according to the variable
14533 @code{nnmail-fancy-expiry-targets}. Here's an example:
14534
14535 @lisp
14536 (setq nnmail-expiry-target 'nnmail-fancy-expiry-target
14537 nnmail-fancy-expiry-targets
14538 '((to-from "boss" "nnfolder:Work")
14539 ("subject" "IMPORTANT" "nnfolder:IMPORTANT.%Y.%b")
14540 ("from" ".*" "nnfolder:Archive-%Y")))
14541 @end lisp
14542
14543 With this setup, any mail that has @code{IMPORTANT} in its Subject
14544 header and was sent in the year @code{YYYY} and month @code{MMM}, will
14545 get expired to the group @code{nnfolder:IMPORTANT.YYYY.MMM}. If its
14546 From or To header contains the string @code{boss}, it will get expired
14547 to @code{nnfolder:Work}. All other mail will get expired to
14548 @code{nnfolder:Archive-YYYY}.
14549
14550 @vindex nnmail-keep-last-article
14551 If @code{nnmail-keep-last-article} is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will never
14552 expire the final article in a mail newsgroup. This is to make life
14553 easier for procmail users.
14554
14555 @vindex gnus-total-expirable-newsgroups
14556 By the way: That line up there, about Gnus never expiring non-expirable
14557 articles, is a lie. If you put @code{total-expire} in the group
14558 parameters, articles will not be marked as expirable, but all read
14559 articles will be put through the expiry process. Use with extreme
14560 caution. Even more dangerous is the
14561 @code{gnus-total-expirable-newsgroups} variable. All groups that match
14562 this regexp will have all read articles put through the expiry process,
14563 which means that @emph{all} old mail articles in the groups in question
14564 will be deleted after a while. Use with extreme caution, and don't come
14565 crying to me when you discover that the regexp you used matched the
14566 wrong group and all your important mail has disappeared. Be a
14567 @emph{man}! Or a @emph{woman}! Whatever you feel more comfortable
14568 with! So there!
14569
14570 Most people make most of their mail groups total-expirable, though.
14571
14572 @vindex gnus-inhibit-user-auto-expire
14573 If @code{gnus-inhibit-user-auto-expire} is non-@code{nil}, user marking
14574 commands will not mark an article as expirable, even if the group has
14575 auto-expire turned on.
14576
14577
14578 @node Washing Mail
14579 @subsection Washing Mail
14580 @cindex mail washing
14581 @cindex list server brain damage
14582 @cindex incoming mail treatment
14583
14584 Mailers and list servers are notorious for doing all sorts of really,
14585 really stupid things with mail. ``Hey, RFC 822 doesn't explicitly
14586 prohibit us from adding the string @code{wE aRe ElItE!!!!!1!!} to the
14587 end of all lines passing through our server, so let's do that!!!!1!''
14588 Yes, but RFC 822 wasn't designed to be read by morons. Things that were
14589 considered to be self-evident were not discussed. So. Here we are.
14590
14591 Case in point: The German version of Microsoft Exchange adds @samp{AW:
14592 } to the subjects of replies instead of @samp{Re: }. I could pretend to
14593 be shocked and dismayed by this, but I haven't got the energy. It is to
14594 laugh.
14595
14596 Gnus provides a plethora of functions for washing articles while
14597 displaying them, but it might be nicer to do the filtering before
14598 storing the mail to disk. For that purpose, we have three hooks and
14599 various functions that can be put in these hooks.
14600
14601 @table @code
14602 @item nnmail-prepare-incoming-hook
14603 @vindex nnmail-prepare-incoming-hook
14604 This hook is called before doing anything with the mail and is meant for
14605 grand, sweeping gestures. It is called in a buffer that contains all
14606 the new, incoming mail. Functions to be used include:
14607
14608 @table @code
14609 @item nnheader-ms-strip-cr
14610 @findex nnheader-ms-strip-cr
14611 Remove trailing carriage returns from each line. This is default on
14612 Emacs running on MS machines.
14613
14614 @end table
14615
14616 @item nnmail-prepare-incoming-header-hook
14617 @vindex nnmail-prepare-incoming-header-hook
14618 This hook is called narrowed to each header. It can be used when
14619 cleaning up the headers. Functions that can be used include:
14620
14621 @table @code
14622 @item nnmail-remove-leading-whitespace
14623 @findex nnmail-remove-leading-whitespace
14624 Clear leading white space that ``helpful'' listservs have added to the
14625 headers to make them look nice. Aaah.
14626
14627 (Note that this function works on both the header on the body of all
14628 messages, so it is a potentially dangerous function to use (if a body
14629 of a message contains something that looks like a header line). So
14630 rather than fix the bug, it is of course the right solution to make it
14631 into a feature by documenting it.)
14632
14633 @item nnmail-remove-list-identifiers
14634 @findex nnmail-remove-list-identifiers
14635 Some list servers add an identifier---for example, @samp{(idm)}---to the
14636 beginning of all @code{Subject} headers. I'm sure that's nice for
14637 people who use stone age mail readers. This function will remove
14638 strings that match the @code{nnmail-list-identifiers} regexp, which can
14639 also be a list of regexp. @code{nnmail-list-identifiers} may not contain
14640 @code{\\(..\\)}.
14641
14642 For instance, if you want to remove the @samp{(idm)} and the
14643 @samp{nagnagnag} identifiers:
14644
14645 @lisp
14646 (setq nnmail-list-identifiers
14647 '("(idm)" "nagnagnag"))
14648 @end lisp
14649
14650 This can also be done non-destructively with
14651 @code{gnus-list-identifiers}, @xref{Article Hiding}.
14652
14653 @item nnmail-remove-tabs
14654 @findex nnmail-remove-tabs
14655 Translate all @samp{TAB} characters into @samp{SPACE} characters.
14656
14657 @item nnmail-fix-eudora-headers
14658 @findex nnmail-fix-eudora-headers
14659 @cindex Eudora
14660 Eudora produces broken @code{References} headers, but OK
14661 @code{In-Reply-To} headers. This function will get rid of the
14662 @code{References} headers.
14663
14664 @end table
14665
14666 @item nnmail-prepare-incoming-message-hook
14667 @vindex nnmail-prepare-incoming-message-hook
14668 This hook is called narrowed to each message. Functions to be used
14669 include:
14670
14671 @table @code
14672 @item article-de-quoted-unreadable
14673 @findex article-de-quoted-unreadable
14674 Decode Quoted Readable encoding.
14675
14676 @end table
14677 @end table
14678
14679
14680 @node Duplicates
14681 @subsection Duplicates
14682
14683 @vindex nnmail-treat-duplicates
14684 @vindex nnmail-message-id-cache-length
14685 @vindex nnmail-message-id-cache-file
14686 @cindex duplicate mails
14687 If you are a member of a couple of mailing lists, you will sometimes
14688 receive two copies of the same mail. This can be quite annoying, so
14689 @code{nnmail} checks for and treats any duplicates it might find. To do
14690 this, it keeps a cache of old @code{Message-ID}s---
14691 @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-file}, which is @file{~/.nnmail-cache} by
14692 default. The approximate maximum number of @code{Message-ID}s stored
14693 there is controlled by the @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-length}
14694 variable, which is 1000 by default. (So 1000 @code{Message-ID}s will be
14695 stored.) If all this sounds scary to you, you can set
14696 @code{nnmail-treat-duplicates} to @code{warn} (which is what it is by
14697 default), and @code{nnmail} won't delete duplicate mails. Instead it
14698 will insert a warning into the head of the mail saying that it thinks
14699 that this is a duplicate of a different message.
14700
14701 This variable can also be a function. If that's the case, the function
14702 will be called from a buffer narrowed to the message in question with
14703 the @code{Message-ID} as a parameter. The function must return either
14704 @code{nil}, @code{warn}, or @code{delete}.
14705
14706 You can turn this feature off completely by setting the variable to
14707 @code{nil}.
14708
14709 If you want all the duplicate mails to be put into a special
14710 @dfn{duplicates} group, you could do that using the normal mail split
14711 methods:
14712
14713 @lisp
14714 (setq nnmail-split-fancy
14715 '(| ;; @r{Messages duplicates go to a separate group.}
14716 ("gnus-warning" "duplicat\\(e\\|ion\\) of message" "duplicate")
14717 ;; @r{Message from daemons, postmaster, and the like to another.}
14718 (any mail "mail.misc")
14719 ;; @r{Other rules.}
14720 [...] ))
14721 @end lisp
14722 @noindent
14723 Or something like:
14724 @lisp
14725 (setq nnmail-split-methods
14726 '(("duplicates" "^Gnus-Warning:.*duplicate")
14727 ;; @r{Other rules.}
14728 [...]))
14729 @end lisp
14730
14731 Here's a neat feature: If you know that the recipient reads her mail
14732 with Gnus, and that she has @code{nnmail-treat-duplicates} set to
14733 @code{delete}, you can send her as many insults as you like, just by
14734 using a @code{Message-ID} of a mail that you know that she's already
14735 received. Think of all the fun! She'll never see any of it! Whee!
14736
14737
14738 @node Not Reading Mail
14739 @subsection Not Reading Mail
14740
14741 If you start using any of the mail back ends, they have the annoying
14742 habit of assuming that you want to read mail with them. This might not
14743 be unreasonable, but it might not be what you want.
14744
14745 If you set @code{mail-sources} and @code{nnmail-spool-file} to
14746 @code{nil}, none of the back ends will ever attempt to read incoming
14747 mail, which should help.
14748
14749 @vindex nnbabyl-get-new-mail
14750 @vindex nnmbox-get-new-mail
14751 @vindex nnml-get-new-mail
14752 @vindex nnmh-get-new-mail
14753 @vindex nnfolder-get-new-mail
14754 This might be too much, if, for instance, you are reading mail quite
14755 happily with @code{nnml} and just want to peek at some old Rmail
14756 file you have stashed away with @code{nnbabyl}. All back ends have
14757 variables called back-end-@code{get-new-mail}. If you want to disable
14758 the @code{nnbabyl} mail reading, you edit the virtual server for the
14759 group to have a setting where @code{nnbabyl-get-new-mail} to @code{nil}.
14760
14761 All the mail back ends will call @code{nn}*@code{-prepare-save-mail-hook}
14762 narrowed to the article to be saved before saving it when reading
14763 incoming mail.
14764
14765
14766 @node Choosing a Mail Back End
14767 @subsection Choosing a Mail Back End
14768
14769 Gnus will read the mail spool when you activate a mail group. The mail
14770 file is first copied to your home directory. What happens after that
14771 depends on what format you want to store your mail in.
14772
14773 There are six different mail back ends in the standard Gnus, and more
14774 back ends are available separately. The mail back end most people use
14775 (because it is possibly the fastest) is @code{nnml} (@pxref{Mail
14776 Spool}).
14777
14778 @menu
14779 * Unix Mail Box:: Using the (quite) standard Un*x mbox.
14780 * Rmail Babyl:: Emacs programs use the Rmail Babyl format.
14781 * Mail Spool:: Store your mail in a private spool?
14782 * MH Spool:: An mhspool-like back end.
14783 * Maildir:: Another one-file-per-message format.
14784 * Mail Folders:: Having one file for each group.
14785 * Comparing Mail Back Ends:: An in-depth looks at pros and cons.
14786 @end menu
14787
14788
14789 @node Unix Mail Box
14790 @subsubsection Unix Mail Box
14791 @cindex nnmbox
14792 @cindex unix mail box
14793
14794 @vindex nnmbox-active-file
14795 @vindex nnmbox-mbox-file
14796 The @dfn{nnmbox} back end will use the standard Un*x mbox file to store
14797 mail. @code{nnmbox} will add extra headers to each mail article to say
14798 which group it belongs in.
14799
14800 Virtual server settings:
14801
14802 @table @code
14803 @item nnmbox-mbox-file
14804 @vindex nnmbox-mbox-file
14805 The name of the mail box in the user's home directory. Default is
14806 @file{~/mbox}.
14807
14808 @item nnmbox-active-file
14809 @vindex nnmbox-active-file
14810 The name of the active file for the mail box. Default is
14811 @file{~/.mbox-active}.
14812
14813 @item nnmbox-get-new-mail
14814 @vindex nnmbox-get-new-mail
14815 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnmbox} will read incoming mail and split it
14816 into groups. Default is @code{t}.
14817 @end table
14818
14819
14820 @node Rmail Babyl
14821 @subsubsection Rmail Babyl
14822 @cindex nnbabyl
14823 @cindex Rmail mbox
14824
14825 @vindex nnbabyl-active-file
14826 @vindex nnbabyl-mbox-file
14827 The @dfn{nnbabyl} back end will use a Babyl mail box (aka. @dfn{Rmail
14828 mbox}) to store mail. @code{nnbabyl} will add extra headers to each
14829 mail article to say which group it belongs in.
14830
14831 Virtual server settings:
14832
14833 @table @code
14834 @item nnbabyl-mbox-file
14835 @vindex nnbabyl-mbox-file
14836 The name of the Rmail mbox file. The default is @file{~/RMAIL}
14837
14838 @item nnbabyl-active-file
14839 @vindex nnbabyl-active-file
14840 The name of the active file for the rmail box. The default is
14841 @file{~/.rmail-active}
14842
14843 @item nnbabyl-get-new-mail
14844 @vindex nnbabyl-get-new-mail
14845 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnbabyl} will read incoming mail. Default is
14846 @code{t}
14847 @end table
14848
14849
14850 @node Mail Spool
14851 @subsubsection Mail Spool
14852 @cindex nnml
14853 @cindex mail @acronym{NOV} spool
14854
14855 The @dfn{nnml} spool mail format isn't compatible with any other known
14856 format. It should be used with some caution.
14857
14858 @vindex nnml-directory
14859 If you use this back end, Gnus will split all incoming mail into files,
14860 one file for each mail, and put the articles into the corresponding
14861 directories under the directory specified by the @code{nnml-directory}
14862 variable. The default value is @file{~/Mail/}.
14863
14864 You do not have to create any directories beforehand; Gnus will take
14865 care of all that.
14866
14867 If you have a strict limit as to how many files you are allowed to store
14868 in your account, you should not use this back end. As each mail gets its
14869 own file, you might very well occupy thousands of inodes within a few
14870 weeks. If this is no problem for you, and it isn't a problem for you
14871 having your friendly systems administrator walking around, madly,
14872 shouting ``Who is eating all my inodes?! Who? Who!?!'', then you should
14873 know that this is probably the fastest format to use. You do not have
14874 to trudge through a big mbox file just to read your new mail.
14875
14876 @code{nnml} is probably the slowest back end when it comes to article
14877 splitting. It has to create lots of files, and it also generates
14878 @acronym{NOV} databases for the incoming mails. This makes it possibly the
14879 fastest back end when it comes to reading mail.
14880
14881 @cindex self contained nnml servers
14882 @cindex marks
14883 When the marks file is used (which it is by default), @code{nnml}
14884 servers have the property that you may backup them using @code{tar} or
14885 similar, and later be able to restore them into Gnus (by adding the
14886 proper @code{nnml} server) and have all your marks be preserved. Marks
14887 for a group is usually stored in the @code{.marks} file (but see
14888 @code{nnml-marks-file-name}) within each @code{nnml} group's directory.
14889 Individual @code{nnml} groups are also possible to backup, use @kbd{G m}
14890 to restore the group (after restoring the backup into the nnml
14891 directory).
14892
14893 If for some reason you believe your @file{.marks} files are screwed
14894 up, you can just delete them all. Gnus will then correctly regenerate
14895 them next time it starts.
14896
14897 Virtual server settings:
14898
14899 @table @code
14900 @item nnml-directory
14901 @vindex nnml-directory
14902 All @code{nnml} directories will be placed under this directory. The
14903 default is the value of @code{message-directory} (whose default value
14904 is @file{~/Mail}).
14905
14906 @item nnml-active-file
14907 @vindex nnml-active-file
14908 The active file for the @code{nnml} server. The default is
14909 @file{~/Mail/active}.
14910
14911 @item nnml-newsgroups-file
14912 @vindex nnml-newsgroups-file
14913 The @code{nnml} group descriptions file. @xref{Newsgroups File
14914 Format}. The default is @file{~/Mail/newsgroups}.
14915
14916 @item nnml-get-new-mail
14917 @vindex nnml-get-new-mail
14918 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnml} will read incoming mail. The default is
14919 @code{t}.
14920
14921 @item nnml-nov-is-evil
14922 @vindex nnml-nov-is-evil
14923 If non-@code{nil}, this back end will ignore any @acronym{NOV} files. The
14924 default is @code{nil}.
14925
14926 @item nnml-nov-file-name
14927 @vindex nnml-nov-file-name
14928 The name of the @acronym{NOV} files. The default is @file{.overview}.
14929
14930 @item nnml-prepare-save-mail-hook
14931 @vindex nnml-prepare-save-mail-hook
14932 Hook run narrowed to an article before saving.
14933
14934 @item nnml-marks-is-evil
14935 @vindex nnml-marks-is-evil
14936 If non-@code{nil}, this back end will ignore any @sc{marks} files. The
14937 default is @code{nil}.
14938
14939 @item nnml-marks-file-name
14940 @vindex nnml-marks-file-name
14941 The name of the @dfn{marks} files. The default is @file{.marks}.
14942
14943 @item nnml-use-compressed-files
14944 @vindex nnml-use-compressed-files
14945 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnml} will allow using compressed message
14946 files.
14947
14948 @end table
14949
14950 @findex nnml-generate-nov-databases
14951 If your @code{nnml} groups and @acronym{NOV} files get totally out of
14952 whack, you can do a complete update by typing @kbd{M-x
14953 nnml-generate-nov-databases}. This command will trawl through the
14954 entire @code{nnml} hierarchy, looking at each and every article, so it
14955 might take a while to complete. A better interface to this
14956 functionality can be found in the server buffer (@pxref{Server
14957 Commands}).
14958
14959
14960 @node MH Spool
14961 @subsubsection MH Spool
14962 @cindex nnmh
14963 @cindex mh-e mail spool
14964
14965 @code{nnmh} is just like @code{nnml}, except that is doesn't generate
14966 @acronym{NOV} databases and it doesn't keep an active file or marks
14967 file. This makes @code{nnmh} a @emph{much} slower back end than
14968 @code{nnml}, but it also makes it easier to write procmail scripts
14969 for.
14970
14971 Virtual server settings:
14972
14973 @table @code
14974 @item nnmh-directory
14975 @vindex nnmh-directory
14976 All @code{nnmh} directories will be located under this directory. The
14977 default is the value of @code{message-directory} (whose default is
14978 @file{~/Mail})
14979
14980 @item nnmh-get-new-mail
14981 @vindex nnmh-get-new-mail
14982 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnmh} will read incoming mail. The default is
14983 @code{t}.
14984
14985 @item nnmh-be-safe
14986 @vindex nnmh-be-safe
14987 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnmh} will go to ridiculous lengths to make
14988 sure that the articles in the folder are actually what Gnus thinks
14989 they are. It will check date stamps and stat everything in sight, so
14990 setting this to @code{t} will mean a serious slow-down. If you never
14991 use anything but Gnus to read the @code{nnmh} articles, you do not
14992 have to set this variable to @code{t}. The default is @code{nil}.
14993 @end table
14994
14995
14996 @node Maildir
14997 @subsubsection Maildir
14998 @cindex nnmaildir
14999 @cindex maildir
15000
15001 @code{nnmaildir} stores mail in the maildir format, with each maildir
15002 corresponding to a group in Gnus. This format is documented here:
15003 @uref{http://cr.yp.to/proto/maildir.html} and here:
15004 @uref{http://www.qmail.org/man/man5/maildir.html}. @code{nnmaildir}
15005 also stores extra information in the @file{.nnmaildir/} directory
15006 within a maildir.
15007
15008 Maildir format was designed to allow concurrent deliveries and
15009 reading, without needing locks. With other back ends, you would have
15010 your mail delivered to a spool of some kind, and then you would
15011 configure Gnus to split mail from that spool into your groups. You
15012 can still do that with @code{nnmaildir}, but the more common
15013 configuration is to have your mail delivered directly to the maildirs
15014 that appear as group in Gnus.
15015
15016 @code{nnmaildir} is designed to be perfectly reliable: @kbd{C-g} will
15017 never corrupt its data in memory, and @code{SIGKILL} will never
15018 corrupt its data in the filesystem.
15019
15020 @code{nnmaildir} stores article marks and @acronym{NOV} data in each
15021 maildir. So you can copy a whole maildir from one Gnus setup to
15022 another, and you will keep your marks.
15023
15024 Virtual server settings:
15025
15026 @table @code
15027 @item directory
15028 For each of your @code{nnmaildir} servers (it's very unlikely that
15029 you'd need more than one), you need to create a directory and populate
15030 it with maildirs or symlinks to maildirs (and nothing else; do not
15031 choose a directory already used for other purposes). Each maildir
15032 will be represented in Gnus as a newsgroup on that server; the
15033 filename of the symlink will be the name of the group. Any filenames
15034 in the directory starting with @samp{.} are ignored. The directory is
15035 scanned when you first start Gnus, and each time you type @kbd{g} in
15036 the group buffer; if any maildirs have been removed or added,
15037 @code{nnmaildir} notices at these times.
15038
15039 The value of the @code{directory} parameter should be a Lisp form
15040 which is processed by @code{eval} and @code{expand-file-name} to get
15041 the path of the directory for this server. The form is @code{eval}ed
15042 only when the server is opened; the resulting string is used until the
15043 server is closed. (If you don't know about forms and @code{eval},
15044 don't worry---a simple string will work.) This parameter is not
15045 optional; you must specify it. I don't recommend using
15046 @code{"~/Mail"} or a subdirectory of it; several other parts of Gnus
15047 use that directory by default for various things, and may get confused
15048 if @code{nnmaildir} uses it too. @code{"~/.nnmaildir"} is a typical
15049 value.
15050
15051 @item target-prefix
15052 This should be a Lisp form which is processed by @code{eval} and
15053 @code{expand-file-name}. The form is @code{eval}ed only when the
15054 server is opened; the resulting string is used until the server is
15055 closed.
15056
15057 When you create a group on an @code{nnmaildir} server, the maildir is
15058 created with @code{target-prefix} prepended to its name, and a symlink
15059 pointing to that maildir is created, named with the plain group name.
15060 So if @code{directory} is @code{"~/.nnmaildir"} and
15061 @code{target-prefix} is @code{"../maildirs/"}, then when you create
15062 the group @code{foo}, @code{nnmaildir} will create
15063 @file{~/.nnmaildir/../maildirs/foo} as a maildir, and will create
15064 @file{~/.nnmaildir/foo} as a symlink pointing to
15065 @file{../maildirs/foo}.
15066
15067 You can set @code{target-prefix} to a string without any slashes to
15068 create both maildirs and symlinks in the same @code{directory}; in
15069 this case, any maildirs found in @code{directory} whose names start
15070 with @code{target-prefix} will not be listed as groups (but the
15071 symlinks pointing to them will be).
15072
15073 As a special case, if @code{target-prefix} is @code{""} (the default),
15074 then when you create a group, the maildir will be created in
15075 @code{directory} without a corresponding symlink. Beware that you
15076 cannot use @code{gnus-group-delete-group} on such groups without the
15077 @code{force} argument.
15078
15079 @item directory-files
15080 This should be a function with the same interface as
15081 @code{directory-files} (such as @code{directory-files} itself). It is
15082 used to scan the server's @code{directory} for maildirs. This
15083 parameter is optional; the default is
15084 @code{nnheader-directory-files-safe} if
15085 @code{nnheader-directory-files-is-safe} is @code{nil}, and
15086 @code{directory-files} otherwise.
15087 (@code{nnheader-directory-files-is-safe} is checked only once when the
15088 server is opened; if you want to check it each time the directory is
15089 scanned, you'll have to provide your own function that does that.)
15090
15091 @item get-new-mail
15092 If non-@code{nil}, then after scanning for new mail in the group
15093 maildirs themselves as usual, this server will also incorporate mail
15094 the conventional Gnus way, from @code{mail-sources} according to
15095 @code{nnmail-split-methods} or @code{nnmail-split-fancy}. The default
15096 value is @code{nil}.
15097
15098 Do @emph{not} use the same maildir both in @code{mail-sources} and as
15099 an @code{nnmaildir} group. The results might happen to be useful, but
15100 that would be by chance, not by design, and the results might be
15101 different in the future. If your split rules create new groups,
15102 remember to supply a @code{create-directory} server parameter.
15103 @end table
15104
15105 @subsubsection Group parameters
15106
15107 @code{nnmaildir} uses several group parameters. It's safe to ignore
15108 all this; the default behavior for @code{nnmaildir} is the same as the
15109 default behavior for other mail back ends: articles are deleted after
15110 one week, etc. Except for the expiry parameters, all this
15111 functionality is unique to @code{nnmaildir}, so you can ignore it if
15112 you're just trying to duplicate the behavior you already have with
15113 another back end.
15114
15115 If the value of any of these parameters is a vector, the first element
15116 is evaluated as a Lisp form and the result is used, rather than the
15117 original value. If the value is not a vector, the value itself is
15118 evaluated as a Lisp form. (This is why these parameters use names
15119 different from those of other, similar parameters supported by other
15120 back ends: they have different, though similar, meanings.) (For
15121 numbers, strings, @code{nil}, and @code{t}, you can ignore the
15122 @code{eval} business again; for other values, remember to use an extra
15123 quote and wrap the value in a vector when appropriate.)
15124
15125 @table @code
15126 @item expire-age
15127 An integer specifying the minimum age, in seconds, of an article
15128 before it will be expired, or the symbol @code{never} to specify that
15129 articles should never be expired. If this parameter is not set,
15130 @code{nnmaildir} falls back to the usual
15131 @code{nnmail-expiry-wait}(@code{-function}) variables (overrideable by
15132 the @code{expiry-wait}(@code{-function}) group parameters. If you
15133 wanted a value of 3 days, you could use something like @code{[(* 3 24
15134 60 60)]}; @code{nnmaildir} will evaluate the form and use the result.
15135 An article's age is measured starting from the article file's
15136 modification time. Normally, this is the same as the article's
15137 delivery time, but editing an article makes it younger. Moving an
15138 article (other than via expiry) may also make an article younger.
15139
15140 @item expire-group
15141 If this is set to a string such as a full Gnus group name, like
15142 @example
15143 "backend+server.address.string:group.name"
15144 @end example
15145 and if it is not the name of the same group that the parameter belongs
15146 to, then articles will be moved to the specified group during expiry
15147 before being deleted. @emph{If this is set to an @code{nnmaildir}
15148 group, the article will be just as old in the destination group as it
15149 was in the source group.} So be careful with @code{expire-age} in the
15150 destination group. If this is set to the name of the same group that
15151 the parameter belongs to, then the article is not expired at all. If
15152 you use the vector form, the first element is evaluated once for each
15153 article. So that form can refer to
15154 @code{nnmaildir-article-file-name}, etc., to decide where to put the
15155 article. @emph{If this parameter is not set, @code{nnmaildir} does
15156 not fall back to the @code{expiry-target} group parameter or the
15157 @code{nnmail-expiry-target} variable.}
15158
15159 @item read-only
15160 If this is set to @code{t}, @code{nnmaildir} will treat the articles
15161 in this maildir as read-only. This means: articles are not renamed
15162 from @file{new/} into @file{cur/}; articles are only found in
15163 @file{new/}, not @file{cur/}; articles are never deleted; articles
15164 cannot be edited. @file{new/} is expected to be a symlink to the
15165 @file{new/} directory of another maildir---e.g., a system-wide mailbox
15166 containing a mailing list of common interest. Everything in the
15167 maildir outside @file{new/} is @emph{not} treated as read-only, so for
15168 a shared mailbox, you do still need to set up your own maildir (or
15169 have write permission to the shared mailbox); your maildir just won't
15170 contain extra copies of the articles.
15171
15172 @item directory-files
15173 A function with the same interface as @code{directory-files}. It is
15174 used to scan the directories in the maildir corresponding to this
15175 group to find articles. The default is the function specified by the
15176 server's @code{directory-files} parameter.
15177
15178 @item distrust-Lines:
15179 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnmaildir} will always count the lines of an
15180 article, rather than use the @code{Lines:} header field. If
15181 @code{nil}, the header field will be used if present.
15182
15183 @item always-marks
15184 A list of mark symbols, such as @code{['(read expire)]}. Whenever
15185 Gnus asks @code{nnmaildir} for article marks, @code{nnmaildir} will
15186 say that all articles have these marks, regardless of whether the
15187 marks stored in the filesystem say so. This is a proof-of-concept
15188 feature that will probably be removed eventually; it ought to be done
15189 in Gnus proper, or abandoned if it's not worthwhile.
15190
15191 @item never-marks
15192 A list of mark symbols, such as @code{['(tick expire)]}. Whenever
15193 Gnus asks @code{nnmaildir} for article marks, @code{nnmaildir} will
15194 say that no articles have these marks, regardless of whether the marks
15195 stored in the filesystem say so. @code{never-marks} overrides
15196 @code{always-marks}. This is a proof-of-concept feature that will
15197 probably be removed eventually; it ought to be done in Gnus proper, or
15198 abandoned if it's not worthwhile.
15199
15200 @item nov-cache-size
15201 An integer specifying the size of the @acronym{NOV} memory cache. To
15202 speed things up, @code{nnmaildir} keeps @acronym{NOV} data in memory
15203 for a limited number of articles in each group. (This is probably not
15204 worthwhile, and will probably be removed in the future.) This
15205 parameter's value is noticed only the first time a group is seen after
15206 the server is opened---i.e., when you first start Gnus, typically.
15207 The @acronym{NOV} cache is never resized until the server is closed
15208 and reopened. The default is an estimate of the number of articles
15209 that would be displayed in the summary buffer: a count of articles
15210 that are either marked with @code{tick} or not marked with
15211 @code{read}, plus a little extra.
15212 @end table
15213
15214 @subsubsection Article identification
15215 Articles are stored in the @file{cur/} subdirectory of each maildir.
15216 Each article file is named like @code{uniq:info}, where @code{uniq}
15217 contains no colons. @code{nnmaildir} ignores, but preserves, the
15218 @code{:info} part. (Other maildir readers typically use this part of
15219 the filename to store marks.) The @code{uniq} part uniquely
15220 identifies the article, and is used in various places in the
15221 @file{.nnmaildir/} subdirectory of the maildir to store information
15222 about the corresponding article. The full pathname of an article is
15223 available in the variable @code{nnmaildir-article-file-name} after you
15224 request the article in the summary buffer.
15225
15226 @subsubsection NOV data
15227 An article identified by @code{uniq} has its @acronym{NOV} data (used
15228 to generate lines in the summary buffer) stored in
15229 @code{.nnmaildir/nov/uniq}. There is no
15230 @code{nnmaildir-generate-nov-databases} function. (There isn't much
15231 need for it---an article's @acronym{NOV} data is updated automatically
15232 when the article or @code{nnmail-extra-headers} has changed.) You can
15233 force @code{nnmaildir} to regenerate the @acronym{NOV} data for a
15234 single article simply by deleting the corresponding @acronym{NOV}
15235 file, but @emph{beware}: this will also cause @code{nnmaildir} to
15236 assign a new article number for this article, which may cause trouble
15237 with @code{seen} marks, the Agent, and the cache.
15238
15239 @subsubsection Article marks
15240 An article identified by @code{uniq} is considered to have the mark
15241 @code{flag} when the file @file{.nnmaildir/marks/flag/uniq} exists.
15242 When Gnus asks @code{nnmaildir} for a group's marks, @code{nnmaildir}
15243 looks for such files and reports the set of marks it finds. When Gnus
15244 asks @code{nnmaildir} to store a new set of marks, @code{nnmaildir}
15245 creates and deletes the corresponding files as needed. (Actually,
15246 rather than create a new file for each mark, it just creates hard
15247 links to @file{.nnmaildir/markfile}, to save inodes.)
15248
15249 You can invent new marks by creating a new directory in
15250 @file{.nnmaildir/marks/}. You can tar up a maildir and remove it from
15251 your server, untar it later, and keep your marks. You can add and
15252 remove marks yourself by creating and deleting mark files. If you do
15253 this while Gnus is running and your @code{nnmaildir} server is open,
15254 it's best to exit all summary buffers for @code{nnmaildir} groups and
15255 type @kbd{s} in the group buffer first, and to type @kbd{g} or
15256 @kbd{M-g} in the group buffer afterwards. Otherwise, Gnus might not
15257 pick up the changes, and might undo them.
15258
15259
15260 @node Mail Folders
15261 @subsubsection Mail Folders
15262 @cindex nnfolder
15263 @cindex mbox folders
15264 @cindex mail folders
15265
15266 @code{nnfolder} is a back end for storing each mail group in a
15267 separate file. Each file is in the standard Un*x mbox format.
15268 @code{nnfolder} will add extra headers to keep track of article
15269 numbers and arrival dates.
15270
15271 @cindex self contained nnfolder servers
15272 @cindex marks
15273 When the marks file is used (which it is by default), @code{nnfolder}
15274 servers have the property that you may backup them using @code{tar} or
15275 similar, and later be able to restore them into Gnus (by adding the
15276 proper @code{nnfolder} server) and have all your marks be preserved.
15277 Marks for a group is usually stored in a file named as the mbox file
15278 with @code{.mrk} concatenated to it (but see
15279 @code{nnfolder-marks-file-suffix}) within the @code{nnfolder}
15280 directory. Individual @code{nnfolder} groups are also possible to
15281 backup, use @kbd{G m} to restore the group (after restoring the backup
15282 into the @code{nnfolder} directory).
15283
15284 Virtual server settings:
15285
15286 @table @code
15287 @item nnfolder-directory
15288 @vindex nnfolder-directory
15289 All the @code{nnfolder} mail boxes will be stored under this
15290 directory. The default is the value of @code{message-directory}
15291 (whose default is @file{~/Mail})
15292
15293 @item nnfolder-active-file
15294 @vindex nnfolder-active-file
15295 The name of the active file. The default is @file{~/Mail/active}.
15296
15297 @item nnfolder-newsgroups-file
15298 @vindex nnfolder-newsgroups-file
15299 The name of the group descriptions file. @xref{Newsgroups File
15300 Format}. The default is @file{~/Mail/newsgroups}
15301
15302 @item nnfolder-get-new-mail
15303 @vindex nnfolder-get-new-mail
15304 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnfolder} will read incoming mail. The
15305 default is @code{t}
15306
15307 @item nnfolder-save-buffer-hook
15308 @vindex nnfolder-save-buffer-hook
15309 @cindex backup files
15310 Hook run before saving the folders. Note that Emacs does the normal
15311 backup renaming of files even with the @code{nnfolder} buffers. If
15312 you wish to switch this off, you could say something like the
15313 following in your @file{.emacs} file:
15314
15315 @lisp
15316 (defun turn-off-backup ()
15317 (set (make-local-variable 'backup-inhibited) t))
15318
15319 (add-hook 'nnfolder-save-buffer-hook 'turn-off-backup)
15320 @end lisp
15321
15322 @item nnfolder-delete-mail-hook
15323 @vindex nnfolder-delete-mail-hook
15324 Hook run in a buffer narrowed to the message that is to be deleted.
15325 This function can be used to copy the message to somewhere else, or to
15326 extract some information from it before removing it.
15327
15328 @item nnfolder-nov-is-evil
15329 @vindex nnfolder-nov-is-evil
15330 If non-@code{nil}, this back end will ignore any @acronym{NOV} files. The
15331 default is @code{nil}.
15332
15333 @item nnfolder-nov-file-suffix
15334 @vindex nnfolder-nov-file-suffix
15335 The extension for @acronym{NOV} files. The default is @file{.nov}.
15336
15337 @item nnfolder-nov-directory
15338 @vindex nnfolder-nov-directory
15339 The directory where the @acronym{NOV} files should be stored. If
15340 @code{nil}, @code{nnfolder-directory} is used.
15341
15342 @item nnfolder-marks-is-evil
15343 @vindex nnfolder-marks-is-evil
15344 If non-@code{nil}, this back end will ignore any @sc{marks} files. The
15345 default is @code{nil}.
15346
15347 @item nnfolder-marks-file-suffix
15348 @vindex nnfolder-marks-file-suffix
15349 The extension for @sc{marks} files. The default is @file{.mrk}.
15350
15351 @item nnfolder-marks-directory
15352 @vindex nnfolder-marks-directory
15353 The directory where the @sc{marks} files should be stored. If
15354 @code{nil}, @code{nnfolder-directory} is used.
15355
15356 @end table
15357
15358
15359 @findex nnfolder-generate-active-file
15360 @kindex M-x nnfolder-generate-active-file
15361 If you have lots of @code{nnfolder}-like files you'd like to read with
15362 @code{nnfolder}, you can use the @kbd{M-x nnfolder-generate-active-file}
15363 command to make @code{nnfolder} aware of all likely files in
15364 @code{nnfolder-directory}. This only works if you use long file names,
15365 though.
15366
15367 @node Comparing Mail Back Ends
15368 @subsubsection Comparing Mail Back Ends
15369
15370 First, just for terminology, the @dfn{back end} is the common word for a
15371 low-level access method---a transport, if you will, by which something
15372 is acquired. The sense is that one's mail has to come from somewhere,
15373 and so selection of a suitable back end is required in order to get that
15374 mail within spitting distance of Gnus.
15375
15376 The same concept exists for Usenet itself: Though access to articles is
15377 typically done by @acronym{NNTP} these days, once upon a midnight dreary, everyone
15378 in the world got at Usenet by running a reader on the machine where the
15379 articles lay (the machine which today we call an @acronym{NNTP} server), and
15380 access was by the reader stepping into the articles' directory spool
15381 area directly. One can still select between either the @code{nntp} or
15382 @code{nnspool} back ends, to select between these methods, if one happens
15383 actually to live on the server (or can see its spool directly, anyway,
15384 via NFS).
15385
15386 The goal in selecting a mail back end is to pick one which
15387 simultaneously represents a suitable way of dealing with the original
15388 format plus leaving mail in a form that is convenient to use in the
15389 future. Here are some high and low points on each:
15390
15391 @table @code
15392 @item nnmbox
15393
15394 UNIX systems have historically had a single, very common, and well-
15395 defined format. All messages arrive in a single @dfn{spool file}, and
15396 they are delineated by a line whose regular expression matches
15397 @samp{^From_}. (My notational use of @samp{_} is to indicate a space,
15398 to make it clear in this instance that this is not the RFC-specified
15399 @samp{From:} header.) Because Emacs and therefore Gnus emanate
15400 historically from the Unix environment, it is simplest if one does not
15401 mess a great deal with the original mailbox format, so if one chooses
15402 this back end, Gnus' primary activity in getting mail from the real spool
15403 area to Gnus' preferred directory is simply to copy it, with no
15404 (appreciable) format change in the process. It is the ``dumbest'' way
15405 to move mail into availability in the Gnus environment. This makes it
15406 fast to move into place, but slow to parse, when Gnus has to look at
15407 what's where.
15408
15409 @item nnbabyl
15410
15411 Once upon a time, there was the DEC-10 and DEC-20, running operating
15412 systems called TOPS and related things, and the usual (only?) mail
15413 reading environment was a thing called Babyl. I don't know what format
15414 was used for mail landing on the system, but Babyl had its own internal
15415 format to which mail was converted, primarily involving creating a
15416 spool-file-like entity with a scheme for inserting Babyl-specific
15417 headers and status bits above the top of each message in the file.
15418 Rmail was Emacs' first mail reader, it was written by Richard Stallman,
15419 and Stallman came out of that TOPS/Babyl environment, so he wrote Rmail
15420 to understand the mail files folks already had in existence. Gnus (and
15421 VM, for that matter) continue to support this format because it's
15422 perceived as having some good qualities in those mailer-specific
15423 headers/status bits stuff. Rmail itself still exists as well, of
15424 course, and is still maintained by Stallman.
15425
15426 Both of the above forms leave your mail in a single file on your
15427 file system, and they must parse that entire file each time you take a
15428 look at your mail.
15429
15430 @item nnml
15431
15432 @code{nnml} is the back end which smells the most as though you were
15433 actually operating with an @code{nnspool}-accessed Usenet system. (In
15434 fact, I believe @code{nnml} actually derived from @code{nnspool} code,
15435 lo these years ago.) One's mail is taken from the original spool file,
15436 and is then cut up into individual message files, 1:1. It maintains a
15437 Usenet-style active file (analogous to what one finds in an INN- or
15438 CNews-based news system in (for instance) @file{/var/lib/news/active},
15439 or what is returned via the @samp{NNTP LIST} verb) and also creates
15440 @dfn{overview} files for efficient group entry, as has been defined for
15441 @acronym{NNTP} servers for some years now. It is slower in mail-splitting,
15442 due to the creation of lots of files, updates to the @code{nnml} active
15443 file, and additions to overview files on a per-message basis, but it is
15444 extremely fast on access because of what amounts to the indexing support
15445 provided by the active file and overviews.
15446
15447 @code{nnml} costs @dfn{inodes} in a big way; that is, it soaks up the
15448 resource which defines available places in the file system to put new
15449 files. Sysadmins take a dim view of heavy inode occupation within
15450 tight, shared file systems. But if you live on a personal machine where
15451 the file system is your own and space is not at a premium, @code{nnml}
15452 wins big.
15453
15454 It is also problematic using this back end if you are living in a
15455 FAT16-based Windows world, since much space will be wasted on all these
15456 tiny files.
15457
15458 @item nnmh
15459
15460 The Rand MH mail-reading system has been around UNIX systems for a very
15461 long time; it operates by splitting one's spool file of messages into
15462 individual files, but with little or no indexing support---@code{nnmh}
15463 is considered to be semantically equivalent to ``@code{nnml} without
15464 active file or overviews''. This is arguably the worst choice, because
15465 one gets the slowness of individual file creation married to the
15466 slowness of access parsing when learning what's new in one's groups.
15467
15468 @item nnfolder
15469
15470 Basically the effect of @code{nnfolder} is @code{nnmbox} (the first
15471 method described above) on a per-group basis. That is, @code{nnmbox}
15472 itself puts @emph{all} one's mail in one file; @code{nnfolder} provides a
15473 little bit of optimization to this so that each of one's mail groups has
15474 a Unix mail box file. It's faster than @code{nnmbox} because each group
15475 can be parsed separately, and still provides the simple Unix mail box
15476 format requiring minimal effort in moving the mail around. In addition,
15477 it maintains an ``active'' file making it much faster for Gnus to figure
15478 out how many messages there are in each separate group.
15479
15480 If you have groups that are expected to have a massive amount of
15481 messages, @code{nnfolder} is not the best choice, but if you receive
15482 only a moderate amount of mail, @code{nnfolder} is probably the most
15483 friendly mail back end all over.
15484
15485 @item nnmaildir
15486
15487 For configuring expiry and other things, @code{nnmaildir} uses
15488 incompatible group parameters, slightly different from those of other
15489 mail back ends.
15490
15491 @code{nnmaildir} is largely similar to @code{nnml}, with some notable
15492 differences. Each message is stored in a separate file, but the
15493 filename is unrelated to the article number in Gnus. @code{nnmaildir}
15494 also stores the equivalent of @code{nnml}'s overview files in one file
15495 per article, so it uses about twice as many inodes as @code{nnml}. (Use
15496 @code{df -i} to see how plentiful your inode supply is.) If this slows
15497 you down or takes up very much space, consider switching to
15498 @uref{http://www.namesys.com/, ReiserFS} or another non-block-structured
15499 file system.
15500
15501 Since maildirs don't require locking for delivery, the maildirs you use
15502 as groups can also be the maildirs your mail is directly delivered to.
15503 This means you can skip Gnus' mail splitting if your mail is already
15504 organized into different mailboxes during delivery. A @code{directory}
15505 entry in @code{mail-sources} would have a similar effect, but would
15506 require one set of mailboxes for spooling deliveries (in mbox format,
15507 thus damaging message bodies), and another set to be used as groups (in
15508 whatever format you like). A maildir has a built-in spool, in the
15509 @code{new/} subdirectory. Beware that currently, mail moved from
15510 @code{new/} to @code{cur/} instead of via mail splitting will not
15511 undergo treatment such as duplicate checking.
15512
15513 @code{nnmaildir} stores article marks for a given group in the
15514 corresponding maildir, in a way designed so that it's easy to manipulate
15515 them from outside Gnus. You can tar up a maildir, unpack it somewhere
15516 else, and still have your marks. @code{nnml} also stores marks, but
15517 it's not as easy to work with them from outside Gnus as with
15518 @code{nnmaildir}.
15519
15520 @code{nnmaildir} uses a significant amount of memory to speed things up.
15521 (It keeps in memory some of the things that @code{nnml} stores in files
15522 and that @code{nnmh} repeatedly parses out of message files.) If this
15523 is a problem for you, you can set the @code{nov-cache-size} group
15524 parameter to something small (0 would probably not work, but 1 probably
15525 would) to make it use less memory. This caching will probably be
15526 removed in the future.
15527
15528 Startup is likely to be slower with @code{nnmaildir} than with other
15529 back ends. Everything else is likely to be faster, depending in part
15530 on your file system.
15531
15532 @code{nnmaildir} does not use @code{nnoo}, so you cannot use @code{nnoo}
15533 to write an @code{nnmaildir}-derived back end.
15534
15535 @end table
15536
15537
15538 @node Browsing the Web
15539 @section Browsing the Web
15540 @cindex web
15541 @cindex browsing the web
15542 @cindex www
15543 @cindex http
15544
15545 Web-based discussion forums are getting more and more popular. On many
15546 subjects, the web-based forums have become the most important forums,
15547 eclipsing the importance of mailing lists and news groups. The reason
15548 is easy to understand---they are friendly to new users; you just point
15549 and click, and there's the discussion. With mailing lists, you have to
15550 go through a cumbersome subscription procedure, and most people don't
15551 even know what a news group is.
15552
15553 The problem with this scenario is that web browsers are not very good at
15554 being newsreaders. They do not keep track of what articles you've read;
15555 they do not allow you to score on subjects you're interested in; they do
15556 not allow off-line browsing; they require you to click around and drive
15557 you mad in the end.
15558
15559 So---if web browsers suck at reading discussion forums, why not use Gnus
15560 to do it instead?
15561
15562 Gnus has been getting a bit of a collection of back ends for providing
15563 interfaces to these sources.
15564
15565 @menu
15566 * Archiving Mail::
15567 * Web Searches:: Creating groups from articles that match a string.
15568 * Slashdot:: Reading the Slashdot comments.
15569 * Ultimate:: The Ultimate Bulletin Board systems.
15570 * Web Archive:: Reading mailing list archived on web.
15571 * RSS:: Reading RDF site summary.
15572 * Customizing w3:: Doing stuff to Emacs/w3 from Gnus.
15573 @end menu
15574
15575 All the web sources require Emacs/w3 and the url library to work.
15576
15577 The main caveat with all these web sources is that they probably won't
15578 work for a very long time. Gleaning information from the @acronym{HTML} data
15579 is guesswork at best, and when the layout is altered, the Gnus back end
15580 will fail. If you have reasonably new versions of these back ends,
15581 though, you should be ok.
15582
15583 One thing all these Web methods have in common is that the Web sources
15584 are often down, unavailable or just plain too slow to be fun. In those
15585 cases, it makes a lot of sense to let the Gnus Agent (@pxref{Gnus
15586 Unplugged}) handle downloading articles, and then you can read them at
15587 leisure from your local disk. No more World Wide Wait for you.
15588
15589 @node Archiving Mail
15590 @subsection Archiving Mail
15591 @cindex archiving mail
15592 @cindex backup of mail
15593
15594 Some of the back ends, notably @code{nnml}, @code{nnfolder}, and
15595 @code{nnmaildir}, now actually store the article marks with each group.
15596 For these servers, archiving and restoring a group while preserving
15597 marks is fairly simple.
15598
15599 (Preserving the group level and group parameters as well still
15600 requires ritual dancing and sacrifices to the @file{.newsrc.eld} deity
15601 though.)
15602
15603 To archive an entire @code{nnml}, @code{nnfolder}, or @code{nnmaildir}
15604 server, take a recursive copy of the server directory. There is no need
15605 to shut down Gnus, so archiving may be invoked by @code{cron} or
15606 similar. You restore the data by restoring the directory tree, and
15607 adding a server definition pointing to that directory in Gnus. The
15608 @ref{Article Backlog}, @ref{Asynchronous Fetching} and other things
15609 might interfere with overwriting data, so you may want to shut down Gnus
15610 before you restore the data.
15611
15612 It is also possible to archive individual @code{nnml},
15613 @code{nnfolder}, or @code{nnmaildir} groups, while preserving marks.
15614 For @code{nnml} or @code{nnmaildir}, you copy all files in the group's
15615 directory. For @code{nnfolder} you need to copy both the base folder
15616 file itself (@file{FOO}, say), and the marks file (@file{FOO.mrk} in
15617 this example). Restoring the group is done with @kbd{G m} from the Group
15618 buffer. The last step makes Gnus notice the new directory.
15619 @code{nnmaildir} notices the new directory automatically, so @kbd{G m}
15620 is unnecessary in that case.
15621
15622 @node Web Searches
15623 @subsection Web Searches
15624 @cindex nnweb
15625 @cindex Google
15626 @cindex dejanews
15627 @cindex gmane
15628 @cindex Usenet searches
15629 @cindex searching the Usenet
15630
15631 It's, like, too neat to search the Usenet for articles that match a
15632 string, but it, like, totally @emph{sucks}, like, totally, to use one of
15633 those, like, Web browsers, and you, like, have to, rilly, like, look at
15634 the commercials, so, like, with Gnus you can do @emph{rad}, rilly,
15635 searches without having to use a browser.
15636
15637 The @code{nnweb} back end allows an easy interface to the mighty search
15638 engine. You create an @code{nnweb} group, enter a search pattern, and
15639 then enter the group and read the articles like you would any normal
15640 group. The @kbd{G w} command in the group buffer (@pxref{Foreign
15641 Groups}) will do this in an easy-to-use fashion.
15642
15643 @code{nnweb} groups don't really lend themselves to being solid
15644 groups---they have a very fleeting idea of article numbers. In fact,
15645 each time you enter an @code{nnweb} group (not even changing the search
15646 pattern), you are likely to get the articles ordered in a different
15647 manner. Not even using duplicate suppression (@pxref{Duplicate
15648 Suppression}) will help, since @code{nnweb} doesn't even know the
15649 @code{Message-ID} of the articles before reading them using some search
15650 engines (Google, for instance). The only possible way to keep track
15651 of which articles you've read is by scoring on the @code{Date}
15652 header---mark all articles posted before the last date you read the
15653 group as read.
15654
15655 If the search engine changes its output substantially, @code{nnweb}
15656 won't be able to parse it and will fail. One could hardly fault the Web
15657 providers if they were to do this---their @emph{raison d'être} is to
15658 make money off of advertisements, not to provide services to the
15659 community. Since @code{nnweb} washes the ads off all the articles, one
15660 might think that the providers might be somewhat miffed. We'll see.
15661
15662 You must have the @code{url} and @code{w3} package installed to be able
15663 to use @code{nnweb}.
15664
15665 Virtual server variables:
15666
15667 @table @code
15668 @item nnweb-type
15669 @vindex nnweb-type
15670 What search engine type is being used. The currently supported types
15671 are @code{google}, @code{dejanews}, and @code{gmane}. Note that
15672 @code{dejanews} is an alias to @code{google}.
15673
15674 @item nnweb-search
15675 @vindex nnweb-search
15676 The search string to feed to the search engine.
15677
15678 @item nnweb-max-hits
15679 @vindex nnweb-max-hits
15680 Advisory maximum number of hits per search to display. The default is
15681 999.
15682
15683 @item nnweb-type-definition
15684 @vindex nnweb-type-definition
15685 Type-to-definition alist. This alist says what @code{nnweb} should do
15686 with the various search engine types. The following elements must be
15687 present:
15688
15689 @table @code
15690 @item article
15691 Function to decode the article and provide something that Gnus
15692 understands.
15693
15694 @item map
15695 Function to create an article number to message header and URL alist.
15696
15697 @item search
15698 Function to send the search string to the search engine.
15699
15700 @item address
15701 The address the aforementioned function should send the search string
15702 to.
15703
15704 @item id
15705 Format string URL to fetch an article by @code{Message-ID}.
15706 @end table
15707
15708 @end table
15709
15710
15711 @node Slashdot
15712 @subsection Slashdot
15713 @cindex Slashdot
15714 @cindex nnslashdot
15715
15716 @uref{http://slashdot.org/, Slashdot} is a popular news site, with
15717 lively discussion following the news articles. @code{nnslashdot} will
15718 let you read this forum in a convenient manner.
15719
15720 The easiest way to read this source is to put something like the
15721 following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
15722
15723 @lisp
15724 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods
15725 '((nnslashdot "")))
15726 @end lisp
15727
15728 This will make Gnus query the @code{nnslashdot} back end for new comments
15729 and groups. The @kbd{F} command will subscribe each new news article as
15730 a new Gnus group, and you can read the comments by entering these
15731 groups. (Note that the default subscription method is to subscribe new
15732 groups as zombies. Other methods are available (@pxref{Subscription
15733 Methods}).
15734
15735 If you want to remove an old @code{nnslashdot} group, the @kbd{G DEL}
15736 command is the most handy tool (@pxref{Foreign Groups}).
15737
15738 When following up to @code{nnslashdot} comments (or posting new
15739 comments), some light @acronym{HTML}izations will be performed. In
15740 particular, text quoted with @samp{> } will be quoted with
15741 @samp{blockquote} instead, and signatures will have @samp{br} added to
15742 the end of each line. Other than that, you can just write @acronym{HTML}
15743 directly into the message buffer. Note that Slashdot filters out some
15744 @acronym{HTML} forms.
15745
15746 The following variables can be altered to change its behavior:
15747
15748 @table @code
15749 @item nnslashdot-threaded
15750 Whether @code{nnslashdot} should display threaded groups or not. The
15751 default is @code{t}. To be able to display threads, @code{nnslashdot}
15752 has to retrieve absolutely all comments in a group upon entry. If a
15753 threaded display is not required, @code{nnslashdot} will only retrieve
15754 the comments that are actually wanted by the user. Threading is nicer,
15755 but much, much slower than unthreaded.
15756
15757 @item nnslashdot-login-name
15758 @vindex nnslashdot-login-name
15759 The login name to use when posting.
15760
15761 @item nnslashdot-password
15762 @vindex nnslashdot-password
15763 The password to use when posting.
15764
15765 @item nnslashdot-directory
15766 @vindex nnslashdot-directory
15767 Where @code{nnslashdot} will store its files. The default is
15768 @file{~/News/slashdot/}.
15769
15770 @item nnslashdot-active-url
15771 @vindex nnslashdot-active-url
15772 The @acronym{URL} format string that will be used to fetch the
15773 information on news articles and comments. The default is@*
15774 @samp{http://slashdot.org/search.pl?section=&min=%d}.
15775
15776 @item nnslashdot-comments-url
15777 @vindex nnslashdot-comments-url
15778 The @acronym{URL} format string that will be used to fetch comments.
15779
15780 @item nnslashdot-article-url
15781 @vindex nnslashdot-article-url
15782 The @acronym{URL} format string that will be used to fetch the news
15783 article. The default is
15784 @samp{http://slashdot.org/article.pl?sid=%s&mode=nocomment}.
15785
15786 @item nnslashdot-threshold
15787 @vindex nnslashdot-threshold
15788 The score threshold. The default is -1.
15789
15790 @item nnslashdot-group-number
15791 @vindex nnslashdot-group-number
15792 The number of old groups, in addition to the ten latest, to keep
15793 updated. The default is 0.
15794
15795 @end table
15796
15797
15798
15799 @node Ultimate
15800 @subsection Ultimate
15801 @cindex nnultimate
15802 @cindex Ultimate Bulletin Board
15803
15804 @uref{http://www.ultimatebb.com/, The Ultimate Bulletin Board} is
15805 probably the most popular Web bulletin board system used. It has a
15806 quite regular and nice interface, and it's possible to get the
15807 information Gnus needs to keep groups updated.
15808
15809 The easiest way to get started with @code{nnultimate} is to say
15810 something like the following in the group buffer: @kbd{B nnultimate RET
15811 http://www.tcj.com/messboard/ubbcgi/ RET}. (Substitute the @acronym{URL}
15812 (not including @samp{Ultimate.cgi} or the like at the end) for a forum
15813 you're interested in; there's quite a list of them on the Ultimate web
15814 site.) Then subscribe to the groups you're interested in from the
15815 server buffer, and read them from the group buffer.
15816
15817 The following @code{nnultimate} variables can be altered:
15818
15819 @table @code
15820 @item nnultimate-directory
15821 @vindex nnultimate-directory
15822 The directory where @code{nnultimate} stores its files. The default is@*
15823 @file{~/News/ultimate/}.
15824 @end table
15825
15826
15827 @node Web Archive
15828 @subsection Web Archive
15829 @cindex nnwarchive
15830 @cindex Web Archive
15831
15832 Some mailing lists only have archives on Web servers, such as
15833 @uref{http://www.egroups.com/} and
15834 @uref{http://www.mail-archive.com/}. It has a quite regular and nice
15835 interface, and it's possible to get the information Gnus needs to keep
15836 groups updated.
15837
15838 @findex gnus-group-make-warchive-group
15839 The easiest way to get started with @code{nnwarchive} is to say
15840 something like the following in the group buffer: @kbd{M-x
15841 gnus-group-make-warchive-group RET @var{an_egroup} RET egroups RET
15842 www.egroups.com RET @var{your@@email.address} RET}. (Substitute the
15843 @var{an_egroup} with the mailing list you subscribed, the
15844 @var{your@@email.address} with your email address.), or to browse the
15845 back end by @kbd{B nnwarchive RET mail-archive RET}.
15846
15847 The following @code{nnwarchive} variables can be altered:
15848
15849 @table @code
15850 @item nnwarchive-directory
15851 @vindex nnwarchive-directory
15852 The directory where @code{nnwarchive} stores its files. The default is@*
15853 @file{~/News/warchive/}.
15854
15855 @item nnwarchive-login
15856 @vindex nnwarchive-login
15857 The account name on the web server.
15858
15859 @item nnwarchive-passwd
15860 @vindex nnwarchive-passwd
15861 The password for your account on the web server.
15862 @end table
15863
15864 @node RSS
15865 @subsection RSS
15866 @cindex nnrss
15867 @cindex RSS
15868
15869 Some web sites have an RDF Site Summary (@acronym{RSS}).
15870 @acronym{RSS} is a format for summarizing headlines from news related
15871 sites (such as BBC or CNN). But basically anything list-like can be
15872 presented as an @acronym{RSS} feed: weblogs, changelogs or recent
15873 changes to a wiki (e.g. @url{http://cliki.net/recent-changes.rdf}).
15874
15875 @acronym{RSS} has a quite regular and nice interface, and it's
15876 possible to get the information Gnus needs to keep groups updated.
15877
15878 Note: you had better use Emacs which supports the @code{utf-8} coding
15879 system because @acronym{RSS} uses UTF-8 for encoding non-@acronym{ASCII}
15880 text by default. It is also used by default for non-@acronym{ASCII}
15881 group names.
15882
15883 @kindex G R (Summary)
15884 Use @kbd{G R} from the summary buffer to subscribe to a feed---you will
15885 be prompted for the location, the title and the description of the feed.
15886 The title, which allows any characters, will be used for the group name
15887 and the name of the group data file. The description can be omitted.
15888
15889 An easy way to get started with @code{nnrss} is to say something like
15890 the following in the group buffer: @kbd{B nnrss RET RET y}, then
15891 subscribe to groups.
15892
15893 The @code{nnrss} back end saves the group data file in
15894 @code{nnrss-directory} (see below) for each @code{nnrss} group. File
15895 names containing non-@acronym{ASCII} characters will be encoded by the
15896 coding system specified with the @code{nnmail-pathname-coding-system}
15897 variable. If it is @code{nil}, in Emacs the coding system defaults to
15898 the value of @code{default-file-name-coding-system}. If you are using
15899 XEmacs and want to use non-@acronym{ASCII} group names, you should set
15900 the value for the @code{nnmail-pathname-coding-system} variable properly.
15901
15902 @cindex OPML
15903 You can also use the following commands to import and export your
15904 subscriptions from a file in @acronym{OPML} format (Outline Processor
15905 Markup Language).
15906
15907 @defun nnrss-opml-import file
15908 Prompt for an @acronym{OPML} file, and subscribe to each feed in the
15909 file.
15910 @end defun
15911
15912 @defun nnrss-opml-export
15913 Write your current @acronym{RSS} subscriptions to a buffer in
15914 @acronym{OPML} format.
15915 @end defun
15916
15917 The following @code{nnrss} variables can be altered:
15918
15919 @table @code
15920 @item nnrss-directory
15921 @vindex nnrss-directory
15922 The directory where @code{nnrss} stores its files. The default is
15923 @file{~/News/rss/}.
15924
15925 @item nnrss-file-coding-system
15926 @vindex nnrss-file-coding-system
15927 The coding system used when reading and writing the @code{nnrss} groups
15928 data files. The default is the value of
15929 @code{mm-universal-coding-system} (which defaults to @code{emacs-mule}
15930 in Emacs or @code{escape-quoted} in XEmacs).
15931
15932 @item nnrss-use-local
15933 @vindex nnrss-use-local
15934 @findex nnrss-generate-download-script
15935 If you set @code{nnrss-use-local} to @code{t}, @code{nnrss} will read
15936 the feeds from local files in @code{nnrss-directory}. You can use
15937 the command @code{nnrss-generate-download-script} to generate a
15938 download script using @command{wget}.
15939 @end table
15940
15941 The following code may be helpful, if you want to show the description in
15942 the summary buffer.
15943
15944 @lisp
15945 (add-to-list 'nnmail-extra-headers nnrss-description-field)
15946 (setq gnus-summary-line-format "%U%R%z%I%(%[%4L: %-15,15f%]%) %s%uX\n")
15947
15948 (defun gnus-user-format-function-X (header)
15949 (let ((descr
15950 (assq nnrss-description-field (mail-header-extra header))))
15951 (if descr (concat "\n\t" (cdr descr)) "")))
15952 @end lisp
15953
15954 The following code may be useful to open an nnrss url directly from the
15955 summary buffer.
15956 @lisp
15957 (require 'browse-url)
15958
15959 (defun browse-nnrss-url( arg )
15960 (interactive "p")
15961 (let ((url (assq nnrss-url-field
15962 (mail-header-extra
15963 (gnus-data-header
15964 (assq (gnus-summary-article-number)
15965 gnus-newsgroup-data))))))
15966 (if url
15967 (progn
15968 (browse-url (cdr url))
15969 (gnus-summary-mark-as-read-forward 1))
15970 (gnus-summary-scroll-up arg))))
15971
15972 (eval-after-load "gnus"
15973 #'(define-key gnus-summary-mode-map
15974 (kbd "<RET>") 'browse-nnrss-url))
15975 (add-to-list 'nnmail-extra-headers nnrss-url-field)
15976 @end lisp
15977
15978 @node Customizing w3
15979 @subsection Customizing w3
15980 @cindex w3
15981 @cindex html
15982 @cindex url
15983 @cindex Netscape
15984
15985 Gnus uses the url library to fetch web pages and Emacs/w3 to display web
15986 pages. Emacs/w3 is documented in its own manual, but there are some
15987 things that may be more relevant for Gnus users.
15988
15989 For instance, a common question is how to make Emacs/w3 follow links
15990 using the @code{browse-url} functions (which will call some external web
15991 browser like Netscape). Here's one way:
15992
15993 @lisp
15994 (eval-after-load "w3"
15995 '(progn
15996 (fset 'w3-fetch-orig (symbol-function 'w3-fetch))
15997 (defun w3-fetch (&optional url target)
15998 (interactive (list (w3-read-url-with-default)))
15999 (if (eq major-mode 'gnus-article-mode)
16000 (browse-url url)
16001 (w3-fetch-orig url target)))))
16002 @end lisp
16003
16004 Put that in your @file{.emacs} file, and hitting links in w3-rendered
16005 @acronym{HTML} in the Gnus article buffers will use @code{browse-url} to
16006 follow the link.
16007
16008
16009 @node IMAP
16010 @section IMAP
16011 @cindex nnimap
16012 @cindex @acronym{IMAP}
16013
16014 @acronym{IMAP} is a network protocol for reading mail (or news, or @dots{}),
16015 think of it as a modernized @acronym{NNTP}. Connecting to a @acronym{IMAP}
16016 server is much similar to connecting to a news server, you just
16017 specify the network address of the server.
16018
16019 @acronym{IMAP} has two properties. First, @acronym{IMAP} can do
16020 everything that @acronym{POP} can, it can hence be viewed as a
16021 @acronym{POP++}. Secondly, @acronym{IMAP} is a mail storage protocol,
16022 similar to @acronym{NNTP} being a news storage protocol---however,
16023 @acronym{IMAP} offers more features than @acronym{NNTP} because news
16024 is more or less read-only whereas mail is read-write.
16025
16026 If you want to use @acronym{IMAP} as a @acronym{POP++}, use an imap
16027 entry in @code{mail-sources}. With this, Gnus will fetch mails from
16028 the @acronym{IMAP} server and store them on the local disk. This is
16029 not the usage described in this section---@xref{Mail Sources}.
16030
16031 If you want to use @acronym{IMAP} as a mail storage protocol, use an nnimap
16032 entry in @code{gnus-secondary-select-methods}. With this, Gnus will
16033 manipulate mails stored on the @acronym{IMAP} server. This is the kind of
16034 usage explained in this section.
16035
16036 A server configuration in @file{~/.gnus.el} with a few @acronym{IMAP}
16037 servers might look something like the following. (Note that for
16038 @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL}, you need external programs and libraries,
16039 see below.)
16040
16041 @lisp
16042 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods
16043 '((nnimap "simpleserver") ; @r{no special configuration}
16044 ; @r{perhaps a ssh port forwarded server:}
16045 (nnimap "dolk"
16046 (nnimap-address "localhost")
16047 (nnimap-server-port 1430))
16048 ; @r{a UW server running on localhost}
16049 (nnimap "barbar"
16050 (nnimap-server-port 143)
16051 (nnimap-address "localhost")
16052 (nnimap-list-pattern ("INBOX" "mail/*")))
16053 ; @r{anonymous public cyrus server:}
16054 (nnimap "cyrus.andrew.cmu.edu"
16055 (nnimap-authenticator anonymous)
16056 (nnimap-list-pattern "archive.*")
16057 (nnimap-stream network))
16058 ; @r{a ssl server on a non-standard port:}
16059 (nnimap "vic20"
16060 (nnimap-address "vic20.somewhere.com")
16061 (nnimap-server-port 9930)
16062 (nnimap-stream ssl))))
16063 @end lisp
16064
16065 After defining the new server, you can subscribe to groups on the
16066 server using normal Gnus commands such as @kbd{U} in the Group Buffer
16067 (@pxref{Subscription Commands}) or via the Server Buffer
16068 (@pxref{Server Buffer}).
16069
16070 The following variables can be used to create a virtual @code{nnimap}
16071 server:
16072
16073 @table @code
16074
16075 @item nnimap-address
16076 @vindex nnimap-address
16077
16078 The address of the remote @acronym{IMAP} server. Defaults to the virtual
16079 server name if not specified.
16080
16081 @item nnimap-server-port
16082 @vindex nnimap-server-port
16083 Port on server to contact. Defaults to port 143, or 993 for @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL}.
16084
16085 Note that this should be an integer, example server specification:
16086
16087 @lisp
16088 (nnimap "mail.server.com"
16089 (nnimap-server-port 4711))
16090 @end lisp
16091
16092 @item nnimap-list-pattern
16093 @vindex nnimap-list-pattern
16094 String or list of strings of mailboxes to limit available groups to.
16095 This is used when the server has very many mailboxes and you're only
16096 interested in a few---some servers export your home directory via
16097 @acronym{IMAP}, you'll probably want to limit the mailboxes to those in
16098 @file{~/Mail/*} then.
16099
16100 The string can also be a cons of REFERENCE and the string as above, what
16101 REFERENCE is used for is server specific, but on the University of
16102 Washington server it's a directory that will be concatenated with the
16103 mailbox.
16104
16105 Example server specification:
16106
16107 @lisp
16108 (nnimap "mail.server.com"
16109 (nnimap-list-pattern ("INBOX" "Mail/*" "alt.sex.*"
16110 ("~friend/Mail/" . "list/*"))))
16111 @end lisp
16112
16113 @item nnimap-stream
16114 @vindex nnimap-stream
16115 The type of stream used to connect to your server. By default, nnimap
16116 will detect and automatically use all of the below, with the exception
16117 of @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL}. (@acronym{IMAP} over
16118 @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} is being replaced by STARTTLS, which can
16119 be automatically detected, but it's not widely deployed yet.)
16120
16121 Example server specification:
16122
16123 @lisp
16124 (nnimap "mail.server.com"
16125 (nnimap-stream ssl))
16126 @end lisp
16127
16128 Please note that the value of @code{nnimap-stream} is a symbol!
16129
16130 @itemize @bullet
16131 @item
16132 @dfn{gssapi:} Connect with GSSAPI (usually Kerberos 5). Requires the
16133 @samp{gsasl} or @samp{imtest} program.
16134 @item
16135 @dfn{kerberos4:} Connect with Kerberos 4. Requires the @samp{imtest} program.
16136 @item
16137 @dfn{starttls:} Connect via the STARTTLS extension (similar to
16138 @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL}). Requires the external library @samp{starttls.el} and program
16139 @samp{starttls}.
16140 @item
16141 @dfn{tls:} Connect through @acronym{TLS}. Requires GNUTLS (the program
16142 @samp{gnutls-cli}).
16143 @item
16144 @dfn{ssl:} Connect through @acronym{SSL}. Requires OpenSSL (the program
16145 @samp{openssl}) or SSLeay (@samp{s_client}).
16146 @item
16147 @dfn{shell:} Use a shell command to start @acronym{IMAP} connection.
16148 @item
16149 @dfn{network:} Plain, TCP/IP network connection.
16150 @end itemize
16151
16152 @vindex imap-kerberos4-program
16153 The @samp{imtest} program is shipped with Cyrus IMAPD. If you're
16154 using @samp{imtest} from Cyrus IMAPD < 2.0.14 (which includes version
16155 1.5.x and 1.6.x) you need to frob @code{imap-process-connection-type}
16156 to make @code{imap.el} use a pty instead of a pipe when communicating
16157 with @samp{imtest}. You will then suffer from a line length
16158 restrictions on @acronym{IMAP} commands, which might make Gnus seem to hang
16159 indefinitely if you have many articles in a mailbox. The variable
16160 @code{imap-kerberos4-program} contain parameters to pass to the imtest
16161 program.
16162
16163 For @acronym{TLS} connection, the @code{gnutls-cli} program from GNUTLS is
16164 needed. It is available from
16165 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gnutls/}.
16166
16167 @vindex imap-gssapi-program
16168 This parameter specifies a list of command lines that invoke a GSSAPI
16169 authenticated @acronym{IMAP} stream in a subshell. They are tried
16170 sequentially until a connection is made, or the list has been
16171 exhausted. By default, @samp{gsasl} from GNU SASL, available from
16172 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gsasl/}, and the @samp{imtest}
16173 program from Cyrus IMAPD (see @code{imap-kerberos4-program}), are
16174 tried.
16175
16176 @vindex imap-ssl-program
16177 For @acronym{SSL} connections, the OpenSSL program is available from
16178 @uref{http://www.openssl.org/}. OpenSSL was formerly known as SSLeay,
16179 and nnimap support it too---although the most recent versions of
16180 SSLeay, 0.9.x, are known to have serious bugs making it
16181 useless. Earlier versions, especially 0.8.x, of SSLeay are known to
16182 work. The variable @code{imap-ssl-program} contain parameters to pass
16183 to OpenSSL/SSLeay.
16184
16185 @vindex imap-shell-program
16186 @vindex imap-shell-host
16187 For @acronym{IMAP} connections using the @code{shell} stream, the variable
16188 @code{imap-shell-program} specify what program to call.
16189
16190 @item nnimap-authenticator
16191 @vindex nnimap-authenticator
16192
16193 The authenticator used to connect to the server. By default, nnimap
16194 will use the most secure authenticator your server is capable of.
16195
16196 Example server specification:
16197
16198 @lisp
16199 (nnimap "mail.server.com"
16200 (nnimap-authenticator anonymous))
16201 @end lisp
16202
16203 Please note that the value of @code{nnimap-authenticator} is a symbol!
16204
16205 @itemize @bullet
16206 @item
16207 @dfn{gssapi:} GSSAPI (usually kerberos 5) authentication. Requires
16208 external program @code{gsasl} or @code{imtest}.
16209 @item
16210 @dfn{kerberos4:} Kerberos 4 authentication. Requires external program
16211 @code{imtest}.
16212 @item
16213 @dfn{digest-md5:} Encrypted username/password via DIGEST-MD5. Requires
16214 external library @code{digest-md5.el}.
16215 @item
16216 @dfn{cram-md5:} Encrypted username/password via CRAM-MD5.
16217 @item
16218 @dfn{login:} Plain-text username/password via LOGIN.
16219 @item
16220 @dfn{anonymous:} Login as ``anonymous'', supplying your email address as password.
16221 @end itemize
16222
16223 @item nnimap-expunge-on-close
16224 @cindex expunging
16225 @vindex nnimap-expunge-on-close
16226 Unlike Parmenides the @acronym{IMAP} designers have decided things that
16227 don't exist actually do exist. More specifically, @acronym{IMAP} has
16228 this concept of marking articles @code{Deleted} which doesn't actually
16229 delete them, and this (marking them @code{Deleted}, that is) is what
16230 nnimap does when you delete an article in Gnus (with @kbd{B DEL} or
16231 similar).
16232
16233 Since the articles aren't really removed when we mark them with the
16234 @code{Deleted} flag we'll need a way to actually delete them. Feel like
16235 running in circles yet?
16236
16237 Traditionally, nnimap has removed all articles marked as @code{Deleted}
16238 when closing a mailbox but this is now configurable by this server
16239 variable.
16240
16241 The possible options are:
16242
16243 @table @code
16244
16245 @item always
16246 The default behavior, delete all articles marked as ``Deleted'' when
16247 closing a mailbox.
16248 @item never
16249 Never actually delete articles. Currently there is no way of showing
16250 the articles marked for deletion in nnimap, but other @acronym{IMAP} clients
16251 may allow you to do this. If you ever want to run the EXPUNGE command
16252 manually, @xref{Expunging mailboxes}.
16253 @item ask
16254 When closing mailboxes, nnimap will ask if you wish to expunge deleted
16255 articles or not.
16256
16257 @end table
16258
16259 @item nnimap-importantize-dormant
16260 @vindex nnimap-importantize-dormant
16261
16262 If non-@code{nil} (the default), marks dormant articles as ticked (as
16263 well), for other @acronym{IMAP} clients. Within Gnus, dormant articles will
16264 naturally still (only) be marked as dormant. This is to make dormant
16265 articles stand out, just like ticked articles, in other @acronym{IMAP}
16266 clients. (In other words, Gnus has two ``Tick'' marks and @acronym{IMAP}
16267 has only one.)
16268
16269 Probably the only reason for frobing this would be if you're trying
16270 enable per-user persistent dormant flags, using something like:
16271
16272 @lisp
16273 (setcdr (assq 'dormant nnimap-mark-to-flag-alist)
16274 (format "gnus-dormant-%s" (user-login-name)))
16275 (setcdr (assq 'dormant nnimap-mark-to-predicate-alist)
16276 (format "KEYWORD gnus-dormant-%s" (user-login-name)))
16277 @end lisp
16278
16279 In this case, you would not want the per-user dormant flag showing up
16280 as ticked for other users.
16281
16282 @item nnimap-expunge-search-string
16283 @cindex expunging
16284 @vindex nnimap-expunge-search-string
16285
16286 This variable contain the @acronym{IMAP} search command sent to server when
16287 searching for articles eligible for expiring. The default is
16288 @code{"UID %s NOT SINCE %s"}, where the first @code{%s} is replaced by
16289 UID set and the second @code{%s} is replaced by a date.
16290
16291 Probably the only useful value to change this to is
16292 @code{"UID %s NOT SENTSINCE %s"}, which makes nnimap use the Date: in
16293 messages instead of the internal article date. See section 6.4.4 of
16294 RFC 2060 for more information on valid strings.
16295
16296 @item nnimap-authinfo-file
16297 @vindex nnimap-authinfo-file
16298
16299 A file containing credentials used to log in on servers. The format is
16300 (almost) the same as the @code{ftp} @file{~/.netrc} file. See the
16301 variable @code{nntp-authinfo-file} for exact syntax; also see
16302 @ref{NNTP}. An example of an .authinfo line for an IMAP server, is:
16303
16304 @example
16305 machine students.uio.no login larsi password geheimnis port imap
16306 @end example
16307
16308 Note that it should be @code{port imap}, or @code{port 143}, if you
16309 use a @code{nnimap-stream} of @code{tls} or @code{ssl}, even if the
16310 actual port number used is port 993 for secured IMAP. For
16311 convenience, Gnus will accept @code{port imaps} as a synonym of
16312 @code{port imap}.
16313
16314 @item nnimap-need-unselect-to-notice-new-mail
16315 @vindex nnimap-need-unselect-to-notice-new-mail
16316
16317 Unselect mailboxes before looking for new mail in them. Some servers
16318 seem to need this under some circumstances; it was reported that
16319 Courier 1.7.1 did.
16320
16321 @end table
16322
16323 @menu
16324 * Splitting in IMAP:: Splitting mail with nnimap.
16325 * Expiring in IMAP:: Expiring mail with nnimap.
16326 * Editing IMAP ACLs:: Limiting/enabling other users access to a mailbox.
16327 * Expunging mailboxes:: Equivalent of a ``compress mailbox'' button.
16328 * A note on namespaces:: How to (not) use @acronym{IMAP} namespace in Gnus.
16329 * Debugging IMAP:: What to do when things don't work.
16330 @end menu
16331
16332
16333
16334 @node Splitting in IMAP
16335 @subsection Splitting in IMAP
16336 @cindex splitting imap mail
16337
16338 Splitting is something Gnus users have loved and used for years, and now
16339 the rest of the world is catching up. Yeah, dream on, not many
16340 @acronym{IMAP} servers have server side splitting and those that have
16341 splitting seem to use some non-standard protocol. This means that
16342 @acronym{IMAP} support for Gnus has to do its own splitting.
16343
16344 And it does.
16345
16346 (Incidentally, people seem to have been dreaming on, and Sieve has
16347 gaining a market share and is supported by several IMAP servers.
16348 Fortunately, Gnus support it too, @xref{Sieve Commands}.)
16349
16350 Here are the variables of interest:
16351
16352 @table @code
16353
16354 @item nnimap-split-crosspost
16355 @cindex splitting, crosspost
16356 @cindex crosspost
16357 @vindex nnimap-split-crosspost
16358
16359 If non-@code{nil}, do crossposting if several split methods match the
16360 mail. If @code{nil}, the first match in @code{nnimap-split-rule}
16361 found will be used.
16362
16363 Nnmail equivalent: @code{nnmail-crosspost}.
16364
16365 @item nnimap-split-inbox
16366 @cindex splitting, inbox
16367 @cindex inbox
16368 @vindex nnimap-split-inbox
16369
16370 A string or a list of strings that gives the name(s) of @acronym{IMAP}
16371 mailboxes to split from. Defaults to @code{nil}, which means that
16372 splitting is disabled!
16373
16374 @lisp
16375 (setq nnimap-split-inbox
16376 '("INBOX" ("~/friend/Mail" . "lists/*") "lists.imap"))
16377 @end lisp
16378
16379 No nnmail equivalent.
16380
16381 @item nnimap-split-rule
16382 @cindex splitting, rules
16383 @vindex nnimap-split-rule
16384
16385 New mail found in @code{nnimap-split-inbox} will be split according to
16386 this variable.
16387
16388 This variable contains a list of lists, where the first element in the
16389 sublist gives the name of the @acronym{IMAP} mailbox to move articles
16390 matching the regexp in the second element in the sublist. Got that?
16391 Neither did I, we need examples.
16392
16393 @lisp
16394 (setq nnimap-split-rule
16395 '(("INBOX.nnimap"
16396 "^Sender: owner-nnimap@@vic20.globalcom.se")
16397 ("INBOX.junk" "^Subject:.*MAKE MONEY")
16398 ("INBOX.private" "")))
16399 @end lisp
16400
16401 This will put all articles from the nnimap mailing list into mailbox
16402 INBOX.nnimap, all articles containing MAKE MONEY in the Subject: line
16403 into INBOX.junk and everything else in INBOX.private.
16404
16405 The first string may contain @samp{\\1} forms, like the ones used by
16406 replace-match to insert sub-expressions from the matched text. For
16407 instance:
16408
16409 @lisp
16410 ("INBOX.lists.\\1" "^Sender: owner-\\([a-z-]+\\)@@")
16411 @end lisp
16412
16413 The first element can also be the symbol @code{junk} to indicate that
16414 matching messages should simply be deleted. Use with care.
16415
16416 The second element can also be a function. In that case, it will be
16417 called with the first element of the rule as the argument, in a buffer
16418 containing the headers of the article. It should return a
16419 non-@code{nil} value if it thinks that the mail belongs in that group.
16420
16421 Nnmail users might recollect that the last regexp had to be empty to
16422 match all articles (like in the example above). This is not required in
16423 nnimap. Articles not matching any of the regexps will not be moved out
16424 of your inbox. (This might affect performance if you keep lots of
16425 unread articles in your inbox, since the splitting code would go over
16426 them every time you fetch new mail.)
16427
16428 These rules are processed from the beginning of the alist toward the
16429 end. The first rule to make a match will ``win'', unless you have
16430 crossposting enabled. In that case, all matching rules will ``win''.
16431
16432 This variable can also have a function as its value, the function will
16433 be called with the headers narrowed and should return a group where it
16434 thinks the article should be split to. See @code{nnimap-split-fancy}.
16435
16436 The splitting code tries to create mailboxes if it needs to.
16437
16438 To allow for different split rules on different virtual servers, and
16439 even different split rules in different inboxes on the same server,
16440 the syntax of this variable have been extended along the lines of:
16441
16442 @lisp
16443 (setq nnimap-split-rule
16444 '(("my1server" (".*" (("ding" "ding@@gnus.org")
16445 ("junk" "From:.*Simon"))))
16446 ("my2server" ("INBOX" nnimap-split-fancy))
16447 ("my[34]server" (".*" (("private" "To:.*Simon")
16448 ("junk" my-junk-func))))))
16449 @end lisp
16450
16451 The virtual server name is in fact a regexp, so that the same rules
16452 may apply to several servers. In the example, the servers
16453 @code{my3server} and @code{my4server} both use the same rules.
16454 Similarly, the inbox string is also a regexp. The actual splitting
16455 rules are as before, either a function, or a list with group/regexp or
16456 group/function elements.
16457
16458 Nnmail equivalent: @code{nnmail-split-methods}.
16459
16460 @item nnimap-split-predicate
16461 @cindex splitting
16462 @vindex nnimap-split-predicate
16463
16464 Mail matching this predicate in @code{nnimap-split-inbox} will be
16465 split, it is a string and the default is @samp{UNSEEN UNDELETED}.
16466
16467 This might be useful if you use another @acronym{IMAP} client to read mail in
16468 your inbox but would like Gnus to split all articles in the inbox
16469 regardless of readedness. Then you might change this to
16470 @samp{UNDELETED}.
16471
16472 @item nnimap-split-fancy
16473 @cindex splitting, fancy
16474 @findex nnimap-split-fancy
16475 @vindex nnimap-split-fancy
16476
16477 It's possible to set @code{nnimap-split-rule} to
16478 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} if you want to use fancy
16479 splitting. @xref{Fancy Mail Splitting}.
16480
16481 However, to be able to have different fancy split rules for nnmail and
16482 nnimap back ends you can set @code{nnimap-split-rule} to
16483 @code{nnimap-split-fancy} and define the nnimap specific fancy split
16484 rule in @code{nnimap-split-fancy}.
16485
16486 Example:
16487
16488 @lisp
16489 (setq nnimap-split-rule 'nnimap-split-fancy
16490 nnimap-split-fancy ...)
16491 @end lisp
16492
16493 Nnmail equivalent: @code{nnmail-split-fancy}.
16494
16495 @item nnimap-split-download-body
16496 @findex nnimap-split-download-body
16497 @vindex nnimap-split-download-body
16498
16499 Set to non-@code{nil} to download entire articles during splitting.
16500 This is generally not required, and will slow things down
16501 considerably. You may need it if you want to use an advanced
16502 splitting function that analyzes the body to split the article.
16503
16504 @end table
16505
16506 @node Expiring in IMAP
16507 @subsection Expiring in IMAP
16508 @cindex expiring imap mail
16509
16510 Even though @code{nnimap} is not a proper @code{nnmail} derived back
16511 end, it supports most features in regular expiring (@pxref{Expiring
16512 Mail}). Unlike splitting in @acronym{IMAP} (@pxref{Splitting in
16513 IMAP}) it does not clone the @code{nnmail} variables (i.e., creating
16514 @var{nnimap-expiry-wait}) but reuse the @code{nnmail} variables. What
16515 follows below are the variables used by the @code{nnimap} expiry
16516 process.
16517
16518 A note on how the expire mark is stored on the @acronym{IMAP} server is
16519 appropriate here as well. The expire mark is translated into a
16520 @code{imap} client specific mark, @code{gnus-expire}, and stored on the
16521 message. This means that likely only Gnus will understand and treat
16522 the @code{gnus-expire} mark properly, although other clients may allow
16523 you to view client specific flags on the message. It also means that
16524 your server must support permanent storage of client specific flags on
16525 messages. Most do, fortunately.
16526
16527 @table @code
16528
16529 @item nnmail-expiry-wait
16530 @item nnmail-expiry-wait-function
16531
16532 These variables are fully supported. The expire value can be a
16533 number, the symbol @code{immediate} or @code{never}.
16534
16535 @item nnmail-expiry-target
16536
16537 This variable is supported, and internally implemented by calling the
16538 @code{nnmail} functions that handle this. It contains an optimization
16539 that if the destination is a @acronym{IMAP} group on the same server, the
16540 article is copied instead of appended (that is, uploaded again).
16541
16542 @end table
16543
16544 @node Editing IMAP ACLs
16545 @subsection Editing IMAP ACLs
16546 @cindex editing imap acls
16547 @cindex Access Control Lists
16548 @cindex Editing @acronym{IMAP} ACLs
16549 @kindex G l (Group)
16550 @findex gnus-group-nnimap-edit-acl
16551
16552 ACL stands for Access Control List. ACLs are used in @acronym{IMAP} for
16553 limiting (or enabling) other users access to your mail boxes. Not all
16554 @acronym{IMAP} servers support this, this function will give an error if it
16555 doesn't.
16556
16557 To edit an ACL for a mailbox, type @kbd{G l}
16558 (@code{gnus-group-edit-nnimap-acl}) and you'll be presented with an ACL
16559 editing window with detailed instructions.
16560
16561 Some possible uses:
16562
16563 @itemize @bullet
16564 @item
16565 Giving ``anyone'' the ``lrs'' rights (lookup, read, keep seen/unseen flags)
16566 on your mailing list mailboxes enables other users on the same server to
16567 follow the list without subscribing to it.
16568 @item
16569 At least with the Cyrus server, you are required to give the user
16570 ``anyone'' posting ("p") capabilities to have ``plussing'' work (that is,
16571 mail sent to user+mailbox@@domain ending up in the @acronym{IMAP} mailbox
16572 INBOX.mailbox).
16573 @end itemize
16574
16575 @node Expunging mailboxes
16576 @subsection Expunging mailboxes
16577 @cindex expunging
16578
16579 @cindex expunge
16580 @cindex manual expunging
16581 @kindex G x (Group)
16582 @findex gnus-group-nnimap-expunge
16583
16584 If you're using the @code{never} setting of @code{nnimap-expunge-on-close},
16585 you may want the option of expunging all deleted articles in a mailbox
16586 manually. This is exactly what @kbd{G x} does.
16587
16588 Currently there is no way of showing deleted articles, you can just
16589 delete them.
16590
16591 @node A note on namespaces
16592 @subsection A note on namespaces
16593 @cindex IMAP namespace
16594 @cindex namespaces
16595
16596 The @acronym{IMAP} protocol has a concept called namespaces, described
16597 by the following text in the RFC:
16598
16599 @display
16600 5.1.2. Mailbox Namespace Naming Convention
16601
16602 By convention, the first hierarchical element of any mailbox name
16603 which begins with "#" identifies the "namespace" of the remainder of
16604 the name. This makes it possible to disambiguate between different
16605 types of mailbox stores, each of which have their own namespaces.
16606
16607 For example, implementations which offer access to USENET
16608 newsgroups MAY use the "#news" namespace to partition the USENET
16609 newsgroup namespace from that of other mailboxes. Thus, the
16610 comp.mail.misc newsgroup would have an mailbox name of
16611 "#news.comp.mail.misc", and the name "comp.mail.misc" could refer
16612 to a different object (e.g. a user's private mailbox).
16613 @end display
16614
16615 While there is nothing in this text that warrants concern for the
16616 @acronym{IMAP} implementation in Gnus, some servers use namespace
16617 prefixes in a way that does not work with how Gnus uses mailbox names.
16618
16619 Specifically, University of Washington's @acronym{IMAP} server uses
16620 mailbox names like @code{#driver.mbx/read-mail} which are valid only
16621 in the @sc{create} and @sc{append} commands. After the mailbox is
16622 created (or a messages is appended to a mailbox), it must be accessed
16623 without the namespace prefix, i.e. @code{read-mail}. Since Gnus do
16624 not make it possible for the user to guarantee that user entered
16625 mailbox names will only be used with the CREATE and APPEND commands,
16626 you should simply not use the namespace prefixed mailbox names in
16627 Gnus.
16628
16629 See the UoW IMAPD documentation for the @code{#driver.*/} prefix
16630 for more information on how to use the prefixes. They are a power
16631 tool and should be used only if you are sure what the effects are.
16632
16633 @node Debugging IMAP
16634 @subsection Debugging IMAP
16635 @cindex IMAP debugging
16636 @cindex protocol dump (IMAP)
16637
16638 @acronym{IMAP} is a complex protocol, more so than @acronym{NNTP} or
16639 @acronym{POP3}. Implementation bugs are not unlikely, and we do our
16640 best to fix them right away. If you encounter odd behavior, chances
16641 are that either the server or Gnus is buggy.
16642
16643 If you are familiar with network protocols in general, you will
16644 probably be able to extract some clues from the protocol dump of the
16645 exchanges between Gnus and the server. Even if you are not familiar
16646 with network protocols, when you include the protocol dump in
16647 @acronym{IMAP}-related bug reports you are helping us with data
16648 critical to solving the problem. Therefore, we strongly encourage you
16649 to include the protocol dump when reporting IMAP bugs in Gnus.
16650
16651
16652 @vindex imap-log
16653 Because the protocol dump, when enabled, generates lots of data, it is
16654 disabled by default. You can enable it by setting @code{imap-log} as
16655 follows:
16656
16657 @lisp
16658 (setq imap-log t)
16659 @end lisp
16660
16661 This instructs the @code{imap.el} package to log any exchanges with
16662 the server. The log is stored in the buffer @samp{*imap-log*}. Look
16663 for error messages, which sometimes are tagged with the keyword
16664 @code{BAD}---but when submitting a bug, make sure to include all the
16665 data.
16666
16667 @node Other Sources
16668 @section Other Sources
16669
16670 Gnus can do more than just read news or mail. The methods described
16671 below allow Gnus to view directories and files as if they were
16672 newsgroups.
16673
16674 @menu
16675 * Directory Groups:: You can read a directory as if it was a newsgroup.
16676 * Anything Groups:: Dired? Who needs dired?
16677 * Document Groups:: Single files can be the basis of a group.
16678 * SOUP:: Reading @sc{soup} packets ``offline''.
16679 * Mail-To-News Gateways:: Posting articles via mail-to-news gateways.
16680 @end menu
16681
16682
16683 @node Directory Groups
16684 @subsection Directory Groups
16685 @cindex nndir
16686 @cindex directory groups
16687
16688 If you have a directory that has lots of articles in separate files in
16689 it, you might treat it as a newsgroup. The files have to have numerical
16690 names, of course.
16691
16692 This might be an opportune moment to mention @code{ange-ftp} (and its
16693 successor @code{efs}), that most wonderful of all wonderful Emacs
16694 packages. When I wrote @code{nndir}, I didn't think much about it---a
16695 back end to read directories. Big deal.
16696
16697 @code{ange-ftp} changes that picture dramatically. For instance, if you
16698 enter the @code{ange-ftp} file name
16699 @file{/ftp.hpc.uh.edu:/pub/emacs/ding-list/} as the directory name,
16700 @code{ange-ftp} or @code{efs} will actually allow you to read this
16701 directory over at @samp{sina} as a newsgroup. Distributed news ahoy!
16702
16703 @code{nndir} will use @acronym{NOV} files if they are present.
16704
16705 @code{nndir} is a ``read-only'' back end---you can't delete or expire
16706 articles with this method. You can use @code{nnmh} or @code{nnml} for
16707 whatever you use @code{nndir} for, so you could switch to any of those
16708 methods if you feel the need to have a non-read-only @code{nndir}.
16709
16710
16711 @node Anything Groups
16712 @subsection Anything Groups
16713 @cindex nneething
16714
16715 From the @code{nndir} back end (which reads a single spool-like
16716 directory), it's just a hop and a skip to @code{nneething}, which
16717 pretends that any arbitrary directory is a newsgroup. Strange, but
16718 true.
16719
16720 When @code{nneething} is presented with a directory, it will scan this
16721 directory and assign article numbers to each file. When you enter such
16722 a group, @code{nneething} must create ``headers'' that Gnus can use.
16723 After all, Gnus is a newsreader, in case you're forgetting.
16724 @code{nneething} does this in a two-step process. First, it snoops each
16725 file in question. If the file looks like an article (i.e., the first
16726 few lines look like headers), it will use this as the head. If this is
16727 just some arbitrary file without a head (e.g. a C source file),
16728 @code{nneething} will cobble up a header out of thin air. It will use
16729 file ownership, name and date and do whatever it can with these
16730 elements.
16731
16732 All this should happen automatically for you, and you will be presented
16733 with something that looks very much like a newsgroup. Totally like a
16734 newsgroup, to be precise. If you select an article, it will be displayed
16735 in the article buffer, just as usual.
16736
16737 If you select a line that represents a directory, Gnus will pop you into
16738 a new summary buffer for this @code{nneething} group. And so on. You can
16739 traverse the entire disk this way, if you feel like, but remember that
16740 Gnus is not dired, really, and does not intend to be, either.
16741
16742 There are two overall modes to this action---ephemeral or solid. When
16743 doing the ephemeral thing (i.e., @kbd{G D} from the group buffer), Gnus
16744 will not store information on what files you have read, and what files
16745 are new, and so on. If you create a solid @code{nneething} group the
16746 normal way with @kbd{G m}, Gnus will store a mapping table between
16747 article numbers and file names, and you can treat this group like any
16748 other groups. When you activate a solid @code{nneething} group, you will
16749 be told how many unread articles it contains, etc., etc.
16750
16751 Some variables:
16752
16753 @table @code
16754 @item nneething-map-file-directory
16755 @vindex nneething-map-file-directory
16756 All the mapping files for solid @code{nneething} groups will be stored
16757 in this directory, which defaults to @file{~/.nneething/}.
16758
16759 @item nneething-exclude-files
16760 @vindex nneething-exclude-files
16761 All files that match this regexp will be ignored. Nice to use to exclude
16762 auto-save files and the like, which is what it does by default.
16763
16764 @item nneething-include-files
16765 @vindex nneething-include-files
16766 Regexp saying what files to include in the group. If this variable is
16767 non-@code{nil}, only files matching this regexp will be included.
16768
16769 @item nneething-map-file
16770 @vindex nneething-map-file
16771 Name of the map files.
16772 @end table
16773
16774
16775 @node Document Groups
16776 @subsection Document Groups
16777 @cindex nndoc
16778 @cindex documentation group
16779 @cindex help group
16780
16781 @code{nndoc} is a cute little thing that will let you read a single file
16782 as a newsgroup. Several files types are supported:
16783
16784 @table @code
16785 @cindex Babyl
16786 @cindex Rmail mbox
16787
16788 @item babyl
16789 The Babyl (Rmail) mail box.
16790 @cindex mbox
16791 @cindex Unix mbox
16792
16793 @item mbox
16794 The standard Unix mbox file.
16795
16796 @cindex MMDF mail box
16797 @item mmdf
16798 The MMDF mail box format.
16799
16800 @item news
16801 Several news articles appended into a file.
16802
16803 @item rnews
16804 @cindex rnews batch files
16805 The rnews batch transport format.
16806 @cindex forwarded messages
16807
16808 @item forward
16809 Forwarded articles.
16810
16811 @item nsmail
16812 Netscape mail boxes.
16813
16814 @item mime-parts
16815 @acronym{MIME} multipart messages.
16816
16817 @item standard-digest
16818 The standard (RFC 1153) digest format.
16819
16820 @item mime-digest
16821 A @acronym{MIME} digest of messages.
16822
16823 @item lanl-gov-announce
16824 Announcement messages from LANL Gov Announce.
16825
16826 @item rfc822-forward
16827 A message forwarded according to RFC822.
16828
16829 @item outlook
16830 The Outlook mail box.
16831
16832 @item oe-dbx
16833 The Outlook Express dbx mail box.
16834
16835 @item exim-bounce
16836 A bounce message from the Exim MTA.
16837
16838 @item forward
16839 A message forwarded according to informal rules.
16840
16841 @item rfc934
16842 An RFC934-forwarded message.
16843
16844 @item mailman
16845 A mailman digest.
16846
16847 @item clari-briefs
16848 A digest of Clarinet brief news items.
16849
16850 @item slack-digest
16851 Non-standard digest format---matches most things, but does it badly.
16852
16853 @item mail-in-mail
16854 The last resort.
16855 @end table
16856
16857 You can also use the special ``file type'' @code{guess}, which means
16858 that @code{nndoc} will try to guess what file type it is looking at.
16859 @code{digest} means that @code{nndoc} should guess what digest type the
16860 file is.
16861
16862 @code{nndoc} will not try to change the file or insert any extra headers into
16863 it---it will simply, like, let you use the file as the basis for a
16864 group. And that's it.
16865
16866 If you have some old archived articles that you want to insert into your
16867 new & spiffy Gnus mail back end, @code{nndoc} can probably help you with
16868 that. Say you have an old @file{RMAIL} file with mail that you now want
16869 to split into your new @code{nnml} groups. You look at that file using
16870 @code{nndoc} (using the @kbd{G f} command in the group buffer
16871 (@pxref{Foreign Groups})), set the process mark on all the articles in
16872 the buffer (@kbd{M P b}, for instance), and then re-spool (@kbd{B r})
16873 using @code{nnml}. If all goes well, all the mail in the @file{RMAIL}
16874 file is now also stored in lots of @code{nnml} directories, and you can
16875 delete that pesky @file{RMAIL} file. If you have the guts!
16876
16877 Virtual server variables:
16878
16879 @table @code
16880 @item nndoc-article-type
16881 @vindex nndoc-article-type
16882 This should be one of @code{mbox}, @code{babyl}, @code{digest},
16883 @code{news}, @code{rnews}, @code{mmdf}, @code{forward}, @code{rfc934},
16884 @code{rfc822-forward}, @code{mime-parts}, @code{standard-digest},
16885 @code{slack-digest}, @code{clari-briefs}, @code{nsmail}, @code{outlook},
16886 @code{oe-dbx}, @code{mailman}, and @code{mail-in-mail} or @code{guess}.
16887
16888 @item nndoc-post-type
16889 @vindex nndoc-post-type
16890 This variable says whether Gnus is to consider the group a news group or
16891 a mail group. There are two valid values: @code{mail} (the default)
16892 and @code{news}.
16893 @end table
16894
16895 @menu
16896 * Document Server Internals:: How to add your own document types.
16897 @end menu
16898
16899
16900 @node Document Server Internals
16901 @subsubsection Document Server Internals
16902
16903 Adding new document types to be recognized by @code{nndoc} isn't
16904 difficult. You just have to whip up a definition of what the document
16905 looks like, write a predicate function to recognize that document type,
16906 and then hook into @code{nndoc}.
16907
16908 First, here's an example document type definition:
16909
16910 @example
16911 (mmdf
16912 (article-begin . "^\^A\^A\^A\^A\n")
16913 (body-end . "^\^A\^A\^A\^A\n"))
16914 @end example
16915
16916 The definition is simply a unique @dfn{name} followed by a series of
16917 regexp pseudo-variable settings. Below are the possible
16918 variables---don't be daunted by the number of variables; most document
16919 types can be defined with very few settings:
16920
16921 @table @code
16922 @item first-article
16923 If present, @code{nndoc} will skip past all text until it finds
16924 something that match this regexp. All text before this will be
16925 totally ignored.
16926
16927 @item article-begin
16928 This setting has to be present in all document type definitions. It
16929 says what the beginning of each article looks like.
16930
16931 @item head-begin-function
16932 If present, this should be a function that moves point to the head of
16933 the article.
16934
16935 @item nndoc-head-begin
16936 If present, this should be a regexp that matches the head of the
16937 article.
16938
16939 @item nndoc-head-end
16940 This should match the end of the head of the article. It defaults to
16941 @samp{^$}---the empty line.
16942
16943 @item body-begin-function
16944 If present, this function should move point to the beginning of the body
16945 of the article.
16946
16947 @item body-begin
16948 This should match the beginning of the body of the article. It defaults
16949 to @samp{^\n}.
16950
16951 @item body-end-function
16952 If present, this function should move point to the end of the body of
16953 the article.
16954
16955 @item body-end
16956 If present, this should match the end of the body of the article.
16957
16958 @item file-end
16959 If present, this should match the end of the file. All text after this
16960 regexp will be totally ignored.
16961
16962 @end table
16963
16964 So, using these variables @code{nndoc} is able to dissect a document
16965 file into a series of articles, each with a head and a body. However, a
16966 few more variables are needed since not all document types are all that
16967 news-like---variables needed to transform the head or the body into
16968 something that's palatable for Gnus:
16969
16970 @table @code
16971 @item prepare-body-function
16972 If present, this function will be called when requesting an article. It
16973 will be called with point at the start of the body, and is useful if the
16974 document has encoded some parts of its contents.
16975
16976 @item article-transform-function
16977 If present, this function is called when requesting an article. It's
16978 meant to be used for more wide-ranging transformation of both head and
16979 body of the article.
16980
16981 @item generate-head-function
16982 If present, this function is called to generate a head that Gnus can
16983 understand. It is called with the article number as a parameter, and is
16984 expected to generate a nice head for the article in question. It is
16985 called when requesting the headers of all articles.
16986
16987 @end table
16988
16989 Let's look at the most complicated example I can come up with---standard
16990 digests:
16991
16992 @example
16993 (standard-digest
16994 (first-article . ,(concat "^" (make-string 70 ?-) "\n\n+"))
16995 (article-begin . ,(concat "\n\n" (make-string 30 ?-) "\n\n+"))
16996 (prepare-body-function . nndoc-unquote-dashes)
16997 (body-end-function . nndoc-digest-body-end)
16998 (head-end . "^ ?$")
16999 (body-begin . "^ ?\n")
17000 (file-end . "^End of .*digest.*[0-9].*\n\\*\\*\\|^End of.*Digest *$")
17001 (subtype digest guess))
17002 @end example
17003
17004 We see that all text before a 70-width line of dashes is ignored; all
17005 text after a line that starts with that @samp{^End of} is also ignored;
17006 each article begins with a 30-width line of dashes; the line separating
17007 the head from the body may contain a single space; and that the body is
17008 run through @code{nndoc-unquote-dashes} before being delivered.
17009
17010 To hook your own document definition into @code{nndoc}, use the
17011 @code{nndoc-add-type} function. It takes two parameters---the first
17012 is the definition itself and the second (optional) parameter says
17013 where in the document type definition alist to put this definition.
17014 The alist is traversed sequentially, and
17015 @code{nndoc-@var{type}-type-p} is called for a given type @var{type}.
17016 So @code{nndoc-mmdf-type-p} is called to see whether a document is of
17017 @code{mmdf} type, and so on. These type predicates should return
17018 @code{nil} if the document is not of the correct type; @code{t} if it
17019 is of the correct type; and a number if the document might be of the
17020 correct type. A high number means high probability; a low number
17021 means low probability with @samp{0} being the lowest valid number.
17022
17023
17024 @node SOUP
17025 @subsection SOUP
17026 @cindex SOUP
17027 @cindex offline
17028
17029 In the PC world people often talk about ``offline'' newsreaders. These
17030 are thingies that are combined reader/news transport monstrosities.
17031 With built-in modem programs. Yecchh!
17032
17033 Of course, us Unix Weenie types of human beans use things like
17034 @code{uucp} and, like, @code{nntpd} and set up proper news and mail
17035 transport things like Ghod intended. And then we just use normal
17036 newsreaders.
17037
17038 However, it can sometimes be convenient to do something that's a bit
17039 easier on the brain if you have a very slow modem, and you're not really
17040 that interested in doing things properly.
17041
17042 A file format called @sc{soup} has been developed for transporting news
17043 and mail from servers to home machines and back again. It can be a bit
17044 fiddly.
17045
17046 First some terminology:
17047
17048 @table @dfn
17049
17050 @item server
17051 This is the machine that is connected to the outside world and where you
17052 get news and/or mail from.
17053
17054 @item home machine
17055 This is the machine that you want to do the actual reading and responding
17056 on. It is typically not connected to the rest of the world in any way.
17057
17058 @item packet
17059 Something that contains messages and/or commands. There are two kinds
17060 of packets:
17061
17062 @table @dfn
17063 @item message packets
17064 These are packets made at the server, and typically contain lots of
17065 messages for you to read. These are called @file{SoupoutX.tgz} by
17066 default, where @var{x} is a number.
17067
17068 @item response packets
17069 These are packets made at the home machine, and typically contains
17070 replies that you've written. These are called @file{SoupinX.tgz} by
17071 default, where @var{x} is a number.
17072
17073 @end table
17074
17075 @end table
17076
17077
17078 @enumerate
17079
17080 @item
17081 You log in on the server and create a @sc{soup} packet. You can either
17082 use a dedicated @sc{soup} thingie (like the @code{awk} program), or you
17083 can use Gnus to create the packet with its @sc{soup} commands (@kbd{O
17084 s} and/or @kbd{G s b}; and then @kbd{G s p}) (@pxref{SOUP Commands}).
17085
17086 @item
17087 You transfer the packet home. Rail, boat, car or modem will do fine.
17088
17089 @item
17090 You put the packet in your home directory.
17091
17092 @item
17093 You fire up Gnus on your home machine using the @code{nnsoup} back end as
17094 the native or secondary server.
17095
17096 @item
17097 You read articles and mail and answer and followup to the things you
17098 want (@pxref{SOUP Replies}).
17099
17100 @item
17101 You do the @kbd{G s r} command to pack these replies into a @sc{soup}
17102 packet.
17103
17104 @item
17105 You transfer this packet to the server.
17106
17107 @item
17108 You use Gnus to mail this packet out with the @kbd{G s s} command.
17109
17110 @item
17111 You then repeat until you die.
17112
17113 @end enumerate
17114
17115 So you basically have a bipartite system---you use @code{nnsoup} for
17116 reading and Gnus for packing/sending these @sc{soup} packets.
17117
17118 @menu
17119 * SOUP Commands:: Commands for creating and sending @sc{soup} packets
17120 * SOUP Groups:: A back end for reading @sc{soup} packets.
17121 * SOUP Replies:: How to enable @code{nnsoup} to take over mail and news.
17122 @end menu
17123
17124
17125 @node SOUP Commands
17126 @subsubsection SOUP Commands
17127
17128 These are commands for creating and manipulating @sc{soup} packets.
17129
17130 @table @kbd
17131 @item G s b
17132 @kindex G s b (Group)
17133 @findex gnus-group-brew-soup
17134 Pack all unread articles in the current group
17135 (@code{gnus-group-brew-soup}). This command understands the
17136 process/prefix convention.
17137
17138 @item G s w
17139 @kindex G s w (Group)
17140 @findex gnus-soup-save-areas
17141 Save all @sc{soup} data files (@code{gnus-soup-save-areas}).
17142
17143 @item G s s
17144 @kindex G s s (Group)
17145 @findex gnus-soup-send-replies
17146 Send all replies from the replies packet
17147 (@code{gnus-soup-send-replies}).
17148
17149 @item G s p
17150 @kindex G s p (Group)
17151 @findex gnus-soup-pack-packet
17152 Pack all files into a @sc{soup} packet (@code{gnus-soup-pack-packet}).
17153
17154 @item G s r
17155 @kindex G s r (Group)
17156 @findex nnsoup-pack-replies
17157 Pack all replies into a replies packet (@code{nnsoup-pack-replies}).
17158
17159 @item O s
17160 @kindex O s (Summary)
17161 @findex gnus-soup-add-article
17162 This summary-mode command adds the current article to a @sc{soup} packet
17163 (@code{gnus-soup-add-article}). It understands the process/prefix
17164 convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
17165
17166 @end table
17167
17168
17169 There are a few variables to customize where Gnus will put all these
17170 thingies:
17171
17172 @table @code
17173
17174 @item gnus-soup-directory
17175 @vindex gnus-soup-directory
17176 Directory where Gnus will save intermediate files while composing
17177 @sc{soup} packets. The default is @file{~/SoupBrew/}.
17178
17179 @item gnus-soup-replies-directory
17180 @vindex gnus-soup-replies-directory
17181 This is what Gnus will use as a temporary directory while sending our
17182 reply packets. @file{~/SoupBrew/SoupReplies/} is the default.
17183
17184 @item gnus-soup-prefix-file
17185 @vindex gnus-soup-prefix-file
17186 Name of the file where Gnus stores the last used prefix. The default is
17187 @samp{gnus-prefix}.
17188
17189 @item gnus-soup-packer
17190 @vindex gnus-soup-packer
17191 A format string command for packing a @sc{soup} packet. The default is
17192 @samp{tar cf - %s | gzip > $HOME/Soupout%d.tgz}.
17193
17194 @item gnus-soup-unpacker
17195 @vindex gnus-soup-unpacker
17196 Format string command for unpacking a @sc{soup} packet. The default is
17197 @samp{gunzip -c %s | tar xvf -}.
17198
17199 @item gnus-soup-packet-directory
17200 @vindex gnus-soup-packet-directory
17201 Where Gnus will look for reply packets. The default is @file{~/}.
17202
17203 @item gnus-soup-packet-regexp
17204 @vindex gnus-soup-packet-regexp
17205 Regular expression matching @sc{soup} reply packets in
17206 @code{gnus-soup-packet-directory}.
17207
17208 @end table
17209
17210
17211 @node SOUP Groups
17212 @subsubsection SOUP Groups
17213 @cindex nnsoup
17214
17215 @code{nnsoup} is the back end for reading @sc{soup} packets. It will
17216 read incoming packets, unpack them, and put them in a directory where
17217 you can read them at leisure.
17218
17219 These are the variables you can use to customize its behavior:
17220
17221 @table @code
17222
17223 @item nnsoup-tmp-directory
17224 @vindex nnsoup-tmp-directory
17225 When @code{nnsoup} unpacks a @sc{soup} packet, it does it in this
17226 directory. (@file{/tmp/} by default.)
17227
17228 @item nnsoup-directory
17229 @vindex nnsoup-directory
17230 @code{nnsoup} then moves each message and index file to this directory.
17231 The default is @file{~/SOUP/}.
17232
17233 @item nnsoup-replies-directory
17234 @vindex nnsoup-replies-directory
17235 All replies will be stored in this directory before being packed into a
17236 reply packet. The default is @file{~/SOUP/replies/}.
17237
17238 @item nnsoup-replies-format-type
17239 @vindex nnsoup-replies-format-type
17240 The @sc{soup} format of the replies packets. The default is @samp{?n}
17241 (rnews), and I don't think you should touch that variable. I probably
17242 shouldn't even have documented it. Drats! Too late!
17243
17244 @item nnsoup-replies-index-type
17245 @vindex nnsoup-replies-index-type
17246 The index type of the replies packet. The default is @samp{?n}, which
17247 means ``none''. Don't fiddle with this one either!
17248
17249 @item nnsoup-active-file
17250 @vindex nnsoup-active-file
17251 Where @code{nnsoup} stores lots of information. This is not an ``active
17252 file'' in the @code{nntp} sense; it's an Emacs Lisp file. If you lose
17253 this file or mess it up in any way, you're dead. The default is
17254 @file{~/SOUP/active}.
17255
17256 @item nnsoup-packer
17257 @vindex nnsoup-packer
17258 Format string command for packing a reply @sc{soup} packet. The default
17259 is @samp{tar cf - %s | gzip > $HOME/Soupin%d.tgz}.
17260
17261 @item nnsoup-unpacker
17262 @vindex nnsoup-unpacker
17263 Format string command for unpacking incoming @sc{soup} packets. The
17264 default is @samp{gunzip -c %s | tar xvf -}.
17265
17266 @item nnsoup-packet-directory
17267 @vindex nnsoup-packet-directory
17268 Where @code{nnsoup} will look for incoming packets. The default is
17269 @file{~/}.
17270
17271 @item nnsoup-packet-regexp
17272 @vindex nnsoup-packet-regexp
17273 Regular expression matching incoming @sc{soup} packets. The default is
17274 @samp{Soupout}.
17275
17276 @item nnsoup-always-save
17277 @vindex nnsoup-always-save
17278 If non-@code{nil}, save the replies buffer after each posted message.
17279
17280 @end table
17281
17282
17283 @node SOUP Replies
17284 @subsubsection SOUP Replies
17285
17286 Just using @code{nnsoup} won't mean that your postings and mailings end
17287 up in @sc{soup} reply packets automagically. You have to work a bit
17288 more for that to happen.
17289
17290 @findex nnsoup-set-variables
17291 The @code{nnsoup-set-variables} command will set the appropriate
17292 variables to ensure that all your followups and replies end up in the
17293 @sc{soup} system.
17294
17295 In specific, this is what it does:
17296
17297 @lisp
17298 (setq message-send-news-function 'nnsoup-request-post)
17299 (setq message-send-mail-function 'nnsoup-request-mail)
17300 @end lisp
17301
17302 And that's it, really. If you only want news to go into the @sc{soup}
17303 system you just use the first line. If you only want mail to be
17304 @sc{soup}ed you use the second.
17305
17306
17307 @node Mail-To-News Gateways
17308 @subsection Mail-To-News Gateways
17309 @cindex mail-to-news gateways
17310 @cindex gateways
17311
17312 If your local @code{nntp} server doesn't allow posting, for some reason
17313 or other, you can post using one of the numerous mail-to-news gateways.
17314 The @code{nngateway} back end provides the interface.
17315
17316 Note that you can't read anything from this back end---it can only be
17317 used to post with.
17318
17319 Server variables:
17320
17321 @table @code
17322 @item nngateway-address
17323 @vindex nngateway-address
17324 This is the address of the mail-to-news gateway.
17325
17326 @item nngateway-header-transformation
17327 @vindex nngateway-header-transformation
17328 News headers often have to be transformed in some odd way or other
17329 for the mail-to-news gateway to accept it. This variable says what
17330 transformation should be called, and defaults to
17331 @code{nngateway-simple-header-transformation}. The function is called
17332 narrowed to the headers to be transformed and with one parameter---the
17333 gateway address.
17334
17335 This default function just inserts a new @code{To} header based on the
17336 @code{Newsgroups} header and the gateway address.
17337 For instance, an article with this @code{Newsgroups} header:
17338
17339 @example
17340 Newsgroups: alt.religion.emacs
17341 @end example
17342
17343 will get this @code{To} header inserted:
17344
17345 @example
17346 To: alt-religion-emacs@@GATEWAY
17347 @end example
17348
17349 The following pre-defined functions exist:
17350
17351 @findex nngateway-simple-header-transformation
17352 @table @code
17353
17354 @item nngateway-simple-header-transformation
17355 Creates a @code{To} header that looks like
17356 @var{newsgroup}@@@code{nngateway-address}.
17357
17358 @findex nngateway-mail2news-header-transformation
17359
17360 @item nngateway-mail2news-header-transformation
17361 Creates a @code{To} header that looks like
17362 @code{nngateway-address}.
17363 @end table
17364
17365 @end table
17366
17367 Here's an example:
17368
17369 @lisp
17370 (setq gnus-post-method
17371 '(nngateway
17372 "mail2news@@replay.com"
17373 (nngateway-header-transformation
17374 nngateway-mail2news-header-transformation)))
17375 @end lisp
17376
17377 So, to use this, simply say something like:
17378
17379 @lisp
17380 (setq gnus-post-method '(nngateway "GATEWAY.ADDRESS"))
17381 @end lisp
17382
17383
17384
17385 @node Combined Groups
17386 @section Combined Groups
17387
17388 Gnus allows combining a mixture of all the other group types into bigger
17389 groups.
17390
17391 @menu
17392 * Virtual Groups:: Combining articles from many groups.
17393 * Kibozed Groups:: Looking through parts of the newsfeed for articles.
17394 @end menu
17395
17396
17397 @node Virtual Groups
17398 @subsection Virtual Groups
17399 @cindex nnvirtual
17400 @cindex virtual groups
17401 @cindex merging groups
17402
17403 An @dfn{nnvirtual group} is really nothing more than a collection of
17404 other groups.
17405
17406 For instance, if you are tired of reading many small groups, you can
17407 put them all in one big group, and then grow tired of reading one
17408 big, unwieldy group. The joys of computing!
17409
17410 You specify @code{nnvirtual} as the method. The address should be a
17411 regexp to match component groups.
17412
17413 All marks in the virtual group will stick to the articles in the
17414 component groups. So if you tick an article in a virtual group, the
17415 article will also be ticked in the component group from whence it
17416 came. (And vice versa---marks from the component groups will also be
17417 shown in the virtual group.). To create an empty virtual group, run
17418 @kbd{G V} (@code{gnus-group-make-empty-virtual}) in the group buffer
17419 and edit the method regexp with @kbd{M-e}
17420 (@code{gnus-group-edit-group-method})
17421
17422 Here's an example @code{nnvirtual} method that collects all Andrea Dworkin
17423 newsgroups into one, big, happy newsgroup:
17424
17425 @lisp
17426 (nnvirtual "^alt\\.fan\\.andrea-dworkin$\\|^rec\\.dworkin.*")
17427 @end lisp
17428
17429 The component groups can be native or foreign; everything should work
17430 smoothly, but if your computer explodes, it was probably my fault.
17431
17432 Collecting the same group from several servers might actually be a good
17433 idea if users have set the Distribution header to limit distribution.
17434 If you would like to read @samp{soc.motss} both from a server in Japan
17435 and a server in Norway, you could use the following as the group regexp:
17436
17437 @example
17438 "^nntp\\+server\\.jp:soc\\.motss$\\|^nntp\\+server\\.no:soc\\.motss$"
17439 @end example
17440
17441 (Remember, though, that if you're creating the group with @kbd{G m}, you
17442 shouldn't double the backslashes, and you should leave off the quote
17443 characters at the beginning and the end of the string.)
17444
17445 This should work kinda smoothly---all articles from both groups should
17446 end up in this one, and there should be no duplicates. Threading (and
17447 the rest) will still work as usual, but there might be problems with the
17448 sequence of articles. Sorting on date might be an option here
17449 (@pxref{Selecting a Group}).
17450
17451 One limitation, however---all groups included in a virtual
17452 group have to be alive (i.e., subscribed or unsubscribed). Killed or
17453 zombie groups can't be component groups for @code{nnvirtual} groups.
17454
17455 @vindex nnvirtual-always-rescan
17456 If the @code{nnvirtual-always-rescan} is non-@code{nil},
17457 @code{nnvirtual} will always scan groups for unread articles when
17458 entering a virtual group. If this variable is @code{nil} (which is the
17459 default) and you read articles in a component group after the virtual
17460 group has been activated, the read articles from the component group
17461 will show up when you enter the virtual group. You'll also see this
17462 effect if you have two virtual groups that have a component group in
17463 common. If that's the case, you should set this variable to @code{t}.
17464 Or you can just tap @code{M-g} on the virtual group every time before
17465 you enter it---it'll have much the same effect.
17466
17467 @code{nnvirtual} can have both mail and news groups as component groups.
17468 When responding to articles in @code{nnvirtual} groups, @code{nnvirtual}
17469 has to ask the back end of the component group the article comes from
17470 whether it is a news or mail back end. However, when you do a @kbd{^},
17471 there is typically no sure way for the component back end to know this,
17472 and in that case @code{nnvirtual} tells Gnus that the article came from a
17473 not-news back end. (Just to be on the safe side.)
17474
17475 @kbd{C-c C-n} in the message buffer will insert the @code{Newsgroups}
17476 line from the article you respond to in these cases.
17477
17478 @code{nnvirtual} groups do not inherit anything but articles and marks
17479 from component groups---group parameters, for instance, are not
17480 inherited.
17481
17482
17483 @node Kibozed Groups
17484 @subsection Kibozed Groups
17485 @cindex nnkiboze
17486 @cindex kibozing
17487
17488 @dfn{Kibozing} is defined by the @acronym{OED} as ``grepping through
17489 (parts of) the news feed''. @code{nnkiboze} is a back end that will
17490 do this for you. Oh joy! Now you can grind any @acronym{NNTP} server
17491 down to a halt with useless requests! Oh happiness!
17492
17493 @kindex G k (Group)
17494 To create a kibozed group, use the @kbd{G k} command in the group
17495 buffer.
17496
17497 The address field of the @code{nnkiboze} method is, as with
17498 @code{nnvirtual}, a regexp to match groups to be ``included'' in the
17499 @code{nnkiboze} group. That's where most similarities between
17500 @code{nnkiboze} and @code{nnvirtual} end.
17501
17502 In addition to this regexp detailing component groups, an
17503 @code{nnkiboze} group must have a score file to say what articles are
17504 to be included in the group (@pxref{Scoring}).
17505
17506 @kindex M-x nnkiboze-generate-groups
17507 @findex nnkiboze-generate-groups
17508 You must run @kbd{M-x nnkiboze-generate-groups} after creating the
17509 @code{nnkiboze} groups you want to have. This command will take time.
17510 Lots of time. Oodles and oodles of time. Gnus has to fetch the
17511 headers from all the articles in all the component groups and run them
17512 through the scoring process to determine if there are any articles in
17513 the groups that are to be part of the @code{nnkiboze} groups.
17514
17515 Please limit the number of component groups by using restrictive
17516 regexps. Otherwise your sysadmin may become annoyed with you, and the
17517 @acronym{NNTP} site may throw you off and never let you back in again.
17518 Stranger things have happened.
17519
17520 @code{nnkiboze} component groups do not have to be alive---they can be dead,
17521 and they can be foreign. No restrictions.
17522
17523 @vindex nnkiboze-directory
17524 The generation of an @code{nnkiboze} group means writing two files in
17525 @code{nnkiboze-directory}, which is @file{~/News/kiboze/} by default.
17526 One contains the @acronym{NOV} header lines for all the articles in
17527 the group, and the other is an additional @file{.newsrc} file to store
17528 information on what groups have been searched through to find
17529 component articles.
17530
17531 Articles marked as read in the @code{nnkiboze} group will have
17532 their @acronym{NOV} lines removed from the @acronym{NOV} file.
17533
17534
17535 @node Gnus Unplugged
17536 @section Gnus Unplugged
17537 @cindex offline
17538 @cindex unplugged
17539 @cindex agent
17540 @cindex Gnus agent
17541 @cindex Gnus unplugged
17542
17543 In olden times (ca. February '88), people used to run their newsreaders
17544 on big machines with permanent connections to the net. News transport
17545 was dealt with by news servers, and all the newsreaders had to do was to
17546 read news. Believe it or not.
17547
17548 Nowadays most people read news and mail at home, and use some sort of
17549 modem to connect to the net. To avoid running up huge phone bills, it
17550 would be nice to have a way to slurp down all the news and mail, hang up
17551 the phone, read for several hours, and then upload any responses you
17552 have to make. And then you repeat the procedure.
17553
17554 Of course, you can use news servers for doing this as well. I've used
17555 @code{inn} together with @code{slurp}, @code{pop} and @code{sendmail}
17556 for some years, but doing that's a bore. Moving the news server
17557 functionality up to the newsreader makes sense if you're the only person
17558 reading news on a machine.
17559
17560 Setting up Gnus as an ``offline'' newsreader is quite simple. In
17561 fact, you don't even have to configure anything.
17562
17563 Of course, to use it as such, you have to learn a few new commands.
17564
17565 @menu
17566 * Agent Basics:: How it all is supposed to work.
17567 * Agent Categories:: How to tell the Gnus Agent what to download.
17568 * Agent Commands:: New commands for all the buffers.
17569 * Agent Visuals:: Ways that the agent may effect your summary buffer.
17570 * Agent as Cache:: The Agent is a big cache too.
17571 * Agent Expiry:: How to make old articles go away.
17572 * Agent Regeneration:: How to recover from lost connections and other accidents.
17573 * Agent and IMAP:: How to use the Agent with @acronym{IMAP}.
17574 * Outgoing Messages:: What happens when you post/mail something?
17575 * Agent Variables:: Customizing is fun.
17576 * Example Setup:: An example @file{~/.gnus.el} file for offline people.
17577 * Batching Agents:: How to fetch news from a @code{cron} job.
17578 * Agent Caveats:: What you think it'll do and what it does.
17579 @end menu
17580
17581
17582 @node Agent Basics
17583 @subsection Agent Basics
17584
17585 First, let's get some terminology out of the way.
17586
17587 The Gnus Agent is said to be @dfn{unplugged} when you have severed the
17588 connection to the net (and notified the Agent that this is the case).
17589 When the connection to the net is up again (and Gnus knows this), the
17590 Agent is @dfn{plugged}.
17591
17592 The @dfn{local} machine is the one you're running on, and which isn't
17593 connected to the net continuously.
17594
17595 @dfn{Downloading} means fetching things from the net to your local
17596 machine. @dfn{Uploading} is doing the opposite.
17597
17598 You know that Gnus gives you all the opportunity you'd ever want for
17599 shooting yourself in the foot. Some people call it flexibility. Gnus
17600 is also customizable to a great extent, which means that the user has a
17601 say on how Gnus behaves. Other newsreaders might unconditionally shoot
17602 you in your foot, but with Gnus, you have a choice!
17603
17604 Gnus is never really in plugged or unplugged state. Rather, it applies
17605 that state to each server individually. This means that some servers
17606 can be plugged while others can be unplugged. Additionally, some
17607 servers can be ignored by the Agent altogether (which means that
17608 they're kinda like plugged always).
17609
17610 So when you unplug the Agent and then wonder why is Gnus opening a
17611 connection to the Net, the next step to do is to look whether all
17612 servers are agentized. If there is an unagentized server, you found
17613 the culprit.
17614
17615 Another thing is the @dfn{offline} state. Sometimes, servers aren't
17616 reachable. When Gnus notices this, it asks you whether you want the
17617 server to be switched to offline state. If you say yes, then the
17618 server will behave somewhat as if it was unplugged, except that Gnus
17619 will ask you whether you want to switch it back online again.
17620
17621 Let's take a typical Gnus session using the Agent.
17622
17623 @itemize @bullet
17624
17625 @item
17626 @findex gnus-unplugged
17627 You start Gnus with @code{gnus-unplugged}. This brings up the Gnus
17628 Agent in a disconnected state. You can read all the news that you have
17629 already fetched while in this mode.
17630
17631 @item
17632 You then decide to see whether any new news has arrived. You connect
17633 your machine to the net (using PPP or whatever), and then hit @kbd{J j}
17634 to make Gnus become @dfn{plugged} and use @kbd{g} to check for new mail
17635 as usual. To check for new mail in unplugged mode (@pxref{Mail
17636 Source Specifiers}).
17637
17638 @item
17639 You can then read the new news immediately, or you can download the
17640 news onto your local machine. If you want to do the latter, you press
17641 @kbd{g} to check if there are any new news and then @kbd{J s} to fetch
17642 all the eligible articles in all the groups. (To let Gnus know which
17643 articles you want to download, @pxref{Agent Categories}).
17644
17645 @item
17646 After fetching the articles, you press @kbd{J j} to make Gnus become
17647 unplugged again, and you shut down the PPP thing (or whatever). And
17648 then you read the news offline.
17649
17650 @item
17651 And then you go to step 2.
17652 @end itemize
17653
17654 Here are some things you should do the first time (or so) that you use
17655 the Agent.
17656
17657 @itemize @bullet
17658
17659 @item
17660 Decide which servers should be covered by the Agent. If you have a mail
17661 back end, it would probably be nonsensical to have it covered by the
17662 Agent. Go to the server buffer (@kbd{^} in the group buffer) and press
17663 @kbd{J a} on the server (or servers) that you wish to have covered by the
17664 Agent (@pxref{Server Agent Commands}), or @kbd{J r} on automatically
17665 added servers you do not wish to have covered by the Agent. By default,
17666 all @code{nntp} and @code{nnimap} servers in @code{gnus-select-method} and
17667 @code{gnus-secondary-select-methods} are agentized.
17668
17669 @item
17670 Decide on download policy. It's fairly simple once you decide whether
17671 you are going to use agent categories, topic parameters, and/or group
17672 parameters to implement your policy. If you're new to gnus, it
17673 is probably best to start with a category, @xref{Agent Categories}.
17674
17675 Both topic parameters (@pxref{Topic Parameters}) and agent categories
17676 (@pxref{Agent Categories}) provide for setting a policy that applies
17677 to multiple groups. Which you use is entirely up to you. Topic
17678 parameters do override categories so, if you mix the two, you'll have
17679 to take that into account. If you have a few groups that deviate from
17680 your policy, you can use group parameters (@pxref{Group Parameters}) to
17681 configure them.
17682
17683 @item
17684 Uhm@dots{} that's it.
17685 @end itemize
17686
17687
17688 @node Agent Categories
17689 @subsection Agent Categories
17690
17691 One of the main reasons to integrate the news transport layer into the
17692 newsreader is to allow greater control over what articles to download.
17693 There's not much point in downloading huge amounts of articles, just to
17694 find out that you're not interested in reading any of them. It's better
17695 to be somewhat more conservative in choosing what to download, and then
17696 mark the articles for downloading manually if it should turn out that
17697 you're interested in the articles anyway.
17698
17699 One of the more effective methods for controlling what is to be
17700 downloaded is to create a @dfn{category} and then assign some (or all)
17701 groups to this category. Groups that do not belong in any other
17702 category belong to the @code{default} category. Gnus has its own
17703 buffer for creating and managing categories.
17704
17705 If you prefer, you can also use group parameters (@pxref{Group
17706 Parameters}) and topic parameters (@pxref{Topic Parameters}) for an
17707 alternative approach to controlling the agent. The only real
17708 difference is that categories are specific to the agent (so there is
17709 less to learn) while group and topic parameters include the kitchen
17710 sink.
17711
17712 Since you can set agent parameters in several different places we have
17713 a rule to decide which source to believe. This rule specifies that
17714 the parameter sources are checked in the following order: group
17715 parameters, topic parameters, agent category, and finally customizable
17716 variables. So you can mix all of these sources to produce a wide range
17717 of behavior, just don't blame me if you don't remember where you put
17718 your settings.
17719
17720 @menu
17721 * Category Syntax:: What a category looks like.
17722 * Category Buffer:: A buffer for maintaining categories.
17723 * Category Variables:: Customize'r'Us.
17724 @end menu
17725
17726
17727 @node Category Syntax
17728 @subsubsection Category Syntax
17729
17730 A category consists of a name, the list of groups belonging to the
17731 category, and a number of optional parameters that override the
17732 customizable variables. The complete list of agent parameters are
17733 listed below.
17734
17735 @cindex Agent Parameters
17736 @table @code
17737 @item gnus-agent-cat-name
17738 The name of the category.
17739
17740 @item gnus-agent-cat-groups
17741 The list of groups that are in this category.
17742
17743 @item gnus-agent-cat-predicate
17744 A predicate which (generally) gives a rough outline of which articles
17745 are eligible for downloading; and
17746
17747 @item gnus-agent-cat-score-file
17748 a score rule which (generally) gives you a finer granularity when
17749 deciding what articles to download. (Note that this @dfn{download
17750 score} is not necessarily related to normal scores.)
17751
17752 @item gnus-agent-cat-enable-expiration
17753 a boolean indicating whether the agent should expire old articles in
17754 this group. Most groups should be expired to conserve disk space. In
17755 fact, its probably safe to say that the gnus.* hierarchy contains the
17756 only groups that should not be expired.
17757
17758 @item gnus-agent-cat-days-until-old
17759 an integer indicating the number of days that the agent should wait
17760 before deciding that a read article is safe to expire.
17761
17762 @item gnus-agent-cat-low-score
17763 an integer that overrides the value of @code{gnus-agent-low-score}.
17764
17765 @item gnus-agent-cat-high-score
17766 an integer that overrides the value of @code{gnus-agent-high-score}.
17767
17768 @item gnus-agent-cat-length-when-short
17769 an integer that overrides the value of
17770 @code{gnus-agent-short-article}.
17771
17772 @item gnus-agent-cat-length-when-long
17773 an integer that overrides the value of @code{gnus-agent-long-article}.
17774
17775 @c @item gnus-agent-cat-disable-undownloaded-faces
17776 @c a symbol indicating whether the summary buffer should @emph{not} display
17777 @c undownloaded articles using the gnus-summary-*-undownloaded-face
17778 @c faces. The symbol nil will enable the use of undownloaded faces while
17779 @c all other symbols disable them.
17780
17781 @item gnus-agent-cat-enable-undownloaded-faces
17782 a symbol indicating whether the summary buffer should display
17783 undownloaded articles using the gnus-summary-*-undownloaded-face
17784 faces. The symbol nil will disable the use of undownloaded faces while
17785 all other symbols enable them.
17786 @end table
17787
17788 The name of a category can not be changed once the category has been
17789 created.
17790
17791 Each category maintains a list of groups that are exclusive members of
17792 that category. The exclusivity rule is automatically enforced, add a
17793 group to a new category and it is automatically removed from its old
17794 category.
17795
17796 A predicate in its simplest form can be a single predicate such as
17797 @code{true} or @code{false}. These two will download every available
17798 article or nothing respectively. In the case of these two special
17799 predicates an additional score rule is superfluous.
17800
17801 Predicates of @code{high} or @code{low} download articles in respect of
17802 their scores in relationship to @code{gnus-agent-high-score} and
17803 @code{gnus-agent-low-score} as described below.
17804
17805 To gain even finer control of what is to be regarded eligible for
17806 download a predicate can consist of a number of predicates with logical
17807 operators sprinkled in between.
17808
17809 Perhaps some examples are in order.
17810
17811 Here's a simple predicate. (It's the default predicate, in fact, used
17812 for all groups that don't belong to any other category.)
17813
17814 @lisp
17815 short
17816 @end lisp
17817
17818 Quite simple, eh? This predicate is true if and only if the article is
17819 short (for some value of ``short'').
17820
17821 Here's a more complex predicate:
17822
17823 @lisp
17824 (or high
17825 (and
17826 (not low)
17827 (not long)))
17828 @end lisp
17829
17830 This means that an article should be downloaded if it has a high score,
17831 or if the score is not low and the article is not long. You get the
17832 drift.
17833
17834 The available logical operators are @code{or}, @code{and} and
17835 @code{not}. (If you prefer, you can use the more ``C''-ish operators
17836 @samp{|}, @code{&} and @code{!} instead.)
17837
17838 The following predicates are pre-defined, but if none of these fit what
17839 you want to do, you can write your own.
17840
17841 When evaluating each of these predicates, the named constant will be
17842 bound to the value determined by calling
17843 @code{gnus-agent-find-parameter} on the appropriate parameter. For
17844 example, gnus-agent-short-article will be bound to
17845 @code{(gnus-agent-find-parameter group 'agent-short-article)}. This
17846 means that you can specify a predicate in your category then tune that
17847 predicate to individual groups.
17848
17849 @table @code
17850 @item short
17851 True iff the article is shorter than @code{gnus-agent-short-article}
17852 lines; default 100.
17853
17854 @item long
17855 True iff the article is longer than @code{gnus-agent-long-article}
17856 lines; default 200.
17857
17858 @item low
17859 True iff the article has a download score less than
17860 @code{gnus-agent-low-score}; default 0.
17861
17862 @item high
17863 True iff the article has a download score greater than
17864 @code{gnus-agent-high-score}; default 0.
17865
17866 @item spam
17867 True iff the Gnus Agent guesses that the article is spam. The
17868 heuristics may change over time, but at present it just computes a
17869 checksum and sees whether articles match.
17870
17871 @item true
17872 Always true.
17873
17874 @item false
17875 Always false.
17876 @end table
17877
17878 If you want to create your own predicate function, here's what you have
17879 to know: The functions are called with no parameters, but the
17880 @code{gnus-headers} and @code{gnus-score} dynamic variables are bound to
17881 useful values.
17882
17883 For example, you could decide that you don't want to download articles
17884 that were posted more than a certain number of days ago (e.g. posted
17885 more than @code{gnus-agent-expire-days} ago) you might write a function
17886 something along the lines of the following:
17887
17888 @lisp
17889 (defun my-article-old-p ()
17890 "Say whether an article is old."
17891 (< (time-to-days (date-to-time (mail-header-date gnus-headers)))
17892 (- (time-to-days (current-time)) gnus-agent-expire-days)))
17893 @end lisp
17894
17895 with the predicate then defined as:
17896
17897 @lisp
17898 (not my-article-old-p)
17899 @end lisp
17900
17901 or you could append your predicate to the predefined
17902 @code{gnus-category-predicate-alist} in your @file{~/.gnus.el} or
17903 wherever.
17904
17905 @lisp
17906 (require 'gnus-agent)
17907 (setq gnus-category-predicate-alist
17908 (append gnus-category-predicate-alist
17909 '((old . my-article-old-p))))
17910 @end lisp
17911
17912 and simply specify your predicate as:
17913
17914 @lisp
17915 (not old)
17916 @end lisp
17917
17918 If/when using something like the above, be aware that there are many
17919 misconfigured systems/mailers out there and so an article's date is not
17920 always a reliable indication of when it was posted. Hell, some people
17921 just don't give a damn.
17922
17923 The above predicates apply to @emph{all} the groups which belong to the
17924 category. However, if you wish to have a specific predicate for an
17925 individual group within a category, or you're just too lazy to set up a
17926 new category, you can enter a group's individual predicate in its group
17927 parameters like so:
17928
17929 @lisp
17930 (agent-predicate . short)
17931 @end lisp
17932
17933 This is the group/topic parameter equivalent of the agent category default.
17934 Note that when specifying a single word predicate like this, the
17935 @code{agent-predicate} specification must be in dotted pair notation.
17936
17937 The equivalent of the longer example from above would be:
17938
17939 @lisp
17940 (agent-predicate or high (and (not low) (not long)))
17941 @end lisp
17942
17943 The outer parenthesis required in the category specification are not
17944 entered here as, not being in dotted pair notation, the value of the
17945 predicate is assumed to be a list.
17946
17947
17948 Now, the syntax of the download score is the same as the syntax of
17949 normal score files, except that all elements that require actually
17950 seeing the article itself are verboten. This means that only the
17951 following headers can be scored on: @code{Subject}, @code{From},
17952 @code{Date}, @code{Message-ID}, @code{References}, @code{Chars},
17953 @code{Lines}, and @code{Xref}.
17954
17955 As with predicates, the specification of the @code{download score rule}
17956 to use in respect of a group can be in either the category definition if
17957 it's to be applicable to all groups in therein, or a group's parameters
17958 if it's to be specific to that group.
17959
17960 In both of these places the @code{download score rule} can take one of
17961 three forms:
17962
17963 @enumerate
17964 @item
17965 Score rule
17966
17967 This has the same syntax as a normal Gnus score file except only a
17968 subset of scoring keywords are available as mentioned above.
17969
17970 example:
17971
17972 @itemize @bullet
17973 @item
17974 Category specification
17975
17976 @lisp
17977 (("from"
17978 ("Lars Ingebrigtsen" 1000000 nil s))
17979 ("lines"
17980 (500 -100 nil <)))
17981 @end lisp
17982
17983 @item
17984 Group/Topic Parameter specification
17985
17986 @lisp
17987 (agent-score ("from"
17988 ("Lars Ingebrigtsen" 1000000 nil s))
17989 ("lines"
17990 (500 -100 nil <)))
17991 @end lisp
17992
17993 Again, note the omission of the outermost parenthesis here.
17994 @end itemize
17995
17996 @item
17997 Agent score file
17998
17999 These score files must @emph{only} contain the permitted scoring
18000 keywords stated above.
18001
18002 example:
18003
18004 @itemize @bullet
18005 @item
18006 Category specification
18007
18008 @lisp
18009 ("~/News/agent.SCORE")
18010 @end lisp
18011
18012 or perhaps
18013
18014 @lisp
18015 ("~/News/agent.SCORE" "~/News/agent.group.SCORE")
18016 @end lisp
18017
18018 @item
18019 Group Parameter specification
18020
18021 @lisp
18022 (agent-score "~/News/agent.SCORE")
18023 @end lisp
18024
18025 Additional score files can be specified as above. Need I say anything
18026 about parenthesis?
18027 @end itemize
18028
18029 @item
18030 Use @code{normal} score files
18031
18032 If you don't want to maintain two sets of scoring rules for a group, and
18033 your desired @code{downloading} criteria for a group are the same as your
18034 @code{reading} criteria then you can tell the agent to refer to your
18035 @code{normal} score files when deciding what to download.
18036
18037 These directives in either the category definition or a group's
18038 parameters will cause the agent to read in all the applicable score
18039 files for a group, @emph{filtering out} those sections that do not
18040 relate to one of the permitted subset of scoring keywords.
18041
18042 @itemize @bullet
18043 @item
18044 Category Specification
18045
18046 @lisp
18047 file
18048 @end lisp
18049
18050 @item
18051 Group Parameter specification
18052
18053 @lisp
18054 (agent-score . file)
18055 @end lisp
18056 @end itemize
18057 @end enumerate
18058
18059 @node Category Buffer
18060 @subsubsection Category Buffer
18061
18062 You'd normally do all category maintenance from the category buffer.
18063 When you enter it for the first time (with the @kbd{J c} command from
18064 the group buffer), you'll only see the @code{default} category.
18065
18066 The following commands are available in this buffer:
18067
18068 @table @kbd
18069 @item q
18070 @kindex q (Category)
18071 @findex gnus-category-exit
18072 Return to the group buffer (@code{gnus-category-exit}).
18073
18074 @item e
18075 @kindex e (Category)
18076 @findex gnus-category-customize-category
18077 Use a customization buffer to set all of the selected category's
18078 parameters at one time (@code{gnus-category-customize-category}).
18079
18080 @item k
18081 @kindex k (Category)
18082 @findex gnus-category-kill
18083 Kill the current category (@code{gnus-category-kill}).
18084
18085 @item c
18086 @kindex c (Category)
18087 @findex gnus-category-copy
18088 Copy the current category (@code{gnus-category-copy}).
18089
18090 @item a
18091 @kindex a (Category)
18092 @findex gnus-category-add
18093 Add a new category (@code{gnus-category-add}).
18094
18095 @item p
18096 @kindex p (Category)
18097 @findex gnus-category-edit-predicate
18098 Edit the predicate of the current category
18099 (@code{gnus-category-edit-predicate}).
18100
18101 @item g
18102 @kindex g (Category)
18103 @findex gnus-category-edit-groups
18104 Edit the list of groups belonging to the current category
18105 (@code{gnus-category-edit-groups}).
18106
18107 @item s
18108 @kindex s (Category)
18109 @findex gnus-category-edit-score
18110 Edit the download score rule of the current category
18111 (@code{gnus-category-edit-score}).
18112
18113 @item l
18114 @kindex l (Category)
18115 @findex gnus-category-list
18116 List all the categories (@code{gnus-category-list}).
18117 @end table
18118
18119
18120 @node Category Variables
18121 @subsubsection Category Variables
18122
18123 @table @code
18124 @item gnus-category-mode-hook
18125 @vindex gnus-category-mode-hook
18126 Hook run in category buffers.
18127
18128 @item gnus-category-line-format
18129 @vindex gnus-category-line-format
18130 Format of the lines in the category buffer (@pxref{Formatting
18131 Variables}). Valid elements are:
18132
18133 @table @samp
18134 @item c
18135 The name of the category.
18136
18137 @item g
18138 The number of groups in the category.
18139 @end table
18140
18141 @item gnus-category-mode-line-format
18142 @vindex gnus-category-mode-line-format
18143 Format of the category mode line (@pxref{Mode Line Formatting}).
18144
18145 @item gnus-agent-short-article
18146 @vindex gnus-agent-short-article
18147 Articles that have fewer lines than this are short. Default 100.
18148
18149 @item gnus-agent-long-article
18150 @vindex gnus-agent-long-article
18151 Articles that have more lines than this are long. Default 200.
18152
18153 @item gnus-agent-low-score
18154 @vindex gnus-agent-low-score
18155 Articles that have a score lower than this have a low score. Default
18156 0.
18157
18158 @item gnus-agent-high-score
18159 @vindex gnus-agent-high-score
18160 Articles that have a score higher than this have a high score. Default
18161 0.
18162
18163 @item gnus-agent-expire-days
18164 @vindex gnus-agent-expire-days
18165 The number of days that a @samp{read} article must stay in the agent's
18166 local disk before becoming eligible for expiration (While the name is
18167 the same, this doesn't mean expiring the article on the server. It
18168 just means deleting the local copy of the article). What is also
18169 important to understand is that the counter starts with the time the
18170 article was written to the local disk and not the time the article was
18171 read.
18172 Default 7.
18173
18174 @item gnus-agent-enable-expiration
18175 @vindex gnus-agent-enable-expiration
18176 Determines whether articles in a group are, by default, expired or
18177 retained indefinitely. The default is @code{ENABLE} which means that
18178 you'll have to disable expiration when desired. On the other hand,
18179 you could set this to @code{DISABLE}. In that case, you would then
18180 have to enable expiration in selected groups.
18181
18182 @end table
18183
18184
18185 @node Agent Commands
18186 @subsection Agent Commands
18187 @findex gnus-agent-toggle-plugged
18188 @kindex J j (Agent)
18189
18190 All the Gnus Agent commands are on the @kbd{J} submap. The @kbd{J j}
18191 (@code{gnus-agent-toggle-plugged}) command works in all modes, and
18192 toggles the plugged/unplugged state of the Gnus Agent.
18193
18194
18195 @menu
18196 * Group Agent Commands:: Configure groups and fetch their contents.
18197 * Summary Agent Commands:: Manually select then fetch specific articles.
18198 * Server Agent Commands:: Select the servers that are supported by the agent.
18199 @end menu
18200
18201
18202
18203
18204 @node Group Agent Commands
18205 @subsubsection Group Agent Commands
18206
18207 @table @kbd
18208 @item J u
18209 @kindex J u (Agent Group)
18210 @findex gnus-agent-fetch-groups
18211 Fetch all eligible articles in the current group
18212 (@code{gnus-agent-fetch-groups}).
18213
18214 @item J c
18215 @kindex J c (Agent Group)
18216 @findex gnus-enter-category-buffer
18217 Enter the Agent category buffer (@code{gnus-enter-category-buffer}).
18218
18219 @item J s
18220 @kindex J s (Agent Group)
18221 @findex gnus-agent-fetch-session
18222 Fetch all eligible articles in all groups
18223 (@code{gnus-agent-fetch-session}).
18224
18225 @item J S
18226 @kindex J S (Agent Group)
18227 @findex gnus-group-send-queue
18228 Send all sendable messages in the queue group
18229 (@code{gnus-group-send-queue}). @xref{Drafts}.
18230
18231 @item J a
18232 @kindex J a (Agent Group)
18233 @findex gnus-agent-add-group
18234 Add the current group to an Agent category
18235 (@code{gnus-agent-add-group}). This command understands the
18236 process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
18237
18238 @item J r
18239 @kindex J r (Agent Group)
18240 @findex gnus-agent-remove-group
18241 Remove the current group from its category, if any
18242 (@code{gnus-agent-remove-group}). This command understands the
18243 process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
18244
18245 @item J Y
18246 @kindex J Y (Agent Group)
18247 @findex gnus-agent-synchronize-flags
18248 Synchronize flags changed while unplugged with remote server, if any.
18249
18250
18251 @end table
18252
18253
18254 @node Summary Agent Commands
18255 @subsubsection Summary Agent Commands
18256
18257 @table @kbd
18258 @item J #
18259 @kindex J # (Agent Summary)
18260 @findex gnus-agent-mark-article
18261 Mark the article for downloading (@code{gnus-agent-mark-article}).
18262
18263 @item J M-#
18264 @kindex J M-# (Agent Summary)
18265 @findex gnus-agent-unmark-article
18266 Remove the downloading mark from the article
18267 (@code{gnus-agent-unmark-article}).
18268
18269 @cindex %
18270 @item @@
18271 @kindex @@ (Agent Summary)
18272 @findex gnus-agent-toggle-mark
18273 Toggle whether to download the article
18274 (@code{gnus-agent-toggle-mark}). The download mark is @samp{%} by
18275 default.
18276
18277 @item J c
18278 @kindex J c (Agent Summary)
18279 @findex gnus-agent-catchup
18280 Mark all articles as read (@code{gnus-agent-catchup}) that are neither cached, downloaded, nor downloadable.
18281
18282 @item J S
18283 @kindex J S (Agent Summary)
18284 @findex gnus-agent-fetch-group
18285 Download all eligible (@pxref{Agent Categories}) articles in this group.
18286 (@code{gnus-agent-fetch-group}).
18287
18288 @item J s
18289 @kindex J s (Agent Summary)
18290 @findex gnus-agent-fetch-series
18291 Download all processable articles in this group.
18292 (@code{gnus-agent-fetch-series}).
18293
18294 @item J u
18295 @kindex J u (Agent Summary)
18296 @findex gnus-agent-summary-fetch-group
18297 Download all downloadable articles in the current group
18298 (@code{gnus-agent-summary-fetch-group}).
18299
18300 @end table
18301
18302
18303 @node Server Agent Commands
18304 @subsubsection Server Agent Commands
18305
18306 @table @kbd
18307 @item J a
18308 @kindex J a (Agent Server)
18309 @findex gnus-agent-add-server
18310 Add the current server to the list of servers covered by the Gnus Agent
18311 (@code{gnus-agent-add-server}).
18312
18313 @item J r
18314 @kindex J r (Agent Server)
18315 @findex gnus-agent-remove-server
18316 Remove the current server from the list of servers covered by the Gnus
18317 Agent (@code{gnus-agent-remove-server}).
18318
18319 @end table
18320
18321
18322 @node Agent Visuals
18323 @subsection Agent Visuals
18324
18325 If you open a summary while unplugged and, Gnus knows from the group's
18326 active range that there are more articles than the headers currently
18327 stored in the Agent, you may see some articles whose subject looks
18328 something like @samp{[Undownloaded article #####]}. These are
18329 placeholders for the missing headers. Aside from setting a mark,
18330 there is not much that can be done with one of these placeholders.
18331 When Gnus finally gets a chance to fetch the group's headers, the
18332 placeholders will automatically be replaced by the actual headers.
18333 You can configure the summary buffer's maneuvering to skip over the
18334 placeholders if you care (See @code{gnus-auto-goto-ignores}).
18335
18336 While it may be obvious to all, the only headers and articles
18337 available while unplugged are those headers and articles that were
18338 fetched into the Agent while previously plugged. To put it another
18339 way, ``If you forget to fetch something while plugged, you might have a
18340 less than satisfying unplugged session''. For this reason, the Agent
18341 adds two visual effects to your summary buffer. These effects display
18342 the download status of each article so that you always know which
18343 articles will be available when unplugged.
18344
18345 The first visual effect is the @samp{%O} spec. If you customize
18346 @code{gnus-summary-line-format} to include this specifier, you will add
18347 a single character field that indicates an article's download status.
18348 Articles that have been fetched into either the Agent or the Cache,
18349 will display @code{gnus-downloaded-mark} (defaults to @samp{+}). All
18350 other articles will display @code{gnus-undownloaded-mark} (defaults to
18351 @samp{-}). If you open a group that has not been agentized, a space
18352 (@samp{ }) will be displayed.
18353
18354 The second visual effect are the undownloaded faces. The faces, there
18355 are three indicating the article's score (low, normal, high), seem to
18356 result in a love/hate response from many Gnus users. The problem is
18357 that the face selection is controlled by a list of condition tests and
18358 face names (See @code{gnus-summary-highlight}). Each condition is
18359 tested in the order in which it appears in the list so early
18360 conditions have precedence over later conditions. All of this means
18361 that, if you tick an undownloaded article, the article will continue
18362 to be displayed in the undownloaded face rather than the ticked face.
18363
18364 If you use the Agent as a cache (to avoid downloading the same article
18365 each time you visit it or to minimize your connection time), the
18366 undownloaded face will probably seem like a good idea. The reason
18367 being that you do all of our work (marking, reading, deleting) with
18368 downloaded articles so the normal faces always appear.
18369
18370 For occasional Agent users, the undownloaded faces may appear to be an
18371 absolutely horrible idea. The issue being that, since most of their
18372 articles have not been fetched into the Agent, most of the normal
18373 faces will be obscured by the undownloaded faces. If this is your
18374 situation, you have two choices available. First, you can completely
18375 disable the undownload faces by customizing
18376 @code{gnus-summary-highlight} to delete the three cons-cells that
18377 refer to the @code{gnus-summary-*-undownloaded-face} faces. Second,
18378 if you prefer to take a more fine-grained approach, you may set the
18379 @code{agent-disable-undownloaded-faces} group parameter to @code{t}.
18380 This parameter, like all other agent parameters, may be set on an
18381 Agent Category (@pxref{Agent Categories}), a Group Topic (@pxref{Topic
18382 Parameters}), or an individual group (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
18383
18384 @node Agent as Cache
18385 @subsection Agent as Cache
18386
18387 When Gnus is plugged, it is not efficient to download headers or
18388 articles from the server again, if they are already stored in the
18389 Agent. So, Gnus normally only downloads headers once, and stores them
18390 in the Agent. These headers are later used when generating the summary
18391 buffer, regardless of whether you are plugged or unplugged. Articles
18392 are not cached in the Agent by default though (that would potentially
18393 consume lots of disk space), but if you have already downloaded an
18394 article into the Agent, Gnus will not download the article from the
18395 server again but use the locally stored copy instead.
18396
18397 If you so desire, you can configure the agent (see @code{gnus-agent-cache}
18398 @pxref{Agent Variables}) to always download headers and articles while
18399 plugged. Gnus will almost certainly be slower, but it will be kept
18400 synchronized with the server. That last point probably won't make any
18401 sense if you are using a nntp or nnimap back end.
18402
18403 @node Agent Expiry
18404 @subsection Agent Expiry
18405
18406 @vindex gnus-agent-expire-days
18407 @findex gnus-agent-expire
18408 @kindex M-x gnus-agent-expire
18409 @kindex M-x gnus-agent-expire-group
18410 @findex gnus-agent-expire-group
18411 @cindex agent expiry
18412 @cindex Gnus agent expiry
18413 @cindex expiry
18414
18415 The Agent back end, @code{nnagent}, doesn't handle expiry. Well, at
18416 least it doesn't handle it like other back ends. Instead, there are
18417 special @code{gnus-agent-expire} and @code{gnus-agent-expire-group}
18418 commands that will expire all read articles that are older than
18419 @code{gnus-agent-expire-days} days. They can be run whenever you feel
18420 that you're running out of space. Neither are particularly fast or
18421 efficient, and it's not a particularly good idea to interrupt them (with
18422 @kbd{C-g} or anything else) once you've started one of them.
18423
18424 Note that other functions, e.g. @code{gnus-request-expire-articles},
18425 might run @code{gnus-agent-expire} for you to keep the agent
18426 synchronized with the group.
18427
18428 The agent parameter @code{agent-enable-expiration} may be used to
18429 prevent expiration in selected groups.
18430
18431 @vindex gnus-agent-expire-all
18432 If @code{gnus-agent-expire-all} is non-@code{nil}, the agent
18433 expiration commands will expire all articles---unread, read, ticked
18434 and dormant. If @code{nil} (which is the default), only read articles
18435 are eligible for expiry, and unread, ticked and dormant articles will
18436 be kept indefinitely.
18437
18438 If you find that some articles eligible for expiry are never expired,
18439 perhaps some Gnus Agent files are corrupted. There's are special
18440 commands, @code{gnus-agent-regenerate} and
18441 @code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group}, to fix possible problems.
18442
18443 @node Agent Regeneration
18444 @subsection Agent Regeneration
18445
18446 @cindex agent regeneration
18447 @cindex Gnus agent regeneration
18448 @cindex regeneration
18449
18450 The local data structures used by @code{nnagent} may become corrupted
18451 due to certain exceptional conditions. When this happens,
18452 @code{nnagent} functionality may degrade or even fail. The solution
18453 to this problem is to repair the local data structures by removing all
18454 internal inconsistencies.
18455
18456 For example, if your connection to your server is lost while
18457 downloaded articles into the agent, the local data structures will not
18458 know about articles successfully downloaded prior to the connection
18459 failure. Running @code{gnus-agent-regenerate} or
18460 @code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group} will update the data structures
18461 such that you don't need to download these articles a second time.
18462
18463 @findex gnus-agent-regenerate
18464 @kindex M-x gnus-agent-regenerate
18465 The command @code{gnus-agent-regenerate} will perform
18466 @code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group} on every agentized group. While
18467 you can run @code{gnus-agent-regenerate} in any buffer, it is strongly
18468 recommended that you first close all summary buffers.
18469
18470 @findex gnus-agent-regenerate-group
18471 @kindex M-x gnus-agent-regenerate-group
18472 The command @code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group} uses the local copies
18473 of individual articles to repair the local @acronym{NOV}(header) database. It
18474 then updates the internal data structures that document which articles
18475 are stored locally. An optional argument will mark articles in the
18476 agent as unread.
18477
18478 @node Agent and IMAP
18479 @subsection Agent and IMAP
18480
18481 The Agent works with any Gnus back end, including nnimap. However,
18482 since there are some conceptual differences between @acronym{NNTP} and
18483 @acronym{IMAP}, this section (should) provide you with some information to
18484 make Gnus Agent work smoother as a @acronym{IMAP} Disconnected Mode client.
18485
18486 The first thing to keep in mind is that all flags (read, ticked, etc)
18487 are kept on the @acronym{IMAP} server, rather than in @file{.newsrc} as is the
18488 case for nntp. Thus Gnus need to remember flag changes when
18489 disconnected, and synchronize these flags when you plug back in.
18490
18491 Gnus keeps track of flag changes when reading nnimap groups under the
18492 Agent. When you plug back in, Gnus will check if you have any changed
18493 any flags and ask if you wish to synchronize these with the server.
18494 The behavior is customizable by @code{gnus-agent-synchronize-flags}.
18495
18496 @vindex gnus-agent-synchronize-flags
18497 If @code{gnus-agent-synchronize-flags} is @code{nil}, the Agent will
18498 never automatically synchronize flags. If it is @code{ask}, which is
18499 the default, the Agent will check if you made any changes and if so
18500 ask if you wish to synchronize these when you re-connect. If it has
18501 any other value, all flags will be synchronized automatically.
18502
18503 If you do not wish to synchronize flags automatically when you
18504 re-connect, you can do it manually with the
18505 @code{gnus-agent-synchronize-flags} command that is bound to @kbd{J Y}
18506 in the group buffer.
18507
18508 Some things are currently not implemented in the Agent that you'd might
18509 expect from a disconnected @acronym{IMAP} client, including:
18510
18511 @itemize @bullet
18512
18513 @item
18514 Copying/moving articles into nnimap groups when unplugged.
18515
18516 @item
18517 Creating/deleting nnimap groups when unplugged.
18518
18519 @end itemize
18520
18521 Technical note: the synchronization algorithm does not work by ``pushing''
18522 all local flags to the server, but rather incrementally update the
18523 server view of flags by changing only those flags that were changed by
18524 the user. Thus, if you set one flag on an article, quit the group and
18525 re-select the group and remove the flag; the flag will be set and
18526 removed from the server when you ``synchronize''. The queued flag
18527 operations can be found in the per-server @code{flags} file in the Agent
18528 directory. It's emptied when you synchronize flags.
18529
18530
18531 @node Outgoing Messages
18532 @subsection Outgoing Messages
18533
18534 When Gnus is unplugged, all outgoing messages (both mail and news) are
18535 stored in the draft group ``queue'' (@pxref{Drafts}). You can view
18536 them there after posting, and edit them at will.
18537
18538 When Gnus is plugged again, you can send the messages either from the
18539 draft group with the special commands available there, or you can use
18540 the @kbd{J S} command in the group buffer to send all the sendable
18541 messages in the draft group.
18542
18543
18544
18545 @node Agent Variables
18546 @subsection Agent Variables
18547
18548 @table @code
18549 @item gnus-agent-directory
18550 @vindex gnus-agent-directory
18551 Where the Gnus Agent will store its files. The default is
18552 @file{~/News/agent/}.
18553
18554 @item gnus-agent-handle-level
18555 @vindex gnus-agent-handle-level
18556 Groups on levels (@pxref{Group Levels}) higher than this variable will
18557 be ignored by the Agent. The default is @code{gnus-level-subscribed},
18558 which means that only subscribed group will be considered by the Agent
18559 by default.
18560
18561 @item gnus-agent-plugged-hook
18562 @vindex gnus-agent-plugged-hook
18563 Hook run when connecting to the network.
18564
18565 @item gnus-agent-unplugged-hook
18566 @vindex gnus-agent-unplugged-hook
18567 Hook run when disconnecting from the network.
18568
18569 @item gnus-agent-fetched-hook
18570 @vindex gnus-agent-fetched-hook
18571 Hook run when finished fetching articles.
18572
18573 @item gnus-agent-cache
18574 @vindex gnus-agent-cache
18575 Variable to control whether use the locally stored @acronym{NOV} and
18576 articles when plugged, e.g. essentially using the Agent as a cache.
18577 The default is non-@code{nil}, which means to use the Agent as a cache.
18578
18579 @item gnus-agent-go-online
18580 @vindex gnus-agent-go-online
18581 If @code{gnus-agent-go-online} is @code{nil}, the Agent will never
18582 automatically switch offline servers into online status. If it is
18583 @code{ask}, the default, the Agent will ask if you wish to switch
18584 offline servers into online status when you re-connect. If it has any
18585 other value, all offline servers will be automatically switched into
18586 online status.
18587
18588 @item gnus-agent-mark-unread-after-downloaded
18589 @vindex gnus-agent-mark-unread-after-downloaded
18590 If @code{gnus-agent-mark-unread-after-downloaded} is non-@code{nil},
18591 mark articles as unread after downloading. This is usually a safe
18592 thing to do as the newly downloaded article has obviously not been
18593 read. The default is @code{t}.
18594
18595 @item gnus-agent-consider-all-articles
18596 @vindex gnus-agent-consider-all-articles
18597 If @code{gnus-agent-consider-all-articles} is non-@code{nil}, the
18598 agent will let the agent predicate decide whether articles need to be
18599 downloaded or not, for all articles. When @code{nil}, the default,
18600 the agent will only let the predicate decide whether unread articles
18601 are downloaded or not. If you enable this, you may also want to look
18602 into the agent expiry settings (@pxref{Category Variables}), so that
18603 the agent doesn't download articles which the agent will later expire,
18604 over and over again.
18605
18606 @item gnus-agent-max-fetch-size
18607 @vindex gnus-agent-max-fetch-size
18608 The agent fetches articles into a temporary buffer prior to parsing
18609 them into individual files. To avoid exceeding the max. buffer size,
18610 the agent alternates between fetching and parsing until all articles
18611 have been fetched. @code{gnus-agent-max-fetch-size} provides a size
18612 limit to control how often the cycling occurs. A large value improves
18613 performance. A small value minimizes the time lost should the
18614 connection be lost while fetching (You may need to run
18615 @code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group} to update the group's state.
18616 However, all articles parsed prior to loosing the connection will be
18617 available while unplugged). The default is 10M so it is unusual to
18618 see any cycling.
18619
18620 @item gnus-server-unopen-status
18621 @vindex gnus-server-unopen-status
18622 Perhaps not an Agent variable, but closely related to the Agent, this
18623 variable says what will happen if Gnus cannot open a server. If the
18624 Agent is enabled, the default, @code{nil}, makes Gnus ask the user
18625 whether to deny the server or whether to unplug the agent. If the
18626 Agent is disabled, Gnus always simply deny the server. Other choices
18627 for this variable include @code{denied} and @code{offline} the latter
18628 is only valid if the Agent is used.
18629
18630 @item gnus-auto-goto-ignores
18631 @vindex gnus-auto-goto-ignores
18632 Another variable that isn't an Agent variable, yet so closely related
18633 that most will look for it here, this variable tells the summary
18634 buffer how to maneuver around undownloaded (only headers stored in the
18635 agent) and unfetched (neither article nor headers stored) articles.
18636
18637 The valid values are @code{nil} (maneuver to any article),
18638 @code{undownloaded} (maneuvering while unplugged ignores articles that
18639 have not been fetched), @code{always-undownloaded} (maneuvering always
18640 ignores articles that have not been fetched), @code{unfetched}
18641 (maneuvering ignores articles whose headers have not been fetched).
18642
18643 @item gnus-agent-auto-agentize-methods
18644 @vindex gnus-agent-auto-agentize-methods
18645 If you have never used the Agent before (or more technically, if
18646 @file{~/News/agent/lib/servers} does not exist), Gnus will
18647 automatically agentize a few servers for you. This variable control
18648 which backends should be auto-agentized. It is typically only useful
18649 to agentize remote backends. The auto-agentizing has the same effect
18650 as running @kbd{J a} on the servers (@pxref{Server Agent Commands}).
18651 If the file exist, you must manage the servers manually by adding or
18652 removing them, this variable is only applicable the first time you
18653 start Gnus. The default is @samp{(nntp nnimap)}.
18654
18655 @end table
18656
18657
18658 @node Example Setup
18659 @subsection Example Setup
18660
18661 If you don't want to read this manual, and you have a fairly standard
18662 setup, you may be able to use something like the following as your
18663 @file{~/.gnus.el} file to get started.
18664
18665 @lisp
18666 ;;; @r{Define how Gnus is to fetch news. We do this over @acronym{NNTP}}
18667 ;;; @r{from your ISP's server.}
18668 (setq gnus-select-method '(nntp "news.your-isp.com"))
18669
18670 ;;; @r{Define how Gnus is to read your mail. We read mail from}
18671 ;;; @r{your ISP's @acronym{POP} server.}
18672 (setq mail-sources '((pop :server "pop.your-isp.com")))
18673
18674 ;;; @r{Say how Gnus is to store the mail. We use nnml groups.}
18675 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods '((nnml "")))
18676
18677 ;;; @r{Make Gnus into an offline newsreader.}
18678 ;;; (gnus-agentize) ; @r{The obsolete setting.}
18679 ;;; (setq gnus-agent t) ; @r{Now the default.}
18680 @end lisp
18681
18682 That should be it, basically. Put that in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file,
18683 edit to suit your needs, start up PPP (or whatever), and type @kbd{M-x
18684 gnus}.
18685
18686 If this is the first time you've run Gnus, you will be subscribed
18687 automatically to a few default newsgroups. You'll probably want to
18688 subscribe to more groups, and to do that, you have to query the
18689 @acronym{NNTP} server for a complete list of groups with the @kbd{A A}
18690 command. This usually takes quite a while, but you only have to do it
18691 once.
18692
18693 After reading and parsing a while, you'll be presented with a list of
18694 groups. Subscribe to the ones you want to read with the @kbd{u}
18695 command. @kbd{l} to make all the killed groups disappear after you've
18696 subscribe to all the groups you want to read. (@kbd{A k} will bring
18697 back all the killed groups.)
18698
18699 You can now read the groups at once, or you can download the articles
18700 with the @kbd{J s} command. And then read the rest of this manual to
18701 find out which of the other gazillion things you want to customize.
18702
18703
18704 @node Batching Agents
18705 @subsection Batching Agents
18706 @findex gnus-agent-batch
18707
18708 Having the Gnus Agent fetch articles (and post whatever messages you've
18709 written) is quite easy once you've gotten things set up properly. The
18710 following shell script will do everything that is necessary:
18711
18712 You can run a complete batch command from the command line with the
18713 following incantation:
18714
18715 @example
18716 #!/bin/sh
18717 emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs -l ~/.gnus.el gnus-agent-batch >/dev/null 2>&1
18718 @end example
18719
18720
18721 @node Agent Caveats
18722 @subsection Agent Caveats
18723
18724 The Gnus Agent doesn't seem to work like most other offline
18725 newsreaders. Here are some common questions that some imaginary people
18726 may ask:
18727
18728 @table @dfn
18729 @item If I read an article while plugged, do they get entered into the Agent?
18730
18731 @strong{No}. If you want this behavior, add
18732 @code{gnus-agent-fetch-selected-article} to
18733 @code{gnus-select-article-hook}.
18734
18735 @item If I read an article while plugged, and the article already exists in
18736 the Agent, will it get downloaded once more?
18737
18738 @strong{No}, unless @code{gnus-agent-cache} is @code{nil}.
18739
18740 @end table
18741
18742 In short, when Gnus is unplugged, it only looks into the locally stored
18743 articles; when it's plugged, it talks to your ISP and may also use the
18744 locally stored articles.
18745
18746
18747 @node Scoring
18748 @chapter Scoring
18749 @cindex scoring
18750
18751 Other people use @dfn{kill files}, but we here at Gnus Towers like
18752 scoring better than killing, so we'd rather switch than fight. They do
18753 something completely different as well, so sit up straight and pay
18754 attention!
18755
18756 @vindex gnus-summary-mark-below
18757 All articles have a default score (@code{gnus-summary-default-score}),
18758 which is 0 by default. This score may be raised or lowered either
18759 interactively or by score files. Articles that have a score lower than
18760 @code{gnus-summary-mark-below} are marked as read.
18761
18762 Gnus will read any @dfn{score files} that apply to the current group
18763 before generating the summary buffer.
18764
18765 There are several commands in the summary buffer that insert score
18766 entries based on the current article. You can, for instance, ask Gnus to
18767 lower or increase the score of all articles with a certain subject.
18768
18769 There are two sorts of scoring entries: Permanent and temporary.
18770 Temporary score entries are self-expiring entries. Any entries that are
18771 temporary and have not been used for, say, a week, will be removed
18772 silently to help keep the sizes of the score files down.
18773
18774 @menu
18775 * Summary Score Commands:: Adding score entries for the current group.
18776 * Group Score Commands:: General score commands.
18777 * Score Variables:: Customize your scoring. (My, what terminology).
18778 * Score File Format:: What a score file may contain.
18779 * Score File Editing:: You can edit score files by hand as well.
18780 * Adaptive Scoring:: Big Sister Gnus knows what you read.
18781 * Home Score File:: How to say where new score entries are to go.
18782 * Followups To Yourself:: Having Gnus notice when people answer you.
18783 * Scoring On Other Headers:: Scoring on non-standard headers.
18784 * Scoring Tips:: How to score effectively.
18785 * Reverse Scoring:: That problem child of old is not problem.
18786 * Global Score Files:: Earth-spanning, ear-splitting score files.
18787 * Kill Files:: They are still here, but they can be ignored.
18788 * Converting Kill Files:: Translating kill files to score files.
18789 * GroupLens:: Getting predictions on what you like to read.
18790 * Advanced Scoring:: Using logical expressions to build score rules.
18791 * Score Decays:: It can be useful to let scores wither away.
18792 @end menu
18793
18794
18795 @node Summary Score Commands
18796 @section Summary Score Commands
18797 @cindex score commands
18798
18799 The score commands that alter score entries do not actually modify real
18800 score files. That would be too inefficient. Gnus maintains a cache of
18801 previously loaded score files, one of which is considered the
18802 @dfn{current score file alist}. The score commands simply insert
18803 entries into this list, and upon group exit, this list is saved.
18804
18805 The current score file is by default the group's local score file, even
18806 if no such score file actually exists. To insert score commands into
18807 some other score file (e.g. @file{all.SCORE}), you must first make this
18808 score file the current one.
18809
18810 General score commands that don't actually change the score file:
18811
18812 @table @kbd
18813
18814 @item V s
18815 @kindex V s (Summary)
18816 @findex gnus-summary-set-score
18817 Set the score of the current article (@code{gnus-summary-set-score}).
18818
18819 @item V S
18820 @kindex V S (Summary)
18821 @findex gnus-summary-current-score
18822 Display the score of the current article
18823 (@code{gnus-summary-current-score}).
18824
18825 @item V t
18826 @kindex V t (Summary)
18827 @findex gnus-score-find-trace
18828 Display all score rules that have been used on the current article
18829 (@code{gnus-score-find-trace}). In the @code{*Score Trace*} buffer, you
18830 may type @kbd{e} to edit score file corresponding to the score rule on
18831 current line and @kbd{f} to format (@code{gnus-score-pretty-print}) the
18832 score file and edit it.
18833
18834 @item V w
18835 @kindex V w (Summary)
18836 @findex gnus-score-find-favourite-words
18837 List words used in scoring (@code{gnus-score-find-favourite-words}).
18838
18839 @item V R
18840 @kindex V R (Summary)
18841 @findex gnus-summary-rescore
18842 Run the current summary through the scoring process
18843 (@code{gnus-summary-rescore}). This might be useful if you're playing
18844 around with your score files behind Gnus' back and want to see the
18845 effect you're having.
18846
18847 @item V c
18848 @kindex V c (Summary)
18849 @findex gnus-score-change-score-file
18850 Make a different score file the current
18851 (@code{gnus-score-change-score-file}).
18852
18853 @item V e
18854 @kindex V e (Summary)
18855 @findex gnus-score-edit-current-scores
18856 Edit the current score file (@code{gnus-score-edit-current-scores}).
18857 You will be popped into a @code{gnus-score-mode} buffer (@pxref{Score
18858 File Editing}).
18859
18860 @item V f
18861 @kindex V f (Summary)
18862 @findex gnus-score-edit-file
18863 Edit a score file and make this score file the current one
18864 (@code{gnus-score-edit-file}).
18865
18866 @item V F
18867 @kindex V F (Summary)
18868 @findex gnus-score-flush-cache
18869 Flush the score cache (@code{gnus-score-flush-cache}). This is useful
18870 after editing score files.
18871
18872 @item V C
18873 @kindex V C (Summary)
18874 @findex gnus-score-customize
18875 Customize a score file in a visually pleasing manner
18876 (@code{gnus-score-customize}).
18877
18878 @end table
18879
18880 The rest of these commands modify the local score file.
18881
18882 @table @kbd
18883
18884 @item V m
18885 @kindex V m (Summary)
18886 @findex gnus-score-set-mark-below
18887 Prompt for a score, and mark all articles with a score below this as
18888 read (@code{gnus-score-set-mark-below}).
18889
18890 @item V x
18891 @kindex V x (Summary)
18892 @findex gnus-score-set-expunge-below
18893 Prompt for a score, and add a score rule to the current score file to
18894 expunge all articles below this score
18895 (@code{gnus-score-set-expunge-below}).
18896 @end table
18897
18898 The keystrokes for actually making score entries follow a very regular
18899 pattern, so there's no need to list all the commands. (Hundreds of
18900 them.)
18901
18902 @findex gnus-summary-increase-score
18903 @findex gnus-summary-lower-score
18904
18905 @enumerate
18906 @item
18907 The first key is either @kbd{I} (upper case i) for increasing the score
18908 or @kbd{L} for lowering the score.
18909 @item
18910 The second key says what header you want to score on. The following
18911 keys are available:
18912 @table @kbd
18913
18914 @item a
18915 Score on the author name.
18916
18917 @item s
18918 Score on the subject line.
18919
18920 @item x
18921 Score on the @code{Xref} line---i.e., the cross-posting line.
18922
18923 @item r
18924 Score on the @code{References} line.
18925
18926 @item d
18927 Score on the date.
18928
18929 @item l
18930 Score on the number of lines.
18931
18932 @item i
18933 Score on the @code{Message-ID} header.
18934
18935 @item e
18936 Score on an ``extra'' header, that is, one of those in gnus-extra-headers,
18937 if your @acronym{NNTP} server tracks additional header data in overviews.
18938
18939 @item f
18940 Score on followups---this matches the author name, and adds scores to
18941 the followups to this author. (Using this key leads to the creation of
18942 @file{ADAPT} files.)
18943
18944 @item b
18945 Score on the body.
18946
18947 @item h
18948 Score on the head.
18949
18950 @item t
18951 Score on thread. (Using this key leads to the creation of @file{ADAPT}
18952 files.)
18953
18954 @end table
18955
18956 @item
18957 The third key is the match type. Which match types are valid depends on
18958 what headers you are scoring on.
18959
18960 @table @code
18961
18962 @item strings
18963
18964 @table @kbd
18965
18966 @item e
18967 Exact matching.
18968
18969 @item s
18970 Substring matching.
18971
18972 @item f
18973 Fuzzy matching (@pxref{Fuzzy Matching}).
18974
18975 @item r
18976 Regexp matching
18977 @end table
18978
18979 @item date
18980 @table @kbd
18981
18982 @item b
18983 Before date.
18984
18985 @item a
18986 After date.
18987
18988 @item n
18989 This date.
18990 @end table
18991
18992 @item number
18993 @table @kbd
18994
18995 @item <
18996 Less than number.
18997
18998 @item =
18999 Equal to number.
19000
19001 @item >
19002 Greater than number.
19003 @end table
19004 @end table
19005
19006 @item
19007 The fourth and usually final key says whether this is a temporary (i.e.,
19008 expiring) score entry, or a permanent (i.e., non-expiring) score entry,
19009 or whether it is to be done immediately, without adding to the score
19010 file.
19011 @table @kbd
19012
19013 @item t
19014 Temporary score entry.
19015
19016 @item p
19017 Permanent score entry.
19018
19019 @item i
19020 Immediately scoring.
19021 @end table
19022
19023 @item
19024 If you are scoring on `e' (extra) headers, you will then be prompted for
19025 the header name on which you wish to score. This must be a header named
19026 in gnus-extra-headers, and @samp{TAB} completion is available.
19027
19028 @end enumerate
19029
19030 So, let's say you want to increase the score on the current author with
19031 exact matching permanently: @kbd{I a e p}. If you want to lower the
19032 score based on the subject line, using substring matching, and make a
19033 temporary score entry: @kbd{L s s t}. Pretty easy.
19034
19035 To make things a bit more complicated, there are shortcuts. If you use
19036 a capital letter on either the second or third keys, Gnus will use
19037 defaults for the remaining one or two keystrokes. The defaults are
19038 ``substring'' and ``temporary''. So @kbd{I A} is the same as @kbd{I a s
19039 t}, and @kbd{I a R} is the same as @kbd{I a r t}.
19040
19041 These functions take both the numerical prefix and the symbolic prefix
19042 (@pxref{Symbolic Prefixes}). A numerical prefix says how much to lower
19043 (or increase) the score of the article. A symbolic prefix of @code{a}
19044 says to use the @file{all.SCORE} file for the command instead of the
19045 current score file.
19046
19047 @vindex gnus-score-mimic-keymap
19048 The @code{gnus-score-mimic-keymap} says whether these commands will
19049 pretend they are keymaps or not.
19050
19051
19052 @node Group Score Commands
19053 @section Group Score Commands
19054 @cindex group score commands
19055
19056 There aren't many of these as yet, I'm afraid.
19057
19058 @table @kbd
19059
19060 @item W f
19061 @kindex W f (Group)
19062 @findex gnus-score-flush-cache
19063 Gnus maintains a cache of score alists to avoid having to reload them
19064 all the time. This command will flush the cache
19065 (@code{gnus-score-flush-cache}).
19066
19067 @end table
19068
19069 You can do scoring from the command line by saying something like:
19070
19071 @findex gnus-batch-score
19072 @cindex batch scoring
19073 @example
19074 $ emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs -l ~/.gnus.el -f gnus-batch-score
19075 @end example
19076
19077
19078 @node Score Variables
19079 @section Score Variables
19080 @cindex score variables
19081
19082 @table @code
19083
19084 @item gnus-use-scoring
19085 @vindex gnus-use-scoring
19086 If @code{nil}, Gnus will not check for score files, and will not, in
19087 general, do any score-related work. This is @code{t} by default.
19088
19089 @item gnus-kill-killed
19090 @vindex gnus-kill-killed
19091 If this variable is @code{nil}, Gnus will never apply score files to
19092 articles that have already been through the kill process. While this
19093 may save you lots of time, it also means that if you apply a kill file
19094 to a group, and then change the kill file and want to run it over you
19095 group again to kill more articles, it won't work. You have to set this
19096 variable to @code{t} to do that. (It is @code{t} by default.)
19097
19098 @item gnus-kill-files-directory
19099 @vindex gnus-kill-files-directory
19100 All kill and score files will be stored in this directory, which is
19101 initialized from the @env{SAVEDIR} environment variable by default.
19102 This is @file{~/News/} by default.
19103
19104 @item gnus-score-file-suffix
19105 @vindex gnus-score-file-suffix
19106 Suffix to add to the group name to arrive at the score file name
19107 (@file{SCORE} by default.)
19108
19109 @item gnus-score-uncacheable-files
19110 @vindex gnus-score-uncacheable-files
19111 @cindex score cache
19112 All score files are normally cached to avoid excessive re-loading of
19113 score files. However, if this might make your Emacs grow big and
19114 bloated, so this regexp can be used to weed out score files unlikely
19115 to be needed again. It would be a bad idea to deny caching of
19116 @file{all.SCORE}, while it might be a good idea to not cache
19117 @file{comp.infosystems.www.authoring.misc.ADAPT}. In fact, this
19118 variable is @samp{ADAPT$} by default, so no adaptive score files will
19119 be cached.
19120
19121 @item gnus-save-score
19122 @vindex gnus-save-score
19123 If you have really complicated score files, and do lots of batch
19124 scoring, then you might set this variable to @code{t}. This will make
19125 Gnus save the scores into the @file{.newsrc.eld} file.
19126
19127 If you do not set this to @code{t}, then manual scores (like those set
19128 with @kbd{V s} (@code{gnus-summary-set-score})) will not be preserved
19129 across group visits.
19130
19131 @item gnus-score-interactive-default-score
19132 @vindex gnus-score-interactive-default-score
19133 Score used by all the interactive raise/lower commands to raise/lower
19134 score with. Default is 1000, which may seem excessive, but this is to
19135 ensure that the adaptive scoring scheme gets enough room to play with.
19136 We don't want the small changes from the adaptive scoring to overwrite
19137 manually entered data.
19138
19139 @item gnus-summary-default-score
19140 @vindex gnus-summary-default-score
19141 Default score of an article, which is 0 by default.
19142
19143 @item gnus-summary-expunge-below
19144 @vindex gnus-summary-expunge-below
19145 Don't display the summary lines of articles that have scores lower than
19146 this variable. This is @code{nil} by default, which means that no
19147 articles will be hidden. This variable is local to the summary buffers,
19148 and has to be set from @code{gnus-summary-mode-hook}.
19149
19150 @item gnus-score-over-mark
19151 @vindex gnus-score-over-mark
19152 Mark (in the third column) used for articles with a score over the
19153 default. Default is @samp{+}.
19154
19155 @item gnus-score-below-mark
19156 @vindex gnus-score-below-mark
19157 Mark (in the third column) used for articles with a score below the
19158 default. Default is @samp{-}.
19159
19160 @item gnus-score-find-score-files-function
19161 @vindex gnus-score-find-score-files-function
19162 Function used to find score files for the current group. This function
19163 is called with the name of the group as the argument.
19164
19165 Predefined functions available are:
19166 @table @code
19167
19168 @item gnus-score-find-single
19169 @findex gnus-score-find-single
19170 Only apply the group's own score file.
19171
19172 @item gnus-score-find-bnews
19173 @findex gnus-score-find-bnews
19174 Apply all score files that match, using bnews syntax. This is the
19175 default. If the current group is @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus}, for instance,
19176 @file{all.emacs.all.SCORE}, @file{not.alt.all.SCORE} and
19177 @file{gnu.all.SCORE} would all apply. In short, the instances of
19178 @samp{all} in the score file names are translated into @samp{.*}, and
19179 then a regexp match is done.
19180
19181 This means that if you have some score entries that you want to apply to
19182 all groups, then you put those entries in the @file{all.SCORE} file.
19183
19184 The score files are applied in a semi-random order, although Gnus will
19185 try to apply the more general score files before the more specific score
19186 files. It does this by looking at the number of elements in the score
19187 file names---discarding the @samp{all} elements.
19188
19189 @item gnus-score-find-hierarchical
19190 @findex gnus-score-find-hierarchical
19191 Apply all score files from all the parent groups. This means that you
19192 can't have score files like @file{all.SCORE}, but you can have
19193 @file{SCORE}, @file{comp.SCORE} and @file{comp.emacs.SCORE} for each
19194 server.
19195
19196 @end table
19197 This variable can also be a list of functions. In that case, all
19198 these functions will be called with the group name as argument, and
19199 all the returned lists of score files will be applied. These
19200 functions can also return lists of lists of score alists directly. In
19201 that case, the functions that return these non-file score alists
19202 should probably be placed before the ``real'' score file functions, to
19203 ensure that the last score file returned is the local score file.
19204 Phu.
19205
19206 For example, to do hierarchical scoring but use a non-server-specific
19207 overall score file, you could use the value
19208 @example
19209 (list (lambda (group) ("all.SCORE"))
19210 'gnus-score-find-hierarchical)
19211 @end example
19212
19213 @item gnus-score-expiry-days
19214 @vindex gnus-score-expiry-days
19215 This variable says how many days should pass before an unused score file
19216 entry is expired. If this variable is @code{nil}, no score file entries
19217 are expired. It's 7 by default.
19218
19219 @item gnus-update-score-entry-dates
19220 @vindex gnus-update-score-entry-dates
19221 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, temporary score entries that have
19222 been triggered (matched) will have their dates updated. (This is how Gnus
19223 controls expiry---all non-matched-entries will become too old while
19224 matched entries will stay fresh and young.) However, if you set this
19225 variable to @code{nil}, even matched entries will grow old and will
19226 have to face that oh-so grim reaper.
19227
19228 @item gnus-score-after-write-file-function
19229 @vindex gnus-score-after-write-file-function
19230 Function called with the name of the score file just written.
19231
19232 @item gnus-score-thread-simplify
19233 @vindex gnus-score-thread-simplify
19234 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, article subjects will be
19235 simplified for subject scoring purposes in the same manner as with
19236 threading---according to the current value of
19237 @code{gnus-simplify-subject-functions}. If the scoring entry uses
19238 @code{substring} or @code{exact} matching, the match will also be
19239 simplified in this manner.
19240
19241 @end table
19242
19243
19244 @node Score File Format
19245 @section Score File Format
19246 @cindex score file format
19247
19248 A score file is an @code{emacs-lisp} file that normally contains just a
19249 single form. Casual users are not expected to edit these files;
19250 everything can be changed from the summary buffer.
19251
19252 Anyway, if you'd like to dig into it yourself, here's an example:
19253
19254 @lisp
19255 (("from"
19256 ("Lars Ingebrigtsen" -10000)
19257 ("Per Abrahamsen")
19258 ("larsi\\|lmi" -50000 nil R))
19259 ("subject"
19260 ("Ding is Badd" nil 728373))
19261 ("xref"
19262 ("alt.politics" -1000 728372 s))
19263 ("lines"
19264 (2 -100 nil <))
19265 (mark 0)
19266 (expunge -1000)
19267 (mark-and-expunge -10)
19268 (read-only nil)
19269 (orphan -10)
19270 (adapt t)
19271 (files "/hom/larsi/News/gnu.SCORE")
19272 (exclude-files "all.SCORE")
19273 (local (gnus-newsgroup-auto-expire t)
19274 (gnus-summary-make-false-root empty))
19275 (eval (ding)))
19276 @end lisp
19277
19278 This example demonstrates most score file elements. @xref{Advanced
19279 Scoring}, for a different approach.
19280
19281 Even though this looks much like Lisp code, nothing here is actually
19282 @code{eval}ed. The Lisp reader is used to read this form, though, so it
19283 has to be valid syntactically, if not semantically.
19284
19285 Six keys are supported by this alist:
19286
19287 @table @code
19288
19289 @item STRING
19290 If the key is a string, it is the name of the header to perform the
19291 match on. Scoring can only be performed on these eight headers:
19292 @code{From}, @code{Subject}, @code{References}, @code{Message-ID},
19293 @code{Xref}, @code{Lines}, @code{Chars} and @code{Date}. In addition to
19294 these headers, there are three strings to tell Gnus to fetch the entire
19295 article and do the match on larger parts of the article: @code{Body}
19296 will perform the match on the body of the article, @code{Head} will
19297 perform the match on the head of the article, and @code{All} will
19298 perform the match on the entire article. Note that using any of these
19299 last three keys will slow down group entry @emph{considerably}. The
19300 final ``header'' you can score on is @code{Followup}. These score
19301 entries will result in new score entries being added for all follow-ups
19302 to articles that matches these score entries.
19303
19304 Following this key is an arbitrary number of score entries, where each
19305 score entry has one to four elements.
19306 @enumerate
19307
19308 @item
19309 The first element is the @dfn{match element}. On most headers this will
19310 be a string, but on the Lines and Chars headers, this must be an
19311 integer.
19312
19313 @item
19314 If the second element is present, it should be a number---the @dfn{score
19315 element}. This number should be an integer in the neginf to posinf
19316 interval. This number is added to the score of the article if the match
19317 is successful. If this element is not present, the
19318 @code{gnus-score-interactive-default-score} number will be used
19319 instead. This is 1000 by default.
19320
19321 @item
19322 If the third element is present, it should be a number---the @dfn{date
19323 element}. This date says when the last time this score entry matched,
19324 which provides a mechanism for expiring the score entries. It this
19325 element is not present, the score entry is permanent. The date is
19326 represented by the number of days since December 31, 1 BCE.
19327
19328 @item
19329 If the fourth element is present, it should be a symbol---the @dfn{type
19330 element}. This element specifies what function should be used to see
19331 whether this score entry matches the article. What match types that can
19332 be used depends on what header you wish to perform the match on.
19333 @table @dfn
19334
19335 @item From, Subject, References, Xref, Message-ID
19336 For most header types, there are the @code{r} and @code{R} (regexp), as
19337 well as @code{s} and @code{S} (substring) types, and @code{e} and
19338 @code{E} (exact match), and @code{w} (word match) types. If this
19339 element is not present, Gnus will assume that substring matching should
19340 be used. @code{R}, @code{S}, and @code{E} differ from the others in
19341 that the matches will be done in a case-sensitive manner. All these
19342 one-letter types are really just abbreviations for the @code{regexp},
19343 @code{string}, @code{exact}, and @code{word} types, which you can use
19344 instead, if you feel like.
19345
19346 @item Extra
19347 Just as for the standard string overview headers, if you are using
19348 gnus-extra-headers, you can score on these headers' values. In this
19349 case, there is a 5th element in the score entry, being the name of the
19350 header to be scored. The following entry is useful in your
19351 @file{all.SCORE} file in case of spam attacks from a single origin
19352 host, if your @acronym{NNTP} server tracks @samp{NNTP-Posting-Host} in
19353 overviews:
19354
19355 @lisp
19356 ("111.222.333.444" -1000 nil s
19357 "NNTP-Posting-Host")
19358 @end lisp
19359
19360 @item Lines, Chars
19361 These two headers use different match types: @code{<}, @code{>},
19362 @code{=}, @code{>=} and @code{<=}.
19363
19364 These predicates are true if
19365
19366 @example
19367 (PREDICATE HEADER MATCH)
19368 @end example
19369
19370 evaluates to non-@code{nil}. For instance, the advanced match
19371 @code{("lines" 4 <)} (@pxref{Advanced Scoring}) will result in the
19372 following form:
19373
19374 @lisp
19375 (< header-value 4)
19376 @end lisp
19377
19378 Or to put it another way: When using @code{<} on @code{Lines} with 4 as
19379 the match, we get the score added if the article has less than 4 lines.
19380 (It's easy to get confused and think it's the other way around. But
19381 it's not. I think.)
19382
19383 When matching on @code{Lines}, be careful because some back ends (like
19384 @code{nndir}) do not generate @code{Lines} header, so every article ends
19385 up being marked as having 0 lines. This can lead to strange results if
19386 you happen to lower score of the articles with few lines.
19387
19388 @item Date
19389 For the Date header we have three kinda silly match types:
19390 @code{before}, @code{at} and @code{after}. I can't really imagine this
19391 ever being useful, but, like, it would feel kinda silly not to provide
19392 this function. Just in case. You never know. Better safe than sorry.
19393 Once burnt, twice shy. Don't judge a book by its cover. Never not have
19394 sex on a first date. (I have been told that at least one person, and I
19395 quote, ``found this function indispensable'', however.)
19396
19397 @cindex ISO8601
19398 @cindex date
19399 A more useful match type is @code{regexp}. With it, you can match the
19400 date string using a regular expression. The date is normalized to
19401 ISO8601 compact format first---@var{YYYYMMDD}@code{T}@var{HHMMSS}. If
19402 you want to match all articles that have been posted on April 1st in
19403 every year, you could use @samp{....0401.........} as a match string,
19404 for instance. (Note that the date is kept in its original time zone, so
19405 this will match articles that were posted when it was April 1st where
19406 the article was posted from. Time zones are such wholesome fun for the
19407 whole family, eh?)
19408
19409 @item Head, Body, All
19410 These three match keys use the same match types as the @code{From} (etc)
19411 header uses.
19412
19413 @item Followup
19414 This match key is somewhat special, in that it will match the
19415 @code{From} header, and affect the score of not only the matching
19416 articles, but also all followups to the matching articles. This allows
19417 you e.g. increase the score of followups to your own articles, or
19418 decrease the score of followups to the articles of some known
19419 trouble-maker. Uses the same match types as the @code{From} header
19420 uses. (Using this match key will lead to creation of @file{ADAPT}
19421 files.)
19422
19423 @item Thread
19424 This match key works along the same lines as the @code{Followup} match
19425 key. If you say that you want to score on a (sub-)thread started by an
19426 article with a @code{Message-ID} @var{x}, then you add a @samp{thread}
19427 match. This will add a new @samp{thread} match for each article that
19428 has @var{x} in its @code{References} header. (These new @samp{thread}
19429 matches will use the @code{Message-ID}s of these matching articles.)
19430 This will ensure that you can raise/lower the score of an entire thread,
19431 even though some articles in the thread may not have complete
19432 @code{References} headers. Note that using this may lead to
19433 undeterministic scores of the articles in the thread. (Using this match
19434 key will lead to creation of @file{ADAPT} files.)
19435 @end table
19436 @end enumerate
19437
19438 @cindex score file atoms
19439 @item mark
19440 The value of this entry should be a number. Any articles with a score
19441 lower than this number will be marked as read.
19442
19443 @item expunge
19444 The value of this entry should be a number. Any articles with a score
19445 lower than this number will be removed from the summary buffer.
19446
19447 @item mark-and-expunge
19448 The value of this entry should be a number. Any articles with a score
19449 lower than this number will be marked as read and removed from the
19450 summary buffer.
19451
19452 @item thread-mark-and-expunge
19453 The value of this entry should be a number. All articles that belong to
19454 a thread that has a total score below this number will be marked as read
19455 and removed from the summary buffer. @code{gnus-thread-score-function}
19456 says how to compute the total score for a thread.
19457
19458 @item files
19459 The value of this entry should be any number of file names. These files
19460 are assumed to be score files as well, and will be loaded the same way
19461 this one was.
19462
19463 @item exclude-files
19464 The clue of this entry should be any number of files. These files will
19465 not be loaded, even though they would normally be so, for some reason or
19466 other.
19467
19468 @item eval
19469 The value of this entry will be @code{eval}el. This element will be
19470 ignored when handling global score files.
19471
19472 @item read-only
19473 Read-only score files will not be updated or saved. Global score files
19474 should feature this atom (@pxref{Global Score Files}). (Note:
19475 @dfn{Global} here really means @dfn{global}; not your personal
19476 apply-to-all-groups score files.)
19477
19478 @item orphan
19479 The value of this entry should be a number. Articles that do not have
19480 parents will get this number added to their scores. Imagine you follow
19481 some high-volume newsgroup, like @samp{comp.lang.c}. Most likely you
19482 will only follow a few of the threads, also want to see any new threads.
19483
19484 You can do this with the following two score file entries:
19485
19486 @example
19487 (orphan -500)
19488 (mark-and-expunge -100)
19489 @end example
19490
19491 When you enter the group the first time, you will only see the new
19492 threads. You then raise the score of the threads that you find
19493 interesting (with @kbd{I T} or @kbd{I S}), and ignore (@kbd{C y}) the
19494 rest. Next time you enter the group, you will see new articles in the
19495 interesting threads, plus any new threads.
19496
19497 I.e.---the orphan score atom is for high-volume groups where a few
19498 interesting threads which can't be found automatically by ordinary
19499 scoring rules exist.
19500
19501 @item adapt
19502 This entry controls the adaptive scoring. If it is @code{t}, the
19503 default adaptive scoring rules will be used. If it is @code{ignore}, no
19504 adaptive scoring will be performed on this group. If it is a list, this
19505 list will be used as the adaptive scoring rules. If it isn't present,
19506 or is something other than @code{t} or @code{ignore}, the default
19507 adaptive scoring rules will be used. If you want to use adaptive
19508 scoring on most groups, you'd set @code{gnus-use-adaptive-scoring} to
19509 @code{t}, and insert an @code{(adapt ignore)} in the groups where you do
19510 not want adaptive scoring. If you only want adaptive scoring in a few
19511 groups, you'd set @code{gnus-use-adaptive-scoring} to @code{nil}, and
19512 insert @code{(adapt t)} in the score files of the groups where you want
19513 it.
19514
19515 @item adapt-file
19516 All adaptive score entries will go to the file named by this entry. It
19517 will also be applied when entering the group. This atom might be handy
19518 if you want to adapt on several groups at once, using the same adaptive
19519 file for a number of groups.
19520
19521 @item local
19522 @cindex local variables
19523 The value of this entry should be a list of @code{(@var{var}
19524 @var{value})} pairs. Each @var{var} will be made buffer-local to the
19525 current summary buffer, and set to the value specified. This is a
19526 convenient, if somewhat strange, way of setting variables in some
19527 groups if you don't like hooks much. Note that the @var{value} won't
19528 be evaluated.
19529 @end table
19530
19531
19532 @node Score File Editing
19533 @section Score File Editing
19534
19535 You normally enter all scoring commands from the summary buffer, but you
19536 might feel the urge to edit them by hand as well, so we've supplied you
19537 with a mode for that.
19538
19539 It's simply a slightly customized @code{emacs-lisp} mode, with these
19540 additional commands:
19541
19542 @table @kbd
19543
19544 @item C-c C-c
19545 @kindex C-c C-c (Score)
19546 @findex gnus-score-edit-done
19547 Save the changes you have made and return to the summary buffer
19548 (@code{gnus-score-edit-done}).
19549
19550 @item C-c C-d
19551 @kindex C-c C-d (Score)
19552 @findex gnus-score-edit-insert-date
19553 Insert the current date in numerical format
19554 (@code{gnus-score-edit-insert-date}). This is really the day number, if
19555 you were wondering.
19556
19557 @item C-c C-p
19558 @kindex C-c C-p (Score)
19559 @findex gnus-score-pretty-print
19560 The adaptive score files are saved in an unformatted fashion. If you
19561 intend to read one of these files, you want to @dfn{pretty print} it
19562 first. This command (@code{gnus-score-pretty-print}) does that for
19563 you.
19564
19565 @end table
19566
19567 Type @kbd{M-x gnus-score-mode} to use this mode.
19568
19569 @vindex gnus-score-mode-hook
19570 @code{gnus-score-menu-hook} is run in score mode buffers.
19571
19572 In the summary buffer you can use commands like @kbd{V f}, @kbd{V e} and
19573 @kbd{V t} to begin editing score files.
19574
19575
19576 @node Adaptive Scoring
19577 @section Adaptive Scoring
19578 @cindex adaptive scoring
19579
19580 If all this scoring is getting you down, Gnus has a way of making it all
19581 happen automatically---as if by magic. Or rather, as if by artificial
19582 stupidity, to be precise.
19583
19584 @vindex gnus-use-adaptive-scoring
19585 When you read an article, or mark an article as read, or kill an
19586 article, you leave marks behind. On exit from the group, Gnus can sniff
19587 these marks and add score elements depending on what marks it finds.
19588 You turn on this ability by setting @code{gnus-use-adaptive-scoring} to
19589 @code{t} or @code{(line)}. If you want score adaptively on separate
19590 words appearing in the subjects, you should set this variable to
19591 @code{(word)}. If you want to use both adaptive methods, set this
19592 variable to @code{(word line)}.
19593
19594 @vindex gnus-default-adaptive-score-alist
19595 To give you complete control over the scoring process, you can customize
19596 the @code{gnus-default-adaptive-score-alist} variable. For instance, it
19597 might look something like this:
19598
19599 @lisp
19600 (setq gnus-default-adaptive-score-alist
19601 '((gnus-unread-mark)
19602 (gnus-ticked-mark (from 4))
19603 (gnus-dormant-mark (from 5))
19604 (gnus-del-mark (from -4) (subject -1))
19605 (gnus-read-mark (from 4) (subject 2))
19606 (gnus-expirable-mark (from -1) (subject -1))
19607 (gnus-killed-mark (from -1) (subject -3))
19608 (gnus-kill-file-mark)
19609 (gnus-ancient-mark)
19610 (gnus-low-score-mark)
19611 (gnus-catchup-mark (from -1) (subject -1))))
19612 @end lisp
19613
19614 As you see, each element in this alist has a mark as a key (either a
19615 variable name or a ``real'' mark---a character). Following this key is
19616 a arbitrary number of header/score pairs. If there are no header/score
19617 pairs following the key, no adaptive scoring will be done on articles
19618 that have that key as the article mark. For instance, articles with
19619 @code{gnus-unread-mark} in the example above will not get adaptive score
19620 entries.
19621
19622 Each article can have only one mark, so just a single of these rules
19623 will be applied to each article.
19624
19625 To take @code{gnus-del-mark} as an example---this alist says that all
19626 articles that have that mark (i.e., are marked with @samp{e}) will have a
19627 score entry added to lower based on the @code{From} header by -4, and
19628 lowered by @code{Subject} by -1. Change this to fit your prejudices.
19629
19630 If you have marked 10 articles with the same subject with
19631 @code{gnus-del-mark}, the rule for that mark will be applied ten times.
19632 That means that that subject will get a score of ten times -1, which
19633 should be, unless I'm much mistaken, -10.
19634
19635 If you have auto-expirable (mail) groups (@pxref{Expiring Mail}), all
19636 the read articles will be marked with the @samp{E} mark. This'll
19637 probably make adaptive scoring slightly impossible, so auto-expiring and
19638 adaptive scoring doesn't really mix very well.
19639
19640 The headers you can score on are @code{from}, @code{subject},
19641 @code{message-id}, @code{references}, @code{xref}, @code{lines},
19642 @code{chars} and @code{date}. In addition, you can score on
19643 @code{followup}, which will create an adaptive score entry that matches
19644 on the @code{References} header using the @code{Message-ID} of the
19645 current article, thereby matching the following thread.
19646
19647 If you use this scheme, you should set the score file atom @code{mark}
19648 to something small---like -300, perhaps, to avoid having small random
19649 changes result in articles getting marked as read.
19650
19651 After using adaptive scoring for a week or so, Gnus should start to
19652 become properly trained and enhance the authors you like best, and kill
19653 the authors you like least, without you having to say so explicitly.
19654
19655 You can control what groups the adaptive scoring is to be performed on
19656 by using the score files (@pxref{Score File Format}). This will also
19657 let you use different rules in different groups.
19658
19659 @vindex gnus-adaptive-file-suffix
19660 The adaptive score entries will be put into a file where the name is the
19661 group name with @code{gnus-adaptive-file-suffix} appended. The default
19662 is @file{ADAPT}.
19663
19664 @vindex gnus-score-exact-adapt-limit
19665 When doing adaptive scoring, substring or fuzzy matching would probably
19666 give you the best results in most cases. However, if the header one
19667 matches is short, the possibility for false positives is great, so if
19668 the length of the match is less than
19669 @code{gnus-score-exact-adapt-limit}, exact matching will be used. If
19670 this variable is @code{nil}, exact matching will always be used to avoid
19671 this problem.
19672
19673 @vindex gnus-default-adaptive-word-score-alist
19674 As mentioned above, you can adapt either on individual words or entire
19675 headers. If you adapt on words, the
19676 @code{gnus-default-adaptive-word-score-alist} variable says what score
19677 each instance of a word should add given a mark.
19678
19679 @lisp
19680 (setq gnus-default-adaptive-word-score-alist
19681 `((,gnus-read-mark . 30)
19682 (,gnus-catchup-mark . -10)
19683 (,gnus-killed-mark . -20)
19684 (,gnus-del-mark . -15)))
19685 @end lisp
19686
19687 This is the default value. If you have adaption on words enabled, every
19688 word that appears in subjects of articles marked with
19689 @code{gnus-read-mark} will result in a score rule that increase the
19690 score with 30 points.
19691
19692 @vindex gnus-default-ignored-adaptive-words
19693 @vindex gnus-ignored-adaptive-words
19694 Words that appear in the @code{gnus-default-ignored-adaptive-words} list
19695 will be ignored. If you wish to add more words to be ignored, use the
19696 @code{gnus-ignored-adaptive-words} list instead.
19697
19698 @vindex gnus-adaptive-word-length-limit
19699 Some may feel that short words shouldn't count when doing adaptive
19700 scoring. If so, you may set @code{gnus-adaptive-word-length-limit} to
19701 an integer. Words shorter than this number will be ignored. This
19702 variable defaults to @code{nil}.
19703
19704 @vindex gnus-adaptive-word-syntax-table
19705 When the scoring is done, @code{gnus-adaptive-word-syntax-table} is the
19706 syntax table in effect. It is similar to the standard syntax table, but
19707 it considers numbers to be non-word-constituent characters.
19708
19709 @vindex gnus-adaptive-word-minimum
19710 If @code{gnus-adaptive-word-minimum} is set to a number, the adaptive
19711 word scoring process will never bring down the score of an article to
19712 below this number. The default is @code{nil}.
19713
19714 @vindex gnus-adaptive-word-no-group-words
19715 If @code{gnus-adaptive-word-no-group-words} is set to @code{t}, gnus
19716 won't adaptively word score any of the words in the group name. Useful
19717 for groups like @samp{comp.editors.emacs}, where most of the subject
19718 lines contain the word @samp{emacs}.
19719
19720 After using this scheme for a while, it might be nice to write a
19721 @code{gnus-psychoanalyze-user} command to go through the rules and see
19722 what words you like and what words you don't like. Or perhaps not.
19723
19724 Note that the adaptive word scoring thing is highly experimental and is
19725 likely to change in the future. Initial impressions seem to indicate
19726 that it's totally useless as it stands. Some more work (involving more
19727 rigorous statistical methods) will have to be done to make this useful.
19728
19729
19730 @node Home Score File
19731 @section Home Score File
19732
19733 The score file where new score file entries will go is called the
19734 @dfn{home score file}. This is normally (and by default) the score file
19735 for the group itself. For instance, the home score file for
19736 @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus} is @file{gnu.emacs.gnus.SCORE}.
19737
19738 However, this may not be what you want. It is often convenient to share
19739 a common home score file among many groups---all @samp{emacs} groups
19740 could perhaps use the same home score file.
19741
19742 @vindex gnus-home-score-file
19743 The variable that controls this is @code{gnus-home-score-file}. It can
19744 be:
19745
19746 @enumerate
19747 @item
19748 A string. Then this file will be used as the home score file for all
19749 groups.
19750
19751 @item
19752 A function. The result of this function will be used as the home score
19753 file. The function will be called with the name of the group as the
19754 parameter.
19755
19756 @item
19757 A list. The elements in this list can be:
19758
19759 @enumerate
19760 @item
19761 @code{(@var{regexp} @var{file-name})}. If the @var{regexp} matches the
19762 group name, the @var{file-name} will be used as the home score file.
19763
19764 @item
19765 A function. If the function returns non-@code{nil}, the result will
19766 be used as the home score file.
19767
19768 @item
19769 A string. Use the string as the home score file.
19770 @end enumerate
19771
19772 The list will be traversed from the beginning towards the end looking
19773 for matches.
19774
19775 @end enumerate
19776
19777 So, if you want to use just a single score file, you could say:
19778
19779 @lisp
19780 (setq gnus-home-score-file
19781 "my-total-score-file.SCORE")
19782 @end lisp
19783
19784 If you want to use @file{gnu.SCORE} for all @samp{gnu} groups and
19785 @file{rec.SCORE} for all @samp{rec} groups (and so on), you can say:
19786
19787 @findex gnus-hierarchial-home-score-file
19788 @lisp
19789 (setq gnus-home-score-file
19790 'gnus-hierarchial-home-score-file)
19791 @end lisp
19792
19793 This is a ready-made function provided for your convenience.
19794 Other functions include
19795
19796 @table @code
19797 @item gnus-current-home-score-file
19798 @findex gnus-current-home-score-file
19799 Return the ``current'' regular score file. This will make scoring
19800 commands add entry to the ``innermost'' matching score file.
19801
19802 @end table
19803
19804 If you want to have one score file for the @samp{emacs} groups and
19805 another for the @samp{comp} groups, while letting all other groups use
19806 their own home score files:
19807
19808 @lisp
19809 (setq gnus-home-score-file
19810 ;; @r{All groups that match the regexp @code{"\\.emacs"}}
19811 '(("\\.emacs" "emacs.SCORE")
19812 ;; @r{All the comp groups in one score file}
19813 ("^comp" "comp.SCORE")))
19814 @end lisp
19815
19816 @vindex gnus-home-adapt-file
19817 @code{gnus-home-adapt-file} works exactly the same way as
19818 @code{gnus-home-score-file}, but says what the home adaptive score file
19819 is instead. All new adaptive file entries will go into the file
19820 specified by this variable, and the same syntax is allowed.
19821
19822 In addition to using @code{gnus-home-score-file} and
19823 @code{gnus-home-adapt-file}, you can also use group parameters
19824 (@pxref{Group Parameters}) and topic parameters (@pxref{Topic
19825 Parameters}) to achieve much the same. Group and topic parameters take
19826 precedence over this variable.
19827
19828
19829 @node Followups To Yourself
19830 @section Followups To Yourself
19831
19832 Gnus offers two commands for picking out the @code{Message-ID} header in
19833 the current buffer. Gnus will then add a score rule that scores using
19834 this @code{Message-ID} on the @code{References} header of other
19835 articles. This will, in effect, increase the score of all articles that
19836 respond to the article in the current buffer. Quite useful if you want
19837 to easily note when people answer what you've said.
19838
19839 @table @code
19840
19841 @item gnus-score-followup-article
19842 @findex gnus-score-followup-article
19843 This will add a score to articles that directly follow up your own
19844 article.
19845
19846 @item gnus-score-followup-thread
19847 @findex gnus-score-followup-thread
19848 This will add a score to all articles that appear in a thread ``below''
19849 your own article.
19850 @end table
19851
19852 @vindex message-sent-hook
19853 These two functions are both primarily meant to be used in hooks like
19854 @code{message-sent-hook}, like this:
19855 @lisp
19856 (add-hook 'message-sent-hook 'gnus-score-followup-thread)
19857 @end lisp
19858
19859
19860 If you look closely at your own @code{Message-ID}, you'll notice that
19861 the first two or three characters are always the same. Here's two of
19862 mine:
19863
19864 @example
19865 <x6u3u47icf.fsf@@eyesore.no>
19866 <x6sp9o7ibw.fsf@@eyesore.no>
19867 @end example
19868
19869 So ``my'' ident on this machine is @samp{x6}. This can be
19870 exploited---the following rule will raise the score on all followups to
19871 myself:
19872
19873 @lisp
19874 ("references"
19875 ("<x6[0-9a-z]+\\.fsf\\(_-_\\)?@@.*eyesore\\.no>"
19876 1000 nil r))
19877 @end lisp
19878
19879 Whether it's the first two or first three characters that are ``yours''
19880 is system-dependent.
19881
19882
19883 @node Scoring On Other Headers
19884 @section Scoring On Other Headers
19885 @cindex scoring on other headers
19886
19887 Gnus is quite fast when scoring the ``traditional''
19888 headers---@samp{From}, @samp{Subject} and so on. However, scoring
19889 other headers requires writing a @code{head} scoring rule, which means
19890 that Gnus has to request every single article from the back end to find
19891 matches. This takes a long time in big groups.
19892
19893 Now, there's not much you can do about this for news groups, but for
19894 mail groups, you have greater control. In @ref{To From Newsgroups},
19895 it's explained in greater detail what this mechanism does, but here's
19896 a cookbook example for @code{nnml} on how to allow scoring on the
19897 @samp{To} and @samp{Cc} headers.
19898
19899 Put the following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file.
19900
19901 @lisp
19902 (setq gnus-extra-headers '(To Cc Newsgroups Keywords)
19903 nnmail-extra-headers gnus-extra-headers)
19904 @end lisp
19905
19906 Restart Gnus and rebuild your @code{nnml} overview files with the
19907 @kbd{M-x nnml-generate-nov-databases} command. This will take a long
19908 time if you have much mail.
19909
19910 Now you can score on @samp{To} and @samp{Cc} as ``extra headers'' like
19911 so: @kbd{I e s p To RET <your name> RET}.
19912
19913 See? Simple.
19914
19915
19916 @node Scoring Tips
19917 @section Scoring Tips
19918 @cindex scoring tips
19919
19920 @table @dfn
19921
19922 @item Crossposts
19923 @cindex crossposts
19924 @cindex scoring crossposts
19925 If you want to lower the score of crossposts, the line to match on is
19926 the @code{Xref} header.
19927 @lisp
19928 ("xref" (" talk.politics.misc:" -1000))
19929 @end lisp
19930
19931 @item Multiple crossposts
19932 If you want to lower the score of articles that have been crossposted to
19933 more than, say, 3 groups:
19934 @lisp
19935 ("xref"
19936 ("[^:\n]+:[0-9]+ +[^:\n]+:[0-9]+ +[^:\n]+:[0-9]+"
19937 -1000 nil r))
19938 @end lisp
19939
19940 @item Matching on the body
19941 This is generally not a very good idea---it takes a very long time.
19942 Gnus actually has to fetch each individual article from the server. But
19943 you might want to anyway, I guess. Even though there are three match
19944 keys (@code{Head}, @code{Body} and @code{All}), you should choose one
19945 and stick with it in each score file. If you use any two, each article
19946 will be fetched @emph{twice}. If you want to match a bit on the
19947 @code{Head} and a bit on the @code{Body}, just use @code{All} for all
19948 the matches.
19949
19950 @item Marking as read
19951 You will probably want to mark articles that have scores below a certain
19952 number as read. This is most easily achieved by putting the following
19953 in your @file{all.SCORE} file:
19954 @lisp
19955 ((mark -100))
19956 @end lisp
19957 You may also consider doing something similar with @code{expunge}.
19958
19959 @item Negated character classes
19960 If you say stuff like @code{[^abcd]*}, you may get unexpected results.
19961 That will match newlines, which might lead to, well, The Unknown. Say
19962 @code{[^abcd\n]*} instead.
19963 @end table
19964
19965
19966 @node Reverse Scoring
19967 @section Reverse Scoring
19968 @cindex reverse scoring
19969
19970 If you want to keep just articles that have @samp{Sex with Emacs} in the
19971 subject header, and expunge all other articles, you could put something
19972 like this in your score file:
19973
19974 @lisp
19975 (("subject"
19976 ("Sex with Emacs" 2))
19977 (mark 1)
19978 (expunge 1))
19979 @end lisp
19980
19981 So, you raise all articles that match @samp{Sex with Emacs} and mark the
19982 rest as read, and expunge them to boot.
19983
19984
19985 @node Global Score Files
19986 @section Global Score Files
19987 @cindex global score files
19988
19989 Sure, other newsreaders have ``global kill files''. These are usually
19990 nothing more than a single kill file that applies to all groups, stored
19991 in the user's home directory. Bah! Puny, weak newsreaders!
19992
19993 What I'm talking about here are Global Score Files. Score files from
19994 all over the world, from users everywhere, uniting all nations in one
19995 big, happy score file union! Ange-score! New and untested!
19996
19997 @vindex gnus-global-score-files
19998 All you have to do to use other people's score files is to set the
19999 @code{gnus-global-score-files} variable. One entry for each score file,
20000 or each score file directory. Gnus will decide by itself what score
20001 files are applicable to which group.
20002
20003 To use the score file
20004 @file{/ftp@@ftp.gnus.org:/pub/larsi/ding/score/soc.motss.SCORE} and
20005 all score files in the @file{/ftp@@ftp.some-where:/pub/score} directory,
20006 say this:
20007
20008 @lisp
20009 (setq gnus-global-score-files
20010 '("/ftp@@ftp.gnus.org:/pub/larsi/ding/score/soc.motss.SCORE"
20011 "/ftp@@ftp.some-where:/pub/score/"))
20012 @end lisp
20013
20014 @findex gnus-score-search-global-directories
20015 @noindent
20016 Simple, eh? Directory names must end with a @samp{/}. These
20017 directories are typically scanned only once during each Gnus session.
20018 If you feel the need to manually re-scan the remote directories, you can
20019 use the @code{gnus-score-search-global-directories} command.
20020
20021 Note that, at present, using this option will slow down group entry
20022 somewhat. (That is---a lot.)
20023
20024 If you want to start maintaining score files for other people to use,
20025 just put your score file up for anonymous ftp and announce it to the
20026 world. Become a retro-moderator! Participate in the retro-moderator
20027 wars sure to ensue, where retro-moderators battle it out for the
20028 sympathy of the people, luring them to use their score files on false
20029 premises! Yay! The net is saved!
20030
20031 Here are some tips for the would-be retro-moderator, off the top of my
20032 head:
20033
20034 @itemize @bullet
20035
20036 @item
20037 Articles heavily crossposted are probably junk.
20038 @item
20039 To lower a single inappropriate article, lower by @code{Message-ID}.
20040 @item
20041 Particularly brilliant authors can be raised on a permanent basis.
20042 @item
20043 Authors that repeatedly post off-charter for the group can safely be
20044 lowered out of existence.
20045 @item
20046 Set the @code{mark} and @code{expunge} atoms to obliterate the nastiest
20047 articles completely.
20048
20049 @item
20050 Use expiring score entries to keep the size of the file down. You
20051 should probably have a long expiry period, though, as some sites keep
20052 old articles for a long time.
20053 @end itemize
20054
20055 @dots{} I wonder whether other newsreaders will support global score files
20056 in the future. @emph{Snicker}. Yup, any day now, newsreaders like Blue
20057 Wave, xrn and 1stReader are bound to implement scoring. Should we start
20058 holding our breath yet?
20059
20060
20061 @node Kill Files
20062 @section Kill Files
20063 @cindex kill files
20064
20065 Gnus still supports those pesky old kill files. In fact, the kill file
20066 entries can now be expiring, which is something I wrote before Daniel
20067 Quinlan thought of doing score files, so I've left the code in there.
20068
20069 In short, kill processing is a lot slower (and I do mean @emph{a lot})
20070 than score processing, so it might be a good idea to rewrite your kill
20071 files into score files.
20072
20073 Anyway, a kill file is a normal @code{emacs-lisp} file. You can put any
20074 forms into this file, which means that you can use kill files as some
20075 sort of primitive hook function to be run on group entry, even though
20076 that isn't a very good idea.
20077
20078 Normal kill files look like this:
20079
20080 @lisp
20081 (gnus-kill "From" "Lars Ingebrigtsen")
20082 (gnus-kill "Subject" "ding")
20083 (gnus-expunge "X")
20084 @end lisp
20085
20086 This will mark every article written by me as read, and remove the
20087 marked articles from the summary buffer. Very useful, you'll agree.
20088
20089 Other programs use a totally different kill file syntax. If Gnus
20090 encounters what looks like a @code{rn} kill file, it will take a stab at
20091 interpreting it.
20092
20093 Two summary functions for editing a @sc{gnus} kill file:
20094
20095 @table @kbd
20096
20097 @item M-k
20098 @kindex M-k (Summary)
20099 @findex gnus-summary-edit-local-kill
20100 Edit this group's kill file (@code{gnus-summary-edit-local-kill}).
20101
20102 @item M-K
20103 @kindex M-K (Summary)
20104 @findex gnus-summary-edit-global-kill
20105 Edit the general kill file (@code{gnus-summary-edit-global-kill}).
20106 @end table
20107
20108 Two group mode functions for editing the kill files:
20109
20110 @table @kbd
20111
20112 @item M-k
20113 @kindex M-k (Group)
20114 @findex gnus-group-edit-local-kill
20115 Edit this group's kill file (@code{gnus-group-edit-local-kill}).
20116
20117 @item M-K
20118 @kindex M-K (Group)
20119 @findex gnus-group-edit-global-kill
20120 Edit the general kill file (@code{gnus-group-edit-global-kill}).
20121 @end table
20122
20123 Kill file variables:
20124
20125 @table @code
20126 @item gnus-kill-file-name
20127 @vindex gnus-kill-file-name
20128 A kill file for the group @samp{soc.motss} is normally called
20129 @file{soc.motss.KILL}. The suffix appended to the group name to get
20130 this file name is detailed by the @code{gnus-kill-file-name} variable.
20131 The ``global'' kill file (not in the score file sense of ``global'', of
20132 course) is just called @file{KILL}.
20133
20134 @vindex gnus-kill-save-kill-file
20135 @item gnus-kill-save-kill-file
20136 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will save the
20137 kill file after processing, which is necessary if you use expiring
20138 kills.
20139
20140 @item gnus-apply-kill-hook
20141 @vindex gnus-apply-kill-hook
20142 @findex gnus-apply-kill-file-unless-scored
20143 @findex gnus-apply-kill-file
20144 A hook called to apply kill files to a group. It is
20145 @code{(gnus-apply-kill-file)} by default. If you want to ignore the
20146 kill file if you have a score file for the same group, you can set this
20147 hook to @code{(gnus-apply-kill-file-unless-scored)}. If you don't want
20148 kill files to be processed, you should set this variable to @code{nil}.
20149
20150 @item gnus-kill-file-mode-hook
20151 @vindex gnus-kill-file-mode-hook
20152 A hook called in kill-file mode buffers.
20153
20154 @end table
20155
20156
20157 @node Converting Kill Files
20158 @section Converting Kill Files
20159 @cindex kill files
20160 @cindex converting kill files
20161
20162 If you have loads of old kill files, you may want to convert them into
20163 score files. If they are ``regular'', you can use
20164 the @file{gnus-kill-to-score.el} package; if not, you'll have to do it
20165 by hand.
20166
20167 The kill to score conversion package isn't included in Gnus by default.
20168 You can fetch it from
20169 @uref{http://www.stud.ifi.uio.no/~larsi/ding-various/gnus-kill-to-score.el}.
20170
20171 If your old kill files are very complex---if they contain more
20172 non-@code{gnus-kill} forms than not, you'll have to convert them by
20173 hand. Or just let them be as they are. Gnus will still use them as
20174 before.
20175
20176
20177 @node GroupLens
20178 @section GroupLens
20179 @cindex GroupLens
20180
20181 @sc{Note:} Unfortunately the GroupLens system seems to have shut down,
20182 so this section is mostly of historical interest.
20183
20184 @uref{http://www.cs.umn.edu/Research/GroupLens/, GroupLens} is a
20185 collaborative filtering system that helps you work together with other
20186 people to find the quality news articles out of the huge volume of
20187 news articles generated every day.
20188
20189 To accomplish this the GroupLens system combines your opinions about
20190 articles you have already read with the opinions of others who have done
20191 likewise and gives you a personalized prediction for each unread news
20192 article. Think of GroupLens as a matchmaker. GroupLens watches how you
20193 rate articles, and finds other people that rate articles the same way.
20194 Once it has found some people you agree with it tells you, in the form
20195 of a prediction, what they thought of the article. You can use this
20196 prediction to help you decide whether or not you want to read the
20197 article.
20198
20199 @menu
20200 * Using GroupLens:: How to make Gnus use GroupLens.
20201 * Rating Articles:: Letting GroupLens know how you rate articles.
20202 * Displaying Predictions:: Displaying predictions given by GroupLens.
20203 * GroupLens Variables:: Customizing GroupLens.
20204 @end menu
20205
20206
20207 @node Using GroupLens
20208 @subsection Using GroupLens
20209
20210 To use GroupLens you must register a pseudonym with your local
20211 @uref{http://www.cs.umn.edu/Research/GroupLens/bbb.html, Better Bit
20212 Bureau (BBB)} is the only better bit in town at the moment.
20213
20214 Once you have registered you'll need to set a couple of variables.
20215
20216 @table @code
20217
20218 @item gnus-use-grouplens
20219 @vindex gnus-use-grouplens
20220 Setting this variable to a non-@code{nil} value will make Gnus hook into
20221 all the relevant GroupLens functions.
20222
20223 @item grouplens-pseudonym
20224 @vindex grouplens-pseudonym
20225 This variable should be set to the pseudonym you got when registering
20226 with the Better Bit Bureau.
20227
20228 @item grouplens-newsgroups
20229 @vindex grouplens-newsgroups
20230 A list of groups that you want to get GroupLens predictions for.
20231
20232 @end table
20233
20234 That's the minimum of what you need to get up and running with GroupLens.
20235 Once you've registered, GroupLens will start giving you scores for
20236 articles based on the average of what other people think. But, to get
20237 the real benefit of GroupLens you need to start rating articles
20238 yourself. Then the scores GroupLens gives you will be personalized for
20239 you, based on how the people you usually agree with have already rated.
20240
20241
20242 @node Rating Articles
20243 @subsection Rating Articles
20244
20245 In GroupLens, an article is rated on a scale from 1 to 5, inclusive.
20246 Where 1 means something like this article is a waste of bandwidth and 5
20247 means that the article was really good. The basic question to ask
20248 yourself is, ``on a scale from 1 to 5 would I like to see more articles
20249 like this one?''
20250
20251 There are four ways to enter a rating for an article in GroupLens.
20252
20253 @table @kbd
20254
20255 @item r
20256 @kindex r (GroupLens)
20257 @findex bbb-summary-rate-article
20258 This function will prompt you for a rating on a scale of one to five.
20259
20260 @item k
20261 @kindex k (GroupLens)
20262 @findex grouplens-score-thread
20263 This function will prompt you for a rating, and rate all the articles in
20264 the thread. This is really useful for some of those long running giant
20265 threads in rec.humor.
20266
20267 @end table
20268
20269 The next two commands, @kbd{n} and @kbd{,} take a numerical prefix to be
20270 the score of the article you're reading.
20271
20272 @table @kbd
20273
20274 @item 1-5 n
20275 @kindex n (GroupLens)
20276 @findex grouplens-next-unread-article
20277 Rate the article and go to the next unread article.
20278
20279 @item 1-5 ,
20280 @kindex , (GroupLens)
20281 @findex grouplens-best-unread-article
20282 Rate the article and go to the next unread article with the highest score.
20283
20284 @end table
20285
20286 If you want to give the current article a score of 4 and then go to the
20287 next article, just type @kbd{4 n}.
20288
20289
20290 @node Displaying Predictions
20291 @subsection Displaying Predictions
20292
20293 GroupLens makes a prediction for you about how much you will like a
20294 news article. The predictions from GroupLens are on a scale from 1 to
20295 5, where 1 is the worst and 5 is the best. You can use the predictions
20296 from GroupLens in one of three ways controlled by the variable
20297 @code{gnus-grouplens-override-scoring}.
20298
20299 @vindex gnus-grouplens-override-scoring
20300 There are three ways to display predictions in grouplens. You may
20301 choose to have the GroupLens scores contribute to, or override the
20302 regular Gnus scoring mechanism. override is the default; however, some
20303 people prefer to see the Gnus scores plus the grouplens scores. To get
20304 the separate scoring behavior you need to set
20305 @code{gnus-grouplens-override-scoring} to @code{'separate}. To have the
20306 GroupLens predictions combined with the grouplens scores set it to
20307 @code{'override} and to combine the scores set
20308 @code{gnus-grouplens-override-scoring} to @code{'combine}. When you use
20309 the combine option you will also want to set the values for
20310 @code{grouplens-prediction-offset} and
20311 @code{grouplens-score-scale-factor}.
20312
20313 @vindex grouplens-prediction-display
20314 In either case, GroupLens gives you a few choices for how you would like
20315 to see your predictions displayed. The display of predictions is
20316 controlled by the @code{grouplens-prediction-display} variable.
20317
20318 The following are valid values for that variable.
20319
20320 @table @code
20321 @item prediction-spot
20322 The higher the prediction, the further to the right an @samp{*} is
20323 displayed.
20324
20325 @item confidence-interval
20326 A numeric confidence interval.
20327
20328 @item prediction-bar
20329 The higher the prediction, the longer the bar.
20330
20331 @item confidence-bar
20332 Numerical confidence.
20333
20334 @item confidence-spot
20335 The spot gets bigger with more confidence.
20336
20337 @item prediction-num
20338 Plain-old numeric value.
20339
20340 @item confidence-plus-minus
20341 Prediction +/- confidence.
20342
20343 @end table
20344
20345
20346 @node GroupLens Variables
20347 @subsection GroupLens Variables
20348
20349 @table @code
20350
20351 @item gnus-summary-grouplens-line-format
20352 The summary line format used in GroupLens-enhanced summary buffers. It
20353 accepts the same specs as the normal summary line format (@pxref{Summary
20354 Buffer Lines}). The default is @samp{%U%R%z%l%I%(%[%4L: %-23,23n%]%)
20355 %s\n}.
20356
20357 @item grouplens-bbb-host
20358 Host running the bbbd server. @samp{grouplens.cs.umn.edu} is the
20359 default.
20360
20361 @item grouplens-bbb-port
20362 Port of the host running the bbbd server. The default is 9000.
20363
20364 @item grouplens-score-offset
20365 Offset the prediction by this value. In other words, subtract the
20366 prediction value by this number to arrive at the effective score. The
20367 default is 0.
20368
20369 @item grouplens-score-scale-factor
20370 This variable allows the user to magnify the effect of GroupLens scores.
20371 The scale factor is applied after the offset. The default is 1.
20372
20373 @end table
20374
20375
20376 @node Advanced Scoring
20377 @section Advanced Scoring
20378
20379 Scoring on Subjects and From headers is nice enough, but what if you're
20380 really interested in what a person has to say only when she's talking
20381 about a particular subject? Or what if you really don't want to
20382 read what person A has to say when she's following up to person B, but
20383 want to read what she says when she's following up to person C?
20384
20385 By using advanced scoring rules you may create arbitrarily complex
20386 scoring patterns.
20387
20388 @menu
20389 * Advanced Scoring Syntax:: A definition.
20390 * Advanced Scoring Examples:: What they look like.
20391 * Advanced Scoring Tips:: Getting the most out of it.
20392 @end menu
20393
20394
20395 @node Advanced Scoring Syntax
20396 @subsection Advanced Scoring Syntax
20397
20398 Ordinary scoring rules have a string as the first element in the rule.
20399 Advanced scoring rules have a list as the first element. The second
20400 element is the score to be applied if the first element evaluated to a
20401 non-@code{nil} value.
20402
20403 These lists may consist of three logical operators, one redirection
20404 operator, and various match operators.
20405
20406 Logical operators:
20407
20408 @table @code
20409 @item &
20410 @itemx and
20411 This logical operator will evaluate each of its arguments until it finds
20412 one that evaluates to @code{false}, and then it'll stop. If all arguments
20413 evaluate to @code{true} values, then this operator will return
20414 @code{true}.
20415
20416 @item |
20417 @itemx or
20418 This logical operator will evaluate each of its arguments until it finds
20419 one that evaluates to @code{true}. If no arguments are @code{true},
20420 then this operator will return @code{false}.
20421
20422 @item !
20423 @itemx not
20424 @itemx ¬
20425 This logical operator only takes a single argument. It returns the
20426 logical negation of the value of its argument.
20427
20428 @end table
20429
20430 There is an @dfn{indirection operator} that will make its arguments
20431 apply to the ancestors of the current article being scored. For
20432 instance, @code{1-} will make score rules apply to the parent of the
20433 current article. @code{2-} will make score rules apply to the
20434 grandparent of the current article. Alternatively, you can write
20435 @code{^^}, where the number of @code{^}s (carets) says how far back into
20436 the ancestry you want to go.
20437
20438 Finally, we have the match operators. These are the ones that do the
20439 real work. Match operators are header name strings followed by a match
20440 and a match type. A typical match operator looks like @samp{("from"
20441 "Lars Ingebrigtsen" s)}. The header names are the same as when using
20442 simple scoring, and the match types are also the same.
20443
20444
20445 @node Advanced Scoring Examples
20446 @subsection Advanced Scoring Examples
20447
20448 Please note that the following examples are score file rules. To
20449 make a complete score file from them, surround them with another pair
20450 of parentheses.
20451
20452 Let's say you want to increase the score of articles written by Lars
20453 when he's talking about Gnus:
20454
20455 @example
20456 @group
20457 ((&
20458 ("from" "Lars Ingebrigtsen")
20459 ("subject" "Gnus"))
20460 1000)
20461 @end group
20462 @end example
20463
20464 Quite simple, huh?
20465
20466 When he writes long articles, he sometimes has something nice to say:
20467
20468 @example
20469 ((&
20470 ("from" "Lars Ingebrigtsen")
20471 (|
20472 ("subject" "Gnus")
20473 ("lines" 100 >)))
20474 1000)
20475 @end example
20476
20477 However, when he responds to things written by Reig Eigil Logge, you
20478 really don't want to read what he's written:
20479
20480 @example
20481 ((&
20482 ("from" "Lars Ingebrigtsen")
20483 (1- ("from" "Reig Eigir Logge")))
20484 -100000)
20485 @end example
20486
20487 Everybody that follows up Redmondo when he writes about disappearing
20488 socks should have their scores raised, but only when they talk about
20489 white socks. However, when Lars talks about socks, it's usually not
20490 very interesting:
20491
20492 @example
20493 ((&
20494 (1-
20495 (&
20496 ("from" "redmondo@@.*no" r)
20497 ("body" "disappearing.*socks" t)))
20498 (! ("from" "Lars Ingebrigtsen"))
20499 ("body" "white.*socks"))
20500 1000)
20501 @end example
20502
20503 The possibilities are endless.
20504
20505
20506 @node Advanced Scoring Tips
20507 @subsection Advanced Scoring Tips
20508
20509 The @code{&} and @code{|} logical operators do short-circuit logic.
20510 That is, they stop processing their arguments when it's clear what the
20511 result of the operation will be. For instance, if one of the arguments
20512 of an @code{&} evaluates to @code{false}, there's no point in evaluating
20513 the rest of the arguments. This means that you should put slow matches
20514 (@samp{body}, @samp{header}) last and quick matches (@samp{from},
20515 @samp{subject}) first.
20516
20517 The indirection arguments (@code{1-} and so on) will make their
20518 arguments work on previous generations of the thread. If you say
20519 something like:
20520
20521 @example
20522 ...
20523 (1-
20524 (1-
20525 ("from" "lars")))
20526 ...
20527 @end example
20528
20529 Then that means ``score on the from header of the grandparent of the
20530 current article''. An indirection is quite fast, but it's better to say:
20531
20532 @example
20533 (1-
20534 (&
20535 ("from" "Lars")
20536 ("subject" "Gnus")))
20537 @end example
20538
20539 than it is to say:
20540
20541 @example
20542 (&
20543 (1- ("from" "Lars"))
20544 (1- ("subject" "Gnus")))
20545 @end example
20546
20547
20548 @node Score Decays
20549 @section Score Decays
20550 @cindex score decays
20551 @cindex decays
20552
20553 You may find that your scores have a tendency to grow without
20554 bounds, especially if you're using adaptive scoring. If scores get too
20555 big, they lose all meaning---they simply max out and it's difficult to
20556 use them in any sensible way.
20557
20558 @vindex gnus-decay-scores
20559 @findex gnus-decay-score
20560 @vindex gnus-decay-score-function
20561 Gnus provides a mechanism for decaying scores to help with this problem.
20562 When score files are loaded and @code{gnus-decay-scores} is
20563 non-@code{nil}, Gnus will run the score files through the decaying
20564 mechanism thereby lowering the scores of all non-permanent score rules.
20565 The decay itself if performed by the @code{gnus-decay-score-function}
20566 function, which is @code{gnus-decay-score} by default. Here's the
20567 definition of that function:
20568
20569 @lisp
20570 (defun gnus-decay-score (score)
20571 "Decay SCORE according to `gnus-score-decay-constant'
20572 and `gnus-score-decay-scale'."
20573 (let ((n (- score
20574 (* (if (< score 0) -1 1)
20575 (min (abs score)
20576 (max gnus-score-decay-constant
20577 (* (abs score)
20578 gnus-score-decay-scale)))))))
20579 (if (and (featurep 'xemacs)
20580 ;; XEmacs' floor can handle only the floating point
20581 ;; number below the half of the maximum integer.
20582 (> (abs n) (lsh -1 -2)))
20583 (string-to-number
20584 (car (split-string (number-to-string n) "\\.")))
20585 (floor n))))
20586 @end lisp
20587
20588 @vindex gnus-score-decay-scale
20589 @vindex gnus-score-decay-constant
20590 @code{gnus-score-decay-constant} is 3 by default and
20591 @code{gnus-score-decay-scale} is 0.05. This should cause the following:
20592
20593 @enumerate
20594 @item
20595 Scores between -3 and 3 will be set to 0 when this function is called.
20596
20597 @item
20598 Scores with magnitudes between 3 and 60 will be shrunk by 3.
20599
20600 @item
20601 Scores with magnitudes greater than 60 will be shrunk by 5% of the
20602 score.
20603 @end enumerate
20604
20605 If you don't like this decay function, write your own. It is called
20606 with the score to be decayed as its only parameter, and it should return
20607 the new score, which should be an integer.
20608
20609 Gnus will try to decay scores once a day. If you haven't run Gnus for
20610 four days, Gnus will decay the scores four times, for instance.
20611
20612 @iftex
20613 @iflatex
20614 @chapter Message
20615 @include message.texi
20616 @chapter Emacs MIME
20617 @include emacs-mime.texi
20618 @chapter Sieve
20619 @include sieve.texi
20620 @chapter PGG
20621 @include pgg.texi
20622 @end iflatex
20623 @end iftex
20624
20625 @node Various
20626 @chapter Various
20627
20628 @menu
20629 * Process/Prefix:: A convention used by many treatment commands.
20630 * Interactive:: Making Gnus ask you many questions.
20631 * Symbolic Prefixes:: How to supply some Gnus functions with options.
20632 * Formatting Variables:: You can specify what buffers should look like.
20633 * Window Layout:: Configuring the Gnus buffer windows.
20634 * Faces and Fonts:: How to change how faces look.
20635 * Compilation:: How to speed Gnus up.
20636 * Mode Lines:: Displaying information in the mode lines.
20637 * Highlighting and Menus:: Making buffers look all nice and cozy.
20638 * Buttons:: Get tendinitis in ten easy steps!
20639 * Daemons:: Gnus can do things behind your back.
20640 * NoCeM:: How to avoid spam and other fatty foods.
20641 * Undo:: Some actions can be undone.
20642 * Predicate Specifiers:: Specifying predicates.
20643 * Moderation:: What to do if you're a moderator.
20644 * Fetching a Group:: Starting Gnus just to read a group.
20645 * Image Enhancements:: Modern versions of Emacs/XEmacs can display images.
20646 * Fuzzy Matching:: What's the big fuzz?
20647 * Thwarting Email Spam:: A how-to on avoiding unsolicited commercial email.
20648 * Other modes:: Interaction with other modes.
20649 * Various Various:: Things that are really various.
20650 @end menu
20651
20652
20653 @node Process/Prefix
20654 @section Process/Prefix
20655 @cindex process/prefix convention
20656
20657 Many functions, among them functions for moving, decoding and saving
20658 articles, use what is known as the @dfn{Process/Prefix convention}.
20659
20660 This is a method for figuring out what articles the user wants the
20661 command to be performed on.
20662
20663 It goes like this:
20664
20665 If the numeric prefix is N, perform the operation on the next N
20666 articles, starting with the current one. If the numeric prefix is
20667 negative, perform the operation on the previous N articles, starting
20668 with the current one.
20669
20670 @vindex transient-mark-mode
20671 If @code{transient-mark-mode} in non-@code{nil} and the region is
20672 active, all articles in the region will be worked upon.
20673
20674 If there is no numeric prefix, but some articles are marked with the
20675 process mark, perform the operation on the articles marked with
20676 the process mark.
20677
20678 If there is neither a numeric prefix nor any articles marked with the
20679 process mark, just perform the operation on the current article.
20680
20681 Quite simple, really, but it needs to be made clear so that surprises
20682 are avoided.
20683
20684 Commands that react to the process mark will push the current list of
20685 process marked articles onto a stack and will then clear all process
20686 marked articles. You can restore the previous configuration with the
20687 @kbd{M P y} command (@pxref{Setting Process Marks}).
20688
20689 @vindex gnus-summary-goto-unread
20690 One thing that seems to shock & horrify lots of people is that, for
20691 instance, @kbd{3 d} does exactly the same as @kbd{d} @kbd{d} @kbd{d}.
20692 Since each @kbd{d} (which marks the current article as read) by default
20693 goes to the next unread article after marking, this means that @kbd{3 d}
20694 will mark the next three unread articles as read, no matter what the
20695 summary buffer looks like. Set @code{gnus-summary-goto-unread} to
20696 @code{nil} for a more straightforward action.
20697
20698 Many commands do not use the process/prefix convention. All commands
20699 that do explicitly say so in this manual. To apply the process/prefix
20700 convention to commands that do not use it, you can use the @kbd{M-&}
20701 command. For instance, to mark all the articles in the group as
20702 expirable, you could say @kbd{M P b M-& E}.
20703
20704
20705 @node Interactive
20706 @section Interactive
20707 @cindex interaction
20708
20709 @table @code
20710
20711 @item gnus-novice-user
20712 @vindex gnus-novice-user
20713 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, you are either a newcomer to the
20714 World of Usenet, or you are very cautious, which is a nice thing to be,
20715 really. You will be given questions of the type ``Are you sure you want
20716 to do this?'' before doing anything dangerous. This is @code{t} by
20717 default.
20718
20719 @item gnus-expert-user
20720 @vindex gnus-expert-user
20721 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, you will seldom be asked any
20722 questions by Gnus. It will simply assume you know what you're doing, no
20723 matter how strange.
20724
20725 @item gnus-interactive-catchup
20726 @vindex gnus-interactive-catchup
20727 Require confirmation before catching up a group if non-@code{nil}. It
20728 is @code{t} by default.
20729
20730 @item gnus-interactive-exit
20731 @vindex gnus-interactive-exit
20732 Require confirmation before exiting Gnus. This variable is @code{t} by
20733 default.
20734 @end table
20735
20736
20737 @node Symbolic Prefixes
20738 @section Symbolic Prefixes
20739 @cindex symbolic prefixes
20740
20741 Quite a lot of Emacs commands react to the (numeric) prefix. For
20742 instance, @kbd{C-u 4 C-f} moves point four characters forward, and
20743 @kbd{C-u 9 0 0 I s s p} adds a permanent @code{Subject} substring score
20744 rule of 900 to the current article.
20745
20746 This is all nice and well, but what if you want to give a command some
20747 additional information? Well, what most commands do is interpret the
20748 ``raw'' prefix in some special way. @kbd{C-u 0 C-x C-s} means that one
20749 doesn't want a backup file to be created when saving the current buffer,
20750 for instance. But what if you want to save without making a backup
20751 file, and you want Emacs to flash lights and play a nice tune at the
20752 same time? You can't, and you're probably perfectly happy that way.
20753
20754 @kindex M-i (Summary)
20755 @findex gnus-symbolic-argument
20756 I'm not, so I've added a second prefix---the @dfn{symbolic prefix}. The
20757 prefix key is @kbd{M-i} (@code{gnus-symbolic-argument}), and the next
20758 character typed in is the value. You can stack as many @kbd{M-i}
20759 prefixes as you want. @kbd{M-i a C-M-u} means ``feed the @kbd{C-M-u}
20760 command the symbolic prefix @code{a}''. @kbd{M-i a M-i b C-M-u} means
20761 ``feed the @kbd{C-M-u} command the symbolic prefixes @code{a} and
20762 @code{b}''. You get the drift.
20763
20764 Typing in symbolic prefixes to commands that don't accept them doesn't
20765 hurt, but it doesn't do any good either. Currently not many Gnus
20766 functions make use of the symbolic prefix.
20767
20768 If you're interested in how Gnus implements this, @pxref{Extended
20769 Interactive}.
20770
20771
20772 @node Formatting Variables
20773 @section Formatting Variables
20774 @cindex formatting variables
20775
20776 Throughout this manual you've probably noticed lots of variables called
20777 things like @code{gnus-group-line-format} and
20778 @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format}. These control how Gnus is to
20779 output lines in the various buffers. There's quite a lot of them.
20780 Fortunately, they all use the same syntax, so there's not that much to
20781 be annoyed by.
20782
20783 Here's an example format spec (from the group buffer): @samp{%M%S%5y:
20784 %(%g%)\n}. We see that it is indeed extremely ugly, and that there are
20785 lots of percentages everywhere.
20786
20787 @menu
20788 * Formatting Basics:: A formatting variable is basically a format string.
20789 * Mode Line Formatting:: Some rules about mode line formatting variables.
20790 * Advanced Formatting:: Modifying output in various ways.
20791 * User-Defined Specs:: Having Gnus call your own functions.
20792 * Formatting Fonts:: Making the formatting look colorful and nice.
20793 * Positioning Point:: Moving point to a position after an operation.
20794 * Tabulation:: Tabulating your output.
20795 * Wide Characters:: Dealing with wide characters.
20796 @end menu
20797
20798 Currently Gnus uses the following formatting variables:
20799 @code{gnus-group-line-format}, @code{gnus-summary-line-format},
20800 @code{gnus-server-line-format}, @code{gnus-topic-line-format},
20801 @code{gnus-group-mode-line-format},
20802 @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format},
20803 @code{gnus-article-mode-line-format},
20804 @code{gnus-server-mode-line-format}, and
20805 @code{gnus-summary-pick-line-format}.
20806
20807 All these format variables can also be arbitrary elisp forms. In that
20808 case, they will be @code{eval}ed to insert the required lines.
20809
20810 @kindex M-x gnus-update-format
20811 @findex gnus-update-format
20812 Gnus includes a command to help you while creating your own format
20813 specs. @kbd{M-x gnus-update-format} will @code{eval} the current form,
20814 update the spec in question and pop you to a buffer where you can
20815 examine the resulting Lisp code to be run to generate the line.
20816
20817
20818
20819 @node Formatting Basics
20820 @subsection Formatting Basics
20821
20822 Each @samp{%} element will be replaced by some string or other when the
20823 buffer in question is generated. @samp{%5y} means ``insert the @samp{y}
20824 spec, and pad with spaces to get a 5-character field''.
20825
20826 As with normal C and Emacs Lisp formatting strings, the numerical
20827 modifier between the @samp{%} and the formatting type character will
20828 @dfn{pad} the output so that it is always at least that long.
20829 @samp{%5y} will make the field always (at least) five characters wide by
20830 padding with spaces to the left. If you say @samp{%-5y}, it will pad to
20831 the right instead.
20832
20833 You may also wish to limit the length of the field to protect against
20834 particularly wide values. For that you can say @samp{%4,6y}, which
20835 means that the field will never be more than 6 characters wide and never
20836 less than 4 characters wide.
20837
20838 Also Gnus supports some extended format specifications, such as
20839 @samp{%&user-date;}.
20840
20841
20842 @node Mode Line Formatting
20843 @subsection Mode Line Formatting
20844
20845 Mode line formatting variables (e.g.,
20846 @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format}) follow the same rules as other,
20847 buffer line oriented formatting variables (@pxref{Formatting Basics})
20848 with the following two differences:
20849
20850 @enumerate
20851
20852 @item
20853 There must be no newline (@samp{\n}) at the end.
20854
20855 @item
20856 The special @samp{%%b} spec can be used to display the buffer name.
20857 Well, it's no spec at all, really---@samp{%%} is just a way to quote
20858 @samp{%} to allow it to pass through the formatting machinery unmangled,
20859 so that Emacs receives @samp{%b}, which is something the Emacs mode line
20860 display interprets to mean ``show the buffer name''. For a full list of
20861 mode line specs Emacs understands, see the documentation of the
20862 @code{mode-line-format} variable.
20863
20864 @end enumerate
20865
20866
20867 @node Advanced Formatting
20868 @subsection Advanced Formatting
20869
20870 It is frequently useful to post-process the fields in some way.
20871 Padding, limiting, cutting off parts and suppressing certain values can
20872 be achieved by using @dfn{tilde modifiers}. A typical tilde spec might
20873 look like @samp{%~(cut 3)~(ignore "0")y}.
20874
20875 These are the valid modifiers:
20876
20877 @table @code
20878 @item pad
20879 @itemx pad-left
20880 Pad the field to the left with spaces until it reaches the required
20881 length.
20882
20883 @item pad-right
20884 Pad the field to the right with spaces until it reaches the required
20885 length.
20886
20887 @item max
20888 @itemx max-left
20889 Cut off characters from the left until it reaches the specified length.
20890
20891 @item max-right
20892 Cut off characters from the right until it reaches the specified
20893 length.
20894
20895 @item cut
20896 @itemx cut-left
20897 Cut off the specified number of characters from the left.
20898
20899 @item cut-right
20900 Cut off the specified number of characters from the right.
20901
20902 @item ignore
20903 Return an empty string if the field is equal to the specified value.
20904
20905 @item form
20906 Use the specified form as the field value when the @samp{@@} spec is
20907 used.
20908
20909 Here's an example:
20910
20911 @lisp
20912 "~(form (current-time-string))@@"
20913 @end lisp
20914
20915 @end table
20916
20917 Let's take an example. The @samp{%o} spec in the summary mode lines
20918 will return a date in compact ISO8601 format---@samp{19960809T230410}.
20919 This is quite a mouthful, so we want to shave off the century number and
20920 the time, leaving us with a six-character date. That would be
20921 @samp{%~(cut-left 2)~(max-right 6)~(pad 6)o}. (Cutting is done before
20922 maxing, and we need the padding to ensure that the date is never less
20923 than 6 characters to make it look nice in columns.)
20924
20925 Ignoring is done first; then cutting; then maxing; and then as the very
20926 last operation, padding.
20927
20928 If you use lots of these advanced thingies, you'll find that Gnus gets
20929 quite slow. This can be helped enormously by running @kbd{M-x
20930 gnus-compile} when you are satisfied with the look of your lines.
20931 @xref{Compilation}.
20932
20933
20934 @node User-Defined Specs
20935 @subsection User-Defined Specs
20936
20937 All the specs allow for inserting user defined specifiers---@samp{u}.
20938 The next character in the format string should be a letter. Gnus
20939 will call the function @code{gnus-user-format-function-}@samp{X}, where
20940 @samp{X} is the letter following @samp{%u}. The function will be passed
20941 a single parameter---what the parameter means depends on what buffer
20942 it's being called from. The function should return a string, which will
20943 be inserted into the buffer just like information from any other
20944 specifier. This function may also be called with dummy values, so it
20945 should protect against that.
20946
20947 Also Gnus supports extended user-defined specs, such as @samp{%u&foo;}.
20948 Gnus will call the function @code{gnus-user-format-function-}@samp{foo}.
20949
20950 You can also use tilde modifiers (@pxref{Advanced Formatting} to achieve
20951 much the same without defining new functions. Here's an example:
20952 @samp{%~(form (count-lines (point-min) (point)))@@}. The form
20953 given here will be evaluated to yield the current line number, and then
20954 inserted.
20955
20956
20957 @node Formatting Fonts
20958 @subsection Formatting Fonts
20959
20960 There are specs for highlighting, and these are shared by all the format
20961 variables. Text inside the @samp{%(} and @samp{%)} specifiers will get
20962 the special @code{mouse-face} property set, which means that it will be
20963 highlighted (with @code{gnus-mouse-face}) when you put the mouse pointer
20964 over it.
20965
20966 Text inside the @samp{%@{} and @samp{%@}} specifiers will have their
20967 normal faces set using @code{gnus-face-0}, which is @code{bold} by
20968 default. If you say @samp{%1@{}, you'll get @code{gnus-face-1} instead,
20969 and so on. Create as many faces as you wish. The same goes for the
20970 @code{mouse-face} specs---you can say @samp{%3(hello%)} to have
20971 @samp{hello} mouse-highlighted with @code{gnus-mouse-face-3}.
20972
20973 Text inside the @samp{%<<} and @samp{%>>} specifiers will get the
20974 special @code{balloon-help} property set to
20975 @code{gnus-balloon-face-0}. If you say @samp{%1<<}, you'll get
20976 @code{gnus-balloon-face-1} and so on. The @code{gnus-balloon-face-*}
20977 variables should be either strings or symbols naming functions that
20978 return a string. When the mouse passes over text with this property
20979 set, a balloon window will appear and display the string. Please
20980 refer to @ref{Tooltips, ,Tooltips, emacs, The Emacs Manual},
20981 (in GNU Emacs) or the doc string of @code{balloon-help-mode} (in
20982 XEmacs) for more information on this. (For technical reasons, the
20983 guillemets have been approximated as @samp{<<} and @samp{>>} in this
20984 paragraph.)
20985
20986 Here's an alternative recipe for the group buffer:
20987
20988 @lisp
20989 ;; @r{Create three face types.}
20990 (setq gnus-face-1 'bold)
20991 (setq gnus-face-3 'italic)
20992
20993 ;; @r{We want the article count to be in}
20994 ;; @r{a bold and green face. So we create}
20995 ;; @r{a new face called @code{my-green-bold}.}
20996 (copy-face 'bold 'my-green-bold)
20997 ;; @r{Set the color.}
20998 (set-face-foreground 'my-green-bold "ForestGreen")
20999 (setq gnus-face-2 'my-green-bold)
21000
21001 ;; @r{Set the new & fancy format.}
21002 (setq gnus-group-line-format
21003 "%M%S%3@{%5y%@}%2[:%] %(%1@{%g%@}%)\n")
21004 @end lisp
21005
21006 I'm sure you'll be able to use this scheme to create totally unreadable
21007 and extremely vulgar displays. Have fun!
21008
21009 Note that the @samp{%(} specs (and friends) do not make any sense on the
21010 mode-line variables.
21011
21012 @node Positioning Point
21013 @subsection Positioning Point
21014
21015 Gnus usually moves point to a pre-defined place on each line in most
21016 buffers. By default, point move to the first colon character on the
21017 line. You can customize this behavior in three different ways.
21018
21019 You can move the colon character to somewhere else on the line.
21020
21021 @findex gnus-goto-colon
21022 You can redefine the function that moves the point to the colon. The
21023 function is called @code{gnus-goto-colon}.
21024
21025 But perhaps the most convenient way to deal with this, if you don't want
21026 to have a colon in your line, is to use the @samp{%*} specifier. If you
21027 put a @samp{%*} somewhere in your format line definition, Gnus will
21028 place point there.
21029
21030
21031 @node Tabulation
21032 @subsection Tabulation
21033
21034 You can usually line up your displays by padding and cutting your
21035 strings. However, when combining various strings of different size, it
21036 can often be more convenient to just output the strings, and then worry
21037 about lining up the following text afterwards.
21038
21039 To do that, Gnus supplies tabulator specs---@samp{%=}. There are two
21040 different types---@dfn{hard tabulators} and @dfn{soft tabulators}.
21041
21042 @samp{%50=} will insert space characters to pad the line up to column
21043 50. If the text is already past column 50, nothing will be inserted.
21044 This is the soft tabulator.
21045
21046 @samp{%-50=} will insert space characters to pad the line up to column
21047 50. If the text is already past column 50, the excess text past column
21048 50 will be removed. This is the hard tabulator.
21049
21050
21051 @node Wide Characters
21052 @subsection Wide Characters
21053
21054 Fixed width fonts in most countries have characters of the same width.
21055 Some countries, however, use Latin characters mixed with wider
21056 characters---most notable East Asian countries.
21057
21058 The problem is that when formatting, Gnus assumes that if a string is 10
21059 characters wide, it'll be 10 Latin characters wide on the screen. In
21060 these countries, that's not true.
21061
21062 @vindex gnus-use-correct-string-widths
21063 To help fix this, you can set @code{gnus-use-correct-string-widths} to
21064 @code{t}. This makes buffer generation slower, but the results will be
21065 prettier. The default value under XEmacs is @code{t} but @code{nil}
21066 for Emacs.
21067
21068
21069 @node Window Layout
21070 @section Window Layout
21071 @cindex window layout
21072
21073 No, there's nothing here about X, so be quiet.
21074
21075 @vindex gnus-use-full-window
21076 If @code{gnus-use-full-window} non-@code{nil}, Gnus will delete all
21077 other windows and occupy the entire Emacs screen by itself. It is
21078 @code{t} by default.
21079
21080 Setting this variable to @code{nil} kinda works, but there are
21081 glitches. Use at your own peril.
21082
21083 @vindex gnus-buffer-configuration
21084 @code{gnus-buffer-configuration} describes how much space each Gnus
21085 buffer should be given. Here's an excerpt of this variable:
21086
21087 @lisp
21088 ((group (vertical 1.0 (group 1.0 point)
21089 (if gnus-carpal (group-carpal 4))))
21090 (article (vertical 1.0 (summary 0.25 point)
21091 (article 1.0))))
21092 @end lisp
21093
21094 This is an alist. The @dfn{key} is a symbol that names some action or
21095 other. For instance, when displaying the group buffer, the window
21096 configuration function will use @code{group} as the key. A full list of
21097 possible names is listed below.
21098
21099 The @dfn{value} (i.e., the @dfn{split}) says how much space each buffer
21100 should occupy. To take the @code{article} split as an example -
21101
21102 @lisp
21103 (article (vertical 1.0 (summary 0.25 point)
21104 (article 1.0)))
21105 @end lisp
21106
21107 This @dfn{split} says that the summary buffer should occupy 25% of upper
21108 half of the screen, and that it is placed over the article buffer. As
21109 you may have noticed, 100% + 25% is actually 125% (yup, I saw y'all
21110 reaching for that calculator there). However, the special number
21111 @code{1.0} is used to signal that this buffer should soak up all the
21112 rest of the space available after the rest of the buffers have taken
21113 whatever they need. There should be only one buffer with the @code{1.0}
21114 size spec per split.
21115
21116 Point will be put in the buffer that has the optional third element
21117 @code{point}. In a @code{frame} split, the last subsplit having a leaf
21118 split where the tag @code{frame-focus} is a member (i.e. is the third or
21119 fourth element in the list, depending on whether the @code{point} tag is
21120 present) gets focus.
21121
21122 Here's a more complicated example:
21123
21124 @lisp
21125 (article (vertical 1.0 (group 4)
21126 (summary 0.25 point)
21127 (if gnus-carpal (summary-carpal 4))
21128 (article 1.0)))
21129 @end lisp
21130
21131 If the size spec is an integer instead of a floating point number,
21132 then that number will be used to say how many lines a buffer should
21133 occupy, not a percentage.
21134
21135 If the @dfn{split} looks like something that can be @code{eval}ed (to be
21136 precise---if the @code{car} of the split is a function or a subr), this
21137 split will be @code{eval}ed. If the result is non-@code{nil}, it will
21138 be used as a split. This means that there will be three buffers if
21139 @code{gnus-carpal} is @code{nil}, and four buffers if @code{gnus-carpal}
21140 is non-@code{nil}.
21141
21142 Not complicated enough for you? Well, try this on for size:
21143
21144 @lisp
21145 (article (horizontal 1.0
21146 (vertical 0.5
21147 (group 1.0)
21148 (gnus-carpal 4))
21149 (vertical 1.0
21150 (summary 0.25 point)
21151 (summary-carpal 4)
21152 (article 1.0))))
21153 @end lisp
21154
21155 Whoops. Two buffers with the mystery 100% tag. And what's that
21156 @code{horizontal} thingie?
21157
21158 If the first element in one of the split is @code{horizontal}, Gnus will
21159 split the window horizontally, giving you two windows side-by-side.
21160 Inside each of these strips you may carry on all you like in the normal
21161 fashion. The number following @code{horizontal} says what percentage of
21162 the screen is to be given to this strip.
21163
21164 For each split, there @emph{must} be one element that has the 100% tag.
21165 The splitting is never accurate, and this buffer will eat any leftover
21166 lines from the splits.
21167
21168 To be slightly more formal, here's a definition of what a valid split
21169 may look like:
21170
21171 @example
21172 @group
21173 split = frame | horizontal | vertical | buffer | form
21174 frame = "(frame " size *split ")"
21175 horizontal = "(horizontal " size *split ")"
21176 vertical = "(vertical " size *split ")"
21177 buffer = "(" buf-name " " size *[ "point" ] *[ "frame-focus"] ")"
21178 size = number | frame-params
21179 buf-name = group | article | summary ...
21180 @end group
21181 @end example
21182
21183 The limitations are that the @code{frame} split can only appear as the
21184 top-level split. @var{form} should be an Emacs Lisp form that should
21185 return a valid split. We see that each split is fully recursive, and
21186 may contain any number of @code{vertical} and @code{horizontal} splits.
21187
21188 @vindex gnus-window-min-width
21189 @vindex gnus-window-min-height
21190 @cindex window height
21191 @cindex window width
21192 Finding the right sizes can be a bit complicated. No window may be less
21193 than @code{gnus-window-min-height} (default 1) characters high, and all
21194 windows must be at least @code{gnus-window-min-width} (default 1)
21195 characters wide. Gnus will try to enforce this before applying the
21196 splits. If you want to use the normal Emacs window width/height limit,
21197 you can just set these two variables to @code{nil}.
21198
21199 If you're not familiar with Emacs terminology, @code{horizontal} and
21200 @code{vertical} splits may work the opposite way of what you'd expect.
21201 Windows inside a @code{horizontal} split are shown side-by-side, and
21202 windows within a @code{vertical} split are shown above each other.
21203
21204 @findex gnus-configure-frame
21205 If you want to experiment with window placement, a good tip is to call
21206 @code{gnus-configure-frame} directly with a split. This is the function
21207 that does all the real work when splitting buffers. Below is a pretty
21208 nonsensical configuration with 5 windows; two for the group buffer and
21209 three for the article buffer. (I said it was nonsensical.) If you
21210 @code{eval} the statement below, you can get an idea of how that would
21211 look straight away, without going through the normal Gnus channels.
21212 Play with it until you're satisfied, and then use
21213 @code{gnus-add-configuration} to add your new creation to the buffer
21214 configuration list.
21215
21216 @lisp
21217 (gnus-configure-frame
21218 '(horizontal 1.0
21219 (vertical 10
21220 (group 1.0)
21221 (article 0.3 point))
21222 (vertical 1.0
21223 (article 1.0)
21224 (horizontal 4
21225 (group 1.0)
21226 (article 10)))))
21227 @end lisp
21228
21229 You might want to have several frames as well. No prob---just use the
21230 @code{frame} split:
21231
21232 @lisp
21233 (gnus-configure-frame
21234 '(frame 1.0
21235 (vertical 1.0
21236 (summary 0.25 point frame-focus)
21237 (article 1.0))
21238 (vertical ((height . 5) (width . 15)
21239 (user-position . t)
21240 (left . -1) (top . 1))
21241 (picon 1.0))))
21242
21243 @end lisp
21244
21245 This split will result in the familiar summary/article window
21246 configuration in the first (or ``main'') frame, while a small additional
21247 frame will be created where picons will be shown. As you can see,
21248 instead of the normal @code{1.0} top-level spec, each additional split
21249 should have a frame parameter alist as the size spec.
21250 @xref{Frame Parameters, , Frame Parameters, elisp, The GNU Emacs Lisp
21251 Reference Manual}. Under XEmacs, a frame property list will be
21252 accepted, too---for instance, @code{(height 5 width 15 left -1 top 1)}
21253 is such a plist.
21254 The list of all possible keys for @code{gnus-buffer-configuration} can
21255 be found in its default value.
21256
21257 Note that the @code{message} key is used for both
21258 @code{gnus-group-mail} and @code{gnus-summary-mail-other-window}. If
21259 it is desirable to distinguish between the two, something like this
21260 might be used:
21261
21262 @lisp
21263 (message (horizontal 1.0
21264 (vertical 1.0 (message 1.0 point))
21265 (vertical 0.24
21266 (if (buffer-live-p gnus-summary-buffer)
21267 '(summary 0.5))
21268 (group 1.0))))
21269 @end lisp
21270
21271 One common desire for a multiple frame split is to have a separate frame
21272 for composing mail and news while leaving the original frame intact. To
21273 accomplish that, something like the following can be done:
21274
21275 @lisp
21276 (message
21277 (frame 1.0
21278 (if (not (buffer-live-p gnus-summary-buffer))
21279 (car (cdr (assoc 'group gnus-buffer-configuration)))
21280 (car (cdr (assoc 'summary gnus-buffer-configuration))))
21281 (vertical ((user-position . t) (top . 1) (left . 1)
21282 (name . "Message"))
21283 (message 1.0 point))))
21284 @end lisp
21285
21286 @findex gnus-add-configuration
21287 Since the @code{gnus-buffer-configuration} variable is so long and
21288 complicated, there's a function you can use to ease changing the config
21289 of a single setting: @code{gnus-add-configuration}. If, for instance,
21290 you want to change the @code{article} setting, you could say:
21291
21292 @lisp
21293 (gnus-add-configuration
21294 '(article (vertical 1.0
21295 (group 4)
21296 (summary .25 point)
21297 (article 1.0))))
21298 @end lisp
21299
21300 You'd typically stick these @code{gnus-add-configuration} calls in your
21301 @file{~/.gnus.el} file or in some startup hook---they should be run after
21302 Gnus has been loaded.
21303
21304 @vindex gnus-always-force-window-configuration
21305 If all windows mentioned in the configuration are already visible, Gnus
21306 won't change the window configuration. If you always want to force the
21307 ``right'' window configuration, you can set
21308 @code{gnus-always-force-window-configuration} to non-@code{nil}.
21309
21310 If you're using tree displays (@pxref{Tree Display}), and the tree
21311 window is displayed vertically next to another window, you may also want
21312 to fiddle with @code{gnus-tree-minimize-window} to avoid having the
21313 windows resized.
21314
21315 @subsection Example Window Configurations
21316
21317 @itemize @bullet
21318 @item
21319 Narrow left hand side occupied by group buffer. Right hand side split
21320 between summary buffer (top one-sixth) and article buffer (bottom).
21321
21322 @ifinfo
21323 @example
21324 +---+---------+
21325 | G | Summary |
21326 | r +---------+
21327 | o | |
21328 | u | Article |
21329 | p | |
21330 +---+---------+
21331 @end example
21332 @end ifinfo
21333
21334 @lisp
21335 (gnus-add-configuration
21336 '(article
21337 (horizontal 1.0
21338 (vertical 25 (group 1.0))
21339 (vertical 1.0
21340 (summary 0.16 point)
21341 (article 1.0)))))
21342
21343 (gnus-add-configuration
21344 '(summary
21345 (horizontal 1.0
21346 (vertical 25 (group 1.0))
21347 (vertical 1.0 (summary 1.0 point)))))
21348 @end lisp
21349
21350 @end itemize
21351
21352
21353 @node Faces and Fonts
21354 @section Faces and Fonts
21355 @cindex faces
21356 @cindex fonts
21357 @cindex colors
21358
21359 Fiddling with fonts and faces used to be very difficult, but these days
21360 it is very simple. You simply say @kbd{M-x customize-face}, pick out
21361 the face you want to alter, and alter it via the standard Customize
21362 interface.
21363
21364
21365 @node Compilation
21366 @section Compilation
21367 @cindex compilation
21368 @cindex byte-compilation
21369
21370 @findex gnus-compile
21371
21372 Remember all those line format specification variables?
21373 @code{gnus-summary-line-format}, @code{gnus-group-line-format}, and so
21374 on. Now, Gnus will of course heed whatever these variables are, but,
21375 unfortunately, changing them will mean a quite significant slow-down.
21376 (The default values of these variables have byte-compiled functions
21377 associated with them, while the user-generated versions do not, of
21378 course.)
21379
21380 To help with this, you can run @kbd{M-x gnus-compile} after you've
21381 fiddled around with the variables and feel that you're (kind of)
21382 satisfied. This will result in the new specs being byte-compiled, and
21383 you'll get top speed again. Gnus will save these compiled specs in the
21384 @file{.newsrc.eld} file. (User-defined functions aren't compiled by
21385 this function, though---you should compile them yourself by sticking
21386 them into the @file{~/.gnus.el} file and byte-compiling that file.)
21387
21388
21389 @node Mode Lines
21390 @section Mode Lines
21391 @cindex mode lines
21392
21393 @vindex gnus-updated-mode-lines
21394 @code{gnus-updated-mode-lines} says what buffers should keep their mode
21395 lines updated. It is a list of symbols. Supported symbols include
21396 @code{group}, @code{article}, @code{summary}, @code{server},
21397 @code{browse}, and @code{tree}. If the corresponding symbol is present,
21398 Gnus will keep that mode line updated with information that may be
21399 pertinent. If this variable is @code{nil}, screen refresh may be
21400 quicker.
21401
21402 @cindex display-time
21403
21404 @vindex gnus-mode-non-string-length
21405 By default, Gnus displays information on the current article in the mode
21406 lines of the summary and article buffers. The information Gnus wishes
21407 to display (e.g. the subject of the article) is often longer than the
21408 mode lines, and therefore have to be cut off at some point. The
21409 @code{gnus-mode-non-string-length} variable says how long the other
21410 elements on the line is (i.e., the non-info part). If you put
21411 additional elements on the mode line (e.g. a clock), you should modify
21412 this variable:
21413
21414 @c Hook written by Francesco Potorti` <pot@cnuce.cnr.it>
21415 @lisp
21416 (add-hook 'display-time-hook
21417 (lambda () (setq gnus-mode-non-string-length
21418 (+ 21
21419 (if line-number-mode 5 0)
21420 (if column-number-mode 4 0)
21421 (length display-time-string)))))
21422 @end lisp
21423
21424 If this variable is @code{nil} (which is the default), the mode line
21425 strings won't be chopped off, and they won't be padded either. Note
21426 that the default is unlikely to be desirable, as even the percentage
21427 complete in the buffer may be crowded off the mode line; the user should
21428 configure this variable appropriately for her configuration.
21429
21430
21431 @node Highlighting and Menus
21432 @section Highlighting and Menus
21433 @cindex visual
21434 @cindex highlighting
21435 @cindex menus
21436
21437 @vindex gnus-visual
21438 The @code{gnus-visual} variable controls most of the Gnus-prettifying
21439 aspects. If @code{nil}, Gnus won't attempt to create menus or use fancy
21440 colors or fonts. This will also inhibit loading the @file{gnus-vis.el}
21441 file.
21442
21443 This variable can be a list of visual properties that are enabled. The
21444 following elements are valid, and are all included by default:
21445
21446 @table @code
21447 @item group-highlight
21448 Do highlights in the group buffer.
21449 @item summary-highlight
21450 Do highlights in the summary buffer.
21451 @item article-highlight
21452 Do highlights in the article buffer.
21453 @item highlight
21454 Turn on highlighting in all buffers.
21455 @item group-menu
21456 Create menus in the group buffer.
21457 @item summary-menu
21458 Create menus in the summary buffers.
21459 @item article-menu
21460 Create menus in the article buffer.
21461 @item browse-menu
21462 Create menus in the browse buffer.
21463 @item server-menu
21464 Create menus in the server buffer.
21465 @item score-menu
21466 Create menus in the score buffers.
21467 @item menu
21468 Create menus in all buffers.
21469 @end table
21470
21471 So if you only want highlighting in the article buffer and menus in all
21472 buffers, you could say something like:
21473
21474 @lisp
21475 (setq gnus-visual '(article-highlight menu))
21476 @end lisp
21477
21478 If you want highlighting only and no menus whatsoever, you'd say:
21479
21480 @lisp
21481 (setq gnus-visual '(highlight))
21482 @end lisp
21483
21484 If @code{gnus-visual} is @code{t}, highlighting and menus will be used
21485 in all Gnus buffers.
21486
21487 Other general variables that influence the look of all buffers include:
21488
21489 @table @code
21490 @item gnus-mouse-face
21491 @vindex gnus-mouse-face
21492 This is the face (i.e., font) used for mouse highlighting in Gnus. No
21493 mouse highlights will be done if @code{gnus-visual} is @code{nil}.
21494
21495 @end table
21496
21497 There are hooks associated with the creation of all the different menus:
21498
21499 @table @code
21500
21501 @item gnus-article-menu-hook
21502 @vindex gnus-article-menu-hook
21503 Hook called after creating the article mode menu.
21504
21505 @item gnus-group-menu-hook
21506 @vindex gnus-group-menu-hook
21507 Hook called after creating the group mode menu.
21508
21509 @item gnus-summary-menu-hook
21510 @vindex gnus-summary-menu-hook
21511 Hook called after creating the summary mode menu.
21512
21513 @item gnus-server-menu-hook
21514 @vindex gnus-server-menu-hook
21515 Hook called after creating the server mode menu.
21516
21517 @item gnus-browse-menu-hook
21518 @vindex gnus-browse-menu-hook
21519 Hook called after creating the browse mode menu.
21520
21521 @item gnus-score-menu-hook
21522 @vindex gnus-score-menu-hook
21523 Hook called after creating the score mode menu.
21524
21525 @end table
21526
21527
21528 @node Buttons
21529 @section Buttons
21530 @cindex buttons
21531 @cindex mouse
21532 @cindex click
21533
21534 Those new-fangled @dfn{mouse} contraptions is very popular with the
21535 young, hep kids who don't want to learn the proper way to do things
21536 these days. Why, I remember way back in the summer of '89, when I was
21537 using Emacs on a Tops 20 system. Three hundred users on one single
21538 machine, and every user was running Simula compilers. Bah!
21539
21540 Right.
21541
21542 @vindex gnus-carpal
21543 Well, you can make Gnus display bufferfuls of buttons you can click to
21544 do anything by setting @code{gnus-carpal} to @code{t}. Pretty simple,
21545 really. Tell the chiropractor I sent you.
21546
21547
21548 @table @code
21549
21550 @item gnus-carpal-mode-hook
21551 @vindex gnus-carpal-mode-hook
21552 Hook run in all carpal mode buffers.
21553
21554 @item gnus-carpal-button-face
21555 @vindex gnus-carpal-button-face
21556 Face used on buttons.
21557
21558 @item gnus-carpal-header-face
21559 @vindex gnus-carpal-header-face
21560 Face used on carpal buffer headers.
21561
21562 @item gnus-carpal-group-buffer-buttons
21563 @vindex gnus-carpal-group-buffer-buttons
21564 Buttons in the group buffer.
21565
21566 @item gnus-carpal-summary-buffer-buttons
21567 @vindex gnus-carpal-summary-buffer-buttons
21568 Buttons in the summary buffer.
21569
21570 @item gnus-carpal-server-buffer-buttons
21571 @vindex gnus-carpal-server-buffer-buttons
21572 Buttons in the server buffer.
21573
21574 @item gnus-carpal-browse-buffer-buttons
21575 @vindex gnus-carpal-browse-buffer-buttons
21576 Buttons in the browse buffer.
21577 @end table
21578
21579 All the @code{buttons} variables are lists. The elements in these list
21580 are either cons cells where the @code{car} contains a text to be displayed and
21581 the @code{cdr} contains a function symbol, or a simple string.
21582
21583
21584 @node Daemons
21585 @section Daemons
21586 @cindex demons
21587 @cindex daemons
21588
21589 Gnus, being larger than any program ever written (allegedly), does lots
21590 of strange stuff that you may wish to have done while you're not
21591 present. For instance, you may want it to check for new mail once in a
21592 while. Or you may want it to close down all connections to all servers
21593 when you leave Emacs idle. And stuff like that.
21594
21595 Gnus will let you do stuff like that by defining various
21596 @dfn{handlers}. Each handler consists of three elements: A
21597 @var{function}, a @var{time}, and an @var{idle} parameter.
21598
21599 Here's an example of a handler that closes connections when Emacs has
21600 been idle for thirty minutes:
21601
21602 @lisp
21603 (gnus-demon-close-connections nil 30)
21604 @end lisp
21605
21606 Here's a handler that scans for @acronym{PGP} headers every hour when
21607 Emacs is idle:
21608
21609 @lisp
21610 (gnus-demon-scan-pgp 60 t)
21611 @end lisp
21612
21613 This @var{time} parameter and that @var{idle} parameter work together
21614 in a strange, but wonderful fashion. Basically, if @var{idle} is
21615 @code{nil}, then the function will be called every @var{time} minutes.
21616
21617 If @var{idle} is @code{t}, then the function will be called after
21618 @var{time} minutes only if Emacs is idle. So if Emacs is never idle,
21619 the function will never be called. But once Emacs goes idle, the
21620 function will be called every @var{time} minutes.
21621
21622 If @var{idle} is a number and @var{time} is a number, the function will
21623 be called every @var{time} minutes only when Emacs has been idle for
21624 @var{idle} minutes.
21625
21626 If @var{idle} is a number and @var{time} is @code{nil}, the function
21627 will be called once every time Emacs has been idle for @var{idle}
21628 minutes.
21629
21630 And if @var{time} is a string, it should look like @samp{07:31}, and
21631 the function will then be called once every day somewhere near that
21632 time. Modified by the @var{idle} parameter, of course.
21633
21634 @vindex gnus-demon-timestep
21635 (When I say ``minute'' here, I really mean @code{gnus-demon-timestep}
21636 seconds. This is 60 by default. If you change that variable,
21637 all the timings in the handlers will be affected.)
21638
21639 So, if you want to add a handler, you could put something like this in
21640 your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
21641
21642 @findex gnus-demon-add-handler
21643 @lisp
21644 (gnus-demon-add-handler 'gnus-demon-close-connections 30 t)
21645 @end lisp
21646
21647 @findex gnus-demon-add-nocem
21648 @findex gnus-demon-add-scanmail
21649 @findex gnus-demon-add-rescan
21650 @findex gnus-demon-add-scan-timestamps
21651 @findex gnus-demon-add-disconnection
21652 Some ready-made functions to do this have been created:
21653 @code{gnus-demon-add-nocem}, @code{gnus-demon-add-disconnection},
21654 @code{gnus-demon-add-nntp-close-connection},
21655 @code{gnus-demon-add-scan-timestamps}, @code{gnus-demon-add-rescan}, and
21656 @code{gnus-demon-add-scanmail}. Just put those functions in your
21657 @file{~/.gnus.el} if you want those abilities.
21658
21659 @findex gnus-demon-init
21660 @findex gnus-demon-cancel
21661 @vindex gnus-demon-handlers
21662 If you add handlers to @code{gnus-demon-handlers} directly, you should
21663 run @code{gnus-demon-init} to make the changes take hold. To cancel all
21664 daemons, you can use the @code{gnus-demon-cancel} function.
21665
21666 Note that adding daemons can be pretty naughty if you over do it. Adding
21667 functions that scan all news and mail from all servers every two seconds
21668 is a sure-fire way of getting booted off any respectable system. So
21669 behave.
21670
21671
21672 @node NoCeM
21673 @section NoCeM
21674 @cindex nocem
21675 @cindex spam
21676
21677 @dfn{Spamming} is posting the same article lots and lots of times.
21678 Spamming is bad. Spamming is evil.
21679
21680 Spamming is usually canceled within a day or so by various anti-spamming
21681 agencies. These agencies usually also send out @dfn{NoCeM} messages.
21682 NoCeM is pronounced ``no see-'em'', and means what the name
21683 implies---these are messages that make the offending articles, like, go
21684 away.
21685
21686 What use are these NoCeM messages if the articles are canceled anyway?
21687 Some sites do not honor cancel messages and some sites just honor cancels
21688 from a select few people. Then you may wish to make use of the NoCeM
21689 messages, which are distributed in the @samp{alt.nocem.misc} newsgroup.
21690
21691 Gnus can read and parse the messages in this group automatically, and
21692 this will make spam disappear.
21693
21694 There are some variables to customize, of course:
21695
21696 @table @code
21697 @item gnus-use-nocem
21698 @vindex gnus-use-nocem
21699 Set this variable to @code{t} to set the ball rolling. It is @code{nil}
21700 by default.
21701
21702 @item gnus-nocem-groups
21703 @vindex gnus-nocem-groups
21704 Gnus will look for NoCeM messages in the groups in this list. The
21705 default is
21706 @lisp
21707 ("news.lists.filters" "news.admin.net-abuse.bulletins"
21708 "alt.nocem.misc" "news.admin.net-abuse.announce")
21709 @end lisp
21710
21711 @item gnus-nocem-issuers
21712 @vindex gnus-nocem-issuers
21713 There are many people issuing NoCeM messages. This list says what
21714 people you want to listen to. The default is
21715 @lisp
21716 ("Automoose-1" "clewis@@ferret.ocunix.on.ca"
21717 "cosmo.roadkill" "SpamHippo" "hweede@@snafu.de")
21718 @end lisp
21719 fine, upstanding citizens all of them.
21720
21721 Known despammers that you can put in this list are listed at@*
21722 @uref{http://www.xs4all.nl/~rosalind/nocemreg/nocemreg.html}.
21723
21724 You do not have to heed NoCeM messages from all these people---just the
21725 ones you want to listen to. You also don't have to accept all NoCeM
21726 messages from the people you like. Each NoCeM message has a @dfn{type}
21727 header that gives the message a (more or less, usually less) rigorous
21728 definition. Common types are @samp{spam}, @samp{spew}, @samp{mmf},
21729 @samp{binary}, and @samp{troll}. To specify this, you have to use
21730 @code{(@var{issuer} @var{conditions} @dots{})} elements in the list.
21731 Each condition is either a string (which is a regexp that matches types
21732 you want to use) or a list on the form @code{(not @var{string})}, where
21733 @var{string} is a regexp that matches types you don't want to use.
21734
21735 For instance, if you want all NoCeM messages from Chris Lewis except his
21736 @samp{troll} messages, you'd say:
21737
21738 @lisp
21739 ("clewis@@ferret.ocunix.on.ca" ".*" (not "troll"))
21740 @end lisp
21741
21742 On the other hand, if you just want nothing but his @samp{spam} and
21743 @samp{spew} messages, you'd say:
21744
21745 @lisp
21746 ("clewis@@ferret.ocunix.on.ca" (not ".*") "spew" "spam")
21747 @end lisp
21748
21749 The specs are applied left-to-right.
21750
21751
21752 @item gnus-nocem-verifyer
21753 @vindex gnus-nocem-verifyer
21754 @findex pgg-verify
21755 This should be a function for verifying that the NoCeM issuer is who she
21756 says she is. The default is @code{pgg-verify}, which returns
21757 non-@code{nil} if the verification is successful, otherwise (including
21758 the case the NoCeM message was not signed) returns @code{nil}. If this
21759 is too slow and you don't care for verification (which may be dangerous),
21760 you can set this variable to @code{nil}.
21761
21762 Formerly the default was @code{mc-verify}, which is a Mailcrypt
21763 function. While you can still use it, you can change it into
21764 @code{pgg-verify} running with GnuPG if you are willing to add the
21765 @acronym{PGP} public keys to GnuPG's keyring.
21766
21767 @item gnus-nocem-directory
21768 @vindex gnus-nocem-directory
21769 This is where Gnus will store its NoCeM cache files. The default is@*
21770 @file{~/News/NoCeM/}.
21771
21772 @item gnus-nocem-expiry-wait
21773 @vindex gnus-nocem-expiry-wait
21774 The number of days before removing old NoCeM entries from the cache.
21775 The default is 15. If you make it shorter Gnus will be faster, but you
21776 might then see old spam.
21777
21778 @item gnus-nocem-check-from
21779 @vindex gnus-nocem-check-from
21780 Non-@code{nil} means check for valid issuers in message bodies.
21781 Otherwise don't bother fetching articles unless their author matches a
21782 valid issuer; that is much faster if you are selective about the
21783 issuers.
21784
21785 @item gnus-nocem-check-article-limit
21786 @vindex gnus-nocem-check-article-limit
21787 If non-@code{nil}, the maximum number of articles to check in any NoCeM
21788 group. NoCeM groups can be huge and very slow to process.
21789
21790 @end table
21791
21792 Using NoCeM could potentially be a memory hog. If you have many living
21793 (i. e., subscribed or unsubscribed groups), your Emacs process will grow
21794 big. If this is a problem, you should kill off all (or most) of your
21795 unsubscribed groups (@pxref{Subscription Commands}).
21796
21797
21798 @node Undo
21799 @section Undo
21800 @cindex undo
21801
21802 It is very useful to be able to undo actions one has done. In normal
21803 Emacs buffers, it's easy enough---you just push the @code{undo} button.
21804 In Gnus buffers, however, it isn't that simple.
21805
21806 The things Gnus displays in its buffer is of no value whatsoever to
21807 Gnus---it's all just data designed to look nice to the user.
21808 Killing a group in the group buffer with @kbd{C-k} makes the line
21809 disappear, but that's just a side-effect of the real action---the
21810 removal of the group in question from the internal Gnus structures.
21811 Undoing something like that can't be done by the normal Emacs
21812 @code{undo} function.
21813
21814 Gnus tries to remedy this somewhat by keeping track of what the user
21815 does and coming up with actions that would reverse the actions the user
21816 takes. When the user then presses the @code{undo} key, Gnus will run
21817 the code to reverse the previous action, or the previous actions.
21818 However, not all actions are easily reversible, so Gnus currently offers
21819 a few key functions to be undoable. These include killing groups,
21820 yanking groups, and changing the list of read articles of groups.
21821 That's it, really. More functions may be added in the future, but each
21822 added function means an increase in data to be stored, so Gnus will
21823 never be totally undoable.
21824
21825 @findex gnus-undo-mode
21826 @vindex gnus-use-undo
21827 @findex gnus-undo
21828 The undoability is provided by the @code{gnus-undo-mode} minor mode. It
21829 is used if @code{gnus-use-undo} is non-@code{nil}, which is the
21830 default. The @kbd{C-M-_} key performs the @code{gnus-undo}
21831 command, which should feel kinda like the normal Emacs @code{undo}
21832 command.
21833
21834
21835 @node Predicate Specifiers
21836 @section Predicate Specifiers
21837 @cindex predicate specifiers
21838
21839 Some Gnus variables are @dfn{predicate specifiers}. This is a special
21840 form that allows flexible specification of predicates without having
21841 to type all that much.
21842
21843 These specifiers are lists consisting of functions, symbols and lists.
21844
21845 Here's an example:
21846
21847 @lisp
21848 (or gnus-article-unseen-p
21849 gnus-article-unread-p)
21850 @end lisp
21851
21852 The available symbols are @code{or}, @code{and} and @code{not}. The
21853 functions all take one parameter.
21854
21855 @findex gnus-make-predicate
21856 Internally, Gnus calls @code{gnus-make-predicate} on these specifiers
21857 to create a function that can be called. This input parameter to this
21858 function will be passed along to all the functions in the predicate
21859 specifier.
21860
21861
21862 @node Moderation
21863 @section Moderation
21864 @cindex moderation
21865
21866 If you are a moderator, you can use the @file{gnus-mdrtn.el} package.
21867 It is not included in the standard Gnus package. Write a mail to
21868 @samp{larsi@@gnus.org} and state what group you moderate, and you'll
21869 get a copy.
21870
21871 The moderation package is implemented as a minor mode for summary
21872 buffers. Put
21873
21874 @lisp
21875 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-mode-hook 'gnus-moderate)
21876 @end lisp
21877
21878 in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file.
21879
21880 If you are the moderator of @samp{rec.zoofle}, this is how it's
21881 supposed to work:
21882
21883 @enumerate
21884 @item
21885 You split your incoming mail by matching on
21886 @samp{Newsgroups:.*rec.zoofle}, which will put all the to-be-posted
21887 articles in some mail group---for instance, @samp{nnml:rec.zoofle}.
21888
21889 @item
21890 You enter that group once in a while and post articles using the @kbd{e}
21891 (edit-and-post) or @kbd{s} (just send unedited) commands.
21892
21893 @item
21894 If, while reading the @samp{rec.zoofle} newsgroup, you happen upon some
21895 articles that weren't approved by you, you can cancel them with the
21896 @kbd{c} command.
21897 @end enumerate
21898
21899 To use moderation mode in these two groups, say:
21900
21901 @lisp
21902 (setq gnus-moderated-list
21903 "^nnml:rec.zoofle$\\|^rec.zoofle$")
21904 @end lisp
21905
21906
21907 @node Fetching a Group
21908 @section Fetching a Group
21909 @cindex fetching a group
21910
21911 @findex gnus-fetch-group
21912 It is sometimes convenient to be able to just say ``I want to read this
21913 group and I don't care whether Gnus has been started or not''. This is
21914 perhaps more useful for people who write code than for users, but the
21915 command @code{gnus-fetch-group} provides this functionality in any case.
21916 It takes the group name as a parameter.
21917
21918
21919 @node Image Enhancements
21920 @section Image Enhancements
21921
21922 XEmacs, as well as Emacs 21@footnote{Emacs 21 on MS Windows doesn't
21923 support images yet.}, is able to display pictures and stuff, so Gnus has
21924 taken advantage of that.
21925
21926 @menu
21927 * X-Face:: Display a funky, teensy black-and-white image.
21928 * Face:: Display a funkier, teensier colored image.
21929 * Smileys:: Show all those happy faces the way they were meant to be shown.
21930 * Picons:: How to display pictures of what you're reading.
21931 * XVarious:: Other XEmacsy Gnusey variables.
21932 @end menu
21933
21934
21935 @node X-Face
21936 @subsection X-Face
21937 @cindex x-face
21938
21939 @code{X-Face} headers describe a 48x48 pixel black-and-white (1 bit
21940 depth) image that's supposed to represent the author of the message.
21941 It seems to be supported by an ever-growing number of mail and news
21942 readers.
21943
21944 @cindex x-face
21945 @findex gnus-article-display-x-face
21946 @vindex gnus-article-x-face-command
21947 @vindex gnus-article-x-face-too-ugly
21948 @iftex
21949 @iflatex
21950 \include{xface}
21951 @end iflatex
21952 @end iftex
21953 @c @anchor{X-Face}
21954
21955 Decoding an @code{X-Face} header either requires an Emacs that has
21956 @samp{compface} support (which most XEmacs versions has), or that you
21957 have @samp{compface} installed on your system. If either is true,
21958 Gnus will default to displaying @code{X-Face} headers.
21959
21960 The variable that controls this is the
21961 @code{gnus-article-x-face-command} variable. If this variable is a
21962 string, this string will be executed in a sub-shell. If it is a
21963 function, this function will be called with the face as the argument.
21964 If the @code{gnus-article-x-face-too-ugly} (which is a regexp) matches
21965 the @code{From} header, the face will not be shown.
21966
21967 The default action under Emacs 20 is to fork off the @code{display}
21968 program@footnote{@code{display} is from the ImageMagick package. For
21969 the @code{uncompface} and @code{icontopbm} programs look for a package
21970 like @code{compface} or @code{faces-xface} on a GNU/Linux system.} to
21971 view the face.
21972
21973 Under XEmacs or Emacs 21+ with suitable image support, the default
21974 action is to display the face before the @code{From} header. (It's
21975 nicer if XEmacs has been compiled with @code{X-Face} support---that
21976 will make display somewhat faster. If there's no native @code{X-Face}
21977 support, Gnus will try to convert the @code{X-Face} header using
21978 external programs from the @code{pbmplus} package and
21979 friends.@footnote{On a GNU/Linux system look for packages with names
21980 like @code{netpbm}, @code{libgr-progs} and @code{compface}.})
21981
21982 (Note: @code{x-face} is used in the variable/function names, not
21983 @code{xface}).
21984
21985 @noindent
21986 Face and variable:
21987
21988 @table @code
21989 @item gnus-x-face
21990 @vindex gnus-x-face
21991 Face to show X-Face. The colors from this face are used as the
21992 foreground and background colors of the displayed X-Faces. The
21993 default colors are black and white.
21994 @end table
21995
21996 Gnus provides a few convenience functions and variables to allow
21997 easier insertion of X-Face headers in outgoing messages.
21998
21999 @findex gnus-random-x-face
22000 @vindex gnus-convert-pbm-to-x-face-command
22001 @vindex gnus-x-face-directory
22002 @code{gnus-random-x-face} goes through all the @samp{pbm} files in
22003 @code{gnus-x-face-directory} and picks one at random, and then
22004 converts it to the X-Face format by using the
22005 @code{gnus-convert-pbm-to-x-face-command} shell command. The
22006 @samp{pbm} files should be 48x48 pixels big. It returns the X-Face
22007 header data as a string.
22008
22009 @findex gnus-insert-random-x-face-header
22010 @code{gnus-insert-random-x-face-header} calls
22011 @code{gnus-random-x-face} and inserts a @samp{X-Face} header with the
22012 randomly generated data.
22013
22014 @findex gnus-x-face-from-file
22015 @vindex gnus-convert-image-to-x-face-command
22016 @code{gnus-x-face-from-file} takes a GIF file as the parameter, and then
22017 converts the file to X-Face format by using the
22018 @code{gnus-convert-image-to-x-face-command} shell command.
22019
22020 Here's how you would typically use the first function. Put something
22021 like the following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
22022
22023 @lisp
22024 (setq message-required-news-headers
22025 (nconc message-required-news-headers
22026 (list '(X-Face . gnus-random-x-face))))
22027 @end lisp
22028
22029 Using the last function would be something like this:
22030
22031 @lisp
22032 (setq message-required-news-headers
22033 (nconc message-required-news-headers
22034 (list '(X-Face . (lambda ()
22035 (gnus-x-face-from-file
22036 "~/My-face.gif"))))))
22037 @end lisp
22038
22039
22040 @node Face
22041 @subsection Face
22042 @cindex face
22043
22044 @c #### FIXME: faces and x-faces'implementations should really be harmonized.
22045
22046 @code{Face} headers are essentially a funkier version of @code{X-Face}
22047 ones. They describe a 48x48 pixel colored image that's supposed to
22048 represent the author of the message.
22049
22050 @cindex face
22051 @findex gnus-article-display-face
22052 The contents of a @code{Face} header must be a base64 encoded PNG image.
22053 See @uref{http://quimby.gnus.org/circus/face/} for the precise
22054 specifications.
22055
22056 Gnus provides a few convenience functions and variables to allow
22057 easier insertion of Face headers in outgoing messages.
22058
22059 @findex gnus-convert-png-to-face
22060 @code{gnus-convert-png-to-face} takes a 48x48 PNG image, no longer than
22061 726 bytes long, and converts it to a face.
22062
22063 @findex gnus-face-from-file
22064 @vindex gnus-convert-image-to-face-command
22065 @code{gnus-face-from-file} takes a JPEG file as the parameter, and then
22066 converts the file to Face format by using the
22067 @code{gnus-convert-image-to-face-command} shell command.
22068
22069 Here's how you would typically use this function. Put something like the
22070 following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
22071
22072 @lisp
22073 (setq message-required-news-headers
22074 (nconc message-required-news-headers
22075 (list '(Face . (lambda ()
22076 (gnus-face-from-file "~/face.jpg"))))))
22077 @end lisp
22078
22079
22080 @node Smileys
22081 @subsection Smileys
22082 @cindex smileys
22083
22084 @iftex
22085 @iflatex
22086 \gnusfig{-3cm}{0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/BigFace,height=20cm}}
22087 \input{smiley}
22088 @end iflatex
22089 @end iftex
22090
22091 @dfn{Smiley} is a package separate from Gnus, but since Gnus is
22092 currently the only package that uses Smiley, it is documented here.
22093
22094 In short---to use Smiley in Gnus, put the following in your
22095 @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
22096
22097 @lisp
22098 (setq gnus-treat-display-smileys t)
22099 @end lisp
22100
22101 Smiley maps text smiley faces---@samp{:-)}, @samp{8-)}, @samp{:-(} and
22102 the like---to pictures and displays those instead of the text smiley
22103 faces. The conversion is controlled by a list of regexps that matches
22104 text and maps that to file names.
22105
22106 @vindex smiley-regexp-alist
22107 The alist used is specified by the @code{smiley-regexp-alist}
22108 variable. The first item in each element is the regexp to be matched;
22109 the second element is the regexp match group that is to be replaced by
22110 the picture; and the third element is the name of the file to be
22111 displayed.
22112
22113 The following variables customize where Smiley will look for these
22114 files:
22115
22116 @table @code
22117
22118 @item smiley-data-directory
22119 @vindex smiley-data-directory
22120 Where Smiley will look for smiley faces files.
22121
22122 @item gnus-smiley-file-types
22123 @vindex gnus-smiley-file-types
22124 List of suffixes on smiley file names to try.
22125
22126 @end table
22127
22128
22129 @node Picons
22130 @subsection Picons
22131
22132 @iftex
22133 @iflatex
22134 \include{picons}
22135 @end iflatex
22136 @end iftex
22137
22138 So@dots{} You want to slow down your news reader even more! This is a
22139 good way to do so. It's also a great way to impress people staring
22140 over your shoulder as you read news.
22141
22142 What are Picons? To quote directly from the Picons Web site:
22143
22144 @iftex
22145 @iflatex
22146 \margindex{}
22147 @end iflatex
22148 @end iftex
22149
22150 @quotation
22151 @dfn{Picons} is short for ``personal icons''. They're small,
22152 constrained images used to represent users and domains on the net,
22153 organized into databases so that the appropriate image for a given
22154 e-mail address can be found. Besides users and domains, there are picon
22155 databases for Usenet newsgroups and weather forecasts. The picons are
22156 in either monochrome @code{XBM} format or color @code{XPM} and
22157 @code{GIF} formats.
22158 @end quotation
22159
22160 @vindex gnus-picon-databases
22161 For instructions on obtaining and installing the picons databases,
22162 point your Web browser at
22163 @uref{http://www.cs.indiana.edu/picons/ftp/index.html}.
22164
22165 If you are using Debian GNU/Linux, saying @samp{apt-get install
22166 picons.*} will install the picons where Gnus can find them.
22167
22168 To enable displaying picons, simply make sure that
22169 @code{gnus-picon-databases} points to the directory containing the
22170 Picons databases.
22171
22172 The following variables offer control over where things are located.
22173
22174 @table @code
22175
22176 @item gnus-picon-databases
22177 @vindex gnus-picon-databases
22178 The location of the picons database. This is a list of directories
22179 containing the @file{news}, @file{domains}, @file{users} (and so on)
22180 subdirectories. Defaults to @code{("/usr/lib/picon"
22181 "/usr/local/faces")}.
22182
22183 @item gnus-picon-news-directories
22184 @vindex gnus-picon-news-directories
22185 List of subdirectories to search in @code{gnus-picon-databases} for
22186 newsgroups faces. @code{("news")} is the default.
22187
22188 @item gnus-picon-user-directories
22189 @vindex gnus-picon-user-directories
22190 List of subdirectories to search in @code{gnus-picon-databases} for user
22191 faces. @code{("users" "usenix" "local" "misc")} is the default.
22192
22193 @item gnus-picon-domain-directories
22194 @vindex gnus-picon-domain-directories
22195 List of subdirectories to search in @code{gnus-picon-databases} for
22196 domain name faces. Defaults to @code{("domains")}. Some people may
22197 want to add @samp{"unknown"} to this list.
22198
22199 @item gnus-picon-file-types
22200 @vindex gnus-picon-file-types
22201 Ordered list of suffixes on picon file names to try. Defaults to
22202 @code{("xpm" "gif" "xbm")} minus those not built-in your Emacs.
22203
22204 @end table
22205
22206
22207 @node XVarious
22208 @subsection Various XEmacs Variables
22209
22210 @table @code
22211 @item gnus-xmas-glyph-directory
22212 @vindex gnus-xmas-glyph-directory
22213 This is where Gnus will look for pictures. Gnus will normally
22214 auto-detect this directory, but you may set it manually if you have an
22215 unusual directory structure.
22216
22217 @item gnus-xmas-logo-color-alist
22218 @vindex gnus-xmas-logo-color-alist
22219 This is an alist where the key is a type symbol and the values are the
22220 foreground and background color of the splash page glyph.
22221
22222 @item gnus-xmas-logo-color-style
22223 @vindex gnus-xmas-logo-color-style
22224 This is the key used to look up the color in the alist described above.
22225 Valid values include @code{flame}, @code{pine}, @code{moss},
22226 @code{irish}, @code{sky}, @code{tin}, @code{velvet}, @code{grape},
22227 @code{labia}, @code{berry}, @code{neutral}, and @code{september}.
22228
22229 @item gnus-xmas-modeline-glyph
22230 @vindex gnus-xmas-modeline-glyph
22231 A glyph displayed in all Gnus mode lines. It is a tiny gnu head by
22232 default.
22233
22234 @end table
22235
22236 @subsubsection Toolbar
22237
22238 @table @code
22239
22240 @item gnus-use-toolbar
22241 @vindex gnus-use-toolbar
22242 If @code{nil}, don't display toolbars. If non-@code{nil}, it should be
22243 one of @code{default-toolbar}, @code{top-toolbar}, @code{bottom-toolbar},
22244 @code{right-toolbar}, or @code{left-toolbar}.
22245
22246 @item gnus-group-toolbar
22247 @vindex gnus-group-toolbar
22248 The toolbar in the group buffer.
22249
22250 @item gnus-summary-toolbar
22251 @vindex gnus-summary-toolbar
22252 The toolbar in the summary buffer.
22253
22254 @item gnus-summary-mail-toolbar
22255 @vindex gnus-summary-mail-toolbar
22256 The toolbar in the summary buffer of mail groups.
22257
22258 @end table
22259
22260 @iftex
22261 @iflatex
22262 \margindex{}
22263 @end iflatex
22264 @end iftex
22265
22266
22267 @node Fuzzy Matching
22268 @section Fuzzy Matching
22269 @cindex fuzzy matching
22270
22271 Gnus provides @dfn{fuzzy matching} of @code{Subject} lines when doing
22272 things like scoring, thread gathering and thread comparison.
22273
22274 As opposed to regular expression matching, fuzzy matching is very fuzzy.
22275 It's so fuzzy that there's not even a definition of what @dfn{fuzziness}
22276 means, and the implementation has changed over time.
22277
22278 Basically, it tries to remove all noise from lines before comparing.
22279 @samp{Re: }, parenthetical remarks, white space, and so on, are filtered
22280 out of the strings before comparing the results. This often leads to
22281 adequate results---even when faced with strings generated by text
22282 manglers masquerading as newsreaders.
22283
22284
22285 @node Thwarting Email Spam
22286 @section Thwarting Email Spam
22287 @cindex email spam
22288 @cindex spam
22289 @cindex UCE
22290 @cindex unsolicited commercial email
22291
22292 In these last days of the Usenet, commercial vultures are hanging about
22293 and grepping through news like crazy to find email addresses they can
22294 foist off their scams and products to. As a reaction to this, many
22295 people have started putting nonsense addresses into their @code{From}
22296 lines. I think this is counterproductive---it makes it difficult for
22297 people to send you legitimate mail in response to things you write, as
22298 well as making it difficult to see who wrote what. This rewriting may
22299 perhaps be a bigger menace than the unsolicited commercial email itself
22300 in the end.
22301
22302 The biggest problem I have with email spam is that it comes in under
22303 false pretenses. I press @kbd{g} and Gnus merrily informs me that I
22304 have 10 new emails. I say ``Golly gee! Happy is me!'' and select the
22305 mail group, only to find two pyramid schemes, seven advertisements
22306 (``New! Miracle tonic for growing full, lustrous hair on your toes!'')
22307 and one mail asking me to repent and find some god.
22308
22309 This is annoying. Here's what you can do about it.
22310
22311 @menu
22312 * The problem of spam:: Some background, and some solutions
22313 * Anti-Spam Basics:: Simple steps to reduce the amount of spam.
22314 * SpamAssassin:: How to use external anti-spam tools.
22315 * Hashcash:: Reduce spam by burning CPU time.
22316 * Filtering Spam Using The Spam ELisp Package::
22317 * Filtering Spam Using Statistics with spam-stat::
22318 @end menu
22319
22320 @node The problem of spam
22321 @subsection The problem of spam
22322 @cindex email spam
22323 @cindex spam filtering approaches
22324 @cindex filtering approaches, spam
22325 @cindex UCE
22326 @cindex unsolicited commercial email
22327
22328 First, some background on spam.
22329
22330 If you have access to e-mail, you are familiar with spam (technically
22331 termed @acronym{UCE}, Unsolicited Commercial E-mail). Simply put, it
22332 exists because e-mail delivery is very cheap compared to paper mail,
22333 so only a very small percentage of people need to respond to an UCE to
22334 make it worthwhile to the advertiser. Ironically, one of the most
22335 common spams is the one offering a database of e-mail addresses for
22336 further spamming. Senders of spam are usually called @emph{spammers},
22337 but terms like @emph{vermin}, @emph{scum}, @emph{sociopaths}, and
22338 @emph{morons} are in common use as well.
22339
22340 Spam comes from a wide variety of sources. It is simply impossible to
22341 dispose of all spam without discarding useful messages. A good
22342 example is the TMDA system, which requires senders
22343 unknown to you to confirm themselves as legitimate senders before
22344 their e-mail can reach you. Without getting into the technical side
22345 of TMDA, a downside is clearly that e-mail from legitimate sources may
22346 be discarded if those sources can't or won't confirm themselves
22347 through the TMDA system. Another problem with TMDA is that it
22348 requires its users to have a basic understanding of e-mail delivery
22349 and processing.
22350
22351 The simplest approach to filtering spam is filtering, at the mail
22352 server or when you sort through incoming mail. If you get 200 spam
22353 messages per day from @samp{random-address@@vmadmin.com}, you block
22354 @samp{vmadmin.com}. If you get 200 messages about @samp{VIAGRA}, you
22355 discard all messages with @samp{VIAGRA} in the message. If you get
22356 lots of spam from Bulgaria, for example, you try to filter all mail
22357 from Bulgarian IPs.
22358
22359 This, unfortunately, is a great way to discard legitimate e-mail. The
22360 risks of blocking a whole country (Bulgaria, Norway, Nigeria, China,
22361 etc.) or even a continent (Asia, Africa, Europe, etc.) from contacting
22362 you should be obvious, so don't do it if you have the choice.
22363
22364 In another instance, the very informative and useful RISKS digest has
22365 been blocked by overzealous mail filters because it @strong{contained}
22366 words that were common in spam messages. Nevertheless, in isolated
22367 cases, with great care, direct filtering of mail can be useful.
22368
22369 Another approach to filtering e-mail is the distributed spam
22370 processing, for instance DCC implements such a system. In essence,
22371 @var{N} systems around the world agree that a machine @var{X} in
22372 Ghana, Estonia, or California is sending out spam e-mail, and these
22373 @var{N} systems enter @var{X} or the spam e-mail from @var{X} into a
22374 database. The criteria for spam detection vary---it may be the number
22375 of messages sent, the content of the messages, and so on. When a user
22376 of the distributed processing system wants to find out if a message is
22377 spam, he consults one of those @var{N} systems.
22378
22379 Distributed spam processing works very well against spammers that send
22380 a large number of messages at once, but it requires the user to set up
22381 fairly complicated checks. There are commercial and free distributed
22382 spam processing systems. Distributed spam processing has its risks as
22383 well. For instance legitimate e-mail senders have been accused of
22384 sending spam, and their web sites and mailing lists have been shut
22385 down for some time because of the incident.
22386
22387 The statistical approach to spam filtering is also popular. It is
22388 based on a statistical analysis of previous spam messages. Usually
22389 the analysis is a simple word frequency count, with perhaps pairs of
22390 words or 3-word combinations thrown into the mix. Statistical
22391 analysis of spam works very well in most of the cases, but it can
22392 classify legitimate e-mail as spam in some cases. It takes time to
22393 run the analysis, the full message must be analyzed, and the user has
22394 to store the database of spam analyses. Statistical analysis on the
22395 server is gaining popularity. This has the advantage of letting the
22396 user Just Read Mail, but has the disadvantage that it's harder to tell
22397 the server that it has misclassified mail.
22398
22399 Fighting spam is not easy, no matter what anyone says. There is no
22400 magic switch that will distinguish Viagra ads from Mom's e-mails.
22401 Even people are having a hard time telling spam apart from non-spam,
22402 because spammers are actively looking to fool us into thinking they
22403 are Mom, essentially. Spamming is irritating, irresponsible, and
22404 idiotic behavior from a bunch of people who think the world owes them
22405 a favor. We hope the following sections will help you in fighting the
22406 spam plague.
22407
22408 @node Anti-Spam Basics
22409 @subsection Anti-Spam Basics
22410 @cindex email spam
22411 @cindex spam
22412 @cindex UCE
22413 @cindex unsolicited commercial email
22414
22415 One way of dealing with spam is having Gnus split out all spam into a
22416 @samp{spam} mail group (@pxref{Splitting Mail}).
22417
22418 First, pick one (1) valid mail address that you can be reached at, and
22419 put it in your @code{From} header of all your news articles. (I've
22420 chosen @samp{larsi@@trym.ifi.uio.no}, but for many addresses on the form
22421 @samp{larsi+usenet@@ifi.uio.no} will be a better choice. Ask your
22422 sysadmin whether your sendmail installation accepts keywords in the local
22423 part of the mail address.)
22424
22425 @lisp
22426 (setq message-default-news-headers
22427 "From: Lars Magne Ingebrigtsen <larsi@@trym.ifi.uio.no>\n")
22428 @end lisp
22429
22430 Then put the following split rule in @code{nnmail-split-fancy}
22431 (@pxref{Fancy Mail Splitting}):
22432
22433 @lisp
22434 (...
22435 (to "larsi@@trym.ifi.uio.no"
22436 (| ("subject" "re:.*" "misc")
22437 ("references" ".*@@.*" "misc")
22438 "spam"))
22439 ...)
22440 @end lisp
22441
22442 This says that all mail to this address is suspect, but if it has a
22443 @code{Subject} that starts with a @samp{Re:} or has a @code{References}
22444 header, it's probably ok. All the rest goes to the @samp{spam} group.
22445 (This idea probably comes from Tim Pierce.)
22446
22447 In addition, many mail spammers talk directly to your @acronym{SMTP} server
22448 and do not include your email address explicitly in the @code{To}
22449 header. Why they do this is unknown---perhaps it's to thwart this
22450 thwarting scheme? In any case, this is trivial to deal with---you just
22451 put anything not addressed to you in the @samp{spam} group by ending
22452 your fancy split rule in this way:
22453
22454 @lisp
22455 (
22456 ...
22457 (to "larsi" "misc")
22458 "spam")
22459 @end lisp
22460
22461 In my experience, this will sort virtually everything into the right
22462 group. You still have to check the @samp{spam} group from time to time to
22463 check for legitimate mail, though. If you feel like being a good net
22464 citizen, you can even send off complaints to the proper authorities on
22465 each unsolicited commercial email---at your leisure.
22466
22467 This works for me. It allows people an easy way to contact me (they can
22468 just press @kbd{r} in the usual way), and I'm not bothered at all with
22469 spam. It's a win-win situation. Forging @code{From} headers to point
22470 to non-existent domains is yucky, in my opinion.
22471
22472 Be careful with this approach. Spammers are wise to it.
22473
22474
22475 @node SpamAssassin
22476 @subsection SpamAssassin, Vipul's Razor, DCC, etc
22477 @cindex SpamAssassin
22478 @cindex Vipul's Razor
22479 @cindex DCC
22480
22481 The days where the hints in the previous section were sufficient in
22482 avoiding spam are coming to an end. There are many tools out there
22483 that claim to reduce the amount of spam you get. This section could
22484 easily become outdated fast, as new products replace old, but
22485 fortunately most of these tools seem to have similar interfaces. Even
22486 though this section will use SpamAssassin as an example, it should be
22487 easy to adapt it to most other tools.
22488
22489 Note that this section does not involve the @code{spam.el} package,
22490 which is discussed in the next section. If you don't care for all
22491 the features of @code{spam.el}, you can make do with these simple
22492 recipes.
22493
22494 If the tool you are using is not installed on the mail server, you
22495 need to invoke it yourself. Ideas on how to use the
22496 @code{:postscript} mail source parameter (@pxref{Mail Source
22497 Specifiers}) follow.
22498
22499 @lisp
22500 (setq mail-sources
22501 '((file :prescript "formail -bs spamassassin < /var/mail/%u")
22502 (pop :user "jrl"
22503 :server "pophost"
22504 :postscript
22505 "mv %t /tmp/foo; formail -bs spamc < /tmp/foo > %t")))
22506 @end lisp
22507
22508 Once you manage to process your incoming spool somehow, thus making
22509 the mail contain e.g.@: a header indicating it is spam, you are ready to
22510 filter it out. Using normal split methods (@pxref{Splitting Mail}):
22511
22512 @lisp
22513 (setq nnmail-split-methods '(("spam" "^X-Spam-Flag: YES")
22514 ...))
22515 @end lisp
22516
22517 Or using fancy split methods (@pxref{Fancy Mail Splitting}):
22518
22519 @lisp
22520 (setq nnmail-split-methods 'nnmail-split-fancy
22521 nnmail-split-fancy '(| ("X-Spam-Flag" "YES" "spam")
22522 ...))
22523 @end lisp
22524
22525 Some people might not like the idea of piping the mail through various
22526 programs using a @code{:prescript} (if some program is buggy, you
22527 might lose all mail). If you are one of them, another solution is to
22528 call the external tools during splitting. Example fancy split method:
22529
22530 @lisp
22531 (setq nnmail-split-fancy '(| (: kevin-spamassassin)
22532 ...))
22533 (defun kevin-spamassassin ()
22534 (save-excursion
22535 (save-restriction
22536 (widen)
22537 (if (eq 1 (call-process-region (point-min) (point-max)
22538 "spamc" nil nil nil "-c"))
22539 "spam"))))
22540 @end lisp
22541
22542 Note that with the nnimap backend, message bodies will not be
22543 downloaded by default. You need to set
22544 @code{nnimap-split-download-body} to @code{t} to do that
22545 (@pxref{Splitting in IMAP}).
22546
22547 That is about it. As some spam is likely to get through anyway, you
22548 might want to have a nifty function to call when you happen to read
22549 spam. And here is the nifty function:
22550
22551 @lisp
22552 (defun my-gnus-raze-spam ()
22553 "Submit SPAM to Vipul's Razor, then mark it as expirable."
22554 (interactive)
22555 (gnus-summary-show-raw-article)
22556 (gnus-summary-save-in-pipe "razor-report -f -d")
22557 (gnus-summary-mark-as-expirable 1))
22558 @end lisp
22559
22560 @node Hashcash
22561 @subsection Hashcash
22562 @cindex hashcash
22563
22564 A novel technique to fight spam is to require senders to do something
22565 costly for each message they send. This has the obvious drawback that
22566 you cannot rely on everyone in the world using this technique,
22567 since it is not part of the Internet standards, but it may be useful
22568 in smaller communities.
22569
22570 While the tools in the previous section work well in practice, they
22571 work only because the tools are constantly maintained and updated as
22572 new form of spam appears. This means that a small percentage of spam
22573 will always get through. It also means that somewhere, someone needs
22574 to read lots of spam to update these tools. Hashcash avoids that, but
22575 instead prefers that everyone you contact through e-mail supports the
22576 scheme. You can view the two approaches as pragmatic vs dogmatic.
22577 The approaches have their own advantages and disadvantages, but as
22578 often in the real world, a combination of them is stronger than either
22579 one of them separately.
22580
22581 @cindex X-Hashcash
22582 The ``something costly'' is to burn CPU time, more specifically to
22583 compute a hash collision up to a certain number of bits. The
22584 resulting hashcash cookie is inserted in a @samp{X-Hashcash:}
22585 header. For more details, and for the external application
22586 @code{hashcash} you need to install to use this feature, see
22587 @uref{http://www.cypherspace.org/~adam/hashcash/}. Even more
22588 information can be found at @uref{http://www.camram.org/}.
22589
22590 If you wish to call hashcash for each message you send, say something
22591 like:
22592
22593 @lisp
22594 (require 'hashcash)
22595 (add-hook 'message-send-hook 'mail-add-payment)
22596 @end lisp
22597
22598 The @file{hashcash.el} library can be found in the Gnus development
22599 contrib directory or at
22600 @uref{http://users.actrix.gen.nz/mycroft/hashcash.el}.
22601
22602 You will need to set up some additional variables as well:
22603
22604 @table @code
22605
22606 @item hashcash-default-payment
22607 @vindex hashcash-default-payment
22608 This variable indicates the default number of bits the hash collision
22609 should consist of. By default this is 0, meaning nothing will be
22610 done. Suggested useful values include 17 to 29.
22611
22612 @item hashcash-payment-alist
22613 @vindex hashcash-payment-alist
22614 Some receivers may require you to spend burn more CPU time than the
22615 default. This variable contains a list of @samp{(@var{addr}
22616 @var{amount})} cells, where @var{addr} is the receiver (email address
22617 or newsgroup) and @var{amount} is the number of bits in the collision
22618 that is needed. It can also contain @samp{(@var{addr} @var{string}
22619 @var{amount})} cells, where the @var{string} is the string to use
22620 (normally the email address or newsgroup name is used).
22621
22622 @item hashcash
22623 @vindex hashcash
22624 Where the @code{hashcash} binary is installed.
22625
22626 @end table
22627
22628 Currently there is no built in functionality in Gnus to verify
22629 hashcash cookies, it is expected that this is performed by your hand
22630 customized mail filtering scripts. Improvements in this area would be
22631 a useful contribution, however.
22632
22633 @node Filtering Spam Using The Spam ELisp Package
22634 @subsection Filtering Spam Using The Spam ELisp Package
22635 @cindex spam filtering
22636 @cindex spam
22637
22638 The idea behind @file{spam.el} is to have a control center for spam detection
22639 and filtering in Gnus. To that end, @file{spam.el} does two things: it
22640 filters new mail, and it analyzes mail known to be spam or ham.
22641 @dfn{Ham} is the name used throughout @file{spam.el} to indicate
22642 non-spam messages.
22643
22644 @cindex spam-initialize
22645 First of all, you @strong{must} run the function
22646 @code{spam-initialize} to autoload @code{spam.el} and to install the
22647 @code{spam.el} hooks. There is one exception: if you use the
22648 @code{spam-use-stat} (@pxref{spam-stat spam filtering}) setting, you
22649 should turn it on before @code{spam-initialize}:
22650
22651 @example
22652 (setq spam-use-stat t) ;; if needed
22653 (spam-initialize)
22654 @end example
22655
22656 So, what happens when you load @file{spam.el}?
22657
22658 First, some hooks will get installed by @code{spam-initialize}. There
22659 are some hooks for @code{spam-stat} so it can save its databases, and
22660 there are hooks so interesting things will happen when you enter and
22661 leave a group. More on the sequence of events later (@pxref{Spam
22662 ELisp Package Sequence of Events}).
22663
22664 You get the following keyboard commands:
22665
22666 @table @kbd
22667
22668 @item M-d
22669 @itemx M s x
22670 @itemx S x
22671 @kindex M-d
22672 @kindex S x
22673 @kindex M s x
22674 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-spam
22675 @code{gnus-summary-mark-as-spam}.
22676
22677 Mark current article as spam, showing it with the @samp{$} mark.
22678 Whenever you see a spam article, make sure to mark its summary line
22679 with @kbd{M-d} before leaving the group. This is done automatically
22680 for unread articles in @emph{spam} groups.
22681
22682 @item M s t
22683 @itemx S t
22684 @kindex M s t
22685 @kindex S t
22686 @findex spam-bogofilter-score
22687 @code{spam-bogofilter-score}.
22688
22689 You must have Bogofilter installed for that command to work properly.
22690
22691 @xref{Bogofilter}.
22692
22693 @end table
22694
22695 Also, when you load @file{spam.el}, you will be able to customize its
22696 variables. Try @code{customize-group} on the @samp{spam} variable
22697 group.
22698
22699 @menu
22700 * Spam ELisp Package Sequence of Events::
22701 * Spam ELisp Package Filtering of Incoming Mail::
22702 * Spam ELisp Package Global Variables::
22703 * Spam ELisp Package Configuration Examples::
22704 * Blacklists and Whitelists::
22705 * BBDB Whitelists::
22706 * Gmane Spam Reporting::
22707 * Anti-spam Hashcash Payments::
22708 * Blackholes::
22709 * Regular Expressions Header Matching::
22710 * Bogofilter::
22711 * ifile spam filtering::
22712 * spam-stat spam filtering::
22713 * SpamOracle::
22714 * Extending the Spam ELisp package::
22715 @end menu
22716
22717 @node Spam ELisp Package Sequence of Events
22718 @subsubsection Spam ELisp Package Sequence of Events
22719 @cindex spam filtering
22720 @cindex spam filtering sequence of events
22721 @cindex spam
22722
22723 You must read this section to understand how @code{spam.el} works.
22724 Do not skip, speed-read, or glance through this section.
22725
22726 There are two @emph{contact points}, if you will, between
22727 @code{spam.el} and the rest of Gnus: checking new mail for spam, and
22728 leaving a group.
22729
22730 Getting new mail is done in one of two ways. You can either split
22731 your incoming mail or you can classify new articles as ham or spam
22732 when you enter the group.
22733
22734 Splitting incoming mail is better suited to mail backends such as
22735 @code{nnml} or @code{nnimap} where new mail appears in a single file
22736 called a @dfn{Spool File}. See @xref{Spam ELisp Package Filtering of
22737 Incoming Mail}.
22738
22739 For backends such as @code{nntp} there is no incoming mail spool, so
22740 an alternate mechanism must be used. This may also happen for
22741 backends where the server is in charge of splitting incoming mail, and
22742 Gnus does not do further splitting. The @code{spam-autodetect} and
22743 @code{spam-autodetect-methods} group parameters (accessible with
22744 @kbd{G c} and @kbd{G p} as usual), and the corresponding variables
22745 @code{gnus-spam-autodetect-methods} and
22746 @code{gnus-spam-autodetect-methods} (accessible with @kbd{M-x
22747 customize-variable} as usual).
22748
22749 When @code{spam-autodetect} is used, it hooks into the process of
22750 entering a group. Thus, entering a group with unseen or unread
22751 articles becomes the substitute for checking incoming mail. Whether
22752 only unseen articles or all unread articles will be processed is
22753 determined by the @code{spam-autodetect-recheck-messages}. When set
22754 to @code{t}, unread messages will be rechecked.
22755
22756 @code{spam-autodetect} grants the user at once more and less control
22757 of spam filtering. The user will have more control over each group's
22758 spam methods, so for instance the @samp{ding} group may have
22759 @code{spam-use-BBDB} as the autodetection method, while the
22760 @samp{suspect} group may have the @code{spam-use-blacklist} and
22761 @code{spam-use-bogofilter} methods enabled. Every article detected to
22762 be spam will be marked with the spam mark @samp{$} and processed on
22763 exit from the group as normal spam. The user has less control over
22764 the @emph{sequence} of checks, as he might with @code{spam-split}.
22765
22766 When the newly split mail goes into groups, or messages are
22767 autodetected to be ham or spam, those groups must be exited (after
22768 entering, if needed) for further spam processing to happen. It
22769 matters whether the group is considered a ham group, a spam group, or
22770 is unclassified, based on its @code{spam-content} parameter
22771 (@pxref{Spam ELisp Package Global Variables}). Spam groups have the
22772 additional characteristic that, when entered, any unseen or unread
22773 articles (depending on the @code{spam-mark-only-unseen-as-spam}
22774 variable) will be marked as spam. Thus, mail split into a spam group
22775 gets automatically marked as spam when you enter the group.
22776
22777 So, when you exit a group, the @code{spam-processors} are applied, if
22778 any are set, and the processed mail is moved to the
22779 @code{ham-process-destination} or the @code{spam-process-destination}
22780 depending on the article's classification. If the
22781 @code{ham-process-destination} or the @code{spam-process-destination},
22782 whichever is appropriate, are @code{nil}, the article is left in the
22783 current group.
22784
22785 If a spam is found in any group (this can be changed to only non-spam
22786 groups with @code{spam-move-spam-nonspam-groups-only}), it is
22787 processed by the active @code{spam-processors} (@pxref{Spam ELisp
22788 Package Global Variables}) when the group is exited. Furthermore, the
22789 spam is moved to the @code{spam-process-destination} (@pxref{Spam
22790 ELisp Package Global Variables}) for further training or deletion.
22791 You have to load the @code{gnus-registry.el} package and enable the
22792 @code{spam-log-to-registry} variable if you want spam to be processed
22793 no more than once. Thus, spam is detected and processed everywhere,
22794 which is what most people want. If the
22795 @code{spam-process-destination} is @code{nil}, the spam is marked as
22796 expired, which is usually the right thing to do.
22797
22798 If spam can not be moved---because of a read-only backend such as
22799 @acronym{NNTP}, for example, it will be copied.
22800
22801 If a ham mail is found in a ham group, as determined by the
22802 @code{ham-marks} parameter, it is processed as ham by the active ham
22803 @code{spam-processor} when the group is exited. With the variables
22804 @code{spam-process-ham-in-spam-groups} and
22805 @code{spam-process-ham-in-nonham-groups} the behavior can be further
22806 altered so ham found anywhere can be processed. You have to load the
22807 @code{gnus-registry.el} package and enable the
22808 @code{spam-log-to-registry} variable if you want ham to be processed
22809 no more than once. Thus, ham is detected and processed only when
22810 necessary, which is what most people want. More on this in
22811 @xref{Spam ELisp Package Configuration Examples}.
22812
22813 If ham can not be moved---because of a read-only backend such as
22814 @acronym{NNTP}, for example, it will be copied.
22815
22816 If all this seems confusing, don't worry. Soon it will be as natural
22817 as typing Lisp one-liners on a neural interface@dots{} err, sorry, that's
22818 50 years in the future yet. Just trust us, it's not so bad.
22819
22820 @node Spam ELisp Package Filtering of Incoming Mail
22821 @subsubsection Spam ELisp Package Filtering of Incoming Mail
22822 @cindex spam filtering
22823 @cindex spam filtering incoming mail
22824 @cindex spam
22825
22826 To use the @file{spam.el} facilities for incoming mail filtering, you
22827 must add the following to your fancy split list
22828 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} or @code{nnimap-split-fancy}:
22829
22830 @example
22831 (: spam-split)
22832 @end example
22833
22834 Note that the fancy split may be called @code{nnmail-split-fancy} or
22835 @code{nnimap-split-fancy}, depending on whether you use the nnmail or
22836 nnimap back ends to retrieve your mail.
22837
22838 Also, @code{spam-split} will not modify incoming mail in any way.
22839
22840 The @code{spam-split} function will process incoming mail and send the
22841 mail considered to be spam into the group name given by the variable
22842 @code{spam-split-group}. By default that group name is @samp{spam},
22843 but you can customize @code{spam-split-group}. Make sure the contents
22844 of @code{spam-split-group} are an @emph{unqualified} group name, for
22845 instance in an @code{nnimap} server @samp{your-server} the value
22846 @samp{spam} will turn out to be @samp{nnimap+your-server:spam}. The
22847 value @samp{nnimap+server:spam}, therefore, is wrong and will
22848 actually give you the group
22849 @samp{nnimap+your-server:nnimap+server:spam} which may or may not
22850 work depending on your server's tolerance for strange group names.
22851
22852 You can also give @code{spam-split} a parameter,
22853 e.g. @code{spam-use-regex-headers} or @code{"maybe-spam"}. Why is
22854 this useful?
22855
22856 Take these split rules (with @code{spam-use-regex-headers} and
22857 @code{spam-use-blackholes} set):
22858
22859 @example
22860 nnimap-split-fancy '(|
22861 (any "ding" "ding")
22862 (: spam-split)
22863 ;; @r{default mailbox}
22864 "mail")
22865 @end example
22866
22867 Now, the problem is that you want all ding messages to make it to the
22868 ding folder. But that will let obvious spam (for example, spam
22869 detected by SpamAssassin, and @code{spam-use-regex-headers}) through,
22870 when it's sent to the ding list. On the other hand, some messages to
22871 the ding list are from a mail server in the blackhole list, so the
22872 invocation of @code{spam-split} can't be before the ding rule.
22873
22874 You can let SpamAssassin headers supersede ding rules, but all other
22875 @code{spam-split} rules (including a second invocation of the
22876 regex-headers check) will be after the ding rule:
22877
22878 @example
22879 nnimap-split-fancy
22880 '(|
22881 ;; @r{all spam detected by @code{spam-use-regex-headers} goes to @samp{regex-spam}}
22882 (: spam-split "regex-spam" 'spam-use-regex-headers)
22883 (any "ding" "ding")
22884 ;; @r{all other spam detected by spam-split goes to @code{spam-split-group}}
22885 (: spam-split)
22886 ;; @r{default mailbox}
22887 "mail")
22888 @end example
22889
22890 This lets you invoke specific @code{spam-split} checks depending on
22891 your particular needs, and to target the results of those checks to a
22892 particular spam group. You don't have to throw all mail into all the
22893 spam tests. Another reason why this is nice is that messages to
22894 mailing lists you have rules for don't have to have resource-intensive
22895 blackhole checks performed on them. You could also specify different
22896 spam checks for your nnmail split vs. your nnimap split. Go crazy.
22897
22898 You should still have specific checks such as
22899 @code{spam-use-regex-headers} set to @code{t}, even if you
22900 specifically invoke @code{spam-split} with the check. The reason is
22901 that when loading @file{spam.el}, some conditional loading is done
22902 depending on what @code{spam-use-xyz} variables you have set. This
22903 is usually not critical, though.
22904
22905 @emph{Note for IMAP users}
22906
22907 The boolean variable @code{nnimap-split-download-body} needs to be
22908 set, if you want to split based on the whole message instead of just
22909 the headers. By default, the nnimap back end will only retrieve the
22910 message headers. If you use @code{spam-check-bogofilter},
22911 @code{spam-check-ifile}, or @code{spam-check-stat} (the splitters that
22912 can benefit from the full message body), you should set this variable.
22913 It is not set by default because it will slow @acronym{IMAP} down, and
22914 that is not an appropriate decision to make on behalf of the user.
22915
22916 @xref{Splitting in IMAP}.
22917
22918 @emph{TODO: spam.el needs to provide a uniform way of training all the
22919 statistical databases. Some have that functionality built-in, others
22920 don't.}
22921
22922 @node Spam ELisp Package Global Variables
22923 @subsubsection Spam ELisp Package Global Variables
22924 @cindex spam filtering
22925 @cindex spam filtering variables
22926 @cindex spam variables
22927 @cindex spam
22928
22929 @vindex gnus-spam-process-newsgroups
22930 The concepts of ham processors and spam processors are very important.
22931 Ham processors and spam processors for a group can be set with the
22932 @code{spam-process} group parameter, or the
22933 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. Ham processors take
22934 mail known to be non-spam (@emph{ham}) and process it in some way so
22935 that later similar mail will also be considered non-spam. Spam
22936 processors take mail known to be spam and process it so similar spam
22937 will be detected later.
22938
22939 The format of the spam or ham processor entry used to be a symbol,
22940 but now it is a @sc{cons} cell. See the individual spam processor entries
22941 for more information.
22942
22943 @vindex gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents
22944 Gnus learns from the spam you get. You have to collect your spam in
22945 one or more spam groups, and set or customize the variable
22946 @code{spam-junk-mailgroups} as appropriate. You can also declare
22947 groups to contain spam by setting their group parameter
22948 @code{spam-contents} to @code{gnus-group-spam-classification-spam}, or
22949 by customizing the corresponding variable
22950 @code{gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents}. The @code{spam-contents} group
22951 parameter and the @code{gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents} variable can
22952 also be used to declare groups as @emph{ham} groups if you set their
22953 classification to @code{gnus-group-spam-classification-ham}. If
22954 groups are not classified by means of @code{spam-junk-mailgroups},
22955 @code{spam-contents}, or @code{gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents}, they are
22956 considered @emph{unclassified}. All groups are unclassified by
22957 default.
22958
22959 @vindex gnus-spam-mark
22960 @cindex $
22961 In spam groups, all messages are considered to be spam by default:
22962 they get the @samp{$} mark (@code{gnus-spam-mark}) when you enter the
22963 group. If you have seen a message, had it marked as spam, then
22964 unmarked it, it won't be marked as spam when you enter the group
22965 thereafter. You can disable that behavior, so all unread messages
22966 will get the @samp{$} mark, if you set the
22967 @code{spam-mark-only-unseen-as-spam} parameter to @code{nil}. You
22968 should remove the @samp{$} mark when you are in the group summary
22969 buffer for every message that is not spam after all. To remove the
22970 @samp{$} mark, you can use @kbd{M-u} to ``unread'' the article, or
22971 @kbd{d} for declaring it read the non-spam way. When you leave a
22972 group, all spam-marked (@samp{$}) articles are sent to a spam
22973 processor which will study them as spam samples.
22974
22975 Messages may also be deleted in various other ways, and unless
22976 @code{ham-marks} group parameter gets overridden below, marks @samp{R}
22977 and @samp{r} for default read or explicit delete, marks @samp{X} and
22978 @samp{K} for automatic or explicit kills, as well as mark @samp{Y} for
22979 low scores, are all considered to be associated with articles which
22980 are not spam. This assumption might be false, in particular if you
22981 use kill files or score files as means for detecting genuine spam, you
22982 should then adjust the @code{ham-marks} group parameter.
22983
22984 @defvar ham-marks
22985 You can customize this group or topic parameter to be the list of
22986 marks you want to consider ham. By default, the list contains the
22987 deleted, read, killed, kill-filed, and low-score marks (the idea is
22988 that these articles have been read, but are not spam). It can be
22989 useful to also include the tick mark in the ham marks. It is not
22990 recommended to make the unread mark a ham mark, because it normally
22991 indicates a lack of classification. But you can do it, and we'll be
22992 happy for you.
22993 @end defvar
22994
22995 @defvar spam-marks
22996 You can customize this group or topic parameter to be the list of
22997 marks you want to consider spam. By default, the list contains only
22998 the spam mark. It is not recommended to change that, but you can if
22999 you really want to.
23000 @end defvar
23001
23002 When you leave @emph{any} group, regardless of its
23003 @code{spam-contents} classification, all spam-marked articles are sent
23004 to a spam processor, which will study these as spam samples. If you
23005 explicit kill a lot, you might sometimes end up with articles marked
23006 @samp{K} which you never saw, and which might accidentally contain
23007 spam. Best is to make sure that real spam is marked with @samp{$},
23008 and nothing else.
23009
23010 @vindex gnus-ham-process-destinations
23011 When you leave a @emph{spam} group, all spam-marked articles are
23012 marked as expired after processing with the spam processor. This is
23013 not done for @emph{unclassified} or @emph{ham} groups. Also, any
23014 @strong{ham} articles in a spam group will be moved to a location
23015 determined by either the @code{ham-process-destination} group
23016 parameter or a match in the @code{gnus-ham-process-destinations}
23017 variable, which is a list of regular expressions matched with group
23018 names (it's easiest to customize this variable with @kbd{M-x
23019 customize-variable @key{RET} gnus-ham-process-destinations}). Each
23020 group name list is a standard Lisp list, if you prefer to customize
23021 the variable manually. If the @code{ham-process-destination}
23022 parameter is not set, ham articles are left in place. If the
23023 @code{spam-mark-ham-unread-before-move-from-spam-group} parameter is
23024 set, the ham articles are marked as unread before being moved.
23025
23026 If ham can not be moved---because of a read-only backend such as
23027 @acronym{NNTP}, for example, it will be copied.
23028
23029 Note that you can use multiples destinations per group or regular
23030 expression! This enables you to send your ham to a regular mail
23031 group and to a @emph{ham training} group.
23032
23033 When you leave a @emph{ham} group, all ham-marked articles are sent to
23034 a ham processor, which will study these as non-spam samples.
23035
23036 @vindex spam-process-ham-in-spam-groups
23037 By default the variable @code{spam-process-ham-in-spam-groups} is
23038 @code{nil}. Set it to @code{t} if you want ham found in spam groups
23039 to be processed. Normally this is not done, you are expected instead
23040 to send your ham to a ham group and process it there.
23041
23042 @vindex spam-process-ham-in-nonham-groups
23043 By default the variable @code{spam-process-ham-in-nonham-groups} is
23044 @code{nil}. Set it to @code{t} if you want ham found in non-ham (spam
23045 or unclassified) groups to be processed. Normally this is not done,
23046 you are expected instead to send your ham to a ham group and process
23047 it there.
23048
23049 @vindex gnus-spam-process-destinations
23050 When you leave a @emph{ham} or @emph{unclassified} group, all
23051 @strong{spam} articles are moved to a location determined by either
23052 the @code{spam-process-destination} group parameter or a match in the
23053 @code{gnus-spam-process-destinations} variable, which is a list of
23054 regular expressions matched with group names (it's easiest to
23055 customize this variable with @kbd{M-x customize-variable @key{RET}
23056 gnus-spam-process-destinations}). Each group name list is a standard
23057 Lisp list, if you prefer to customize the variable manually. If the
23058 @code{spam-process-destination} parameter is not set, the spam
23059 articles are only expired. The group name is fully qualified, meaning
23060 that if you see @samp{nntp:servername} before the group name in the
23061 group buffer then you need it here as well.
23062
23063 If spam can not be moved---because of a read-only backend such as
23064 @acronym{NNTP}, for example, it will be copied.
23065
23066 Note that you can use multiples destinations per group or regular
23067 expression! This enables you to send your spam to multiple @emph{spam
23068 training} groups.
23069
23070 @vindex spam-log-to-registry
23071 The problem with processing ham and spam is that Gnus doesn't track
23072 this processing by default. Enable the @code{spam-log-to-registry}
23073 variable so @code{spam.el} will use @code{gnus-registry.el} to track
23074 what articles have been processed, and avoid processing articles
23075 multiple times. Keep in mind that if you limit the number of registry
23076 entries, this won't work as well as it does without a limit.
23077
23078 @vindex spam-mark-only-unseen-as-spam
23079 Set this variable if you want only unseen articles in spam groups to
23080 be marked as spam. By default, it is set. If you set it to
23081 @code{nil}, unread articles will also be marked as spam.
23082
23083 @vindex spam-mark-ham-unread-before-move-from-spam-group
23084 Set this variable if you want ham to be unmarked before it is moved
23085 out of the spam group. This is very useful when you use something
23086 like the tick mark @samp{!} to mark ham---the article will be placed
23087 in your @code{ham-process-destination}, unmarked as if it came fresh
23088 from the mail server.
23089
23090 @vindex spam-autodetect-recheck-messages
23091 When autodetecting spam, this variable tells @code{spam.el} whether
23092 only unseen articles or all unread articles should be checked for
23093 spam. It is recommended that you leave it off.
23094
23095 @node Spam ELisp Package Configuration Examples
23096 @subsubsection Spam ELisp Package Configuration Examples
23097 @cindex spam filtering
23098 @cindex spam filtering configuration examples
23099 @cindex spam configuration examples
23100 @cindex spam
23101
23102 @subsubheading Ted's setup
23103
23104 From Ted Zlatanov <tzz@@lifelogs.com>.
23105 @example
23106 ;; @r{for @code{gnus-registry-split-fancy-with-parent} and spam autodetection}
23107 ;; @r{see @file{gnus-registry.el} for more information}
23108 (gnus-registry-initialize)
23109 (spam-initialize)
23110
23111 ;; @r{I like @kbd{C-s} for marking spam}
23112 (define-key gnus-summary-mode-map "\C-s" 'gnus-summary-mark-as-spam)
23113
23114 (setq
23115 spam-log-to-registry t ; @r{for spam autodetection}
23116 spam-use-BBDB t
23117 spam-use-regex-headers t ; @r{catch X-Spam-Flag (SpamAssassin)}
23118 ;; @r{all groups with @samp{spam} in the name contain spam}
23119 gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents
23120 '(("spam" gnus-group-spam-classification-spam))
23121 ;; @r{see documentation for these}
23122 spam-move-spam-nonspam-groups-only nil
23123 spam-mark-only-unseen-as-spam t
23124 spam-mark-ham-unread-before-move-from-spam-group t
23125 nnimap-split-rule 'nnimap-split-fancy
23126 ;; @r{understand what this does before you copy it to your own setup!}
23127 nnimap-split-fancy '(|
23128 ;; @r{trace references to parents and put in their group}
23129 (: gnus-registry-split-fancy-with-parent)
23130 ;; @r{this will catch server-side SpamAssassin tags}
23131 (: spam-split 'spam-use-regex-headers)
23132 (any "ding" "ding")
23133 ;; @r{note that spam by default will go to @samp{spam}}
23134 (: spam-split)
23135 ;; @r{default mailbox}
23136 "mail"))
23137
23138 ;; @r{my parameters, set with @kbd{G p}}
23139
23140 ;; @r{all nnml groups, and all nnimap groups except}
23141 ;; @r{@samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:train} and}
23142 ;; @r{@samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:spam}: any spam goes to nnimap training,}
23143 ;; @r{because it must have been detected manually}
23144
23145 ((spam-process-destination . "nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:train"))
23146
23147 ;; @r{all @acronym{NNTP} groups}
23148 ;; @r{autodetect spam with the blacklist and ham with the BBDB}
23149 ((spam-autodetect-methods spam-use-blacklist spam-use-BBDB)
23150 ;; @r{send all spam to the training group}
23151 (spam-process-destination . "nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:train"))
23152
23153 ;; @r{only some @acronym{NNTP} groups, where I want to autodetect spam}
23154 ((spam-autodetect . t))
23155
23156 ;; @r{my nnimap @samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:spam} group}
23157
23158 ;; @r{this is a spam group}
23159 ((spam-contents gnus-group-spam-classification-spam)
23160
23161 ;; @r{any spam (which happens when I enter for all unseen messages,}
23162 ;; @r{because of the @code{gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents} setting above), goes to}
23163 ;; @r{@samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:train} unless I mark it as ham}
23164
23165 (spam-process-destination "nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:train")
23166
23167 ;; @r{any ham goes to my @samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:mail} folder, but}
23168 ;; @r{also to my @samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:trainham} folder for training}
23169
23170 (ham-process-destination "nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:mail"
23171 "nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:trainham")
23172 ;; @r{in this group, only @samp{!} marks are ham}
23173 (ham-marks
23174 (gnus-ticked-mark))
23175 ;; @r{remembers senders in the blacklist on the way out---this is}
23176 ;; @r{definitely not needed, it just makes me feel better}
23177 (spam-process (gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-blacklist)))
23178
23179 ;; @r{Later, on the @acronym{IMAP} server I use the @samp{train} group for training}
23180 ;; @r{SpamAssassin to recognize spam, and the @samp{trainham} group fora}
23181 ;; @r{recognizing ham---but Gnus has nothing to do with it.}
23182
23183 @end example
23184
23185 @subsubheading Using @file{spam.el} on an IMAP server with a statistical filter on the server
23186 From Reiner Steib <reiner.steib@@gmx.de>.
23187
23188 My provider has set up bogofilter (in combination with @acronym{DCC}) on
23189 the mail server (@acronym{IMAP}). Recognized spam goes to
23190 @samp{spam.detected}, the rest goes through the normal filter rules,
23191 i.e. to @samp{some.folder} or to @samp{INBOX}. Training on false
23192 positives or negatives is done by copying or moving the article to
23193 @samp{training.ham} or @samp{training.spam} respectively. A cron job on
23194 the server feeds those to bogofilter with the suitable ham or spam
23195 options and deletes them from the @samp{training.ham} and
23196 @samp{training.spam} folders.
23197
23198 With the following entries in @code{gnus-parameters}, @code{spam.el}
23199 does most of the job for me:
23200
23201 @lisp
23202 ("nnimap:spam\\.detected"
23203 (gnus-article-sort-functions '(gnus-article-sort-by-chars))
23204 (ham-process-destination "nnimap:INBOX" "nnimap:training.ham")
23205 (spam-contents gnus-group-spam-classification-spam))
23206 ("nnimap:\\(INBOX\\|other-folders\\)"
23207 (spam-process-destination . "nnimap:training.spam")
23208 (spam-contents gnus-group-spam-classification-ham))
23209 @end lisp
23210
23211 @itemize
23212
23213 @item @b{The Spam folder:}
23214
23215 In the folder @samp{spam.detected}, I have to check for false positives
23216 (i.e. legitimate mails, that were wrongly judged as spam by
23217 bogofilter or DCC).
23218
23219 Because of the @code{gnus-group-spam-classification-spam} entry, all
23220 messages are marked as spam (with @code{$}). When I find a false
23221 positive, I mark the message with some other ham mark (@code{ham-marks},
23222 @ref{Spam ELisp Package Global Variables}). On group exit, those
23223 messages are copied to both groups, @samp{INBOX} (where I want to have
23224 the article) and @samp{training.ham} (for training bogofilter) and
23225 deleted from the @samp{spam.detected} folder.
23226
23227 The @code{gnus-article-sort-by-chars} entry simplifies detection of
23228 false positives for me. I receive lots of worms (sweN, @dots{}), that all
23229 have a similar size. Grouping them by size (i.e. chars) makes finding
23230 other false positives easier. (Of course worms aren't @i{spam}
23231 (@acronym{UCE}, @acronym{UBE}) strictly speaking. Anyhow, bogofilter is
23232 an excellent tool for filtering those unwanted mails for me.)
23233
23234 @item @b{Ham folders:}
23235
23236 In my ham folders, I just hit @kbd{S x}
23237 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-spam}) whenever I see an unrecognized spam
23238 mail (false negative). On group exit, those messages are moved to
23239 @samp{training.ham}.
23240 @end itemize
23241
23242 @subsubheading Reporting spam articles in Gmane groups with @code{spam-report.el}
23243
23244 From Reiner Steib <reiner.steib@@gmx.de>.
23245
23246 With following entry in @code{gnus-parameters}, @kbd{S x}
23247 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-spam}) marks articles in @code{gmane.*}
23248 groups as spam and reports the to Gmane at group exit:
23249
23250 @lisp
23251 ("^gmane\\."
23252 (spam-process (gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-report-gmane)))
23253 @end lisp
23254
23255 Additionally, I use @code{(setq spam-report-gmane-use-article-number nil)}
23256 because I don't read the groups directly from news.gmane.org, but
23257 through my local news server (leafnode). I.e. the article numbers are
23258 not the same as on news.gmane.org, thus @code{spam-report.el} has to check
23259 the @code{X-Report-Spam} header to find the correct number.
23260
23261 @node Blacklists and Whitelists
23262 @subsubsection Blacklists and Whitelists
23263 @cindex spam filtering
23264 @cindex whitelists, spam filtering
23265 @cindex blacklists, spam filtering
23266 @cindex spam
23267
23268 @defvar spam-use-blacklist
23269
23270 Set this variable to @code{t} if you want to use blacklists when
23271 splitting incoming mail. Messages whose senders are in the blacklist
23272 will be sent to the @code{spam-split-group}. This is an explicit
23273 filter, meaning that it acts only on mail senders @emph{declared} to
23274 be spammers.
23275
23276 @end defvar
23277
23278 @defvar spam-use-whitelist
23279
23280 Set this variable to @code{t} if you want to use whitelists when
23281 splitting incoming mail. Messages whose senders are not in the
23282 whitelist will be sent to the next spam-split rule. This is an
23283 explicit filter, meaning that unless someone is in the whitelist, their
23284 messages are not assumed to be spam or ham.
23285
23286 @end defvar
23287
23288 @defvar spam-use-whitelist-exclusive
23289
23290 Set this variable to @code{t} if you want to use whitelists as an
23291 implicit filter, meaning that every message will be considered spam
23292 unless the sender is in the whitelist. Use with care.
23293
23294 @end defvar
23295
23296 @defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-blacklist
23297
23298 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
23299 customizing the group parameters or the
23300 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
23301 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the senders of
23302 spam-marked articles will be added to the blacklist.
23303
23304 @emph{WARNING}
23305
23306 Instead of the obsolete
23307 @code{gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-blacklist}, it is recommended
23308 that you use @code{'(spam spam-use-blacklist)}. Everything will work
23309 the same way, we promise.
23310
23311 @end defvar
23312
23313 @defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-whitelist
23314
23315 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
23316 customizing the group parameters or the
23317 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
23318 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the senders of
23319 ham-marked articles in @emph{ham} groups will be added to the
23320 whitelist. Note that this ham processor has no effect in @emph{spam}
23321 or @emph{unclassified} groups.
23322
23323 @emph{WARNING}
23324
23325 Instead of the obsolete
23326 @code{gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-whitelist}, it is recommended
23327 that you use @code{'(ham spam-use-whitelist)}. Everything will work
23328 the same way, we promise.
23329
23330 @end defvar
23331
23332 Blacklists are lists of regular expressions matching addresses you
23333 consider to be spam senders. For instance, to block mail from any
23334 sender at @samp{vmadmin.com}, you can put @samp{vmadmin.com} in your
23335 blacklist. You start out with an empty blacklist. Blacklist entries
23336 use the Emacs regular expression syntax.
23337
23338 Conversely, whitelists tell Gnus what addresses are considered
23339 legitimate. All messages from whitelisted addresses are considered
23340 non-spam. Also see @ref{BBDB Whitelists}. Whitelist entries use the
23341 Emacs regular expression syntax.
23342
23343 The blacklist and whitelist file locations can be customized with the
23344 @code{spam-directory} variable (@file{~/News/spam} by default), or
23345 the @code{spam-whitelist} and @code{spam-blacklist} variables
23346 directly. The whitelist and blacklist files will by default be in the
23347 @code{spam-directory} directory, named @file{whitelist} and
23348 @file{blacklist} respectively.
23349
23350 @node BBDB Whitelists
23351 @subsubsection BBDB Whitelists
23352 @cindex spam filtering
23353 @cindex BBDB whitelists, spam filtering
23354 @cindex BBDB, spam filtering
23355 @cindex spam
23356
23357 @defvar spam-use-BBDB
23358
23359 Analogous to @code{spam-use-whitelist} (@pxref{Blacklists and
23360 Whitelists}), but uses the BBDB as the source of whitelisted
23361 addresses, without regular expressions. You must have the BBDB loaded
23362 for @code{spam-use-BBDB} to work properly. Messages whose senders are
23363 not in the BBDB will be sent to the next spam-split rule. This is an
23364 explicit filter, meaning that unless someone is in the BBDB, their
23365 messages are not assumed to be spam or ham.
23366
23367 @end defvar
23368
23369 @defvar spam-use-BBDB-exclusive
23370
23371 Set this variable to @code{t} if you want to use the BBDB as an
23372 implicit filter, meaning that every message will be considered spam
23373 unless the sender is in the BBDB. Use with care. Only sender
23374 addresses in the BBDB will be allowed through; all others will be
23375 classified as spammers.
23376
23377 @end defvar
23378
23379 @defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-BBDB
23380
23381 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
23382 customizing the group parameters or the
23383 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
23384 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the senders of
23385 ham-marked articles in @emph{ham} groups will be added to the
23386 BBDB. Note that this ham processor has no effect in @emph{spam}
23387 or @emph{unclassified} groups.
23388
23389 @emph{WARNING}
23390
23391 Instead of the obsolete
23392 @code{gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-BBDB}, it is recommended
23393 that you use @code{'(ham spam-use-BBDB)}. Everything will work
23394 the same way, we promise.
23395
23396 @end defvar
23397
23398 @node Gmane Spam Reporting
23399 @subsubsection Gmane Spam Reporting
23400 @cindex spam reporting
23401 @cindex Gmane, spam reporting
23402 @cindex Gmane, spam reporting
23403 @cindex spam
23404
23405 @defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-report-gmane
23406
23407 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
23408 customizing the group parameters or the
23409 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
23410 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the spam-marked
23411 articles groups will be reported to the Gmane administrators via a
23412 HTTP request.
23413
23414 Gmane can be found at @uref{http://gmane.org}.
23415
23416 @emph{WARNING}
23417
23418 Instead of the obsolete
23419 @code{gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-report-gmane}, it is recommended
23420 that you use @code{'(spam spam-use-gmane)}. Everything will work the
23421 same way, we promise.
23422
23423 @end defvar
23424
23425 @defvar spam-report-gmane-use-article-number
23426
23427 This variable is @code{t} by default. Set it to @code{nil} if you are
23428 running your own news server, for instance, and the local article
23429 numbers don't correspond to the Gmane article numbers. When
23430 @code{spam-report-gmane-use-article-number} is @code{nil},
23431 @code{spam-report.el} will use the @code{X-Report-Spam} header that
23432 Gmane provides.
23433
23434 @end defvar
23435
23436 @node Anti-spam Hashcash Payments
23437 @subsubsection Anti-spam Hashcash Payments
23438 @cindex spam filtering
23439 @cindex hashcash, spam filtering
23440 @cindex spam
23441
23442 @defvar spam-use-hashcash
23443
23444 Similar to @code{spam-use-whitelist} (@pxref{Blacklists and
23445 Whitelists}), but uses hashcash tokens for whitelisting messages
23446 instead of the sender address. You must have the @code{hashcash.el}
23447 package loaded for @code{spam-use-hashcash} to work properly.
23448 Messages without a hashcash payment token will be sent to the next
23449 spam-split rule. This is an explicit filter, meaning that unless a
23450 hashcash token is found, the messages are not assumed to be spam or
23451 ham.
23452
23453 @end defvar
23454
23455 @node Blackholes
23456 @subsubsection Blackholes
23457 @cindex spam filtering
23458 @cindex blackholes, spam filtering
23459 @cindex spam
23460
23461 @defvar spam-use-blackholes
23462
23463 This option is disabled by default. You can let Gnus consult the
23464 blackhole-type distributed spam processing systems (DCC, for instance)
23465 when you set this option. The variable @code{spam-blackhole-servers}
23466 holds the list of blackhole servers Gnus will consult. The current
23467 list is fairly comprehensive, but make sure to let us know if it
23468 contains outdated servers.
23469
23470 The blackhole check uses the @code{dig.el} package, but you can tell
23471 @file{spam.el} to use @code{dns.el} instead for better performance if
23472 you set @code{spam-use-dig} to @code{nil}. It is not recommended at
23473 this time to set @code{spam-use-dig} to @code{nil} despite the
23474 possible performance improvements, because some users may be unable to
23475 use it, but you can try it and see if it works for you.
23476
23477 @end defvar
23478
23479 @defvar spam-blackhole-servers
23480
23481 The list of servers to consult for blackhole checks.
23482
23483 @end defvar
23484
23485 @defvar spam-blackhole-good-server-regex
23486
23487 A regular expression for IPs that should not be checked against the
23488 blackhole server list. When set to @code{nil}, it has no effect.
23489
23490 @end defvar
23491
23492 @defvar spam-use-dig
23493
23494 Use the @code{dig.el} package instead of the @code{dns.el} package.
23495 The default setting of @code{t} is recommended.
23496
23497 @end defvar
23498
23499 Blackhole checks are done only on incoming mail. There is no spam or
23500 ham processor for blackholes.
23501
23502 @node Regular Expressions Header Matching
23503 @subsubsection Regular Expressions Header Matching
23504 @cindex spam filtering
23505 @cindex regular expressions header matching, spam filtering
23506 @cindex spam
23507
23508 @defvar spam-use-regex-headers
23509
23510 This option is disabled by default. You can let Gnus check the
23511 message headers against lists of regular expressions when you set this
23512 option. The variables @code{spam-regex-headers-spam} and
23513 @code{spam-regex-headers-ham} hold the list of regular expressions.
23514 Gnus will check against the message headers to determine if the
23515 message is spam or ham, respectively.
23516
23517 @end defvar
23518
23519 @defvar spam-regex-headers-spam
23520
23521 The list of regular expressions that, when matched in the headers of
23522 the message, positively identify it as spam.
23523
23524 @end defvar
23525
23526 @defvar spam-regex-headers-ham
23527
23528 The list of regular expressions that, when matched in the headers of
23529 the message, positively identify it as ham.
23530
23531 @end defvar
23532
23533 Regular expression header checks are done only on incoming mail.
23534 There is no specific spam or ham processor for regular expressions.
23535
23536 @node Bogofilter
23537 @subsubsection Bogofilter
23538 @cindex spam filtering
23539 @cindex bogofilter, spam filtering
23540 @cindex spam
23541
23542 @defvar spam-use-bogofilter
23543
23544 Set this variable if you want @code{spam-split} to use Eric Raymond's
23545 speedy Bogofilter.
23546
23547 With a minimum of care for associating the @samp{$} mark for spam
23548 articles only, Bogofilter training all gets fairly automatic. You
23549 should do this until you get a few hundreds of articles in each
23550 category, spam or not. The command @kbd{S t} in summary mode, either
23551 for debugging or for curiosity, shows the @emph{spamicity} score of
23552 the current article (between 0.0 and 1.0).
23553
23554 Bogofilter determines if a message is spam based on a specific
23555 threshold. That threshold can be customized, consult the Bogofilter
23556 documentation.
23557
23558 If the @code{bogofilter} executable is not in your path, Bogofilter
23559 processing will be turned off.
23560
23561 You should not enable this if you use @code{spam-use-bogofilter-headers}.
23562
23563 @end defvar
23564
23565 @defvar spam-use-bogofilter-headers
23566
23567 Set this variable if you want @code{spam-split} to use Eric Raymond's
23568 speedy Bogofilter, looking only at the message headers. It works
23569 similarly to @code{spam-use-bogofilter}, but the @code{X-Bogosity} header
23570 must be in the message already. Normally you would do this with a
23571 procmail recipe or something similar; consult the Bogofilter
23572 installation documents for details.
23573
23574 You should not enable this if you use @code{spam-use-bogofilter}.
23575
23576 @end defvar
23577
23578 @defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-bogofilter
23579 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
23580 customizing the group parameters or the
23581 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
23582 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, spam-marked articles
23583 will be added to the Bogofilter spam database.
23584
23585 @emph{WARNING}
23586
23587 Instead of the obsolete
23588 @code{gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-bogofilter}, it is recommended
23589 that you use @code{'(spam spam-use-bogofilter)}. Everything will work
23590 the same way, we promise.
23591 @end defvar
23592
23593 @defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-bogofilter
23594 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
23595 customizing the group parameters or the
23596 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
23597 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the ham-marked
23598 articles in @emph{ham} groups will be added to the Bogofilter database
23599 of non-spam messages. Note that this ham processor has no effect in
23600 @emph{spam} or @emph{unclassified} groups.
23601
23602 @emph{WARNING}
23603
23604 Instead of the obsolete
23605 @code{gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-bogofilter}, it is recommended
23606 that you use @code{'(ham spam-use-bogofilter)}. Everything will work
23607 the same way, we promise.
23608 @end defvar
23609
23610 @defvar spam-bogofilter-database-directory
23611
23612 This is the directory where Bogofilter will store its databases. It
23613 is not specified by default, so Bogofilter will use its own default
23614 database directory.
23615
23616 @end defvar
23617
23618 The Bogofilter mail classifier is similar to @command{ifile} in intent and
23619 purpose. A ham and a spam processor are provided, plus the
23620 @code{spam-use-bogofilter} and @code{spam-use-bogofilter-headers}
23621 variables to indicate to spam-split that Bogofilter should either be
23622 used, or has already been used on the article. The 0.9.2.1 version of
23623 Bogofilter was used to test this functionality.
23624
23625 @node ifile spam filtering
23626 @subsubsection ifile spam filtering
23627 @cindex spam filtering
23628 @cindex ifile, spam filtering
23629 @cindex spam
23630
23631 @defvar spam-use-ifile
23632
23633 Enable this variable if you want @code{spam-split} to use @command{ifile}, a
23634 statistical analyzer similar to Bogofilter.
23635
23636 @end defvar
23637
23638 @defvar spam-ifile-all-categories
23639
23640 Enable this variable if you want @code{spam-use-ifile} to give you all
23641 the ifile categories, not just spam/non-spam. If you use this, make
23642 sure you train ifile as described in its documentation.
23643
23644 @end defvar
23645
23646 @defvar spam-ifile-spam-category
23647
23648 This is the category of spam messages as far as ifile is concerned.
23649 The actual string used is irrelevant, but you probably want to leave
23650 the default value of @samp{spam}.
23651 @end defvar
23652
23653 @defvar spam-ifile-database-path
23654
23655 This is the filename for the ifile database. It is not specified by
23656 default, so ifile will use its own default database name.
23657
23658 @end defvar
23659
23660 The ifile mail classifier is similar to Bogofilter in intent and
23661 purpose. A ham and a spam processor are provided, plus the
23662 @code{spam-use-ifile} variable to indicate to spam-split that ifile
23663 should be used. The 1.2.1 version of ifile was used to test this
23664 functionality.
23665
23666 @node spam-stat spam filtering
23667 @subsubsection spam-stat spam filtering
23668 @cindex spam filtering
23669 @cindex spam-stat, spam filtering
23670 @cindex spam-stat
23671 @cindex spam
23672
23673 @xref{Filtering Spam Using Statistics with spam-stat}.
23674
23675 @defvar spam-use-stat
23676
23677 Enable this variable if you want @code{spam-split} to use
23678 spam-stat.el, an Emacs Lisp statistical analyzer.
23679
23680 @end defvar
23681
23682 @defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-stat
23683 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
23684 customizing the group parameters or the
23685 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
23686 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the spam-marked
23687 articles will be added to the spam-stat database of spam messages.
23688
23689 @emph{WARNING}
23690
23691 Instead of the obsolete
23692 @code{gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-stat}, it is recommended
23693 that you use @code{'(spam spam-use-stat)}. Everything will work
23694 the same way, we promise.
23695 @end defvar
23696
23697 @defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-stat
23698 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
23699 customizing the group parameters or the
23700 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
23701 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the ham-marked
23702 articles in @emph{ham} groups will be added to the spam-stat database
23703 of non-spam messages. Note that this ham processor has no effect in
23704 @emph{spam} or @emph{unclassified} groups.
23705
23706 @emph{WARNING}
23707
23708 Instead of the obsolete
23709 @code{gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-stat}, it is recommended
23710 that you use @code{'(ham spam-use-stat)}. Everything will work
23711 the same way, we promise.
23712 @end defvar
23713
23714 This enables @file{spam.el} to cooperate with @file{spam-stat.el}.
23715 @file{spam-stat.el} provides an internal (Lisp-only) spam database,
23716 which unlike ifile or Bogofilter does not require external programs.
23717 A spam and a ham processor, and the @code{spam-use-stat} variable for
23718 @code{spam-split} are provided.
23719
23720 @node SpamOracle
23721 @subsubsection Using SpamOracle with Gnus
23722 @cindex spam filtering
23723 @cindex SpamOracle
23724 @cindex spam
23725
23726 An easy way to filter out spam is to use SpamOracle. SpamOracle is an
23727 statistical mail filtering tool written by Xavier Leroy and needs to be
23728 installed separately.
23729
23730 There are several ways to use SpamOracle with Gnus. In all cases, your
23731 mail is piped through SpamOracle in its @emph{mark} mode. SpamOracle will
23732 then enter an @samp{X-Spam} header indicating whether it regards the
23733 mail as a spam mail or not.
23734
23735 One possibility is to run SpamOracle as a @code{:prescript} from the
23736 @xref{Mail Source Specifiers}, (@pxref{SpamAssassin}). This method has
23737 the advantage that the user can see the @emph{X-Spam} headers.
23738
23739 The easiest method is to make @file{spam.el} (@pxref{Filtering Spam
23740 Using The Spam ELisp Package}) call SpamOracle.
23741
23742 @vindex spam-use-spamoracle
23743 To enable SpamOracle usage by @file{spam.el}, set the variable
23744 @code{spam-use-spamoracle} to @code{t} and configure the
23745 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} or @code{nnimap-split-fancy} as described in
23746 the section @xref{Filtering Spam Using The Spam ELisp Package}. In
23747 this example the @samp{INBOX} of an nnimap server is filtered using
23748 SpamOracle. Mails recognized as spam mails will be moved to
23749 @code{spam-split-group}, @samp{Junk} in this case. Ham messages stay
23750 in @samp{INBOX}:
23751
23752 @example
23753 (setq spam-use-spamoracle t
23754 spam-split-group "Junk"
23755 nnimap-split-inbox '("INBOX")
23756 nnimap-split-rule 'nnimap-split-fancy
23757 nnimap-split-fancy '(| (: spam-split) "INBOX"))
23758 @end example
23759
23760 @defvar spam-use-spamoracle
23761 Set to @code{t} if you want Gnus to enable spam filtering using
23762 SpamOracle.
23763 @end defvar
23764
23765 @defvar spam-spamoracle-binary
23766 Gnus uses the SpamOracle binary called @file{spamoracle} found in the
23767 user's PATH. Using the variable @code{spam-spamoracle-binary}, this
23768 can be customized.
23769 @end defvar
23770
23771 @defvar spam-spamoracle-database
23772 By default, SpamOracle uses the file @file{~/.spamoracle.db} as a database to
23773 store its analyses. This is controlled by the variable
23774 @code{spam-spamoracle-database} which defaults to @code{nil}. That means
23775 the default SpamOracle database will be used. In case you want your
23776 database to live somewhere special, set
23777 @code{spam-spamoracle-database} to this path.
23778 @end defvar
23779
23780 SpamOracle employs a statistical algorithm to determine whether a
23781 message is spam or ham. In order to get good results, meaning few
23782 false hits or misses, SpamOracle needs training. SpamOracle learns the
23783 characteristics of your spam mails. Using the @emph{add} mode
23784 (training mode) one has to feed good (ham) and spam mails to
23785 SpamOracle. This can be done by pressing @kbd{|} in the Summary buffer
23786 and pipe the mail to a SpamOracle process or using @file{spam.el}'s
23787 spam- and ham-processors, which is much more convenient. For a
23788 detailed description of spam- and ham-processors, @xref{Filtering Spam
23789 Using The Spam ELisp Package}.
23790
23791 @defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-spamoracle
23792 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
23793 customizing the group parameter or the
23794 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is added
23795 to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, spam-marked articles will be
23796 sent to SpamOracle as spam samples.
23797
23798 @emph{WARNING}
23799
23800 Instead of the obsolete
23801 @code{gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-spamoracle}, it is recommended
23802 that you use @code{'(spam spam-use-spamoracle)}. Everything will work
23803 the same way, we promise.
23804 @end defvar
23805
23806 @defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-spamoracle
23807 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
23808 customizing the group parameter or the
23809 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is added
23810 to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the ham-marked articles in
23811 @emph{ham} groups will be sent to the SpamOracle as samples of ham
23812 messages. Note that this ham processor has no effect in @emph{spam} or
23813 @emph{unclassified} groups.
23814
23815 @emph{WARNING}
23816
23817 Instead of the obsolete
23818 @code{gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-spamoracle}, it is recommended
23819 that you use @code{'(ham spam-use-spamoracle)}. Everything will work
23820 the same way, we promise.
23821 @end defvar
23822
23823 @emph{Example:} These are the Group Parameters of a group that has been
23824 classified as a ham group, meaning that it should only contain ham
23825 messages.
23826 @example
23827 ((spam-contents gnus-group-spam-classification-ham)
23828 (spam-process ((ham spam-use-spamoracle)
23829 (spam spam-use-spamoracle))))
23830 @end example
23831 For this group the @code{spam-use-spamoracle} is installed for both
23832 ham and spam processing. If the group contains spam message
23833 (e.g. because SpamOracle has not had enough sample messages yet) and
23834 the user marks some messages as spam messages, these messages will be
23835 processed by SpamOracle. The processor sends the messages to
23836 SpamOracle as new samples for spam.
23837
23838 @node Extending the Spam ELisp package
23839 @subsubsection Extending the Spam ELisp package
23840 @cindex spam filtering
23841 @cindex spam elisp package, extending
23842 @cindex extending the spam elisp package
23843
23844 Say you want to add a new back end called blackbox. For filtering
23845 incoming mail, provide the following:
23846
23847 @enumerate
23848
23849 @item
23850 Code
23851
23852 @lisp
23853 (defvar spam-use-blackbox nil
23854 "True if blackbox should be used.")
23855 @end lisp
23856
23857 Add
23858 @lisp
23859 (spam-use-blackbox . spam-check-blackbox)
23860 @end lisp
23861 to @code{spam-list-of-checks}.
23862
23863 Add
23864 @lisp
23865 (gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-blackbox ham spam-use-blackbox)
23866 (gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-blackbox spam spam-use-blackbox)
23867 @end lisp
23868
23869 to @code{spam-list-of-processors}.
23870
23871 Add
23872 @lisp
23873 (spam-use-blackbox spam-blackbox-register-routine
23874 nil
23875 spam-blackbox-unregister-routine
23876 nil)
23877 @end lisp
23878
23879 to @code{spam-registration-functions}. Write the register/unregister
23880 routines using the bogofilter register/unregister routines as a
23881 start, or other restister/unregister routines more appropriate to
23882 Blackbox.
23883
23884 @item
23885 Functionality
23886
23887 Write the @code{spam-check-blackbox} function. It should return
23888 @samp{nil} or @code{spam-split-group}, observing the other
23889 conventions. See the existing @code{spam-check-*} functions for
23890 examples of what you can do, and stick to the template unless you
23891 fully understand the reasons why you aren't.
23892
23893 Make sure to add @code{spam-use-blackbox} to
23894 @code{spam-list-of-statistical-checks} if Blackbox is a statistical
23895 mail analyzer that needs the full message body to operate.
23896
23897 @end enumerate
23898
23899 For processing spam and ham messages, provide the following:
23900
23901 @enumerate
23902
23903 @item
23904 Code
23905
23906 Note you don't have to provide a spam or a ham processor. Only
23907 provide them if Blackbox supports spam or ham processing.
23908
23909 Also, ham and spam processors are being phased out as single
23910 variables. Instead the form @code{'(spam spam-use-blackbox)} or
23911 @code{'(ham spam-use-blackbox)} is favored. For now, spam/ham
23912 processor variables are still around but they won't be for long.
23913
23914 @lisp
23915 (defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-blackbox "blackbox-spam"
23916 "The Blackbox summary exit spam processor.
23917 Only applicable to spam groups.")
23918
23919 (defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-blackbox "blackbox-ham"
23920 "The whitelist summary exit ham processor.
23921 Only applicable to non-spam (unclassified and ham) groups.")
23922
23923 @end lisp
23924
23925 @item
23926 Gnus parameters
23927
23928 Add
23929 @lisp
23930 (const :tag "Spam: Blackbox" (spam spam-use-blackbox))
23931 (const :tag "Ham: Blackbox" (ham spam-use-blackbox))
23932 @end lisp
23933 to the @code{spam-process} group parameter in @code{gnus.el}. Make
23934 sure you do it twice, once for the parameter and once for the
23935 variable customization.
23936
23937 Add
23938 @lisp
23939 (variable-item spam-use-blackbox)
23940 @end lisp
23941 to the @code{spam-autodetect-methods} group parameter in
23942 @code{gnus.el}.
23943
23944 @end enumerate
23945
23946
23947 @node Filtering Spam Using Statistics with spam-stat
23948 @subsection Filtering Spam Using Statistics with spam-stat
23949 @cindex Paul Graham
23950 @cindex Graham, Paul
23951 @cindex naive Bayesian spam filtering
23952 @cindex Bayesian spam filtering, naive
23953 @cindex spam filtering, naive Bayesian
23954
23955 Paul Graham has written an excellent essay about spam filtering using
23956 statistics: @uref{http://www.paulgraham.com/spam.html,A Plan for
23957 Spam}. In it he describes the inherent deficiency of rule-based
23958 filtering as used by SpamAssassin, for example: Somebody has to write
23959 the rules, and everybody else has to install these rules. You are
23960 always late. It would be much better, he argues, to filter mail based
23961 on whether it somehow resembles spam or non-spam. One way to measure
23962 this is word distribution. He then goes on to describe a solution
23963 that checks whether a new mail resembles any of your other spam mails
23964 or not.
23965
23966 The basic idea is this: Create a two collections of your mail, one
23967 with spam, one with non-spam. Count how often each word appears in
23968 either collection, weight this by the total number of mails in the
23969 collections, and store this information in a dictionary. For every
23970 word in a new mail, determine its probability to belong to a spam or a
23971 non-spam mail. Use the 15 most conspicuous words, compute the total
23972 probability of the mail being spam. If this probability is higher
23973 than a certain threshold, the mail is considered to be spam.
23974
23975 Gnus supports this kind of filtering. But it needs some setting up.
23976 First, you need two collections of your mail, one with spam, one with
23977 non-spam. Then you need to create a dictionary using these two
23978 collections, and save it. And last but not least, you need to use
23979 this dictionary in your fancy mail splitting rules.
23980
23981 @menu
23982 * Creating a spam-stat dictionary::
23983 * Splitting mail using spam-stat::
23984 * Low-level interface to the spam-stat dictionary::
23985 @end menu
23986
23987 @node Creating a spam-stat dictionary
23988 @subsubsection Creating a spam-stat dictionary
23989
23990 Before you can begin to filter spam based on statistics, you must
23991 create these statistics based on two mail collections, one with spam,
23992 one with non-spam. These statistics are then stored in a dictionary
23993 for later use. In order for these statistics to be meaningful, you
23994 need several hundred emails in both collections.
23995
23996 Gnus currently supports only the nnml back end for automated dictionary
23997 creation. The nnml back end stores all mails in a directory, one file
23998 per mail. Use the following:
23999
24000 @defun spam-stat-process-spam-directory
24001 Create spam statistics for every file in this directory. Every file
24002 is treated as one spam mail.
24003 @end defun
24004
24005 @defun spam-stat-process-non-spam-directory
24006 Create non-spam statistics for every file in this directory. Every
24007 file is treated as one non-spam mail.
24008 @end defun
24009
24010 Usually you would call @code{spam-stat-process-spam-directory} on a
24011 directory such as @file{~/Mail/mail/spam} (this usually corresponds
24012 the the group @samp{nnml:mail.spam}), and you would call
24013 @code{spam-stat-process-non-spam-directory} on a directory such as
24014 @file{~/Mail/mail/misc} (this usually corresponds the the group
24015 @samp{nnml:mail.misc}).
24016
24017 When you are using @acronym{IMAP}, you won't have the mails available
24018 locally, so that will not work. One solution is to use the Gnus Agent
24019 to cache the articles. Then you can use directories such as
24020 @file{"~/News/agent/nnimap/mail.yourisp.com/personal_spam"} for
24021 @code{spam-stat-process-spam-directory}. @xref{Agent as Cache}.
24022
24023 @defvar spam-stat
24024 This variable holds the hash-table with all the statistics---the
24025 dictionary we have been talking about. For every word in either
24026 collection, this hash-table stores a vector describing how often the
24027 word appeared in spam and often it appeared in non-spam mails.
24028 @end defvar
24029
24030 If you want to regenerate the statistics from scratch, you need to
24031 reset the dictionary.
24032
24033 @defun spam-stat-reset
24034 Reset the @code{spam-stat} hash-table, deleting all the statistics.
24035 @end defun
24036
24037 When you are done, you must save the dictionary. The dictionary may
24038 be rather large. If you will not update the dictionary incrementally
24039 (instead, you will recreate it once a month, for example), then you
24040 can reduce the size of the dictionary by deleting all words that did
24041 not appear often enough or that do not clearly belong to only spam or
24042 only non-spam mails.
24043
24044 @defun spam-stat-reduce-size
24045 Reduce the size of the dictionary. Use this only if you do not want
24046 to update the dictionary incrementally.
24047 @end defun
24048
24049 @defun spam-stat-save
24050 Save the dictionary.
24051 @end defun
24052
24053 @defvar spam-stat-file
24054 The filename used to store the dictionary. This defaults to
24055 @file{~/.spam-stat.el}.
24056 @end defvar
24057
24058 @node Splitting mail using spam-stat
24059 @subsubsection Splitting mail using spam-stat
24060
24061 In order to use @code{spam-stat} to split your mail, you need to add the
24062 following to your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
24063
24064 @lisp
24065 (require 'spam-stat)
24066 (spam-stat-load)
24067 @end lisp
24068
24069 This will load the necessary Gnus code, and the dictionary you
24070 created.
24071
24072 Next, you need to adapt your fancy splitting rules: You need to
24073 determine how to use @code{spam-stat}. The following examples are for
24074 the nnml back end. Using the nnimap back end works just as well. Just
24075 use @code{nnimap-split-fancy} instead of @code{nnmail-split-fancy}.
24076
24077 In the simplest case, you only have two groups, @samp{mail.misc} and
24078 @samp{mail.spam}. The following expression says that mail is either
24079 spam or it should go into @samp{mail.misc}. If it is spam, then
24080 @code{spam-stat-split-fancy} will return @samp{mail.spam}.
24081
24082 @lisp
24083 (setq nnmail-split-fancy
24084 `(| (: spam-stat-split-fancy)
24085 "mail.misc"))
24086 @end lisp
24087
24088 @defvar spam-stat-split-fancy-spam-group
24089 The group to use for spam. Default is @samp{mail.spam}.
24090 @end defvar
24091
24092 If you also filter mail with specific subjects into other groups, use
24093 the following expression. Only mails not matching the regular
24094 expression are considered potential spam.
24095
24096 @lisp
24097 (setq nnmail-split-fancy
24098 `(| ("Subject" "\\bspam-stat\\b" "mail.emacs")
24099 (: spam-stat-split-fancy)
24100 "mail.misc"))
24101 @end lisp
24102
24103 If you want to filter for spam first, then you must be careful when
24104 creating the dictionary. Note that @code{spam-stat-split-fancy} must
24105 consider both mails in @samp{mail.emacs} and in @samp{mail.misc} as
24106 non-spam, therefore both should be in your collection of non-spam
24107 mails, when creating the dictionary!
24108
24109 @lisp
24110 (setq nnmail-split-fancy
24111 `(| (: spam-stat-split-fancy)
24112 ("Subject" "\\bspam-stat\\b" "mail.emacs")
24113 "mail.misc"))
24114 @end lisp
24115
24116 You can combine this with traditional filtering. Here, we move all
24117 HTML-only mails into the @samp{mail.spam.filtered} group. Note that since
24118 @code{spam-stat-split-fancy} will never see them, the mails in
24119 @samp{mail.spam.filtered} should be neither in your collection of spam mails,
24120 nor in your collection of non-spam mails, when creating the
24121 dictionary!
24122
24123 @lisp
24124 (setq nnmail-split-fancy
24125 `(| ("Content-Type" "text/html" "mail.spam.filtered")
24126 (: spam-stat-split-fancy)
24127 ("Subject" "\\bspam-stat\\b" "mail.emacs")
24128 "mail.misc"))
24129 @end lisp
24130
24131
24132 @node Low-level interface to the spam-stat dictionary
24133 @subsubsection Low-level interface to the spam-stat dictionary
24134
24135 The main interface to using @code{spam-stat}, are the following functions:
24136
24137 @defun spam-stat-buffer-is-spam
24138 Called in a buffer, that buffer is considered to be a new spam mail.
24139 Use this for new mail that has not been processed before.
24140 @end defun
24141
24142 @defun spam-stat-buffer-is-no-spam
24143 Called in a buffer, that buffer is considered to be a new non-spam
24144 mail. Use this for new mail that has not been processed before.
24145 @end defun
24146
24147 @defun spam-stat-buffer-change-to-spam
24148 Called in a buffer, that buffer is no longer considered to be normal
24149 mail but spam. Use this to change the status of a mail that has
24150 already been processed as non-spam.
24151 @end defun
24152
24153 @defun spam-stat-buffer-change-to-non-spam
24154 Called in a buffer, that buffer is no longer considered to be spam but
24155 normal mail. Use this to change the status of a mail that has already
24156 been processed as spam.
24157 @end defun
24158
24159 @defun spam-stat-save
24160 Save the hash table to the file. The filename used is stored in the
24161 variable @code{spam-stat-file}.
24162 @end defun
24163
24164 @defun spam-stat-load
24165 Load the hash table from a file. The filename used is stored in the
24166 variable @code{spam-stat-file}.
24167 @end defun
24168
24169 @defun spam-stat-score-word
24170 Return the spam score for a word.
24171 @end defun
24172
24173 @defun spam-stat-score-buffer
24174 Return the spam score for a buffer.
24175 @end defun
24176
24177 @defun spam-stat-split-fancy
24178 Use this function for fancy mail splitting. Add the rule @samp{(:
24179 spam-stat-split-fancy)} to @code{nnmail-split-fancy}
24180 @end defun
24181
24182 Make sure you load the dictionary before using it. This requires the
24183 following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
24184
24185 @lisp
24186 (require 'spam-stat)
24187 (spam-stat-load)
24188 @end lisp
24189
24190 Typical test will involve calls to the following functions:
24191
24192 @smallexample
24193 Reset: (setq spam-stat (make-hash-table :test 'equal))
24194 Learn spam: (spam-stat-process-spam-directory "~/Mail/mail/spam")
24195 Learn non-spam: (spam-stat-process-non-spam-directory "~/Mail/mail/misc")
24196 Save table: (spam-stat-save)
24197 File size: (nth 7 (file-attributes spam-stat-file))
24198 Number of words: (hash-table-count spam-stat)
24199 Test spam: (spam-stat-test-directory "~/Mail/mail/spam")
24200 Test non-spam: (spam-stat-test-directory "~/Mail/mail/misc")
24201 Reduce table size: (spam-stat-reduce-size)
24202 Save table: (spam-stat-save)
24203 File size: (nth 7 (file-attributes spam-stat-file))
24204 Number of words: (hash-table-count spam-stat)
24205 Test spam: (spam-stat-test-directory "~/Mail/mail/spam")
24206 Test non-spam: (spam-stat-test-directory "~/Mail/mail/misc")
24207 @end smallexample
24208
24209 Here is how you would create your dictionary:
24210
24211 @smallexample
24212 Reset: (setq spam-stat (make-hash-table :test 'equal))
24213 Learn spam: (spam-stat-process-spam-directory "~/Mail/mail/spam")
24214 Learn non-spam: (spam-stat-process-non-spam-directory "~/Mail/mail/misc")
24215 Repeat for any other non-spam group you need...
24216 Reduce table size: (spam-stat-reduce-size)
24217 Save table: (spam-stat-save)
24218 @end smallexample
24219
24220 @node Other modes
24221 @section Interaction with other modes
24222
24223 @subsection Dired
24224 @cindex dired
24225
24226 @code{gnus-dired-minor-mode} provided some useful functions for dired
24227 buffers. It is enabled with
24228 @lisp
24229 (add-hook 'dired-mode-hook 'turn-on-gnus-dired-mode)
24230 @end lisp
24231
24232 @table @kbd
24233 @item C-c C-m C-a
24234 @findex gnus-dired-attach
24235 Send dired's marked files as an attachment (@code{gnus-dired-attach}).
24236 You will be prompted for a message buffer.
24237
24238 @item C-c C-m C-l
24239 @findex gnus-dired-find-file-mailcap
24240 Visit a file according to the appropriate mailcap entry
24241 (@code{gnus-dired-find-file-mailcap}). With prefix, open file in a new
24242 buffer.
24243
24244 @item C-c C-m C-p
24245 @findex gnus-dired-print
24246 Print file according to the mailcap entry (@code{gnus-dired-print}). If
24247 there is no print command, print in a PostScript image.
24248 @end table
24249
24250 @node Various Various
24251 @section Various Various
24252 @cindex mode lines
24253 @cindex highlights
24254
24255 @table @code
24256
24257 @item gnus-home-directory
24258 @vindex gnus-home-directory
24259 All Gnus file and directory variables will be initialized from this
24260 variable, which defaults to @file{~/}.
24261
24262 @item gnus-directory
24263 @vindex gnus-directory
24264 Most Gnus storage file and directory variables will be initialized from
24265 this variable, which defaults to the @env{SAVEDIR} environment
24266 variable, or @file{~/News/} if that variable isn't set.
24267
24268 Note that Gnus is mostly loaded when the @file{~/.gnus.el} file is read.
24269 This means that other directory variables that are initialized from this
24270 variable won't be set properly if you set this variable in
24271 @file{~/.gnus.el}. Set this variable in @file{.emacs} instead.
24272
24273 @item gnus-default-directory
24274 @vindex gnus-default-directory
24275 Not related to the above variable at all---this variable says what the
24276 default directory of all Gnus buffers should be. If you issue commands
24277 like @kbd{C-x C-f}, the prompt you'll get starts in the current buffer's
24278 default directory. If this variable is @code{nil} (which is the
24279 default), the default directory will be the default directory of the
24280 buffer you were in when you started Gnus.
24281
24282 @item gnus-verbose
24283 @vindex gnus-verbose
24284 This variable is an integer between zero and ten. The higher the value,
24285 the more messages will be displayed. If this variable is zero, Gnus
24286 will never flash any messages, if it is seven (which is the default),
24287 most important messages will be shown, and if it is ten, Gnus won't ever
24288 shut up, but will flash so many messages it will make your head swim.
24289
24290 @item gnus-verbose-backends
24291 @vindex gnus-verbose-backends
24292 This variable works the same way as @code{gnus-verbose}, but it applies
24293 to the Gnus back ends instead of Gnus proper.
24294
24295 @item nnheader-max-head-length
24296 @vindex nnheader-max-head-length
24297 When the back ends read straight heads of articles, they all try to read
24298 as little as possible. This variable (default 4096) specifies
24299 the absolute max length the back ends will try to read before giving up
24300 on finding a separator line between the head and the body. If this
24301 variable is @code{nil}, there is no upper read bound. If it is
24302 @code{t}, the back ends won't try to read the articles piece by piece,
24303 but read the entire articles. This makes sense with some versions of
24304 @code{ange-ftp} or @code{efs}.
24305
24306 @item nnheader-head-chop-length
24307 @vindex nnheader-head-chop-length
24308 This variable (default 2048) says how big a piece of each article to
24309 read when doing the operation described above.
24310
24311 @item nnheader-file-name-translation-alist
24312 @vindex nnheader-file-name-translation-alist
24313 @cindex file names
24314 @cindex invalid characters in file names
24315 @cindex characters in file names
24316 This is an alist that says how to translate characters in file names.
24317 For instance, if @samp{:} is invalid as a file character in file names
24318 on your system (you OS/2 user you), you could say something like:
24319
24320 @lisp
24321 @group
24322 (setq nnheader-file-name-translation-alist
24323 '((?: . ?_)))
24324 @end group
24325 @end lisp
24326
24327 In fact, this is the default value for this variable on OS/2 and MS
24328 Windows (phooey) systems.
24329
24330 @item gnus-hidden-properties
24331 @vindex gnus-hidden-properties
24332 This is a list of properties to use to hide ``invisible'' text. It is
24333 @code{(invisible t intangible t)} by default on most systems, which
24334 makes invisible text invisible and intangible.
24335
24336 @item gnus-parse-headers-hook
24337 @vindex gnus-parse-headers-hook
24338 A hook called before parsing headers. It can be used, for instance, to
24339 gather statistics on the headers fetched, or perhaps you'd like to prune
24340 some headers. I don't see why you'd want that, though.
24341
24342 @item gnus-shell-command-separator
24343 @vindex gnus-shell-command-separator
24344 String used to separate two shell commands. The default is @samp{;}.
24345
24346 @item gnus-invalid-group-regexp
24347 @vindex gnus-invalid-group-regexp
24348
24349 Regexp to match ``invalid'' group names when querying user for a group
24350 name. The default value catches some @strong{really} invalid group
24351 names who could possibly mess up Gnus internally (like allowing
24352 @samp{:} in a group name, which is normally used to delimit method and
24353 group).
24354
24355 @acronym{IMAP} users might want to allow @samp{/} in group names though.
24356
24357
24358 @end table
24359
24360 @node The End
24361 @chapter The End
24362
24363 Well, that's the manual---you can get on with your life now. Keep in
24364 touch. Say hello to your cats from me.
24365
24366 My @strong{ghod}---I just can't stand goodbyes. Sniffle.
24367
24368 Ol' Charles Reznikoff said it pretty well, so I leave the floor to him:
24369
24370 @quotation
24371 @strong{Te Deum}
24372
24373 @sp 1
24374 Not because of victories @*
24375 I sing,@*
24376 having none,@*
24377 but for the common sunshine,@*
24378 the breeze,@*
24379 the largess of the spring.
24380
24381 @sp 1
24382 Not for victory@*
24383 but for the day's work done@*
24384 as well as I was able;@*
24385 not for a seat upon the dais@*
24386 but at the common table.@*
24387 @end quotation
24388
24389
24390 @node Appendices
24391 @chapter Appendices
24392
24393 @menu
24394 * XEmacs:: Requirements for installing under XEmacs.
24395 * History:: How Gnus got where it is today.
24396 * On Writing Manuals:: Why this is not a beginner's guide.
24397 * Terminology:: We use really difficult, like, words here.
24398 * Customization:: Tailoring Gnus to your needs.
24399 * Troubleshooting:: What you might try if things do not work.
24400 * Gnus Reference Guide:: Rilly, rilly technical stuff.
24401 * Emacs for Heathens:: A short introduction to Emacsian terms.
24402 * Frequently Asked Questions:: The Gnus FAQ
24403 @end menu
24404
24405
24406 @node XEmacs
24407 @section XEmacs
24408 @cindex XEmacs
24409 @cindex installing under XEmacs
24410
24411 XEmacs is distributed as a collection of packages. You should install
24412 whatever packages the Gnus XEmacs package requires. The current
24413 requirements are @samp{gnus}, @samp{mail-lib}, @samp{xemacs-base},
24414 @samp{eterm}, @samp{sh-script}, @samp{net-utils}, @samp{os-utils},
24415 @samp{dired}, @samp{mh-e}, @samp{sieve}, @samp{ps-print}, @samp{w3},
24416 @samp{pgg}, @samp{mailcrypt}, @samp{ecrypto}, and @samp{sasl}.
24417
24418
24419 @node History
24420 @section History
24421
24422 @cindex history
24423 @sc{gnus} was written by Masanobu @sc{Umeda}. When autumn crept up in
24424 '94, Lars Magne Ingebrigtsen grew bored and decided to rewrite Gnus.
24425
24426 If you want to investigate the person responsible for this outrage,
24427 you can point your (feh!) web browser to
24428 @uref{http://quimby.gnus.org/}. This is also the primary
24429 distribution point for the new and spiffy versions of Gnus, and is
24430 known as The Site That Destroys Newsrcs And Drives People Mad.
24431
24432 During the first extended alpha period of development, the new Gnus was
24433 called ``(ding) Gnus''. @dfn{(ding)} is, of course, short for
24434 @dfn{ding is not Gnus}, which is a total and utter lie, but who cares?
24435 (Besides, the ``Gnus'' in this abbreviation should probably be
24436 pronounced ``news'' as @sc{Umeda} intended, which makes it a more
24437 appropriate name, don't you think?)
24438
24439 In any case, after spending all that energy on coming up with a new and
24440 spunky name, we decided that the name was @emph{too} spunky, so we
24441 renamed it back again to ``Gnus''. But in mixed case. ``Gnus'' vs.
24442 ``@sc{gnus}''. New vs. old.
24443
24444 @menu
24445 * Gnus Versions:: What Gnus versions have been released.
24446 * Other Gnus Versions:: Other Gnus versions that also have been released.
24447 * Why?:: What's the point of Gnus?
24448 * Compatibility:: Just how compatible is Gnus with @sc{gnus}?
24449 * Conformity:: Gnus tries to conform to all standards.
24450 * Emacsen:: Gnus can be run on a few modern Emacsen.
24451 * Gnus Development:: How Gnus is developed.
24452 * Contributors:: Oodles of people.
24453 * New Features:: Pointers to some of the new stuff in Gnus.
24454 @end menu
24455
24456
24457 @node Gnus Versions
24458 @subsection Gnus Versions
24459 @cindex ding Gnus
24460 @cindex September Gnus
24461 @cindex Red Gnus
24462 @cindex Quassia Gnus
24463 @cindex Pterodactyl Gnus
24464 @cindex Oort Gnus
24465 @cindex No Gnus
24466 @cindex Gnus versions
24467
24468 The first ``proper'' release of Gnus 5 was done in November 1995 when it
24469 was included in the Emacs 19.30 distribution (132 (ding) Gnus releases
24470 plus 15 Gnus 5.0 releases).
24471
24472 In May 1996 the next Gnus generation (aka. ``September Gnus'' (after 99
24473 releases)) was released under the name ``Gnus 5.2'' (40 releases).
24474
24475 On July 28th 1996 work on Red Gnus was begun, and it was released on
24476 January 25th 1997 (after 84 releases) as ``Gnus 5.4'' (67 releases).
24477
24478 On September 13th 1997, Quassia Gnus was started and lasted 37 releases.
24479 If was released as ``Gnus 5.6'' on March 8th 1998 (46 releases).
24480
24481 Gnus 5.6 begat Pterodactyl Gnus on August 29th 1998 and was released as
24482 ``Gnus 5.8'' (after 99 releases and a CVS repository) on December 3rd
24483 1999.
24484
24485 On the 26th of October 2000, Oort Gnus was begun.
24486
24487 If you happen upon a version of Gnus that has a prefixed name --
24488 ``(ding) Gnus'', ``September Gnus'', ``Red Gnus'', ``Quassia Gnus'',
24489 ``Pterodactyl Gnus'', ``Oort Gnus'' -- don't panic. Don't let it know
24490 that you're frightened. Back away. Slowly. Whatever you do, don't
24491 run. Walk away, calmly, until you're out of its reach. Find a proper
24492 released version of Gnus and snuggle up to that instead.
24493
24494
24495 @node Other Gnus Versions
24496 @subsection Other Gnus Versions
24497 @cindex Semi-gnus
24498
24499 In addition to the versions of Gnus which have had their releases
24500 coordinated by Lars, one major development has been Semi-gnus from
24501 Japan. It's based on a library called @acronym{SEMI}, which provides
24502 @acronym{MIME} capabilities.
24503
24504 These Gnusae are based mainly on Gnus 5.6 and Pterodactyl Gnus.
24505 Collectively, they are called ``Semi-gnus'', and different strains are
24506 called T-gnus, ET-gnus, Nana-gnus and Chaos. These provide powerful
24507 @acronym{MIME} and multilingualization things, especially important for
24508 Japanese users.
24509
24510
24511 @node Why?
24512 @subsection Why?
24513
24514 What's the point of Gnus?
24515
24516 I want to provide a ``rad'', ``happening'', ``way cool'' and ``hep''
24517 newsreader, that lets you do anything you can think of. That was my
24518 original motivation, but while working on Gnus, it has become clear to
24519 me that this generation of newsreaders really belong in the stone age.
24520 Newsreaders haven't developed much since the infancy of the net. If the
24521 volume continues to rise with the current rate of increase, all current
24522 newsreaders will be pretty much useless. How do you deal with
24523 newsgroups that have thousands of new articles each day? How do you
24524 keep track of millions of people who post?
24525
24526 Gnus offers no real solutions to these questions, but I would very much
24527 like to see Gnus being used as a testing ground for new methods of
24528 reading and fetching news. Expanding on @sc{Umeda}-san's wise decision
24529 to separate the newsreader from the back ends, Gnus now offers a simple
24530 interface for anybody who wants to write new back ends for fetching mail
24531 and news from different sources. I have added hooks for customizations
24532 everywhere I could imagine it being useful. By doing so, I'm inviting
24533 every one of you to explore and invent.
24534
24535 May Gnus never be complete. @kbd{C-u 100 M-x all-hail-emacs} and
24536 @kbd{C-u 100 M-x all-hail-xemacs}.
24537
24538
24539 @node Compatibility
24540 @subsection Compatibility
24541
24542 @cindex compatibility
24543 Gnus was designed to be fully compatible with @sc{gnus}. Almost all key
24544 bindings have been kept. More key bindings have been added, of course,
24545 but only in one or two obscure cases have old bindings been changed.
24546
24547 Our motto is:
24548 @quotation
24549 @cartouche
24550 @center In a cloud bones of steel.
24551 @end cartouche
24552 @end quotation
24553
24554 All commands have kept their names. Some internal functions have changed
24555 their names.
24556
24557 The @code{gnus-uu} package has changed drastically. @xref{Decoding
24558 Articles}.
24559
24560 One major compatibility question is the presence of several summary
24561 buffers. All variables relevant while reading a group are
24562 buffer-local to the summary buffer they belong in. Although many
24563 important variables have their values copied into their global
24564 counterparts whenever a command is executed in the summary buffer, this
24565 change might lead to incorrect values being used unless you are careful.
24566
24567 All code that relies on knowledge of @sc{gnus} internals will probably
24568 fail. To take two examples: Sorting @code{gnus-newsrc-alist} (or
24569 changing it in any way, as a matter of fact) is strictly verboten. Gnus
24570 maintains a hash table that points to the entries in this alist (which
24571 speeds up many functions), and changing the alist directly will lead to
24572 peculiar results.
24573
24574 @cindex hilit19
24575 @cindex highlighting
24576 Old hilit19 code does not work at all. In fact, you should probably
24577 remove all hilit code from all Gnus hooks
24578 (@code{gnus-group-prepare-hook} and @code{gnus-summary-prepare-hook}).
24579 Gnus provides various integrated functions for highlighting. These are
24580 faster and more accurate. To make life easier for everybody, Gnus will
24581 by default remove all hilit calls from all hilit hooks. Uncleanliness!
24582 Away!
24583
24584 Packages like @code{expire-kill} will no longer work. As a matter of
24585 fact, you should probably remove all old @sc{gnus} packages (and other
24586 code) when you start using Gnus. More likely than not, Gnus already
24587 does what you have written code to make @sc{gnus} do. (Snicker.)
24588
24589 Even though old methods of doing things are still supported, only the
24590 new methods are documented in this manual. If you detect a new method of
24591 doing something while reading this manual, that does not mean you have
24592 to stop doing it the old way.
24593
24594 Gnus understands all @sc{gnus} startup files.
24595
24596 @kindex M-x gnus-bug
24597 @findex gnus-bug
24598 @cindex reporting bugs
24599 @cindex bugs
24600 Overall, a casual user who hasn't written much code that depends on
24601 @sc{gnus} internals should suffer no problems. If problems occur,
24602 please let me know by issuing that magic command @kbd{M-x gnus-bug}.
24603
24604 @vindex gnus-bug-create-help-buffer
24605 If you are in the habit of sending bug reports @emph{very} often, you
24606 may find the helpful help buffer annoying after a while. If so, set
24607 @code{gnus-bug-create-help-buffer} to @code{nil} to avoid having it pop
24608 up at you.
24609
24610
24611 @node Conformity
24612 @subsection Conformity
24613
24614 No rebels without a clue here, ma'am. We conform to all standards known
24615 to (wo)man. Except for those standards and/or conventions we disagree
24616 with, of course.
24617
24618 @table @strong
24619
24620 @item RFC (2)822
24621 @cindex RFC 822
24622 @cindex RFC 2822
24623 There are no known breaches of this standard.
24624
24625 @item RFC 1036
24626 @cindex RFC 1036
24627 There are no known breaches of this standard, either.
24628
24629 @item Son-of-RFC 1036
24630 @cindex Son-of-RFC 1036
24631 We do have some breaches to this one.
24632
24633 @table @emph
24634
24635 @item X-Newsreader
24636 @itemx User-Agent
24637 These are considered to be ``vanity headers'', while I consider them
24638 to be consumer information. After seeing so many badly formatted
24639 articles coming from @code{tin} and @code{Netscape} I know not to use
24640 either of those for posting articles. I would not have known that if
24641 it wasn't for the @code{X-Newsreader} header.
24642 @end table
24643
24644 @item USEFOR
24645 @cindex USEFOR
24646 USEFOR is an IETF working group writing a successor to RFC 1036, based
24647 on Son-of-RFC 1036. They have produced a number of drafts proposing
24648 various changes to the format of news articles. The Gnus towers will
24649 look into implementing the changes when the draft is accepted as an RFC.
24650
24651 @item MIME - RFC 2045-2049 etc
24652 @cindex @acronym{MIME}
24653 All the various @acronym{MIME} RFCs are supported.
24654
24655 @item Disposition Notifications - RFC 2298
24656 Message Mode is able to request notifications from the receiver.
24657
24658 @item PGP - RFC 1991 and RFC 2440
24659 @cindex RFC 1991
24660 @cindex RFC 2440
24661 RFC 1991 is the original @acronym{PGP} message specification,
24662 published as an informational RFC. RFC 2440 was the follow-up, now
24663 called Open PGP, and put on the Standards Track. Both document a
24664 non-@acronym{MIME} aware @acronym{PGP} format. Gnus supports both
24665 encoding (signing and encryption) and decoding (verification and
24666 decryption).
24667
24668 @item PGP/MIME - RFC 2015/3156
24669 RFC 2015 (superseded by 3156 which references RFC 2440 instead of RFC
24670 1991) describes the @acronym{MIME}-wrapping around the RF 1991/2440 format.
24671 Gnus supports both encoding and decoding.
24672
24673 @item S/MIME - RFC 2633
24674 RFC 2633 describes the @acronym{S/MIME} format.
24675
24676 @item IMAP - RFC 1730/2060, RFC 2195, RFC 2086, RFC 2359, RFC 2595, RFC 1731
24677 RFC 1730 is @acronym{IMAP} version 4, updated somewhat by RFC 2060
24678 (@acronym{IMAP} 4 revision 1). RFC 2195 describes CRAM-MD5
24679 authentication for @acronym{IMAP}. RFC 2086 describes access control
24680 lists (ACLs) for @acronym{IMAP}. RFC 2359 describes a @acronym{IMAP}
24681 protocol enhancement. RFC 2595 describes the proper @acronym{TLS}
24682 integration (STARTTLS) with @acronym{IMAP}. RFC 1731 describes the
24683 GSSAPI/Kerberos4 mechanisms for @acronym{IMAP}.
24684
24685 @end table
24686
24687 If you ever notice Gnus acting non-compliant with regards to the texts
24688 mentioned above, don't hesitate to drop a note to Gnus Towers and let us
24689 know.
24690
24691
24692 @node Emacsen
24693 @subsection Emacsen
24694 @cindex Emacsen
24695 @cindex XEmacs
24696 @cindex Mule
24697 @cindex Emacs
24698
24699 Gnus should work on:
24700
24701 @itemize @bullet
24702
24703 @item
24704 Emacs 20.7 and up.
24705
24706 @item
24707 XEmacs 21.1 and up.
24708
24709 @end itemize
24710
24711 This Gnus version will absolutely not work on any Emacsen older than
24712 that. Not reliably, at least. Older versions of Gnus may work on older
24713 Emacs versions.
24714
24715 There are some vague differences between Gnus on the various
24716 platforms---XEmacs features more graphics (a logo and a toolbar)---but
24717 other than that, things should look pretty much the same under all
24718 Emacsen.
24719
24720
24721 @node Gnus Development
24722 @subsection Gnus Development
24723
24724 Gnus is developed in a two-phased cycle. The first phase involves much
24725 discussion on the @samp{ding@@gnus.org} mailing list, where people
24726 propose changes and new features, post patches and new back ends. This
24727 phase is called the @dfn{alpha} phase, since the Gnusae released in this
24728 phase are @dfn{alpha releases}, or (perhaps more commonly in other
24729 circles) @dfn{snapshots}. During this phase, Gnus is assumed to be
24730 unstable and should not be used by casual users. Gnus alpha releases
24731 have names like ``Red Gnus'' and ``Quassia Gnus''.
24732
24733 After futzing around for 50-100 alpha releases, Gnus is declared
24734 @dfn{frozen}, and only bug fixes are applied. Gnus loses the prefix,
24735 and is called things like ``Gnus 5.6.32'' instead. Normal people are
24736 supposed to be able to use these, and these are mostly discussed on the
24737 @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus} newsgroup.
24738
24739 @cindex Incoming*
24740 @vindex mail-source-delete-incoming
24741 Some variable defaults differ between alpha Gnusae and released Gnusae.
24742 In particular, @code{mail-source-delete-incoming} defaults to @code{nil} in
24743 alpha Gnusae and @code{t} in released Gnusae. This is to prevent
24744 lossage of mail if an alpha release hiccups while handling the mail.
24745
24746 The division of discussion between the ding mailing list and the Gnus
24747 newsgroup is not purely based on publicity concerns. It's true that
24748 having people write about the horrible things that an alpha Gnus release
24749 can do (sometimes) in a public forum may scare people off, but more
24750 importantly, talking about new experimental features that have been
24751 introduced may confuse casual users. New features are frequently
24752 introduced, fiddled with, and judged to be found wanting, and then
24753 either discarded or totally rewritten. People reading the mailing list
24754 usually keep up with these rapid changes, while people on the newsgroup
24755 can't be assumed to do so.
24756
24757
24758
24759 @node Contributors
24760 @subsection Contributors
24761 @cindex contributors
24762
24763 The new Gnus version couldn't have been done without the help of all the
24764 people on the (ding) mailing list. Every day for over a year I have
24765 gotten billions of nice bug reports from them, filling me with joy,
24766 every single one of them. Smooches. The people on the list have been
24767 tried beyond endurance, what with my ``oh, that's a neat idea <type
24768 type>, yup, I'll release it right away <ship off> no wait, that doesn't
24769 work at all <type type>, yup, I'll ship that one off right away <ship
24770 off> no, wait, that absolutely does not work'' policy for releases.
24771 Micro$oft---bah. Amateurs. I'm @emph{much} worse. (Or is that
24772 ``worser''? ``much worser''? ``worsest''?)
24773
24774 I would like to take this opportunity to thank the Academy for@dots{} oops,
24775 wrong show.
24776
24777 @itemize @bullet
24778
24779 @item
24780 Masanobu @sc{Umeda}---the writer of the original @sc{gnus}.
24781
24782 @item
24783 Shenghuo Zhu---uudecode.el, mm-uu.el, rfc1843.el, webmail.el,
24784 nnwarchive and many, many other things connected with @acronym{MIME} and
24785 other types of en/decoding, as well as general bug fixing, new
24786 functionality and stuff.
24787
24788 @item
24789 Per Abrahamsen---custom, scoring, highlighting and @sc{soup} code (as
24790 well as numerous other things).
24791
24792 @item
24793 Luis Fernandes---design and graphics.
24794
24795 @item
24796 Joe Reiss---creator of the smiley faces.
24797
24798 @item
24799 Justin Sheehy---the @acronym{FAQ} maintainer.
24800
24801 @item
24802 Erik Naggum---help, ideas, support, code and stuff.
24803
24804 @item
24805 Wes Hardaker---@file{gnus-picon.el} and the manual section on
24806 @dfn{picons} (@pxref{Picons}).
24807
24808 @item
24809 Kim-Minh Kaplan---further work on the picon code.
24810
24811 @item
24812 Brad Miller---@file{gnus-gl.el} and the GroupLens manual section
24813 (@pxref{GroupLens}).
24814
24815 @item
24816 Sudish Joseph---innumerable bug fixes.
24817
24818 @item
24819 Ilja Weis---@file{gnus-topic.el}.
24820
24821 @item
24822 Steven L. Baur---lots and lots and lots of bugs detections and fixes.
24823
24824 @item
24825 Vladimir Alexiev---the refcard and reference booklets.
24826
24827 @item
24828 Felix Lee & Jamie Zawinski---I stole some pieces from the XGnus
24829 distribution by Felix Lee and JWZ.
24830
24831 @item
24832 Scott Byer---@file{nnfolder.el} enhancements & rewrite.
24833
24834 @item
24835 Peter Mutsaers---orphan article scoring code.
24836
24837 @item
24838 Ken Raeburn---POP mail support.
24839
24840 @item
24841 Hallvard B Furuseth---various bits and pieces, especially dealing with
24842 .newsrc files.
24843
24844 @item
24845 Brian Edmonds---@file{gnus-bbdb.el}.
24846
24847 @item
24848 David Moore---rewrite of @file{nnvirtual.el} and many other things.
24849
24850 @item
24851 Kevin Davidson---came up with the name @dfn{ding}, so blame him.
24852
24853 @item
24854 François Pinard---many, many interesting and thorough bug reports, as
24855 well as autoconf support.
24856
24857 @end itemize
24858
24859 This manual was proof-read by Adrian Aichner, with Ricardo Nassif, Mark
24860 Borges, and Jost Krieger proof-reading parts of the manual.
24861
24862 The following people have contributed many patches and suggestions:
24863
24864 Christopher Davis,
24865 Andrew Eskilsson,
24866 Kai Grossjohann,
24867 Kevin Greiner,
24868 Jesper Harder,
24869 Paul Jarc,
24870 Simon Josefsson,
24871 David KÃ¥gedal,
24872 Richard Pieri,
24873 Fabrice Popineau,
24874 Daniel Quinlan,
24875 Michael Shields,
24876 Reiner Steib,
24877 Jason L. Tibbitts, III,
24878 Jack Vinson,
24879 Katsumi Yamaoka, @c Yamaoka
24880 and
24881 Teodor Zlatanov.
24882
24883 Also thanks to the following for patches and stuff:
24884
24885 Jari Aalto,
24886 Adrian Aichner,
24887 Vladimir Alexiev,
24888 Russ Allbery,
24889 Peter Arius,
24890 Matt Armstrong,
24891 Marc Auslander,
24892 Miles Bader,
24893 Alexei V. Barantsev,
24894 Frank Bennett,
24895 Robert Bihlmeyer,
24896 Chris Bone,
24897 Mark Borges,
24898 Mark Boyns,
24899 Lance A. Brown,
24900 Rob Browning,
24901 Kees de Bruin,
24902 Martin Buchholz,
24903 Joe Buehler,
24904 Kevin Buhr,
24905 Alastair Burt,
24906 Joao Cachopo,
24907 Zlatko Calusic,
24908 Massimo Campostrini,
24909 Castor,
24910 David Charlap,
24911 Dan Christensen,
24912 Kevin Christian,
24913 Jae-you Chung, @c ?
24914 James H. Cloos, Jr.,
24915 Laura Conrad,
24916 Michael R. Cook,
24917 Glenn Coombs,
24918 Andrew J. Cosgriff,
24919 Neil Crellin,
24920 Frank D. Cringle,
24921 Geoffrey T. Dairiki,
24922 Andre Deparade,
24923 Ulrik Dickow,
24924 Dave Disser,
24925 Rui-Tao Dong, @c ?
24926 Joev Dubach,
24927 Michael Welsh Duggan,
24928 Dave Edmondson,
24929 Paul Eggert,
24930 Mark W. Eichin,
24931 Karl Eichwalder,
24932 Enami Tsugutomo, @c Enami
24933 Michael Ernst,
24934 Luc Van Eycken,
24935 Sam Falkner,
24936 Nelson Jose dos Santos Ferreira,
24937 Sigbjorn Finne,
24938 Sven Fischer,
24939 Paul Fisher,
24940 Decklin Foster,
24941 Gary D. Foster,
24942 Paul Franklin,
24943 Guy Geens,
24944 Arne Georg Gleditsch,
24945 David S. Goldberg,
24946 Michelangelo Grigni,
24947 Dale Hagglund,
24948 D. Hall,
24949 Magnus Hammerin,
24950 Kenichi Handa, @c Handa
24951 Raja R. Harinath,
24952 Yoshiki Hayashi, @c Hayashi
24953 P. E. Jareth Hein,
24954 Hisashige Kenji, @c Hisashige
24955 Scott Hofmann,
24956 Marc Horowitz,
24957 Gunnar Horrigmo,
24958 Richard Hoskins,
24959 Brad Howes,
24960 Miguel de Icaza,
24961 François Felix Ingrand,
24962 Tatsuya Ichikawa, @c Ichikawa
24963 Ishikawa Ichiro, @c Ishikawa
24964 Lee Iverson,
24965 Iwamuro Motonori, @c Iwamuro
24966 Rajappa Iyer,
24967 Andreas Jaeger,
24968 Adam P. Jenkins,
24969 Randell Jesup,
24970 Fred Johansen,
24971 Gareth Jones,
24972 Greg Klanderman,
24973 Karl Kleinpaste,
24974 Michael Klingbeil,
24975 Peter Skov Knudsen,
24976 Shuhei Kobayashi, @c Kobayashi
24977 Petr Konecny,
24978 Koseki Yoshinori, @c Koseki
24979 Thor Kristoffersen,
24980 Jens Lautenbacher,
24981 Martin Larose,
24982 Seokchan Lee, @c Lee
24983 Joerg Lenneis,
24984 Carsten Leonhardt,
24985 James LewisMoss,
24986 Christian Limpach,
24987 Markus Linnala,
24988 Dave Love,
24989 Mike McEwan,
24990 Tonny Madsen,
24991 Shlomo Mahlab,
24992 Nat Makarevitch,
24993 Istvan Marko,
24994 David Martin,
24995 Jason R. Mastaler,
24996 Gordon Matzigkeit,
24997 Timo Metzemakers,
24998 Richard Mlynarik,
24999 Lantz Moore,
25000 Morioka Tomohiko, @c Morioka
25001 Erik Toubro Nielsen,
25002 Hrvoje Niksic,
25003 Andy Norman,
25004 Fred Oberhauser,
25005 C. R. Oldham,
25006 Alexandre Oliva,
25007 Ken Olstad,
25008 Masaharu Onishi, @c Onishi
25009 Hideki Ono, @c Ono
25010 Ettore Perazzoli,
25011 William Perry,
25012 Stephen Peters,
25013 Jens-Ulrik Holger Petersen,
25014 Ulrich Pfeifer,
25015 Matt Pharr,
25016 Andy Piper,
25017 John McClary Prevost,
25018 Bill Pringlemeir,
25019 Mike Pullen,
25020 Jim Radford,
25021 Colin Rafferty,
25022 Lasse Rasinen,
25023 Lars Balker Rasmussen,
25024 Joe Reiss,
25025 Renaud Rioboo,
25026 Roland B. Roberts,
25027 Bart Robinson,
25028 Christian von Roques,
25029 Markus Rost,
25030 Jason Rumney,
25031 Wolfgang Rupprecht,
25032 Jay Sachs,
25033 Dewey M. Sasser,
25034 Conrad Sauerwald,
25035 Loren Schall,
25036 Dan Schmidt,
25037 Ralph Schleicher,
25038 Philippe Schnoebelen,
25039 Andreas Schwab,
25040 Randal L. Schwartz,
25041 Danny Siu,
25042 Matt Simmons,
25043 Paul D. Smith,
25044 Jeff Sparkes,
25045 Toby Speight,
25046 Michael Sperber,
25047 Darren Stalder,
25048 Richard Stallman,
25049 Greg Stark,
25050 Sam Steingold,
25051 Paul Stevenson,
25052 Jonas Steverud,
25053 Paul Stodghill,
25054 Kiyokazu Suto, @c Suto
25055 Kurt Swanson,
25056 Samuel Tardieu,
25057 Teddy,
25058 Chuck Thompson,
25059 Tozawa Akihiko, @c Tozawa
25060 Philippe Troin,
25061 James Troup,
25062 Trung Tran-Duc,
25063 Jack Twilley,
25064 Aaron M. Ucko,
25065 Aki Vehtari,
25066 Didier Verna,
25067 Vladimir Volovich,
25068 Jan Vroonhof,
25069 Stefan Waldherr,
25070 Pete Ware,
25071 Barry A. Warsaw,
25072 Christoph Wedler,
25073 Joe Wells,
25074 Lee Willis,
25075 and
25076 Lloyd Zusman.
25077
25078
25079 For a full overview of what each person has done, the ChangeLogs
25080 included in the Gnus alpha distributions should give ample reading
25081 (550kB and counting).
25082
25083 Apologies to everybody that I've forgotten, of which there are many, I'm
25084 sure.
25085
25086 Gee, that's quite a list of people. I guess that must mean that there
25087 actually are people who are using Gnus. Who'd'a thunk it!
25088
25089
25090 @node New Features
25091 @subsection New Features
25092 @cindex new features
25093
25094 @menu
25095 * ding Gnus:: New things in Gnus 5.0/5.1, the first new Gnus.
25096 * September Gnus:: The Thing Formally Known As Gnus 5.2/5.3.
25097 * Red Gnus:: Third time best---Gnus 5.4/5.5.
25098 * Quassia Gnus:: Two times two is four, or Gnus 5.6/5.7.
25099 * Pterodactyl Gnus:: Pentad also starts with P, AKA Gnus 5.8/5.9.
25100 * Oort Gnus:: It's big. It's far out. Gnus 5.10/5.11.
25101 @end menu
25102
25103 These lists are, of course, just @emph{short} overviews of the
25104 @emph{most} important new features. No, really. There are tons more.
25105 Yes, we have feeping creaturism in full effect.
25106
25107 @node ding Gnus
25108 @subsubsection (ding) Gnus
25109
25110 New features in Gnus 5.0/5.1:
25111
25112 @itemize @bullet
25113
25114 @item
25115 The look of all buffers can be changed by setting format-like variables
25116 (@pxref{Group Buffer Format} and @pxref{Summary Buffer Format}).
25117
25118 @item
25119 Local spool and several @acronym{NNTP} servers can be used at once
25120 (@pxref{Select Methods}).
25121
25122 @item
25123 You can combine groups into virtual groups (@pxref{Virtual Groups}).
25124
25125 @item
25126 You can read a number of different mail formats (@pxref{Getting Mail}).
25127 All the mail back ends implement a convenient mail expiry scheme
25128 (@pxref{Expiring Mail}).
25129
25130 @item
25131 Gnus can use various strategies for gathering threads that have lost
25132 their roots (thereby gathering loose sub-threads into one thread) or it
25133 can go back and retrieve enough headers to build a complete thread
25134 (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).
25135
25136 @item
25137 Killed groups can be displayed in the group buffer, and you can read
25138 them as well (@pxref{Listing Groups}).
25139
25140 @item
25141 Gnus can do partial group updates---you do not have to retrieve the
25142 entire active file just to check for new articles in a few groups
25143 (@pxref{The Active File}).
25144
25145 @item
25146 Gnus implements a sliding scale of subscribedness to groups
25147 (@pxref{Group Levels}).
25148
25149 @item
25150 You can score articles according to any number of criteria
25151 (@pxref{Scoring}). You can even get Gnus to find out how to score
25152 articles for you (@pxref{Adaptive Scoring}).
25153
25154 @item
25155 Gnus maintains a dribble buffer that is auto-saved the normal Emacs
25156 manner, so it should be difficult to lose much data on what you have
25157 read if your machine should go down (@pxref{Auto Save}).
25158
25159 @item
25160 Gnus now has its own startup file (@file{~/.gnus.el}) to avoid
25161 cluttering up the @file{.emacs} file.
25162
25163 @item
25164 You can set the process mark on both groups and articles and perform
25165 operations on all the marked items (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
25166
25167 @item
25168 You can grep through a subset of groups and create a group from the
25169 results (@pxref{Kibozed Groups}).
25170
25171 @item
25172 You can list subsets of groups according to, well, anything
25173 (@pxref{Listing Groups}).
25174
25175 @item
25176 You can browse foreign servers and subscribe to groups from those
25177 servers (@pxref{Browse Foreign Server}).
25178
25179 @item
25180 Gnus can fetch articles, asynchronously, on a second connection to the
25181 server (@pxref{Asynchronous Fetching}).
25182
25183 @item
25184 You can cache articles locally (@pxref{Article Caching}).
25185
25186 @item
25187 The uudecode functions have been expanded and generalized
25188 (@pxref{Decoding Articles}).
25189
25190 @item
25191 You can still post uuencoded articles, which was a little-known feature
25192 of @sc{gnus}' past (@pxref{Uuencoding and Posting}).
25193
25194 @item
25195 Fetching parents (and other articles) now actually works without
25196 glitches (@pxref{Finding the Parent}).
25197
25198 @item
25199 Gnus can fetch @acronym{FAQ}s and group descriptions (@pxref{Group Information}).
25200
25201 @item
25202 Digests (and other files) can be used as the basis for groups
25203 (@pxref{Document Groups}).
25204
25205 @item
25206 Articles can be highlighted and customized (@pxref{Customizing
25207 Articles}).
25208
25209 @item
25210 URLs and other external references can be buttonized (@pxref{Article
25211 Buttons}).
25212
25213 @item
25214 You can do lots of strange stuff with the Gnus window & frame
25215 configuration (@pxref{Window Layout}).
25216
25217 @item
25218 You can click on buttons instead of using the keyboard
25219 (@pxref{Buttons}).
25220
25221 @end itemize
25222
25223
25224 @node September Gnus
25225 @subsubsection September Gnus
25226
25227 @iftex
25228 @iflatex
25229 \gnusfig{-28cm}{0cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/september,height=20cm}}
25230 @end iflatex
25231 @end iftex
25232
25233 New features in Gnus 5.2/5.3:
25234
25235 @itemize @bullet
25236
25237 @item
25238 A new message composition mode is used. All old customization variables
25239 for @code{mail-mode}, @code{rnews-reply-mode} and @code{gnus-msg} are
25240 now obsolete.
25241
25242 @item
25243 Gnus is now able to generate @dfn{sparse} threads---threads where
25244 missing articles are represented by empty nodes (@pxref{Customizing
25245 Threading}).
25246
25247 @lisp
25248 (setq gnus-build-sparse-threads 'some)
25249 @end lisp
25250
25251 @item
25252 Outgoing articles are stored on a special archive server
25253 (@pxref{Archived Messages}).
25254
25255 @item
25256 Partial thread regeneration now happens when articles are
25257 referred.
25258
25259 @item
25260 Gnus can make use of GroupLens predictions (@pxref{GroupLens}).
25261
25262 @item
25263 Picons (personal icons) can be displayed under XEmacs (@pxref{Picons}).
25264
25265 @item
25266 A @code{trn}-like tree buffer can be displayed (@pxref{Tree Display}).
25267
25268 @lisp
25269 (setq gnus-use-trees t)
25270 @end lisp
25271
25272 @item
25273 An @code{nn}-like pick-and-read minor mode is available for the summary
25274 buffers (@pxref{Pick and Read}).
25275
25276 @lisp
25277 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-mode-hook 'gnus-pick-mode)
25278 @end lisp
25279
25280 @item
25281 In binary groups you can use a special binary minor mode (@pxref{Binary
25282 Groups}).
25283
25284 @item
25285 Groups can be grouped in a folding topic hierarchy (@pxref{Group
25286 Topics}).
25287
25288 @lisp
25289 (add-hook 'gnus-group-mode-hook 'gnus-topic-mode)
25290 @end lisp
25291
25292 @item
25293 Gnus can re-send and bounce mail (@pxref{Summary Mail Commands}).
25294
25295 @item
25296 Groups can now have a score, and bubbling based on entry frequency
25297 is possible (@pxref{Group Score}).
25298
25299 @lisp
25300 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-exit-hook 'gnus-summary-bubble-group)
25301 @end lisp
25302
25303 @item
25304 Groups can be process-marked, and commands can be performed on
25305 groups of groups (@pxref{Marking Groups}).
25306
25307 @item
25308 Caching is possible in virtual groups.
25309
25310 @item
25311 @code{nndoc} now understands all kinds of digests, mail boxes, rnews
25312 news batches, ClariNet briefs collections, and just about everything
25313 else (@pxref{Document Groups}).
25314
25315 @item
25316 Gnus has a new back end (@code{nnsoup}) to create/read SOUP packets
25317 (@pxref{SOUP}).
25318
25319 @item
25320 The Gnus cache is much faster.
25321
25322 @item
25323 Groups can be sorted according to many criteria (@pxref{Sorting
25324 Groups}).
25325
25326 @item
25327 New group parameters have been introduced to set list-addresses and
25328 expiry times (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
25329
25330 @item
25331 All formatting specs allow specifying faces to be used
25332 (@pxref{Formatting Fonts}).
25333
25334 @item
25335 There are several more commands for setting/removing/acting on process
25336 marked articles on the @kbd{M P} submap (@pxref{Setting Process Marks}).
25337
25338 @item
25339 The summary buffer can be limited to show parts of the available
25340 articles based on a wide range of criteria. These commands have been
25341 bound to keys on the @kbd{/} submap (@pxref{Limiting}).
25342
25343 @item
25344 Articles can be made persistent with the @kbd{*} command
25345 (@pxref{Persistent Articles}).
25346
25347 @item
25348 All functions for hiding article elements are now toggles.
25349
25350 @item
25351 Article headers can be buttonized (@pxref{Article Washing}).
25352
25353 @item
25354 All mail back ends support fetching articles by @code{Message-ID}.
25355
25356 @item
25357 Duplicate mail can now be treated properly (@pxref{Duplicates}).
25358
25359 @item
25360 All summary mode commands are available directly from the article
25361 buffer (@pxref{Article Keymap}).
25362
25363 @item
25364 Frames can be part of @code{gnus-buffer-configuration} (@pxref{Window
25365 Layout}).
25366
25367 @item
25368 Mail can be re-scanned by a daemonic process (@pxref{Daemons}).
25369 @iftex
25370 @iflatex
25371 \marginpar[\mbox{}\hfill\epsfig{figure=ps/fseptember,height=5cm}]{\epsfig{figure=ps/fseptember,height=5cm}}
25372 @end iflatex
25373 @end iftex
25374
25375 @item
25376 Gnus can make use of NoCeM files to weed out spam (@pxref{NoCeM}).
25377
25378 @lisp
25379 (setq gnus-use-nocem t)
25380 @end lisp
25381
25382 @item
25383 Groups can be made permanently visible (@pxref{Listing Groups}).
25384
25385 @lisp
25386 (setq gnus-permanently-visible-groups "^nnml:")
25387 @end lisp
25388
25389 @item
25390 Many new hooks have been introduced to make customizing easier.
25391
25392 @item
25393 Gnus respects the @code{Mail-Copies-To} header.
25394
25395 @item
25396 Threads can be gathered by looking at the @code{References} header
25397 (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).
25398
25399 @lisp
25400 (setq gnus-summary-thread-gathering-function
25401 'gnus-gather-threads-by-references)
25402 @end lisp
25403
25404 @item
25405 Read articles can be stored in a special backlog buffer to avoid
25406 refetching (@pxref{Article Backlog}).
25407
25408 @lisp
25409 (setq gnus-keep-backlog 50)
25410 @end lisp
25411
25412 @item
25413 A clean copy of the current article is always stored in a separate
25414 buffer to allow easier treatment.
25415
25416 @item
25417 Gnus can suggest where to save articles (@pxref{Saving Articles}).
25418
25419 @item
25420 Gnus doesn't have to do as much prompting when saving (@pxref{Saving
25421 Articles}).
25422
25423 @lisp
25424 (setq gnus-prompt-before-saving t)
25425 @end lisp
25426
25427 @item
25428 @code{gnus-uu} can view decoded files asynchronously while fetching
25429 articles (@pxref{Other Decode Variables}).
25430
25431 @lisp
25432 (setq gnus-uu-grabbed-file-functions 'gnus-uu-grab-view)
25433 @end lisp
25434
25435 @item
25436 Filling in the article buffer now works properly on cited text
25437 (@pxref{Article Washing}).
25438
25439 @item
25440 Hiding cited text adds buttons to toggle hiding, and how much
25441 cited text to hide is now customizable (@pxref{Article Hiding}).
25442
25443 @lisp
25444 (setq gnus-cited-lines-visible 2)
25445 @end lisp
25446
25447 @item
25448 Boring headers can be hidden (@pxref{Article Hiding}).
25449
25450 @item
25451 Default scoring values can now be set from the menu bar.
25452
25453 @item
25454 Further syntax checking of outgoing articles have been added.
25455
25456 @end itemize
25457
25458
25459 @node Red Gnus
25460 @subsubsection Red Gnus
25461
25462 New features in Gnus 5.4/5.5:
25463
25464 @iftex
25465 @iflatex
25466 \gnusfig{-5.5cm}{-4cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/red,height=20cm}}
25467 @end iflatex
25468 @end iftex
25469
25470 @itemize @bullet
25471
25472 @item
25473 @file{nntp.el} has been totally rewritten in an asynchronous fashion.
25474
25475 @item
25476 Article prefetching functionality has been moved up into
25477 Gnus (@pxref{Asynchronous Fetching}).
25478
25479 @item
25480 Scoring can now be performed with logical operators like @code{and},
25481 @code{or}, @code{not}, and parent redirection (@pxref{Advanced
25482 Scoring}).
25483
25484 @item
25485 Article washing status can be displayed in the
25486 article mode line (@pxref{Misc Article}).
25487
25488 @item
25489 @file{gnus.el} has been split into many smaller files.
25490
25491 @item
25492 Suppression of duplicate articles based on Message-ID can be done
25493 (@pxref{Duplicate Suppression}).
25494
25495 @lisp
25496 (setq gnus-suppress-duplicates t)
25497 @end lisp
25498
25499 @item
25500 New variables for specifying what score and adapt files are to be
25501 considered home score and adapt files (@pxref{Home Score File}) have
25502 been added.
25503
25504 @item
25505 @code{nndoc} was rewritten to be easily extendable (@pxref{Document
25506 Server Internals}).
25507
25508 @item
25509 Groups can inherit group parameters from parent topics (@pxref{Topic
25510 Parameters}).
25511
25512 @item
25513 Article editing has been revamped and is now actually usable.
25514
25515 @item
25516 Signatures can be recognized in more intelligent fashions
25517 (@pxref{Article Signature}).
25518
25519 @item
25520 Summary pick mode has been made to look more @code{nn}-like. Line
25521 numbers are displayed and the @kbd{.} command can be used to pick
25522 articles (@code{Pick and Read}).
25523
25524 @item
25525 Commands for moving the @file{.newsrc.eld} from one server to
25526 another have been added (@pxref{Changing Servers}).
25527
25528 @item
25529 There's a way now to specify that ``uninteresting'' fields be suppressed
25530 when generating lines in buffers (@pxref{Advanced Formatting}).
25531
25532 @item
25533 Several commands in the group buffer can be undone with @kbd{C-M-_}
25534 (@pxref{Undo}).
25535
25536 @item
25537 Scoring can be done on words using the new score type @code{w}
25538 (@pxref{Score File Format}).
25539
25540 @item
25541 Adaptive scoring can be done on a Subject word-by-word basis
25542 (@pxref{Adaptive Scoring}).
25543
25544 @lisp
25545 (setq gnus-use-adaptive-scoring '(word))
25546 @end lisp
25547
25548 @item
25549 Scores can be decayed (@pxref{Score Decays}).
25550
25551 @lisp
25552 (setq gnus-decay-scores t)
25553 @end lisp
25554
25555 @item
25556 Scoring can be performed using a regexp on the Date header. The Date is
25557 normalized to compact ISO 8601 format first (@pxref{Score File Format}).
25558
25559 @item
25560 A new command has been added to remove all data on articles from
25561 the native server (@pxref{Changing Servers}).
25562
25563 @item
25564 A new command for reading collections of documents
25565 (@code{nndoc} with @code{nnvirtual} on top) has been added---@kbd{C-M-d}
25566 (@pxref{Really Various Summary Commands}).
25567
25568 @item
25569 Process mark sets can be pushed and popped (@pxref{Setting Process
25570 Marks}).
25571
25572 @item
25573 A new mail-to-news back end makes it possible to post even when the @acronym{NNTP}
25574 server doesn't allow posting (@pxref{Mail-To-News Gateways}).
25575
25576 @item
25577 A new back end for reading searches from Web search engines
25578 (@dfn{DejaNews}, @dfn{Alta Vista}, @dfn{InReference}) has been added
25579 (@pxref{Web Searches}).
25580
25581 @item
25582 Groups inside topics can now be sorted using the standard sorting
25583 functions, and each topic can be sorted independently (@pxref{Topic
25584 Sorting}).
25585
25586 @item
25587 Subsets of the groups can be sorted independently (@code{Sorting
25588 Groups}).
25589
25590 @item
25591 Cached articles can be pulled into the groups (@pxref{Summary Generation
25592 Commands}).
25593 @iftex
25594 @iflatex
25595 \marginpar[\mbox{}\hfill\epsfig{figure=ps/fred,width=3cm}]{\epsfig{figure=ps/fred,width=3cm}}
25596 @end iflatex
25597 @end iftex
25598
25599 @item
25600 Score files are now applied in a more reliable order (@pxref{Score
25601 Variables}).
25602
25603 @item
25604 Reports on where mail messages end up can be generated (@pxref{Splitting
25605 Mail}).
25606
25607 @item
25608 More hooks and functions have been added to remove junk from incoming
25609 mail before saving the mail (@pxref{Washing Mail}).
25610
25611 @item
25612 Emphasized text can be properly fontisized:
25613
25614 @end itemize
25615
25616
25617 @node Quassia Gnus
25618 @subsubsection Quassia Gnus
25619
25620 New features in Gnus 5.6:
25621
25622 @itemize @bullet
25623
25624 @item
25625 New functionality for using Gnus as an offline newsreader has been
25626 added. A plethora of new commands and modes have been added.
25627 @xref{Gnus Unplugged}, for the full story.
25628
25629 @item
25630 The @code{nndraft} back end has returned, but works differently than
25631 before. All Message buffers are now also articles in the @code{nndraft}
25632 group, which is created automatically.
25633
25634 @item
25635 @code{gnus-alter-header-function} can now be used to alter header
25636 values.
25637
25638 @item
25639 @code{gnus-summary-goto-article} now accept Message-ID's.
25640
25641 @item
25642 A new Message command for deleting text in the body of a message
25643 outside the region: @kbd{C-c C-v}.
25644
25645 @item
25646 You can now post to component group in @code{nnvirtual} groups with
25647 @kbd{C-u C-c C-c}.
25648
25649 @item
25650 @code{nntp-rlogin-program}---new variable to ease customization.
25651
25652 @item
25653 @code{C-u C-c C-c} in @code{gnus-article-edit-mode} will now inhibit
25654 re-highlighting of the article buffer.
25655
25656 @item
25657 New element in @code{gnus-boring-article-headers}---@code{long-to}.
25658
25659 @item
25660 @kbd{M-i} symbolic prefix command. @xref{Symbolic Prefixes}, for
25661 details.
25662
25663 @item
25664 @kbd{L} and @kbd{I} in the summary buffer now take the symbolic prefix
25665 @kbd{a} to add the score rule to the @file{all.SCORE} file.
25666
25667 @item
25668 @code{gnus-simplify-subject-functions} variable to allow greater
25669 control over simplification.
25670
25671 @item
25672 @kbd{A T}---new command for fetching the current thread.
25673
25674 @item
25675 @kbd{/ T}---new command for including the current thread in the
25676 limit.
25677
25678 @item
25679 @kbd{M-RET} is a new Message command for breaking cited text.
25680
25681 @item
25682 @samp{\\1}-expressions are now valid in @code{nnmail-split-methods}.
25683
25684 @item
25685 The @code{custom-face-lookup} function has been removed.
25686 If you used this function in your initialization files, you must
25687 rewrite them to use @code{face-spec-set} instead.
25688
25689 @item
25690 Canceling now uses the current select method. Symbolic prefix
25691 @kbd{a} forces normal posting method.
25692
25693 @item
25694 New command to translate M******** sm*rtq**t*s into proper
25695 text---@kbd{W d}.
25696
25697 @item
25698 For easier debugging of @code{nntp}, you can set
25699 @code{nntp-record-commands} to a non-@code{nil} value.
25700
25701 @item
25702 @code{nntp} now uses @file{~/.authinfo}, a @file{.netrc}-like file, for
25703 controlling where and how to send @sc{authinfo} to @acronym{NNTP} servers.
25704
25705 @item
25706 A command for editing group parameters from the summary buffer
25707 has been added.
25708
25709 @item
25710 A history of where mails have been split is available.
25711
25712 @item
25713 A new article date command has been added---@code{article-date-iso8601}.
25714
25715 @item
25716 Subjects can be simplified when threading by setting
25717 @code{gnus-score-thread-simplify}.
25718
25719 @item
25720 A new function for citing in Message has been
25721 added---@code{message-cite-original-without-signature}.
25722
25723 @item
25724 @code{article-strip-all-blank-lines}---new article command.
25725
25726 @item
25727 A new Message command to kill to the end of the article has
25728 been added.
25729
25730 @item
25731 A minimum adaptive score can be specified by using the
25732 @code{gnus-adaptive-word-minimum} variable.
25733
25734 @item
25735 The ``lapsed date'' article header can be kept continually
25736 updated by the @code{gnus-start-date-timer} command.
25737
25738 @item
25739 Web listserv archives can be read with the @code{nnlistserv} back end.
25740
25741 @item
25742 Old dejanews archives can now be read by @code{nnweb}.
25743
25744 @end itemize
25745
25746 @node Pterodactyl Gnus
25747 @subsubsection Pterodactyl Gnus
25748
25749 New features in Gnus 5.8:
25750
25751 @itemize @bullet
25752
25753 @item
25754 The mail-fetching functions have changed. See the manual for the
25755 many details. In particular, all procmail fetching variables are gone.
25756
25757 If you used procmail like in
25758
25759 @lisp
25760 (setq nnmail-use-procmail t)
25761 (setq nnmail-spool-file 'procmail)
25762 (setq nnmail-procmail-directory "~/mail/incoming/")
25763 (setq nnmail-procmail-suffix "\\.in")
25764 @end lisp
25765
25766 this now has changed to
25767
25768 @lisp
25769 (setq mail-sources
25770 '((directory :path "~/mail/incoming/"
25771 :suffix ".in")))
25772 @end lisp
25773
25774 @xref{Mail Source Specifiers}.
25775
25776 @item
25777 Gnus is now a @acronym{MIME}-capable reader. This affects many parts of
25778 Gnus, and adds a slew of new commands. See the manual for details.
25779
25780 @item
25781 Gnus has also been multilingualized. This also affects too
25782 many parts of Gnus to summarize here, and adds many new variables.
25783
25784 @item
25785 @code{gnus-auto-select-first} can now be a function to be
25786 called to position point.
25787
25788 @item
25789 The user can now decide which extra headers should be included in
25790 summary buffers and @acronym{NOV} files.
25791
25792 @item
25793 @code{gnus-article-display-hook} has been removed. Instead, a number
25794 of variables starting with @code{gnus-treat-} have been added.
25795
25796 @item
25797 The Gnus posting styles have been redone again and now works in a
25798 subtly different manner.
25799
25800 @item
25801 New web-based back ends have been added: @code{nnslashdot},
25802 @code{nnwarchive} and @code{nnultimate}. nnweb has been revamped,
25803 again, to keep up with ever-changing layouts.
25804
25805 @item
25806 Gnus can now read @acronym{IMAP} mail via @code{nnimap}.
25807
25808 @end itemize
25809
25810 @node Oort Gnus
25811 @subsubsection Oort Gnus
25812 @cindex Oort Gnus
25813
25814 New features in Gnus 5.10:
25815
25816 @itemize @bullet
25817
25818 @item
25819 @kbd{F} (@code{gnus-article-followup-with-original}) and @kbd{R}
25820 (@code{gnus-article-reply-with-original}) only yank the text in the
25821 region if the region is active.
25822
25823 @item
25824 @code{gnus-group-read-ephemeral-group} can be called interactively,
25825 using @kbd{G M}.
25826
25827 @item
25828 In draft groups, @kbd{e} is now bound to @code{gnus-draft-edit-message}.
25829 Use @kbd{B w} for @code{gnus-summary-edit-article} instead.
25830
25831 @item
25832 The revised Gnus @acronym{FAQ} is included in the manual,
25833 @xref{Frequently Asked Questions}.
25834
25835 @item
25836 Upgrading from previous (stable) version if you have used Oort.
25837
25838 If you have tried Oort (the unstable Gnus branch leading to this
25839 release) but went back to a stable version, be careful when upgrading to
25840 this version. In particular, you will probably want to remove all
25841 @file{.marks} (nnml) and @file{.mrk} (nnfolder) files, so that flags are
25842 read from your @file{.newsrc.eld} instead of from the
25843 @file{.marks}/@file{.mrk} file where this release store flags. See a
25844 later entry for more information about marks. Note that downgrading
25845 isn't save in general.
25846
25847 @item
25848 Article Buttons
25849
25850 More buttons for URLs, mail addresses, Message-IDs, Info links, man
25851 pages and Emacs or Gnus related references. @xref{Article Buttons}. The
25852 variables @code{gnus-button-@var{*}-level} can be used to control the
25853 appearance of all article buttons. @xref{Article Button Levels}.
25854
25855 @item
25856 Dired integration
25857
25858 @code{gnus-dired-minor-mode} (see @ref{Other modes}) installs key
25859 bindings in dired buffers to send a file as an attachment, open a file
25860 using the appropriate mailcap entry, and print a file using the mailcap
25861 entry.
25862
25863 @item
25864 Gnus can display RSS newsfeeds as a newsgroup. @xref{RSS}.
25865
25866 @item
25867 Single-part yenc encoded attachments can be decoded.
25868
25869 @item
25870 Picons
25871
25872 The picons code has been reimplemented to work in GNU Emacs---some of
25873 the previous options have been removed or renamed.
25874
25875 Picons are small ``personal icons'' representing users, domain and
25876 newsgroups, which can be displayed in the Article buffer.
25877 @xref{Picons}.
25878
25879 @item
25880 If the new option @code{gnus-treat-body-boundary} is non-@code{nil}, a
25881 boundary line is drawn at the end of the headers.
25882
25883 @item
25884 Retrieval of charters and control messages
25885
25886 There are new commands for fetching newsgroup charters (@kbd{H c}) and
25887 control messages (@kbd{H C}).
25888
25889 @item
25890 Delayed articles
25891
25892 You can delay the sending of a message with @kbd{C-c C-j} in the Message
25893 buffer. The messages are delivered at specified time. This is useful
25894 for sending yourself reminders. @xref{Delayed Articles}.
25895
25896 @item
25897 If @code{auto-compression-mode} is enabled, attachments are automatically
25898 decompressed when activated.
25899
25900 @item
25901 If the new option @code{nnml-use-compressed-files} is non-@code{nil},
25902 the nnml back end allows compressed message files.
25903
25904 @item
25905 Signed article headers (X-PGP-Sig) can be verified with @kbd{W p}.
25906
25907 @item
25908 The Summary Buffer uses an arrow in the fringe to indicate the current
25909 article. Use @code{(setq gnus-summary-display-arrow nil)} to disable it.
25910
25911 @item
25912 Warn about email replies to news
25913
25914 Do you often find yourself replying to news by email by mistake? Then
25915 the new option @code{gnus-confirm-mail-reply-to-news} is just the thing for
25916 you.
25917
25918 @item
25919 If the new option @code{gnus-summary-display-while-building} is
25920 non-@code{nil}, the summary buffer is shown and updated as it's being
25921 built.
25922
25923 @item
25924 The new @code{recent} mark @samp{.} indicates newly arrived messages (as
25925 opposed to old but unread messages).
25926
25927 @item
25928 The new option @code{gnus-gcc-mark-as-read} automatically marks
25929 Gcc articles as read.
25930
25931 @item
25932 The nndoc back end now supports mailman digests and exim bounces.
25933
25934 @item
25935 Gnus supports RFC 2369 mailing list headers, and adds a number of
25936 related commands in mailing list groups. @xref{Mailing List}.
25937
25938 @item
25939 The Date header can be displayed in a format that can be read aloud
25940 in English. @xref{Article Date}.
25941
25942 @item
25943 The envelope sender address can be customized when using Sendmail.
25944 @xref{Mail Variables, Mail Variables,, message, Message Manual}.
25945
25946 @item
25947 diffs are automatically highlighted in groups matching
25948 @code{mm-uu-diff-groups-regexp}
25949
25950 @item
25951 @acronym{TLS} wrapper shipped with Gnus
25952
25953 @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} is now supported in @acronym{IMAP} and
25954 @acronym{NNTP} via @file{tls.el} and GNUTLS. The old
25955 @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} support via (external third party)
25956 @file{ssl.el} and OpenSSL still works.
25957
25958 @item
25959 New @file{make.bat} for compiling and installing Gnus under MS Windows
25960
25961 Use @file{make.bat} if you want to install Gnus under MS Windows, the
25962 first argument to the batch-program should be the directory where
25963 @file{xemacs.exe} respectively @file{emacs.exe} is located, iff you want
25964 to install Gnus after compiling it, give @file{make.bat} @code{/copy} as
25965 the second parameter.
25966
25967 @file{make.bat} has been rewritten from scratch, it now features
25968 automatic recognition of XEmacs and GNU Emacs, generates
25969 @file{gnus-load.el}, checks if errors occur while compilation and
25970 generation of info files and reports them at the end of the build
25971 process. It now uses @code{makeinfo} if it is available and falls
25972 back to @file{infohack.el} otherwise. @file{make.bat} should now
25973 install all files which are necessary to run Gnus and be generally a
25974 complete replacement for the @code{configure; make; make install}
25975 cycle used under Unix systems.
25976
25977 The new @file{make.bat} makes @file{make-x.bat} superfluous, so it has
25978 been removed.
25979
25980 @item
25981 Support for non-@acronym{ASCII} domain names
25982
25983 Message supports non-@acronym{ASCII} domain names in From:, To: and
25984 Cc: and will query you whether to perform encoding when you try to
25985 send a message. The variable @code{message-use-idna} controls this.
25986 Gnus will also decode non-@acronym{ASCII} domain names in From:, To:
25987 and Cc: when you view a message. The variable @code{gnus-use-idna}
25988 controls this.
25989
25990 @item
25991 Better handling of Microsoft citation styles
25992
25993 Gnus now tries to recognize the mangled header block that some Microsoft
25994 mailers use to indicate that the rest of the message is a citation, even
25995 though it is not quoted in any way. The variable
25996 @code{gnus-cite-unsightly-citation-regexp} matches the start of these
25997 citations.
25998
25999 @item
26000 @code{gnus-article-skip-boring}
26001
26002 If you set @code{gnus-article-skip-boring} to @code{t}, then Gnus will
26003 not scroll down to show you a page that contains only boring text,
26004 which by default means cited text and signature. You can customize
26005 what is skippable using @code{gnus-article-boring-faces}.
26006
26007 This feature is especially useful if you read many articles that
26008 consist of a little new content at the top with a long, untrimmed
26009 message cited below.
26010
26011 @item
26012 The format spec @code{%C} for positioning point has changed to @code{%*}.
26013
26014 @item
26015 The new variable @code{gnus-parameters} can be used to set group parameters.
26016
26017 Earlier this was done only via @kbd{G p} (or @kbd{G c}), which stored
26018 the parameters in @file{~/.newsrc.eld}, but via this variable you can
26019 enjoy the powers of customize, and simplified backups since you set the
26020 variable in @file{~/.emacs} instead of @file{~/.newsrc.eld}. The
26021 variable maps regular expressions matching group names to group
26022 parameters, a'la:
26023 @lisp
26024 (setq gnus-parameters
26025 '(("mail\\..*"
26026 (gnus-show-threads nil)
26027 (gnus-use-scoring nil))
26028 ("^nnimap:\\(foo.bar\\)$"
26029 (to-group . "\\1"))))
26030 @end lisp
26031
26032 @item
26033 Smileys (@samp{:-)}, @samp{;-)} etc) are now iconized for Emacs too.
26034
26035 Put @code{(setq gnus-treat-display-smileys nil)} in @file{~/.emacs} to
26036 disable it.
26037
26038 @item
26039 Gnus no longer generate the Sender: header automatically.
26040
26041 Earlier it was generated iff the user configurable email address was
26042 different from the Gnus guessed default user address. As the guessing
26043 algorithm is rarely correct these days, and (more controversially) the
26044 only use of the Sender: header was to check if you are entitled to
26045 cancel/supersede news (which is now solved by Cancel Locks instead,
26046 see another entry), generation of the header has been disabled by
26047 default. See the variables @code{message-required-headers},
26048 @code{message-required-news-headers}, and
26049 @code{message-required-mail-headers}.
26050
26051 @item
26052 Features from third party @file{message-utils.el} added to @file{message.el}.
26053
26054 Message now asks if you wish to remove @samp{(was: <old subject>)} from
26055 subject lines (see @code{message-subject-trailing-was-query}). @kbd{C-c
26056 M-m} and @kbd{C-c M-f} inserts markers indicating included text.
26057 @kbd{C-c C-f a} adds a X-No-Archive: header. @kbd{C-c C-f x} inserts
26058 appropriate headers and a note in the body for cross-postings and
26059 followups (see the variables @code{message-cross-post-@var{*}}).
26060
26061 @item
26062 References and X-Draft-Headers are no longer generated when you start
26063 composing messages and @code{message-generate-headers-first} is
26064 @code{nil}.
26065
26066 @item
26067 Improved anti-spam features.
26068
26069 Gnus is now able to take out spam from your mail and news streams
26070 using a wide variety of programs and filter rules. Among the supported
26071 methods are RBL blocklists, bogofilter and white/blacklists. Hooks
26072 for easy use of external packages such as SpamAssassin and Hashcash
26073 are also new. @xref{Thwarting Email Spam}.
26074
26075 @item
26076 Easy inclusion of X-Faces headers.
26077
26078 @item
26079 Face headers handling.
26080
26081 @item
26082 In the summary buffer, the new command @kbd{/ N} inserts new messages
26083 and @kbd{/ o} inserts old messages.
26084
26085 @item
26086 Gnus decodes morse encoded messages if you press @kbd{W m}.
26087
26088 @item
26089 Unread count correct in nnimap groups.
26090
26091 The estimated number of unread articles in the group buffer should now
26092 be correct for nnimap groups. This is achieved by calling
26093 @code{nnimap-fixup-unread-after-getting-new-news} from the
26094 @code{gnus-setup-news-hook} (called on startup) and
26095 @code{gnus-after-getting-new-news-hook}. (called after getting new
26096 mail). If you have modified those variables from the default, you may
26097 want to add @code{nnimap-fixup-unread-after-getting-new-news} again. If
26098 you were happy with the estimate and want to save some (minimal) time
26099 when getting new mail, remove the function.
26100
26101 @item
26102 Group Carbon Copy (GCC) quoting
26103
26104 To support groups that contains SPC and other weird characters, groups
26105 are quoted before they are placed in the Gcc: header. This means
26106 variables such as @code{gnus-message-archive-group} should no longer
26107 contain quote characters to make groups containing SPC work. Also, if
26108 you are using the string @samp{nnml:foo, nnml:bar} (indicating Gcc
26109 into two groups) you must change it to return the list
26110 @code{("nnml:foo" "nnml:bar")}, otherwise the Gcc: line will be quoted
26111 incorrectly. Note that returning the string @samp{nnml:foo, nnml:bar}
26112 was incorrect earlier, it just didn't generate any problems since it
26113 was inserted directly.
26114
26115 @item
26116 @file{~/News/overview/} not used.
26117
26118 As a result of the following change, the @file{~/News/overview/}
26119 directory is not used any more. You can safely delete the entire
26120 hierarchy.
26121
26122 @item
26123 @code{gnus-agent}
26124
26125 The Gnus Agent has seen a major updated and is now enabled by default,
26126 and all nntp and nnimap servers from @code{gnus-select-method} and
26127 @code{gnus-secondary-select-method} are agentized by default. Earlier
26128 only the server in @code{gnus-select-method} was agentized by the
26129 default, and the agent was disabled by default. When the agent is
26130 enabled, headers are now also retrieved from the Agent cache instead
26131 of the back ends when possible. Earlier this only happened in the
26132 unplugged state. You can enroll or remove servers with @kbd{J a} and
26133 @kbd{J r} in the server buffer. Gnus will not download articles into
26134 the Agent cache, unless you instruct it to do so, though, by using
26135 @kbd{J u} or @kbd{J s} from the Group buffer. You revert to the old
26136 behavior of having the Agent disabled with @code{(setq gnus-agent
26137 nil)}. Note that putting @code{(gnus-agentize)} in @file{~/.gnus.el}
26138 is not needed any more.
26139
26140 @item
26141 @code{gnus-summary-line-format}
26142
26143 The default value changed to @samp{%U%R%z%I%(%[%4L: %-23,23f%]%)
26144 %s\n}. Moreover @code{gnus-extra-headers},
26145 @code{nnmail-extra-headers} and @code{gnus-ignored-from-addresses}
26146 changed their default so that the users name will be replaced by the
26147 recipient's name or the group name posting to for @acronym{NNTP}
26148 groups.
26149
26150 @item
26151 @file{deuglify.el} (@code{gnus-article-outlook-deuglify-article})
26152
26153 A new file from Raymond Scholz @email{rscholz@@zonix.de} for deuglifying
26154 broken Outlook (Express) articles.
26155
26156 @item
26157 @code{(require 'gnus-load)}
26158
26159 If you use a stand-alone Gnus distribution, you'd better add
26160 @code{(require 'gnus-load)} into your @file{~/.emacs} after adding the Gnus
26161 lisp directory into load-path.
26162
26163 File @file{gnus-load.el} contains autoload commands, functions and variables,
26164 some of which may not be included in distributions of Emacsen.
26165
26166 @item
26167 @code{gnus-slave-unplugged}
26168
26169 A new command which starts Gnus offline in slave mode.
26170
26171 @item
26172 @code{message-insinuate-rmail}
26173
26174 Adding @code{(message-insinuate-rmail)} and @code{(setq
26175 mail-user-agent 'gnus-user-agent)} in @file{.emacs} convinces Rmail to
26176 compose, reply and forward messages in message-mode, where you can
26177 enjoy the power of @acronym{MML}.
26178
26179 @item
26180 @code{message-minibuffer-local-map}
26181
26182 The line below enables BBDB in resending a message:
26183 @lisp
26184 (define-key message-minibuffer-local-map [(tab)]
26185 'bbdb-complete-name)
26186 @end lisp
26187
26188 @item
26189 Externalizing and deleting of attachments.
26190
26191 If @code{gnus-gcc-externalize-attachments} or
26192 @code{message-fcc-externalize-attachments} is non-@code{nil}, attach
26193 local files as external parts.
26194
26195 The command @code{gnus-mime-save-part-and-strip} (bound to @kbd{C-o}
26196 on @acronym{MIME} buttons) saves a part and replaces the part with an
26197 external one. @code{gnus-mime-delete-part} (bound to @kbd{d} on
26198 @acronym{MIME} buttons) removes a part. It works only on back ends
26199 that support editing.
26200
26201 @item
26202 @code{gnus-default-charset}
26203
26204 The default value is determined from the
26205 @code{current-language-environment} variable, instead of
26206 @code{iso-8859-1}. Also the @samp{.*} item in
26207 @code{gnus-group-charset-alist} is removed.
26208
26209 @item
26210 @code{gnus-posting-styles}
26211
26212 Add a new format of match like
26213 @lisp
26214 ((header "to" "larsi.*org")
26215 (Organization "Somewhere, Inc."))
26216 @end lisp
26217 The old format like the lines below is obsolete, but still accepted.
26218 @lisp
26219 (header "to" "larsi.*org"
26220 (Organization "Somewhere, Inc."))
26221 @end lisp
26222
26223 @item
26224 @code{message-ignored-news-headers} and @code{message-ignored-mail-headers}
26225
26226 @samp{X-Draft-From} and @samp{X-Gnus-Agent-Meta-Information} have been
26227 added into these two variables. If you customized those, perhaps you
26228 need add those two headers too.
26229
26230 @item
26231 Gnus reads the @acronym{NOV} and articles in the Agent if plugged.
26232
26233 If one reads an article while plugged, and the article already exists
26234 in the Agent, it won't get downloaded once more. @code{(setq
26235 gnus-agent-cache nil)} reverts to the old behavior.
26236
26237 @item
26238 Gnus supports the ``format=flowed'' (RFC 2646) parameter. On
26239 composing messages, it is enabled by @code{use-hard-newlines}.
26240 Decoding format=flowed was present but not documented in earlier
26241 versions.
26242
26243 @item
26244 Gnus supports the generation of RFC 2298 Disposition Notification requests.
26245
26246 This is invoked with the @kbd{C-c M-n} key binding from message mode.
26247
26248 @item
26249 Gnus supports Maildir groups.
26250
26251 Gnus includes a new back end @file{nnmaildir.el}. @xref{Maildir}.
26252
26253 @item
26254 Printing capabilities are enhanced.
26255
26256 Gnus supports Muttprint natively with @kbd{O P} from the Summary and
26257 Article buffers. Also, each individual @acronym{MIME} part can be
26258 printed using @kbd{p} on the @acronym{MIME} button.
26259
26260 @item
26261 Message supports the Importance: (RFC 2156) header.
26262
26263 In the message buffer, @kbd{C-c C-f C-i} or @kbd{C-c C-u} cycles through
26264 the valid values.
26265
26266 @item
26267 Gnus supports Cancel Locks in News.
26268
26269 This means a header @samp{Cancel-Lock} is inserted in news posting. It is
26270 used to determine if you wrote an article or not (for canceling and
26271 superseding). Gnus generates a random password string the first time
26272 you post a message, and saves it in your @file{~/.emacs} using the Custom
26273 system. While the variable is called @code{canlock-password}, it is not
26274 security sensitive data. Publishing your canlock string on the web
26275 will not allow anyone to be able to anything she could not already do.
26276 The behavior can be changed by customizing @code{message-insert-canlock}.
26277
26278 @item
26279 Gnus supports server-side mail filtering using Sieve.
26280
26281 Sieve rules can be added as Group Parameters for groups, and the
26282 complete Sieve script is generated using @kbd{D g} from the Group
26283 buffer, and then uploaded to the server using @kbd{C-c C-l} in the
26284 generated Sieve buffer. @xref{Sieve Commands}, and the new Sieve
26285 manual @ref{Top, , Top, sieve, Emacs Sieve}.
26286
26287 @item
26288 Extended format specs.
26289
26290 Format spec @samp{%&user-date;} is added into
26291 @code{gnus-summary-line-format-alist}. Also, user defined extended
26292 format specs are supported. The extended format specs look like
26293 @samp{%u&foo;}, which invokes function
26294 @code{gnus-user-format-function-@var{foo}}. Because @samp{&} is used as the
26295 escape character, old user defined format @samp{%u&} is no longer supported.
26296
26297 @item
26298 @kbd{/ *} (@code{gnus-summary-limit-include-cached}) is rewritten.
26299
26300 It was aliased to @kbd{Y c}
26301 (@code{gnus-summary-insert-cached-articles}). The new function filters
26302 out other articles.
26303
26304 @item Some limiting commands accept a @kbd{C-u} prefix to negate the match.
26305
26306 If @kbd{C-u} is used on subject, author or extra headers, i.e., @kbd{/
26307 s}, @kbd{/ a}, and @kbd{/ x}
26308 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-@{subject,author,extra@}}) respectively, the
26309 result will be to display all articles that do not match the expression.
26310
26311 @item
26312 Group names are treated as UTF-8 by default.
26313
26314 This is supposedly what USEFOR wanted to migrate to. See
26315 @code{gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist} and
26316 @code{gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist} for customization.
26317
26318 @item
26319 The nnml and nnfolder back ends store marks for each groups.
26320
26321 This makes it possible to take backup of nnml/nnfolder servers/groups
26322 separately of @file{~/.newsrc.eld}, while preserving marks. It also
26323 makes it possible to share articles and marks between users (without
26324 sharing the @file{~/.newsrc.eld} file) within e.g. a department. It
26325 works by storing the marks stored in @file{~/.newsrc.eld} in a per-group
26326 file @file{.marks} (for nnml) and @file{@var{groupname}.mrk} (for
26327 nnfolder, named @var{groupname}). If the nnml/nnfolder is moved to
26328 another machine, Gnus will automatically use the @file{.marks} or
26329 @file{.mrk} file instead of the information in @file{~/.newsrc.eld}.
26330 The new server variables @code{nnml-marks-is-evil} and
26331 @code{nnfolder-marks-is-evil} can be used to disable this feature.
26332
26333 @item
26334 The menu bar item (in Group and Summary buffer) named ``Misc'' has
26335 been renamed to ``Gnus''.
26336
26337 @item
26338 The menu bar item (in Message mode) named ``@acronym{MML}'' has been
26339 renamed to ``Attachments''. Note that this menu also contains security
26340 related stuff, like signing and encryption (@pxref{Security, Security,,
26341 message, Message Manual}).
26342
26343 @item
26344 @code{gnus-group-charset-alist} and
26345 @code{gnus-group-ignored-charsets-alist}.
26346
26347 The regexps in these variables are compared with full group names
26348 instead of real group names in 5.8. Users who customize these
26349 variables should change those regexps accordingly. For example:
26350 @lisp
26351 ("^han\\>" euc-kr) -> ("\\(^\\|:\\)han\\>" euc-kr)
26352 @end lisp
26353
26354 @item
26355 Gnus supports @acronym{PGP} (RFC 1991/2440), @acronym{PGP/MIME} (RFC
26356 2015/3156) and @acronym{S/MIME} (RFC 2630-2633).
26357
26358 It needs an external @acronym{S/MIME} and OpenPGP implementation, but no
26359 additional Lisp libraries. This add several menu items to the
26360 Attachments menu, and @kbd{C-c RET} key bindings, when composing
26361 messages. This also obsoletes @code{gnus-article-hide-pgp-hook}.
26362
26363 @item
26364 Gnus inlines external parts (message/external).
26365
26366 @item
26367 @acronym{MML} (Mime compose) prefix changed from @kbd{M-m} to @kbd{C-c
26368 C-m}.
26369
26370 This change was made to avoid conflict with the standard binding of
26371 @code{back-to-indentation}, which is also useful in message mode.
26372
26373 @item
26374 The default for @code{message-forward-show-mml} changed to symbol @code{best}.
26375
26376 The behavior for the @code{best} value is to show @acronym{MML} (i.e.,
26377 convert to @acronym{MIME}) when appropriate. @acronym{MML} will not be
26378 used when forwarding signed or encrypted messages, as the conversion
26379 invalidate the digital signature.
26380 @end itemize
26381
26382 @iftex
26383
26384 @page
26385 @node The Manual
26386 @section The Manual
26387 @cindex colophon
26388 @cindex manual
26389
26390 This manual was generated from a TeXinfo file and then run through
26391 either @code{texi2dvi}
26392 @iflatex
26393 or my own home-brewed TeXinfo to \LaTeX\ transformer,
26394 and then run through @code{latex} and @code{dvips}
26395 @end iflatex
26396 to get what you hold in your hands now.
26397
26398 The following conventions have been used:
26399
26400 @enumerate
26401
26402 @item
26403 This is a @samp{string}
26404
26405 @item
26406 This is a @kbd{keystroke}
26407
26408 @item
26409 This is a @file{file}
26410
26411 @item
26412 This is a @code{symbol}
26413
26414 @end enumerate
26415
26416 So if I were to say ``set @code{flargnoze} to @samp{yes}'', that would
26417 mean:
26418
26419 @lisp
26420 (setq flargnoze "yes")
26421 @end lisp
26422
26423 If I say ``set @code{flumphel} to @code{yes}'', that would mean:
26424
26425 @lisp
26426 (setq flumphel 'yes)
26427 @end lisp
26428
26429 @samp{yes} and @code{yes} are two @emph{very} different things---don't
26430 ever get them confused.
26431
26432 @iflatex
26433 @c @head
26434 Of course, everything in this manual is of vital interest, so you should
26435 read it all. Several times. However, if you feel like skimming the
26436 manual, look for that gnu head you should see in the margin over
26437 there---it means that what's being discussed is of more importance than
26438 the rest of the stuff. (On the other hand, if everything is infinitely
26439 important, how can anything be more important than that? Just one more
26440 of the mysteries of this world, I guess.)
26441 @end iflatex
26442
26443 @end iftex
26444
26445
26446 @node On Writing Manuals
26447 @section On Writing Manuals
26448
26449 I guess most manuals are written after-the-fact; documenting a program
26450 that's already there. This is not how this manual is written. When
26451 implementing something, I write the manual entry for that something
26452 straight away. I then see that it's difficult to explain the
26453 functionality, so I write how it's supposed to be, and then I change the
26454 implementation. Writing the documentation and writing the code goes
26455 hand in hand.
26456
26457 This, of course, means that this manual has no, or little, flow. It
26458 documents absolutely everything in Gnus, but often not where you're
26459 looking for it. It is a reference manual, and not a guide to how to get
26460 started with Gnus.
26461
26462 That would be a totally different book, that should be written using the
26463 reference manual as source material. It would look quite differently.
26464
26465
26466 @page
26467 @node Terminology
26468 @section Terminology
26469
26470 @cindex terminology
26471 @table @dfn
26472
26473 @item news
26474 @cindex news
26475 This is what you are supposed to use this thing for---reading news.
26476 News is generally fetched from a nearby @acronym{NNTP} server, and is
26477 generally publicly available to everybody. If you post news, the entire
26478 world is likely to read just what you have written, and they'll all
26479 snigger mischievously. Behind your back.
26480
26481 @item mail
26482 @cindex mail
26483 Everything that's delivered to you personally is mail. Some news/mail
26484 readers (like Gnus) blur the distinction between mail and news, but
26485 there is a difference. Mail is private. News is public. Mailing is
26486 not posting, and replying is not following up.
26487
26488 @item reply
26489 @cindex reply
26490 Send a mail to the person who has written what you are reading.
26491
26492 @item follow up
26493 @cindex follow up
26494 Post an article to the current newsgroup responding to the article you
26495 are reading.
26496
26497 @item back end
26498 @cindex back end
26499 Gnus considers mail and news to be mostly the same, really. The only
26500 difference is how to access the actual articles. News articles are
26501 commonly fetched via the protocol @acronym{NNTP}, whereas mail
26502 messages could be read from a file on the local disk. The internal
26503 architecture of Gnus thus comprises a ``front end'' and a number of
26504 ``back ends''. Internally, when you enter a group (by hitting
26505 @key{RET}, say), you thereby invoke a function in the front end in
26506 Gnus. The front end then ``talks'' to a back end and says things like
26507 ``Give me the list of articles in the foo group'' or ``Show me article
26508 number 4711''.
26509
26510 So a back end mainly defines either a protocol (the @code{nntp} back
26511 end accesses news via @acronym{NNTP}, the @code{nnimap} back end
26512 accesses mail via @acronym{IMAP}) or a file format and directory
26513 layout (the @code{nnspool} back end accesses news via the common
26514 ``spool directory'' format, the @code{nnml} back end access mail via a
26515 file format and directory layout that's quite similar).
26516
26517 Gnus does not handle the underlying media, so to speak---this is all
26518 done by the back ends. A back end is a collection of functions to
26519 access the articles.
26520
26521 However, sometimes the term ``back end'' is also used where ``server''
26522 would have been more appropriate. And then there is the term ``select
26523 method'' which can mean either. The Gnus terminology can be quite
26524 confusing.
26525
26526 @item native
26527 @cindex native
26528 Gnus will always use one method (and back end) as the @dfn{native}, or
26529 default, way of getting news.
26530
26531 @item foreign
26532 @cindex foreign
26533 You can also have any number of foreign groups active at the same time.
26534 These are groups that use non-native non-secondary back ends for getting
26535 news.
26536
26537 @item secondary
26538 @cindex secondary
26539 Secondary back ends are somewhere half-way between being native and being
26540 foreign, but they mostly act like they are native.
26541
26542 @item article
26543 @cindex article
26544 A message that has been posted as news.
26545
26546 @item mail message
26547 @cindex mail message
26548 A message that has been mailed.
26549
26550 @item message
26551 @cindex message
26552 A mail message or news article
26553
26554 @item head
26555 @cindex head
26556 The top part of a message, where administrative information (etc.) is
26557 put.
26558
26559 @item body
26560 @cindex body
26561 The rest of an article. Everything not in the head is in the
26562 body.
26563
26564 @item header
26565 @cindex header
26566 A line from the head of an article.
26567
26568 @item headers
26569 @cindex headers
26570 A collection of such lines, or a collection of heads. Or even a
26571 collection of @acronym{NOV} lines.
26572
26573 @item @acronym{NOV}
26574 @cindex @acronym{NOV}
26575 When Gnus enters a group, it asks the back end for the headers of all
26576 unread articles in the group. Most servers support the News OverView
26577 format, which is more compact and much faster to read and parse than the
26578 normal @sc{head} format.
26579
26580 @item level
26581 @cindex levels
26582 Each group is subscribed at some @dfn{level} or other (1-9). The ones
26583 that have a lower level are ``more'' subscribed than the groups with a
26584 higher level. In fact, groups on levels 1-5 are considered
26585 @dfn{subscribed}; 6-7 are @dfn{unsubscribed}; 8 are @dfn{zombies}; and 9
26586 are @dfn{killed}. Commands for listing groups and scanning for new
26587 articles will all use the numeric prefix as @dfn{working level}.
26588
26589 @item killed groups
26590 @cindex killed groups
26591 No information on killed groups is stored or updated, which makes killed
26592 groups much easier to handle than subscribed groups.
26593
26594 @item zombie groups
26595 @cindex zombie groups
26596 Just like killed groups, only slightly less dead.
26597
26598 @item active file
26599 @cindex active file
26600 The news server has to keep track of what articles it carries, and what
26601 groups exist. All this information in stored in the active file, which
26602 is rather large, as you might surmise.
26603
26604 @item bogus groups
26605 @cindex bogus groups
26606 A group that exists in the @file{.newsrc} file, but isn't known to the
26607 server (i.e., it isn't in the active file), is a @emph{bogus group}.
26608 This means that the group probably doesn't exist (any more).
26609
26610 @item activating
26611 @cindex activating groups
26612 The act of asking the server for info on a group and computing the
26613 number of unread articles is called @dfn{activating the group}.
26614 Un-activated groups are listed with @samp{*} in the group buffer.
26615
26616 @item spool
26617 @cindex spool
26618 News servers store their articles locally in one fashion or other.
26619 One old-fashioned storage method is to have just one file per
26620 article. That's called a ``traditional spool''.
26621
26622 @item server
26623 @cindex server
26624 A machine one can connect to and get news (or mail) from.
26625
26626 @item select method
26627 @cindex select method
26628 A structure that specifies the back end, the server and the virtual
26629 server settings.
26630
26631 @item virtual server
26632 @cindex virtual server
26633 A named select method. Since a select method defines all there is to
26634 know about connecting to a (physical) server, taking the thing as a
26635 whole is a virtual server.
26636
26637 @item washing
26638 @cindex washing
26639 Taking a buffer and running it through a filter of some sort. The
26640 result will (more often than not) be cleaner and more pleasing than the
26641 original.
26642
26643 @item ephemeral groups
26644 @cindex ephemeral groups
26645 @cindex temporary groups
26646 Most groups store data on what articles you have read. @dfn{Ephemeral}
26647 groups are groups that will have no data stored---when you exit the
26648 group, it'll disappear into the aether.
26649
26650 @item solid groups
26651 @cindex solid groups
26652 This is the opposite of ephemeral groups. All groups listed in the
26653 group buffer are solid groups.
26654
26655 @item sparse articles
26656 @cindex sparse articles
26657 These are article placeholders shown in the summary buffer when
26658 @code{gnus-build-sparse-threads} has been switched on.
26659
26660 @item threading
26661 @cindex threading
26662 To put responses to articles directly after the articles they respond
26663 to---in a hierarchical fashion.
26664
26665 @item root
26666 @cindex root
26667 @cindex thread root
26668 The first article in a thread is the root. It is the ancestor of all
26669 articles in the thread.
26670
26671 @item parent
26672 @cindex parent
26673 An article that has responses.
26674
26675 @item child
26676 @cindex child
26677 An article that responds to a different article---its parent.
26678
26679 @item digest
26680 @cindex digest
26681 A collection of messages in one file. The most common digest format is
26682 specified by RFC 1153.
26683
26684 @item splitting
26685 @cindex splitting, terminolgy
26686 @cindex mail sorting
26687 @cindex mail filtering (splitting)
26688 The action of sorting your emails according to certain rules. Sometimes
26689 incorrectly called mail filtering.
26690
26691 @end table
26692
26693
26694 @page
26695 @node Customization
26696 @section Customization
26697 @cindex general customization
26698
26699 All variables are properly documented elsewhere in this manual. This
26700 section is designed to give general pointers on how to customize Gnus
26701 for some quite common situations.
26702
26703 @menu
26704 * Slow/Expensive Connection:: You run a local Emacs and get the news elsewhere.
26705 * Slow Terminal Connection:: You run a remote Emacs.
26706 * Little Disk Space:: You feel that having large setup files is icky.
26707 * Slow Machine:: You feel like buying a faster machine.
26708 @end menu
26709
26710
26711 @node Slow/Expensive Connection
26712 @subsection Slow/Expensive NNTP Connection
26713
26714 If you run Emacs on a machine locally, and get your news from a machine
26715 over some very thin strings, you want to cut down on the amount of data
26716 Gnus has to get from the @acronym{NNTP} server.
26717
26718 @table @code
26719
26720 @item gnus-read-active-file
26721 Set this to @code{nil}, which will inhibit Gnus from requesting the
26722 entire active file from the server. This file is often very large. You
26723 also have to set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} and
26724 @code{gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups} to @code{nil} to make sure that Gnus
26725 doesn't suddenly decide to fetch the active file anyway.
26726
26727 @item gnus-nov-is-evil
26728 This one has to be @code{nil}. If not, grabbing article headers from
26729 the @acronym{NNTP} server will not be very fast. Not all @acronym{NNTP} servers
26730 support @sc{xover}; Gnus will detect this by itself.
26731 @end table
26732
26733
26734 @node Slow Terminal Connection
26735 @subsection Slow Terminal Connection
26736
26737 Let's say you use your home computer for dialing up the system that runs
26738 Emacs and Gnus. If your modem is slow, you want to reduce (as much as
26739 possible) the amount of data sent over the wires.
26740
26741 @table @code
26742
26743 @item gnus-auto-center-summary
26744 Set this to @code{nil} to inhibit Gnus from re-centering the summary
26745 buffer all the time. If it is @code{vertical}, do only vertical
26746 re-centering. If it is neither @code{nil} nor @code{vertical}, do both
26747 horizontal and vertical recentering.
26748
26749 @item gnus-visible-headers
26750 Cut down on the headers included in the articles to the
26751 minimum. You can, in fact, make do without them altogether---most of the
26752 useful data is in the summary buffer, anyway. Set this variable to
26753 @samp{^NEVVVVER} or @samp{From:}, or whatever you feel you need.
26754
26755 Set this hook to all the available hiding commands:
26756 @lisp
26757 (setq gnus-treat-hide-headers 'head
26758 gnus-treat-hide-signature t
26759 gnus-treat-hide-citation t)
26760 @end lisp
26761
26762 @item gnus-use-full-window
26763 By setting this to @code{nil}, you can make all the windows smaller.
26764 While this doesn't really cut down much generally, it means that you
26765 have to see smaller portions of articles before deciding that you didn't
26766 want to read them anyway.
26767
26768 @item gnus-thread-hide-subtree
26769 If this is non-@code{nil}, all threads in the summary buffer will be
26770 hidden initially.
26771
26772
26773 @item gnus-updated-mode-lines
26774 If this is @code{nil}, Gnus will not put information in the buffer mode
26775 lines, which might save some time.
26776 @end table
26777
26778
26779 @node Little Disk Space
26780 @subsection Little Disk Space
26781 @cindex disk space
26782
26783 The startup files can get rather large, so you may want to cut their
26784 sizes a bit if you are running out of space.
26785
26786 @table @code
26787
26788 @item gnus-save-newsrc-file
26789 If this is @code{nil}, Gnus will never save @file{.newsrc}---it will
26790 only save @file{.newsrc.eld}. This means that you will not be able to
26791 use any other newsreaders than Gnus. This variable is @code{t} by
26792 default.
26793
26794 @item gnus-read-newsrc-file
26795 If this is @code{nil}, Gnus will never read @file{.newsrc}---it will
26796 only read @file{.newsrc.eld}. This means that you will not be able to
26797 use any other newsreaders than Gnus. This variable is @code{t} by
26798 default.
26799
26800 @item gnus-save-killed-list
26801 If this is @code{nil}, Gnus will not save the list of dead groups. You
26802 should also set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} to @code{ask-server}
26803 and @code{gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups} to @code{nil} if you set this
26804 variable to @code{nil}. This variable is @code{t} by default.
26805
26806 @end table
26807
26808
26809 @node Slow Machine
26810 @subsection Slow Machine
26811 @cindex slow machine
26812
26813 If you have a slow machine, or are just really impatient, there are a
26814 few things you can do to make Gnus run faster.
26815
26816 Set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} and
26817 @code{gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups} to @code{nil} to make startup faster.
26818
26819 Set @code{gnus-show-threads}, @code{gnus-use-cross-reference} and
26820 @code{gnus-nov-is-evil} to @code{nil} to make entering and exiting the
26821 summary buffer faster.
26822
26823
26824 @page
26825 @node Troubleshooting
26826 @section Troubleshooting
26827 @cindex troubleshooting
26828
26829 Gnus works @emph{so} well straight out of the box---I can't imagine any
26830 problems, really.
26831
26832 Ahem.
26833
26834 @enumerate
26835
26836 @item
26837 Make sure your computer is switched on.
26838
26839 @item
26840 Make sure that you really load the current Gnus version. If you have
26841 been running @sc{gnus}, you need to exit Emacs and start it up again before
26842 Gnus will work.
26843
26844 @item
26845 Try doing an @kbd{M-x gnus-version}. If you get something that looks
26846 like @samp{Gnus v5.10.6} you have the right files loaded. Otherwise
26847 you have some old @file{.el} files lying around. Delete these.
26848
26849 @item
26850 Read the help group (@kbd{G h} in the group buffer) for a
26851 @acronym{FAQ} and a how-to.
26852
26853 @item
26854 @vindex max-lisp-eval-depth
26855 Gnus works on many recursive structures, and in some extreme (and very
26856 rare) cases Gnus may recurse down ``too deeply'' and Emacs will beep at
26857 you. If this happens to you, set @code{max-lisp-eval-depth} to 500 or
26858 something like that.
26859 @end enumerate
26860
26861 If all else fails, report the problem as a bug.
26862
26863 @cindex bugs
26864 @cindex reporting bugs
26865
26866 @kindex M-x gnus-bug
26867 @findex gnus-bug
26868 If you find a bug in Gnus, you can report it with the @kbd{M-x gnus-bug}
26869 command. @kbd{M-x set-variable RET debug-on-error RET t RET}, and send
26870 me the backtrace. I will fix bugs, but I can only fix them if you send
26871 me a precise description as to how to reproduce the bug.
26872
26873 You really can never be too detailed in a bug report. Always use the
26874 @kbd{M-x gnus-bug} command when you make bug reports, even if it creates
26875 a 10Kb mail each time you use it, and even if you have sent me your
26876 environment 500 times before. I don't care. I want the full info each
26877 time.
26878
26879 It is also important to remember that I have no memory whatsoever. If
26880 you send a bug report, and I send you a reply, and then you just send
26881 back ``No, it's not! Moron!'', I will have no idea what you are
26882 insulting me about. Always over-explain everything. It's much easier
26883 for all of us---if I don't have all the information I need, I will just
26884 mail you and ask for more info, and everything takes more time.
26885
26886 If the problem you're seeing is very visual, and you can't quite explain
26887 it, copy the Emacs window to a file (with @code{xwd}, for instance), put
26888 it somewhere it can be reached, and include the URL of the picture in
26889 the bug report.
26890
26891 @cindex patches
26892 If you would like to contribute a patch to fix bugs or make
26893 improvements, please produce the patch using @samp{diff -u}.
26894
26895 @cindex edebug
26896 If you want to debug your problem further before reporting, possibly
26897 in order to solve the problem yourself and send a patch, you can use
26898 edebug. Debugging Lisp code is documented in the Elisp manual
26899 (@pxref{Debugging, , Debugging Lisp Programs, elisp, The GNU Emacs
26900 Lisp Reference Manual}). To get you started with edebug, consider if
26901 you discover some weird behavior when pressing @kbd{c}, the first
26902 step is to do @kbd{C-h k c} and click on the hyperlink (Emacs only) in
26903 the documentation buffer that leads you to the function definition,
26904 then press @kbd{M-x edebug-defun RET} with point inside that function,
26905 return to Gnus and press @kbd{c} to invoke the code. You will be
26906 placed in the lisp buffer and can single step using @kbd{SPC} and
26907 evaluate expressions using @kbd{M-:} or inspect variables using
26908 @kbd{C-h v}, abort execution with @kbd{q}, and resume execution with
26909 @kbd{c} or @kbd{g}.
26910
26911 @cindex elp
26912 @cindex profile
26913 @cindex slow
26914 Sometimes, a problem do not directly generate an elisp error but
26915 manifests itself by causing Gnus to be very slow. In these cases, you
26916 can use @kbd{M-x toggle-debug-on-quit} and press @kbd{C-g} when things are
26917 slow, and then try to analyze the backtrace (repeating the procedure
26918 helps isolating the real problem areas).
26919
26920 A fancier approach is to use the elisp profiler, ELP. The profiler is
26921 (or should be) fully documented elsewhere, but to get you started
26922 there are a few steps that need to be followed. First, instrument the
26923 part of Gnus you are interested in for profiling, e.g. @kbd{M-x
26924 elp-instrument-package RET gnus} or @kbd{M-x elp-instrument-package
26925 RET message}. Then perform the operation that is slow and press
26926 @kbd{M-x elp-results}. You will then see which operations that takes
26927 time, and can debug them further. If the entire operation takes much
26928 longer than the time spent in the slowest function in the profiler
26929 output, you probably profiled the wrong part of Gnus. To reset
26930 profiling statistics, use @kbd{M-x elp-reset-all}. @kbd{M-x
26931 elp-restore-all} is supposed to remove profiling, but given the
26932 complexities and dynamic code generation in Gnus, it might not always
26933 work perfectly.
26934
26935 @cindex gnu.emacs.gnus
26936 @cindex ding mailing list
26937 If you just need help, you are better off asking on
26938 @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus}. I'm not very helpful. You can also ask on
26939 @email{ding@@gnus.org, the ding mailing list}. Write to
26940 @email{ding-request@@gnus.org} to subscribe.
26941
26942
26943 @page
26944 @node Gnus Reference Guide
26945 @section Gnus Reference Guide
26946
26947 It is my hope that other people will figure out smart stuff that Gnus
26948 can do, and that other people will write those smart things as well. To
26949 facilitate that I thought it would be a good idea to describe the inner
26950 workings of Gnus. And some of the not-so-inner workings, while I'm at
26951 it.
26952
26953 You can never expect the internals of a program not to change, but I
26954 will be defining (in some details) the interface between Gnus and its
26955 back ends (this is written in stone), the format of the score files
26956 (ditto), data structures (some are less likely to change than others)
26957 and general methods of operation.
26958
26959 @menu
26960 * Gnus Utility Functions:: Common functions and variable to use.
26961 * Back End Interface:: How Gnus communicates with the servers.
26962 * Score File Syntax:: A BNF definition of the score file standard.
26963 * Headers:: How Gnus stores headers internally.
26964 * Ranges:: A handy format for storing mucho numbers.
26965 * Group Info:: The group info format.
26966 * Extended Interactive:: Symbolic prefixes and stuff.
26967 * Emacs/XEmacs Code:: Gnus can be run under all modern Emacsen.
26968 * Various File Formats:: Formats of files that Gnus use.
26969 @end menu
26970
26971
26972 @node Gnus Utility Functions
26973 @subsection Gnus Utility Functions
26974 @cindex Gnus utility functions
26975 @cindex utility functions
26976 @cindex functions
26977 @cindex internal variables
26978
26979 When writing small functions to be run from hooks (and stuff), it's
26980 vital to have access to the Gnus internal functions and variables.
26981 Below is a list of the most common ones.
26982
26983 @table @code
26984
26985 @item gnus-newsgroup-name
26986 @vindex gnus-newsgroup-name
26987 This variable holds the name of the current newsgroup.
26988
26989 @item gnus-find-method-for-group
26990 @findex gnus-find-method-for-group
26991 A function that returns the select method for @var{group}.
26992
26993 @item gnus-group-real-name
26994 @findex gnus-group-real-name
26995 Takes a full (prefixed) Gnus group name, and returns the unprefixed
26996 name.
26997
26998 @item gnus-group-prefixed-name
26999 @findex gnus-group-prefixed-name
27000 Takes an unprefixed group name and a select method, and returns the full
27001 (prefixed) Gnus group name.
27002
27003 @item gnus-get-info
27004 @findex gnus-get-info
27005 Returns the group info list for @var{group}.
27006
27007 @item gnus-group-unread
27008 @findex gnus-group-unread
27009 The number of unread articles in @var{group}, or @code{t} if that is
27010 unknown.
27011
27012 @item gnus-active
27013 @findex gnus-active
27014 The active entry for @var{group}.
27015
27016 @item gnus-set-active
27017 @findex gnus-set-active
27018 Set the active entry for @var{group}.
27019
27020 @item gnus-add-current-to-buffer-list
27021 @findex gnus-add-current-to-buffer-list
27022 Adds the current buffer to the list of buffers to be killed on Gnus
27023 exit.
27024
27025 @item gnus-continuum-version
27026 @findex gnus-continuum-version
27027 Takes a Gnus version string as a parameter and returns a floating point
27028 number. Earlier versions will always get a lower number than later
27029 versions.
27030
27031 @item gnus-group-read-only-p
27032 @findex gnus-group-read-only-p
27033 Says whether @var{group} is read-only or not.
27034
27035 @item gnus-news-group-p
27036 @findex gnus-news-group-p
27037 Says whether @var{group} came from a news back end.
27038
27039 @item gnus-ephemeral-group-p
27040 @findex gnus-ephemeral-group-p
27041 Says whether @var{group} is ephemeral or not.
27042
27043 @item gnus-server-to-method
27044 @findex gnus-server-to-method
27045 Returns the select method corresponding to @var{server}.
27046
27047 @item gnus-server-equal
27048 @findex gnus-server-equal
27049 Says whether two virtual servers are equal.
27050
27051 @item gnus-group-native-p
27052 @findex gnus-group-native-p
27053 Says whether @var{group} is native or not.
27054
27055 @item gnus-group-secondary-p
27056 @findex gnus-group-secondary-p
27057 Says whether @var{group} is secondary or not.
27058
27059 @item gnus-group-foreign-p
27060 @findex gnus-group-foreign-p
27061 Says whether @var{group} is foreign or not.
27062
27063 @item gnus-group-find-parameter
27064 @findex gnus-group-find-parameter
27065 Returns the parameter list of @var{group}. If given a second parameter,
27066 returns the value of that parameter for @var{group}.
27067
27068 @item gnus-group-set-parameter
27069 @findex gnus-group-set-parameter
27070 Takes three parameters; @var{group}, @var{parameter} and @var{value}.
27071
27072 @item gnus-narrow-to-body
27073 @findex gnus-narrow-to-body
27074 Narrows the current buffer to the body of the article.
27075
27076 @item gnus-check-backend-function
27077 @findex gnus-check-backend-function
27078 Takes two parameters, @var{function} and @var{group}. If the back end
27079 @var{group} comes from supports @var{function}, return non-@code{nil}.
27080
27081 @lisp
27082 (gnus-check-backend-function "request-scan" "nnml:misc")
27083 @result{} t
27084 @end lisp
27085
27086 @item gnus-read-method
27087 @findex gnus-read-method
27088 Prompts the user for a select method.
27089
27090 @end table
27091
27092
27093 @node Back End Interface
27094 @subsection Back End Interface
27095
27096 Gnus doesn't know anything about @acronym{NNTP}, spools, mail or virtual
27097 groups. It only knows how to talk to @dfn{virtual servers}. A virtual
27098 server is a @dfn{back end} and some @dfn{back end variables}. As examples
27099 of the first, we have @code{nntp}, @code{nnspool} and @code{nnmbox}. As
27100 examples of the latter we have @code{nntp-port-number} and
27101 @code{nnmbox-directory}.
27102
27103 When Gnus asks for information from a back end---say @code{nntp}---on
27104 something, it will normally include a virtual server name in the
27105 function parameters. (If not, the back end should use the ``current''
27106 virtual server.) For instance, @code{nntp-request-list} takes a virtual
27107 server as its only (optional) parameter. If this virtual server hasn't
27108 been opened, the function should fail.
27109
27110 Note that a virtual server name has no relation to some physical server
27111 name. Take this example:
27112
27113 @lisp
27114 (nntp "odd-one"
27115 (nntp-address "ifi.uio.no")
27116 (nntp-port-number 4324))
27117 @end lisp
27118
27119 Here the virtual server name is @samp{odd-one} while the name of
27120 the physical server is @samp{ifi.uio.no}.
27121
27122 The back ends should be able to switch between several virtual servers.
27123 The standard back ends implement this by keeping an alist of virtual
27124 server environments that they pull down/push up when needed.
27125
27126 There are two groups of interface functions: @dfn{required functions},
27127 which must be present, and @dfn{optional functions}, which Gnus will
27128 always check for presence before attempting to call 'em.
27129
27130 All these functions are expected to return data in the buffer
27131 @code{nntp-server-buffer} (@samp{ *nntpd*}), which is somewhat
27132 unfortunately named, but we'll have to live with it. When I talk about
27133 @dfn{resulting data}, I always refer to the data in that buffer. When I
27134 talk about @dfn{return value}, I talk about the function value returned by
27135 the function call. Functions that fail should return @code{nil} as the
27136 return value.
27137
27138 Some back ends could be said to be @dfn{server-forming} back ends, and
27139 some might be said not to be. The latter are back ends that generally
27140 only operate on one group at a time, and have no concept of ``server''
27141 ---they have a group, and they deliver info on that group and nothing
27142 more.
27143
27144 Gnus identifies each message by way of group name and article number. A
27145 few remarks about these article numbers might be useful. First of all,
27146 the numbers are positive integers. Secondly, it is normally not
27147 possible for later articles to ``re-use'' older article numbers without
27148 confusing Gnus. That is, if a group has ever contained a message
27149 numbered 42, then no other message may get that number, or Gnus will get
27150 mightily confused.@footnote{See the function
27151 @code{nnchoke-request-update-info}, @ref{Optional Back End Functions}.}
27152 Third, article numbers must be assigned in order of arrival in the
27153 group; this is not necessarily the same as the date of the message.
27154
27155 The previous paragraph already mentions all the ``hard'' restrictions that
27156 article numbers must fulfill. But it seems that it might be useful to
27157 assign @emph{consecutive} article numbers, for Gnus gets quite confused
27158 if there are holes in the article numbering sequence. However, due to
27159 the ``no-reuse'' restriction, holes cannot be avoided altogether. It's
27160 also useful for the article numbers to start at 1 to avoid running out
27161 of numbers as long as possible.
27162
27163 Note that by convention, back ends are named @code{nnsomething}, but
27164 Gnus also comes with some @code{nnnotbackends}, such as
27165 @file{nnheader.el}, @file{nnmail.el} and @file{nnoo.el}.
27166
27167 In the examples and definitions I will refer to the imaginary back end
27168 @code{nnchoke}.
27169
27170 @cindex @code{nnchoke}
27171
27172 @menu
27173 * Required Back End Functions:: Functions that must be implemented.
27174 * Optional Back End Functions:: Functions that need not be implemented.
27175 * Error Messaging:: How to get messages and report errors.
27176 * Writing New Back Ends:: Extending old back ends.
27177 * Hooking New Back Ends Into Gnus:: What has to be done on the Gnus end.
27178 * Mail-like Back Ends:: Some tips on mail back ends.
27179 @end menu
27180
27181
27182 @node Required Back End Functions
27183 @subsubsection Required Back End Functions
27184
27185 @table @code
27186
27187 @item (nnchoke-retrieve-headers ARTICLES &optional GROUP SERVER FETCH-OLD)
27188
27189 @var{articles} is either a range of article numbers or a list of
27190 @code{Message-ID}s. Current back ends do not fully support either---only
27191 sequences (lists) of article numbers, and most back ends do not support
27192 retrieval of @code{Message-ID}s. But they should try for both.
27193
27194 The result data should either be HEADs or @acronym{NOV} lines, and the result
27195 value should either be @code{headers} or @code{nov} to reflect this.
27196 This might later be expanded to @code{various}, which will be a mixture
27197 of HEADs and @acronym{NOV} lines, but this is currently not supported by Gnus.
27198
27199 If @var{fetch-old} is non-@code{nil} it says to try fetching ``extra
27200 headers'', in some meaning of the word. This is generally done by
27201 fetching (at most) @var{fetch-old} extra headers less than the smallest
27202 article number in @code{articles}, and filling the gaps as well. The
27203 presence of this parameter can be ignored if the back end finds it
27204 cumbersome to follow the request. If this is non-@code{nil} and not a
27205 number, do maximum fetches.
27206
27207 Here's an example HEAD:
27208
27209 @example
27210 221 1056 Article retrieved.
27211 Path: ifi.uio.no!sturles
27212 From: sturles@@ifi.uio.no (Sturle Sunde)
27213 Newsgroups: ifi.discussion
27214 Subject: Re: Something very droll
27215 Date: 27 Oct 1994 14:02:57 +0100
27216 Organization: Dept. of Informatics, University of Oslo, Norway
27217 Lines: 26
27218 Message-ID: <38o8e1$a0o@@holmenkollen.ifi.uio.no>
27219 References: <38jdmq$4qu@@visbur.ifi.uio.no>
27220 NNTP-Posting-Host: holmenkollen.ifi.uio.no
27221 .
27222 @end example
27223
27224 So a @code{headers} return value would imply that there's a number of
27225 these in the data buffer.
27226
27227 Here's a BNF definition of such a buffer:
27228
27229 @example
27230 headers = *head
27231 head = error / valid-head
27232 error-message = [ "4" / "5" ] 2number " " <error message> eol
27233 valid-head = valid-message *header "." eol
27234 valid-message = "221 " <number> " Article retrieved." eol
27235 header = <text> eol
27236 @end example
27237
27238 @cindex BNF
27239 (The version of BNF used here is the one used in RFC822.)
27240
27241 If the return value is @code{nov}, the data buffer should contain
27242 @dfn{network overview database} lines. These are basically fields
27243 separated by tabs.
27244
27245 @example
27246 nov-buffer = *nov-line
27247 nov-line = field 7*8[ <TAB> field ] eol
27248 field = <text except TAB>
27249 @end example
27250
27251 For a closer look at what should be in those fields,
27252 @pxref{Headers}.
27253
27254
27255 @item (nnchoke-open-server SERVER &optional DEFINITIONS)
27256
27257 @var{server} is here the virtual server name. @var{definitions} is a
27258 list of @code{(VARIABLE VALUE)} pairs that define this virtual server.
27259
27260 If the server can't be opened, no error should be signaled. The back end
27261 may then choose to refuse further attempts at connecting to this
27262 server. In fact, it should do so.
27263
27264 If the server is opened already, this function should return a
27265 non-@code{nil} value. There should be no data returned.
27266
27267
27268 @item (nnchoke-close-server &optional SERVER)
27269
27270 Close connection to @var{server} and free all resources connected
27271 to it. Return @code{nil} if the server couldn't be closed for some
27272 reason.
27273
27274 There should be no data returned.
27275
27276
27277 @item (nnchoke-request-close)
27278
27279 Close connection to all servers and free all resources that the back end
27280 have reserved. All buffers that have been created by that back end
27281 should be killed. (Not the @code{nntp-server-buffer}, though.) This
27282 function is generally only called when Gnus is shutting down.
27283
27284 There should be no data returned.
27285
27286
27287 @item (nnchoke-server-opened &optional SERVER)
27288
27289 If @var{server} is the current virtual server, and the connection to the
27290 physical server is alive, then this function should return a
27291 non-@code{nil} value. This function should under no circumstances
27292 attempt to reconnect to a server we have lost connection to.
27293
27294 There should be no data returned.
27295
27296
27297 @item (nnchoke-status-message &optional SERVER)
27298
27299 This function should return the last error message from @var{server}.
27300
27301 There should be no data returned.
27302
27303
27304 @item (nnchoke-request-article ARTICLE &optional GROUP SERVER TO-BUFFER)
27305
27306 The result data from this function should be the article specified by
27307 @var{article}. This might either be a @code{Message-ID} or a number.
27308 It is optional whether to implement retrieval by @code{Message-ID}, but
27309 it would be nice if that were possible.
27310
27311 If @var{to-buffer} is non-@code{nil}, the result data should be returned
27312 in this buffer instead of the normal data buffer. This is to make it
27313 possible to avoid copying large amounts of data from one buffer to
27314 another, while Gnus mainly requests articles to be inserted directly
27315 into its article buffer.
27316
27317 If it is at all possible, this function should return a cons cell where
27318 the @code{car} is the group name the article was fetched from, and the @code{cdr} is
27319 the article number. This will enable Gnus to find out what the real
27320 group and article numbers are when fetching articles by
27321 @code{Message-ID}. If this isn't possible, @code{t} should be returned
27322 on successful article retrieval.
27323
27324
27325 @item (nnchoke-request-group GROUP &optional SERVER FAST)
27326
27327 Get data on @var{group}. This function also has the side effect of
27328 making @var{group} the current group.
27329
27330 If @var{fast}, don't bother to return useful data, just make @var{group}
27331 the current group.
27332
27333 Here's an example of some result data and a definition of the same:
27334
27335 @example
27336 211 56 1000 1059 ifi.discussion
27337 @end example
27338
27339 The first number is the status, which should be 211. Next is the
27340 total number of articles in the group, the lowest article number, the
27341 highest article number, and finally the group name. Note that the total
27342 number of articles may be less than one might think while just
27343 considering the highest and lowest article numbers, but some articles
27344 may have been canceled. Gnus just discards the total-number, so
27345 whether one should take the bother to generate it properly (if that is a
27346 problem) is left as an exercise to the reader. If the group contains no
27347 articles, the lowest article number should be reported as 1 and the
27348 highest as 0.
27349
27350 @example
27351 group-status = [ error / info ] eol
27352 error = [ "4" / "5" ] 2<number> " " <Error message>
27353 info = "211 " 3* [ <number> " " ] <string>
27354 @end example
27355
27356
27357 @item (nnchoke-close-group GROUP &optional SERVER)
27358
27359 Close @var{group} and free any resources connected to it. This will be
27360 a no-op on most back ends.
27361
27362 There should be no data returned.
27363
27364
27365 @item (nnchoke-request-list &optional SERVER)
27366
27367 Return a list of all groups available on @var{server}. And that means
27368 @emph{all}.
27369
27370 Here's an example from a server that only carries two groups:
27371
27372 @example
27373 ifi.test 0000002200 0000002000 y
27374 ifi.discussion 3324 3300 n
27375 @end example
27376
27377 On each line we have a group name, then the highest article number in
27378 that group, the lowest article number, and finally a flag. If the group
27379 contains no articles, the lowest article number should be reported as 1
27380 and the highest as 0.
27381
27382 @example
27383 active-file = *active-line
27384 active-line = name " " <number> " " <number> " " flags eol
27385 name = <string>
27386 flags = "n" / "y" / "m" / "x" / "j" / "=" name
27387 @end example
27388
27389 The flag says whether the group is read-only (@samp{n}), is moderated
27390 (@samp{m}), is dead (@samp{x}), is aliased to some other group
27391 (@samp{=other-group}) or none of the above (@samp{y}).
27392
27393
27394 @item (nnchoke-request-post &optional SERVER)
27395
27396 This function should post the current buffer. It might return whether
27397 the posting was successful or not, but that's not required. If, for
27398 instance, the posting is done asynchronously, it has generally not been
27399 completed by the time this function concludes. In that case, this
27400 function should set up some kind of sentinel to beep the user loud and
27401 clear if the posting could not be completed.
27402
27403 There should be no result data from this function.
27404
27405 @end table
27406
27407
27408 @node Optional Back End Functions
27409 @subsubsection Optional Back End Functions
27410
27411 @table @code
27412
27413 @item (nnchoke-retrieve-groups GROUPS &optional SERVER)
27414
27415 @var{groups} is a list of groups, and this function should request data
27416 on all those groups. How it does it is of no concern to Gnus, but it
27417 should attempt to do this in a speedy fashion.
27418
27419 The return value of this function can be either @code{active} or
27420 @code{group}, which says what the format of the result data is. The
27421 former is in the same format as the data from
27422 @code{nnchoke-request-list}, while the latter is a buffer full of lines
27423 in the same format as @code{nnchoke-request-group} gives.
27424
27425 @example
27426 group-buffer = *active-line / *group-status
27427 @end example
27428
27429
27430 @item (nnchoke-request-update-info GROUP INFO &optional SERVER)
27431
27432 A Gnus group info (@pxref{Group Info}) is handed to the back end for
27433 alterations. This comes in handy if the back end really carries all
27434 the information (as is the case with virtual and imap groups). This
27435 function should destructively alter the info to suit its needs, and
27436 should return a non-@code{nil} value.
27437
27438 There should be no result data from this function.
27439
27440
27441 @item (nnchoke-request-type GROUP &optional ARTICLE)
27442
27443 When the user issues commands for ``sending news'' (@kbd{F} in the
27444 summary buffer, for instance), Gnus has to know whether the article the
27445 user is following up on is news or mail. This function should return
27446 @code{news} if @var{article} in @var{group} is news, @code{mail} if it
27447 is mail and @code{unknown} if the type can't be decided. (The
27448 @var{article} parameter is necessary in @code{nnvirtual} groups which
27449 might very well combine mail groups and news groups.) Both @var{group}
27450 and @var{article} may be @code{nil}.
27451
27452 There should be no result data from this function.
27453
27454
27455 @item (nnchoke-request-set-mark GROUP ACTION &optional SERVER)
27456
27457 Set/remove/add marks on articles. Normally Gnus handles the article
27458 marks (such as read, ticked, expired etc) internally, and store them in
27459 @file{~/.newsrc.eld}. Some back ends (such as @acronym{IMAP}) however carry
27460 all information about the articles on the server, so Gnus need to
27461 propagate the mark information to the server.
27462
27463 @var{action} is a list of mark setting requests, having this format:
27464
27465 @example
27466 (RANGE ACTION MARK)
27467 @end example
27468
27469 @var{range} is a range of articles you wish to update marks on.
27470 @var{action} is @code{add} or @code{del}, used to add marks or remove
27471 marks (preserving all marks not mentioned). @var{mark} is a list of
27472 marks; where each mark is a symbol. Currently used marks are
27473 @code{read}, @code{tick}, @code{reply}, @code{expire}, @code{killed},
27474 @code{dormant}, @code{save}, @code{download}, @code{unsend},
27475 @code{forward} and @code{recent}, but your back end should, if
27476 possible, not limit itself to these.
27477
27478 Given contradictory actions, the last action in the list should be the
27479 effective one. That is, if your action contains a request to add the
27480 @code{tick} mark on article 1 and, later in the list, a request to
27481 remove the mark on the same article, the mark should in fact be removed.
27482
27483 An example action list:
27484
27485 @example
27486 (((5 12 30) 'del '(tick))
27487 ((10 . 90) 'add '(read expire))
27488 ((92 94) 'del '(read)))
27489 @end example
27490
27491 The function should return a range of articles it wasn't able to set the
27492 mark on (currently not used for anything).
27493
27494 There should be no result data from this function.
27495
27496 @item (nnchoke-request-update-mark GROUP ARTICLE MARK)
27497
27498 If the user tries to set a mark that the back end doesn't like, this
27499 function may change the mark. Gnus will use whatever this function
27500 returns as the mark for @var{article} instead of the original
27501 @var{mark}. If the back end doesn't care, it must return the original
27502 @var{mark}, and not @code{nil} or any other type of garbage.
27503
27504 The only use for this I can see is what @code{nnvirtual} does with
27505 it---if a component group is auto-expirable, marking an article as read
27506 in the virtual group should result in the article being marked as
27507 expirable.
27508
27509 There should be no result data from this function.
27510
27511
27512 @item (nnchoke-request-scan &optional GROUP SERVER)
27513
27514 This function may be called at any time (by Gnus or anything else) to
27515 request that the back end check for incoming articles, in one way or
27516 another. A mail back end will typically read the spool file or query
27517 the @acronym{POP} server when this function is invoked. The
27518 @var{group} doesn't have to be heeded---if the back end decides that
27519 it is too much work just scanning for a single group, it may do a
27520 total scan of all groups. It would be nice, however, to keep things
27521 local if that's practical.
27522
27523 There should be no result data from this function.
27524
27525
27526 @item (nnchoke-request-group-description GROUP &optional SERVER)
27527
27528 The result data from this function should be a description of
27529 @var{group}.
27530
27531 @example
27532 description-line = name <TAB> description eol
27533 name = <string>
27534 description = <text>
27535 @end example
27536
27537 @item (nnchoke-request-list-newsgroups &optional SERVER)
27538
27539 The result data from this function should be the description of all
27540 groups available on the server.
27541
27542 @example
27543 description-buffer = *description-line
27544 @end example
27545
27546
27547 @item (nnchoke-request-newgroups DATE &optional SERVER)
27548
27549 The result data from this function should be all groups that were
27550 created after @samp{date}, which is in normal human-readable date format
27551 (i.e., the date format used in mail and news headers, and returned by
27552 the function @code{message-make-date} by default). The data should be
27553 in the active buffer format.
27554
27555 It is okay for this function to return ``too many'' groups; some back ends
27556 might find it cheaper to return the full list of groups, rather than
27557 just the new groups. But don't do this for back ends with many groups.
27558 Normally, if the user creates the groups herself, there won't be too
27559 many groups, so @code{nnml} and the like are probably safe. But for
27560 back ends like @code{nntp}, where the groups have been created by the
27561 server, it is quite likely that there can be many groups.
27562
27563
27564 @item (nnchoke-request-create-group GROUP &optional SERVER)
27565
27566 This function should create an empty group with name @var{group}.
27567
27568 There should be no return data.
27569
27570
27571 @item (nnchoke-request-expire-articles ARTICLES &optional GROUP SERVER FORCE)
27572
27573 This function should run the expiry process on all articles in the
27574 @var{articles} range (which is currently a simple list of article
27575 numbers.) It is left up to the back end to decide how old articles
27576 should be before they are removed by this function. If @var{force} is
27577 non-@code{nil}, all @var{articles} should be deleted, no matter how new
27578 they are.
27579
27580 This function should return a list of articles that it did not/was not
27581 able to delete.
27582
27583 There should be no result data returned.
27584
27585
27586 @item (nnchoke-request-move-article ARTICLE GROUP SERVER ACCEPT-FORM &optional LAST)
27587
27588 This function should move @var{article} (which is a number) from
27589 @var{group} by calling @var{accept-form}.
27590
27591 This function should ready the article in question for moving by
27592 removing any header lines it has added to the article, and generally
27593 should ``tidy up'' the article. Then it should @code{eval}
27594 @var{accept-form} in the buffer where the ``tidy'' article is. This
27595 will do the actual copying. If this @code{eval} returns a
27596 non-@code{nil} value, the article should be removed.
27597
27598 If @var{last} is @code{nil}, that means that there is a high likelihood
27599 that there will be more requests issued shortly, so that allows some
27600 optimizations.
27601
27602 The function should return a cons where the @code{car} is the group name and
27603 the @code{cdr} is the article number that the article was entered as.
27604
27605 There should be no data returned.
27606
27607
27608 @item (nnchoke-request-accept-article GROUP &optional SERVER LAST)
27609
27610 This function takes the current buffer and inserts it into @var{group}.
27611 If @var{last} in @code{nil}, that means that there will be more calls to
27612 this function in short order.
27613
27614 The function should return a cons where the @code{car} is the group name and
27615 the @code{cdr} is the article number that the article was entered as.
27616
27617 The group should exist before the back end is asked to accept the
27618 article for that group.
27619
27620 There should be no data returned.
27621
27622
27623 @item (nnchoke-request-replace-article ARTICLE GROUP BUFFER)
27624
27625 This function should remove @var{article} (which is a number) from
27626 @var{group} and insert @var{buffer} there instead.
27627
27628 There should be no data returned.
27629
27630
27631 @item (nnchoke-request-delete-group GROUP FORCE &optional SERVER)
27632
27633 This function should delete @var{group}. If @var{force}, it should
27634 really delete all the articles in the group, and then delete the group
27635 itself. (If there is such a thing as ``the group itself''.)
27636
27637 There should be no data returned.
27638
27639
27640 @item (nnchoke-request-rename-group GROUP NEW-NAME &optional SERVER)
27641
27642 This function should rename @var{group} into @var{new-name}. All
27643 articles in @var{group} should move to @var{new-name}.
27644
27645 There should be no data returned.
27646
27647 @end table
27648
27649
27650 @node Error Messaging
27651 @subsubsection Error Messaging
27652
27653 @findex nnheader-report
27654 @findex nnheader-get-report
27655 The back ends should use the function @code{nnheader-report} to report
27656 error conditions---they should not raise errors when they aren't able to
27657 perform a request. The first argument to this function is the back end
27658 symbol, and the rest are interpreted as arguments to @code{format} if
27659 there are multiple of them, or just a string if there is one of them.
27660 This function must always returns @code{nil}.
27661
27662 @lisp
27663 (nnheader-report 'nnchoke "You did something totally bogus")
27664
27665 (nnheader-report 'nnchoke "Could not request group %s" group)
27666 @end lisp
27667
27668 Gnus, in turn, will call @code{nnheader-get-report} when it gets a
27669 @code{nil} back from a server, and this function returns the most
27670 recently reported message for the back end in question. This function
27671 takes one argument---the server symbol.
27672
27673 Internally, these functions access @var{back-end}@code{-status-string},
27674 so the @code{nnchoke} back end will have its error message stored in
27675 @code{nnchoke-status-string}.
27676
27677
27678 @node Writing New Back Ends
27679 @subsubsection Writing New Back Ends
27680
27681 Many back ends are quite similar. @code{nnml} is just like
27682 @code{nnspool}, but it allows you to edit the articles on the server.
27683 @code{nnmh} is just like @code{nnml}, but it doesn't use an active file,
27684 and it doesn't maintain overview databases. @code{nndir} is just like
27685 @code{nnml}, but it has no concept of ``groups'', and it doesn't allow
27686 editing articles.
27687
27688 It would make sense if it were possible to ``inherit'' functions from
27689 back ends when writing new back ends. And, indeed, you can do that if you
27690 want to. (You don't have to if you don't want to, of course.)
27691
27692 All the back ends declare their public variables and functions by using a
27693 package called @code{nnoo}.
27694
27695 To inherit functions from other back ends (and allow other back ends to
27696 inherit functions from the current back end), you should use the
27697 following macros:
27698
27699 @table @code
27700
27701 @item nnoo-declare
27702 This macro declares the first parameter to be a child of the subsequent
27703 parameters. For instance:
27704
27705 @lisp
27706 (nnoo-declare nndir
27707 nnml nnmh)
27708 @end lisp
27709
27710 @code{nndir} has declared here that it intends to inherit functions from
27711 both @code{nnml} and @code{nnmh}.
27712
27713 @item defvoo
27714 This macro is equivalent to @code{defvar}, but registers the variable as
27715 a public server variable. Most state-oriented variables should be
27716 declared with @code{defvoo} instead of @code{defvar}.
27717
27718 In addition to the normal @code{defvar} parameters, it takes a list of
27719 variables in the parent back ends to map the variable to when executing
27720 a function in those back ends.
27721
27722 @lisp
27723 (defvoo nndir-directory nil
27724 "Where nndir will look for groups."
27725 nnml-current-directory nnmh-current-directory)
27726 @end lisp
27727
27728 This means that @code{nnml-current-directory} will be set to
27729 @code{nndir-directory} when an @code{nnml} function is called on behalf
27730 of @code{nndir}. (The same with @code{nnmh}.)
27731
27732 @item nnoo-define-basics
27733 This macro defines some common functions that almost all back ends should
27734 have.
27735
27736 @lisp
27737 (nnoo-define-basics nndir)
27738 @end lisp
27739
27740 @item deffoo
27741 This macro is just like @code{defun} and takes the same parameters. In
27742 addition to doing the normal @code{defun} things, it registers the
27743 function as being public so that other back ends can inherit it.
27744
27745 @item nnoo-map-functions
27746 This macro allows mapping of functions from the current back end to
27747 functions from the parent back ends.
27748
27749 @lisp
27750 (nnoo-map-functions nndir
27751 (nnml-retrieve-headers 0 nndir-current-group 0 0)
27752 (nnmh-request-article 0 nndir-current-group 0 0))
27753 @end lisp
27754
27755 This means that when @code{nndir-retrieve-headers} is called, the first,
27756 third, and fourth parameters will be passed on to
27757 @code{nnml-retrieve-headers}, while the second parameter is set to the
27758 value of @code{nndir-current-group}.
27759
27760 @item nnoo-import
27761 This macro allows importing functions from back ends. It should be the
27762 last thing in the source file, since it will only define functions that
27763 haven't already been defined.
27764
27765 @lisp
27766 (nnoo-import nndir
27767 (nnmh
27768 nnmh-request-list
27769 nnmh-request-newgroups)
27770 (nnml))
27771 @end lisp
27772
27773 This means that calls to @code{nndir-request-list} should just be passed
27774 on to @code{nnmh-request-list}, while all public functions from
27775 @code{nnml} that haven't been defined in @code{nndir} yet should be
27776 defined now.
27777
27778 @end table
27779
27780 Below is a slightly shortened version of the @code{nndir} back end.
27781
27782 @lisp
27783 ;;; @r{nndir.el --- single directory newsgroup access for Gnus}
27784 ;; @r{Copyright (C) 1995,96 Free Software Foundation, Inc.}
27785
27786 ;;; @r{Code:}
27787
27788 (require 'nnheader)
27789 (require 'nnmh)
27790 (require 'nnml)
27791 (require 'nnoo)
27792 (eval-when-compile (require 'cl))
27793
27794 (nnoo-declare nndir
27795 nnml nnmh)
27796
27797 (defvoo nndir-directory nil
27798 "Where nndir will look for groups."
27799 nnml-current-directory nnmh-current-directory)
27800
27801 (defvoo nndir-nov-is-evil nil
27802 "*Non-nil means that nndir will never retrieve NOV headers."
27803 nnml-nov-is-evil)
27804
27805 (defvoo nndir-current-group ""
27806 nil
27807 nnml-current-group nnmh-current-group)
27808 (defvoo nndir-top-directory nil nil nnml-directory nnmh-directory)
27809 (defvoo nndir-get-new-mail nil nil nnml-get-new-mail nnmh-get-new-mail)
27810
27811 (defvoo nndir-status-string "" nil nnmh-status-string)
27812 (defconst nndir-version "nndir 1.0")
27813
27814 ;;; @r{Interface functions.}
27815
27816 (nnoo-define-basics nndir)
27817
27818 (deffoo nndir-open-server (server &optional defs)
27819 (setq nndir-directory
27820 (or (cadr (assq 'nndir-directory defs))
27821 server))
27822 (unless (assq 'nndir-directory defs)
27823 (push `(nndir-directory ,server) defs))
27824 (push `(nndir-current-group
27825 ,(file-name-nondirectory
27826 (directory-file-name nndir-directory)))
27827 defs)
27828 (push `(nndir-top-directory
27829 ,(file-name-directory (directory-file-name nndir-directory)))
27830 defs)
27831 (nnoo-change-server 'nndir server defs))
27832
27833 (nnoo-map-functions nndir
27834 (nnml-retrieve-headers 0 nndir-current-group 0 0)
27835 (nnmh-request-article 0 nndir-current-group 0 0)
27836 (nnmh-request-group nndir-current-group 0 0)
27837 (nnmh-close-group nndir-current-group 0))
27838
27839 (nnoo-import nndir
27840 (nnmh
27841 nnmh-status-message
27842 nnmh-request-list
27843 nnmh-request-newgroups))
27844
27845 (provide 'nndir)
27846 @end lisp
27847
27848
27849 @node Hooking New Back Ends Into Gnus
27850 @subsubsection Hooking New Back Ends Into Gnus
27851
27852 @vindex gnus-valid-select-methods
27853 @findex gnus-declare-backend
27854 Having Gnus start using your new back end is rather easy---you just
27855 declare it with the @code{gnus-declare-backend} functions. This will
27856 enter the back end into the @code{gnus-valid-select-methods} variable.
27857
27858 @code{gnus-declare-backend} takes two parameters---the back end name and
27859 an arbitrary number of @dfn{abilities}.
27860
27861 Here's an example:
27862
27863 @lisp
27864 (gnus-declare-backend "nnchoke" 'mail 'respool 'address)
27865 @end lisp
27866
27867 The above line would then go in the @file{nnchoke.el} file.
27868
27869 The abilities can be:
27870
27871 @table @code
27872 @item mail
27873 This is a mailish back end---followups should (probably) go via mail.
27874 @item post
27875 This is a newsish back end---followups should (probably) go via news.
27876 @item post-mail
27877 This back end supports both mail and news.
27878 @item none
27879 This is neither a post nor mail back end---it's something completely
27880 different.
27881 @item respool
27882 It supports respooling---or rather, it is able to modify its source
27883 articles and groups.
27884 @item address
27885 The name of the server should be in the virtual server name. This is
27886 true for almost all back ends.
27887 @item prompt-address
27888 The user should be prompted for an address when doing commands like
27889 @kbd{B} in the group buffer. This is true for back ends like
27890 @code{nntp}, but not @code{nnmbox}, for instance.
27891 @end table
27892
27893
27894 @node Mail-like Back Ends
27895 @subsubsection Mail-like Back Ends
27896
27897 One of the things that separate the mail back ends from the rest of the
27898 back ends is the heavy dependence by most of the mail back ends on
27899 common functions in @file{nnmail.el}. For instance, here's the
27900 definition of @code{nnml-request-scan}:
27901
27902 @lisp
27903 (deffoo nnml-request-scan (&optional group server)
27904 (setq nnml-article-file-alist nil)
27905 (nnmail-get-new-mail 'nnml 'nnml-save-nov nnml-directory group))
27906 @end lisp
27907
27908 It simply calls @code{nnmail-get-new-mail} with a few parameters,
27909 and @code{nnmail} takes care of all the moving and splitting of the
27910 mail.
27911
27912 This function takes four parameters.
27913
27914 @table @var
27915 @item method
27916 This should be a symbol to designate which back end is responsible for
27917 the call.
27918
27919 @item exit-function
27920 This function should be called after the splitting has been performed.
27921
27922 @item temp-directory
27923 Where the temporary files should be stored.
27924
27925 @item group
27926 This optional argument should be a group name if the splitting is to be
27927 performed for one group only.
27928 @end table
27929
27930 @code{nnmail-get-new-mail} will call @var{back-end}@code{-save-mail} to
27931 save each article. @var{back-end}@code{-active-number} will be called to
27932 find the article number assigned to this article.
27933
27934 The function also uses the following variables:
27935 @var{back-end}@code{-get-new-mail} (to see whether to get new mail for
27936 this back end); and @var{back-end}@code{-group-alist} and
27937 @var{back-end}@code{-active-file} to generate the new active file.
27938 @var{back-end}@code{-group-alist} should be a group-active alist, like
27939 this:
27940
27941 @example
27942 (("a-group" (1 . 10))
27943 ("some-group" (34 . 39)))
27944 @end example
27945
27946
27947 @node Score File Syntax
27948 @subsection Score File Syntax
27949
27950 Score files are meant to be easily parseable, but yet extremely
27951 mallable. It was decided that something that had the same read syntax
27952 as an Emacs Lisp list would fit that spec.
27953
27954 Here's a typical score file:
27955
27956 @lisp
27957 (("summary"
27958 ("win95" -10000 nil s)
27959 ("Gnus"))
27960 ("from"
27961 ("Lars" -1000))
27962 (mark -100))
27963 @end lisp
27964
27965 BNF definition of a score file:
27966
27967 @example
27968 score-file = "" / "(" *element ")"
27969 element = rule / atom
27970 rule = string-rule / number-rule / date-rule
27971 string-rule = "(" quote string-header quote space *string-match ")"
27972 number-rule = "(" quote number-header quote space *number-match ")"
27973 date-rule = "(" quote date-header quote space *date-match ")"
27974 quote = <ascii 34>
27975 string-header = "subject" / "from" / "references" / "message-id" /
27976 "xref" / "body" / "head" / "all" / "followup"
27977 number-header = "lines" / "chars"
27978 date-header = "date"
27979 string-match = "(" quote <string> quote [ "" / [ space score [ "" /
27980 space date [ "" / [ space string-match-t ] ] ] ] ] ")"
27981 score = "nil" / <integer>
27982 date = "nil" / <natural number>
27983 string-match-t = "nil" / "s" / "substring" / "S" / "Substring" /
27984 "r" / "regex" / "R" / "Regex" /
27985 "e" / "exact" / "E" / "Exact" /
27986 "f" / "fuzzy" / "F" / "Fuzzy"
27987 number-match = "(" <integer> [ "" / [ space score [ "" /
27988 space date [ "" / [ space number-match-t ] ] ] ] ] ")"
27989 number-match-t = "nil" / "=" / "<" / ">" / ">=" / "<="
27990 date-match = "(" quote <string> quote [ "" / [ space score [ "" /
27991 space date [ "" / [ space date-match-t ] ] ] ] ")"
27992 date-match-t = "nil" / "at" / "before" / "after"
27993 atom = "(" [ required-atom / optional-atom ] ")"
27994 required-atom = mark / expunge / mark-and-expunge / files /
27995 exclude-files / read-only / touched
27996 optional-atom = adapt / local / eval
27997 mark = "mark" space nil-or-number
27998 nil-or-number = "nil" / <integer>
27999 expunge = "expunge" space nil-or-number
28000 mark-and-expunge = "mark-and-expunge" space nil-or-number
28001 files = "files" *[ space <string> ]
28002 exclude-files = "exclude-files" *[ space <string> ]
28003 read-only = "read-only" [ space "nil" / space "t" ]
28004 adapt = "adapt" [ space "ignore" / space "t" / space adapt-rule ]
28005 adapt-rule = "(" *[ <string> *[ "(" <string> <integer> ")" ] ")"
28006 local = "local" *[ space "(" <string> space <form> ")" ]
28007 eval = "eval" space <form>
28008 space = *[ " " / <TAB> / <NEWLINE> ]
28009 @end example
28010
28011 Any unrecognized elements in a score file should be ignored, but not
28012 discarded.
28013
28014 As you can see, white space is needed, but the type and amount of white
28015 space is irrelevant. This means that formatting of the score file is
28016 left up to the programmer---if it's simpler to just spew it all out on
28017 one looong line, then that's ok.
28018
28019 The meaning of the various atoms are explained elsewhere in this
28020 manual (@pxref{Score File Format}).
28021
28022
28023 @node Headers
28024 @subsection Headers
28025
28026 Internally Gnus uses a format for storing article headers that
28027 corresponds to the @acronym{NOV} format in a mysterious fashion. One could
28028 almost suspect that the author looked at the @acronym{NOV} specification and
28029 just shamelessly @emph{stole} the entire thing, and one would be right.
28030
28031 @dfn{Header} is a severely overloaded term. ``Header'' is used in
28032 RFC 1036 to talk about lines in the head of an article (e.g.,
28033 @code{From}). It is used by many people as a synonym for
28034 ``head''---``the header and the body''. (That should be avoided, in my
28035 opinion.) And Gnus uses a format internally that it calls ``header'',
28036 which is what I'm talking about here. This is a 9-element vector,
28037 basically, with each header (ouch) having one slot.
28038
28039 These slots are, in order: @code{number}, @code{subject}, @code{from},
28040 @code{date}, @code{id}, @code{references}, @code{chars}, @code{lines},
28041 @code{xref}, and @code{extra}. There are macros for accessing and
28042 setting these slots---they all have predictable names beginning with
28043 @code{mail-header-} and @code{mail-header-set-}, respectively.
28044
28045 All these slots contain strings, except the @code{extra} slot, which
28046 contains an alist of header/value pairs (@pxref{To From Newsgroups}).
28047
28048
28049 @node Ranges
28050 @subsection Ranges
28051
28052 @sc{gnus} introduced a concept that I found so useful that I've started
28053 using it a lot and have elaborated on it greatly.
28054
28055 The question is simple: If you have a large amount of objects that are
28056 identified by numbers (say, articles, to take a @emph{wild} example)
28057 that you want to qualify as being ``included'', a normal sequence isn't
28058 very useful. (A 200,000 length sequence is a bit long-winded.)
28059
28060 The solution is as simple as the question: You just collapse the
28061 sequence.
28062
28063 @example
28064 (1 2 3 4 5 6 10 11 12)
28065 @end example
28066
28067 is transformed into
28068
28069 @example
28070 ((1 . 6) (10 . 12))
28071 @end example
28072
28073 To avoid having those nasty @samp{(13 . 13)} elements to denote a
28074 lonesome object, a @samp{13} is a valid element:
28075
28076 @example
28077 ((1 . 6) 7 (10 . 12))
28078 @end example
28079
28080 This means that comparing two ranges to find out whether they are equal
28081 is slightly tricky:
28082
28083 @example
28084 ((1 . 5) 7 8 (10 . 12))
28085 @end example
28086
28087 and
28088
28089 @example
28090 ((1 . 5) (7 . 8) (10 . 12))
28091 @end example
28092
28093 are equal. In fact, any non-descending list is a range:
28094
28095 @example
28096 (1 2 3 4 5)
28097 @end example
28098
28099 is a perfectly valid range, although a pretty long-winded one. This is
28100 also valid:
28101
28102 @example
28103 (1 . 5)
28104 @end example
28105
28106 and is equal to the previous range.
28107
28108 Here's a BNF definition of ranges. Of course, one must remember the
28109 semantic requirement that the numbers are non-descending. (Any number
28110 of repetition of the same number is allowed, but apt to disappear in
28111 range handling.)
28112
28113 @example
28114 range = simple-range / normal-range
28115 simple-range = "(" number " . " number ")"
28116 normal-range = "(" start-contents ")"
28117 contents = "" / simple-range *[ " " contents ] /
28118 number *[ " " contents ]
28119 @end example
28120
28121 Gnus currently uses ranges to keep track of read articles and article
28122 marks. I plan on implementing a number of range operators in C if The
28123 Powers That Be are willing to let me. (I haven't asked yet, because I
28124 need to do some more thinking on what operators I need to make life
28125 totally range-based without ever having to convert back to normal
28126 sequences.)
28127
28128
28129 @node Group Info
28130 @subsection Group Info
28131
28132 Gnus stores all permanent info on groups in a @dfn{group info} list.
28133 This list is from three to six elements (or more) long and exhaustively
28134 describes the group.
28135
28136 Here are two example group infos; one is a very simple group while the
28137 second is a more complex one:
28138
28139 @example
28140 ("no.group" 5 ((1 . 54324)))
28141
28142 ("nnml:my.mail" 3 ((1 . 5) 9 (20 . 55))
28143 ((tick (15 . 19)) (replied 3 6 (19 . 3)))
28144 (nnml "")
28145 ((auto-expire . t) (to-address . "ding@@gnus.org")))
28146 @end example
28147
28148 The first element is the @dfn{group name}---as Gnus knows the group,
28149 anyway. The second element is the @dfn{subscription level}, which
28150 normally is a small integer. (It can also be the @dfn{rank}, which is a
28151 cons cell where the @code{car} is the level and the @code{cdr} is the
28152 score.) The third element is a list of ranges of read articles. The
28153 fourth element is a list of lists of article marks of various kinds.
28154 The fifth element is the select method (or virtual server, if you like).
28155 The sixth element is a list of @dfn{group parameters}, which is what
28156 this section is about.
28157
28158 Any of the last three elements may be missing if they are not required.
28159 In fact, the vast majority of groups will normally only have the first
28160 three elements, which saves quite a lot of cons cells.
28161
28162 Here's a BNF definition of the group info format:
28163
28164 @example
28165 info = "(" group space ralevel space read
28166 [ "" / [ space marks-list [ "" / [ space method [ "" /
28167 space parameters ] ] ] ] ] ")"
28168 group = quote <string> quote
28169 ralevel = rank / level
28170 level = <integer in the range of 1 to inf>
28171 rank = "(" level "." score ")"
28172 score = <integer in the range of 1 to inf>
28173 read = range
28174 marks-lists = nil / "(" *marks ")"
28175 marks = "(" <string> range ")"
28176 method = "(" <string> *elisp-forms ")"
28177 parameters = "(" *elisp-forms ")"
28178 @end example
28179
28180 Actually that @samp{marks} rule is a fib. A @samp{marks} is a
28181 @samp{<string>} consed on to a @samp{range}, but that's a bitch to say
28182 in pseudo-BNF.
28183
28184 If you have a Gnus info and want to access the elements, Gnus offers a
28185 series of macros for getting/setting these elements.
28186
28187 @table @code
28188 @item gnus-info-group
28189 @itemx gnus-info-set-group
28190 @findex gnus-info-group
28191 @findex gnus-info-set-group
28192 Get/set the group name.
28193
28194 @item gnus-info-rank
28195 @itemx gnus-info-set-rank
28196 @findex gnus-info-rank
28197 @findex gnus-info-set-rank
28198 Get/set the group rank (@pxref{Group Score}).
28199
28200 @item gnus-info-level
28201 @itemx gnus-info-set-level
28202 @findex gnus-info-level
28203 @findex gnus-info-set-level
28204 Get/set the group level.
28205
28206 @item gnus-info-score
28207 @itemx gnus-info-set-score
28208 @findex gnus-info-score
28209 @findex gnus-info-set-score
28210 Get/set the group score (@pxref{Group Score}).
28211
28212 @item gnus-info-read
28213 @itemx gnus-info-set-read
28214 @findex gnus-info-read
28215 @findex gnus-info-set-read
28216 Get/set the ranges of read articles.
28217
28218 @item gnus-info-marks
28219 @itemx gnus-info-set-marks
28220 @findex gnus-info-marks
28221 @findex gnus-info-set-marks
28222 Get/set the lists of ranges of marked articles.
28223
28224 @item gnus-info-method
28225 @itemx gnus-info-set-method
28226 @findex gnus-info-method
28227 @findex gnus-info-set-method
28228 Get/set the group select method.
28229
28230 @item gnus-info-params
28231 @itemx gnus-info-set-params
28232 @findex gnus-info-params
28233 @findex gnus-info-set-params
28234 Get/set the group parameters.
28235 @end table
28236
28237 All the getter functions take one parameter---the info list. The setter
28238 functions take two parameters---the info list and the new value.
28239
28240 The last three elements in the group info aren't mandatory, so it may be
28241 necessary to extend the group info before setting the element. If this
28242 is necessary, you can just pass on a non-@code{nil} third parameter to
28243 the three final setter functions to have this happen automatically.
28244
28245
28246 @node Extended Interactive
28247 @subsection Extended Interactive
28248 @cindex interactive
28249 @findex gnus-interactive
28250
28251 Gnus extends the standard Emacs @code{interactive} specification
28252 slightly to allow easy use of the symbolic prefix (@pxref{Symbolic
28253 Prefixes}). Here's an example of how this is used:
28254
28255 @lisp
28256 (defun gnus-summary-increase-score (&optional score symp)
28257 (interactive (gnus-interactive "P\ny"))
28258 ...
28259 )
28260 @end lisp
28261
28262 The best thing to do would have been to implement
28263 @code{gnus-interactive} as a macro which would have returned an
28264 @code{interactive} form, but this isn't possible since Emacs checks
28265 whether a function is interactive or not by simply doing an @code{assq}
28266 on the lambda form. So, instead we have @code{gnus-interactive}
28267 function that takes a string and returns values that are usable to
28268 @code{interactive}.
28269
28270 This function accepts (almost) all normal @code{interactive} specs, but
28271 adds a few more.
28272
28273 @table @samp
28274 @item y
28275 @vindex gnus-current-prefix-symbol
28276 The current symbolic prefix---the @code{gnus-current-prefix-symbol}
28277 variable.
28278
28279 @item Y
28280 @vindex gnus-current-prefix-symbols
28281 A list of the current symbolic prefixes---the
28282 @code{gnus-current-prefix-symbol} variable.
28283
28284 @item A
28285 The current article number---the @code{gnus-summary-article-number}
28286 function.
28287
28288 @item H
28289 The current article header---the @code{gnus-summary-article-header}
28290 function.
28291
28292 @item g
28293 The current group name---the @code{gnus-group-group-name}
28294 function.
28295
28296 @end table
28297
28298
28299 @node Emacs/XEmacs Code
28300 @subsection Emacs/XEmacs Code
28301 @cindex XEmacs
28302 @cindex Emacsen
28303
28304 While Gnus runs under Emacs, XEmacs and Mule, I decided that one of the
28305 platforms must be the primary one. I chose Emacs. Not because I don't
28306 like XEmacs or Mule, but because it comes first alphabetically.
28307
28308 This means that Gnus will byte-compile under Emacs with nary a warning,
28309 while XEmacs will pump out gigabytes of warnings while byte-compiling.
28310 As I use byte-compilation warnings to help me root out trivial errors in
28311 Gnus, that's very useful.
28312
28313 I've also consistently used Emacs function interfaces, but have used
28314 Gnusey aliases for the functions. To take an example: Emacs defines a
28315 @code{run-at-time} function while XEmacs defines a @code{start-itimer}
28316 function. I then define a function called @code{gnus-run-at-time} that
28317 takes the same parameters as the Emacs @code{run-at-time}. When running
28318 Gnus under Emacs, the former function is just an alias for the latter.
28319 However, when running under XEmacs, the former is an alias for the
28320 following function:
28321
28322 @lisp
28323 (defun gnus-xmas-run-at-time (time repeat function &rest args)
28324 (start-itimer
28325 "gnus-run-at-time"
28326 `(lambda ()
28327 (,function ,@@args))
28328 time repeat))
28329 @end lisp
28330
28331 This sort of thing has been done for bunches of functions. Gnus does
28332 not redefine any native Emacs functions while running under XEmacs---it
28333 does this @code{defalias} thing with Gnus equivalents instead. Cleaner
28334 all over.
28335
28336 In the cases where the XEmacs function interface was obviously cleaner,
28337 I used it instead. For example @code{gnus-region-active-p} is an alias
28338 for @code{region-active-p} in XEmacs, whereas in Emacs it is a function.
28339
28340 Of course, I could have chosen XEmacs as my native platform and done
28341 mapping functions the other way around. But I didn't. The performance
28342 hit these indirections impose on Gnus under XEmacs should be slight.
28343
28344
28345 @node Various File Formats
28346 @subsection Various File Formats
28347
28348 @menu
28349 * Active File Format:: Information on articles and groups available.
28350 * Newsgroups File Format:: Group descriptions.
28351 @end menu
28352
28353
28354 @node Active File Format
28355 @subsubsection Active File Format
28356
28357 The active file lists all groups available on the server in
28358 question. It also lists the highest and lowest current article numbers
28359 in each group.
28360
28361 Here's an excerpt from a typical active file:
28362
28363 @example
28364 soc.motss 296030 293865 y
28365 alt.binaries.pictures.fractals 3922 3913 n
28366 comp.sources.unix 1605 1593 m
28367 comp.binaries.ibm.pc 5097 5089 y
28368 no.general 1000 900 y
28369 @end example
28370
28371 Here's a pseudo-BNF definition of this file:
28372
28373 @example
28374 active = *group-line
28375 group-line = group spc high-number spc low-number spc flag <NEWLINE>
28376 group = <non-white-space string>
28377 spc = " "
28378 high-number = <non-negative integer>
28379 low-number = <positive integer>
28380 flag = "y" / "n" / "m" / "j" / "x" / "=" group
28381 @end example
28382
28383 For a full description of this file, see the manual pages for
28384 @samp{innd}, in particular @samp{active(5)}.
28385
28386
28387 @node Newsgroups File Format
28388 @subsubsection Newsgroups File Format
28389
28390 The newsgroups file lists groups along with their descriptions. Not all
28391 groups on the server have to be listed, and not all groups in the file
28392 have to exist on the server. The file is meant purely as information to
28393 the user.
28394
28395 The format is quite simple; a group name, a tab, and the description.
28396 Here's the definition:
28397
28398 @example
28399 newsgroups = *line
28400 line = group tab description <NEWLINE>
28401 group = <non-white-space string>
28402 tab = <TAB>
28403 description = <string>
28404 @end example
28405
28406
28407 @page
28408 @node Emacs for Heathens
28409 @section Emacs for Heathens
28410
28411 Believe it or not, but some people who use Gnus haven't really used
28412 Emacs much before they embarked on their journey on the Gnus Love Boat.
28413 If you are one of those unfortunates whom ``@kbd{C-M-a}'', ``kill the
28414 region'', and ``set @code{gnus-flargblossen} to an alist where the key
28415 is a regexp that is used for matching on the group name'' are magical
28416 phrases with little or no meaning, then this appendix is for you. If
28417 you are already familiar with Emacs, just ignore this and go fondle your
28418 cat instead.
28419
28420 @menu
28421 * Keystrokes:: Entering text and executing commands.
28422 * Emacs Lisp:: The built-in Emacs programming language.
28423 @end menu
28424
28425
28426 @node Keystrokes
28427 @subsection Keystrokes
28428
28429 @itemize @bullet
28430 @item
28431 Q: What is an experienced Emacs user?
28432
28433 @item
28434 A: A person who wishes that the terminal had pedals.
28435 @end itemize
28436
28437 Yes, when you use Emacs, you are apt to use the control key, the shift
28438 key and the meta key a lot. This is very annoying to some people
28439 (notably @code{vi}le users), and the rest of us just love the hell out
28440 of it. Just give up and submit. Emacs really does stand for
28441 ``Escape-Meta-Alt-Control-Shift'', and not ``Editing Macros'', as you
28442 may have heard from other disreputable sources (like the Emacs author).
28443
28444 The shift keys are normally located near your pinky fingers, and are
28445 normally used to get capital letters and stuff. You probably use it all
28446 the time. The control key is normally marked ``CTRL'' or something like
28447 that. The meta key is, funnily enough, never marked as such on any
28448 keyboard. The one I'm currently at has a key that's marked ``Alt'',
28449 which is the meta key on this keyboard. It's usually located somewhere
28450 to the left hand side of the keyboard, usually on the bottom row.
28451
28452 Now, us Emacs people don't say ``press the meta-control-m key'',
28453 because that's just too inconvenient. We say ``press the @kbd{C-M-m}
28454 key''. @kbd{M-} is the prefix that means ``meta'' and ``C-'' is the
28455 prefix that means ``control''. So ``press @kbd{C-k}'' means ``press
28456 down the control key, and hold it down while you press @kbd{k}''.
28457 ``Press @kbd{C-M-k}'' means ``press down and hold down the meta key and
28458 the control key and then press @kbd{k}''. Simple, ay?
28459
28460 This is somewhat complicated by the fact that not all keyboards have a
28461 meta key. In that case you can use the ``escape'' key. Then @kbd{M-k}
28462 means ``press escape, release escape, press @kbd{k}''. That's much more
28463 work than if you have a meta key, so if that's the case, I respectfully
28464 suggest you get a real keyboard with a meta key. You can't live without
28465 it.
28466
28467
28468
28469 @node Emacs Lisp
28470 @subsection Emacs Lisp
28471
28472 Emacs is the King of Editors because it's really a Lisp interpreter.
28473 Each and every key you tap runs some Emacs Lisp code snippet, and since
28474 Emacs Lisp is an interpreted language, that means that you can configure
28475 any key to run any arbitrary code. You just, like, do it.
28476
28477 Gnus is written in Emacs Lisp, and is run as a bunch of interpreted
28478 functions. (These are byte-compiled for speed, but it's still
28479 interpreted.) If you decide that you don't like the way Gnus does
28480 certain things, it's trivial to have it do something a different way.
28481 (Well, at least if you know how to write Lisp code.) However, that's
28482 beyond the scope of this manual, so we are simply going to talk about
28483 some common constructs that you normally use in your @file{.emacs} file
28484 to customize Gnus.
28485
28486 If you want to set the variable @code{gnus-florgbnize} to four (4), you
28487 write the following:
28488
28489 @lisp
28490 (setq gnus-florgbnize 4)
28491 @end lisp
28492
28493 This function (really ``special form'') @code{setq} is the one that can
28494 set a variable to some value. This is really all you need to know. Now
28495 you can go and fill your @file{.emacs} file with lots of these to change
28496 how Gnus works.
28497
28498 If you have put that thing in your @file{.emacs} file, it will be read
28499 and @code{eval}ed (which is lisp-ese for ``run'') the next time you
28500 start Emacs. If you want to change the variable right away, simply say
28501 @kbd{C-x C-e} after the closing parenthesis. That will @code{eval} the
28502 previous ``form'', which is a simple @code{setq} statement here.
28503
28504 Go ahead---just try it, if you're located at your Emacs. After you
28505 @kbd{C-x C-e}, you will see @samp{4} appear in the echo area, which
28506 is the return value of the form you @code{eval}ed.
28507
28508 Some pitfalls:
28509
28510 If the manual says ``set @code{gnus-read-active-file} to @code{some}'',
28511 that means:
28512
28513 @lisp
28514 (setq gnus-read-active-file 'some)
28515 @end lisp
28516
28517 On the other hand, if the manual says ``set @code{gnus-nntp-server} to
28518 @samp{nntp.ifi.uio.no}'', that means:
28519
28520 @lisp
28521 (setq gnus-nntp-server "nntp.ifi.uio.no")
28522 @end lisp
28523
28524 So be careful not to mix up strings (the latter) with symbols (the
28525 former). The manual is unambiguous, but it can be confusing.
28526
28527 @page
28528 @include gnus-faq.texi
28529
28530 @node Index
28531 @chapter Index
28532 @printindex cp
28533
28534 @node Key Index
28535 @chapter Key Index
28536 @printindex ky
28537
28538 @summarycontents
28539 @contents
28540 @bye
28541
28542 @iftex
28543 @iflatex
28544 \end{document}
28545 @end iflatex
28546 @end iftex
28547
28548 @c Local Variables:
28549 @c mode: texinfo
28550 @c coding: iso-8859-1
28551 @c End:
28552
28553 @ignore
28554 arch-tag: c9fa47e7-78ca-4681-bda9-9fef45d1c819
28555 @end ignore